GDB: Introduce limited array lengths while printing values
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988--2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing @value{GDBN}
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The @value{GDBN} Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: @value{GDBN} trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Debuginfod:: Download debugging resources with @code{debuginfod}
188 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
189 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
190 how you can copy and share @value{GDBN}
191 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
192 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
193 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
194 functions, and Python data types
195 @end menu
196
197 @end ifnottex
198
199 @contents
200
201 @node Summary
202 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
203
204 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
205 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
206 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
207
208 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
209 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
210
211 @itemize @bullet
212 @item
213 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
214
215 @item
216 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
217
218 @item
219 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
220
221 @item
222 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
223 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
224 @end itemize
225
226 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
227 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
228 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
229
230 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
231 @ref{D,,D}.
232
233 @cindex Modula-2
234 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
235 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
236
237 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
238 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
239
240 @cindex Pascal
241 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
242 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
243 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
244 syntax.
245
246 @cindex Fortran
247 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
248 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
249 underscore.
250
251 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
252 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
253
254 @menu
255 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
256 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
257 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
258 @end menu
259
260 @node Free Software
261 @unnumberedsec Free Software
262
263 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
264 General Public License
265 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
266 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
267 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
268 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
269 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
270 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
271
272 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
273 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
274 from anyone else.
275
276 @node Free Documentation
277 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
278
279 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
280 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
281 include with the free software. Many of our most important
282 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
283 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
284 when an important free software package does not come with a free
285 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
286 gaps today.
287
288 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
289 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
290 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
291 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
292 them from the free software world.
293
294 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
295 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
296 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
297 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
298 contract to make it non-free.
299
300 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
301 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
302 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
303 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
304 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
305 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
306 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
307
308 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
309 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
310 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
311 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
312
313 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
314 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
315 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
316 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
317 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
318 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
319 community.
320
321 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
322 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
323 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
324 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
325 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
326 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
327 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
328 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
329 of the manual.
330
331 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
332 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
333 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
334 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
335 manual to replace it.
336
337 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
338 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
339 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
340 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
341 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
342 the free software community.
343
344 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
345 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
346 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
347 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
348 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
349 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
350 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
351 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
352 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
353
354 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
355 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
356 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
357 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
358 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
359 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
360 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
361 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
362
363 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
364 published by other publishers, at
365 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
366
367 @node Contributors
368 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
369
370 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
371 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
372 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
373 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
374 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
375 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
376 blow-by-blow account.
377
378 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
379
380 @quotation
381 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
382 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
383 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
384 @end quotation
385
386 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
387 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
388 releases:
389 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
390 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
391 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
392 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
393 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
394 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
395 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
396 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
397 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
398
399 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
400 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
401
402 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
403 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
404 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
405 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
406 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
407
408 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
409 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
410 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
411
412 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
413 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
414
415 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
416
417 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
418 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
419 support.
420 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
421 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
422 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
423 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
424 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
425 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
426 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
427 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
428 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
429 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
430 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
431 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
432 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
433 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
434 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
435 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
436
437 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
438
439 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
440 libraries.
441
442 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
443 about several machine instruction sets.
444
445 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
446 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
447 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
448 and RDI targets, respectively.
449
450 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
451 command-line editing and command history.
452
453 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
454 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
455
456 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
457 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
458 symbols.
459
460 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
461 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
462
463 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
464
465 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
466 processors.
467
468 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
469
470 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
471
472 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
473
474 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
475 watchpoints.
476
477 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
478
479 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
480
481 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
482 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
483
484 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
485 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
486 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
487 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
488 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
489 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
490 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
491
492 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
493 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
494
495 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
496 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
497 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
498 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
499 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
500 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
501 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
502 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
503 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
504 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
505 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
506 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
507 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
508 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
509 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
510
511 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
512 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
513
514 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
515 Hat.
516
517 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
518 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
519 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
520 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
521 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
522 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
523
524 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
525 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
526 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
527 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
528 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
529 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
530 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
531 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
532 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
533 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
534 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
535 Weigand.
536
537 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
538 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
539 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
540 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
541
542 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
543 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
544
545 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
546 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
547 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
548 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
549
550 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
551 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
552 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
553 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
554 SSITH research programme.
555
556 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
557 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
558 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
559 Stafford Horne.
560
561 Weimin Pan, David Faust and Jose E. Marchesi contributed support for
562 the Linux kernel BPF virtual architecture. This work was sponsored by
563 Oracle.
564
565 @node Sample Session
566 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
567
568 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
569 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
570 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
571
572 @iftex
573 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
574 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
575 @end iftex
576
577 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
578 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
579
580 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
581 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
582 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
583 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
584 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
585 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
586 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
587 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
588 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
589
590 @smallexample
591 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
592 $ @b{./m4}
593 @b{define(foo,0000)}
594
595 @b{foo}
596 0000
597 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
598
599 @b{bar}
600 0000
601 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
602
603 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
604 @b{baz}
605 @b{Ctrl-d}
606 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
611
612 @smallexample
613 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
614 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
615 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
616 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
617 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
618 the conditions.
619 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
620 for details.
621
622 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
623 (@value{GDBP})
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
628 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
629 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
630 that examples fit in this manual.
631
632 @smallexample
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
634 @end smallexample
635
636 @noindent
637 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
638 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
639 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
640 @code{break} command.
641
642 @smallexample
643 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
644 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
645 @end smallexample
646
647 @noindent
648 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
649 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
650 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
651
652 @smallexample
653 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
654 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
655 @b{define(foo,0000)}
656
657 @b{foo}
658 0000
659 @end smallexample
660
661 @noindent
662 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
663 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
664 context where it stops.
665
666 @smallexample
667 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
668
669 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
670 at builtin.c:879
671 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
672 @end smallexample
673
674 @noindent
675 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
676 the next line of the current function.
677
678 @smallexample
679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
680 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
681 : nil,
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
686 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
687 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
688 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
692 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
693 at input.c:530
694 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
699 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
700 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
701 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
702 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
703 stack frame for each active subroutine.
704
705 @smallexample
706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
707 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
708 at input.c:530
709 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
710 at builtin.c:882
711 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
712 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
713 at macro.c:71
714 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
715 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
720 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
721 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
722
723 @smallexample
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
725 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
726 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
727 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
728 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
730 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
731 : xstrdup(rq);
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
733 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
734 @end smallexample
735
736 @noindent
737 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
738 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
739 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
740 (@code{print}) to see their values.
741
742 @smallexample
743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
744 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
746 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
751 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
752 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
756 533 xfree(rquote);
757 534
758 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
759 : xstrdup (lq);
760 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
761 : xstrdup (rq);
762 537
763 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
764 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
765 540 @}
766 541
767 542 void
768 @end smallexample
769
770 @noindent
771 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
772 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
773
774 @smallexample
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
776 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
777 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
778 540 @}
779 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
780 $3 = 9
781 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
782 $4 = 7
783 @end smallexample
784
785 @noindent
786 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
787 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
788 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
789 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
790 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
791 assignments.
792
793 @smallexample
794 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
795 $5 = 7
796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
797 $6 = 9
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @noindent
801 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
802 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
803 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
804 example that caused trouble initially:
805
806 @smallexample
807 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
808 Continuing.
809
810 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
811
812 baz
813 0000
814 @end smallexample
815
816 @noindent
817 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
818 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
819 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
820
821 @smallexample
822 @b{Ctrl-d}
823 Program exited normally.
824 @end smallexample
825
826 @noindent
827 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
828 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
829 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
830
831 @smallexample
832 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
833 @end smallexample
834
835 @node Invocation
836 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
837
838 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
839 The essentials are:
840 @itemize @bullet
841 @item
842 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
843 @item
844 type @kbd{quit}, @kbd{exit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
845 @end itemize
846
847 @menu
848 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
849 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
850 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
851 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
852 @end menu
853
854 @node Invoking GDB
855 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
856
857 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
858 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
859
860 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
861 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
862
863 The command-line options described here are designed
864 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
865 options may effectively be unavailable.
866
867 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
868 specifying an executable program:
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
876 specified:
877
878 @smallexample
879 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
880 @end smallexample
881
882 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option
883 @code{-p}, if you want to debug a running process:
884
885 @smallexample
886 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
887 @value{GDBP} -p 1234
888 @end smallexample
889
890 @noindent
891 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234}. With option @option{-p} you
892 can omit the @var{program} filename.
893
894 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
895 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
896 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
897 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
898 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
899
900 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
901 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
902 option processing.
903 @smallexample
904 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
905 @end smallexample
906 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
907 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
908
909 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
910 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
911 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
912
913 @smallexample
914 @value{GDBP} --silent
915 @end smallexample
916
917 @noindent
918 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
919 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
920
921 @noindent
922 Type
923
924 @smallexample
925 @value{GDBP} -help
926 @end smallexample
927
928 @noindent
929 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
930 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
931
932 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
933 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
934 @samp{-x} option is used.
935
936
937 @menu
938 * File Options:: Choosing files
939 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
940 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
941 * Initialization Files:: Initialization Files
942 @end menu
943
944 @node File Options
945 @subsection Choosing Files
946
947 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
948 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
949 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
950 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
951 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
952 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
953 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
954 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
955 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
956 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
957 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
958 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
959 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
960
961 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
962 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
963 argument and ignore it.
964
965 For the @samp{-s}, @samp{-e}, and @samp{-se} options, and their long
966 form equivalents, the method used to search the file system for the
967 symbol and/or executable file is the same as that used by the
968 @code{file} command. @xref{Files, ,file}.
969
970 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
971 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
972 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
973 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
974 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
975
976 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
977 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
978 @c it.
979
980 @table @code
981 @item -symbols @var{file}
982 @itemx -s @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--symbols}
984 @cindex @code{-s}
985 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
986
987 @item -exec @var{file}
988 @itemx -e @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--exec}
990 @cindex @code{-e}
991 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
992 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
993
994 @item -se @var{file}
995 @cindex @code{--se}
996 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
997 file.
998
999 @item -core @var{file}
1000 @itemx -c @var{file}
1001 @cindex @code{--core}
1002 @cindex @code{-c}
1003 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
1004
1005 @item -pid @var{number}
1006 @itemx -p @var{number}
1007 @cindex @code{--pid}
1008 @cindex @code{-p}
1009 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
1010
1011 @item -command @var{file}
1012 @itemx -x @var{file}
1013 @cindex @code{--command}
1014 @cindex @code{-x}
1015 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1016 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1017 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1018
1019 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1020 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1021 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1022 @cindex @code{-ex}
1023 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1024
1025 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1026 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1027
1028 @smallexample
1029 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1030 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1031 @end smallexample
1032
1033 @item -init-command @var{file}
1034 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1035 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1036 @cindex @code{-ix}
1037 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1038 after loading gdbinit files).
1039 @xref{Startup}.
1040
1041 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1042 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1043 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1044 @cindex @code{-iex}
1045 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1046 after loading gdbinit files).
1047 @xref{Startup}.
1048
1049 @item -early-init-command @var{file}
1050 @itemx -eix @var{file}
1051 @cindex @code{--early-init-command}
1052 @cindex @code{-eix}
1053 Execute commands from @var{file} very early in the initialization
1054 process, before any output is produced. @xref{Startup}.
1055
1056 @item -early-init-eval-command @var{command}
1057 @itemx -eiex @var{command}
1058 @cindex @code{--early-init-eval-command}
1059 @cindex @code{-eiex}
1060 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command very early in the initialization
1061 process, before any output is produced.
1062
1063 @item -directory @var{directory}
1064 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1065 @cindex @code{--directory}
1066 @cindex @code{-d}
1067 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1068
1069 @item -r
1070 @itemx -readnow
1071 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1072 @cindex @code{-r}
1073 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1074 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1075 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1076
1077 @item --readnever
1078 @anchor{--readnever}
1079 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1080 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1081 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1082 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1083 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1084 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1085 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1086 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1087 @end table
1088
1089 @node Mode Options
1090 @subsection Choosing Modes
1091
1092 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1093 batch mode or quiet mode.
1094
1095 @table @code
1096 @anchor{-nx}
1097 @item -nx
1098 @itemx -n
1099 @cindex @code{--nx}
1100 @cindex @code{-n}
1101 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files
1102 (@pxref{Initialization Files}).
1103
1104 @anchor{-nh}
1105 @item -nh
1106 @cindex @code{--nh}
1107 Do not execute commands found in any home directory initialization
1108 file (@pxref{Initialization Files,,Home directory initialization
1109 file}). The system wide and current directory initialization files
1110 are still loaded.
1111
1112 @item -quiet
1113 @itemx -silent
1114 @itemx -q
1115 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1116 @cindex @code{--silent}
1117 @cindex @code{-q}
1118 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1119 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1120
1121 @kindex set startup-quietly
1122 @kindex show startup-quietly
1123 This can also be enabled using @code{set startup-quietly on}. The
1124 default is @code{off}. Use @code{show startup-quietly} to see the
1125 current setting. Place @code{set startup-quietly on} into your early
1126 initialization file (@pxref{Initialization Files,,Initialization
1127 Files}) to have future @value{GDBN} sessions startup quietly.
1128
1129 @item -batch
1130 @cindex @code{--batch}
1131 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1132 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1133 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1134 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1135 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1136 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1137 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1138
1139 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1140 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1141 make this more useful, the message
1142
1143 @smallexample
1144 Program exited normally.
1145 @end smallexample
1146
1147 @noindent
1148 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1149 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1150 mode.
1151
1152 @item -batch-silent
1153 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1154 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1155 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1156 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1157 for an interactive session.
1158
1159 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1160 messages, for example.
1161
1162 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1163 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1164
1165 @item -return-child-result
1166 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1167 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1168 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1169
1170 @itemize @bullet
1171 @item
1172 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1173 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1174 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1175 @item
1176 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1177 @item
1178 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1179 the exit code will be -1.
1180 @end itemize
1181
1182 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1183 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1184 interface.
1185
1186 @item -nowindows
1187 @itemx -nw
1188 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1189 @cindex @code{-nw}
1190 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1191 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1192 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1193
1194 @item -windows
1195 @itemx -w
1196 @cindex @code{--windows}
1197 @cindex @code{-w}
1198 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1199 used if possible.
1200
1201 @item -cd @var{directory}
1202 @cindex @code{--cd}
1203 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1204 instead of the current directory.
1205
1206 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1207 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1208 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1209 @cindex @code{-D}
1210 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1211 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1212 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1213
1214 @item -fullname
1215 @itemx -f
1216 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1217 @cindex @code{-f}
1218 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1219 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1220 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1221 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1222 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1223 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1224 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1225 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1226 frame.
1227
1228 @item -annotate @var{level}
1229 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1230 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1231 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1232 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1233 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1234 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1235 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1236 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1237 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1238
1239 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1240 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1241
1242 @item --args
1243 @cindex @code{--args}
1244 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1245 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1246 This option stops option processing.
1247
1248 @item -baud @var{bps}
1249 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1250 @cindex @code{--baud}
1251 @cindex @code{-b}
1252 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1253 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1254
1255 @item -l @var{timeout}
1256 @cindex @code{-l}
1257 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1258 for remote debugging.
1259
1260 @item -tty @var{device}
1261 @itemx -t @var{device}
1262 @cindex @code{--tty}
1263 @cindex @code{-t}
1264 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1265 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1266
1267 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1268 @item -tui
1269 @cindex @code{--tui}
1270 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1271 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1272 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1273 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1274 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1275 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1276
1277 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1278 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1279 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1280 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1281 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1282 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1283
1284 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi3}) causes
1285 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} version 3 (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1286 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 9.1. @sc{gdb/mi}
1287 version 2 (@code{mi2}), included in @value{GDBN} 6.0 and version 1 (@code{mi1}),
1288 included in @value{GDBN} 5.3, are also available. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1289 interfaces are no longer supported.
1290
1291 @item -write
1292 @cindex @code{--write}
1293 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1294 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1295 (@pxref{Patching}).
1296
1297 @item -statistics
1298 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1299 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1300 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1301
1302 @item -version
1303 @cindex @code{--version}
1304 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1305 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1306
1307 @item -configuration
1308 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1309 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1310 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1311 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1312
1313 @end table
1314
1315 @node Startup
1316 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1317 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1318
1319 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1320
1321 @enumerate
1322
1323 @item
1324 Performs minimal setup required to initialize basic internal state.
1325
1326 @item
1327 @cindex early initialization file
1328 Reads commands from the early initialization file (if any) in your
1329 home directory. Only a restricted set of commands can be placed into
1330 an early initialization file, see @ref{Initialization Files}, for
1331 details.
1332
1333 @item
1334 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-eiex} and
1335 @samp{-eix} command line options in their specified order. Only a
1336 restricted set of commands can be used with @samp{-eiex} and
1337 @samp{eix}, see @ref{Initialization Files}, for details.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1341 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1342
1343 @item
1344 @cindex init file
1345 Reads the system wide initialization file and the files from the
1346 system wide initialization directory, @pxref{System Wide Init Files}.
1347
1348 @item
1349 Reads the initialization file (if any) in your home directory and
1350 executes all the commands in that file, @pxref{Home Directory Init
1351 File}.
1352
1353 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1354 @item
1355 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1356 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1357 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1358 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1359 gets loaded.
1360
1361 @item
1362 Processes command line options and operands.
1363
1364 @item
1365 Reads and executes the commands from the initialization file (if any)
1366 in the current working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load
1367 local-gdbinit} is set to @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current
1368 Directory}). This is only done if the current directory is different
1369 from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one init file,
1370 one generic in your home directory, and another, specific to the
1371 program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1372 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Init File in the Current Directory during
1373 Startup}.
1374
1375 @item
1376 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1377 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1378 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1379 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1380
1381 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1382 you must do something like the following:
1383
1384 @smallexample
1385 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1386 @end smallexample
1387
1388 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1389 off too late.
1390
1391 @item
1392 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1393 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1394 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1395
1396 @item
1397 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1398 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1399 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1400 @end enumerate
1401
1402 @node Initialization Files
1403 @subsection Initialization Files
1404 @cindex init file name
1405
1406 During startup (@pxref{Startup}) @value{GDBN} will execute commands
1407 from several initialization files. These initialization files use the
1408 same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command Files}) and are
1409 processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way.
1410
1411 To display the list of initialization files loaded by @value{GDBN} at
1412 startup, in the order they will be loaded, you can use @kbd{gdb
1413 --help}.
1414
1415 @cindex early initialization
1416 The @dfn{early initialization} file is loaded very early in
1417 @value{GDBN}'s initialization process, before the interpreter
1418 (@pxref{Interpreters}) has been initialized, and before the default
1419 target (@pxref{Targets}) is initialized. Only @code{set} or
1420 @code{source} commands should be placed into an early initialization
1421 file, and the only @code{set} commands that can be used are those that
1422 control how @value{GDBN} starts up.
1423
1424 Commands that can be placed into an early initialization file will be
1425 documented as such throughout this manual. Any command that is not
1426 documented as being suitable for an early initialization file should
1427 instead be placed into a general initialization file. Command files
1428 passed to @code{--early-init-command} or @code{-eix} are also early
1429 initialization files, with the same command restrictions. Only
1430 commands that can appear in an early initialization file should be
1431 passed to @code{--early-init-eval-command} or @code{-eiex}.
1432
1433 @cindex general initialization
1434 In contrast, the @dfn{general initialization} files are processed
1435 later, after @value{GDBN} has finished its own internal initialization
1436 process, any valid command can be used in these files.
1437
1438 @cindex initialization file
1439 Throughout the rest of this document the term @dfn{initialization
1440 file} refers to one of the general initialization files, not the early
1441 initialization file. Any discussion of the early initialization file
1442 will specifically mention that it is the early initialization file
1443 being discussed.
1444
1445 As the system wide and home directory initialization files are
1446 processed before most command line options, changes to settings
1447 (e.g.@: @samp{set complaints}) can affect subsequent processing of
1448 command line options and operands.
1449
1450 The following sections describe where @value{GDBN} looks for the early
1451 initialization and initialization files, and the order that the files
1452 are searched for.
1453
1454 @subsubsection Home directory early initialization files
1455
1456 @value{GDBN} initially looks for an early initialization file in the
1457 users home directory@footnote{On DOS/Windows systems, the home
1458 directory is the one pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
1459 variable.}. There are a number of locations that @value{GDBN} will
1460 search in the home directory, these locations are searched in order
1461 and @value{GDBN} will load the first file that it finds, and
1462 subsequent locations will not be checked.
1463
1464 On non-macOS hosts the locations searched are:
1465 @itemize
1466 @item
1467 The file @file{gdb/gdbearlyinit} within the directory pointed to by the
1468 environment variable @env{XDG_CONFIG_HOME}, if it is defined.
1469 @item
1470 The file @file{.config/gdb/gdbearlyinit} within the directory pointed to
1471 by the environment variable @env{HOME}, if it is defined.
1472 @item
1473 The file @file{.gdbearlyinit} within the directory pointed to by the
1474 environment variable @env{HOME}, if it is defined.
1475 @end itemize
1476
1477 By contrast, on macOS hosts the locations searched are:
1478 @itemize
1479 @item
1480 The file @file{Library/Preferences/gdb/gdbearlyinit} within the
1481 directory pointed to by the environment variable @env{HOME}, if it is
1482 defined.
1483 @item
1484 The file @file{.gdbearlyinit} within the directory pointed to by the
1485 environment variable @env{HOME}, if it is defined.
1486 @end itemize
1487
1488 It is possible to prevent the home directory early initialization file
1489 from being loaded using the @samp{-nx} or @samp{-nh} command line
1490 options, @pxref{Mode Options,,Choosing Modes}.
1491
1492 @anchor{System Wide Init Files}
1493 @subsubsection System wide initialization files
1494
1495 There are two locations that are searched for system wide
1496 initialization files. Both of these locations are always checked:
1497
1498 @table @code
1499
1500 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1501 This is a single system-wide initialization file. Its location is
1502 specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit} configure option
1503 (@pxref{System-wide configuration}). It is loaded first when
1504 @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options have been processed.
1505
1506 @item @file{system.gdbinit.d}
1507 This is the system-wide initialization directory. Its location is
1508 specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit-dir} configure option
1509 (@pxref{System-wide configuration}). Files in this directory are
1510 loaded in alphabetical order immediately after @file{system.gdbinit}
1511 (if enabled) when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1512 have been processed. Files need to have a recognized scripting
1513 language extension (@file{.py}/@file{.scm}) or be named with a
1514 @file{.gdb} extension to be interpreted as regular @value{GDBN}
1515 commands. @value{GDBN} will not recurse into any subdirectories of
1516 this directory.
1517
1518 @end table
1519
1520 It is possible to prevent the system wide initialization files from
1521 being loaded using the @samp{-nx} command line option, @pxref{Mode
1522 Options,,Choosing Modes}.
1523
1524 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1525 @subsubsection Home directory initialization file
1526 @cindex @file{gdbinit}
1527 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1528 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1529
1530 After loading the system wide initialization files @value{GDBN} will
1531 look for an initialization file in the users home
1532 directory@footnote{On DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the
1533 one pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment variable.}. There are a
1534 number of locations that @value{GDBN} will search in the home
1535 directory, these locations are searched in order and @value{GDBN} will
1536 load the first file that it finds, and subsequent locations will not
1537 be checked.
1538
1539 On non-Apple hosts the locations searched are:
1540 @table @file
1541 @item $XDG_CONFIG_HOME/gdb/gdbinit
1542 @item $HOME/.config/gdb/gdbinit
1543 @item $HOME/.gdbinit
1544 @end table
1545
1546 While on Apple hosts the locations searched are:
1547 @table @file
1548 @item $HOME/Library/Preferences/gdb/gdbinit
1549 @item $HOME/.gdbinit
1550 @end table
1551
1552 It is possible to prevent the home directory initialization file from
1553 being loaded using the @samp{-nx} or @samp{-nh} command line options,
1554 @pxref{Mode Options,,Choosing Modes}.
1555
1556 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead of
1557 @file{.gdbinit} or @file{gdbinit}, due to the limitations of file
1558 names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows port of @value{GDBN}
1559 uses the standard name, but if it finds a @file{gdb.ini} file in your
1560 home directory, it warns you about that and suggests to rename the
1561 file to the standard name.
1562
1563 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1564 @subsubsection Local directory initialization file
1565
1566 @value{GDBN} will check the current directory for a file called
1567 @file{.gdbinit}. It is loaded last, after command line options
1568 other than @samp{-x} and @samp{-ex} have been processed. The command
1569 line options @samp{-x} and @samp{-ex} are processed last, after
1570 @file{.gdbinit} has been loaded, @pxref{File Options,,Choosing
1571 Files}.
1572
1573 If the file in the current directory was already loaded as the home
1574 directory initialization file then it will not be loaded a second
1575 time.
1576
1577 It is possible to prevent the local directory initialization file from
1578 being loaded using the @samp{-nx} command line option, @pxref{Mode
1579 Options,,Choosing Modes}.
1580
1581 @node Quitting GDB
1582 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1583 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1584 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1585
1586 @table @code
1587 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1588 @kindex exit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1589 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1590 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1591 @itemx exit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1592 @itemx q
1593 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1594 @code{q}), the @code{exit} command, or type an end-of-file
1595 character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you do not supply @var{expression},
1596 @value{GDBN} will terminate normally; otherwise it will terminate using
1597 the result of @var{expression} as the error code.
1598 @end table
1599
1600 @cindex interrupt
1601 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1602 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1603 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1604 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1605 until a time when it is safe.
1606
1607 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1608 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1609 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1610
1611 @node Shell Commands
1612 @section Shell Commands
1613
1614 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1615 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1616 just use the @code{shell} command.
1617
1618 @table @code
1619 @kindex shell
1620 @kindex !
1621 @cindex shell escape
1622 @item shell @var{command-string}
1623 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1624 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1625 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1626 On GNU and Unix systems, the environment variable @env{SHELL}, if it
1627 exists, determines which shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses
1628 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on GNU and Unix systems,
1629 @file{cmd.exe} on MS-Windows, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1630 @end table
1631
1632 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1633 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1634 @value{GDBN}:
1635
1636 @table @code
1637 @kindex make
1638 @cindex calling make
1639 @item make @var{make-args}
1640 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1641 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1642 @end table
1643
1644 @table @code
1645 @kindex pipe
1646 @kindex |
1647 @cindex send the output of a gdb command to a shell command
1648 @anchor{pipe}
1649 @item pipe [@var{command}] | @var{shell_command}
1650 @itemx | [@var{command}] | @var{shell_command}
1651 @itemx pipe -d @var{delim} @var{command} @var{delim} @var{shell_command}
1652 @itemx | -d @var{delim} @var{command} @var{delim} @var{shell_command}
1653 Executes @var{command} and sends its output to @var{shell_command}.
1654 Note that no space is needed around @code{|}.
1655 If no @var{command} is provided, the last command executed is repeated.
1656
1657 In case the @var{command} contains a @code{|}, the option @code{-d @var{delim}}
1658 can be used to specify an alternate delimiter string @var{delim} that separates
1659 the @var{command} from the @var{shell_command}.
1660
1661 Example:
1662 @smallexample
1663 @group
1664 (@value{GDBP}) p var
1665 $1 = @{
1666 black = 144,
1667 red = 233,
1668 green = 377,
1669 blue = 610,
1670 white = 987
1671 @}
1672 @end group
1673 @group
1674 (@value{GDBP}) pipe p var|wc
1675 7 19 80
1676 (@value{GDBP}) |p var|wc -l
1677 7
1678 @end group
1679 @group
1680 (@value{GDBP}) p /x var
1681 $4 = @{
1682 black = 0x90,
1683 red = 0xe9,
1684 green = 0x179,
1685 blue = 0x262,
1686 white = 0x3db
1687 @}
1688 (@value{GDBP}) ||grep red
1689 red => 0xe9,
1690 @end group
1691 @group
1692 (@value{GDBP}) | -d ! echo this contains a | char\n ! sed -e 's/|/PIPE/'
1693 this contains a PIPE char
1694 (@value{GDBP}) | -d xxx echo this contains a | char!\n xxx sed -e 's/|/PIPE/'
1695 this contains a PIPE char!
1696 (@value{GDBP})
1697 @end group
1698 @end smallexample
1699 @end table
1700
1701 The convenience variables @code{$_shell_exitcode} and @code{$_shell_exitsignal}
1702 can be used to examine the exit status of the last shell command launched
1703 by @code{shell}, @code{make}, @code{pipe} and @code{|}.
1704 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}.
1705
1706 @node Logging Output
1707 @section Logging Output
1708 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1709 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1710
1711 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1712 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1713
1714 @table @code
1715 @kindex set logging enabled
1716 @item set logging enabled [on|off]
1717 Enable or disable logging.
1718 @cindex logging file name
1719 @item set logging file @var{file}
1720 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1721 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1722 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1723 you want @code{set logging enabled on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1724 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1725 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1726 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1727 @item set logging debugredirect [on|off]
1728 By default, @value{GDBN} debug output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1729 Set @code{debugredirect} if you want debug output to go only to the log file.
1730 @kindex show logging
1731 @item show logging
1732 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1733 @end table
1734
1735 You can also redirect the output of a @value{GDBN} command to a
1736 shell command. @xref{pipe}.
1737 @node Commands
1738 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1739
1740 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1741 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1742 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1743 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1744 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1745
1746 @menu
1747 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1748 * Command Settings:: How to change default behavior of commands
1749 * Completion:: Command completion
1750 * Command Options:: Command options
1751 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1752 @end menu
1753
1754 @node Command Syntax
1755 @section Command Syntax
1756
1757 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1758 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1759 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1760 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1761 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1762 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1763
1764 @cindex abbreviation
1765 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1766 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1767 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1768 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1769 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1770 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1771 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1772
1773 @cindex repeating commands
1774 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1775 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1776 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1777 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1778 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1779 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1780 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1781
1782 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1783 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1784 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1785
1786 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1787 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1788 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1789 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1790 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1791
1792 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1793 @cindex comment
1794 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1795 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1796 Files,,Command Files}).
1797
1798 @cindex repeating command sequences
1799 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1800 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1801 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1802 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1803 for editing.
1804
1805
1806 @node Command Settings
1807 @section Command Settings
1808 @cindex default behavior of commands, changing
1809 @cindex default settings, changing
1810
1811 Many commands change their behavior according to command-specific
1812 variables or settings. These settings can be changed with the
1813 @code{set} subcommands. For example, the @code{print} command
1814 (@pxref{Data, ,Examining Data}) prints arrays differently depending on
1815 settings changeable with the commands @code{set print elements
1816 NUMBER-OF-ELEMENTS} and @code{set print array-indexes}, among others.
1817
1818 You can change these settings to your preference in the gdbinit files
1819 loaded at @value{GDBN} startup. @xref{Startup}.
1820
1821 The settings can also be changed interactively during the debugging
1822 session. For example, to change the limit of array elements to print,
1823 you can do the following:
1824 @smallexample
1825 (@value{GDBP}) set print elements 10
1826 (@value{GDBP}) print some_array
1827 $1 = @{0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90...@}
1828 @end smallexample
1829
1830 The above @code{set print elements 10} command changes the number of
1831 elements to print from the default of 200 to 10. If you only intend
1832 this limit of 10 to be used for printing @code{some_array}, then you
1833 must restore the limit back to 200, with @code{set print elements
1834 200}.
1835
1836 Some commands allow overriding settings with command options. For
1837 example, the @code{print} command supports a number of options that
1838 allow overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set
1839 print} subcommands. @xref{print options}. The example above could be
1840 rewritten as:
1841 @smallexample
1842 (@value{GDBP}) print -elements 10 -- some_array
1843 $1 = @{0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90...@}
1844 @end smallexample
1845
1846 Alternatively, you can use the @code{with} command to change a setting
1847 temporarily, for the duration of a command invocation.
1848
1849 @table @code
1850 @kindex with command
1851 @kindex w @r{(@code{with})}
1852 @cindex settings
1853 @cindex temporarily change settings
1854 @item with @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
1855 @itemx w @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
1856 Temporarily set @var{setting} to @var{value} for the duration of
1857 @var{command}.
1858
1859 @var{setting} is any setting you can change with the @code{set}
1860 subcommands. @var{value} is the value to assign to @code{setting}
1861 while running @code{command}.
1862
1863 If no @var{command} is provided, the last command executed is
1864 repeated.
1865
1866 If a @var{command} is provided, it must be preceded by a double dash
1867 (@code{--}) separator. This is required because some settings accept
1868 free-form arguments, such as expressions or filenames.
1869
1870 For example, the command
1871 @smallexample
1872 (@value{GDBP}) with print array on -- print some_array
1873 @end smallexample
1874 @noindent
1875 is equivalent to the following 3 commands:
1876 @smallexample
1877 (@value{GDBP}) set print array on
1878 (@value{GDBP}) print some_array
1879 (@value{GDBP}) set print array off
1880 @end smallexample
1881
1882 The @code{with} command is particularly useful when you want to
1883 override a setting while running user-defined commands, or commands
1884 defined in Python or Guile. @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
1885
1886 @smallexample
1887 (@value{GDBP}) with print pretty on -- my_complex_command
1888 @end smallexample
1889
1890 To change several settings for the same command, you can nest
1891 @code{with} commands. For example, @code{with language ada -- with
1892 print elements 10} temporarily changes the language to Ada and sets a
1893 limit of 10 elements to print for arrays and strings.
1894
1895 @end table
1896
1897 @node Completion
1898 @section Command Completion
1899
1900 @cindex completion
1901 @cindex word completion
1902 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1903 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1904 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1905 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, command options, and the names of symbols
1906 in your program.
1907
1908 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1909 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1910 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1911 enter it). For example, if you type
1912
1913 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1914 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1915 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1916 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1917 @smallexample
1918 (@value{GDBP}) info bre@key{TAB}
1919 @end smallexample
1920
1921 @noindent
1922 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1923 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1924
1925 @smallexample
1926 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1927 @end smallexample
1928
1929 @noindent
1930 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1931 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1932 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1933 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1934 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1935 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1936
1937 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1938 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1939 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1940 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1941 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1942 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1943 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1944 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1945 example:
1946
1947 @smallexample
1948 (@value{GDBP}) b make_@key{TAB}
1949 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1950 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1951 make_abs_section make_function_type
1952 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1953 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1954 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1955 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1956 @end smallexample
1957
1958 @noindent
1959 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1960 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1961 command.
1962
1963 If the command you are trying to complete expects either a keyword or a
1964 number to follow, then @samp{NUMBER} will be shown among the available
1965 completions, for example:
1966
1967 @smallexample
1968 (@value{GDBP}) print -elements @key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1969 NUMBER unlimited
1970 (@value{GDBP}) print -elements@tie{}
1971 @end smallexample
1972
1973 @noindent
1974 Here, the option expects a number (e.g., @code{100}), not literal
1975 @code{NUMBER}. Such metasyntactical arguments are always presented in
1976 uppercase.
1977
1978 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1979 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1980 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1981 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1982 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1983
1984 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1985 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1986 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1987
1988 @smallexample
1989 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1990 main
1991 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1992 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1993 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1994 @end smallexample
1995
1996 @noindent
1997 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex set max-completions
2001 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
2002 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
2003 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
2004 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
2005 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
2006 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
2007 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
2008 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
2009 completion slow.
2010 @kindex show max-completions
2011 @item show max-completions
2012 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
2013 during completion.
2014 @end table
2015
2016 @cindex quotes in commands
2017 @cindex completion of quoted strings
2018 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
2019 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
2020 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
2021 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
2022 @value{GDBN} commands.
2023
2024 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
2025 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
2026 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
2027 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
2028 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
2029 Operators}).
2030
2031 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
2032 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
2033 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
2034 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
2035 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
2036 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
2037 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
2038 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
2039 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
2040
2041 @smallexample
2042 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<@kbd{M-?}
2043 func<int>() func<float>()
2044 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
2045 @end smallexample
2046
2047 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Location Specifications}), you don't
2048 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
2049 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
2050 function:
2051
2052 @smallexample
2053 (@value{GDBP}) b func<@kbd{M-?}
2054 func<int>() func<float>()
2055 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
2056 @end smallexample
2057
2058 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
2059 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
2060 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
2061 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
2062 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
2063 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
2064
2065 @smallexample
2066 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(@kbd{M-?}
2067 bubble(int) bubble(double)
2068 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou@kbd{M-?}
2069 bubble(double)
2070 @end smallexample
2071
2072 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
2073 require quoting.
2074
2075 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
2076 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
2077 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
2078 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
2079
2080 @cindex completion of structure field names
2081 @cindex structure field name completion
2082 @cindex completion of union field names
2083 @cindex union field name completion
2084 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
2085 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
2086 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
2087 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
2088 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
2089 left-hand-side:
2090
2091 @smallexample
2092 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
2093 magic to_fputs to_rewind
2094 to_data to_isatty to_write
2095 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
2096 to_flush to_read
2097 @end smallexample
2098
2099 @noindent
2100 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
2101 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
2102 follows:
2103
2104 @smallexample
2105 struct ui_file
2106 @{
2107 int *magic;
2108 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
2109 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
2110 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
2111 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
2112 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
2113 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
2114 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
2115 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
2116 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
2117 void *to_data;
2118 @}
2119 @end smallexample
2120
2121 @node Command Options
2122 @section Command options
2123
2124 @cindex command options
2125 Some commands accept options starting with a leading dash. For
2126 example, @code{print -pretty}. Similarly to command names, you can
2127 abbreviate a @value{GDBN} option to the first few letters of the
2128 option name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous, and you can also use
2129 the @key{TAB} key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word
2130 in an option (or to show you the alternatives available, if there is
2131 more than one possibility).
2132
2133 @cindex command options, raw input
2134 Some commands take raw input as argument. For example, the print
2135 command processes arbitrary expressions in any of the languages
2136 supported by @value{GDBN}. With such commands, because raw input may
2137 start with a leading dash that would be confused with an option or any
2138 of its abbreviations, e.g.@: @code{print -p} (short for @code{print
2139 -pretty} or printing negative @code{p}?), if you specify any command
2140 option, then you must use a double-dash (@code{--}) delimiter to
2141 indicate the end of options.
2142
2143 @cindex command options, boolean
2144
2145 Some options are described as accepting an argument which can be
2146 either @code{on} or @code{off}. These are known as @dfn{boolean
2147 options}. Similarly to boolean settings commands---@code{on} and
2148 @code{off} are the typical values, but any of @code{1}, @code{yes} and
2149 @code{enable} can also be used as ``true'' value, and any of @code{0},
2150 @code{no} and @code{disable} can also be used as ``false'' value. You
2151 can also omit a ``true'' value, as it is implied by default.
2152
2153 For example, these are equivalent:
2154
2155 @smallexample
2156 (@value{GDBP}) print -object on -pretty off -element unlimited -- *myptr
2157 (@value{GDBP}) p -o -p 0 -e u -- *myptr
2158 @end smallexample
2159
2160 You can discover the set of options some command accepts by completing
2161 on @code{-} after the command name. For example:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) print -@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
2165 -address -max-depth -object -static-members
2166 -array -memory-tag-violations -pretty -symbol
2167 -array-indexes -nibbles -raw-values -union
2168 -elements -null-stop -repeats -vtbl
2169 @end smallexample
2170
2171 Completion will in some cases guide you with a suggestion of what kind
2172 of argument an option expects. For example:
2173
2174 @smallexample
2175 (@value{GDBP}) print -elements @key{TAB}@key{TAB}
2176 NUMBER unlimited
2177 @end smallexample
2178
2179 @noindent
2180 Here, the option expects a number (e.g., @code{100}), not literal
2181 @code{NUMBER}. Such metasyntactical arguments are always presented in
2182 uppercase.
2183
2184 (For more on using the @code{print} command, see @ref{Data, ,Examining
2185 Data}.)
2186
2187 @node Help
2188 @section Getting Help
2189 @cindex online documentation
2190 @kindex help
2191
2192 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
2193 using the command @code{help}.
2194
2195 @table @code
2196 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
2197 @item help
2198 @itemx h
2199 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
2200 display a short list of named classes of commands:
2201
2202 @smallexample
2203 (@value{GDBP}) help
2204 List of classes of commands:
2205
2206 aliases -- User-defined aliases of other commands
2207 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2208 data -- Examining data
2209 files -- Specifying and examining files
2210 internals -- Maintenance commands
2211 obscure -- Obscure features
2212 running -- Running the program
2213 stack -- Examining the stack
2214 status -- Status inquiries
2215 support -- Support facilities
2216 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
2217 stopping the program
2218 user-defined -- User-defined commands
2219
2220 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
2221 commands in that class.
2222 Type "help" followed by command name for full
2223 documentation.
2224 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
2225 (@value{GDBP})
2226 @end smallexample
2227 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
2228
2229 @item help @var{class}
2230 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
2231 list of the individual commands in that class. If a command has
2232 aliases, the aliases are given after the command name, separated by
2233 commas. If an alias has default arguments, the full definition of
2234 the alias is given after the first line.
2235 For example, here is the help display for the class @code{status}:
2236
2237 @smallexample
2238 (@value{GDBP}) help status
2239 Status inquiries.
2240
2241 List of commands:
2242
2243 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
2244 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
2245 info, inf, i -- Generic command for showing things
2246 about the program being debugged
2247 info address, iamain -- Describe where symbol SYM is stored.
2248 alias iamain = info address main
2249 info all-registers -- List of all registers and their contents,
2250 for selected stack frame.
2251 ...
2252 show, info set -- Generic command for showing things
2253 about the debugger
2254
2255 Type "help" followed by command name for full
2256 documentation.
2257 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
2258 (@value{GDBP})
2259 @end smallexample
2260
2261 @item help @var{command}
2262 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
2263 short paragraph on how to use that command. If that command has
2264 one or more aliases, @value{GDBN} will display a first line with
2265 the command name and all its aliases separated by commas.
2266 This first line will be followed by the full definition of all aliases
2267 having default arguments.
2268 When asking the help for an alias, the documentation for the aliased
2269 command is shown.
2270
2271 A user-defined alias can optionally be documented using the
2272 @code{document} command (@pxref{Define, document}). @value{GDBN} then
2273 considers this alias as different from the aliased command: this alias
2274 is not listed in the aliased command help output, and asking help for
2275 this alias will show the documentation provided for the alias instead of
2276 the documentation of the aliased command.
2277
2278 @kindex apropos
2279 @item apropos [-v] @var{regexp}
2280 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
2281 commands and aliases, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
2282 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. The optional flag @samp{-v},
2283 which stands for @samp{verbose}, indicates to output the full documentation
2284 of the matching commands and highlight the parts of the documentation
2285 matching @var{regexp}. For example:
2286
2287 @smallexample
2288 apropos alias
2289 @end smallexample
2290
2291 @noindent
2292 results in:
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 @group
2296 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
2297 aliases -- User-defined aliases of other commands
2298 @end group
2299 @end smallexample
2300
2301 @noindent
2302 while
2303
2304 @smallexample
2305 apropos -v cut.*thread apply
2306 @end smallexample
2307
2308 @noindent
2309 results in the below output, where @samp{cut for 'thread apply}
2310 is highlighted if styling is enabled.
2311
2312 @smallexample
2313 @group
2314 taas -- Apply a command to all threads (ignoring errors
2315 and empty output).
2316 Usage: taas COMMAND
2317 shortcut for 'thread apply all -s COMMAND'
2318
2319 tfaas -- Apply a command to all frames of all threads
2320 (ignoring errors and empty output).
2321 Usage: tfaas COMMAND
2322 shortcut for 'thread apply all -s frame apply all -s COMMAND'
2323 @end group
2324 @end smallexample
2325
2326 @kindex complete
2327 @item complete @var{args}
2328 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
2329 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
2330 command you want completed. For example:
2331
2332 @smallexample
2333 complete i
2334 @end smallexample
2335
2336 @noindent results in:
2337
2338 @smallexample
2339 @group
2340 if
2341 ignore
2342 info
2343 inspect
2344 @end group
2345 @end smallexample
2346
2347 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
2348 @end table
2349
2350 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
2351 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
2352 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
2353 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
2354 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
2355 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
2356 Index}.
2357
2358 @c @group
2359 @table @code
2360 @kindex info
2361 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
2362 @item info
2363 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
2364 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
2365 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
2366 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
2367 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
2368 @w{@code{help info}}.
2369
2370 @kindex set
2371 @item set
2372 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
2373 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
2374 @code{set prompt $}.
2375
2376 @kindex show
2377 @item show
2378 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
2379 @value{GDBN} itself.
2380 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
2381 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
2382 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
2383 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
2384
2385 @kindex info set
2386 To display all the settable parameters and their current
2387 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
2388 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
2389 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
2390 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
2391 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
2392 @end table
2393 @c @end group
2394
2395 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
2396 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
2397
2398 @table @code
2399 @kindex show version
2400 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
2401 @item show version
2402 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2403 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
2404 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
2405 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
2406 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
2407 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
2408 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2409 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
2410 @value{GDBN}.
2411
2412 @kindex show copying
2413 @kindex info copying
2414 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
2415 @item show copying
2416 @itemx info copying
2417 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
2418
2419 @kindex show warranty
2420 @kindex info warranty
2421 @item show warranty
2422 @itemx info warranty
2423 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
2424 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2425
2426 @kindex show configuration
2427 @item show configuration
2428 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
2429 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
2430 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
2431 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
2432 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
2433 your report.
2434
2435 @end table
2436
2437 @node Running
2438 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
2439
2440 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
2441 debugging information when you compile it.
2442
2443 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
2444 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
2445 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
2446 kill a child process.
2447
2448 @menu
2449 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
2450 * Starting:: Starting your program
2451 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
2452 * Environment:: Your program's environment
2453
2454 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
2455 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
2456 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
2457 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
2458 * Inferiors Connections and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors
2459 connections and programs
2460 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
2461 * Forks:: Debugging forks
2462 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2463 @end menu
2464
2465 @node Compilation
2466 @section Compiling for Debugging
2467
2468 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
2469 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
2470 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
2471 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
2472 and addresses in the executable code.
2473
2474 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2475 the compiler.
2476
2477 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2478 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2479 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2480 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2481 executables containing debugging information.
2482
2483 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2484 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2485 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2486 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2487 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2488
2489 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2490 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2491 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2492
2493 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2494 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2495 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2496 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2497 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2498 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2499
2500 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2501 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2502 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2503
2504 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2505 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2506 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2507 format in @value{GDBN}.
2508
2509 @need 2000
2510 @node Starting
2511 @section Starting your Program
2512 @cindex starting
2513 @cindex running
2514
2515 @table @code
2516 @kindex run
2517 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2518 @item run
2519 @itemx r
2520 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2521 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2522 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2523 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2524 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2525
2526 @end table
2527
2528 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2529 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2530 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2531 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2532 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2533 message like this one:
2534
2535 @smallexample
2536 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2537 Try "help target" or "continue".
2538 @end smallexample
2539
2540 @noindent
2541 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2542 first (@pxref{load}).
2543
2544 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2545 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2546 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2547 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2548 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2549 divided into four categories:
2550
2551 @table @asis
2552 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2553 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2554 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2555 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2556 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2557 the arguments.
2558 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2559 @env{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @env{SHELL},
2560 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2561 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2562 below for details).
2563
2564 @item The @emph{environment.}
2565 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2566 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2567 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2568 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2569
2570 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2571 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2572 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2573 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2574 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2575 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2576 Directory}.
2577
2578 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2579 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2580 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2581 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2582 set a different device for your program.
2583 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2584
2585 @cindex pipes
2586 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2587 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2588 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2589 wrong program.
2590 @end table
2591
2592 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2593 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2594 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2595 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2596 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2597
2598 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2599 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2600 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2601 your current breakpoints.
2602
2603 @table @code
2604 @kindex start
2605 @item start
2606 @cindex run to main procedure
2607 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2608 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2609 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2610 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2611 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2612 procedure, depending on the language used.
2613
2614 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2615 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2616 the @samp{run} command.
2617
2618 @cindex elaboration phase
2619 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2620 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2621 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2622 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2623 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2624 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2625 will remain to halt execution.
2626
2627 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2628 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2629 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2630 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2631 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2632
2633 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2634 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2635 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2636 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2637 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2638 use the @code{starti} command.
2639
2640 @kindex starti
2641 @item starti
2642 @cindex run to first instruction
2643 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2644 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2645 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2646 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2647 the start of the elaboration phase.
2648
2649 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2650 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2651 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2652 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2653 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2654 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2655 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2656 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2657 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2658 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2659 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2660 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2661
2662 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2663 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2664 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2665 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2666
2667 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2668 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2669 environment:
2670
2671 @smallexample
2672 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2673 (@value{GDBP}) run
2674 @end smallexample
2675
2676 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2677 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2678
2679 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2680 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2681 @item set startup-with-shell
2682 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2683 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2684 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2685 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2686 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2687 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2688 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2689 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2690 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2691 startup failures such as:
2692
2693 @smallexample
2694 (@value{GDBP}) run
2695 Starting program: ./a.out
2696 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2697 @end smallexample
2698
2699 @noindent
2700 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2701 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2702 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2703 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2704 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2705 @env{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2706
2707 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2708 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2709 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2710 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2711 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2712 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2713
2714 By default, if the current inferior is not connected to any target yet
2715 (e.g., with @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your
2716 program as a native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine.
2717 If you're sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine,
2718 you can tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target
2719 automatically with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off}
2720 command.
2721
2722 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if the current inferior is not
2723 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2724 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2725
2726 If @code{off}, and if the current inferior is not connected to a
2727 target already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2728
2729 @smallexample
2730 (@value{GDBP}) run
2731 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2732 @end smallexample
2733
2734 If the current inferior is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN}
2735 always uses it with the @code{run} command.
2736
2737 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2738 @code{target native} command. For example,
2739
2740 @smallexample
2741 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2742 (@value{GDBP}) run
2743 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2744 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2745 (@value{GDBP}) run
2746 Starting program: ./a.out
2747 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2748 @end smallexample
2749
2750 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2751 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2752 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2753 disconnect.
2754
2755 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2756 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2757 proc}, @code{info os}.
2758
2759 @kindex set disable-randomization
2760 @item set disable-randomization
2761 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2762 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2763 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2764 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2765 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2766
2767 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2768 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2769
2770 @smallexample
2771 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2772 @end smallexample
2773
2774 @item set disable-randomization off
2775 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2776 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2777 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2778 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2779 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2780 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2781
2782 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2783 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2784 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2785 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2786 a code at its expected addresses.
2787
2788 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2789 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2790 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2791 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2792 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2793 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2794 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2795 a randomly chosen address.
2796
2797 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2798 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2799 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2800 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2801 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2802
2803 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2804 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2805
2806 @item show disable-randomization
2807 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2808 the virtual address space of the started program.
2809
2810 @end table
2811
2812 @node Arguments
2813 @section Your Program's Arguments
2814
2815 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2816 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2817 @code{run} command.
2818 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2819 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2820 @env{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2821 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @env{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2822 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2823
2824 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2825 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2826 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2827 the program, not by the shell.
2828
2829 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2830 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2831
2832 @table @code
2833 @kindex set args
2834 @item set args
2835 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2836 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2837 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2838 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2839 it again without arguments.
2840
2841 @kindex show args
2842 @item show args
2843 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2844 @end table
2845
2846 @node Environment
2847 @section Your Program's Environment
2848
2849 @cindex environment (of your program)
2850 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2851 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2852 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2853 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2854 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2855 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2856 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2857
2858 @table @code
2859 @kindex path
2860 @item path @var{directory}
2861 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @env{PATH} environment variable
2862 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2863 The value of @env{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2864 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2865 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2866 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2867 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2868
2869 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2870 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2871 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2872 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2873 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2874 @var{directory} to the search path.
2875 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2876 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2877
2878 @kindex show paths
2879 @item show paths
2880 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @env{PATH}
2881 environment variable).
2882
2883 @kindex show environment
2884 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2885 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2886 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2887 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2888 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2889
2890 @kindex set environment
2891 @anchor{set environment}
2892 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2893 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2894 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2895 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2896 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2897 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2898 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2899 null value.
2900 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2901 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2902
2903 For example, this command:
2904
2905 @smallexample
2906 set env USER = foo
2907 @end smallexample
2908
2909 @noindent
2910 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2911 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2912 are not actually required.)
2913
2914 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2915 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2916 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2917 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2918 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2919
2920 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2921 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2922 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2923
2924 @kindex unset environment
2925 @anchor{unset environment}
2926 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2927 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2928 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2929 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2930 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2931
2932 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2933 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2934 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2935 @end table
2936
2937 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2938 the shell indicated by your @env{SHELL} environment variable if it
2939 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @env{SHELL} variable
2940 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2941 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2942 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @env{BASH_ENV}
2943 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2944 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2945 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2946 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2947
2948 @node Working Directory
2949 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2950
2951 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2952 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2953 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2954 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2955 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2956 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2957 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2958 debugging.
2959
2960 @table @code
2961 @kindex set cwd
2962 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2963 @anchor{set cwd command}
2964 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2965 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2966 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2967 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2968 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2969 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2970 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2971 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2972 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2973 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2974 fallback.
2975
2976 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2977 the @code{cd} command.
2978 @xref{cd command}.
2979
2980 @kindex show cwd
2981 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2982 @item show cwd
2983 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2984 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2985 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2986
2987 @kindex cd
2988 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2989 @anchor{cd command}
2990 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2991 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2992 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2993
2994 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2995 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2996 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2997 @xref{set cwd command}.
2998
2999 @kindex pwd
3000 @item pwd
3001 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
3002 @end table
3003
3004 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
3005 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
3006 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
3007 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
3008 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
3009 current working directory of the debuggee.
3010
3011 @node Input/Output
3012 @section Your Program's Input and Output
3013
3014 @cindex redirection
3015 @cindex i/o
3016 @cindex terminal
3017 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
3018 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
3019 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
3020 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
3021 running your program.
3022
3023 @table @code
3024 @kindex info terminal
3025 @item info terminal
3026 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
3027 program is using.
3028 @end table
3029
3030 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
3031 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
3032
3033 @smallexample
3034 run > outfile
3035 @end smallexample
3036
3037 @noindent
3038 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
3039
3040 @kindex tty
3041 @cindex controlling terminal
3042 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
3043 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
3044 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
3045 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
3046 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
3047
3048 @smallexample
3049 tty /dev/ttyb
3050 @end smallexample
3051
3052 @noindent
3053 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
3054 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
3055 that as their controlling terminal.
3056
3057 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
3058 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
3059 terminal.
3060
3061 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
3062 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
3063 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
3064 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
3065
3066 @cindex inferior tty
3067 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
3068 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
3069 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
3070 program.
3071
3072 @table @code
3073 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
3074 @kindex set inferior-tty
3075 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
3076 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
3077 @value{GDBN}.
3078
3079 @item show inferior-tty
3080 @kindex show inferior-tty
3081 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
3082 @end table
3083
3084 @node Attach
3085 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
3086 @kindex attach
3087 @cindex attach
3088
3089 @table @code
3090 @item attach @var{process-id}
3091 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
3092 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
3093 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
3094 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
3095 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
3096
3097 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
3098 executing the command.
3099 @end table
3100
3101 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
3102 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
3103 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
3104 also have permission to send the process a signal.
3105
3106 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
3107 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
3108 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
3109 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
3110 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
3111 Specify Files}.
3112
3113 @anchor{set exec-file-mismatch}
3114 If the debugger can determine that the executable file running in the
3115 process it is attaching to does not match the current exec-file loaded
3116 by @value{GDBN}, the option @code{exec-file-mismatch} specifies how to
3117 handle the mismatch. @value{GDBN} tries to compare the files by
3118 comparing their build IDs (@pxref{build ID}), if available.
3119
3120 @table @code
3121 @kindex exec-file-mismatch
3122 @cindex set exec-file-mismatch
3123 @item set exec-file-mismatch @samp{ask|warn|off}
3124
3125 Whether to detect mismatch between the current executable file loaded
3126 by @value{GDBN} and the executable file used to start the process. If
3127 @samp{ask}, the default, display a warning and ask the user whether to
3128 load the process executable file; if @samp{warn}, just display a
3129 warning; if @samp{off}, don't attempt to detect a mismatch.
3130 If the user confirms loading the process executable file, then its symbols
3131 will be loaded as well.
3132
3133 @cindex show exec-file-mismatch
3134 @item show exec-file-mismatch
3135 Show the current value of @code{exec-file-mismatch}.
3136
3137 @end table
3138
3139 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
3140 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
3141 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
3142 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
3143 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
3144 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
3145 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
3146
3147 @table @code
3148 @kindex detach
3149 @item detach
3150 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
3151 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
3152 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
3153 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
3154 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
3155 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
3156 executing the command.
3157 @end table
3158
3159 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
3160 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
3161 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
3162 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
3163 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
3164 Messages}).
3165
3166 @node Kill Process
3167 @section Killing the Child Process
3168
3169 @table @code
3170 @kindex kill
3171 @item kill
3172 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
3173 @end table
3174
3175 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
3176 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
3177 is running.
3178
3179 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
3180 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
3181 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
3182 outside the debugger.
3183
3184 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
3185 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
3186 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
3187 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
3188 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
3189 breakpoint settings).
3190
3191 @node Inferiors Connections and Programs
3192 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors Connections and Programs
3193
3194 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
3195 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
3196 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
3197 before starting another). On some systems @value{GDBN} may even let
3198 you debug several programs simultaneously on different remote systems.
3199 In the most general case, you can have multiple threads of execution
3200 in each of multiple processes, launched from multiple executables,
3201 running on different machines.
3202
3203 @cindex inferior
3204 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
3205 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
3206 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
3207 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
3208 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
3209 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
3210 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
3211 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
3212 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
3213 threads running in it.
3214
3215 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
3216 inferiors}}:
3217
3218 @table @code
3219 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
3220 @item info inferiors
3221 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
3222 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
3223 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
3224 the display to just the requested inferiors.
3225
3226 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
3227
3228 @enumerate
3229 @item
3230 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3231
3232 @item
3233 the target system's inferior identifier
3234
3235 @item
3236 the target connection the inferior is bound to, including the unique
3237 connection number assigned by @value{GDBN}, and the protocol used by
3238 the connection.
3239
3240 @item
3241 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
3242
3243 @end enumerate
3244
3245 @noindent
3246 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
3247 indicates the current inferior.
3248
3249 For example,
3250 @end table
3251 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3252
3253 @smallexample
3254 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3255 Num Description Connection Executable
3256 * 1 process 3401 1 (native) goodbye
3257 2 process 2307 2 (extended-remote host:10000) hello
3258 @end smallexample
3259
3260 To get informations about the current inferior, use @code{inferior}:
3261
3262 @table @code
3263 @kindex inferior
3264 @item inferior
3265 Shows information about the current inferior.
3266
3267 For example,
3268 @end table
3269 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3270
3271 @smallexample
3272 (@value{GDBP}) inferior
3273 [Current inferior is 1 [process 3401] (helloworld)]
3274 @end smallexample
3275
3276 To find out what open target connections exist at any moment, use
3277 @w{@code{info connections}}:
3278
3279 @table @code
3280 @kindex info connections [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
3281 @item info connections
3282 Print a list of all open target connections currently being managed by
3283 @value{GDBN}. By default all connections are printed, but the
3284 argument @var{id}@dots{} -- a space separated list of connections
3285 numbers -- can be used to limit the display to just the requested
3286 connections.
3287
3288 @value{GDBN} displays for each connection (in this order):
3289
3290 @enumerate
3291 @item
3292 the connection number assigned by @value{GDBN}.
3293
3294 @item
3295 the protocol used by the connection.
3296
3297 @item
3298 a textual description of the protocol used by the connection.
3299
3300 @end enumerate
3301
3302 @noindent
3303 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the connection number indicates the
3304 connection of the current inferior.
3305
3306 For example,
3307 @end table
3308 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3309
3310 @smallexample
3311 (@value{GDBP}) info connections
3312 Num What Description
3313 * 1 extended-remote host:10000 Extended remote serial target in gdb-specific protocol
3314 2 native Native process
3315 3 core Local core dump file
3316 @end smallexample
3317
3318 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
3319
3320 @table @code
3321 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
3322 @item inferior @var{infno}
3323 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
3324 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
3325 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
3326 @end table
3327
3328 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
3329 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
3330 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
3331 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
3332 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
3333 information on convenience variables.
3334
3335 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
3336 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
3337 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
3338 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
3339 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
3340 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
3341
3342 @table @code
3343 @anchor{add_inferior_cli}
3344 @kindex add-inferior
3345 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ] [-no-connection ]
3346 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
3347 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
3348 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
3349 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
3350 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
3351
3352 By default, the new inferior begins connected to the same target
3353 connection as the current inferior. For example, if the current
3354 inferior was connected to @code{gdbserver} with @code{target remote},
3355 then the new inferior will be connected to the same @code{gdbserver}
3356 instance. The @samp{-no-connection} option starts the new inferior
3357 with no connection yet. You can then for example use the @code{target
3358 remote} command to connect to some other @code{gdbserver} instance,
3359 use @code{run} to spawn a local program, etc.
3360
3361 @kindex clone-inferior
3362 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
3363 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
3364 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
3365 number of the current inferior. This command copies the values of the
3366 @var{args}, @w{@var{inferior-tty}} and @var{cwd} properties from the
3367 current inferior to the new one. It also propagates changes the user
3368 made to environment variables using the @w{@code{set environment}} and
3369 @w{@code{unset environment}} commands. This is a convenient command
3370 when you want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
3371
3372 @smallexample
3373 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3374 Num Description Connection Executable
3375 * 1 process 29964 1 (native) helloworld
3376 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
3377 Added inferior 2.
3378 1 inferiors added.
3379 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3380 Num Description Connection Executable
3381 * 1 process 29964 1 (native) helloworld
3382 2 <null> 1 (native) helloworld
3383 @end smallexample
3384
3385 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
3386
3387 @kindex remove-inferiors
3388 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3389 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
3390 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
3391 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
3392
3393 @end table
3394
3395 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
3396 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
3397 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
3398 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
3399
3400 @table @code
3401 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3402 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
3403 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
3404 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
3405 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
3406 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
3407
3408 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3409 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3410 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
3411 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
3412 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
3413 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
3414 @end table
3415
3416 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
3417 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
3418 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
3419 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
3420
3421
3422 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
3423 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
3424
3425 @table @code
3426 @kindex set print inferior-events
3427 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
3428 @item set print inferior-events
3429 @itemx set print inferior-events on
3430 @itemx set print inferior-events off
3431 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
3432 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
3433 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
3434 detached. By default, these messages will be printed.
3435
3436 @kindex show print inferior-events
3437 @item show print inferior-events
3438 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
3439 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
3440 @end table
3441
3442 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
3443 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
3444 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
3445
3446
3447 Occasionally, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
3448 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
3449 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
3450 info program-spaces}} command.
3451
3452 @table @code
3453 @kindex maint info program-spaces
3454 @item maint info program-spaces
3455 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
3456 @value{GDBN}.
3457
3458 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
3459
3460 @enumerate
3461 @item
3462 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3463
3464 @item
3465 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
3466 the @code{file} command.
3467
3468 @item
3469 the name of the core file loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
3470 the @code{core-file} command.
3471
3472 @end enumerate
3473
3474 @noindent
3475 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
3476 indicates the current program space.
3477
3478 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
3479 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
3480 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
3481
3482 @smallexample
3483 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
3484 Id Executable Core File
3485 * 1 hello
3486 2 goodbye
3487 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
3488 @end smallexample
3489
3490 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
3491 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
3492 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
3493 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
3494 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
3495
3496 @smallexample
3497 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
3498 Id Executable Core File
3499 * 1 vfork-test
3500 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
3501 @end smallexample
3502
3503 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
3504 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
3505 @end table
3506
3507 @node Threads
3508 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
3509
3510 @cindex threads of execution
3511 @cindex multiple threads
3512 @cindex switching threads
3513 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
3514 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
3515 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
3516 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
3517 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
3518 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
3519 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
3520
3521 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
3522 programs:
3523
3524 @itemize @bullet
3525 @item automatic notification of new threads
3526 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
3527 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
3528 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
3529 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
3530 @item thread-specific breakpoints
3531 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
3532 messages on thread start and exit.
3533 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
3534 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
3535 isn't compatible with the program.
3536 @end itemize
3537
3538 @cindex focus of debugging
3539 @cindex current thread
3540 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
3541 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
3542 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
3543 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
3544 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
3545
3546 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
3547 @cindex thread identifier (system)
3548 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
3549 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
3550 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
3551 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
3552 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
3553 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
3554 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
3555 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
3556
3557 @smallexample
3558 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
3559 @end smallexample
3560
3561 @noindent
3562 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
3563 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
3564 further qualifier.
3565
3566 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
3567 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
3568 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
3569 @c program?
3570 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
3571 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
3572 @c threads ab initio?
3573
3574 @anchor{thread numbers}
3575 @cindex thread number, per inferior
3576 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
3577 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
3578 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
3579 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
3580 between threads of different inferiors.
3581
3582 @cindex qualified thread ID
3583 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3584 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3585 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3586 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3587 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3588 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3589 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3590 inferior.
3591
3592 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3593 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3594 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3595 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3596
3597 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3598 @cindex thread ID lists
3599 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3600 argument. A list element can be:
3601
3602 @enumerate
3603 @item
3604 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3605 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3606 @samp{1}.
3607
3608 @item
3609 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3610 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3611 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3612
3613 @item
3614 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3615 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3616 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3617 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3618 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3619
3620 @end enumerate
3621
3622 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3623 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3624 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3625 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3626 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3627 7.1}.
3628
3629
3630 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3631 @cindex global thread number
3632 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3633 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3634 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3635 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3636 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3637 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3638
3639 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3640 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3641 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3642
3643 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3644 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3645 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3646 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3647 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3648 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3649 and so forth. The convenience variable @samp{$_inferior_thread_count}
3650 contains the number of live threads in the current inferior.
3651 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
3652 information on convenience variables.
3653
3654 When running in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), where new
3655 threads can be created, and existing threads exit, at any time,
3656 @samp{$_inferior_thread_count} could return a different value each
3657 time it is evaluated.
3658
3659 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3660 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3661 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3662
3663 @smallexample
3664 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3665 @end smallexample
3666
3667 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3668
3669 @smallexample
3670 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3671 @end smallexample
3672
3673 @table @code
3674 @anchor{info_threads}
3675 @kindex info threads
3676 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3677
3678 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3679 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3680 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3681 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3682
3683 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3684
3685 @enumerate
3686 @item
3687 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3688
3689 @item
3690 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3691 option was specified
3692
3693 @item
3694 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3695
3696 @item
3697 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3698 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3699 program itself.
3700
3701 @item
3702 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3703 @end enumerate
3704
3705 @noindent
3706 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3707 indicates the current thread.
3708
3709 For example,
3710 @end table
3711 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3712
3713 @smallexample
3714 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3715 Id Target Id Frame
3716 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3717 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3718 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3719 at threadtest.c:68
3720 @end smallexample
3721
3722 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3723 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3724 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3725
3726 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3727 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3728
3729 @smallexample
3730 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3731 Id GId Target Id Frame
3732 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3733 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3734 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3735 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3736 @end smallexample
3737
3738 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3739 Solaris-specific command:
3740
3741 @table @code
3742 @item maint info sol-threads
3743 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3744 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3745 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3746 @end table
3747
3748 @table @code
3749 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3750 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3751 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3752 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3753 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3754 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3755
3756 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3757 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3758
3759 @smallexample
3760 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3761 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3762 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3763 8 printf ("hello\n");
3764 @end smallexample
3765
3766 @noindent
3767 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3768 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3769 threads.
3770
3771 @anchor{thread apply all}
3772 @kindex thread apply
3773 @cindex apply command to several threads
3774 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3775 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3776 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3777 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3778 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3779 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3780 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3781 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3782
3783 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3784 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3785 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3786 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3787 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3788
3789 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3790 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3791 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3792 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3793
3794 @table @code
3795 @item -c
3796 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3797 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3798 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3799 @item -s
3800 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3801 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3802 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3803 are not printed.
3804 @item -q
3805 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3806 information.
3807 @end table
3808
3809 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3810
3811 @kindex taas
3812 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3813 @item taas [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
3814 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}}.
3815 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3816
3817 The @code{taas} command accepts the same options as the @code{thread
3818 apply all} command. @xref{thread apply all}.
3819
3820 @kindex tfaas
3821 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3822 @item tfaas [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
3823 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s -- frame apply all -s [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}}.
3824 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3825 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3826 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3827 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3828 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3829 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3830 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3831
3832 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3833 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3834 is, using:
3835 @smallexample
3836 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3837 @end smallexample
3838
3839 The @code{tfaas} command accepts the same options as the @code{frame
3840 apply} command. @xref{Frame Apply,,frame apply}.
3841
3842 @kindex thread name
3843 @cindex name a thread
3844 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3845 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3846 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3847 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3848
3849 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3850 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3851 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3852 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3853 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3854
3855 @kindex thread find
3856 @cindex search for a thread
3857 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3858 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3859 matches the supplied regular expression.
3860
3861 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3862 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3863 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3864 is the LWP id.
3865
3866 @smallexample
3867 (@value{GDBP}) thread find 26688
3868 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3869 (@value{GDBP}) info thread 4
3870 Id Target Id Frame
3871 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3872 @end smallexample
3873
3874 @kindex set print thread-events
3875 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3876 @item set print thread-events
3877 @itemx set print thread-events on
3878 @itemx set print thread-events off
3879 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3880 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3881 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3882 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3883 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3884
3885 @kindex show print thread-events
3886 @item show print thread-events
3887 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3888 have started and exited.
3889 @end table
3890
3891 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3892 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3893 programs with multiple threads.
3894
3895 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3896 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3897
3898 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3899 @table @code
3900 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3901 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3902 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3903 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3904 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3905 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3906 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3907 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3908 macro.
3909
3910 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3911 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3912 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3913 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3914 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3915 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3916
3917 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3918 refers to the default system directories that are
3919 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3920 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3921 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3922
3923 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3924 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3925 was loaded in the inferior process.
3926
3927 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3928 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3929 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3930 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3931 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3932 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3933 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3934
3935 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3936 only on some platforms.
3937
3938 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3939 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3940 Display current libthread_db search path.
3941
3942 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3943 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3944 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3945 @item set debug libthread-db
3946 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3947 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3948 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3949
3950 @kindex set debug threads
3951 @kindex show debug threads
3952 @cindex debugging @code{threads}
3953 @item set debug threads @r{[}on@r{|}off@r{]}
3954 @itemx show debug threads
3955 When @samp{on} @value{GDBN} will print additional messages when
3956 threads are created and deleted.
3957 @end table
3958
3959 @node Forks
3960 @section Debugging Forks
3961
3962 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3963 @cindex multiple processes
3964 @cindex processes, multiple
3965 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3966 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3967 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3968 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3969 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3970 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3971 will cause it to terminate.
3972
3973 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3974 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3975 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3976 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3977 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3978 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3979 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3980 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3981 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3982 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3983
3984 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3985 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3986 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3987 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3988
3989 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3990 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3991 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3992
3993 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3994 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3995
3996 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3997 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3998
3999 @table @code
4000 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
4001 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
4002 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
4003 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
4004 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
4005
4006 @table @code
4007 @item parent
4008 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
4009 unimpeded. This is the default.
4010
4011 @item child
4012 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
4013 unimpeded.
4014
4015 @end table
4016
4017 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
4018 @item show follow-fork-mode
4019 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
4020 @end table
4021
4022 @cindex debugging multiple processes
4023 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
4024 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
4025
4026 @table @code
4027 @kindex set detach-on-fork
4028 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
4029 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
4030 retain debugger control over them both.
4031
4032 @table @code
4033 @item on
4034 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
4035 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
4036 independently. This is the default.
4037
4038 @item off
4039 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
4040 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
4041 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
4042 is held suspended.
4043
4044 @end table
4045
4046 @kindex show detach-on-fork
4047 @item show detach-on-fork
4048 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
4049 @end table
4050
4051 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
4052 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
4053 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
4054 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
4055 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors Connections and
4056 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors Connections and Programs}).
4057
4058 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
4059 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
4060 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
4061 command. @xref{Inferiors Connections and Programs, ,Debugging
4062 Multiple Inferiors Connections and Programs}.
4063
4064 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
4065 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
4066 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
4067 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
4068 the child process's @code{main}.
4069
4070 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
4071 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
4072
4073 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
4074 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
4075 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
4076 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
4077 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
4078 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
4079 command.
4080
4081 @table @code
4082 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
4083 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
4084
4085 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
4086 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
4087
4088 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
4089
4090 @table @code
4091 @item new
4092 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
4093 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
4094 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
4095 original inferior.
4096
4097 For example:
4098
4099 @smallexample
4100 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
4101 (@value{GDBP}) info inferior
4102 Id Description Executable
4103 * 1 <null> prog1
4104 (@value{GDBP}) run
4105 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
4106 Program exited normally.
4107 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
4108 Id Description Executable
4109 1 <null> prog1
4110 * 2 <null> prog2
4111 @end smallexample
4112
4113 @item same
4114 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
4115 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
4116 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
4117 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
4118 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
4119
4120 For example:
4121
4122 @smallexample
4123 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
4124 Id Description Executable
4125 * 1 <null> prog1
4126 (@value{GDBP}) run
4127 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
4128 Program exited normally.
4129 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
4130 Id Description Executable
4131 * 1 <null> prog2
4132 @end smallexample
4133
4134 @end table
4135 @end table
4136
4137 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
4138 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
4139
4140 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
4141 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
4142 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
4143
4144 @node Checkpoint/Restart
4145 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
4146
4147 @cindex checkpoint
4148 @cindex restart
4149 @cindex bookmark
4150 @cindex snapshot of a process
4151 @cindex rewind program state
4152
4153 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
4154 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
4155 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
4156 later.
4157
4158 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
4159 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
4160 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
4161 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
4162 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
4163
4164 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
4165 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
4166 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
4167 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
4168 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
4169 start again from there.
4170
4171 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
4172 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
4173
4174 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
4175
4176 @table @code
4177 @kindex checkpoint
4178 @item checkpoint
4179 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
4180 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
4181 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
4182
4183 @kindex info checkpoints
4184 @item info checkpoints
4185 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
4186 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
4187 listed:
4188
4189 @table @code
4190 @item Checkpoint ID
4191 @item Process ID
4192 @item Code Address
4193 @item Source line, or label
4194 @end table
4195
4196 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
4197 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
4198 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
4199 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
4200 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
4201 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
4202 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
4203
4204 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
4205 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
4206 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
4207 the debugger.
4208
4209 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
4210 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
4211 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
4212
4213 @end table
4214
4215 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
4216 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
4217 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
4218 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
4219 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
4220 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
4221 previously read data can be read again.
4222
4223 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
4224 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
4225 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
4226 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
4227 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
4228 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
4229
4230 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
4231 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
4232 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
4233 different execution path this time.
4234
4235 @cindex checkpoints and process id
4236 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
4237 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
4238 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
4239 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
4240 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
4241 potentially pose a problem.
4242
4243 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
4244
4245 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
4246 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
4247 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
4248 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
4249 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
4250 next.
4251
4252 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
4253 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
4254 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
4255 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
4256 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
4257
4258 @node Stopping
4259 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
4260
4261 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
4262 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
4263 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
4264
4265 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
4266 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
4267 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
4268 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
4269 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
4270 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
4271 explicitly request this information at any time.
4272
4273 @table @code
4274 @kindex info program
4275 @item info program
4276 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
4277 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
4278 @end table
4279
4280 @menu
4281 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
4282 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
4283 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
4284 Skipping over functions and files
4285 * Signals:: Signals
4286 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4287 @end menu
4288
4289 @node Breakpoints
4290 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
4291
4292 @cindex breakpoints
4293 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
4294 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
4295 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
4296 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
4297 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
4298 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
4299 program.
4300
4301 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
4302 the executable is run.
4303
4304 @cindex watchpoints
4305 @cindex data breakpoints
4306 @cindex memory tracing
4307 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
4308 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
4309 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
4310 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
4311 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
4312 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
4313 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
4314 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
4315 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
4316 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
4317 same commands.
4318
4319 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
4320 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
4321 Automatic Display}.
4322
4323 @cindex catchpoints
4324 @cindex breakpoint on events
4325 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
4326 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
4327 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
4328 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
4329 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
4330 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
4331 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4332
4333 @cindex breakpoint numbers
4334 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
4335 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4336 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
4337 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
4338 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
4339 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
4340 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
4341 enable it again.
4342
4343 @cindex breakpoint ranges
4344 @cindex breakpoint lists
4345 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
4346 @cindex lists of breakpoints
4347 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
4348 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
4349 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
4350 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
4351 are operated on.
4352
4353 @menu
4354 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
4355 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
4356 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
4357 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
4358 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
4359 * Conditions:: Break conditions
4360 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
4361 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
4362 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
4363 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
4364 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4365 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4366 @end menu
4367
4368 @node Set Breaks
4369 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
4370
4371 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
4372 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
4373 @c
4374 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
4375
4376 @kindex break
4377 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
4378 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
4379 @cindex latest breakpoint
4380 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
4381 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
4382 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently:
4383 @smallexample
4384 (gdb) b main
4385 Breakpoint 1 at 0x11c6: file zeoes.c, line 24.
4386 (gdb) p $bpnum
4387 $1 = 1
4388 @end smallexample
4389
4390 A breakpoint may be mapped to multiple code locations for example with
4391 inlined functions, Ada generics, C@t{++} templates or overloaded function names.
4392 @value{GDBN} then indicates the number of code locations in the breakpoint
4393 command output:
4394 @smallexample
4395 (gdb) b some_func
4396 Breakpoint 2 at 0x1179: some_func. (3 locations)
4397 (gdb) p $bpnum
4398 $2 = 2
4399 (gdb)
4400 @end smallexample
4401
4402 @vindex $_hit_bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
4403 @vindex $_hit_locno@r{, convenience variable}
4404 When your program stops on a breakpoint, the convenience variables
4405 @samp{$_hit_bpnum} and @samp{$_hit_locno} are respectively set to the number of
4406 the encountered breakpoint and the number of the breakpoint's code location:
4407 @smallexample
4408 Thread 1 "zeoes" hit Breakpoint 2.1, some_func () at zeoes.c:8
4409 8 printf("some func\n");
4410 (gdb) p $_hit_bpnum
4411 $5 = 2
4412 (gdb) p $_hit_locno
4413 $6 = 1
4414 (gdb)
4415 @end smallexample
4416
4417 Note that @samp{$_hit_bpnum} and @samp{$bpnum} are not equivalent:
4418 @samp{$_hit_bpnum} is set to the breakpoint number @b{last hit}, while
4419 @samp{$bpnum} is set to the breakpoint number @b{last set}.
4420
4421
4422 If the encountered breakpoint has only one code location, @samp{$_hit_locno}
4423 is set to 1:
4424 @smallexample
4425 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0x7fffffffe018) at zeoes.c:24
4426 24 if (argc > 1)
4427 (gdb) p $_hit_bpnum
4428 $3 = 1
4429 (gdb) p $_hit_locno
4430 $4 = 1
4431 (gdb)
4432 @end smallexample
4433
4434 The @samp{$_hit_bpnum} and @samp{$_hit_locno} variables can typically be used
4435 in a breakpoint command list.
4436 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}). For example, as
4437 part of the breakpoint command list, you can disable completely the
4438 encountered breakpoint using @kbd{disable $_hit_bpnum} or disable the
4439 specific encountered breakpoint location using
4440 @kbd{disable $_hit_bpnum.$_hit_locno}.
4441 If a breakpoint has only one location, @samp{$_hit_locno} is set to 1
4442 and the commands @kbd{disable $_hit_bpnum} and
4443 @kbd{disable $_hit_bpnum.$_hit_locno} both disable the breakpoint.
4444
4445 You can also define aliases to easily disable the last hit location or
4446 last hit breakpoint:
4447 @smallexample
4448 (gdb) alias lld = disable $_hit_bpnum.$_hit_locno
4449 (gdb) alias lbd = disable $_hit_bpnum
4450 @end smallexample
4451
4452 @table @code
4453 @item break @var{locspec}
4454 Set a breakpoint at all the code locations in your program that result
4455 from resolving the given @var{locspec}. @var{locspec} can specify a
4456 function name, a line number, an address of an instruction, and more.
4457 @xref{Location Specifications}, for the various forms of
4458 @var{locspec}. The breakpoint will stop your program just before it
4459 executes the instruction at the address of any of the breakpoint's
4460 code locations.
4461
4462 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such
4463 as C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one symbol, and
4464 thus more than one place to break. @xref{Ambiguous
4465 Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of that
4466 situation.
4467
4468 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
4469 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
4470 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
4471
4472 @item break
4473 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
4474 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
4475 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
4476 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
4477 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
4478 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
4479 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
4480 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
4481 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
4482 inside loops.
4483
4484 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
4485 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
4486 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
4487 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
4488 existed when your program stopped.
4489
4490 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
4491 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
4492 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
4493 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
4494 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
4495 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
4496 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
4497
4498 The breakpoint may be mapped to multiple locations. If the breakpoint
4499 condition @var{cond} is invalid at some but not all of the locations,
4500 the locations for which the condition is invalid are disabled. For
4501 example, @value{GDBN} reports below that two of the three locations
4502 are disabled.
4503
4504 @smallexample
4505 (@value{GDBP}) break func if a == 10
4506 warning: failed to validate condition at location 0x11ce, disabling:
4507 No symbol "a" in current context.
4508 warning: failed to validate condition at location 0x11b6, disabling:
4509 No symbol "a" in current context.
4510 Breakpoint 1 at 0x11b6: func. (3 locations)
4511 @end smallexample
4512
4513 Locations that are disabled because of the condition are denoted by an
4514 uppercase @code{N} in the output of the @code{info breakpoints}
4515 command:
4516
4517 @smallexample
4518 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
4519 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4520 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4521 stop only if a == 10
4522 1.1 N* 0x00000000000011b6 in ...
4523 1.2 y 0x00000000000011c2 in ...
4524 1.3 N* 0x00000000000011ce in ...
4525 (*): Breakpoint condition is invalid at this location.
4526 @end smallexample
4527
4528 If the breakpoint condition @var{cond} is invalid in the context of
4529 @emph{all} the locations of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN} refuses to
4530 define the breakpoint. For example, if variable @code{foo} is an
4531 undefined variable:
4532
4533 @smallexample
4534 (@value{GDBP}) break func if foo
4535 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4536 @end smallexample
4537
4538 @item break @dots{} -force-condition if @var{cond}
4539 There may be cases where the condition @var{cond} is invalid at all
4540 the current locations, but the user knows that it will be valid at a
4541 future location; for example, because of a library load. In such
4542 cases, by using the @code{-force-condition} keyword before @samp{if},
4543 @value{GDBN} can be forced to define the breakpoint with the given
4544 condition expression instead of refusing it.
4545
4546 @smallexample
4547 (@value{GDBP}) break func -force-condition if foo
4548 warning: failed to validate condition at location 1, disabling:
4549 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4550 warning: failed to validate condition at location 2, disabling:
4551 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4552 warning: failed to validate condition at location 3, disabling:
4553 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4554 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1158: test.c:18. (3 locations)
4555 @end smallexample
4556
4557 This causes all the present locations where the breakpoint would
4558 otherwise be inserted, to be disabled, as seen in the example above.
4559 However, if there exist locations at which the condition is valid, the
4560 @code{-force-condition} keyword has no effect.
4561
4562 @kindex tbreak
4563 @item tbreak @var{args}
4564 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
4565 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
4566 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
4567 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
4568
4569 @kindex hbreak
4570 @cindex hardware breakpoints
4571 @item hbreak @var{args}
4572 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
4573 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
4574 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
4575 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
4576 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
4577 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
4578 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
4579 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
4580 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
4581 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
4582 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
4583 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
4584 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
4585 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
4586 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
4587 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4588 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4589 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4590
4591 @kindex thbreak
4592 @item thbreak @var{args}
4593 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
4594 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
4595 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
4596 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
4597 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
4598 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
4599 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
4600 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
4601
4602 @kindex rbreak
4603 @cindex regular expression
4604 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
4605 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
4606 @item rbreak @var{regex}
4607 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
4608 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
4609 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
4610 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
4611 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
4612 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
4613
4614 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
4615 to print the list of all breakpoints it sets according to the
4616 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
4617 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
4618 language of the breakpoint's function, other values mean to use
4619 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
4620
4621 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
4622 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
4623 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
4624 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
4625 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
4626 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
4627
4628 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
4629 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
4630 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
4631 classes.
4632
4633 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
4634 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
4635 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
4636
4637 @smallexample
4638 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
4639 @end smallexample
4640
4641 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
4642 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
4643 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
4644 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
4645 every function in a given file:
4646
4647 @smallexample
4648 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
4649 @end smallexample
4650
4651 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
4652 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
4653
4654 @kindex info breakpoints
4655 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
4656 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4657 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4658 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
4659 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
4660 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
4661 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
4662
4663 @table @emph
4664 @item Breakpoint Numbers
4665 @item Type
4666 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
4667 @item Disposition
4668 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
4669 @item Enabled or Disabled
4670 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
4671 that are not enabled.
4672 @item Address
4673 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
4674 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
4675 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
4676 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
4677 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
4678 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
4679 @item What
4680 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
4681 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
4682 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
4683 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
4684 @end table
4685
4686 @noindent
4687 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
4688 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
4689 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
4690 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
4691 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
4692 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
4693
4694 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
4695 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
4696 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
4697 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
4698
4699 @noindent
4700 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
4701 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
4702 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
4703 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
4704 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
4705
4706 @noindent
4707 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
4708 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
4709 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
4710 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
4711 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
4712 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
4713
4714 @noindent
4715 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
4716 @code{info break} also displays that count.
4717
4718 @end table
4719
4720 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
4721 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
4722 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
4723 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4724
4725 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
4726 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
4727 It is possible that a single logical breakpoint is set at several code
4728 locations in your program. @xref{Location Specifications}, for
4729 examples.
4730
4731 A breakpoint with multiple code locations is displayed in the
4732 breakpoint table using several rows---one header row, followed by one
4733 row for each code location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in
4734 the address column. Each code location row contains the actual
4735 address, source file, source line and function of its code location.
4736 The number column for a code location is of the form
4737 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4738
4739 For example:
4740
4741 @smallexample
4742 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4743 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4744 stop only if i==1
4745 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4746 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4747 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4748 @end smallexample
4749
4750 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4751 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4752 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4753 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4754 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4755 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4756 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4757 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4758 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4759 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4760 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4761
4762 Locations that are enabled while their parent breakpoint is disabled
4763 won't trigger a break, and are denoted by @code{y-} in the @code{Enb}
4764 column. For example:
4765
4766 @smallexample
4767 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
4768 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4769 1 breakpoint keep n <MULTIPLE>
4770 1.1 y- 0x00000000000011b6 in ...
4771 1.2 y- 0x00000000000011c2 in ...
4772 1.3 n 0x00000000000011ce in ...
4773 @end smallexample
4774
4775 @cindex pending breakpoints
4776 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4777 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4778 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4779 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4780 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4781 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4782 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4783 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4784 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4785 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4786 is not yet resolved.
4787
4788 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4789 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4790 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4791 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4792 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4793 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4794
4795 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4796 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4797 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4798 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4799
4800 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4801 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4802 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4803
4804 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4805 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve the location spec
4806 to any code location in your program (@pxref{Location
4807 Specifications}):
4808
4809 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4810 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4811 @table @code
4812 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4813 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot resolve the
4814 location spec, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be
4815 created.
4816
4817 @item set breakpoint pending on
4818 This indicates that when @value{GDBN} cannot resolve the location
4819 spec, it should create a pending breakpoint without confirmation.
4820
4821 @item set breakpoint pending off
4822 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. If
4823 @value{GDBN} cannot resolve the location spec, it aborts the
4824 breakpoint creation with an error. This setting does not affect any
4825 pending breakpoints previously created.
4826
4827 @item show breakpoint pending
4828 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4829 @end table
4830
4831 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4832 variants. Once a breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4833 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4834
4835 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4836 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4837 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4838 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4839 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4840 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4841 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4842 breakpoints.
4843
4844 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4845
4846 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4847 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4848 @table @code
4849 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4850 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4851 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4852 breakpoint must be used.
4853
4854 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4855 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4856 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4857 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4858 @end table
4859
4860 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4861 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4862 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4863 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4864 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4865 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4866 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4867 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4868 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4869
4870 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4871 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4872 @table @code
4873 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4874 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4875 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4876 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4877
4878 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4879 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4880 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4881 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4882 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4883 @end table
4884
4885 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4886 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4887 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4888
4889 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4890 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4891
4892 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4893
4894 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4895 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4896 @table @code
4897 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4898 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4899 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4900 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4901 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4902
4903 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4904 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4905 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4906 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4907 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4908 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4909 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4910 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4911 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4912 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4913 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4914 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4915 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4916
4917 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4918 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4919 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4920 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4921 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4922 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4923 @end table
4924
4925
4926 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4927 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4928 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4929 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4930 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4931 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4932 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4933 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4934
4935
4936 @node Set Watchpoints
4937 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4938
4939 @cindex setting watchpoints
4940 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4941 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4942 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4943 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4944 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4945
4946 @itemize @bullet
4947 @item
4948 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4949
4950 @item
4951 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4952 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4953 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4954
4955 @item
4956 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4957 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4958 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4959 @end itemize
4960
4961 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4962 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4963 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4964 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4965 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4966 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4967 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4968 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4969 the expression changes.
4970
4971 @cindex software watchpoints
4972 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4973 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4974 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4975 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4976 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4977 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4978 culprit.)
4979
4980 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4981 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4982 slow down the running of your program.
4983
4984 @table @code
4985 @kindex watch
4986 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]} @r{[}task @var{task-id}@r{]}
4987 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4988 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4989 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4990 to watch the value of a single variable:
4991
4992 @smallexample
4993 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4994 @end smallexample
4995
4996 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4997 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4998 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4999 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
5000 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
5001 with Hardware Watchpoints.
5002
5003 Similarly, if the @code{task} argument is given, then the watchpoint
5004 will be specific to the indicated Ada task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
5005
5006 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
5007 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
5008 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
5009 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
5010 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
5011 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
5012 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
5013 error.
5014
5015 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
5016 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
5017 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
5018 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
5019 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
5020 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
5021 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
5022 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
5023 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
5024 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
5025 Examples:
5026
5027 @smallexample
5028 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
5029 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
5030 @end smallexample
5031
5032 @kindex rwatch
5033 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
5034 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
5035 by the program.
5036
5037 @kindex awatch
5038 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
5039 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
5040 or written into by the program.
5041
5042 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5043 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5044 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
5045 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
5046 @end table
5047
5048 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
5049 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
5050 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
5051 a never-changing value:
5052
5053 @smallexample
5054 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
5055 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
5056 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
5057 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
5058 @end smallexample
5059
5060 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
5061 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
5062 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
5063 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
5064 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
5065 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
5066
5067 @cindex use only software watchpoints
5068 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
5069 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
5070 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
5071 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
5072 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
5073 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
5074 mechanism of watching expression values.)
5075
5076 @table @code
5077 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
5078 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
5079 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
5080
5081 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
5082 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
5083 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
5084 @end table
5085
5086 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
5087 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
5088 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
5089
5090 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
5091
5092 @smallexample
5093 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
5094 @end smallexample
5095
5096 @noindent
5097 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
5098
5099 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
5100 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
5101 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
5102 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
5103 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
5104 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
5105 will print a message like this:
5106
5107 @smallexample
5108 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
5109 @end smallexample
5110
5111 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
5112 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
5113 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
5114 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
5115 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
5116 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
5117 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
5118 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
5119
5120 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
5121 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
5122 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
5123 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
5124 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
5125 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
5126
5127 @smallexample
5128 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
5129 @end smallexample
5130
5131 @noindent
5132 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
5133
5134 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
5135 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
5136 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
5137 expression with separately allocated resources.
5138
5139 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
5140 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
5141 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
5142
5143 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
5144 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
5145 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
5146 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
5147 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
5148 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
5149 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
5150 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
5151 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
5152
5153 @cindex watchpoints and threads
5154 @cindex threads and watchpoints
5155 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
5156 watched expression from every thread.
5157
5158 @quotation
5159 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
5160 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
5161 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
5162 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
5163 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
5164 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
5165 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
5166 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
5167 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
5168 @end quotation
5169
5170 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
5171
5172 @node Set Catchpoints
5173 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
5174 @cindex catchpoints, setting
5175 @cindex exception handlers
5176 @cindex event handling
5177
5178 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
5179 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
5180 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
5181
5182 @table @code
5183 @kindex catch
5184 @item catch @var{event}
5185 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
5186
5187 @table @code
5188 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
5189 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
5190 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
5191 @kindex catch throw
5192 @kindex catch rethrow
5193 @kindex catch catch
5194 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
5195 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
5196
5197 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
5198 regular expression will be caught.
5199
5200 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
5201 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
5202 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
5203 exception being thrown.
5204
5205 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
5206 @value{GDBN}:
5207
5208 @itemize @bullet
5209 @item
5210 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
5211 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
5212 supported.
5213
5214 @item
5215 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
5216 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
5217 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
5218 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
5219 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
5220 built.
5221
5222 @item
5223 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
5224 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
5225
5226 @item
5227 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
5228 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
5229 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
5230 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
5231
5232 @item
5233 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
5234 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
5235 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
5236 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
5237 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
5238 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
5239 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
5240 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
5241 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
5242
5243 @item
5244 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
5245
5246 @item
5247 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
5248 @end itemize
5249
5250 @item exception @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
5251 @kindex catch exception
5252 @cindex Ada exception catching
5253 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
5254 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
5255 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
5256 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
5257 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
5258
5259 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
5260 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
5261 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
5262 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
5263 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
5264 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
5265 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
5266 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
5267
5268 @vindex $_ada_exception@r{, convenience variable}
5269 The convenience variable @code{$_ada_exception} holds the address of
5270 the exception being thrown. This can be useful when setting a
5271 condition for such a catchpoint.
5272
5273 @item exception unhandled
5274 @kindex catch exception unhandled
5275 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program. The
5276 convenience variable @code{$_ada_exception} is set as for @code{catch
5277 exception}.
5278
5279 @item handlers @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
5280 @kindex catch handlers
5281 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
5282 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
5283 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
5284 specified at the end of the command
5285 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
5286 only when this specific exception is handled.
5287 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
5288
5289 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
5290 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
5291 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
5292 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
5293 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
5294 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
5295 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
5296 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
5297 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
5298
5299 The convenience variable @code{$_ada_exception} is set as for
5300 @code{catch exception}.
5301
5302 @item assert
5303 @kindex catch assert
5304 A failed Ada assertion. Note that the convenience variable
5305 @code{$_ada_exception} is @emph{not} set by this catchpoint.
5306
5307 @item exec
5308 @kindex catch exec
5309 @cindex break on fork/exec
5310 A call to @code{exec}.
5311
5312 @anchor{catch syscall}
5313 @item syscall
5314 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
5315 @kindex catch syscall
5316 @cindex break on a system call.
5317 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
5318 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
5319 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
5320 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
5321 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
5322 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
5323 will be caught.
5324
5325 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
5326 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
5327 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
5328 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
5329
5330 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
5331 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
5332 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
5333 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
5334
5335 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
5336 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
5337 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
5338 available choices.
5339
5340 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
5341 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
5342 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
5343 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
5344 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
5345 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
5346 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
5347 behind the OS upgrades).
5348
5349 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
5350 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
5351 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
5352 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
5353 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
5354 available in every system. You can use the command completion
5355 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
5356 syscall groups available on your environment.
5357
5358 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
5359 arguments to it:
5360
5361 @smallexample
5362 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
5363 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
5364 (@value{GDBP}) r
5365 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
5366
5367 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
5368 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
5369 (@value{GDBP}) c
5370 Continuing.
5371
5372 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
5373 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
5374 (@value{GDBP})
5375 @end smallexample
5376
5377 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
5378
5379 @smallexample
5380 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
5381 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
5382 (@value{GDBP}) r
5383 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
5384
5385 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
5386 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
5387 (@value{GDBP}) c
5388 Continuing.
5389
5390 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
5391 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
5392 (@value{GDBP})
5393 @end smallexample
5394
5395 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
5396 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
5397 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
5398
5399 @smallexample
5400 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
5401 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
5402 (@value{GDBP}) r
5403 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
5404
5405 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
5406 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
5407 (@value{GDBP}) c
5408 Continuing.
5409
5410 Program exited normally.
5411 (@value{GDBP})
5412 @end smallexample
5413
5414 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
5415
5416 @smallexample
5417 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
5418 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
5419 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
5420 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
5421 (@value{GDBP}) r
5422 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
5423
5424 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
5425 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
5426
5427 (@value{GDBP}) c
5428 Continuing.
5429 @end smallexample
5430
5431 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
5432 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
5433 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
5434 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
5435
5436 @smallexample
5437 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
5438 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
5439 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
5440 (@value{GDBP})
5441 @end smallexample
5442
5443 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
5444 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
5445 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
5446 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
5447 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
5448 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
5449
5450 @smallexample
5451 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
5452 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
5453 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
5454 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
5455 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
5456 (@value{GDBP})
5457 @end smallexample
5458
5459 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
5460
5461 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
5462 number. In this case, you would see something like:
5463
5464 @smallexample
5465 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
5466 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
5467 @end smallexample
5468
5469 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
5470
5471 @item fork
5472 @kindex catch fork
5473 A call to @code{fork}.
5474
5475 @item vfork
5476 @kindex catch vfork
5477 A call to @code{vfork}.
5478
5479 @item load @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
5480 @itemx unload @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
5481 @kindex catch load
5482 @kindex catch unload
5483 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
5484 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
5485 matches one of the affected libraries.
5486
5487 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5488 @kindex catch signal
5489 The delivery of a signal.
5490
5491 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
5492 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
5493 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
5494
5495 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
5496 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
5497 signal names.
5498
5499 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
5500 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
5501 will be caught.
5502
5503 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
5504 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
5505 catchpoint.
5506
5507 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
5508 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
5509 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
5510 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
5511 commands.
5512
5513 @end table
5514
5515 @item tcatch @var{event}
5516 @kindex tcatch
5517 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
5518 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
5519
5520 @end table
5521
5522 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
5523
5524
5525 @node Delete Breaks
5526 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
5527
5528 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
5529 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
5530 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
5531 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
5532 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
5533 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
5534
5535 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
5536 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
5537 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
5538 their breakpoint numbers.
5539
5540 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
5541 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
5542 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
5543
5544 @table @code
5545 @kindex clear
5546 @item clear
5547 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
5548 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
5549 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
5550 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
5551
5552 @item clear @var{locspec}
5553 Delete any breakpoint with a code location that corresponds to
5554 @var{locspec}. @xref{Location Specifications}, for the various forms
5555 of @var{locspec}. Which code locations correspond to @var{locspec}
5556 depends on the form used in the location specification @var{locspec}:
5557
5558 @table @code
5559 @item @var{linenum}
5560 @itemx @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5561 @itemx -line @var{linenum}
5562 @itemx -source @var{filename} -line @var{linenum}
5563 If @var{locspec} specifies a line number, with or without a file name,
5564 the command deletes any breakpoint with a code location that is at or
5565 within the specified line @var{linenum} in files that match the
5566 specified @var{filename}. If @var{filename} is omitted, it defaults
5567 to the current source file.
5568
5569 @item *@var{address}
5570 If @var{locspec} specifies an address, the command deletes any
5571 breakpoint with a code location that is at the given @var{address}.
5572
5573 @item @var{function}
5574 @itemx -function @var{function}
5575 If @var{locspec} specifies a function, the command deletes any
5576 breakpoint with a code location that is at the entry to any function
5577 whose name matches @var{function}.
5578 @end table
5579
5580 Ambiguity in names of files and functions can be resolved as described
5581 in @ref{Location Specifications}.
5582
5583 @cindex delete breakpoints
5584 @kindex delete
5585 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
5586 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5587 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
5588 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
5589 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
5590 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
5591 @end table
5592
5593 @node Disabling
5594 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
5595
5596 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
5597 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
5598 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
5599 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
5600 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
5601
5602 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
5603 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
5604 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
5605 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
5606 do not know which numbers to use.
5607
5608 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
5609 affects all of its locations.
5610
5611 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
5612 different states of enablement:
5613
5614 @itemize @bullet
5615 @item
5616 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
5617 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
5618 @item
5619 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
5620 @item
5621 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
5622 disabled.
5623 @item
5624 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
5625 N times, then becomes disabled.
5626 @item
5627 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
5628 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
5629 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
5630 @end itemize
5631
5632 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
5633 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
5634
5635 @table @code
5636 @kindex disable
5637 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
5638 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5639 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
5640 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
5641 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
5642 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
5643 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
5644
5645 @kindex enable
5646 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5647 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
5648 become effective once again in stopping your program.
5649
5650 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
5651 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
5652 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
5653
5654 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
5655 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
5656 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
5657 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
5658 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
5659 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
5660 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
5661
5662 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
5663 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
5664 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
5665 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
5666 @end table
5667
5668 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
5669 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
5670 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
5671 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
5672 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
5673 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
5674 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
5675 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
5676 Stepping}.)
5677
5678 @node Conditions
5679 @subsection Break Conditions
5680 @cindex conditional breakpoints
5681 @cindex breakpoint conditions
5682
5683 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5684 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
5685 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
5686 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
5687 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
5688 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
5689 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
5690 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
5691
5692 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
5693 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
5694 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
5695 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
5696 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
5697
5698 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
5699 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
5700 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
5701 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
5702 one.
5703
5704 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
5705 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
5706 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
5707 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
5708 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
5709 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
5710 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
5711 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
5712 conditions for the
5713 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
5714 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
5715
5716 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
5717 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
5718 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
5719 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
5720 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
5721 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
5722
5723 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
5724 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
5725 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
5726 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
5727 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
5728
5729 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
5730 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
5731 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
5732 with the @code{condition} command.
5733
5734 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
5735 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
5736 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
5737 catchpoint.
5738
5739 @table @code
5740 @kindex condition
5741 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
5742 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
5743 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
5744 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
5745 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
5746 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
5747 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
5748 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
5749 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
5750 prints an error message:
5751
5752 @smallexample
5753 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5754 @end smallexample
5755
5756 @noindent
5757 @value{GDBN} does
5758 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
5759 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
5760 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5761
5762 @item condition -force @var{bnum} @var{expression}
5763 When the @code{-force} flag is used, define the condition even if
5764 @var{expression} is invalid at all the current locations of breakpoint
5765 @var{bnum}. This is similar to the @code{-force-condition} option
5766 of the @code{break} command.
5767
5768 @item condition @var{bnum}
5769 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
5770 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
5771 @end table
5772
5773 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
5774 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
5775 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
5776 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
5777 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5778 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5779 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5780 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5781 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5782 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5783 your program reaches it.
5784
5785 @table @code
5786 @kindex ignore
5787 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5788 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5789 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5790 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5791 takes no action.
5792
5793 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5794 a count of zero.
5795
5796 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5797 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5798 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5799 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5800
5801 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5802 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5803 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5804
5805 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5806 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5807 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5808 Variables}.
5809 @end table
5810
5811 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5812
5813
5814 @node Break Commands
5815 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5816
5817 @cindex breakpoint commands
5818 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5819 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5820 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5821 enable other breakpoints.
5822
5823 @table @code
5824 @kindex commands
5825 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5826 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5827 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5828 @itemx end
5829 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5830 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5831 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5832
5833 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5834 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5835
5836 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5837 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5838 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5839 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5840 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5841 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5842 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5843 Expressions}).
5844 @end table
5845
5846 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5847 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5848
5849 Inside a command list, you can use the command
5850 @kbd{disable $_hit_bpnum} to disable the encountered breakpoint.
5851
5852 If your breakpoint has several code locations, the command
5853 @kbd{disable $_hit_bpnum.$_hit_locno} will disable the specific breakpoint
5854 code location encountered. If the breakpoint has only one location,
5855 this command will disable the encountered breakpoint.
5856
5857 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5858 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5859 that resumes execution.
5860
5861 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5862 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5863 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5864 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5865 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5866
5867 @kindex silent
5868 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5869 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5870 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5871 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5872 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5873 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5874
5875 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5876 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5877 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5878
5879 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5880 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5881
5882 @smallexample
5883 break foo if x>0
5884 commands
5885 silent
5886 printf "x is %d\n",x
5887 cont
5888 end
5889 @end smallexample
5890
5891 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5892 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5893 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5894 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5895 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5896 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5897 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5898
5899 @smallexample
5900 break 403
5901 commands
5902 silent
5903 set x = y + 4
5904 cont
5905 end
5906 @end smallexample
5907
5908 @node Dynamic Printf
5909 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5910
5911 @cindex dynamic printf
5912 @cindex dprintf
5913 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5914 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5915 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5916 having to recompile it.
5917
5918 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5919 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5920 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5921 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5922 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5923 redirects to files and so forth.
5924
5925 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5926 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5927 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5928 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5929 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5930 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5931 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5932
5933 @table @code
5934 @kindex dprintf
5935 @item dprintf @var{locspec},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5936 Whenever execution reaches a code location that results from resolving
5937 @var{locspec}, print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under
5938 the control of the string @var{template}. To print several values,
5939 separate them with commas.
5940
5941 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5942 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5943 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5944 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5945 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5946 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5947
5948 @table @code
5949 @item gdb
5950 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5951 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5952
5953 @item call
5954 @kindex dprintf-style call
5955 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5956 @code{printf}).
5957
5958 @item agent
5959 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5960 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5961 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5962 support running commands on the target.
5963 @end table
5964
5965 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5966 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5967 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5968 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5969 command.
5970
5971 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5972 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5973 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5974 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5975 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5976 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5977
5978 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5979 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5980 you could do the following:
5981
5982 @example
5983 (@value{GDBP}) set dprintf-style call
5984 (@value{GDBP}) set dprintf-function fprintf
5985 (@value{GDBP}) set dprintf-channel mylog
5986 (@value{GDBP}) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5987 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5988 (@value{GDBP}) info break
5989 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5990 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5991 continue
5992 (@value{GDBP})
5993 @end example
5994
5995 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5996 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5997 the variable settings.
5998
5999 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
6000 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
6001 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
6002 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
6003 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
6004 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
6005
6006 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
6007 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
6008 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
6009
6010 @end table
6011
6012 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
6013 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
6014 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
6015 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
6016 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
6017 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
6018
6019 @node Save Breakpoints
6020 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
6021
6022 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
6023 breakpoints}} command.
6024
6025 @table @code
6026 @kindex save breakpoints
6027 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
6028 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
6029 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
6030 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6031 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
6032 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
6033 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
6034 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
6035 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
6036 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
6037 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
6038 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
6039 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
6040 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
6041 that can no longer be recreated.
6042 @end table
6043
6044 @node Static Probe Points
6045 @subsection Static Probe Points
6046
6047 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
6048 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
6049 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
6050 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
6051 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
6052
6053 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
6054 ELF-compatible systems:
6055
6056 @itemize @bullet
6057
6058 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
6059 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
6060 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
6061 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
6062 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
6063 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
6064 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
6065 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
6066
6067 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
6068 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
6069 C@t{++} languages.
6070 @end itemize
6071
6072 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
6073 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
6074 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
6075 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
6076 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
6077 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
6078 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
6079 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
6080 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
6081
6082 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
6083 probes}, with optional arguments:
6084
6085 @table @code
6086 @kindex info probes
6087 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
6088 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
6089 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
6090 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
6091
6092 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
6093 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
6094 probes from all providers are listed.
6095
6096 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
6097 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
6098 considered when deciding whether to display them.
6099
6100 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
6101 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
6102 given, all object files are considered.
6103
6104 @item info probes all
6105 List the available static probes, from all types.
6106 @end table
6107
6108 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
6109 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
6110 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
6111 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
6112 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
6113
6114 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
6115 commands, with optional arguments:
6116
6117 @anchor{enable probes}
6118 @table @code
6119 @kindex enable probes
6120 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
6121 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
6122 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
6123 all probes from all providers are enabled.
6124
6125 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
6126 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
6127 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
6128
6129 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
6130 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
6131 given, all object files are considered.
6132
6133 @kindex disable probes
6134 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
6135 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
6136 optional arguments accepted by this command.
6137 @end table
6138
6139 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
6140 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
6141 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
6142 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
6143 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
6144 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
6145 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
6146 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
6147 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
6148 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
6149 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
6150 at the current probe point.
6151
6152 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
6153 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
6154 an error message.
6155
6156
6157 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
6158 @node Error in Breakpoints
6159 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
6160
6161 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
6162 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
6163
6164 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
6165 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
6166 @smallexample
6167 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
6168 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
6169 @end smallexample
6170
6171 @noindent
6172 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
6173 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
6174 watchpoints it needs to insert.
6175
6176 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
6177 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
6178
6179 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
6180 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
6181 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
6182
6183 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
6184 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
6185 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
6186 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
6187
6188 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
6189 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
6190 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
6191 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
6192 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
6193 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
6194 first in the bundle.
6195
6196 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
6197 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
6198 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
6199 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
6200 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
6201 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
6202 is hit.
6203
6204 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
6205 that's been subject to address adjustment:
6206
6207 @smallexample
6208 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
6209 @end smallexample
6210
6211 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
6212 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
6213 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
6214 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
6215 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
6216 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
6217 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
6218 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
6219
6220 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
6221 adjusted breakpoints:
6222
6223 @smallexample
6224 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
6225 to 0x00010410.
6226 @end smallexample
6227
6228 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
6229 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
6230 frequently than expected.
6231
6232 @node Continuing and Stepping
6233 @section Continuing and Stepping
6234
6235 @cindex stepping
6236 @cindex continuing
6237 @cindex resuming execution
6238 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
6239 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
6240 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
6241 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
6242 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
6243 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
6244 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
6245 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
6246 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
6247 handlers}).)
6248
6249 @table @code
6250 @kindex continue
6251 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
6252 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
6253 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6254 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6255 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6256 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
6257 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
6258 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
6259 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
6260 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
6261
6262 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
6263 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
6264 @code{continue} is ignored.
6265
6266 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
6267 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
6268 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
6269 @code{continue}.
6270 @end table
6271
6272 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
6273 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
6274 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
6275 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
6276
6277 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
6278 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
6279 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
6280 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
6281 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
6282 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
6283
6284 @table @code
6285 @kindex step
6286 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
6287 @item step
6288 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
6289 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
6290 abbreviated @code{s}.
6291
6292 @quotation
6293 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
6294 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
6295 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
6296 @c distinction here.
6297 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
6298 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
6299 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
6300 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
6301 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
6302 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
6303 below.
6304 @end quotation
6305
6306 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
6307 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
6308 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
6309 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
6310 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
6311 called within the line.
6312
6313 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
6314 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
6315 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
6316 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
6317 was any debugging information about the routine.
6318
6319 @item step @var{count}
6320 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
6321 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
6322 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
6323
6324 @kindex next
6325 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
6326 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6327 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
6328 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
6329 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
6330 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
6331 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
6332 is abbreviated @code{n}.
6333
6334 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
6335
6336
6337 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
6338 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
6339 @c
6340 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
6341 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
6342 @c function are executed without stopping.
6343
6344 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
6345 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
6346 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
6347
6348 @kindex set step-mode
6349 @item set step-mode
6350 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
6351 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
6352 @itemx set step-mode on
6353 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
6354 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
6355 information rather than stepping over it.
6356
6357 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
6358 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
6359 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
6360
6361 @item set step-mode off
6362 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
6363 debug information. This is the default.
6364
6365 @item show step-mode
6366 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
6367 source line debug information.
6368
6369 @kindex finish
6370 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
6371 @item finish
6372 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
6373 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
6374 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
6375
6376 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
6377 ,Returning from a Function}).
6378
6379 @kindex set print finish
6380 @kindex show print finish
6381 @item set print finish @r{[}on|off@r{]}
6382 @itemx show print finish
6383 By default the @code{finish} command will show the value that is
6384 returned by the function. This can be disabled using @code{set print
6385 finish off}. When disabled, the value is still entered into the value
6386 history (@pxref{Value History}), but not displayed.
6387
6388 @kindex until
6389 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
6390 @cindex run until specified location
6391 @item until
6392 @itemx u
6393 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
6394 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
6395 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
6396 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
6397 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
6398 than the address of the jump.
6399
6400 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
6401 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
6402 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
6403 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
6404 through the next iteration.
6405
6406 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
6407 stack frame.
6408
6409 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
6410 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
6411 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
6412 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
6413 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
6414
6415 @smallexample
6416 (@value{GDBP}) f
6417 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
6418 206 expand_input();
6419 (@value{GDBP}) until
6420 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
6421 @end smallexample
6422
6423 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
6424 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
6425 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
6426 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
6427 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
6428 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
6429 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
6430
6431 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
6432 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
6433 argument.
6434
6435 @item until @var{locspec}
6436 @itemx u @var{locspec}
6437 Continue running your program until either it reaches a code location
6438 that results from resolving @var{locspec}, or the current stack frame
6439 returns. @var{locspec} is any of the forms described in @ref{Location
6440 Specifications}.
6441 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
6442 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
6443 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
6444 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
6445 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
6446 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
6447 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
6448 invocations have returned.
6449
6450 @smallexample
6451 94 int factorial (int value)
6452 95 @{
6453 96 if (value > 1) @{
6454 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
6455 98 @}
6456 99 return (value);
6457 100 @}
6458 @end smallexample
6459
6460
6461 @kindex advance @var{locspec}
6462 @item advance @var{locspec}
6463 Continue running your program until either it reaches a code location
6464 that results from resolving @var{locspec}, or the current stack frame
6465 returns. @var{locspec} is any of the forms described in @ref{Location
6466 Specifications}. This command is similar to @code{until}, but
6467 @code{advance} will not skip over recursive function calls, and the
6468 target code location doesn't have to be in the same frame as the
6469 current one.
6470
6471
6472 @kindex stepi
6473 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
6474 @item stepi
6475 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
6476 @itemx si
6477 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
6478
6479 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
6480 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
6481 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
6482 Display,, Automatic Display}.
6483
6484 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
6485
6486 @need 750
6487 @kindex nexti
6488 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
6489 @item nexti
6490 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
6491 @itemx ni
6492 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
6493 proceed until the function returns.
6494
6495 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
6496
6497 @end table
6498
6499 @anchor{range stepping}
6500 @cindex range stepping
6501 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
6502 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
6503 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
6504 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
6505 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
6506 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
6507 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
6508 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
6509 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
6510 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
6511 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
6512 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
6513 if necessary:
6514
6515 @table @code
6516 @kindex set range-stepping
6517 @kindex show range-stepping
6518 @item set range-stepping
6519 @itemx show range-stepping
6520 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
6521
6522 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
6523 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
6524 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
6525 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
6526 default is @code{on}.
6527
6528 @end table
6529
6530 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
6531 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
6532 @cindex skipping over functions and files
6533
6534 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
6535 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
6536 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
6537 a particular file when stepping.
6538
6539 For example, consider the following C function:
6540
6541 @smallexample
6542 101 int func()
6543 102 @{
6544 103 foo(boring());
6545 104 bar(boring());
6546 105 @}
6547 @end smallexample
6548
6549 @noindent
6550 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
6551 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
6552 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
6553 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
6554
6555 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
6556 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
6557 is called from many places.
6558
6559 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
6560 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
6561 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
6562 @code{foo}.
6563
6564 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
6565 (@pxref{Location Specifications}), regular expression that matches the function's
6566 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
6567
6568 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
6569 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
6570 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
6571 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
6572 the underlying system.
6573 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
6574 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
6575
6576 @table @code
6577 @kindex skip
6578 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
6579 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
6580 that specify what to skip.
6581 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
6582
6583 @table @code
6584 @item -file @var{file}
6585 @itemx -fi @var{file}
6586 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
6587
6588 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
6589 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
6590 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
6591 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
6592 over when stepping.
6593
6594 @smallexample
6595 (@value{GDBP}) skip -gfi utils/*.c
6596 @end smallexample
6597
6598 @item -function @var{linespec}
6599 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
6600 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
6601 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
6602 @xref{Location Specifications}.
6603
6604 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
6605 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
6606 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
6607 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
6608
6609 This form is useful for complex function names.
6610 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
6611 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
6612 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
6613 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
6614 regular expression makes this easier.
6615
6616 @smallexample
6617 (@value{GDBP}) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
6618 @end smallexample
6619
6620 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
6621 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
6622
6623 @smallexample
6624 (@value{GDBP}) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
6625 @end smallexample
6626 @end table
6627
6628 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
6629 will be skipped.
6630
6631 @kindex skip function
6632 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
6633 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
6634 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
6635 stepping. @xref{Location Specifications}.
6636
6637 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
6638 will be skipped.
6639
6640 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
6641 @kbd{skip function file}.)
6642
6643 @kindex skip file
6644 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
6645 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
6646 will be skipped over when stepping.
6647
6648 @smallexample
6649 (@value{GDBP}) skip file boring.c
6650 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
6651 @end smallexample
6652
6653 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
6654 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
6655 @end table
6656
6657 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
6658 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
6659
6660 @table @code
6661 @kindex info skip
6662 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6663 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
6664 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
6665 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
6666
6667 @table @emph
6668 @item Identifier
6669 A number identifying this skip.
6670 @item Enabled or Disabled
6671 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
6672 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
6673 @item Glob
6674 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
6675 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
6676 @item File
6677 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
6678 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
6679 @item RE
6680 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
6681 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
6682 @item Function
6683 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
6684 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
6685 @end table
6686
6687 @kindex skip delete
6688 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6689 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
6690 skips.
6691
6692 @kindex skip enable
6693 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6694 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
6695 skips.
6696
6697 @kindex skip disable
6698 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6699 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
6700 skips.
6701
6702 @kindex set debug skip
6703 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
6704 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
6705
6706 @kindex show debug skip
6707 @item show debug skip
6708 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
6709
6710 @end table
6711
6712 @node Signals
6713 @section Signals
6714 @cindex signals
6715
6716 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
6717 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
6718 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
6719 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
6720 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
6721 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
6722 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
6723 requested an alarm).
6724
6725 @cindex fatal signals
6726 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
6727 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
6728 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
6729 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
6730 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
6731 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
6732
6733 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
6734 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
6735 signal.
6736
6737 @cindex handling signals
6738 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
6739 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
6740 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
6741 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
6742 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
6743
6744 @table @code
6745 @kindex info signals
6746 @kindex info handle
6747 @item info signals
6748 @itemx info handle
6749 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
6750 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
6751 the defined types of signals.
6752
6753 @item info signals @var{sig}
6754 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
6755
6756 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
6757
6758 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
6759 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
6760 for details about this command.
6761
6762 @kindex handle
6763 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[} @var{signal} @dots{} @r{]} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
6764 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles each @var{signal}. Each
6765 @var{signal} can be the number of a signal or its name (with or
6766 without the @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of
6767 the form @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning
6768 all the known signals, except @code{SIGINT} and @code{SIGTRAP}, which
6769 are used by @value{GDBN}. Optional argument @var{keywords}, described
6770 below, say what changes to make to all of the specified signals.
6771 @end table
6772
6773 @c @group
6774 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
6775 Their full names are:
6776
6777 @table @code
6778 @item nostop
6779 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
6780 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
6781
6782 @item stop
6783 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
6784 the @code{print} keyword as well.
6785
6786 @item print
6787 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
6788
6789 @item noprint
6790 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
6791 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
6792
6793 @item pass
6794 @itemx noignore
6795 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
6796 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
6797 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
6798
6799 @item nopass
6800 @itemx ignore
6801 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6802 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6803 @end table
6804 @c @end group
6805
6806 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6807 program until you
6808 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6809 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6810 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6811 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6812 program sees that signal when you continue.
6813
6814 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6815 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6816 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6817 erroneous signals.
6818
6819 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6820 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6821 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6822 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6823 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6824 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6825 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6826 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6827 Program a Signal}.
6828
6829 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6830 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6831
6832 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6833 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6834 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6835 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6836 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6837 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6838 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6839 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6840 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6841 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6842 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6843 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6844 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6845
6846 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6847
6848 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6849 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6850 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6851 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6852
6853 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6854 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6855 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6856 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6857
6858 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6859 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6860
6861 @smallexample
6862 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6863 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6864 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6865 (@value{GDBP}) c
6866 Continuing.
6867
6868 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6869 main () sigusr1.c:28
6870 28 p = 0;
6871 (@value{GDBP}) si
6872 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6873 9 @{
6874 @end smallexample
6875
6876 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6877 program to receive the signal first:
6878
6879 @smallexample
6880 (@value{GDBP}) n
6881 28 p = 0;
6882 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6883 (@value{GDBP}) si
6884 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6885 9 @{
6886 (@value{GDBP})
6887 @end smallexample
6888
6889 @cindex extra signal information
6890 @anchor{extra signal information}
6891
6892 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6893 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6894 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6895 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6896 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6897 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6898 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6899 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6900 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6901 system header.
6902
6903 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6904 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6905
6906 @smallexample
6907 @group
6908 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6909 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6910 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6911 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6912 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6913 type = struct @{
6914 int si_signo;
6915 int si_errno;
6916 int si_code;
6917 union @{
6918 int _pad[28];
6919 struct @{...@} _kill;
6920 struct @{...@} _timer;
6921 struct @{...@} _rt;
6922 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6923 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6924 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6925 @} _sifields;
6926 @}
6927 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6928 type = struct @{
6929 void *si_addr;
6930 @}
6931 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6932 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6933 @end group
6934 @end smallexample
6935
6936 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6937
6938 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6939 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6940 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6941 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6942 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6943 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6944 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6945 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6946 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6947 information is displayed.
6948
6949 The usual output of a segfault is:
6950 @smallexample
6951 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6952 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6953 68 value = *(p + len);
6954 @end smallexample
6955
6956 While a bound violation is presented as:
6957 @smallexample
6958 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6959 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6960 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6961 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6962 68 value = *(p + len);
6963 @end smallexample
6964
6965 @node Thread Stops
6966 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6967
6968 @cindex stopped threads
6969 @cindex threads, stopped
6970
6971 @cindex continuing threads
6972 @cindex threads, continuing
6973
6974 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6975 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6976 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6977 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6978 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6979 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6980 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6981 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6982 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6983
6984 @menu
6985 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6986 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6987 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6988 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6989 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6990 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6991 @end menu
6992
6993 @node All-Stop Mode
6994 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6995
6996 @cindex all-stop mode
6997
6998 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6999 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
7000 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
7001 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
7002 underfoot.
7003
7004 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
7005 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
7006 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
7007
7008 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
7009 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
7010 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
7011 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
7012 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
7013 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
7014 stops.
7015
7016 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
7017 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
7018 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
7019 first thread completes whatever you requested.
7020
7021 @cindex automatic thread selection
7022 @cindex switching threads automatically
7023 @cindex threads, automatic switching
7024 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
7025 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
7026 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
7027 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
7028 thread.
7029
7030 @anchor{set scheduler-locking}
7031
7032 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
7033 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
7034
7035 @table @code
7036 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
7037 @cindex scheduler locking mode
7038 @cindex lock scheduler
7039 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
7040 record mode, and replay mode. @var{mode} can be one of
7041 the following:
7042
7043 @table @code
7044 @item off
7045 There is no locking and any thread may run at any time.
7046
7047 @item on
7048 Only the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed.
7049
7050 @item step
7051 Behaves like @code{on} when stepping, and @code{off} otherwise.
7052 Threads other than the current never get a chance to run when you
7053 step, and they are completely free to run when you use commands like
7054 @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}.
7055
7056 This mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
7057 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that the
7058 focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. However, unless
7059 another thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN}
7060 does not change the current thread away from the thread that you are
7061 debugging.
7062
7063 @item replay
7064 Behaves like @code{on} in replay mode, and @code{off} in either record
7065 mode or during normal execution. This is the default mode.
7066 @end table
7067
7068 @item show scheduler-locking
7069 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
7070 @end table
7071
7072 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
7073 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
7074 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
7075 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
7076 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
7077 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
7078 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
7079 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
7080 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
7081 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
7082 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
7083 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
7084 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
7085 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
7086
7087 @table @code
7088 @kindex set schedule-multiple
7089 @item set schedule-multiple
7090 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
7091 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
7092 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
7093 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
7094 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
7095 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
7096
7097 @item show schedule-multiple
7098 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
7099 multiple processes.
7100 @end table
7101
7102 @node Non-Stop Mode
7103 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
7104
7105 @cindex non-stop mode
7106
7107 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
7108 @c with more details.
7109
7110 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
7111 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
7112 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
7113 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
7114 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
7115 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
7116
7117 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
7118 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
7119 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
7120 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
7121 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
7122 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
7123 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
7124 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
7125 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
7126 independently and simultaneously.
7127
7128 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
7129 or attach to your program:
7130
7131 @smallexample
7132 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
7133 set pagination off
7134
7135 # Finally, turn it on!
7136 set non-stop on
7137 @end smallexample
7138
7139 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
7140
7141 @table @code
7142 @kindex set non-stop
7143 @item set non-stop on
7144 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
7145 @item set non-stop off
7146 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
7147 @kindex show non-stop
7148 @item show non-stop
7149 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
7150 @end table
7151
7152 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
7153 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
7154 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
7155 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
7156 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
7157 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
7158 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
7159 default.
7160
7161 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
7162 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
7163 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
7164
7165 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
7166 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
7167 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
7168 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
7169 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
7170
7171 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
7172 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
7173 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
7174 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
7175 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
7176
7177 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
7178
7179 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
7180 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
7181 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
7182 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
7183 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
7184 previously current thread.
7185
7186 @node Background Execution
7187 @subsection Background Execution
7188
7189 @cindex foreground execution
7190 @cindex background execution
7191 @cindex asynchronous execution
7192 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
7193
7194 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
7195 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
7196 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
7197 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
7198 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
7199 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
7200
7201 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
7202 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
7203
7204 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
7205 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
7206 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
7207 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
7208 are:
7209
7210 @table @code
7211 @kindex run&
7212 @item run
7213 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
7214
7215 @item attach
7216 @kindex attach&
7217 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
7218
7219 @item step
7220 @kindex step&
7221 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
7222
7223 @item stepi
7224 @kindex stepi&
7225 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
7226
7227 @item next
7228 @kindex next&
7229 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
7230
7231 @item nexti
7232 @kindex nexti&
7233 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
7234
7235 @item continue
7236 @kindex continue&
7237 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
7238
7239 @item finish
7240 @kindex finish&
7241 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
7242
7243 @item until
7244 @kindex until&
7245 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
7246
7247 @end table
7248
7249 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
7250 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
7251 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
7252 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
7253 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
7254 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
7255
7256 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
7257 using the @code{interrupt} command.
7258
7259 @table @code
7260 @kindex interrupt
7261 @item interrupt
7262 @itemx interrupt -a
7263
7264 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
7265 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
7266 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
7267 use @code{interrupt -a}.
7268 @end table
7269
7270 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
7271 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
7272
7273 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
7274 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
7275 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
7276
7277 @table @code
7278 @cindex breakpoints and threads
7279 @cindex thread breakpoints
7280 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
7281 @item break @var{locspec} thread @var{thread-id}
7282 @itemx break @var{locspec} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
7283 @var{locspec} specifies a code location or locations in your program.
7284 @xref{Location Specifications}, for details.
7285
7286 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
7287 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
7288 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
7289 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
7290 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
7291
7292 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
7293 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
7294 program.
7295
7296 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
7297 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
7298 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
7299
7300 @smallexample
7301 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
7302 @end smallexample
7303
7304 @end table
7305
7306 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
7307 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
7308 thread list. For example:
7309
7310 @smallexample
7311 (@value{GDBP}) c
7312 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
7313 @end smallexample
7314
7315 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
7316 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
7317 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
7318 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
7319 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
7320 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
7321 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
7322 command.
7323
7324 @node Interrupted System Calls
7325 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
7326
7327 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
7328 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
7329 @cindex premature return from system calls
7330 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
7331 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
7332 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
7333 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
7334 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
7335 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
7336 stop execution.
7337
7338 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
7339 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
7340 style anyways.
7341
7342 For example, do not write code like this:
7343
7344 @smallexample
7345 sleep (10);
7346 @end smallexample
7347
7348 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
7349 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
7350
7351 Instead, write this:
7352
7353 @smallexample
7354 int unslept = 10;
7355 while (unslept > 0)
7356 unslept = sleep (unslept);
7357 @end smallexample
7358
7359 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
7360 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
7361 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
7362 @value{GDBN}.
7363
7364 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
7365 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
7366 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
7367 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
7368
7369 @node Observer Mode
7370 @subsection Observer Mode
7371
7372 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
7373 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
7374 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
7375 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
7376 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
7377
7378 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
7379 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
7380 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
7381 mode.
7382
7383 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
7384 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
7385 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
7386 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
7387 stream will still not be able to be placed.
7388
7389 @table @code
7390
7391 @kindex observer
7392 @item set observer on
7393 @itemx set observer off
7394 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
7395 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
7396 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
7397 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
7398
7399 @item show observer
7400 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
7401
7402 @kindex may-write-registers
7403 @item set may-write-registers on
7404 @itemx set may-write-registers off
7405 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
7406 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
7407 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
7408
7409 @item show may-write-registers
7410 Show the current permission to write registers.
7411
7412 @kindex may-write-memory
7413 @item set may-write-memory on
7414 @itemx set may-write-memory off
7415 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
7416 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
7417 defaults to @code{on}.
7418
7419 @item show may-write-memory
7420 Show the current permission to write memory.
7421
7422 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
7423 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
7424 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
7425 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
7426 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
7427 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
7428
7429 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
7430 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
7431
7432 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
7433 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
7434 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
7435 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
7436 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
7437 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
7438 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
7439
7440 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
7441 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
7442
7443 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
7444 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
7445 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
7446 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
7447 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
7448 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
7449 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
7450
7451 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
7452 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
7453
7454 @kindex may-interrupt
7455 @item set may-interrupt on
7456 @itemx set may-interrupt off
7457 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
7458 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
7459 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
7460 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
7461
7462 @item show may-interrupt
7463 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
7464
7465 @end table
7466
7467 @node Reverse Execution
7468 @chapter Running programs backward
7469 @cindex reverse execution
7470 @cindex running programs backward
7471
7472 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
7473 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
7474 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
7475 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
7476
7477 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
7478 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
7479 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
7480 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
7481 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
7482 all target environments can support reverse execution.
7483
7484 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
7485 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
7486 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
7487 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
7488 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
7489 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
7490 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
7491 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
7492 prior values@footnote{
7493 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
7494 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
7495 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
7496
7497 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
7498 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
7499 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
7500 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
7501 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
7502 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
7503 consistent state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
7504 }.
7505
7506 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} has built-in support for reverse
7507 execution, activated with the @code{record} or @code{record btrace}
7508 commands. @xref{Process Record and Replay}. Some remote targets,
7509 typically full system emulators, support reverse execution directly
7510 without requiring any special command.
7511
7512 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
7513 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
7514
7515 @table @code
7516 @kindex reverse-continue
7517 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
7518 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
7519 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
7520 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
7521 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
7522 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
7523 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
7524
7525 @kindex reverse-step
7526 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
7527 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7528 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
7529 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
7530
7531 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
7532 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
7533 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
7534 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
7535 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
7536 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
7537
7538 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
7539 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
7540
7541 @kindex reverse-stepi
7542 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
7543 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7544 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
7545 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
7546 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
7547 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
7548 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
7549
7550 @kindex reverse-next
7551 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
7552 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7553 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
7554 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
7555 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
7556 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
7557 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
7558 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
7559 line of a function back to its return to its caller
7560 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
7561
7562 @kindex reverse-nexti
7563 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
7564 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7565 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
7566 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
7567 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
7568 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
7569 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
7570 frame) is reached.
7571
7572 @kindex reverse-finish
7573 @item reverse-finish
7574 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
7575 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
7576 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
7577 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
7578
7579 @kindex set exec-direction
7580 @item set exec-direction
7581 Set the direction of target execution.
7582 @item set exec-direction reverse
7583 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
7584 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
7585 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
7586 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
7587 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
7588 @item set exec-direction forward
7589 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
7590 This is the default.
7591 @end table
7592
7593
7594 @node Process Record and Replay
7595 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
7596 @cindex process record and replay
7597 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
7598
7599 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
7600 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
7601 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
7602
7603 @cindex replay mode
7604 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
7605 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
7606 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
7607 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
7608 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
7609 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
7610 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
7611 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
7612 execution log.
7613
7614 @cindex record mode
7615 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
7616 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
7617 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
7618 for future replay.
7619
7620 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
7621 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
7622 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
7623 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
7624 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
7625 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
7626
7627 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
7628 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
7629 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
7630 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
7631
7632 Currently, process record and replay is supported on ARM, Aarch64,
7633 Moxie, PowerPC, PowerPC64, S/390, and x86 (i386/amd64) running
7634 GNU/Linux. Process record and replay can be used both when native
7635 debugging, and when remote debugging via @code{gdbserver}.
7636
7637 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
7638 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
7639
7640 @table @code
7641 @kindex target record
7642 @kindex target record-full
7643 @kindex target record-btrace
7644 @kindex record
7645 @kindex record full
7646 @kindex record btrace
7647 @kindex record btrace bts
7648 @kindex record btrace pt
7649 @kindex record bts
7650 @kindex record pt
7651 @kindex rec
7652 @kindex rec full
7653 @kindex rec btrace
7654 @kindex rec btrace bts
7655 @kindex rec btrace pt
7656 @kindex rec bts
7657 @kindex rec pt
7658 @item record @var{method}
7659 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
7660 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
7661 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
7662 recording methods are available:
7663
7664 @table @code
7665 @item full
7666 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
7667 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
7668 execution.
7669
7670 @item btrace @var{format}
7671 Hardware-supported instruction recording, supported on Intel
7672 processors. This method does not record data. Further, the data is
7673 collected in a ring buffer so old data will be overwritten when the
7674 buffer is full. It allows limited reverse execution. Variables and
7675 registers are not available during reverse execution. In remote
7676 debugging, recording continues on disconnect. Recorded data can be
7677 inspected after reconnecting. The recording may be stopped using
7678 @code{record stop}.
7679
7680 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
7681 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
7682 formats are available:
7683
7684 @table @code
7685 @item bts
7686 @cindex branch trace store
7687 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
7688 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
7689 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
7690
7691 @item pt
7692 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
7693 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
7694 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
7695 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
7696
7697 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
7698 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
7699 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
7700
7701 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
7702 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
7703 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
7704 buffer-size with care.
7705 @end table
7706
7707 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
7708 @end table
7709
7710 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
7711 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
7712 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
7713 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
7714
7715 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
7716 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
7717 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
7718 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
7719 doesn't support displaced stepping.
7720
7721 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
7722 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
7723 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
7724 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
7725 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
7726 does not support these two modes.
7727
7728 @kindex record stop
7729 @kindex rec s
7730 @item record stop
7731 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
7732 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
7733 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
7734
7735 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
7736 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
7737 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
7738 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
7739 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
7740
7741 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
7742 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
7743 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
7744 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
7745 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
7746
7747 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
7748 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
7749
7750 @kindex record goto
7751 @item record goto
7752 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
7753 ways to specify the location to go to:
7754
7755 @table @code
7756 @item record goto begin
7757 @itemx record goto start
7758 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
7759
7760 @item record goto end
7761 Go to the end of the execution log.
7762
7763 @item record goto @var{n}
7764 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
7765 @end table
7766
7767 @kindex record save
7768 @item record save @var{filename}
7769 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
7770 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
7771 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
7772
7773 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7774
7775 @kindex record restore
7776 @item record restore @var{filename}
7777 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
7778 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
7779
7780 @kindex set record full
7781 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
7782 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
7783 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
7784 recording method. Default value is 200000.
7785
7786 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
7787 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
7788 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
7789 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
7790 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
7791 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
7792 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
7793 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
7794
7795 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
7796 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
7797 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
7798
7799 @kindex show record full
7800 @item show record full insn-number-max
7801 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
7802 recording method.
7803
7804 @item set record full stop-at-limit
7805 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
7806 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
7807 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
7808 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
7809 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
7810 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
7811 oldest one to be deleted.
7812
7813 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
7814 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
7815
7816 @item show record full stop-at-limit
7817 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
7818
7819 @item set record full memory-query
7820 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
7821 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
7822 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
7823 case.
7824
7825 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7826 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7827 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7828 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7829 results.
7830
7831 @item show record full memory-query
7832 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7833
7834 @kindex set record btrace
7835 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7836 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7837 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7838 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7839 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7840 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7841 You can use the following command for that:
7842
7843 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7844 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7845 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7846 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7847 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7848 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7849 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7850 position.
7851
7852 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7853 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7854 errata when decoding the trace.
7855
7856 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7857 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7858 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7859 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7860 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7861 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7862 which the trace was recorded.
7863
7864 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7865 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7866 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7867 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7868 disable the workarounds.
7869
7870 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7871 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{processor identifier}}. In addition,
7872 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7873 (default).
7874
7875 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7876 identifiers are currently supported:
7877
7878 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7879
7880 @item @code{intel}
7881 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7882
7883 @end multitable
7884
7885 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7886 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7887
7888 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7889 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7890 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7891
7892 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7893 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7894 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7895 supports.
7896
7897 @smallexample
7898 (@value{GDBP}) info record
7899 Active record target: record-btrace
7900 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7901 Buffer size: 16kB.
7902 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7903 (@value{GDBP}) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7904 (@value{GDBP}) info record
7905 Active record target: record-btrace
7906 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7907 Buffer size: 16kB.
7908 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7909 @end smallexample
7910
7911 @kindex show record btrace
7912 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7913 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7914
7915 @item show record btrace cpu
7916 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7917 workarounds.
7918
7919 @kindex set record btrace bts
7920 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7921 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7922 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7923 format. Default is 64KB.
7924
7925 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7926 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7927 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7928 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7929 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7930 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7931 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7932
7933 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7934 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7935
7936 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7937 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7938
7939 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7940 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7941 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7942
7943 @kindex set record btrace pt
7944 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7945 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7946 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7947 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7948
7949 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7950 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7951 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7952 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7953 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7954 actual buffer size for each thread.
7955
7956 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7957 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7958
7959 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7960 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7961
7962 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7963 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7964 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7965
7966 @kindex info record
7967 @item info record
7968 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7969 method:
7970
7971 @table @code
7972 @item full
7973 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7974 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7975
7976 @itemize @bullet
7977 @item
7978 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7979 @item
7980 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7981 @item
7982 Highest recorded instruction number.
7983 @item
7984 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7985 @item
7986 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7987 @item
7988 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7989 @end itemize
7990
7991 @item btrace
7992 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7993
7994 @itemize @bullet
7995 @item
7996 Recording format.
7997 @item
7998 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7999 @item
8000 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
8001 instructions.
8002 @item
8003 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
8004 @end itemize
8005
8006 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
8007 @itemize @bullet
8008 @item
8009 Size of the perf ring buffer.
8010 @end itemize
8011
8012 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
8013 @itemize @bullet
8014 @item
8015 Size of the perf ring buffer.
8016 @end itemize
8017 @end table
8018
8019 @kindex record delete
8020 @kindex rec del
8021 @item record delete
8022 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
8023 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
8024 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
8025 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
8026
8027 @kindex record instruction-history
8028 @kindex rec instruction-history
8029 @item record instruction-history
8030 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
8031 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
8032 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
8033 are printed in execution order.
8034
8035 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
8036 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
8037 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} or @code{/b}
8038 modifier. The behaviour of the @code{/m}, @code{/s}, @code{/r}, and
8039 @code{/b} modifiers are the same as for the @kbd{disassemble} command
8040 (@pxref{disassemble,,@kbd{disassemble}}).
8041
8042 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
8043 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
8044 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
8045 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
8046 @code{/p} modifier.
8047
8048 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
8049 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
8050 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
8051
8052 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
8053 feature is not available for all recording formats.
8054
8055 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
8056 disassemble:
8057
8058 @table @code
8059 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
8060 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
8061 @var{insn}.
8062
8063 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
8064 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
8065 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
8066 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
8067 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
8068 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
8069
8070 @item record instruction-history
8071 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
8072
8073 @item record instruction-history -
8074 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
8075
8076 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
8077 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
8078 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
8079 number @var{end} is included.
8080 @end table
8081
8082 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
8083
8084 @kindex set record
8085 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
8086 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
8087 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
8088 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
8089 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
8090
8091 @kindex show record
8092 @item show record instruction-history-size
8093 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
8094 instruction-history} command.
8095
8096 @kindex record function-call-history
8097 @kindex rec function-call-history
8098 @item record function-call-history
8099 Prints the execution history at function granularity. For each sequence
8100 of instructions that belong to the same function, it prints the name of
8101 that function, the source lines for this instruction sequence (if the
8102 @code{/l} modifier is specified), and the instructions numbers that form
8103 the sequence (if the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names
8104 are indented to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
8105 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be given
8106 together.
8107
8108 @smallexample
8109 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
8110 1 void foo (void)
8111 2 @{
8112 3 @}
8113 4
8114 5 void bar (void)
8115 6 @{
8116 7 ...
8117 8 foo ();
8118 9 ...
8119 10 @}
8120 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
8121 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
8122 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
8123 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
8124 @end smallexample
8125
8126 By default, ten functions are printed. This can be changed using the
8127 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
8128 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
8129 to print:
8130
8131 @table @code
8132 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
8133 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
8134
8135 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
8136 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
8137 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
8138 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
8139 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
8140
8141 @item record function-call-history
8142 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-function print.
8143
8144 @item record function-call-history -
8145 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-function print.
8146
8147 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
8148 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
8149 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
8150 @end table
8151
8152 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
8153
8154 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
8155 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
8156 Define how many functions to print in the
8157 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
8158 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited functions.
8159
8160 @item show record function-call-history-size
8161 Show how many functions to print in the
8162 @code{record function-call-history} command.
8163 @end table
8164
8165
8166 @node Stack
8167 @chapter Examining the Stack
8168
8169 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
8170 stopped and how it got there.
8171
8172 @cindex call stack
8173 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
8174 is generated.
8175 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
8176 the arguments of the call,
8177 and the local variables of the function being called.
8178 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
8179 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
8180 stack}.
8181
8182 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
8183 stack allow you to see all of this information.
8184
8185 @cindex selected frame
8186 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
8187 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
8188 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
8189 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
8190 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
8191 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8192
8193 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
8194 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
8195 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
8196
8197 @menu
8198 * Frames:: Stack frames
8199 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
8200 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
8201 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
8202 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
8203 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
8204
8205 @end menu
8206
8207 @node Frames
8208 @section Stack Frames
8209
8210 @cindex frame, definition
8211 @cindex stack frame
8212 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
8213 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
8214 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
8215 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
8216 which the function is executing.
8217
8218 @cindex initial frame
8219 @cindex outermost frame
8220 @cindex innermost frame
8221 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
8222 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
8223 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
8224 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
8225 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
8226 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
8227 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
8228 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
8229
8230 @cindex frame pointer
8231 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
8232 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
8233 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
8234 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
8235 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
8236 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
8237
8238 @cindex frame level
8239 @cindex frame number
8240 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
8241 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
8242 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
8243 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
8244 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
8245 describe this number.
8246
8247 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
8248 @c underflow problems.
8249 @cindex frameless execution
8250 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
8251 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
8252 @smallexample
8253 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
8254 @end smallexample
8255 generates functions without a frame.)
8256 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
8257 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
8258 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
8259 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
8260 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
8261 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
8262 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
8263
8264 @node Backtrace
8265 @section Backtraces
8266
8267 @cindex traceback
8268 @cindex call stack traces
8269 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
8270 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
8271 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
8272 stack.
8273
8274 @anchor{backtrace-command}
8275 @kindex backtrace
8276 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
8277 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
8278 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
8279 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
8280 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
8281 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
8282
8283 @table @code
8284 @item backtrace [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{qualifier}]@dots{} [@var{count}]
8285 @itemx bt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{qualifier}]@dots{} [@var{count}]
8286 Print the backtrace of the entire stack.
8287
8288 The optional @var{count} can be one of the following:
8289
8290 @table @code
8291 @item @var{n}
8292 @itemx @var{n}
8293 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
8294 number.
8295
8296 @item -@var{n}
8297 @itemx -@var{n}
8298 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
8299 number.
8300 @end table
8301
8302 Options:
8303
8304 @table @code
8305 @item -full
8306 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
8307 with the optional @var{count} to limit the number of frames shown.
8308
8309 @item -no-filters
8310 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
8311 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
8312 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
8313 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
8314 support.
8315
8316 @item -hide
8317 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
8318 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
8319 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{-hide}
8320 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
8321 @end table
8322
8323 The @code{backtrace} command also supports a number of options that
8324 allow overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set
8325 backtrace} and @code{set print} subcommands:
8326
8327 @table @code
8328 @item -past-main [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8329 Set whether backtraces should continue past @code{main}. Related setting:
8330 @ref{set backtrace past-main}.
8331
8332 @item -past-entry [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8333 Set whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a program.
8334 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-entry}.
8335
8336 @item -entry-values @code{no}|@code{only}|@code{preferred}|@code{if-needed}|@code{both}|@code{compact}|@code{default}
8337 Set printing of function arguments at function entry.
8338 Related setting: @ref{set print entry-values}.
8339
8340 @item -frame-arguments @code{all}|@code{scalars}|@code{none}
8341 Set printing of non-scalar frame arguments.
8342 Related setting: @ref{set print frame-arguments}.
8343
8344 @item -raw-frame-arguments [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8345 Set whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
8346 Related setting: @ref{set print raw-frame-arguments}.
8347
8348 @item -frame-info @code{auto}|@code{source-line}|@code{location}|@code{source-and-location}|@code{location-and-address}|@code{short-location}
8349 Set printing of frame information.
8350 Related setting: @ref{set print frame-info}.
8351 @end table
8352
8353 The optional @var{qualifier} is maintained for backward compatibility.
8354 It can be one of the following:
8355
8356 @table @code
8357 @item full
8358 Equivalent to the @code{-full} option.
8359
8360 @item no-filters
8361 Equivalent to the @code{-no-filters} option.
8362
8363 @item hide
8364 Equivalent to the @code{-hide} option.
8365 @end table
8366
8367 @end table
8368
8369 @kindex where
8370 @kindex info stack
8371 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
8372 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
8373
8374 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
8375 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
8376 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
8377 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
8378 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
8379 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
8380 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
8381 multi-threaded program.
8382
8383 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
8384 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
8385 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
8386 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
8387 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
8388 line number.
8389
8390 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
8391 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
8392
8393 @smallexample
8394 @group
8395 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
8396 at builtin.c:993
8397 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
8398 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
8399 at macro.c:71
8400 (More stack frames follow...)
8401 @end group
8402 @end smallexample
8403
8404 @noindent
8405 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
8406 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
8407 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
8408
8409 @noindent
8410 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
8411 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
8412 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
8413 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
8414 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
8415 The command @kbd{set print frame-info} (@pxref{Print Settings}) controls
8416 what frame information is printed.
8417
8418 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
8419 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
8420 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
8421 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
8422 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
8423 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
8424 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
8425 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
8426 such a backtrace might look like:
8427
8428 @smallexample
8429 @group
8430 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
8431 at builtin.c:993
8432 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
8433 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
8434 at macro.c:71
8435 (More stack frames follow...)
8436 @end group
8437 @end smallexample
8438
8439 @noindent
8440 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
8441 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
8442
8443 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
8444 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
8445 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
8446
8447 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
8448 @cindex program entry point
8449 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
8450 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
8451 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
8452 @code{main}@footnote{
8453 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
8454 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
8455 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
8456 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
8457 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
8458 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
8459
8460 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
8461 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
8462
8463 @table @code
8464 @item set backtrace past-main
8465 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
8466 @anchor{set backtrace past-main}
8467 @kindex set backtrace
8468 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
8469
8470 @item set backtrace past-main off
8471 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
8472 default.
8473
8474 @item show backtrace past-main
8475 @kindex show backtrace
8476 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
8477
8478 @item set backtrace past-entry
8479 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
8480 @anchor{set backtrace past-entry}
8481 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
8482 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
8483 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
8484
8485 @item set backtrace past-entry off
8486 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
8487 application. This is the default.
8488
8489 @item show backtrace past-entry
8490 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
8491
8492 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
8493 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
8494 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
8495 @anchor{set backtrace limit}
8496 @cindex backtrace limit
8497 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
8498 or zero means unlimited levels.
8499
8500 @item show backtrace limit
8501 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
8502 @end table
8503
8504 You can control how file names are displayed.
8505
8506 @table @code
8507 @item set filename-display
8508 @itemx set filename-display relative
8509 @cindex filename-display
8510 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
8511
8512 @item set filename-display basename
8513 Display only basename of a filename.
8514
8515 @item set filename-display absolute
8516 Display an absolute filename.
8517
8518 @item show filename-display
8519 Show the current way to display filenames.
8520 @end table
8521
8522 @node Selection
8523 @section Selecting a Frame
8524
8525 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
8526 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
8527 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
8528 of the stack frame just selected.
8529
8530 @table @code
8531 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
8532 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
8533 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8534 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8535 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
8536 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
8537
8538 @table @code
8539 @kindex frame level
8540 @item @var{num}
8541 @item level @var{num}
8542 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
8543 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
8544 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
8545 for @code{main}.
8546
8547 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
8548 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
8549 commands are equivalent:
8550
8551 @smallexample
8552 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
8553 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
8554 @end smallexample
8555
8556 @kindex frame address
8557 @item address @var{stack-address}
8558 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
8559 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
8560 @command{info frame}, for example:
8561
8562 @smallexample
8563 (@value{GDBP}) info frame
8564 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
8565 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
8566 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
8567 source language c++.
8568 Arglist at unknown address.
8569 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
8570 @end smallexample
8571
8572 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
8573 indicated by the line:
8574
8575 @smallexample
8576 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
8577 @end smallexample
8578
8579 @kindex frame function
8580 @item function @var{function-name}
8581 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
8582 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
8583 most stack frame is selected.
8584
8585 @kindex frame view
8586 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
8587 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
8588 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
8589 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
8590
8591 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
8592 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
8593 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
8594 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
8595
8596 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
8597 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
8598 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
8599 for example @command{frame level 0}.
8600
8601 @end table
8602
8603 @kindex up
8604 @item up @var{n}
8605 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
8606 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
8607 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
8608
8609 @kindex down
8610 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
8611 @item down @var{n}
8612 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
8613 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
8614 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
8615 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
8616 @end table
8617
8618 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
8619 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
8620 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
8621 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
8622
8623 @need 1000
8624 For example:
8625
8626 @smallexample
8627 @group
8628 (@value{GDBP}) up
8629 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
8630 at env.c:10
8631 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
8632 @end group
8633 @end smallexample
8634
8635 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
8636 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
8637 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
8638 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
8639 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
8640 for details.
8641
8642 @table @code
8643 @kindex select-frame
8644 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8645 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
8646 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
8647 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
8648 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
8649 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
8650 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8651
8652 @kindex down-silently
8653 @kindex up-silently
8654 @item up-silently @var{n}
8655 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
8656 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
8657 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
8658 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
8659 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
8660 distracting.
8661 @end table
8662
8663 @node Frame Info
8664 @section Information About a Frame
8665
8666 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
8667 stack frame.
8668
8669 @table @code
8670 @item frame
8671 @itemx f
8672 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
8673 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
8674 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
8675 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
8676 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8677
8678 @kindex info frame
8679 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
8680 @item info frame
8681 @itemx info f
8682 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
8683 including:
8684
8685 @itemize @bullet
8686 @item
8687 the address of the frame
8688 @item
8689 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
8690 @item
8691 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
8692 @item
8693 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
8694 @item
8695 the address of the frame's arguments
8696 @item
8697 the address of the frame's local variables
8698 @item
8699 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
8700 @item
8701 which registers were saved in the frame
8702 @end itemize
8703
8704 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
8705 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
8706 the usual conventions.
8707
8708 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8709 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8710 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
8711 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
8712 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
8713 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
8714
8715 @kindex info args
8716 @item info args [-q]
8717 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
8718
8719 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
8720 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
8721 have been printed.
8722
8723 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
8724 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
8725 with the provided regexp(s).
8726
8727 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
8728 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
8729
8730 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
8731 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
8732 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
8733 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
8734 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
8735 of special characters or quotes.
8736
8737 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
8738 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
8739 @var{type_regexp}.
8740
8741 @item info locals [-q]
8742 @kindex info locals
8743 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
8744 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
8745 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
8746
8747 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
8748 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
8749 have been printed.
8750
8751 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
8752 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
8753 with the provided regexp(s).
8754
8755 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
8756 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
8757
8758 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
8759 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
8760 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
8761 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
8762 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
8763 of special characters or quotes.
8764
8765 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
8766 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
8767 @var{type_regexp}.
8768
8769 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
8770 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
8771 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
8772 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
8773 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
8774 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
8775 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
8776 @smallexample
8777 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
8778 @end smallexample
8779 @noindent
8780 or the equivalent shorter form
8781 @smallexample
8782 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
8783 @end smallexample
8784
8785 @end table
8786
8787 @node Frame Apply
8788 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
8789 @kindex frame apply
8790 @cindex apply command to several frames
8791 @table @code
8792 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
8793 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
8794 @var{command} to one or more frames.
8795
8796 @table @code
8797 @item @code{all}
8798 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
8799
8800 @item @var{count}
8801 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
8802 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
8803
8804 @item @var{-count}
8805 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
8806 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
8807
8808 @item @code{level}
8809 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
8810 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
8811 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
8812 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
8813 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
8814 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
8815
8816 @end table
8817
8818 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
8819 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
8820 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}.
8821 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
8822
8823 The @code{frame apply} command also supports a number of options that
8824 allow overriding relevant @code{set backtrace} settings:
8825
8826 @table @code
8827 @item -past-main [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8828 Whether backtraces should continue past @code{main}.
8829 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-main}.
8830
8831 @item -past-entry [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8832 Whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a program.
8833 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-entry}.
8834 @end table
8835
8836 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
8837 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
8838 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
8839 following options can be used to fine-tune these behaviors:
8840
8841 @table @code
8842 @item -c
8843 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
8844 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
8845 @code{frame apply} then continues.
8846 @item -s
8847 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
8848 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
8849 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
8850 are not printed.
8851 @item -q
8852 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
8853 information.
8854 @end table
8855
8856 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
8857 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
8858 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
8859 @code{#1 main} frame.
8860
8861 @smallexample
8862 @group
8863 (@value{GDBP}) frame apply all p j
8864 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8865 No symbol "j" in current context.
8866 (@value{GDBP}) frame apply all -c p j
8867 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8868 No symbol "j" in current context.
8869 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8870 $1 = 5
8871 (@value{GDBP}) frame apply all -s p j
8872 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8873 $2 = 5
8874 (@value{GDBP})
8875 @end group
8876 @end smallexample
8877
8878 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
8879 information before the command output:
8880
8881 @smallexample
8882 @group
8883 (@value{GDBP}) frame apply all p $sp
8884 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8885 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8886 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8887 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8888 (@value{GDBP})
8889 @end group
8890 @end smallexample
8891
8892 If the flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8893 @smallexample
8894 @group
8895 (@value{GDBP}) frame apply all -q p $sp
8896 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8897 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8898 (@value{GDBP})
8899 @end group
8900 @end smallexample
8901
8902 @end table
8903
8904 @table @code
8905
8906 @kindex faas
8907 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8908 @item faas @var{command}
8909 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8910 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8911
8912 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8913 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8914 is, using:
8915 @smallexample
8916 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8917 @end smallexample
8918
8919 The @code{faas} command accepts the same options as the @code{frame
8920 apply} command. @xref{Frame Apply,,frame apply}.
8921
8922 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8923 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8924 @end table
8925
8926
8927 @node Frame Filter Management
8928 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8929 @cindex managing frame filters
8930
8931 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8932 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8933
8934 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8935 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8936
8937 @table @code
8938 @kindex info frame-filter
8939 @item info frame-filter
8940 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8941 their name, priority and enabled status.
8942
8943 @kindex disable frame-filter
8944 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8945 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8946 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8947 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8948 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8949 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8950 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8951 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8952 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8953 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8954 may be enabled again later.
8955
8956 @kindex enable frame-filter
8957 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8958 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8959 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8960 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8961 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8962 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8963 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8964 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8965 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8966
8967 Example:
8968
8969 @smallexample
8970 (@value{GDBP}) info frame-filter
8971
8972 global frame-filters:
8973 Priority Enabled Name
8974 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8975 100 Yes Reverse
8976
8977 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8978 Priority Enabled Name
8979 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8980
8981 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8982 Priority Enabled Name
8983 999 Yes BuildProgramFilter
8984
8985 (@value{GDBP}) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8986 (@value{GDBP}) info frame-filter
8987
8988 global frame-filters:
8989 Priority Enabled Name
8990 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8991 100 Yes Reverse
8992
8993 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8994 Priority Enabled Name
8995 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8996
8997 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8998 Priority Enabled Name
8999 999 No BuildProgramFilter
9000
9001 (@value{GDBP}) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
9002 (@value{GDBP}) info frame-filter
9003
9004 global frame-filters:
9005 Priority Enabled Name
9006 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
9007 100 Yes Reverse
9008
9009 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
9010 Priority Enabled Name
9011 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
9012
9013 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
9014 Priority Enabled Name
9015 999 No BuildProgramFilter
9016 @end smallexample
9017
9018 @kindex set frame-filter priority
9019 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
9020 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
9021 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
9022 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
9023 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
9024 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
9025
9026 @kindex show frame-filter priority
9027 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
9028 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
9029 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
9030 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
9031 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
9032 dictionary resides.
9033
9034 Example:
9035
9036 @smallexample
9037 (@value{GDBP}) info frame-filter
9038
9039 global frame-filters:
9040 Priority Enabled Name
9041 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
9042 100 Yes Reverse
9043
9044 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
9045 Priority Enabled Name
9046 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
9047
9048 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
9049 Priority Enabled Name
9050 999 No BuildProgramFilter
9051
9052 (@value{GDBP}) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
9053 (@value{GDBP}) info frame-filter
9054
9055 global frame-filters:
9056 Priority Enabled Name
9057 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
9058 50 Yes Reverse
9059
9060 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
9061 Priority Enabled Name
9062 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
9063
9064 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
9065 Priority Enabled Name
9066 999 No BuildProgramFilter
9067 @end smallexample
9068 @end table
9069
9070 @node Source
9071 @chapter Examining Source Files
9072
9073 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
9074 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
9075 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
9076 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
9077 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
9078 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
9079 source files by explicit command.
9080
9081 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
9082 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
9083 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
9084
9085 @menu
9086 * List:: Printing source lines
9087 * Location Specifications:: How to specify code locations
9088 * Edit:: Editing source files
9089 * Search:: Searching source files
9090 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
9091 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
9092 * Disable Reading Source:: Disable Reading Source Code
9093 @end menu
9094
9095 @node List
9096 @section Printing Source Lines
9097
9098 @kindex list
9099 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
9100 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
9101 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
9102 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
9103 print; see @ref{Location Specifications}, for the full list.
9104
9105 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
9106
9107 @table @code
9108 @item list @var{linenum}
9109 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
9110 current source file.
9111
9112 @item list @var{function}
9113 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
9114 @var{function}.
9115
9116 @item list
9117 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
9118 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
9119 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
9120 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
9121 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
9122
9123 @item list -
9124 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
9125 @end table
9126
9127 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
9128 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
9129 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
9130
9131 @table @code
9132 @kindex set listsize
9133 @item set listsize @var{count}
9134 @itemx set listsize unlimited
9135 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
9136 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
9137 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
9138
9139 @kindex show listsize
9140 @item show listsize
9141 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
9142 @end table
9143
9144 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
9145 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
9146 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
9147 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
9148 each repetition moves up in the source file.
9149
9150 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or
9151 two location specs. These location specs are interpreted to resolve
9152 to source code lines; there are several ways of writing them
9153 (@pxref{Location Specifications}), but the effect is always to resolve
9154 to some source lines to display.
9155
9156 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
9157
9158 @table @code
9159 @item list @var{locspec}
9160 Print lines centered around the line or lines of all the code
9161 locations that result from resolving @var{locspec}.
9162
9163 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
9164 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
9165 location specs. When a @code{list} command has two location specs,
9166 and the source file of the second location spec is omitted, this
9167 refers to the same source file as the first location spec. If either
9168 @var{first} or @var{last} resolve to more than one source line in the
9169 program, then the list command shows the list of resolved source
9170 lines and does not proceed with the source code listing.
9171
9172 @item list ,@var{last}
9173 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
9174
9175 Likewise, if @var{last} resolves to more than one source line in the
9176 program, then the list command prints the list of resolved source
9177 lines and does not proceed with the source code listing.
9178
9179 @item list @var{first},
9180 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
9181
9182 @item list +
9183 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
9184
9185 @item list -
9186 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
9187
9188 @item list
9189 As described in the preceding table.
9190 @end table
9191
9192 @node Location Specifications
9193 @section Location Specifications
9194 @cindex specifying location
9195 @cindex locspec
9196 @cindex source location
9197 @cindex code location
9198
9199 @cindex location spec
9200 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
9201 or locations of your program's code. Many times locations are
9202 specified using a source line number, but they can also be specified
9203 by a function name, an address, a label, etc. The different
9204 forms of specifying a location that @value{GDBN} recognizes are
9205 collectively known as forms of @dfn{location specification}, or
9206 @dfn{location spec}. This section documents the forms of specifying
9207 locations that @value{GDBN} recognizes.
9208
9209 @cindex location resolution
9210 @cindex resolution of location spec
9211 When you specify a location, @value{GDBN} needs to find the place in
9212 your program, known as @dfn{code location}, that corresponds to the
9213 given location spec. We call this process of finding actual code
9214 locations corresponding to a location spec @dfn{location resolution}.
9215
9216 A concrete code location in your program is uniquely identifiable by a
9217 set of several attributes: its source line number, the name of its
9218 source file, the fully-qualified and prototyped function in which it
9219 is defined, and an instruction address. Because each inferior has its
9220 own address space, the inferior number is also a necessary part of
9221 these attributes.
9222
9223 By contrast, location specs you type will many times omit some of
9224 these attributes. For example, it is customary to specify just the
9225 source line number to mean a line in the current source file, or
9226 specify just the basename of the file, omitting its directories. In
9227 other words, a location spec is usually incomplete, a kind of
9228 blueprint, and @value{GDBN} needs to complete the missing attributes
9229 by using the implied defaults, and by considering the source code and
9230 the debug information available to it. This is what location
9231 resolution is about.
9232
9233 The resolution of an incomplete location spec can produce more than a
9234 single code location, if the spec doesn't allow distinguishing between
9235 them. Here are some examples of situations that result in a location
9236 spec matching multiple code locations in your program:
9237
9238 @itemize @bullet
9239 @item
9240 The location spec specifies a function name, and there are several
9241 functions in the program which have that name. (To distinguish
9242 between them, you can specify a fully-qualified and prototyped
9243 function name, such as @code{A::func(int)} instead of just
9244 @code{func}.)
9245
9246 @item
9247 The location spec specifies a source file name, and there are several
9248 source files in the program that share the same name, for example
9249 several files with the same basename in different subdirectories. (To
9250 distinguish between them, specify enough leading directories with the
9251 file name.)
9252
9253 @item
9254 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
9255 instances of the function body, used in different cases, but their
9256 source-level names are identical.
9257
9258 @item
9259 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
9260 correspond to any number of instantiations.
9261
9262 @item
9263 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to several
9264 actual code locations with that function's inlined code.
9265 @end itemize
9266
9267 Resolution of a location spec can also fail to produce a complete code
9268 location, or even fail to produce any code location. Here are some
9269 examples of such situations:
9270
9271 @itemize @bullet
9272 @item
9273 Some parts of the program lack detailed enough debug info, so the
9274 resolved code location lacks some attributes, like source file name
9275 and line number, leaving just the instruction address and perhaps also
9276 a function name. Such an incomplete code location is only usable in
9277 contexts that work with addresses and/or function names. Some
9278 commands can only work with complete code locations.
9279
9280 @item
9281 The location spec specifies a function name, and there are no
9282 functions in the program by that name, or they only exist in a
9283 yet-unloaded shared library.
9284
9285 @item
9286 The location spec specifies a source file name, and there are no
9287 source files in the program by that name, or they only exist in a
9288 yet-unloaded shared library.
9289
9290 @item
9291 The location spec specifies both a source file name and a source line
9292 number, and even though there are source files in the program that
9293 match the file name, none of those files has the specified line
9294 number.
9295 @end itemize
9296
9297 Locations may be specified using three different formats: linespec
9298 locations, explicit locations, or address locations. The following
9299 subsections describe these formats.
9300
9301 @menu
9302 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
9303 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
9304 * Address Locations:: Address locations
9305 @end menu
9306
9307 @node Linespec Locations
9308 @subsection Linespec Locations
9309 @cindex linespec locations
9310
9311 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
9312 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
9313 specifying a linespec:
9314
9315 @table @code
9316 @item @var{linenum}
9317 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
9318
9319 @item -@var{offset}
9320 @itemx +@var{offset}
9321 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
9322 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
9323 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
9324 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
9325 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
9326 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
9327 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
9328 linespec.
9329
9330 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
9331 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
9332 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
9333 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
9334 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
9335 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
9336 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
9337
9338 @item @var{function}
9339 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
9340 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
9341
9342 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
9343 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
9344 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
9345 means in all packages.
9346
9347 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
9348 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
9349 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
9350
9351 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
9352 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
9353 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
9354 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
9355
9356 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
9357
9358 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
9359 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
9360
9361 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
9362 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
9363 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
9364 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
9365 functions in different source files.
9366
9367 @item @var{label}
9368 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
9369 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
9370 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
9371 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
9372
9373 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
9374 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
9375 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
9376 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
9377 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
9378 specifies the location of such a static probe.
9379
9380 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
9381 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
9382 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
9383 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
9384 each one of those probes.
9385 @end table
9386
9387 @node Explicit Locations
9388 @subsection Explicit Locations
9389 @cindex explicit locations
9390
9391 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
9392 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
9393
9394 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
9395 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
9396 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
9397 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
9398 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
9399
9400 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
9401 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
9402 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
9403 the symbol table to know.
9404
9405 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
9406 following table:
9407
9408 @table @code
9409 @item -source @var{filename}
9410 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
9411 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
9412 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
9413 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
9414 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
9415
9416 @item -function @var{function}
9417 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
9418 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
9419 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
9420 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
9421
9422 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
9423 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
9424 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
9425 means in all packages.
9426
9427 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
9428 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
9429 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
9430 breakpoint on both symbols.
9431
9432 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
9433
9434 @item -qualified
9435
9436 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
9437 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
9438
9439 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
9440 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
9441 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
9442
9443 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
9444 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
9445 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
9446
9447 @item -label @var{label}
9448 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
9449 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
9450 selected stack frame.
9451
9452 @item -line @var{number}
9453 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
9454 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
9455 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
9456 relative to the current line.
9457 @end table
9458
9459 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
9460 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
9461
9462 @node Address Locations
9463 @subsection Address Locations
9464 @cindex address locations
9465
9466 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
9467 the generalized form *@var{address}.
9468
9469 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
9470 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
9471 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
9472 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
9473 source files.
9474
9475 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
9476 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
9477 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
9478 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
9479 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
9480 of @var{address}:
9481
9482 @table @code
9483 @item @var{expression}
9484 Any expression valid in the current working language.
9485
9486 @item @var{funcaddr}
9487 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
9488 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
9489 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
9490 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
9491 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
9492 (although the Pascal form also works).
9493
9494 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
9495 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
9496
9497 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
9498 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
9499 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
9500 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
9501 functions with identical names in different source files.
9502 @end table
9503
9504 @node Edit
9505 @section Editing Source Files
9506 @cindex editing source files
9507
9508 @kindex edit
9509 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
9510 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
9511 The editing program of your choice
9512 is invoked with the current line set to
9513 the active line in the program.
9514 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
9515 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
9516
9517 @table @code
9518 @item edit @var{locspec}
9519 Edit the source file of the code location that results from resolving
9520 @code{locspec}. Editing starts at the source file and source line
9521 @code{locspec} resolves to.
9522 @xref{Location Specifications}, for all the possible forms of the
9523 @var{locspec} argument.
9524
9525 If @code{locspec} resolves to more than one source line in your
9526 program, then the command prints the list of resolved source lines and
9527 does not proceed with the editing.
9528
9529 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
9530
9531 @table @code
9532 @item edit @var{number}
9533 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
9534
9535 @item edit @var{function}
9536 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
9537 @end table
9538
9539 @end table
9540
9541 @subsection Choosing your Editor
9542 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
9543 @footnote{
9544 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
9545 following command-line syntax:
9546 @smallexample
9547 ex +@var{number} file
9548 @end smallexample
9549 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
9550 the file where to start editing.}.
9551 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
9552 by setting the environment variable @env{EDITOR} before using
9553 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
9554 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
9555 @smallexample
9556 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
9557 export EDITOR
9558 gdb @dots{}
9559 @end smallexample
9560 or in the @code{csh} shell,
9561 @smallexample
9562 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
9563 gdb @dots{}
9564 @end smallexample
9565
9566 @node Search
9567 @section Searching Source Files
9568 @cindex searching source files
9569
9570 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
9571 regular expression.
9572
9573 @table @code
9574 @kindex search
9575 @kindex forward-search
9576 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
9577 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
9578 @itemx search @var{regexp}
9579 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
9580 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
9581 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
9582 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
9583 @code{fo}.
9584
9585 @kindex reverse-search
9586 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
9587 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
9588 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
9589 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
9590 this command as @code{rev}.
9591 @end table
9592
9593 @node Source Path
9594 @section Specifying Source Directories
9595
9596 @cindex source path
9597 @cindex directories for source files
9598 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
9599 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
9600 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
9601 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
9602 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
9603 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
9604 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
9605
9606 For example, suppose an executable references the file
9607 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, does not record a compilation
9608 directory, and the @dfn{source path} is @file{/mnt/cross}.
9609 @value{GDBN} would look for the source file in the following
9610 locations:
9611
9612 @enumerate
9613
9614 @item @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9615 @item @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9616 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9617
9618 @end enumerate
9619
9620 If the source file is not present at any of the above locations then
9621 an error is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
9622 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
9623 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
9624 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
9625 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
9626 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
9627
9628 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
9629 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above,
9630 except that non-absolute file names are not looked up literally. If
9631 the @dfn{source path} is @file{/mnt/cross}, the source file is
9632 recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, and no compilation directory is
9633 recorded, then @value{GDBN} will search in the following locations:
9634
9635 @enumerate
9636
9637 @item @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}
9638 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9639
9640 @end enumerate
9641
9642 @kindex cdir
9643 @kindex cwd
9644 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
9645 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
9646 @cindex compilation directory
9647 @cindex current directory
9648 @cindex working directory
9649 @cindex directory, current
9650 @cindex directory, compilation
9651 The @dfn{source path} will always include two special entries
9652 @samp{$cdir} and @samp{$cwd}, these refer to the compilation directory
9653 (if one is recorded) and the current working directory respectively.
9654
9655 @samp{$cdir} causes @value{GDBN} to search within the compilation
9656 directory, if one is recorded in the debug information. If no
9657 compilation directory is recorded in the debug information then
9658 @samp{$cdir} is ignored.
9659
9660 @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former tracks the
9661 current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
9662 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
9663 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
9664
9665 If a compilation directory is recorded in the debug information, and
9666 @value{GDBN} has not found the source file after the first search
9667 using @dfn{source path}, then @value{GDBN} will combine the
9668 compilation directory and the filename, and then search for the source
9669 file again using the @dfn{source path}.
9670
9671 For example, if the executable records the source file as
9672 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, the compilation directory is
9673 recorded as @file{/project/build}, and the @dfn{source path} is
9674 @file{/mnt/cross:$cdir:$cwd} while the current working directory of
9675 the @value{GDBN} session is @file{/home/user}, then @value{GDBN} will
9676 search for the source file in the following locations:
9677
9678 @enumerate
9679
9680 @item @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9681 @item @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9682 @item @file{/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9683 @item @file{/home/user/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9684 @item @file{/mnt/cross/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9685 @item @file{/project/build/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9686 @item @file{/home/user/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9687 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9688 @item @file{/project/build/foo.c}
9689 @item @file{/home/user/foo.c}
9690
9691 @end enumerate
9692
9693 If the file name in the previous example had been recorded in the
9694 executable as a relative path rather than an absolute path, then the
9695 first look up would not have occurred, but all of the remaining steps
9696 would be similar.
9697
9698 When searching for source files on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where
9699 absolute paths start with a drive letter (e.g.@:
9700 @file{C:/project/foo.c}), @value{GDBN} will remove the drive letter
9701 from the file name before appending it to a search directory from
9702 @dfn{source path}; for instance if the executable references the
9703 source file @file{C:/project/foo.c} and @dfn{source path} is set to
9704 @file{D:/mnt/cross}, then @value{GDBN} will search in the following
9705 locations for the source file:
9706
9707 @enumerate
9708
9709 @item @file{C:/project/foo.c}
9710 @item @file{D:/mnt/cross/project/foo.c}
9711 @item @file{D:/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9712
9713 @end enumerate
9714
9715 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
9716 source files.
9717
9718 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
9719 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
9720 each line is in the file.
9721
9722 @kindex directory
9723 @kindex dir
9724 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{$cdir}
9725 and @samp{$cwd}, in that order.
9726 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
9727
9728 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
9729 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
9730
9731 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
9732 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
9733 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
9734 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
9735 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
9736 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
9737 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
9738 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
9739 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
9740 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
9741 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
9742 name to look up the sources.
9743
9744 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
9745 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
9746 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
9747 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
9748 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
9749 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
9750 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
9751 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
9752
9753 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
9754 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
9755 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
9756 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
9757 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
9758 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
9759 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
9760
9761 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
9762 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
9763 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
9764 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
9765 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
9766 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
9767 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
9768 command.
9769
9770 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
9771 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
9772 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
9773 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
9774 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
9775 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
9776 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
9777
9778 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
9779 @cindex default source path substitution
9780 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
9781 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
9782 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
9783 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
9784 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
9785 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
9786 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
9787 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
9788 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
9789 together.
9790
9791 @table @code
9792 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
9793 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
9794 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
9795 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
9796 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
9797 part of absolute file names) or
9798 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
9799 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
9800
9801 The special strings @samp{$cdir} (to refer to the compilation
9802 directory, if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} (to refer to the
9803 current working directory) can also be included in the list of
9804 directories @var{dirname}. Though these will already be in the source
9805 path they will be moved forward in the list so @value{GDBN} searches
9806 them sooner.
9807
9808 @item directory
9809 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
9810
9811 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
9812 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
9813
9814 @item set directories @var{path-list}
9815 @kindex set directories
9816 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
9817 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
9818
9819 @item show directories
9820 @kindex show directories
9821 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
9822
9823 @anchor{set substitute-path}
9824 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
9825 @kindex set substitute-path
9826 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
9827 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
9828 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
9829
9830 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
9831 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
9832
9833 @smallexample
9834 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
9835 @end smallexample
9836
9837 @noindent
9838 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
9839 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
9840 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
9841
9842 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
9843 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
9844 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
9845 the substitution.
9846
9847 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
9848
9849 @smallexample
9850 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
9851 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
9852 @end smallexample
9853
9854 @noindent
9855 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
9856 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
9857 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
9858 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
9859
9860
9861 @item unset substitute-path [path]
9862 @kindex unset substitute-path
9863 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
9864 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
9865 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
9866
9867 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
9868
9869 @item show substitute-path [path]
9870 @kindex show substitute-path
9871 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
9872 which would rewrite that path, if any.
9873
9874 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
9875 rules.
9876
9877 @end table
9878
9879 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
9880 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
9881 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
9882
9883 @enumerate
9884 @item
9885 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
9886
9887 @item
9888 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
9889 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
9890 directories in one command.
9891 @end enumerate
9892
9893 @node Machine Code
9894 @section Source and Machine Code
9895 @cindex source line and its code address
9896
9897 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
9898 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
9899 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
9900 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
9901 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
9902 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
9903 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
9904 well as hex.
9905
9906 @table @code
9907 @kindex info line
9908 @item info line
9909 @itemx info line @var{locspec}
9910 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for the
9911 source lines of the code locations that result from resolving
9912 @var{locspec}. @xref{Location Specifications}, for the various forms
9913 of @var{locspec}.
9914 With no @var{locspec}, information about the current source line is
9915 printed.
9916 @end table
9917
9918 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
9919 the object code for the first line of function
9920 @code{m4_changequote}:
9921
9922 @smallexample
9923 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
9924 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
9925 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
9926 @end smallexample
9927
9928 @noindent
9929 @cindex code address and its source line
9930 We can also inquire, using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
9931 @var{locspec}, what source line covers a particular address
9932 @var{addr}:
9933 @smallexample
9934 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
9935 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
9936 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
9937 @end smallexample
9938
9939 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
9940 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
9941 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
9942 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
9943 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
9944 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
9945 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
9946 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9947 Variables}).
9948
9949 @cindex info line, repeated calls
9950 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
9951 specifying a location will display information about the next source
9952 line.
9953
9954 @anchor{disassemble}
9955 @table @code
9956 @kindex disassemble
9957 @cindex assembly instructions
9958 @cindex instructions, assembly
9959 @cindex machine instructions
9960 @cindex listing machine instructions
9961 @item disassemble
9962 @itemx disassemble /m
9963 @itemx disassemble /s
9964 @itemx disassemble /r
9965 @itemx disassemble /b
9966 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
9967 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
9968 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in
9969 hex as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} or @code{/b}
9970 modifier. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
9971 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
9972 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
9973 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should be
9974 separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The arguments
9975 specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
9976
9977 @table @code
9978 @item @var{start},@var{end}
9979 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
9980 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
9981 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
9982 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
9983 @end table
9984
9985 @noindent
9986 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
9987 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
9988
9989 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
9990 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
9991
9992 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
9993 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
9994 @end table
9995
9996 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
9997 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
9998
9999 @smallexample
10000 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
10001 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
10002 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
10003 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
10004 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
10005 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
10006 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
10007 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
10008 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
10009 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
10010 End of assembler dump.
10011 @end smallexample
10012
10013 The following two examples are for RISC-V, and demonstrates the
10014 difference between the @code{/r} and @code{/b} modifiers. First with
10015 @code{/b}, the bytes of the instruction are printed, in hex, in memory
10016 order:
10017
10018 @smallexample
10019 (@value{GDBP}) disassemble /b 0x00010150,0x0001015c
10020 Dump of assembler code from 0x10150 to 0x1015c:
10021 0x00010150 <call_me+4>: 22 dc sw s0,56(sp)
10022 0x00010152 <call_me+6>: 80 00 addi s0,sp,64
10023 0x00010154 <call_me+8>: 23 26 a4 fe sw a0,-20(s0)
10024 0x00010158 <call_me+12>: 23 24 b4 fe sw a1,-24(s0)
10025 End of assembler dump.
10026 @end smallexample
10027
10028 In contrast, with @code{/r} the bytes of the instruction are displayed
10029 in the instruction order, for RISC-V this means that the bytes have been
10030 swapped to little-endian order:
10031
10032 @smallexample
10033 (@value{GDBP}) disassemble /r 0x00010150,0x0001015c
10034 Dump of assembler code from 0x10150 to 0x1015c:
10035 0x00010150 <call_me+4>: dc22 sw s0,56(sp)
10036 0x00010152 <call_me+6>: 0080 addi s0,sp,64
10037 0x00010154 <call_me+8>: fea42623 sw a0,-20(s0)
10038 0x00010158 <call_me+12>: feb42423 sw a1,-24(s0)
10039 End of assembler dump.
10040 @end smallexample
10041
10042 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
10043 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
10044 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
10045
10046 @smallexample
10047 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
10048 Dump of assembler code for function main:
10049 5 @{
10050 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
10051 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
10052 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
10053 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
10054 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
10055
10056 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
10057 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
10058 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
10059
10060 7 return 0;
10061 8 @}
10062 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
10063 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
10064 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
10065
10066 End of assembler dump.
10067 @end smallexample
10068
10069 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
10070 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
10071 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
10072 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
10073 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
10074 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
10075 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
10076 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
10077 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
10078
10079 @file{foo.h}:
10080
10081 @smallexample
10082 int
10083 foo (int a)
10084 @{
10085 if (a < 0)
10086 return a * 2;
10087 if (a == 0)
10088 return 1;
10089 return a + 10;
10090 @}
10091 @end smallexample
10092
10093 @file{foo.c}:
10094
10095 @smallexample
10096 #include "foo.h"
10097 volatile int x, y;
10098 int
10099 main ()
10100 @{
10101 x = foo (y);
10102 return 0;
10103 @}
10104 @end smallexample
10105
10106 @smallexample
10107 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
10108 Dump of assembler code for function main:
10109 5 @{
10110
10111 6 x = foo (y);
10112 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
10113 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
10114
10115 7 return 0;
10116 8 @}
10117 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
10118 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
10119 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
10120 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
10121
10122 End of assembler dump.
10123 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
10124 Dump of assembler code for function main:
10125 foo.c:
10126 5 @{
10127 6 x = foo (y);
10128 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
10129
10130 foo.h:
10131 4 if (a < 0)
10132 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
10133 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
10134
10135 6 if (a == 0)
10136 7 return 1;
10137 8 return a + 10;
10138 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
10139 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
10140 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
10141 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
10142
10143 foo.c:
10144 6 x = foo (y);
10145 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
10146
10147 7 return 0;
10148 8 @}
10149 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
10150 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
10151
10152 foo.h:
10153 5 return a * 2;
10154 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
10155 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
10156 End of assembler dump.
10157 @end smallexample
10158
10159 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
10160
10161 @smallexample
10162 (@value{GDBP}) disas /r 0x400281,+10
10163 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
10164 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
10165 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
10166 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
10167 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
10168 End of assembler dump.
10169 @end smallexample
10170
10171 Note that the @samp{disassemble} command's address arguments are
10172 specified using expressions in your programming language
10173 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), not location specs
10174 (@pxref{Location Specifications}). So, for example, if you want to
10175 disassemble function @code{bar} in file @file{foo.c}, you must type
10176 @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar} and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
10177
10178 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
10179 mnemonics or other syntax.
10180
10181 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
10182 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
10183 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
10184 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
10185 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
10186
10187 @table @code
10188 @kindex set disassembler-options
10189 @cindex disassembler options
10190 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
10191 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
10192 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
10193 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
10194 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
10195 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
10196 The default value is the empty string.
10197
10198 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
10199 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
10200 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARC, ARM, MIPS,
10201 PowerPC and S/390.
10202
10203 @kindex show disassembler-options
10204 @item show disassembler-options
10205 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
10206 @end table
10207
10208 @table @code
10209 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
10210 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
10211 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
10212 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
10213 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
10214 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
10215
10216 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
10217 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
10218 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
10219 assemblers for x86-based targets.
10220
10221 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
10222 @item show disassembly-flavor
10223 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
10224 @end table
10225
10226 @table @code
10227 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
10228 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
10229 @item set disassemble-next-line
10230 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
10231 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
10232 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
10233 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
10234 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
10235 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
10236 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
10237 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
10238 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
10239 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
10240 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
10241 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
10242 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
10243 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
10244 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
10245 instruction.
10246 @end table
10247
10248 @node Disable Reading Source
10249 @section Disable Reading Source Code
10250 @cindex source code, disable access
10251
10252 In some cases it can be desirable to prevent @value{GDBN} from
10253 accessing source code files. One case where this might be desirable
10254 is if the source code files are located over a slow network
10255 connection.
10256
10257 The following command can be used to control whether @value{GDBN}
10258 should access source code files or not:
10259
10260 @table @code
10261 @kindex set source open
10262 @kindex show source open
10263 @item set source open @r{[}on@r{|}off@r{]}
10264 @itemx show source open
10265 When this option is @code{on}, which is the default, @value{GDBN} will
10266 access source code files when needed, for example to print source
10267 lines when @value{GDBN} stops, or in response to the @code{list}
10268 command.
10269
10270 When this option is @code{off}, @value{GDBN} will not access source
10271 code files.
10272 @end table
10273
10274 @node Data
10275 @chapter Examining Data
10276
10277 @cindex printing data
10278 @cindex examining data
10279 @kindex print
10280 @kindex inspect
10281 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
10282 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
10283 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
10284 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
10285 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
10286 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
10287
10288 @table @code
10289 @item print [[@var{options}] --] @var{expr}
10290 @itemx print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f} @var{expr}
10291 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
10292 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
10293 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
10294 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
10295 Formats}.
10296
10297 @anchor{print options}
10298 The @code{print} command supports a number of options that allow
10299 overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set print}
10300 subcommands:
10301
10302 @table @code
10303 @item -address [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10304 Set printing of addresses.
10305 Related setting: @ref{set print address}.
10306
10307 @item -array [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10308 Pretty formatting of arrays.
10309 Related setting: @ref{set print array}.
10310
10311 @item -array-indexes [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10312 Set printing of array indexes.
10313 Related setting: @ref{set print array-indexes}.
10314
10315 @item -characters @var{number-of-characters}|@code{elements}|@code{unlimited}
10316 Set limit on string characters to print. The value @code{elements}
10317 causes the limit on array elements to print to be used. The value
10318 @code{unlimited} causes there to be no limit. Related setting:
10319 @ref{set print characters}.
10320
10321 @item -elements @var{number-of-elements}|@code{unlimited}
10322 Set limit on array elements and optionally string characters to print.
10323 See @ref{set print characters}, and the @code{-characters} option above
10324 for when this option applies to strings. The value @code{unlimited}
10325 causes there to be no limit. @xref{set print elements}, for a related
10326 CLI command.
10327
10328 @item -max-depth @var{depth}|@code{unlimited}
10329 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
10330 ellipsis. Related setting: @ref{set print max-depth}.
10331
10332 @item -nibbles [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10333 Set whether to print binary values in groups of four bits, known
10334 as ``nibbles''. @xref{set print nibbles}.
10335
10336 @item -memory-tag-violations [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10337 Set printing of additional information about memory tag violations.
10338 @xref{set print memory-tag-violations}.
10339
10340 @item -null-stop [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10341 Set printing of char arrays to stop at first null char. Related
10342 setting: @ref{set print null-stop}.
10343
10344 @item -object [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10345 Set printing C@t{++} virtual function tables. Related setting:
10346 @ref{set print object}.
10347
10348 @item -pretty [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10349 Set pretty formatting of structures. Related setting: @ref{set print
10350 pretty}.
10351
10352 @item -raw-values [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10353 Set whether to print values in raw form, bypassing any
10354 pretty-printers for that value. Related setting: @ref{set print
10355 raw-values}.
10356
10357 @item -repeats @var{number-of-repeats}|@code{unlimited}
10358 Set threshold for repeated print elements. @code{unlimited} causes
10359 all elements to be individually printed. Related setting: @ref{set
10360 print repeats}.
10361
10362 @item -static-members [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10363 Set printing C@t{++} static members. Related setting: @ref{set print
10364 static-members}.
10365
10366 @item -symbol [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10367 Set printing of symbol names when printing pointers. Related setting:
10368 @ref{set print symbol}.
10369
10370 @item -union [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10371 Set printing of unions interior to structures. Related setting:
10372 @ref{set print union}.
10373
10374 @item -vtbl [@code{on}|@code{off}]
10375 Set printing of C++ virtual function tables. Related setting:
10376 @ref{set print vtbl}.
10377 @end table
10378
10379 Because the @code{print} command accepts arbitrary expressions which
10380 may look like options (including abbreviations), if you specify any
10381 command option, then you must use a double dash (@code{--}) to mark
10382 the end of option processing.
10383
10384 For example, this prints the value of the @code{-p} expression:
10385
10386 @smallexample
10387 (@value{GDBP}) print -p
10388 @end smallexample
10389
10390 While this repeats the last value in the value history (see below)
10391 with the @code{-pretty} option in effect:
10392
10393 @smallexample
10394 (@value{GDBP}) print -p --
10395 @end smallexample
10396
10397 Here is an example including both on option and an expression:
10398
10399 @smallexample
10400 @group
10401 (@value{GDBP}) print -pretty -- *myptr
10402 $1 = @{
10403 next = 0x0,
10404 flags = @{
10405 sweet = 1,
10406 sour = 1
10407 @},
10408 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10409 @}
10410 @end group
10411 @end smallexample
10412
10413 @item print [@var{options}]
10414 @itemx print [@var{options}] /@var{f}
10415 @cindex reprint the last value
10416 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
10417 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
10418 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
10419 @end table
10420
10421 If the architecture supports memory tagging, the @code{print} command will
10422 display pointer/memory tag mismatches if what is being printed is a pointer
10423 or reference type. @xref{Memory Tagging}.
10424
10425 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
10426 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
10427 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10428
10429 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
10430 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{expr}}
10431 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
10432 Table}.
10433
10434 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
10435 @kindex explore
10436 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
10437 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
10438 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
10439 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
10440 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
10441 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
10442 embedded in the higher level data types.
10443
10444 @table @code
10445 @item explore @var{arg}
10446 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
10447 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
10448 @end table
10449
10450 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
10451 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
10452 C program as
10453
10454 @smallexample
10455 struct SimpleStruct
10456 @{
10457 int i;
10458 double d;
10459 @};
10460
10461 struct ComplexStruct
10462 @{
10463 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
10464 int arr[10];
10465 @};
10466 @end smallexample
10467
10468 @noindent
10469 followed by variable declarations as
10470
10471 @smallexample
10472 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
10473 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
10474 @end smallexample
10475
10476 @noindent
10477 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
10478 @code{explore} command as follows.
10479
10480 @smallexample
10481 (@value{GDBP}) explore cs
10482 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
10483 the following fields:
10484
10485 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
10486 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
10487
10488 Enter the field number of choice:
10489 @end smallexample
10490
10491 @noindent
10492 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
10493 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
10494 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
10495 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
10496 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
10497 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
10498 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
10499 field will be explored as if it were an array.
10500
10501 @smallexample
10502 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
10503 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
10504 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
10505 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
10506
10507 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
10508 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
10509
10510 Press enter to return to parent value:
10511 @end smallexample
10512
10513 @noindent
10514 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
10515 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
10516 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
10517 to explore.
10518
10519 @smallexample
10520 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
10521 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
10522
10523 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
10524
10525 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
10526
10527 Press enter to return to parent value:
10528 @end smallexample
10529
10530 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
10531 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
10532 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
10533 level data structure).
10534
10535 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
10536 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
10537 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
10538 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
10539 same example as above, your can explore the type
10540 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
10541 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
10542
10543 @smallexample
10544 (@value{GDBP}) explore struct ComplexStruct
10545 @end smallexample
10546
10547 @noindent
10548 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
10549 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
10550 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
10551 example.
10552
10553 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
10554 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
10555 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
10556 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
10557 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
10558
10559 @table @code
10560 @item explore value @var{expr}
10561 @cindex explore value
10562 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
10563 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
10564 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
10565 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
10566 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
10567
10568 @item explore type @var{arg}
10569 @cindex explore type
10570 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
10571 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
10572 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
10573 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
10574 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
10575 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
10576 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
10577 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
10578 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
10579 @end table
10580
10581 @menu
10582 * Expressions:: Expressions
10583 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
10584 * Variables:: Program variables
10585 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
10586 * Output Formats:: Output formats
10587 * Memory:: Examining memory
10588 * Memory Tagging:: Memory Tagging
10589 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
10590 * Print Settings:: Print settings
10591 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
10592 * Value History:: Value history
10593 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
10594 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
10595 * Registers:: Registers
10596 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
10597 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
10598 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
10599 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
10600 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
10601 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
10602 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
10603 character set than GDB does
10604 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
10605 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
10606 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
10607 @end menu
10608
10609 @node Expressions
10610 @section Expressions
10611
10612 @cindex expressions
10613 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
10614 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
10615 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
10616 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
10617 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
10618 you compiled your program to include this information; see
10619 @ref{Compilation}.
10620
10621 @cindex arrays in expressions
10622 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
10623 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
10624 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
10625 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
10626 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
10627 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
10628
10629 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
10630 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
10631 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
10632 languages.
10633
10634 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
10635 expressions regardless of your programming language.
10636
10637 @cindex casts, in expressions
10638 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
10639 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
10640 at that address in memory.
10641 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
10642
10643 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
10644 to programming languages:
10645
10646 @table @code
10647 @item @@
10648 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
10649 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
10650
10651 @item ::
10652 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
10653 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
10654
10655 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
10656 @cindex type casting memory
10657 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
10658 @cindex casts, to view memory
10659 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
10660 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
10661 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
10662 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
10663 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
10664 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
10665 @end table
10666
10667 @node Ambiguous Expressions
10668 @section Ambiguous Expressions
10669 @cindex ambiguous expressions
10670
10671 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
10672 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
10673 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
10674 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
10675 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
10676 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
10677 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
10678
10679 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
10680 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
10681 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
10682 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
10683 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
10684 as well.
10685
10686 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
10687 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
10688 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
10689 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
10690 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
10691 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
10692 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
10693 choices.
10694
10695 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
10696 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
10697 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
10698
10699 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
10700 @smallexample
10701 @group
10702 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
10703 [0] cancel
10704 [1] all
10705 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
10706 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
10707 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
10708 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
10709 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
10710 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
10711 > 2 4 6
10712 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
10713 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
10714 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
10715 Multiple breakpoints were set.
10716 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
10717 breakpoints.
10718 (@value{GDBP})
10719 @end group
10720 @end smallexample
10721
10722 @table @code
10723 @kindex set multiple-symbols
10724 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
10725 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
10726
10727 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
10728 is ambiguous.
10729
10730 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
10731 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
10732 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
10733 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
10734 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
10735 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
10736 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
10737 in the use of the menu.
10738
10739 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
10740 when an ambiguity is detected.
10741
10742 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
10743 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
10744
10745 @kindex show multiple-symbols
10746 @item show multiple-symbols
10747 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
10748 @end table
10749
10750 @node Variables
10751 @section Program Variables
10752
10753 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
10754 in your program.
10755
10756 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
10757 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
10758
10759 @itemize @bullet
10760 @item
10761 global (or file-static)
10762 @end itemize
10763
10764 @noindent or
10765
10766 @itemize @bullet
10767 @item
10768 visible according to the scope rules of the
10769 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
10770 @end itemize
10771
10772 @noindent This means that in the function
10773
10774 @smallexample
10775 foo (a)
10776 int a;
10777 @{
10778 bar (a);
10779 @{
10780 int b = test ();
10781 bar (b);
10782 @}
10783 @}
10784 @end smallexample
10785
10786 @noindent
10787 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
10788 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
10789 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
10790 the block where @code{b} is declared.
10791
10792 @cindex variable name conflict
10793 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
10794 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
10795 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
10796 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
10797 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
10798 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
10799 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
10800
10801 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
10802 @ifnotinfo
10803 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
10804 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
10805 @end ifnotinfo
10806 @smallexample
10807 @var{file}::@var{variable}
10808 @var{function}::@var{variable}
10809 @end smallexample
10810
10811 @noindent
10812 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
10813 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
10814 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
10815 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
10816
10817 @smallexample
10818 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
10819 @end smallexample
10820
10821 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
10822 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
10823 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
10824 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
10825 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
10826
10827 @smallexample
10828 void
10829 foo (int a)
10830 @{
10831 if (a < 10)
10832 bar (a);
10833 else
10834 process (a); /* Stop here */
10835 @}
10836
10837 int
10838 bar (int a)
10839 @{
10840 foo (a + 5);
10841 @}
10842 @end smallexample
10843
10844 @noindent
10845 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
10846 here is what you might see
10847 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
10848
10849 @smallexample
10850 (@value{GDBP}) p a
10851 $1 = 10
10852 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
10853 $2 = 5
10854 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
10855 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
10856 (@value{GDBP}) p a
10857 $3 = 5
10858 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
10859 $4 = 0
10860 @end smallexample
10861
10862 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
10863 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
10864 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
10865 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
10866 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
10867
10868 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
10869 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
10870 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
10871 @code{some_global}.
10872
10873 @smallexample
10874 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
10875 $1 = 23
10876 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
10877 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
10878 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
10879 $2 = 27
10880 @end smallexample
10881
10882 @cindex wrong values
10883 @cindex variable values, wrong
10884 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
10885 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
10886 @quotation
10887 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
10888 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
10889 scope, and just before exit.
10890 @end quotation
10891 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
10892 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
10893 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
10894 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
10895 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
10896 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
10897 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
10898 variable definitions may be gone.
10899
10900 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
10901 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
10902 when compiling.
10903
10904 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
10905 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
10906 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
10907 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
10908 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
10909 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
10910 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
10911
10912 @smallexample
10913 No symbol "foo" in current context.
10914 @end smallexample
10915
10916 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
10917 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
10918 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
10919 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
10920 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
10921
10922 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
10923 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
10924 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
10925 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
10926
10927 @cindex no debug info variables
10928 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
10929 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
10930 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
10931 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
10932 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
10933 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
10934 example, in a C program:
10935
10936 @smallexample
10937 (@value{GDBP}) p var
10938 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
10939 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
10940 $1 = 3.14
10941 @end smallexample
10942
10943 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
10944 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
10945 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
10946 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
10947 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
10948
10949 @smallexample
10950 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
10951 29 i++;
10952 (@value{GDBP}) next
10953 30 e (i);
10954 (@value{GDBP}) print i
10955 $1 = 31
10956 (@value{GDBP}) print i@@entry
10957 $2 = 30
10958 @end smallexample
10959
10960 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
10961 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
10962 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
10963 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
10964 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
10965 For program code
10966
10967 @smallexample
10968 char var0[] = "A";
10969 signed char var1[] = "A";
10970 @end smallexample
10971
10972 You get during debugging
10973 @smallexample
10974 (@value{GDBP}) print var0
10975 $1 = "A"
10976 (@value{GDBP}) print var1
10977 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
10978 @end smallexample
10979
10980 @node Arrays
10981 @section Artificial Arrays
10982
10983 @cindex artificial array
10984 @cindex arrays
10985 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
10986 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
10987 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
10988 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
10989 program.
10990
10991 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
10992 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
10993 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
10994 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
10995 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
10996 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
10997 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
10998 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
10999 example. If a program says
11000
11001 @smallexample
11002 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
11003 @end smallexample
11004
11005 @noindent
11006 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
11007
11008 @smallexample
11009 p *array@@len
11010 @end smallexample
11011
11012 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
11013 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
11014 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
11015 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
11016 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
11017
11018 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
11019 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
11020 The value need not be in memory:
11021 @smallexample
11022 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
11023 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
11024 @end smallexample
11025
11026 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
11027 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
11028 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
11029 @smallexample
11030 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
11031 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
11032 @end smallexample
11033
11034 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
11035 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
11036 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
11037 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
11038 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
11039 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
11040 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
11041 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
11042 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
11043 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
11044
11045 @smallexample
11046 set $i = 0
11047 p dtab[$i++]->fv
11048 @key{RET}
11049 @key{RET}
11050 @dots{}
11051 @end smallexample
11052
11053 @node Output Formats
11054 @section Output Formats
11055
11056 @cindex formatted output
11057 @cindex output formats
11058 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
11059 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
11060 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
11061 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
11062 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
11063
11064 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
11065 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
11066 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
11067 letters supported are:
11068
11069 @table @code
11070 @item x
11071 Print the binary representation of the value in hexadecimal.
11072
11073 @item d
11074 Print the binary representation of the value in decimal.
11075
11076 @item u
11077 Print the binary representation of the value as an decimal, as if it
11078 were unsigned.
11079
11080 @item o
11081 Print the binary representation of the value in octal.
11082
11083 @item t
11084 Print the binary representation of the value in binary. The letter
11085 @samp{t} stands for ``two''. @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used
11086 because these format letters are also used with the @code{x} command,
11087 where @samp{b} stands for ``byte''; see @ref{Memory,,Examining
11088 Memory}.}
11089
11090 @item a
11091 @cindex unknown address, locating
11092 @cindex locate address
11093 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
11094 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
11095 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
11096
11097 @smallexample
11098 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
11099 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
11100 @end smallexample
11101
11102 @noindent
11103 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
11104 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
11105
11106 @item c
11107 Cast the value to an integer (unlike other formats, this does not just
11108 reinterpret the underlying bits) and print it as a character constant.
11109 This prints both the numerical value and its character representation.
11110 The character representation is replaced with the octal escape
11111 @samp{\nnn} for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
11112
11113 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
11114 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
11115 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
11116 data.
11117
11118 @item f
11119 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
11120 using typical floating point syntax.
11121
11122 @item s
11123 @cindex printing strings
11124 @cindex printing byte arrays
11125 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
11126 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
11127 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
11128 natural types.
11129
11130 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
11131 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
11132 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
11133 array.
11134
11135 @item z
11136 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
11137 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
11138 to the size of the integer type.
11139
11140 @item r
11141 @cindex raw printing
11142 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
11143 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
11144 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
11145 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
11146 pretty-printer which might exist.
11147 @end table
11148
11149 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
11150
11151 @smallexample
11152 p/x $pc
11153 @end smallexample
11154
11155 @noindent
11156 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
11157 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
11158
11159 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
11160 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
11161 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
11162
11163 @node Memory
11164 @section Examining Memory
11165
11166 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
11167 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
11168
11169 @cindex examining memory
11170 @table @code
11171 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
11172 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
11173 @itemx x @var{addr}
11174 @itemx x
11175 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
11176 @end table
11177
11178 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
11179 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
11180 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
11181 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
11182 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
11183
11184 @table @r
11185 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
11186 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
11187 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
11188 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
11189 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
11190 @c 4.1.2.
11191
11192 @item @var{f}, the display format
11193 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
11194 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
11195 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), @samp{i} (for machine instructions) and
11196 @samp{m} (for displaying memory tags).
11197 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
11198 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
11199
11200 @item @var{u}, the unit size
11201 The unit size is any of
11202
11203 @table @code
11204 @item b
11205 Bytes.
11206 @item h
11207 Halfwords (two bytes).
11208 @item w
11209 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
11210 @item g
11211 Giant words (eight bytes).
11212 @end table
11213
11214 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
11215 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
11216 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
11217 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
11218 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
11219 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
11220 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
11221 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
11222 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
11223 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
11224 be altered.
11225
11226 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
11227 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
11228 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
11229 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
11230 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
11231 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
11232 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
11233 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
11234 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
11235 a value from memory).
11236 @end table
11237
11238 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
11239 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
11240 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
11241 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
11242 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
11243
11244 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
11245 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
11246 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x5431a}, @code{0x5431c}, and @code{0x5431e}.
11247
11248 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
11249 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
11250 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
11251 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
11252 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
11253
11254 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
11255 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
11256 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
11257 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
11258 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
11259 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
11260 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
11261 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
11262 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
11263
11264 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
11265 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
11266 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
11267 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
11268 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
11269 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
11270
11271 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
11272 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
11273 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
11274 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
11275 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
11276 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
11277 for successive uses of @code{x}.
11278
11279 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
11280 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
11281
11282 @smallexample
11283 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
11284 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
11285 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
11286 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
11287 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
11288 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
11289 @end smallexample
11290
11291 If the architecture supports memory tagging, the tags can be displayed by
11292 using @samp{m}. @xref{Memory Tagging}.
11293
11294 The information will be displayed once per granule size
11295 (the amount of bytes a particular memory tag covers). For example, AArch64
11296 has a granule size of 16 bytes, so it will display a tag every 16 bytes.
11297
11298 Due to the way @value{GDBN} prints information with the @code{x} command (not
11299 aligned to a particular boundary), the tag information will refer to the
11300 initial address displayed on a particular line. If a memory tag boundary
11301 is crossed in the middle of a line displayed by the @code{x} command, it
11302 will be displayed on the next line.
11303
11304 The @samp{m} format doesn't affect any other specified formats that were
11305 passed to the @code{x} command.
11306
11307 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
11308 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
11309 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
11310 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
11311 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
11312 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
11313 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
11314 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
11315 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
11316
11317 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
11318 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
11319 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
11320
11321 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
11322 @cindex addressable memory unit
11323 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
11324 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
11325 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
11326 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
11327 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
11328 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
11329 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
11330 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
11331 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
11332
11333 @cindex remote memory comparison
11334 @cindex target memory comparison
11335 @cindex verify remote memory image
11336 @cindex verify target memory image
11337 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
11338 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
11339 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
11340 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
11341 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
11342 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
11343
11344 @table @code
11345 @kindex compare-sections
11346 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
11347 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
11348 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
11349 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
11350 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
11351 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
11352
11353 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
11354 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
11355 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
11356 @end table
11357
11358 @node Memory Tagging
11359 @section Memory Tagging
11360
11361 Memory tagging is a memory protection technology that uses a pair of tags to
11362 validate memory accesses through pointers. The tags are integer values
11363 usually comprised of a few bits, depending on the architecture.
11364
11365 There are two types of tags that are used in this setup: logical and
11366 allocation. A logical tag is stored in the pointers themselves, usually at the
11367 higher bits of the pointers. An allocation tag is the tag associated
11368 with particular ranges of memory in the physical address space, against which
11369 the logical tags from pointers are compared.
11370
11371 The pointer tag (logical tag) must match the memory tag (allocation tag)
11372 for the memory access to be valid. If the logical tag does not match the
11373 allocation tag, that will raise a memory violation.
11374
11375 Allocation tags cover multiple contiguous bytes of physical memory. This
11376 range of bytes is called a memory tag granule and is architecture-specific.
11377 For example, AArch64 has a tag granule of 16 bytes, meaning each allocation
11378 tag spans 16 bytes of memory.
11379
11380 If the underlying architecture supports memory tagging, like AArch64 MTE
11381 or SPARC ADI do, @value{GDBN} can make use of it to validate pointers
11382 against memory allocation tags.
11383
11384 The @code{print} (@pxref{Data}) and @code{x} (@pxref{Memory}) commands will
11385 display tag information when appropriate, and a command prefix of
11386 @code{memory-tag} gives access to the various memory tagging commands.
11387
11388 The @code{memory-tag} commands are the following:
11389
11390 @table @code
11391 @kindex memory-tag print-logical-tag
11392 @item memory-tag print-logical-tag @var{pointer_expression}
11393 Print the logical tag stored in @var{pointer_expression}.
11394 @kindex memory-tag with-logical-tag
11395 @item memory-tag with-logical-tag @var{pointer_expression} @var{tag_bytes}
11396 Print the pointer given by @var{pointer_expression}, augmented with a logical
11397 tag of @var{tag_bytes}.
11398 @kindex memory-tag print-allocation-tag
11399 @item memory-tag print-allocation-tag @var{address_expression}
11400 Print the allocation tag associated with the memory address given by
11401 @var{address_expression}.
11402 @kindex memory-tag setatag
11403 @item memory-tag setatag @var{starting_address} @var{length} @var{tag_bytes}
11404 Set the allocation tag(s) for memory range @r{[}@var{starting_address},
11405 @var{starting_address} + @var{length}@r{)} to @var{tag_bytes}.
11406 @kindex memory-tag check
11407 @item memory-tag check @var{pointer_expression}
11408 Check if the logical tag in the pointer given by @var{pointer_expression}
11409 matches the allocation tag for the memory referenced by the pointer.
11410
11411 This essentially emulates the hardware validation that is done when tagged
11412 memory is accessed through a pointer, but does not cause a memory fault as
11413 it would during hardware validation.
11414
11415 It can be used to inspect potential memory tagging violations in the running
11416 process, before any faults get triggered.
11417 @end table
11418
11419 @node Auto Display
11420 @section Automatic Display
11421 @cindex automatic display
11422 @cindex display of expressions
11423
11424 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
11425 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
11426 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
11427 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
11428 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
11429 The automatic display looks like this:
11430
11431 @smallexample
11432 2: foo = 38
11433 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
11434 @end smallexample
11435
11436 @noindent
11437 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
11438 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
11439 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
11440 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
11441 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
11442 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
11443
11444 @table @code
11445 @kindex display
11446 @item display @var{expr}
11447 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
11448 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11449
11450 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
11451
11452 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
11453 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
11454 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
11455 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
11456 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
11457
11458 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
11459 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
11460 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
11461 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
11462 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
11463 @end table
11464
11465 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
11466 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
11467 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11468
11469 @table @code
11470 @kindex delete display
11471 @kindex undisplay
11472 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
11473 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
11474 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
11475 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
11476 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
11477 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
11478 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
11479
11480 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11481 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
11482
11483 @kindex disable display
11484 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
11485 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
11486 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
11487 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
11488 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
11489 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
11490 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
11491 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
11492
11493 @kindex enable display
11494 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
11495 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
11496 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
11497 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
11498 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
11499 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
11500 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
11501
11502 @item display
11503 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
11504 done when your program stops.
11505
11506 @kindex info display
11507 @item info display
11508 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
11509 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
11510 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
11511 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
11512 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
11513 @end table
11514
11515 @cindex display disabled out of scope
11516 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
11517 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
11518 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
11519 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
11520 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
11521 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
11522 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
11523 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
11524 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
11525 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
11526
11527 @node Print Settings
11528 @section Print Settings
11529
11530 @cindex format options
11531 @cindex print settings
11532 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
11533 and symbols are printed.
11534
11535 @noindent
11536 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
11537
11538 @table @code
11539 @kindex set print
11540 @anchor{set print address}
11541 @item set print address
11542 @itemx set print address on
11543 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
11544 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
11545 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
11546 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
11547 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
11548 @code{set print address on}:
11549
11550 @smallexample
11551 @group
11552 (@value{GDBP}) f
11553 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
11554 at input.c:530
11555 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
11556 @end group
11557 @end smallexample
11558
11559 @item set print address off
11560 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
11561 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
11562
11563 @smallexample
11564 @group
11565 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
11566 (@value{GDBP}) f
11567 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
11568 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
11569 @end group
11570 @end smallexample
11571
11572 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
11573 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
11574 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
11575 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
11576
11577 @kindex show print
11578 @item show print address
11579 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
11580 @end table
11581
11582 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
11583 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
11584 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
11585 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
11586 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
11587 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
11588 it prints a symbolic address:
11589
11590 @table @code
11591 @item set print symbol-filename on
11592 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
11593 @cindex symbol, source file and line
11594 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
11595 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
11596
11597 @item set print symbol-filename off
11598 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
11599 default.
11600
11601 @item show print symbol-filename
11602 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
11603 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
11604 @end table
11605
11606 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
11607 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
11608 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
11609
11610 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
11611 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
11612
11613 @table @code
11614 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
11615 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
11616 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
11617 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
11618 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
11619 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
11620 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
11621 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
11622
11623 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
11624 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
11625 symbolic address.
11626 @end table
11627
11628 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
11629 @cindex pointer, finding referent
11630 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
11631 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
11632 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
11633 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
11634 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
11635 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
11636
11637 @smallexample
11638 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
11639 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
11640 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
11641 @end smallexample
11642
11643 @quotation
11644 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
11645 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
11646 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
11647 @end quotation
11648
11649 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
11650 @samp{set print symbol on}:
11651
11652 @anchor{set print symbol}
11653 @table @code
11654 @item set print symbol on
11655 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
11656 one exists.
11657
11658 @item set print symbol off
11659 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
11660 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
11661 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
11662
11663 @item show print symbol
11664 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
11665 address.
11666 @end table
11667
11668 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
11669
11670 @table @code
11671 @anchor{set print array}
11672 @item set print array
11673 @itemx set print array on
11674 @cindex pretty print arrays
11675 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
11676 but uses more space. The default is off.
11677
11678 @item set print array off
11679 Return to compressed format for arrays.
11680
11681 @item show print array
11682 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
11683 arrays.
11684
11685 @cindex print array indexes
11686 @anchor{set print array-indexes}
11687 @item set print array-indexes
11688 @itemx set print array-indexes on
11689 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
11690 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
11691 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
11692
11693 @item set print array-indexes off
11694 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
11695
11696 @item show print array-indexes
11697 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
11698 arrays.
11699
11700 @anchor{set print nibbles}
11701 @item set print nibbles
11702 @itemx set print nibbles on
11703 @cindex print binary values in groups of four bits
11704 Print binary values in groups of four bits, known as @dfn{nibbles},
11705 when using the print command of @value{GDBN} with the option @samp{/t}.
11706 For example, this is what it looks like with @code{set print nibbles on}:
11707
11708 @smallexample
11709 @group
11710 (@value{GDBP}) print val_flags
11711 $1 = 1230
11712 (@value{GDBP}) print/t val_flags
11713 $2 = 0100 1100 1110
11714 @end group
11715 @end smallexample
11716
11717 @item set print nibbles off
11718 Don't printing binary values in groups. This is the default.
11719
11720 @item show print nibbles
11721 Show whether to print binary values in groups of four bits.
11722
11723 @anchor{set print characters}
11724 @item set print characters @var{number-of-characters}
11725 @itemx set print characters elements
11726 @itemx set print characters unlimited
11727 @cindex number of string characters to print
11728 @cindex limit on number of printed string characters
11729 Set a limit on how many characters of a string @value{GDBN} will print.
11730 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large string, it stops printing after it
11731 has printed the number of characters set by the @code{set print
11732 characters} command. This equally applies to multi-byte and wide
11733 character strings, that is for strings whose character type is
11734 @code{wchar_t}, @code{char16_t}, or @code{char32_t} it is the number of
11735 actual characters rather than underlying bytes the encoding uses that
11736 this setting controls.
11737 Setting @var{number-of-characters} to @code{elements} means that the
11738 limit on the number of characters to print follows one for array
11739 elements; see @ref{set print elements}.
11740 Setting @var{number-of-characters} to @code{unlimited} means that the
11741 number of characters to print is unlimited.
11742 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to @code{elements}.
11743
11744 @item show print characters
11745 Display the number of characters of a large string that @value{GDBN}
11746 will print.
11747
11748 @anchor{set print elements}
11749 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
11750 @itemx set print elements unlimited
11751 @cindex number of array elements to print
11752 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
11753 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
11754 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
11755 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
11756 By default this limit also applies to the display of strings; see
11757 @ref{set print characters}.
11758 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
11759 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
11760 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
11761
11762 When printing very large arrays, whose size is greater than
11763 @code{max-value-size} (@pxref{set max-value-size,,max-value-size}),
11764 if the @code{print elements} is set such that the size of the elements
11765 being printed is less than or equal to @code{max-value-size}, then
11766 @value{GDBN} will print the array (up to the @code{print elements} limit),
11767 and only @code{max-value-size} worth of data will be added into the value
11768 history (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}).
11769
11770 @item show print elements
11771 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
11772
11773 @anchor{set print frame-arguments}
11774 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
11775 @kindex set print frame-arguments
11776 @cindex printing frame argument values
11777 @cindex print all frame argument values
11778 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
11779 @cindex do not print frame arguments
11780 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
11781 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
11782 values are:
11783
11784 @table @code
11785 @item all
11786 The values of all arguments are printed.
11787
11788 @item scalars
11789 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
11790 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
11791 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
11792 only scalar arguments are shown:
11793
11794 @smallexample
11795 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
11796 at frame-args.c:23
11797 @end smallexample
11798
11799 @item none
11800 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
11801 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
11802
11803 @smallexample
11804 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
11805 at frame-args.c:23
11806 @end smallexample
11807
11808 @item presence
11809 Only the presence of arguments is indicated by @code{@dots{}}.
11810 The @code{@dots{}} are not printed for function without any arguments.
11811 None of the argument names and values are printed.
11812 In this case, the example above now becomes:
11813
11814 @smallexample
11815 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (@dots{}) at frame-args.c:23
11816 @end smallexample
11817
11818 @end table
11819
11820 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
11821 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
11822 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
11823 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
11824 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
11825 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
11826 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
11827 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
11828 to @code{scalars} (the default), @code{none} or @code{presence} avoids
11829 this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
11830
11831 @item show print frame-arguments
11832 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
11833
11834 @anchor{set print raw-frame-arguments}
11835 @item set print raw-frame-arguments on
11836 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
11837
11838 @item set print raw-frame-arguments off
11839 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
11840 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
11841 otherwise print the value in raw form.
11842 This is the default.
11843
11844 @item show print raw-frame-arguments
11845 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
11846
11847 @anchor{set print entry-values}
11848 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
11849 @kindex set print entry-values
11850 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
11851 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
11852 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
11853 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
11854 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
11855
11856 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
11857 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
11858 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
11859 @code{no} setting.
11860
11861 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11862 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
11863 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11864 this information.
11865
11866 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
11867
11868 @table @code
11869 @item no
11870 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
11871 point.
11872 @smallexample
11873 #0 equal (val=5)
11874 #0 different (val=6)
11875 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
11876 #0 born (val=10)
11877 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11878 @end smallexample
11879
11880 @item only
11881 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
11882 values are never printed.
11883 @smallexample
11884 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
11885 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
11886 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11887 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11888 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11889 @end smallexample
11890
11891 @item preferred
11892 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
11893 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
11894 value for such parameter.
11895 @smallexample
11896 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
11897 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
11898 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11899 #0 born (val=10)
11900 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11901 @end smallexample
11902
11903 @item if-needed
11904 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
11905 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
11906 parameter.
11907 @smallexample
11908 #0 equal (val=5)
11909 #0 different (val=6)
11910 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11911 #0 born (val=10)
11912 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11913 @end smallexample
11914
11915 @item both
11916 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
11917 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
11918 optimizations.
11919 @smallexample
11920 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
11921 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11922 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
11923 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11924 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11925 @end smallexample
11926
11927 @item compact
11928 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
11929 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
11930 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
11931 values are known and identical, print the shortened
11932 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
11933 @smallexample
11934 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
11935 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11936 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11937 #0 born (val=10)
11938 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11939 @end smallexample
11940
11941 @item default
11942 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
11943 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
11944 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
11945 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
11946 @smallexample
11947 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
11948 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11949 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
11950 #0 born (val=10)
11951 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11952 @end smallexample
11953 @end table
11954
11955 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
11956 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
11957
11958 @item show print entry-values
11959 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
11960 entry.
11961
11962 @anchor{set print frame-info}
11963 @item set print frame-info @var{value}
11964 @kindex set print frame-info
11965 @cindex printing frame information
11966 @cindex frame information, printing
11967 This command allows to control the information printed when
11968 the debugger prints a frame. See @ref{Frames}, @ref{Backtrace},
11969 for a general explanation about frames and frame information.
11970 Note that some other settings (such as @code{set print frame-arguments}
11971 and @code{set print address}) are also influencing if and how some frame
11972 information is displayed. In particular, the frame program counter is never
11973 printed if @code{set print address} is off.
11974
11975 The possible values for @code{set print frame-info} are:
11976 @table @code
11977 @item short-location
11978 Print the frame level, the program counter (if not at the
11979 beginning of the location source line), the function, the function
11980 arguments.
11981 @item location
11982 Same as @code{short-location} but also print the source file and source line
11983 number.
11984 @item location-and-address
11985 Same as @code{location} but print the program counter even if located at the
11986 beginning of the location source line.
11987 @item source-line
11988 Print the program counter (if not at the beginning of the location
11989 source line), the line number and the source line.
11990 @item source-and-location
11991 Print what @code{location} and @code{source-line} are printing.
11992 @item auto
11993 The information printed for a frame is decided automatically
11994 by the @value{GDBN} command that prints a frame.
11995 For example, @code{frame} prints the information printed by
11996 @code{source-and-location} while @code{stepi} will switch between
11997 @code{source-line} and @code{source-and-location} depending on the program
11998 counter.
11999 The default value is @code{auto}.
12000 @end table
12001
12002 @anchor{set print repeats}
12003 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
12004 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
12005 @cindex repeated array elements
12006 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
12007 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
12008 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
12009 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
12010 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
12011 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
12012 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
12013 is 10.
12014
12015 @item show print repeats
12016 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
12017 elements.
12018
12019 @anchor{set print max-depth}
12020 @item set print max-depth @var{depth}
12021 @item set print max-depth unlimited
12022 @cindex printing nested structures
12023 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
12024 ellipsis, this can make visualising deeply nested structures easier.
12025
12026 For example, given this C code
12027
12028 @smallexample
12029 typedef struct s1 @{ int a; @} s1;
12030 typedef struct s2 @{ s1 b; @} s2;
12031 typedef struct s3 @{ s2 c; @} s3;
12032 typedef struct s4 @{ s3 d; @} s4;
12033
12034 s4 var = @{ @{ @{ @{ 3 @} @} @} @};
12035 @end smallexample
12036
12037 The following table shows how different values of @var{depth} will
12038 effect how @code{var} is printed by @value{GDBN}:
12039
12040 @multitable @columnfractions .3 .7
12041 @headitem @var{depth} setting @tab Result of @samp{p var}
12042 @item unlimited
12043 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
12044 @item @code{0}
12045 @tab @code{$1 = @{...@}}
12046 @item @code{1}
12047 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{...@}@}}
12048 @item @code{2}
12049 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}}
12050 @item @code{3}
12051 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}@}}
12052 @item @code{4}
12053 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
12054 @end multitable
12055
12056 To see the contents of structures that have been hidden the user can
12057 either increase the print max-depth, or they can print the elements of
12058 the structure that are visible, for example
12059
12060 @smallexample
12061 (@value{GDBP}) set print max-depth 2
12062 (@value{GDBP}) p var
12063 $1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}
12064 (@value{GDBP}) p var.d
12065 $2 = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}
12066 (@value{GDBP}) p var.d.c
12067 $3 = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}
12068 @end smallexample
12069
12070 The pattern used to replace nested structures varies based on
12071 language, for most languages @code{@{...@}} is used, but Fortran uses
12072 @code{(...)}.
12073
12074 @item show print max-depth
12075 Display the current threshold after which nested structures are
12076 replaces with ellipsis.
12077
12078 @anchor{set print memory-tag-violations}
12079 @cindex printing memory tag violation information
12080 @item set print memory-tag-violations
12081 @itemx set print memory-tag-violations on
12082 Cause @value{GDBN} to display additional information about memory tag violations
12083 when printing pointers and addresses.
12084
12085 @item set print memory-tag-violations off
12086 Stop printing memory tag violation information.
12087
12088 @item show print memory-tag-violations
12089 Show whether memory tag violation information is displayed when printing
12090 pointers and addresses.
12091
12092 @anchor{set print null-stop}
12093 @item set print null-stop
12094 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
12095 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
12096 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
12097 contain only short strings.
12098 The default is off.
12099
12100 @item show print null-stop
12101 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
12102 @sc{null} character.
12103
12104 @anchor{set print pretty}
12105 @item set print pretty on
12106 @cindex print structures in indented form
12107 @cindex indentation in structure display
12108 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
12109 per line, like this:
12110
12111 @smallexample
12112 @group
12113 $1 = @{
12114 next = 0x0,
12115 flags = @{
12116 sweet = 1,
12117 sour = 1
12118 @},
12119 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
12120 @}
12121 @end group
12122 @end smallexample
12123
12124 @item set print pretty off
12125 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
12126
12127 @smallexample
12128 @group
12129 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
12130 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
12131 @end group
12132 @end smallexample
12133
12134 @noindent
12135 This is the default format.
12136
12137 @item show print pretty
12138 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
12139
12140 @anchor{set print raw-values}
12141 @item set print raw-values on
12142 Print values in raw form, without applying the pretty
12143 printers for the value.
12144
12145 @item set print raw-values off
12146 Print values in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
12147 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
12148 otherwise print the value in raw form.
12149
12150 The default setting is ``off''.
12151
12152 @item show print raw-values
12153 Show whether to print values in raw form.
12154
12155 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
12156 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
12157 @cindex octal escapes in strings
12158 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
12159 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
12160 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
12161 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
12162 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
12163
12164 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
12165 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
12166 international character sets, and is the default.
12167
12168 @item show print sevenbit-strings
12169 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
12170
12171 @anchor{set print union}
12172 @item set print union on
12173 @cindex unions in structures, printing
12174 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
12175 and other unions. This is the default setting.
12176
12177 @item set print union off
12178 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
12179 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
12180 instead.
12181
12182 @item show print union
12183 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
12184 structures and other unions.
12185
12186 For example, given the declarations
12187
12188 @smallexample
12189 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
12190 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
12191 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
12192 Bug_forms;
12193
12194 struct thing @{
12195 Species it;
12196 union @{
12197 Tree_forms tree;
12198 Bug_forms bug;
12199 @} form;
12200 @};
12201
12202 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
12203 @end smallexample
12204
12205 @noindent
12206 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
12207
12208 @smallexample
12209 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
12210 @end smallexample
12211
12212 @noindent
12213 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
12214
12215 @smallexample
12216 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
12217 @end smallexample
12218
12219 @noindent
12220 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
12221 and in Pascal.
12222 @end table
12223
12224 @need 1000
12225 @noindent
12226 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
12227
12228 @table @code
12229 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
12230 @item set print demangle
12231 @itemx set print demangle on
12232 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
12233 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
12234 linkage. The default is on.
12235
12236 @item show print demangle
12237 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
12238
12239 @item set print asm-demangle
12240 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
12241 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
12242 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
12243 The default is off.
12244
12245 @item show print asm-demangle
12246 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
12247 or demangled form.
12248
12249 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
12250 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
12251 @kindex set demangle-style
12252 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
12253 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to represent
12254 C@t{++} names. If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible
12255 formats. The default value is @var{auto}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a
12256 decoding style by inspecting your program.
12257
12258 @item show demangle-style
12259 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
12260
12261 @anchor{set print object}
12262 @item set print object
12263 @itemx set print object on
12264 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
12265 @cindex display derived types
12266 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
12267 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
12268 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
12269 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
12270 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
12271 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
12272 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
12273
12274 @item set print object off
12275 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
12276 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
12277
12278 @item show print object
12279 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
12280
12281 @anchor{set print static-members}
12282 @item set print static-members
12283 @itemx set print static-members on
12284 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
12285 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
12286
12287 @item set print static-members off
12288 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
12289
12290 @item show print static-members
12291 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
12292
12293 @item set print pascal_static-members
12294 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
12295 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
12296 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
12297 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
12298
12299 @item set print pascal_static-members off
12300 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
12301
12302 @item show print pascal_static-members
12303 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
12304
12305 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
12306 @anchor{set print vtbl}
12307 @item set print vtbl
12308 @itemx set print vtbl on
12309 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
12310 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
12311 @cindex VTBL display
12312 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
12313 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
12314 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
12315
12316 @item set print vtbl off
12317 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
12318
12319 @item show print vtbl
12320 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
12321 @end table
12322
12323 @node Pretty Printing
12324 @section Pretty Printing
12325
12326 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
12327 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
12328 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
12329
12330 @menu
12331 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
12332 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
12333 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
12334 @end menu
12335
12336 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
12337 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
12338
12339 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
12340 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
12341 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
12342
12343 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
12344 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
12345 pretty-printers with their names.
12346 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
12347 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
12348 Each such subprinter has its own name.
12349 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
12350
12351 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
12352 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
12353 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
12354 do anything special.
12355
12356 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
12357
12358 @itemize @bullet
12359 @item
12360 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
12361 all inferiors.
12362
12363 @item
12364 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
12365 when debugging that program.
12366 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
12367
12368 @item
12369 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
12370 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
12371 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
12372 @end itemize
12373
12374 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
12375 pretty-printers are selected,
12376
12377 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
12378 for new types.
12379
12380 @node Pretty-Printer Example
12381 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
12382
12383 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
12384
12385 @smallexample
12386 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12387 $1 = @{
12388 static npos = 4294967295,
12389 _M_dataplus = @{
12390 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
12391 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
12392 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
12393 @},
12394 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
12395 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
12396 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
12397 @}
12398 @}
12399 @end smallexample
12400
12401 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
12402
12403 @smallexample
12404 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12405 $2 = "abcd"
12406 @end smallexample
12407
12408 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
12409 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
12410 @cindex pretty-printer commands
12411
12412 @table @code
12413 @kindex info pretty-printer
12414 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
12415 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
12416 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
12417
12418 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
12419 whose pretty-printers to list.
12420 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
12421 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
12422 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
12423 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
12424 looks up a printer from these three objects.
12425
12426 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
12427 to list.
12428
12429 @kindex disable pretty-printer
12430 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
12431 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
12432 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
12433
12434 @kindex enable pretty-printer
12435 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
12436 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
12437 @end table
12438
12439 Example:
12440
12441 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
12442 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
12443 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
12444 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
12445
12446 @smallexample
12447 @group
12448 (@value{GDBP}) info pretty-printer
12449 library1.so:
12450 foo
12451 library2.so:
12452 bar
12453 bar1
12454 bar2
12455 @end group
12456 @group
12457 (@value{GDBP}) info pretty-printer library2
12458 library2.so:
12459 bar
12460 bar1
12461 bar2
12462 @end group
12463 @group
12464 (@value{GDBP}) disable pretty-printer library1
12465 1 printer disabled
12466 2 of 3 printers enabled
12467 (@value{GDBP}) info pretty-printer
12468 library1.so:
12469 foo [disabled]
12470 library2.so:
12471 bar
12472 bar1
12473 bar2
12474 @end group
12475 @group
12476 (@value{GDBP}) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
12477 1 printer disabled
12478 1 of 3 printers enabled
12479 (@value{GDBP}) info pretty-printer library2
12480 library2.so:
12481 bar
12482 bar1 [disabled]
12483 bar2
12484 @end group
12485 @group
12486 (@value{GDBP}) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
12487 1 printer disabled
12488 0 of 3 printers enabled
12489 (@value{GDBP}) info pretty-printer
12490 library1.so:
12491 foo [disabled]
12492 library2.so:
12493 bar [disabled]
12494 bar1 [disabled]
12495 bar2
12496 @end group
12497 @end smallexample
12498
12499 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
12500 as can each individual subprinter.
12501
12502 Printing values and frame arguments is done by default using
12503 the enabled pretty printers.
12504
12505 The print option @code{-raw-values} and @value{GDBN} setting
12506 @code{set print raw-values} (@pxref{set print raw-values}) can be
12507 used to print values without applying the enabled pretty printers.
12508
12509 Similarly, the backtrace option @code{-raw-frame-arguments} and
12510 @value{GDBN} setting @code{set print raw-frame-arguments}
12511 (@pxref{set print raw-frame-arguments}) can be used to ignore the
12512 enabled pretty printers when printing frame argument values.
12513
12514 @node Value History
12515 @section Value History
12516
12517 @cindex value history
12518 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
12519 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
12520 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
12521 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
12522 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
12523 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
12524 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
12525 symbol table.
12526
12527 @cindex @code{$}
12528 @cindex @code{$$}
12529 @cindex history number
12530 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
12531 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
12532 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
12533 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
12534 history number.
12535
12536 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
12537 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
12538 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
12539 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
12540 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
12541 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
12542 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
12543
12544 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
12545 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
12546
12547 @smallexample
12548 p *$
12549 @end smallexample
12550
12551 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
12552 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
12553
12554 @smallexample
12555 p *$.next
12556 @end smallexample
12557
12558 @noindent
12559 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
12560 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
12561
12562 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
12563 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
12564
12565 @smallexample
12566 print x
12567 set x=5
12568 @end smallexample
12569
12570 @noindent
12571 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
12572 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
12573
12574 @table @code
12575 @kindex show values
12576 @item show values
12577 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
12578 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
12579 values} does not change the history.
12580
12581 @item show values @var{n}
12582 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
12583
12584 @item show values +
12585 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
12586 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
12587 @end table
12588
12589 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
12590 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
12591
12592 @node Convenience Vars
12593 @section Convenience Variables
12594
12595 @cindex convenience variables
12596 @cindex user-defined variables
12597 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
12598 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
12599 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
12600 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
12601 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
12602
12603 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
12604 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
12605 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
12606 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
12607 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
12608
12609 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
12610 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
12611 For example:
12612
12613 @smallexample
12614 set $foo = *object_ptr
12615 @end smallexample
12616
12617 @noindent
12618 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
12619 @code{object_ptr}.
12620
12621 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
12622 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
12623 value with another assignment at any time.
12624
12625 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
12626 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
12627 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
12628 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
12629
12630 @table @code
12631 @kindex show convenience
12632 @cindex show all user variables and functions
12633 @item show convenience
12634 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
12635 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
12636 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
12637
12638 @kindex init-if-undefined
12639 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
12640 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
12641 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
12642 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
12643 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
12644 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
12645 override default values used in a command script.
12646
12647 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
12648 any side-effects do not occur.
12649 @end table
12650
12651 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
12652 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
12653 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
12654
12655 @smallexample
12656 set $i = 0
12657 print bar[$i++]->contents
12658 @end smallexample
12659
12660 @noindent
12661 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
12662
12663 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
12664 values likely to be useful.
12665
12666 @table @code
12667 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
12668 @item $_
12669 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
12670 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
12671 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
12672 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
12673 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
12674 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
12675 to the type of @code{$__}.
12676
12677 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
12678 @item $__
12679 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
12680 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
12681 to match the format in which the data was printed.
12682
12683 @item $_exitcode
12684 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
12685 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
12686 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
12687 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
12688
12689 @item $_exitsignal
12690 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
12691 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
12692 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
12693 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
12694
12695 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
12696 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
12697 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
12698 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
12699 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
12700
12701 @smallexample
12702 #include <signal.h>
12703
12704 int
12705 main (int argc, char *argv[])
12706 @{
12707 raise (SIGALRM);
12708 return 0;
12709 @}
12710 @end smallexample
12711
12712 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
12713 or signalled would be:
12714
12715 @smallexample
12716 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
12717 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
12718 End with a line saying just ``end''.
12719 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
12720 >echo The program has exited\n
12721 >else
12722 >echo The program has signalled\n
12723 >end
12724 >end
12725 (@value{GDBP}) run
12726 Starting program:
12727
12728 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
12729 The program no longer exists.
12730 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
12731 The program has signalled
12732 @end smallexample
12733
12734 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
12735 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
12736 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
12737 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
12738
12739 @smallexample
12740 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
12741 The program has exited
12742 @end smallexample
12743
12744 @item $_exception
12745 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
12746 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
12747
12748 @item $_ada_exception
12749 The variable @code{$_ada_exception} is set to the address of the
12750 exception being caught or thrown at an Ada exception-related
12751 catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
12752
12753 @item $_probe_argc
12754 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
12755 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12756
12757 @item $_sdata
12758 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
12759 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
12760 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
12761 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
12762 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
12763
12764 @item $_siginfo
12765 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
12766 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
12767 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
12768 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
12769 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
12770
12771 @item $_tlb
12772 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
12773 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
12774 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
12775 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
12776 @xref{General Query Packets}.
12777 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
12778
12779 @item $_inferior
12780 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors Connections and
12781 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors Connections and Programs}.
12782
12783 @item $_thread
12784 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
12785
12786 @item $_gthread
12787 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
12788
12789 @item $_inferior_thread_count
12790 The number of live threads in the current inferior. @xref{Threads}.
12791
12792 @item $_gdb_major
12793 @itemx $_gdb_minor
12794 @vindex $_gdb_major@r{, convenience variable}
12795 @vindex $_gdb_minor@r{, convenience variable}
12796 The major and minor version numbers of the running @value{GDBN}.
12797 Development snapshots and pretest versions have their minor version
12798 incremented by one; thus, @value{GDBN} pretest 9.11.90 will produce
12799 the value 12 for @code{$_gdb_minor}. These variables allow you to
12800 write scripts that work with different versions of @value{GDBN}
12801 without errors caused by features unavailable in some of those
12802 versions.
12803
12804 @item $_shell_exitcode
12805 @itemx $_shell_exitsignal
12806 @vindex $_shell_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
12807 @vindex $_shell_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
12808 @cindex shell command, exit code
12809 @cindex shell command, exit signal
12810 @cindex exit status of shell commands
12811 @value{GDBN} commands such as @code{shell} and @code{|} are launching
12812 shell commands. When a launched command terminates, @value{GDBN}
12813 automatically maintains the variables @code{$_shell_exitcode}
12814 and @code{$_shell_exitsignal} according to the exit status of the last
12815 launched command. These variables are set and used similarly to
12816 the variables @code{$_exitcode} and @code{$_exitsignal}.
12817
12818 @end table
12819
12820 @node Convenience Funs
12821 @section Convenience Functions
12822
12823 @cindex convenience functions
12824 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
12825 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
12826 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
12827 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
12828 @value{GDBN}.
12829
12830 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
12831 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
12832
12833 @table @code
12834
12835 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
12836 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
12837 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
12838 returns zero.
12839
12840 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
12841 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
12842 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
12843 it is @code{void}:
12844
12845 @smallexample
12846 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
12847 $1 = void
12848 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
12849 $2 = 1
12850 (@value{GDBP}) run
12851 Starting program: ./a.out
12852 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
12853 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
12854 $3 = 0
12855 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
12856 $4 = 0
12857 @end smallexample
12858
12859 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
12860 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
12861 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
12862 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
12863 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
12864 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
12865 anymore.
12866
12867 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
12868 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
12869
12870 @smallexample
12871 void
12872 foo (void)
12873 @{
12874 @}
12875 @end smallexample
12876
12877 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
12878
12879 @smallexample
12880 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
12881 $1 = void
12882 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
12883 $2 = 1
12884 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
12885 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
12886 $3 = void
12887 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
12888 $4 = 1
12889 @end smallexample
12890
12891 @item $_gdb_setting_str (@var{setting})
12892 @findex $_gdb_setting_str@r{, convenience function}
12893 Return the value of the @value{GDBN} @var{setting} as a string.
12894 @var{setting} is any setting that can be used in a @code{set} or
12895 @code{show} command (@pxref{Controlling GDB}).
12896
12897 @smallexample
12898 (@value{GDBP}) show print frame-arguments
12899 Printing of non-scalar frame arguments is "scalars".
12900 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("print frame-arguments")
12901 $1 = "scalars"
12902 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("height")
12903 $2 = "30"
12904 (@value{GDBP})
12905 @end smallexample
12906
12907 @item $_gdb_setting (@var{setting})
12908 @findex $_gdb_setting@r{, convenience function}
12909 Return the value of the @value{GDBN} @var{setting}.
12910 The type of the returned value depends on the setting.
12911
12912 The value type for boolean and auto boolean settings is @code{int}.
12913 The boolean values @code{off} and @code{on} are converted to
12914 the integer values @code{0} and @code{1}. The value @code{auto} is
12915 converted to the value @code{-1}.
12916
12917 The value type for integer settings is either @code{unsigned int}
12918 or @code{int}, depending on the setting.
12919
12920 Some integer settings accept an @code{unlimited} value.
12921 Depending on the setting, the @code{set} command also accepts
12922 the value @code{0} or the value @code{@minus{}1} as a synonym for
12923 @code{unlimited}.
12924 For example, @code{set height unlimited} is equivalent to
12925 @code{set height 0}.
12926
12927 Some other settings that accept the @code{unlimited} value
12928 use the value @code{0} to literally mean zero.
12929 For example, @code{set history size 0} indicates to not
12930 record any @value{GDBN} commands in the command history.
12931 For such settings, @code{@minus{}1} is the synonym
12932 for @code{unlimited}.
12933
12934 See the documentation of the corresponding @code{set} command for
12935 the numerical value equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
12936
12937 The @code{$_gdb_setting} function converts the unlimited value
12938 to a @code{0} or a @code{@minus{}1} value according to what the
12939 @code{set} command uses.
12940
12941 @smallexample
12942 @group
12943 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("height")
12944 $1 = "30"
12945 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting("height")
12946 $2 = 30
12947 (@value{GDBP}) set height unlimited
12948 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("height")
12949 $3 = "unlimited"
12950 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting("height")
12951 $4 = 0
12952 @end group
12953 @group
12954 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("history size")
12955 $5 = "unlimited"
12956 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting("history size")
12957 $6 = -1
12958 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting_str("disassemble-next-line")
12959 $7 = "auto"
12960 (@value{GDBP}) p $_gdb_setting("disassemble-next-line")
12961 $8 = -1
12962 (@value{GDBP})
12963 @end group
12964 @end smallexample
12965
12966 Other setting types (enum, filename, optional filename, string, string noescape)
12967 are returned as string values.
12968
12969
12970 @item $_gdb_maint_setting_str (@var{setting})
12971 @findex $_gdb_maint_setting_str@r{, convenience function}
12972 Like the @code{$_gdb_setting_str} function, but works with
12973 @code{maintenance set} variables.
12974
12975 @item $_gdb_maint_setting (@var{setting})
12976 @findex $_gdb_maint_setting@r{, convenience function}
12977 Like the @code{$_gdb_setting} function, but works with
12978 @code{maintenance set} variables.
12979
12980 @end table
12981
12982 The following functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
12983 @code{Python} support.
12984
12985 @table @code
12986
12987 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
12988 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
12989 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
12990 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
12991 Otherwise it returns zero.
12992
12993 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
12994 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
12995 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
12996 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
12997 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
12998 regular expression support.
12999
13000 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
13001 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
13002 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
13003 Otherwise it returns zero.
13004
13005 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
13006 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
13007 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
13008
13009 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
13010 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
13011 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
13012 Otherwise it returns zero.
13013
13014 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
13015 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
13016 The default is 1.
13017
13018 Example:
13019
13020 @smallexample
13021 (@value{GDBP}) backtrace
13022 #0 bottom_func ()
13023 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
13024 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
13025 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
13026 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
13027 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
13028 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
13029 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
13030 (@value{GDBP}) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
13031 $1 = 1
13032 (@value{GDBP}) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
13033 $1 = 1
13034 @end smallexample
13035
13036 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
13037 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
13038 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
13039 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
13040
13041 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
13042 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
13043 The default is 1.
13044
13045 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
13046 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
13047 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
13048 Otherwise it returns zero.
13049
13050 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
13051 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
13052 The default is 1.
13053
13054 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
13055 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
13056 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
13057 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
13058
13059 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
13060 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
13061 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
13062 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
13063
13064 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
13065 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
13066 The default is 1.
13067
13068 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
13069 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
13070 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
13071 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
13072
13073 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
13074 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
13075 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
13076
13077 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
13078 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
13079 an enumerated type:
13080
13081 @smallexample
13082 (@value{GDBP}) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
13083 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
13084 @end smallexample
13085
13086 @item $_cimag(@var{value})
13087 @itemx $_creal(@var{value})
13088 @findex $_cimag@r{, convenience function}
13089 @findex $_creal@r{, convenience function}
13090 Return the imaginary (@code{$_cimag}) or real (@code{$_creal}) part of
13091 the complex number @var{value}.
13092
13093 The type of the imaginary or real part depends on the type of the
13094 complex number, e.g., using @code{$_cimag} on a @code{float complex}
13095 will return an imaginary part of type @code{float}.
13096
13097 @end table
13098
13099 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
13100 convenience functions.
13101
13102 @table @code
13103 @item help function
13104 @kindex help function
13105 @cindex show all convenience functions
13106 Print a list of all convenience functions.
13107 @end table
13108
13109 @node Registers
13110 @section Registers
13111
13112 @cindex registers
13113 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
13114 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
13115 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
13116 your machine.
13117
13118 @table @code
13119 @kindex info registers
13120 @item info registers
13121 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
13122 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
13123
13124 @kindex info all-registers
13125 @cindex floating point registers
13126 @item info all-registers
13127 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
13128 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
13129
13130 @anchor{info_registers_reggroup}
13131 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
13132 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
13133 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggroup} can be any of those returned by
13134 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
13135
13136 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
13137 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
13138 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
13139 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
13140 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
13141 @end table
13142
13143 @anchor{standard registers}
13144 @cindex stack pointer register
13145 @cindex program counter register
13146 @cindex process status register
13147 @cindex frame pointer register
13148 @cindex standard registers
13149 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
13150 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
13151 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
13152 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
13153 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
13154 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
13155 register that contains the processor status. For example,
13156 you could print the program counter in hex with
13157
13158 @smallexample
13159 p/x $pc
13160 @end smallexample
13161
13162 @noindent
13163 or print the instruction to be executed next with
13164
13165 @smallexample
13166 x/i $pc
13167 @end smallexample
13168
13169 @noindent
13170 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
13171 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
13172 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
13173 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
13174 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
13175 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
13176 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
13177
13178 @smallexample
13179 set $sp += 4
13180 @end smallexample
13181
13182 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
13183 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
13184 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
13185 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
13186 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
13187 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
13188 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
13189
13190 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
13191 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
13192 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
13193 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
13194 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
13195 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
13196 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
13197
13198 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
13199 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
13200 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
13201 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
13202 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
13203 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
13204 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
13205 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
13206 prints the data in both formats.
13207
13208 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
13209 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
13210 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
13211 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
13212 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
13213 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
13214 registers in @code{struct} notation:
13215
13216 @smallexample
13217 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
13218 $1 = @{
13219 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
13220 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
13221 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
13222 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
13223 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
13224 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
13225 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
13226 @}
13227 @end smallexample
13228
13229 @noindent
13230 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
13231 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
13232 value to a @code{struct} member:
13233
13234 @smallexample
13235 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
13236 @end smallexample
13237
13238 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
13239 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
13240 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
13241 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
13242 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
13243 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
13244
13245 @cindex caller-saved registers
13246 @cindex call-clobbered registers
13247 @cindex volatile registers
13248 @cindex <not saved> values
13249 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
13250 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
13251 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
13252 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
13253 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
13254 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
13255 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
13256 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
13257 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
13258 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
13259 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
13260 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
13261 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
13262 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
13263 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
13264 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
13265 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
13266 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
13267 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
13268 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
13269 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
13270 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
13271 represent the value the register had just before the call.
13272
13273 @node Floating Point Hardware
13274 @section Floating Point Hardware
13275 @cindex floating point
13276
13277 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
13278 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
13279
13280 @table @code
13281 @kindex info float
13282 @item info float
13283 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
13284 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
13285 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
13286 the ARM and x86 machines.
13287 @end table
13288
13289 @node Vector Unit
13290 @section Vector Unit
13291 @cindex vector unit
13292
13293 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
13294 more information about the status of the vector unit.
13295
13296 @table @code
13297 @kindex info vector
13298 @item info vector
13299 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
13300 layout vary depending on the hardware.
13301 @end table
13302
13303 @node OS Information
13304 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
13305 @cindex OS information
13306
13307 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
13308 you debug your program.
13309
13310 @cindex auxiliary vector
13311 @cindex vector, auxiliary
13312 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
13313 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
13314 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
13315 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
13316 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
13317 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
13318 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
13319 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
13320 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
13321 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
13322 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
13323
13324 @table @code
13325 @kindex info auxv
13326 @item info auxv
13327 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
13328 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
13329 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
13330 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
13331 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
13332 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
13333 an unrecognized tag.
13334 @end table
13335
13336 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
13337 information and show it to you. The types of information available
13338 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
13339 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
13340 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
13341 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
13342 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
13343
13344 @table @code
13345 @kindex info os
13346 @item info os @var{infotype}
13347
13348 Display OS information of the requested type.
13349
13350 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
13351
13352 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
13353 @table @code
13354 @kindex info os cpus
13355 @item cpus
13356 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
13357 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
13358 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
13359 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
13360 kernel initialization.
13361
13362 @kindex info os files
13363 @item files
13364 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
13365 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
13366 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
13367 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
13368
13369 @kindex info os modules
13370 @item modules
13371 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
13372 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
13373 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
13374 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
13375 in memory.
13376
13377 @kindex info os msg
13378 @item msg
13379 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
13380 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
13381 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
13382 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
13383 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
13384 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
13385 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
13386 the message queue was last changed.
13387
13388 @kindex info os processes
13389 @item processes
13390 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
13391 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
13392 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
13393 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
13394 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
13395 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
13396
13397 @kindex info os procgroups
13398 @item procgroups
13399 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
13400 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
13401 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
13402 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
13403 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
13404 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
13405 and the process group leader is listed first.
13406
13407 @kindex info os semaphores
13408 @item semaphores
13409 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
13410 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
13411 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
13412 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
13413 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
13414
13415 @kindex info os shm
13416 @item shm
13417 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
13418 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
13419 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
13420 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
13421 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
13422 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
13423 attached to, detach from, and changed.
13424
13425 @kindex info os sockets
13426 @item sockets
13427 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
13428 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
13429 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
13430 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
13431 connection.
13432
13433 @kindex info os threads
13434 @item threads
13435 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
13436 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
13437 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
13438 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
13439 process is not listed.
13440 @end table
13441
13442 @item info os
13443 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
13444 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
13445 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
13446 types, this command will report an error.
13447 @end table
13448
13449 @node Memory Region Attributes
13450 @section Memory Region Attributes
13451 @cindex memory region attributes
13452
13453 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
13454 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
13455 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
13456 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
13457 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
13458 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
13459 user can override the fetched regions.
13460
13461 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
13462 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
13463 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
13464 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
13465 all memory.
13466
13467 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
13468 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
13469
13470 @table @code
13471 @kindex mem
13472 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
13473 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
13474 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
13475 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
13476 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
13477 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
13478
13479 @item mem auto
13480 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
13481 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
13482
13483 @kindex delete mem
13484 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
13485 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
13486 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
13487
13488 @kindex disable mem
13489 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
13490 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
13491 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
13492 It may be enabled again later.
13493
13494 @kindex enable mem
13495 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
13496 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
13497
13498 @kindex info mem
13499 @item info mem
13500 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
13501 for each region:
13502
13503 @table @emph
13504 @item Memory Region Number
13505 @item Enabled or Disabled.
13506 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
13507 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
13508
13509 @item Lo Address
13510 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
13511
13512 @item Hi Address
13513 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
13514
13515 @item Attributes
13516 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
13517 @end table
13518 @end table
13519
13520
13521 @subsection Attributes
13522
13523 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
13524 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
13525 write accesses to a memory region.
13526
13527 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
13528 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
13529 etc.@: from accessing memory.
13530
13531 @table @code
13532 @item ro
13533 Memory is read only.
13534 @item wo
13535 Memory is write only.
13536 @item rw
13537 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
13538 @end table
13539
13540 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
13541 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
13542 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
13543 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
13544 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
13545
13546 @table @code
13547 @item 8
13548 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
13549 @item 16
13550 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
13551 @item 32
13552 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
13553 @item 64
13554 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
13555 @end table
13556
13557 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
13558 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
13559 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
13560 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
13561 @c
13562 @c @table @code
13563 @c @item hwbreak
13564 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
13565 @c @item swbreak (default)
13566 @c @end table
13567
13568 @subsubsection Data Cache
13569 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
13570 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
13571 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
13572 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
13573 registers.
13574
13575 @table @code
13576 @item cache
13577 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
13578 @item nocache
13579 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
13580 @end table
13581
13582 @subsection Memory Access Checking
13583 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
13584 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
13585 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
13586 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
13587
13588 @table @code
13589 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
13590 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
13591 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
13592 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
13593 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
13594 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
13595 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
13596 The default value is @code{on}.
13597 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
13598 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
13599 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
13600 @end table
13601
13602
13603 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
13604 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
13605 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
13606 @c
13607 @c @table @code
13608 @c @item verify
13609 @c @item noverify (default)
13610 @c @end table
13611
13612 @node Dump/Restore Files
13613 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
13614 @cindex dump/restore files
13615 @cindex append data to a file
13616 @cindex dump data to a file
13617 @cindex restore data from a file
13618
13619 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
13620 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
13621 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
13622 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
13623 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
13624 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
13625 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
13626
13627 @table @code
13628
13629 @kindex dump
13630 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
13631 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
13632 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
13633 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
13634
13635 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
13636 @table @code
13637 @item binary
13638 Raw binary form.
13639 @item ihex
13640 Intel hex format.
13641 @item srec
13642 Motorola S-record format.
13643 @item tekhex
13644 Tektronix Hex format.
13645 @item verilog
13646 Verilog Hex format.
13647 @end table
13648
13649 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
13650 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
13651 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
13652 form.
13653
13654 @kindex append
13655 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
13656 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
13657 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
13658 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
13659 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
13660
13661 @kindex restore
13662 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
13663 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
13664 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
13665 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
13666 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
13667
13668 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
13669 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
13670 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
13671 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
13672 from that location.
13673
13674 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
13675 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
13676 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
13677 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
13678
13679 @end table
13680
13681 @node Core File Generation
13682 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
13683 @cindex dump core from inferior
13684
13685 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
13686 image of a running process and its process status (register values
13687 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
13688 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
13689 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
13690 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
13691 the post-mortem debugging mode.
13692
13693 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
13694 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
13695 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
13696
13697 @table @code
13698 @kindex gcore
13699 @kindex generate-core-file
13700 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
13701 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
13702 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
13703 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
13704 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
13705 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
13706
13707 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
13708 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
13709
13710 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
13711 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
13712 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
13713 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
13714 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
13715
13716 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
13717 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
13718 @item set use-coredump-filter on
13719 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
13720 Enable or disable the use of the file
13721 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
13722 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
13723 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
13724 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
13725
13726 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
13727 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
13728 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
13729 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
13730 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
13731 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
13732 about the bits that can be set in the
13733 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
13734 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
13735
13736 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
13737 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
13738 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
13739 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
13740 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
13741 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
13742 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
13743 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
13744
13745 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
13746 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
13747 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
13748 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
13749 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
13750 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
13751 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
13752
13753 The default value is @code{off}.
13754 @end table
13755
13756 @node Character Sets
13757 @section Character Sets
13758 @cindex character sets
13759 @cindex charset
13760 @cindex translating between character sets
13761 @cindex host character set
13762 @cindex target character set
13763
13764 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
13765 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
13766 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
13767 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
13768 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
13769 @dfn{target character set}.
13770
13771 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
13772 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
13773 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
13774 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
13775 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
13776 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
13777 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
13778 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
13779 character and string literals in expressions.
13780
13781 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
13782 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
13783 target-charset} command, described below.
13784
13785 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
13786 support:
13787
13788 @table @code
13789 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
13790 @kindex set target-charset
13791 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
13792 list of supported target character sets, type
13793 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
13794
13795 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
13796 @kindex set host-charset
13797 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
13798
13799 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
13800 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
13801 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
13802 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
13803 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
13804
13805 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
13806 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
13807 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
13808
13809 @item set charset @var{charset}
13810 @kindex set charset
13811 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
13812 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
13813 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
13814 for both host and target.
13815
13816 @item show charset
13817 @kindex show charset
13818 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
13819
13820 @item show host-charset
13821 @kindex show host-charset
13822 Show the name of the current host character set.
13823
13824 @item show target-charset
13825 @kindex show target-charset
13826 Show the name of the current target character set.
13827
13828 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
13829 @kindex set target-wide-charset
13830 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
13831 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
13832 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
13833 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
13834
13835 @item show target-wide-charset
13836 @kindex show target-wide-charset
13837 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
13838 @end table
13839
13840 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
13841 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
13842 @file{charset-test.c}:
13843
13844 @smallexample
13845 #include <stdio.h>
13846
13847 char ascii_hello[]
13848 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
13849 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
13850 char ibm1047_hello[]
13851 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
13852 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
13853
13854 main ()
13855 @{
13856 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13857 @}
13858 @end smallexample
13859
13860 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
13861 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
13862 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
13863
13864 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
13865
13866 @smallexample
13867 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
13868 $ gdb -nw charset-test
13869 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
13870 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13871 @dots{}
13872 (@value{GDBP})
13873 @end smallexample
13874
13875 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
13876 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
13877 strings:
13878
13879 @smallexample
13880 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
13881 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
13882 (@value{GDBP})
13883 @end smallexample
13884
13885 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
13886 initial character set:
13887 @smallexample
13888 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
13889 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
13890 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
13891 (@value{GDBP})
13892 @end smallexample
13893
13894 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
13895 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
13896 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
13897 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
13898 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
13899
13900 @smallexample
13901 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
13902 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
13903 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
13904 $2 = 72 'H'
13905 (@value{GDBP})
13906 @end smallexample
13907
13908 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
13909 literals you use in expressions:
13910
13911 @smallexample
13912 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
13913 $3 = 43 '+'
13914 (@value{GDBP})
13915 @end smallexample
13916
13917 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
13918 character.
13919
13920 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
13921 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
13922 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
13923
13924 @smallexample
13925 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
13926 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
13927 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
13928 $5 = 200 '\310'
13929 (@value{GDBP})
13930 @end smallexample
13931
13932 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
13933 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
13934
13935 @smallexample
13936 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
13937 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
13938 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
13939 @end smallexample
13940
13941 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
13942 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
13943 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
13944 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
13945 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
13946
13947 @smallexample
13948 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
13949 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
13950 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
13951 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
13952 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
13953 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
13954 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
13955 $7 = 72 '\110'
13956 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
13957 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
13958 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
13959 $9 = 200 'H'
13960 (@value{GDBP})
13961 @end smallexample
13962
13963 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
13964 string literals you use in expressions:
13965
13966 @smallexample
13967 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
13968 $10 = 78 '+'
13969 (@value{GDBP})
13970 @end smallexample
13971
13972 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
13973 character.
13974
13975 @node Caching Target Data
13976 @section Caching Data of Targets
13977 @cindex caching data of targets
13978
13979 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
13980 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
13981 @xref{Inferiors Connections and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
13982 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
13983 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
13984 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
13985 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
13986 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
13987 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
13988 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
13989 is executing.
13990 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
13991 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
13992 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
13993 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
13994 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
13995 in the code segment.
13996 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
13997 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
13998
13999 @table @code
14000 @kindex set remotecache
14001 @item set remotecache on
14002 @itemx set remotecache off
14003 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
14004 with old scripts.
14005
14006 @kindex show remotecache
14007 @item show remotecache
14008 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
14009
14010 @kindex set stack-cache
14011 @item set stack-cache on
14012 @itemx set stack-cache off
14013 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
14014 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
14015
14016 @kindex show stack-cache
14017 @item show stack-cache
14018 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
14019
14020 @kindex set code-cache
14021 @item set code-cache on
14022 @itemx set code-cache off
14023 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
14024 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
14025 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
14026
14027 @kindex show code-cache
14028 @item show code-cache
14029 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
14030 accesses.
14031
14032 @kindex info dcache
14033 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
14034 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
14035 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
14036 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
14037 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
14038 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
14039
14040 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
14041 printed in hex.
14042
14043 @item set dcache size @var{size}
14044 @cindex dcache size
14045 @kindex set dcache size
14046 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
14047
14048 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
14049 @cindex dcache line-size
14050 @kindex set dcache line-size
14051 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
14052 Must be a power of 2.
14053
14054 @item show dcache size
14055 @kindex show dcache size
14056 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
14057
14058 @item show dcache line-size
14059 @kindex show dcache line-size
14060 Show default size of dcache lines.
14061
14062 @item maint flush dcache
14063 @cindex dcache, flushing
14064 @kindex maint flush dcache
14065 Flush the contents (if any) of the dcache. This maintainer command is
14066 useful when debugging the dcache implementation.
14067
14068 @end table
14069
14070 @node Searching Memory
14071 @section Search Memory
14072 @cindex searching memory
14073
14074 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
14075 @code{find} command.
14076
14077 @table @code
14078 @kindex find
14079 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
14080 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
14081 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
14082 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
14083 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
14084 @end table
14085
14086 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
14087 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
14088
14089 @table @r
14090 @item @var{s}, search query size
14091 The size of each search query value.
14092
14093 @table @code
14094 @item b
14095 bytes
14096 @item h
14097 halfwords (two bytes)
14098 @item w
14099 words (four bytes)
14100 @item g
14101 giant words (eight bytes)
14102 @end table
14103
14104 All values are interpreted in the current language.
14105 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
14106 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
14107 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
14108 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
14109
14110 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
14111 value's type in the current language.
14112 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
14113 pattern as a mixture of types.
14114 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
14115 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
14116 which is typically four bytes.
14117
14118 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
14119 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
14120 @end table
14121
14122 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
14123 (@code{"}).
14124 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
14125 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
14126
14127 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
14128 number of matches found.
14129
14130 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
14131 @samp{$_}.
14132 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
14133
14134 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
14135
14136 @smallexample
14137 void
14138 hello ()
14139 @{
14140 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
14141 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
14142 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
14143 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
14144 printf ("%s\n", hello);
14145 @}
14146 @end smallexample
14147
14148 @noindent
14149 you get during debugging:
14150
14151 @smallexample
14152 (@value{GDBP}) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
14153 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
14154 1 pattern found
14155 (@value{GDBP}) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
14156 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
14157 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
14158 2 patterns found.
14159 (@value{GDBP}) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
14160 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
14161 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
14162 2 patterns found.
14163 (@value{GDBP}) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
14164 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
14165 1 pattern found
14166 (@value{GDBP}) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
14167 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
14168 1 pattern found
14169 (@value{GDBP}) print $numfound
14170 $1 = 1
14171 (@value{GDBP}) print $_
14172 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
14173 @end smallexample
14174
14175 @node Value Sizes
14176 @section Value Sizes
14177
14178 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
14179 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
14180 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
14181 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
14182 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large amount of memory.
14183
14184 @table @code
14185 @anchor{set max-value-size}
14186 @kindex set max-value-size
14187 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
14188 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
14189 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
14190 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
14191 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
14192
14193 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
14194 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
14195
14196 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
14197 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
14198 currently 16 bytes.
14199
14200 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
14201 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
14202 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
14203 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
14204 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
14205 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
14206 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
14207 size is less than @var{bytes}.
14208
14209 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
14210
14211 @kindex show max-value-size
14212 @item show max-value-size
14213 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
14214 allocate for the contents of a value.
14215 @end table
14216
14217 @node Optimized Code
14218 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
14219 @cindex optimized code, debugging
14220 @cindex debugging optimized code
14221
14222 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
14223 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
14224 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
14225 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
14226 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
14227 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
14228 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
14229
14230 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
14231 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
14232 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
14233 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
14234
14235 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
14236 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
14237 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
14238 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
14239 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
14240 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
14241
14242 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
14243 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
14244 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
14245 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
14246 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
14247
14248 @menu
14249 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
14250 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
14251 @end menu
14252
14253 @node Inline Functions
14254 @section Inline Functions
14255 @cindex inline functions, debugging
14256
14257 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
14258 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
14259 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
14260 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
14261 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
14262 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
14263 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
14264 @code{info frame} command.
14265
14266 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
14267 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
14268 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
14269 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
14270 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
14271 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
14272 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
14273 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
14274 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
14275 local variables in the caller.
14276
14277 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
14278 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
14279 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
14280 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
14281 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
14282 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
14283 instructions are executed.
14284
14285 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
14286 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
14287 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
14288 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
14289
14290 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
14291 function calls are the same as normal calls:
14292
14293 @itemize @bullet
14294 @item
14295 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
14296 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
14297 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
14298 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
14299 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
14300 or inside the inlined function instead.
14301
14302 @item
14303 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
14304 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
14305 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
14306 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
14307
14308 @end itemize
14309
14310 @node Tail Call Frames
14311 @section Tail Call Frames
14312 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
14313
14314 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
14315 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
14316 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
14317 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
14318 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
14319
14320 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
14321 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
14322 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
14323 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
14324 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
14325 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
14326 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
14327
14328 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
14329 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
14330 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
14331 this information.
14332
14333 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
14334 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
14335
14336 @smallexample
14337 (@value{GDBP}) x/i $pc - 2
14338 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
14339 (@value{GDBP}) info frame
14340 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
14341 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
14342 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
14343 source language c++.
14344 Arglist at unknown address.
14345 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
14346 @end smallexample
14347
14348 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
14349 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
14350 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
14351 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
14352 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
14353 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
14354
14355 @table @code
14356 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
14357 @item set debug entry-values
14358 @kindex set debug entry-values
14359 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
14360 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
14361 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
14362 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
14363 result.
14364
14365 @item show debug entry-values
14366 @kindex show debug entry-values
14367 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
14368 values at function entry and tail calls.
14369 @end table
14370
14371 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
14372 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
14373 reference by variable @code{x}):
14374
14375 @smallexample
14376 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
14377 void (*x) (void) = c;
14378 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
14379 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
14380 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
14381
14382 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
14383 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
14384 a () at t.c:3
14385 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
14386 (@value{GDBP}) bt
14387 #0 a () at t.c:3
14388 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
14389 @end smallexample
14390
14391 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
14392
14393 @smallexample
14394 int i;
14395 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
14396 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
14397 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
14398 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
14399 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
14400 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
14401 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
14402 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
14403
14404 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
14405 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
14406 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
14407 (@value{GDBP}) bt
14408 #0 f () at t.c:2
14409 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
14410 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
14411 @end smallexample
14412
14413 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
14414 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
14415
14416 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
14417 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
14418 @set ARROW @click{}
14419 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
14420 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
14421 @end ifset
14422 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
14423 @set ARROW ->
14424 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
14425 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
14426 @end ifclear
14427
14428 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
14429 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
14430 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
14431
14432 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
14433 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequence - that one is
14434 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
14435 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
14436 further @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
14437 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
14438
14439 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
14440 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
14441 also ambiguous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
14442 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
14443 omitted.
14444
14445 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
14446 entry may fail:
14447
14448 @smallexample
14449 int v;
14450 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
14451 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
14452 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
14453 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
14454 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
14455 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
14456
14457 (@value{GDBP}) bt
14458 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
14459 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
14460 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
14461 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
14462 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
14463 @end smallexample
14464
14465 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
14466 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
14467 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify the @code{i} variable, therefore
14468 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
14469 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
14470
14471 @node Macros
14472 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
14473
14474 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
14475 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
14476 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
14477 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
14478 where it was defined.
14479
14480 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
14481 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
14482 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
14483 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
14484
14485 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
14486 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
14487 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
14488 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
14489 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
14490 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
14491 see @ref{List}.
14492
14493 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
14494 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
14495 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
14496
14497 @table @code
14498
14499 @kindex macro expand
14500 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
14501 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
14502 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
14503 @item macro expand @var{expression}
14504 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
14505 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
14506 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
14507 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
14508 it can be any string of tokens.
14509
14510 @kindex macro exp1
14511 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
14512 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
14513 @cindex expand macro once
14514 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
14515 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
14516 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
14517 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
14518 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
14519 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
14520 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
14521 can be any string of tokens.
14522
14523 @kindex info macro
14524 @cindex macro definition, showing
14525 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
14526 @cindex macros, from debug info
14527 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
14528 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
14529 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
14530 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
14531 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
14532 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
14533
14534 @kindex info macros
14535 @item info macros @var{locspec}
14536 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the source line of
14537 the code location that results from resolving @var{locspec}, and
14538 describe the source location or compiler command-line where those
14539 definitions were established.
14540
14541 @kindex macro define
14542 @cindex user-defined macros
14543 @cindex defining macros interactively
14544 @cindex macros, user-defined
14545 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
14546 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
14547 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
14548 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
14549 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
14550 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
14551 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
14552 @var{arglist}.
14553
14554 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
14555 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
14556 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
14557 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
14558 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
14559
14560 @kindex macro undef
14561 @item macro undef @var{macro}
14562 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
14563 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
14564 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
14565 in the program being debugged.
14566
14567 @kindex macro list
14568 @item macro list
14569 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
14570 @end table
14571
14572 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
14573 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
14574 show our source files:
14575
14576 @smallexample
14577 $ cat sample.c
14578 #include <stdio.h>
14579 #include "sample.h"
14580
14581 #define M 42
14582 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
14583
14584 main ()
14585 @{
14586 #define N 28
14587 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
14588 #undef N
14589 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
14590 #define N 1729
14591 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
14592 @}
14593 $ cat sample.h
14594 #define Q <
14595 $
14596 @end smallexample
14597
14598 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
14599 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
14600 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
14601 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
14602 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
14603 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
14604 information.
14605
14606 @smallexample
14607 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
14608 $
14609 @end smallexample
14610
14611 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
14612
14613 @smallexample
14614 $ gdb -nw sample
14615 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
14616 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14617 GDB is free software, @dots{}
14618 (@value{GDBP})
14619 @end smallexample
14620
14621 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
14622 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
14623 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
14624
14625 @smallexample
14626 (@value{GDBP}) list main
14627 3
14628 4 #define M 42
14629 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
14630 6
14631 7 main ()
14632 8 @{
14633 9 #define N 28
14634 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
14635 11 #undef N
14636 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
14637 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
14638 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
14639 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
14640 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
14641 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
14642 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
14643 #define Q <
14644 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
14645 expands to: (42 + 1)
14646 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
14647 expands to: once (M + 1)
14648 (@value{GDBP})
14649 @end smallexample
14650
14651 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
14652 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
14653 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
14654 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
14655
14656 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
14657 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
14658
14659 @smallexample
14660 (@value{GDBP}) break main
14661 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
14662 (@value{GDBP}) run
14663 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
14664
14665 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
14666 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
14667 (@value{GDBP})
14668 @end smallexample
14669
14670 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
14671
14672 @smallexample
14673 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
14674 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
14675 #define N 28
14676 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
14677 expands to: 28 < 42
14678 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
14679 $1 = 1
14680 (@value{GDBP})
14681 @end smallexample
14682
14683 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
14684 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
14685 thereof) in force at each point:
14686
14687 @smallexample
14688 (@value{GDBP}) next
14689 Hello, world!
14690 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
14691 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
14692 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
14693 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
14694 (@value{GDBP}) next
14695 We're so creative.
14696 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
14697 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
14698 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
14699 #define N 1729
14700 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
14701 expands to: 1729 < 42
14702 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
14703 $2 = 0
14704 (@value{GDBP})
14705 @end smallexample
14706
14707 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
14708 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
14709 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
14710 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
14711
14712 @smallexample
14713 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
14714 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
14715 -D__STDC__=1
14716 (@value{GDBP})
14717 @end smallexample
14718
14719
14720 @node Tracepoints
14721 @chapter Tracepoints
14722 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
14723 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
14724
14725 @cindex tracepoints
14726 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
14727 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
14728 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
14729 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
14730 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
14731 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
14732 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
14733
14734 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
14735 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
14736 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
14737 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
14738 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
14739 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
14740 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
14741 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
14742 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
14743 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
14744 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
14745
14746 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
14747 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
14748 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
14749 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
14750 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
14751 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
14752 Packets}.
14753
14754 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
14755 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
14756 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
14757
14758 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
14759
14760 @menu
14761 * Set Tracepoints::
14762 * Analyze Collected Data::
14763 * Tracepoint Variables::
14764 * Trace Files::
14765 @end menu
14766
14767 @node Set Tracepoints
14768 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
14769
14770 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
14771 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
14772 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
14773 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
14774 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
14775 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
14776 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
14777
14778 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
14779 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
14780 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
14781 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
14782 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
14783 tracepoint was hit.
14784
14785 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
14786 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
14787 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
14788 either.
14789
14790 @cindex fast tracepoints
14791 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
14792 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
14793 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
14794
14795 @cindex static tracepoints
14796 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
14797 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
14798 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
14799 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
14800 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
14801 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
14802 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
14803 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
14804 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
14805 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
14806 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
14807 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
14808 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
14809 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
14810 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
14811 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
14812 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
14813 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
14814 static tracepoint marker.
14815
14816 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
14817 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
14818
14819 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
14820 conditions and actions.
14821
14822 @menu
14823 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
14824 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
14825 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
14826 * Tracepoint Conditions::
14827 * Trace State Variables::
14828 * Tracepoint Actions::
14829 * Listing Tracepoints::
14830 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
14831 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
14832 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
14833 @end menu
14834
14835 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
14836 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
14837
14838 @table @code
14839 @cindex set tracepoint
14840 @kindex trace
14841 @item trace @var{locspec}
14842 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
14843 Its argument @var{locspec} can be any valid location specification.
14844 @xref{Location Specifications}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
14845 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
14846 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
14847 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
14848 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
14849 in tracing}).
14850 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
14851 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
14852 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
14853 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
14854 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
14855 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
14856 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
14857 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
14858 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
14859 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
14860 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
14861 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
14862
14863 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
14864
14865 @smallexample
14866 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
14867
14868 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
14869
14870 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
14871
14872 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
14873
14874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
14875 @end smallexample
14876
14877 @noindent
14878 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
14879
14880 @item trace @var{locspec} if @var{cond}
14881 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
14882 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
14883 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
14884 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
14885 information on tracepoint conditions.
14886
14887 @item ftrace @var{locspec} [ if @var{cond} ]
14888 @cindex set fast tracepoint
14889 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
14890 @kindex ftrace
14891 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
14892 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
14893 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
14894 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
14895 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
14896 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
14897 message.
14898
14899 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
14900 @code{trace}.
14901
14902 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
14903 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
14904 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
14905 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
14906 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
14907 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
14908 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
14909 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
14910
14911 @example
14912 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
14913 @end example
14914
14915 @noindent
14916 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
14917 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
14918
14919 @item strace [@var{locspec} | -m @var{marker}] [ if @var{cond} ]
14920 @cindex set static tracepoint
14921 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
14922 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
14923 @kindex strace
14924 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
14925 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
14926 instrumentation point, or marker, found at the code locations that
14927 result from resolving @var{locspec}. It may not be possible to set a
14928 static tracepoint at the desired code location, in which case the
14929 command will exit with an explanatory message.
14930
14931 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
14932 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
14933 @code{-m @var{marker}} instead of a location spec. This probes the marker
14934 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
14935 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
14936 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
14937 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
14938 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
14939 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
14940 tracing engine:
14941
14942 @smallexample
14943 main ()
14944 @{
14945 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
14946 @}
14947 @end smallexample
14948
14949 @noindent
14950 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
14951 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
14952
14953 @smallexample
14954 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
14955 Cnt Enb ID Address What
14956 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
14957 Data: "str %s"
14958 [etc...]
14959 @end smallexample
14960
14961 @noindent
14962 so you may probe the marker above with:
14963
14964 @smallexample
14965 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
14966 @end smallexample
14967
14968 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
14969 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
14970 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
14971 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
14972 string. The user data is then the result of running that formatting
14973 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
14974 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
14975 the @samp{Data:} field.
14976
14977 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
14978 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
14979 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
14980
14981 @vindex $tpnum
14982 @cindex last tracepoint number
14983 @cindex recent tracepoint number
14984 @cindex tracepoint number
14985 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
14986 of the most recently set tracepoint.
14987
14988 @kindex delete tracepoint
14989 @cindex tracepoint deletion
14990 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
14991 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
14992 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
14993 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
14994
14995 Examples:
14996
14997 @smallexample
14998 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
14999
15000 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
15001 @end smallexample
15002
15003 @noindent
15004 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
15005 @end table
15006
15007 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
15008 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
15009
15010 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
15011
15012 @table @code
15013 @kindex disable tracepoint
15014 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
15015 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
15016 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
15017 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
15018 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
15019 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
15020 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
15021 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
15022 next trace experiment.
15023
15024 @kindex enable tracepoint
15025 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
15026 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
15027 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
15028 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
15029 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
15030 next time a trace experiment is run.
15031 @end table
15032
15033 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
15034 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
15035
15036 @table @code
15037 @kindex passcount
15038 @cindex tracepoint pass count
15039 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
15040 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
15041 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
15042 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
15043 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
15044 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
15045 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
15046 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
15047 user.
15048
15049 Examples:
15050
15051 @smallexample
15052 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
15053 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
15054
15055 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
15056 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
15057 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
15058 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
15059 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
15060 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
15061 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
15062 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
15063 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
15064 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
15065 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
15066 @end smallexample
15067 @end table
15068
15069 @node Tracepoint Conditions
15070 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
15071 @cindex conditional tracepoints
15072 @cindex tracepoint conditions
15073
15074 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
15075 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
15076 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
15077 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
15078 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
15079 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
15080 is true.
15081
15082 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
15083 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
15084 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
15085 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
15086 just as with breakpoints.
15087
15088 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
15089 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
15090 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
15091 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
15092 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
15093 accesses, and so forth.
15094
15095 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
15096 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
15097 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
15098 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
15099 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
15100 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
15101 search through.
15102
15103 @smallexample
15104 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
15105 @end smallexample
15106
15107 @node Trace State Variables
15108 @subsection Trace State Variables
15109 @cindex trace state variables
15110
15111 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
15112 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
15113 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
15114 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
15115 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
15116 integers.
15117
15118 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
15119 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
15120 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
15121 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
15122
15123 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
15124 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
15125 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
15126 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
15127 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
15128 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
15129 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
15130 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
15131 variable with the same name.
15132
15133 @table @code
15134
15135 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
15136 @kindex tvariable
15137 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
15138 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
15139 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
15140 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
15141 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
15142 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
15143 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
15144 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
15145 value. The default initial value is 0.
15146
15147 @item info tvariables
15148 @kindex info tvariables
15149 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
15150 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
15151 currently running.
15152
15153 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
15154 @kindex delete tvariable
15155 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
15156 are specified.
15157
15158 @end table
15159
15160 @node Tracepoint Actions
15161 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
15162
15163 @table @code
15164 @kindex actions
15165 @cindex tracepoint actions
15166 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
15167 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
15168 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
15169 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
15170 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
15171 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
15172 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
15173 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
15174 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
15175 @code{while-stepping}.
15176
15177 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
15178 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
15179 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
15180
15181 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
15182 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
15183 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
15184
15185 @smallexample
15186 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
15187
15188 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
15189
15190 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
15191 @end smallexample
15192
15193 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
15194 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
15195 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
15196 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
15197 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
15198 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
15199 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
15200 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
15201
15202 @smallexample
15203 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
15204 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
15205 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
15206 > collect bar,baz
15207 > collect $regs
15208 > while-stepping 12
15209 > collect $pc, arr[i]
15210 > end
15211 end
15212 @end smallexample
15213
15214 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
15215 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
15216 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
15217 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
15218 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
15219 special arguments are supported:
15220
15221 @table @code
15222 @item $regs
15223 Collect all registers.
15224
15225 @item $args
15226 Collect all function arguments.
15227
15228 @item $locals
15229 Collect all local variables.
15230
15231 @item $_ret
15232 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
15233 of a backtrace.
15234
15235 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
15236 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
15237 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
15238 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
15239 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
15240 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
15241
15242 @item $_probe_argc
15243 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
15244 tracepoint is located.
15245 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
15246
15247 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
15248 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
15249 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
15250 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
15251
15252 @item $_sdata
15253 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
15254 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
15255 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
15256 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
15257 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
15258 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
15259 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
15260 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
15261 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
15262
15263 @smallexample
15264 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
15265 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
15266 @end smallexample
15267
15268 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
15269 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
15270 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
15271 @value{GDBN}.
15272 @end table
15273
15274 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
15275 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
15276 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
15277
15278 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
15279 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
15280 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
15281 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
15282 @code{print characters} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
15283 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
15284 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
15285 @samp{mystr}.
15286
15287 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
15288 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
15289
15290 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
15291 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
15292 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
15293 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
15294 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
15295 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
15296 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
15297 action were used.
15298
15299 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
15300 @item while-stepping @var{n}
15301 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
15302 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
15303 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
15304 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
15305
15306 @smallexample
15307 > while-stepping 12
15308 > collect $regs, myglobal
15309 > end
15310 >
15311 @end smallexample
15312
15313 @noindent
15314 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
15315 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
15316 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
15317 @code{stepping}.
15318
15319 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
15320 @kindex set default-collect
15321 @cindex default collection action
15322 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
15323 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
15324 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
15325 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
15326 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
15327 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
15328
15329 @item show default-collect
15330 @kindex show default-collect
15331 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
15332 tracepoint hit.
15333
15334 @end table
15335
15336 @node Listing Tracepoints
15337 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
15338
15339 @table @code
15340 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
15341 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
15342 @cindex information about tracepoints
15343 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
15344 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
15345 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
15346 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
15347 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
15348 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
15349
15350 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
15351 tracing:
15352
15353 @itemize @bullet
15354 @item
15355 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
15356
15357 @item
15358 the state about installed on target of each location
15359 @end itemize
15360
15361 @smallexample
15362 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
15363 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15364 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
15365 while-stepping 20
15366 collect globfoo, $regs
15367 end
15368 collect globfoo2
15369 end
15370 pass count 1200
15371 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
15372 collect $eip
15373 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
15374 installed on target
15375 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
15376 installed on target
15377 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
15378 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
15379 not installed on target
15380 (@value{GDBP})
15381 @end smallexample
15382
15383 @noindent
15384 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
15385 @end table
15386
15387 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
15388 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
15389
15390 @table @code
15391 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
15392 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
15393 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
15394 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
15395 program.
15396
15397 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
15398
15399 @table @emph
15400 @item Count
15401 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
15402 stable identifier.
15403 @item ID
15404 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
15405 @item Enabled or Disabled
15406 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
15407 that are not enabled.
15408 @item Address
15409 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
15410 @item What
15411 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
15412 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
15413 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
15414 will be left blank.
15415 @end table
15416
15417 @noindent
15418 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
15419
15420 @table @emph
15421 @item Data
15422 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
15423 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
15424 marker call.
15425 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
15426 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
15427 @end table
15428
15429 @smallexample
15430 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
15431 Cnt ID Enb Address What
15432 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
15433 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
15434 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
15435 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
15436 Data: str %s
15437 (@value{GDBP})
15438 @end smallexample
15439 @end table
15440
15441 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
15442 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
15443
15444 @table @code
15445 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
15446 @cindex start a new trace experiment
15447 @cindex collected data discarded
15448 @item tstart
15449 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
15450 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
15451 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
15452 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
15453 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
15454 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
15455 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
15456 information, and so forth.
15457
15458 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
15459 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
15460 @item tstop
15461 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
15462 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
15463 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
15464 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
15465 needs to be stopped quickly.
15466
15467 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
15468 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
15469 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
15470
15471 @kindex tstatus
15472 @cindex status of trace data collection
15473 @cindex trace experiment, status of
15474 @item tstatus
15475 This command displays the status of the current trace data
15476 collection.
15477 @end table
15478
15479 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
15480
15481 @smallexample
15482 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
15483 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
15484 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
15485 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
15486 > while-stepping 11
15487 > collect $regs
15488 > end
15489 > end
15490 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
15491 [time passes @dots{}]
15492 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
15493 @end smallexample
15494
15495 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
15496 @cindex disconnected tracing
15497 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
15498 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
15499 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
15500 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
15501 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
15502 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
15503 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
15504 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
15505
15506 @table @code
15507 @item set disconnected-tracing on
15508 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
15509 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
15510 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
15511 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
15512 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
15513 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
15514 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
15515
15516 @item show disconnected-tracing
15517 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
15518 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
15519
15520 @end table
15521
15522 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
15523 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
15524 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
15525 it will continue after reconnection.
15526
15527 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
15528 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
15529 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
15530 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
15531 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
15532 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
15533 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
15534 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
15535 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
15536 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
15537
15538 @cindex circular trace buffer
15539 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
15540 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
15541 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
15542 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
15543 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
15544 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
15545 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
15546 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
15547 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
15548 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
15549 the next run.
15550
15551 @table @code
15552 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
15553 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
15554 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
15555 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
15556 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
15557 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
15558 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
15559
15560 @item show circular-trace-buffer
15561 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
15562 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
15563 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
15564 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
15565 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
15566
15567 @end table
15568
15569 @table @code
15570 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
15571 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
15572 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
15573 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
15574 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
15575 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
15576 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
15577 likes. This is also the default.
15578
15579 @item show trace-buffer-size
15580 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
15581 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
15582 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
15583 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
15584 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
15585 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
15586 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
15587 @end table
15588
15589 @table @code
15590 @item set trace-user @var{text}
15591 @kindex set trace-user
15592
15593 @item show trace-user
15594 @kindex show trace-user
15595
15596 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
15597 @kindex set trace-notes
15598 Set the trace run's notes.
15599
15600 @item show trace-notes
15601 @kindex show trace-notes
15602 Show the trace run's notes.
15603
15604 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
15605 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
15606 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
15607 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
15608 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
15609
15610 @item show trace-stop-notes
15611 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
15612 Show the trace run's stop notes.
15613
15614 @end table
15615
15616 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
15617 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
15618
15619 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
15620 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
15621 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
15622 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
15623 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
15624 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
15625 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
15626 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
15627 mentioned here.
15628
15629 @itemize @bullet
15630
15631 @item
15632 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
15633 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
15634 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
15635 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
15636 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
15637 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
15638 cannot be collected either.
15639
15640 @item
15641 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
15642 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
15643 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
15644 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
15645 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
15646 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
15647 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
15648 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
15649 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
15650 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
15651
15652 @item
15653 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
15654 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
15655 in a misleading way.
15656
15657 @item
15658 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
15659 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
15660 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
15661 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
15662 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
15663 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
15664 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
15665 by @code{ptr}.
15666
15667 @item
15668 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
15669 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
15670 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
15671 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
15672 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
15673 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
15674 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
15675 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
15676 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
15677 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
15678 invalid address.
15679
15680 @item
15681 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
15682 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
15683 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
15684 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
15685 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
15686 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
15687 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
15688 it to zero.
15689
15690 @end itemize
15691
15692 @node Analyze Collected Data
15693 @section Using the Collected Data
15694
15695 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
15696 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
15697 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
15698 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
15699 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
15700 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
15701 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
15702 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
15703 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
15704 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
15705 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
15706 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
15707 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
15708 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
15709 the buffer will fail.
15710
15711 @menu
15712 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
15713 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
15714 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
15715 @end menu
15716
15717 @node tfind
15718 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
15719
15720 @kindex tfind
15721 @cindex select trace snapshot
15722 @cindex find trace snapshot
15723 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
15724 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
15725 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
15726 snapshot is selected.
15727
15728 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
15729
15730 @table @code
15731 @item tfind start
15732 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
15733 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
15734
15735 @item tfind none
15736 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
15737
15738 @item tfind end
15739 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
15740
15741 @item tfind
15742 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
15743 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
15744
15745 @item tfind -
15746 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
15747 retracing earlier steps.
15748
15749 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
15750 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
15751 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
15752 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
15753 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
15754
15755 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
15756 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
15757 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
15758 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
15759 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
15760
15761 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
15762 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
15763 addresses (exclusive).
15764
15765 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
15766 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
15767 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
15768
15769 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
15770 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
15771 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
15772 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
15773 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
15774 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
15775 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
15776 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
15777 @end table
15778
15779 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
15780 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
15781 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
15782 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
15783 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
15784 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
15785 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
15786 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
15787 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
15788 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
15789 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
15790 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
15791 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
15792 tracepoint as the current one.
15793
15794 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
15795 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
15796 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
15797 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
15798 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
15799
15800 @smallexample
15801 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
15802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
15803 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
15804 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
15805 > tfind
15806 > end
15807
15808 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
15809 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
15810 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
15811 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
15812 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
15813 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
15814 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
15815 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
15816 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
15817 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
15818 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
15819 @end smallexample
15820
15821 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
15822 the buffer:
15823
15824 @smallexample
15825 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
15826 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
15827 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
15828 > tfind line
15829 > end
15830
15831 Frame 0, X = 1
15832 Frame 7, X = 2
15833 Frame 13, X = 255
15834 @end smallexample
15835
15836 @node tdump
15837 @subsection @code{tdump}
15838 @kindex tdump
15839 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
15840 @cindex tracepoint data, display
15841
15842 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
15843 the current trace snapshot.
15844
15845 @smallexample
15846 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
15847 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
15848 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
15849 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
15850 > end
15851
15852 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
15853
15854 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
15855 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
15856 at gdb_test.c:444
15857 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
15858
15859 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
15860 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
15861 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
15862 d1 0x18 24
15863 d2 0x80 128
15864 d3 0x33 51
15865 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
15866 d5 0x22 34
15867 d6 0xe0 224
15868 d7 0x380035 3670069
15869 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
15870 a1 0x3000668 50333288
15871 a2 0x100 256
15872 a3 0x322000 3284992
15873 a4 0x3000698 50333336
15874 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
15875 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
15876 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
15877 ps 0x0 0
15878 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
15879 fpcontrol 0x0 0
15880 fpstatus 0x0 0
15881 fpiaddr 0x0 0
15882 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
15883 p1 = (void *) 0x11
15884 p2 = (void *) 0x22
15885 p3 = (void *) 0x33
15886 p4 = (void *) 0x44
15887 p5 = (void *) 0x55
15888 p6 = (void *) 0x66
15889 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
15890
15891 (@value{GDBP})
15892 @end smallexample
15893
15894 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
15895 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
15896 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
15897 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
15898
15899 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
15900 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
15901 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
15902 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
15903 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
15904 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
15905 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
15906 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
15907 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
15908 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
15909
15910 @node save tracepoints
15911 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
15912 @kindex save tracepoints
15913 @kindex save-tracepoints
15914 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
15915
15916 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
15917 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
15918 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
15919 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
15920 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
15921 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
15922
15923 @node Tracepoint Variables
15924 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
15925 @cindex tracepoint variables
15926 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
15927
15928 @table @code
15929 @vindex $trace_frame
15930 @item (int) $trace_frame
15931 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
15932 snapshot is selected.
15933
15934 @vindex $tracepoint
15935 @item (int) $tracepoint
15936 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
15937
15938 @vindex $trace_line
15939 @item (int) $trace_line
15940 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
15941
15942 @vindex $trace_file
15943 @item (char []) $trace_file
15944 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
15945
15946 @vindex $trace_func
15947 @item (char []) $trace_func
15948 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
15949 @end table
15950
15951 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
15952 use @code{output} instead.
15953
15954 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
15955 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
15956 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
15957 which are managed by the target.
15958
15959 @smallexample
15960 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
15961
15962 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
15963 > output $trace_file
15964 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
15965 > tfind
15966 > end
15967 @end smallexample
15968
15969 @node Trace Files
15970 @section Using Trace Files
15971 @cindex trace files
15972
15973 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
15974 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
15975 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
15976 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
15977 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
15978
15979 @table @code
15980
15981 @kindex tsave
15982 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
15983 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
15984 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
15985 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
15986 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
15987 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
15988 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
15989 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
15990 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
15991 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
15992 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
15993 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
15994 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
15995 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
15996 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
15997
15998 @kindex target tfile
15999 @kindex tfile
16000 @kindex target ctf
16001 @kindex ctf
16002 @item target tfile @var{filename}
16003 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
16004 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
16005 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
16006 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
16007 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
16008 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
16009 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
16010 the host.
16011
16012 @smallexample
16013 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
16014 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
16015 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
16016 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
16017 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
16018 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
16019 i = 0
16020 a = 0
16021 b = 1 '\001'
16022 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
16023 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
16024 (@value{GDBP}) p b
16025 $1 = 1
16026 @end smallexample
16027
16028 @end table
16029
16030 @node Overlays
16031 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
16032 @cindex overlays
16033
16034 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
16035 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
16036 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
16037 use overlays.
16038
16039 @menu
16040 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
16041 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
16042 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
16043 mapped by asking the inferior.
16044 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
16045 @end menu
16046
16047 @node How Overlays Work
16048 @section How Overlays Work
16049 @cindex mapped overlays
16050 @cindex unmapped overlays
16051 @cindex load address, overlay's
16052 @cindex mapped address
16053 @cindex overlay area
16054
16055 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
16056 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
16057 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
16058 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
16059 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
16060
16061 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
16062 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
16063 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
16064 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
16065 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
16066 largest overlay as well.
16067
16068 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
16069 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
16070 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
16071 there.
16072
16073 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
16074 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
16075 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
16076
16077 @smallexample
16078 @group
16079 Data Instruction Larger
16080 Address Space Address Space Address Space
16081 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
16082 | | | | | |
16083 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
16084 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
16085 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
16086 | and heap | | | | | |
16087 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
16088 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
16089 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
16090 | | | | | |
16091 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
16092 address | | | | | |
16093 | overlay | <-' | | |
16094 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
16095 | | <---. | | load address
16096 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
16097 | | | |
16098 +-----------+ | |
16099 +-----------+
16100 | |
16101 +-----------+
16102
16103 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
16104 @end group
16105 @end smallexample
16106
16107 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
16108 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
16109 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
16110 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
16111 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
16112 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
16113 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
16114 program and the overlay area.
16115
16116 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
16117 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
16118 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
16119 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
16120 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
16121 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
16122 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
16123
16124 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
16125 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
16126 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
16127
16128 @itemize @bullet
16129
16130 @item
16131 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
16132 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
16133 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
16134 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
16135
16136 @item
16137 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
16138 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
16139 your program's performance.
16140
16141 @item
16142 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
16143 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
16144 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
16145 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
16146 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
16147 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
16148 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
16149
16150 @item
16151 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
16152 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
16153 instruction and data spaces.
16154
16155 @end itemize
16156
16157 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
16158 improved in many ways:
16159
16160 @itemize @bullet
16161
16162 @item
16163 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
16164 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
16165 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
16166 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
16167 area in the usual way.
16168
16169 @item
16170 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
16171 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
16172
16173 @item
16174 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
16175 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
16176 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
16177 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
16178 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
16179 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
16180 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
16181
16182 @end itemize
16183
16184
16185 @node Overlay Commands
16186 @section Overlay Commands
16187
16188 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
16189 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
16190 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
16191 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
16192 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
16193 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
16194
16195 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
16196 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
16197
16198 @table @code
16199 @item overlay off
16200 @kindex overlay
16201 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
16202 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
16203 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
16204 overlay support is disabled.
16205
16206 @item overlay manual
16207 @cindex manual overlay debugging
16208 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
16209 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
16210 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
16211 commands described below.
16212
16213 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
16214 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
16215 @cindex map an overlay
16216 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
16217 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
16218 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
16219 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
16220 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
16221 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
16222
16223 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
16224 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
16225 @cindex unmap an overlay
16226 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
16227 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
16228 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
16229 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
16230
16231 @item overlay auto
16232 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
16233 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
16234 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
16235 Overlay Debugging}.
16236
16237 @item overlay load-target
16238 @itemx overlay load
16239 @cindex reloading the overlay table
16240 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
16241 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
16242 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
16243 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
16244 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
16245
16246 @item overlay list-overlays
16247 @itemx overlay list
16248 @cindex listing mapped overlays
16249 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
16250 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
16251
16252 @end table
16253
16254 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
16255 of the function the address falls in:
16256
16257 @smallexample
16258 (@value{GDBP}) print main
16259 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
16260 @end smallexample
16261 @noindent
16262 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
16263 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
16264 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
16265 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
16266
16267 @smallexample
16268 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
16269 No sections are mapped.
16270 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
16271 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
16272 @end smallexample
16273 @noindent
16274 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
16275 name normally:
16276
16277 @smallexample
16278 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
16279 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
16280 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
16281 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
16282 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
16283 @end smallexample
16284
16285 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
16286 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
16287 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
16288 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
16289 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
16290
16291 @itemize @bullet
16292 @item
16293 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
16294 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
16295 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
16296 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
16297 @item
16298 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
16299 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
16300 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
16301 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
16302 breakpoints properly.
16303 @end itemize
16304
16305
16306 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
16307 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
16308 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
16309
16310 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
16311 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
16312 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
16313 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
16314 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
16315 current state of the overlays.
16316
16317 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
16318 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
16319
16320 @table @asis
16321
16322 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
16323 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
16324
16325 @smallexample
16326 struct
16327 @{
16328 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
16329 unsigned long vma;
16330
16331 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
16332 unsigned long size;
16333
16334 /* The overlay's load address. */
16335 unsigned long lma;
16336
16337 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
16338 zero otherwise. */
16339 unsigned long mapped;
16340 @}
16341 @end smallexample
16342
16343 @item @code{_novlys}:
16344 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
16345 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
16346
16347 @end table
16348
16349 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
16350 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
16351 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
16352 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
16353 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
16354 currently mapped.
16355
16356 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
16357 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
16358 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
16359 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
16360 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
16361 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
16362 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
16363 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
16364 are not being executed.
16365
16366 @node Overlay Sample Program
16367 @section Overlay Sample Program
16368 @cindex overlay example program
16369
16370 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
16371 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
16372 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
16373 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
16374 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
16375 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
16376 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
16377
16378 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
16379 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
16380 suite. The program consists of the following files from
16381 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
16382
16383 @table @file
16384 @item overlays.c
16385 The main program file.
16386 @item ovlymgr.c
16387 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
16388 @item foo.c
16389 @itemx bar.c
16390 @itemx baz.c
16391 @itemx grbx.c
16392 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
16393 @item d10v.ld
16394 @itemx m32r.ld
16395 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
16396 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
16397 @end table
16398
16399 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
16400 cross-compiler like this:
16401
16402 @smallexample
16403 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
16404 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
16405 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
16406 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
16407 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
16408 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
16409 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
16410 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
16411 @end smallexample
16412
16413 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
16414 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
16415 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
16416
16417
16418 @node Languages
16419 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
16420 @cindex languages
16421
16422 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
16423 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
16424 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
16425 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
16426 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
16427 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
16428
16429 @cindex working language
16430 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
16431 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
16432 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
16433 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
16434 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
16435 language}.
16436
16437 @menu
16438 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
16439 * Show:: Displaying the language
16440 * Checks:: Type and range checks
16441 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
16442 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
16443 @end menu
16444
16445 @node Setting
16446 @section Switching Between Source Languages
16447
16448 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
16449 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
16450 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
16451 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
16452 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
16453 are printed, etc.
16454
16455 In addition to the working language, every source file that
16456 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
16457 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
16458 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
16459 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
16460 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
16461 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
16462 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
16463 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
16464 Displaying the Language}.
16465
16466 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
16467 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
16468 another language. In that case, make the
16469 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
16470 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
16471 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
16472
16473 @menu
16474 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
16475 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
16476 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
16477 @end menu
16478
16479 @node Filenames
16480 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
16481
16482 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
16483 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
16484
16485 @table @file
16486 @item .ada
16487 @itemx .ads
16488 @itemx .adb
16489 @itemx .a
16490 Ada source file.
16491
16492 @item .c
16493 C source file
16494
16495 @item .C
16496 @itemx .cc
16497 @itemx .cp
16498 @itemx .cpp
16499 @itemx .cxx
16500 @itemx .c++
16501 C@t{++} source file
16502
16503 @item .d
16504 D source file
16505
16506 @item .m
16507 Objective-C source file
16508
16509 @item .f
16510 @itemx .F
16511 Fortran source file
16512
16513 @item .mod
16514 Modula-2 source file
16515
16516 @item .s
16517 @itemx .S
16518 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
16519 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
16520 @end table
16521
16522 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
16523 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
16524
16525 @node Manually
16526 @subsection Setting the Working Language
16527
16528 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
16529 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
16530 your program.
16531
16532 @kindex set language
16533 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
16534 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
16535 a language, such as
16536 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
16537 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
16538
16539 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
16540 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
16541 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
16542 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
16543 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
16544 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
16545 command such as:
16546
16547 @smallexample
16548 print a = b + c
16549 @end smallexample
16550
16551 @noindent
16552 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
16553 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
16554 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
16555 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
16556
16557 @node Automatically
16558 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
16559
16560 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
16561 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
16562 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
16563 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
16564 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
16565 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
16566 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
16567 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
16568 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
16569
16570 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
16571 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
16572 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
16573 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
16574 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
16575
16576 @node Show
16577 @section Displaying the Language
16578
16579 The following commands help you find out which language is the
16580 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
16581
16582 @table @code
16583 @item show language
16584 @anchor{show language}
16585 @kindex show language
16586 Display the current working language. This is the
16587 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
16588 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
16589
16590 @item info frame
16591 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
16592 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
16593 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
16594 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
16595 information listed here.
16596
16597 @item info source
16598 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
16599 Display the source language of this source file.
16600 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
16601 information listed here.
16602 @end table
16603
16604 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
16605 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
16606 with a language explicitly:
16607
16608 @table @code
16609 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
16610 @kindex set extension-language
16611 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
16612 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
16613
16614 @item info extensions
16615 @kindex info extensions
16616 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
16617 @end table
16618
16619 @node Checks
16620 @section Type and Range Checking
16621
16622 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
16623 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
16624 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
16625 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
16626 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
16627 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
16628 errors when your program is running.
16629
16630 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
16631 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
16632 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
16633 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
16634
16635 @menu
16636 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
16637 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
16638 @end menu
16639
16640 @cindex type checking
16641 @cindex checks, type
16642 @node Type Checking
16643 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
16644
16645 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
16646 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
16647 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
16648 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
16649
16650 @smallexample
16651 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
16652
16653 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
16654 $1 = 2
16655 @exdent but
16656 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
16657 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
16658 @end smallexample
16659
16660 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
16661 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
16662
16663 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
16664 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
16665 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
16666 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
16667 expressions like the second example above.
16668
16669 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
16670 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
16671 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
16672 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
16673 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
16674 little sense to evaluate anyway.
16675
16676 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
16677
16678 @kindex set check type
16679 @kindex show check type
16680 @table @code
16681 @item set check type on
16682 @itemx set check type off
16683 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
16684 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
16685 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
16686
16687 @item show check type
16688 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
16689 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
16690 @end table
16691
16692 @cindex range checking
16693 @cindex checks, range
16694 @node Range Checking
16695 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
16696
16697 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
16698 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
16699 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
16700 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
16701 not exceed the bounds of the array.
16702
16703 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
16704 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
16705 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
16706 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
16707
16708 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
16709 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
16710 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
16711 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
16712 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
16713 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
16714
16715 @smallexample
16716 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
16717 @end smallexample
16718
16719 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
16720 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
16721 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
16722
16723 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
16724
16725 @kindex set check range
16726 @kindex show check range
16727 @table @code
16728 @item set check range auto
16729 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
16730 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
16731 each language.
16732
16733 @item set check range on
16734 @itemx set check range off
16735 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
16736 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
16737 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
16738 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
16739
16740 @item set check range warn
16741 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
16742 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
16743 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
16744 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
16745 systems).
16746
16747 @item show check range
16748 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
16749 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
16750 @end table
16751
16752 @node Supported Languages
16753 @section Supported Languages
16754
16755 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
16756 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
16757 @c This is false ...
16758 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
16759 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
16760 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
16761 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
16762 language.
16763
16764 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
16765 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
16766 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
16767 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
16768 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
16769 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
16770 language reference or tutorial.
16771
16772 @menu
16773 * C:: C and C@t{++}
16774 * D:: D
16775 * Go:: Go
16776 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
16777 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
16778 * Fortran:: Fortran
16779 * Pascal:: Pascal
16780 * Rust:: Rust
16781 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
16782 * Ada:: Ada
16783 @end menu
16784
16785 @node C
16786 @subsection C and C@t{++}
16787
16788 @cindex C and C@t{++}
16789 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
16790
16791 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
16792 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
16793 together.
16794
16795 @cindex C@t{++}
16796 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
16797 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
16798 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
16799 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
16800 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
16801 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
16802 compiler (@code{aCC}).
16803
16804 @menu
16805 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
16806 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
16807 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
16808 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
16809 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
16810 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
16811 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
16812 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
16813 @end menu
16814
16815 @node C Operators
16816 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
16817
16818 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
16819
16820 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16821 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16822 often defined on groups of types.
16823
16824 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
16825
16826 @itemize @bullet
16827
16828 @item
16829 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
16830 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
16831
16832 @item
16833 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
16834 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
16835
16836 @item
16837 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
16838
16839 @item
16840 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
16841
16842 @end itemize
16843
16844 @noindent
16845 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
16846 in order of increasing precedence:
16847
16848 @table @code
16849 @item ,
16850 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
16851 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
16852 expression being the last expression evaluated.
16853
16854 @item =
16855 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
16856 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
16857
16858 @item @var{op}=
16859 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
16860 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
16861 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
16862 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
16863 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
16864
16865 @item ?:
16866 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
16867 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
16868 should be of an integral type.
16869
16870 @item ||
16871 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
16872
16873 @item &&
16874 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
16875
16876 @item |
16877 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
16878
16879 @item ^
16880 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
16881
16882 @item &
16883 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
16884
16885 @item ==@r{, }!=
16886 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
16887 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
16888
16889 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
16890 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
16891 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
16892 and non-zero for true.
16893
16894 @item <<@r{, }>>
16895 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
16896
16897 @item @@
16898 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16899
16900 @item +@r{, }-
16901 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
16902 pointer types.
16903
16904 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
16905 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
16906 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
16907 integral types.
16908
16909 @item ++@r{, }--
16910 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
16911 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
16912 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
16913 operation takes place.
16914
16915 @item *
16916 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
16917 @code{++}.
16918
16919 @item &
16920 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
16921
16922 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
16923 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
16924 to examine the address
16925 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
16926 stored.
16927
16928 @item -
16929 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
16930 precedence as @code{++}.
16931
16932 @item !
16933 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
16934 @code{++}.
16935
16936 @item ~
16937 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
16938 @code{++}.
16939
16940
16941 @item .@r{, }->
16942 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
16943 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
16944 pointer based on the stored type information.
16945 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
16946
16947 @item .*@r{, }->*
16948 Dereferences of pointers to members.
16949
16950 @item []
16951 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
16952 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
16953
16954 @item ()
16955 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
16956
16957 @item ::
16958 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
16959 and @code{class} types.
16960
16961 @item ::
16962 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
16963 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
16964 above.
16965 @end table
16966
16967 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
16968 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
16969 predefined meaning.
16970
16971 @node C Constants
16972 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
16973
16974 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
16975
16976 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
16977 following ways:
16978
16979 @itemize @bullet
16980 @item
16981 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
16982 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
16983 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
16984 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
16985 @code{long} value.
16986
16987 @item
16988 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
16989 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
16990 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
16991 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
16992 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
16993 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
16994 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
16995 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
16996 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
16997 constant.
16998
16999 @item
17000 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
17001 integral equivalents.
17002
17003 @item
17004 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
17005 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
17006 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
17007 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
17008 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
17009 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
17010 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
17011 @samp{\n} for newline.
17012
17013 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
17014 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
17015 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
17016 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
17017
17018 @item
17019 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
17020 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
17021 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
17022 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
17023 characters.
17024
17025 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
17026 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
17027 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
17028
17029 @item
17030 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
17031 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
17032
17033 @item
17034 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
17035 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
17036 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
17037 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
17038 @end itemize
17039
17040 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
17041 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
17042
17043 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
17044 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
17045
17046 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
17047 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
17048 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
17049 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
17050 @quotation
17051 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
17052 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
17053 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
17054 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
17055 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
17056 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
17057 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
17058 code. @xref{Compilation}.
17059 @end quotation
17060
17061 @enumerate
17062
17063 @cindex member functions
17064 @item
17065 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
17066
17067 @smallexample
17068 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
17069 @end smallexample
17070
17071 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
17072 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
17073 @item
17074 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
17075 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
17076 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
17077 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
17078 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
17079
17080 @cindex call overloaded functions
17081 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
17082 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
17083 @item
17084 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
17085 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
17086 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
17087 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
17088 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
17089 default arguments.
17090
17091 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
17092 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
17093 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
17094 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
17095 number of function arguments.
17096
17097 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
17098 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
17099 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
17100
17101 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
17102 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
17103 @smallexample
17104 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
17105 @end smallexample
17106
17107 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
17108 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
17109
17110 @cindex reference declarations
17111 @item
17112 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
17113 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
17114 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
17115
17116 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
17117 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
17118 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
17119 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
17120 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
17121
17122 @item
17123 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
17124 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
17125 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
17126 necessary, for example in an expression like
17127 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
17128 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
17129 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
17130
17131 @item
17132 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
17133 specification.
17134 @end enumerate
17135
17136 @node C Defaults
17137 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
17138
17139 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
17140
17141 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
17142 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
17143 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
17144 selects the working language.
17145
17146 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
17147 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
17148 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
17149 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
17150 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
17151 for further details.
17152
17153 @node C Checks
17154 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
17155
17156 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
17157
17158 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
17159 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
17160 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
17161 constants to pointers.
17162
17163 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
17164 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
17165 that is not itself an array.
17166
17167 @node Debugging C
17168 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
17169
17170 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
17171 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
17172 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
17173 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
17174
17175 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
17176 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
17177 ,Expressions}.
17178
17179 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
17180 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
17181
17182 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
17183
17184 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
17185 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
17186
17187 @table @code
17188 @cindex break in overloaded functions
17189 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
17190 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
17191 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
17192 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
17193 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
17194
17195 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
17196 @item rbreak @var{regex}
17197 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
17198 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
17199 classes.
17200 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17201
17202 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
17203 @item catch throw
17204 @itemx catch rethrow
17205 @itemx catch catch
17206 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
17207 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
17208
17209 @cindex inheritance
17210 @item ptype @var{typename}
17211 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
17212 @var{typename}.
17213 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
17214
17215 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
17216 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
17217 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
17218 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
17219 multiple inheritance is in use.
17220
17221 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
17222 @item demangle @var{name}
17223 Demangle @var{name}.
17224 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
17225
17226 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
17227 @item set print demangle
17228 @itemx show print demangle
17229 @itemx set print asm-demangle
17230 @itemx show print asm-demangle
17231 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
17232 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
17233 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
17234
17235 @item set print object
17236 @itemx show print object
17237 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
17238 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
17239
17240 @item set print vtbl
17241 @itemx show print vtbl
17242 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
17243 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
17244 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
17245 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
17246
17247 @kindex set overload-resolution
17248 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
17249 @item set overload-resolution on
17250 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
17251 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
17252 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
17253 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
17254 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
17255 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
17256
17257 @item set overload-resolution off
17258 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
17259 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
17260 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
17261 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
17262 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
17263 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
17264 argument types.
17265
17266 @kindex show overload-resolution
17267 @item show overload-resolution
17268 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
17269
17270 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
17271 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
17272 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
17273 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
17274 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
17275 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
17276 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
17277
17278 @item @r{Breakpoints in template functions}
17279
17280 Similar to how overloaded symbols are handled, @value{GDBN} will ignore
17281 template parameter lists when it encounters a symbol which includes a
17282 C@t{++} template. This permits setting breakpoints on families of template functions
17283 or functions whose parameters include template types.
17284
17285 The @kbd{-qualified} flag may be used to override this behavior, causing
17286 @value{GDBN} to search for a specific function or type.
17287
17288 The @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facility also understands
17289 template parameters and may be used to list available choices or finish
17290 template parameter lists for you. @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for
17291 details on how to do this.
17292
17293 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
17294
17295 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
17296 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
17297 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
17298 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
17299 for more detail.
17300
17301 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
17302 function that returns a std::string:
17303
17304 @smallexample
17305 std::string function(int);
17306 @end smallexample
17307
17308 @noindent
17309 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
17310 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
17311
17312 @smallexample
17313 function[abi:cxx11](int)
17314 @end smallexample
17315
17316 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
17317 tag. For example:
17318
17319 @smallexample
17320 (@value{GDBP}) b function(int)
17321 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
17322 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
17323 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
17324 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
17325 at main.cc:10
17326 @end smallexample
17327
17328 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
17329 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
17330 name, like:
17331
17332 @smallexample
17333 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
17334 @end smallexample
17335 @end table
17336
17337 @node Decimal Floating Point
17338 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
17339 @cindex decimal floating point format
17340
17341 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
17342 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
17343 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
17344 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
17345
17346 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
17347 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
17348 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
17349 configured target.
17350
17351 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
17352 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
17353 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
17354
17355 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
17356 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
17357 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
17358
17359 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
17360 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
17361 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
17362
17363 @node D
17364 @subsection D
17365
17366 @cindex D
17367 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
17368 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
17369 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
17370
17371 @node Go
17372 @subsection Go
17373
17374 @cindex Go (programming language)
17375 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
17376 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
17377
17378 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
17379
17380 @table @code
17381 @cindex current Go package
17382 @item The current Go package
17383 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
17384 specifying global variables and functions.
17385
17386 For example, given the program:
17387
17388 @example
17389 package main
17390 var myglob = "Shall we?"
17391 func main () @{
17392 // ...
17393 @}
17394 @end example
17395
17396 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
17397
17398 @example
17399 (@value{GDBP}) p myglob
17400 (@value{GDBP}) p main.myglob
17401 @end example
17402
17403 @cindex builtin Go types
17404 @item Builtin Go types
17405 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
17406 as a string.
17407
17408 @cindex builtin Go functions
17409 @item Builtin Go functions
17410 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
17411 function and handles it internally.
17412
17413 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
17414 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
17415 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
17416 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
17417 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
17418 @end table
17419
17420 @node Objective-C
17421 @subsection Objective-C
17422
17423 @cindex Objective-C
17424 This section provides information about some commands and command
17425 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
17426 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
17427 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
17428
17429 @menu
17430 * Method Names in Commands::
17431 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
17432 @end menu
17433
17434 @node Method Names in Commands
17435 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
17436
17437 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
17438 names as line specifications:
17439
17440 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
17441 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
17442 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
17443 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
17444 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
17445 @itemize
17446 @item @code{clear}
17447 @item @code{break}
17448 @item @code{info line}
17449 @item @code{jump}
17450 @item @code{list}
17451 @end itemize
17452
17453 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
17454
17455 @smallexample
17456 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
17457 @end smallexample
17458
17459 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
17460 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
17461 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
17462 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
17463 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
17464 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
17465 debugged, enter:
17466
17467 @smallexample
17468 break -[Fruit create]
17469 @end smallexample
17470
17471 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
17472 enter:
17473
17474 @smallexample
17475 list +[NSText initialize]
17476 @end smallexample
17477
17478 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
17479 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
17480 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
17481 is also possible to specify just a method name:
17482
17483 @smallexample
17484 break create
17485 @end smallexample
17486
17487 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
17488 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
17489 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
17490 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
17491 none apply.
17492
17493 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
17494 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
17495
17496 @smallexample
17497 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
17498 @end smallexample
17499
17500 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
17501 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
17502 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
17503 @kindex print-object
17504 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
17505
17506 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
17507
17508 @smallexample
17509 print -[@var{object} hash]
17510 @end smallexample
17511
17512 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
17513 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
17514 @noindent
17515 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
17516 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
17517 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
17518 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
17519 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
17520 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
17521
17522 @node OpenCL C
17523 @subsection OpenCL C
17524
17525 @cindex OpenCL C
17526 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
17527
17528 @menu
17529 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
17530 * OpenCL C Expressions::
17531 * OpenCL C Operators::
17532 @end menu
17533
17534 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
17535 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
17536
17537 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
17538 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
17539 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
17540 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
17541 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
17542
17543 @node OpenCL C Expressions
17544 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
17545
17546 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
17547 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
17548 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
17549 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
17550
17551 @node OpenCL C Operators
17552 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
17553
17554 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
17555 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
17556 vector data types.
17557
17558 @node Fortran
17559 @subsection Fortran
17560 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
17561
17562 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran. Note, that not
17563 all Fortran language features are available yet.
17564
17565 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
17566 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
17567 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
17568 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
17569 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
17570 underscore.
17571
17572 @cindex Fortran Defaults
17573 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
17574 default uses case-insensitive matching for Fortran symbols. You can
17575 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
17576 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
17577
17578 @menu
17579 * Fortran Types:: Fortran builtin types
17580 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
17581 * Fortran Intrinsics:: Fortran intrinsic functions
17582 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
17583 @end menu
17584
17585 @node Fortran Types
17586 @subsubsection Fortran Types
17587
17588 @cindex Fortran Types
17589
17590 In Fortran the primitive data-types have an associated @code{KIND} type
17591 parameter, written as @samp{@var{type}*@var{kindparam}},
17592 @samp{@var{type}*@var{kindparam}}, or in the @value{GDBN}-only dialect
17593 @samp{@var{type}_@var{kindparam}}. A concrete example would be
17594 @samp{@code{Real*4}}, @samp{@code{Real(kind=4)}}, and @samp{@code{Real_4}}.
17595 The kind of a type can be retrieved by using the intrinsic function
17596 @code{KIND}, see @ref{Fortran Intrinsics}.
17597
17598 Generally, the actual implementation of the @code{KIND} type parameter is
17599 compiler specific. In @value{GDBN} the kind parameter is implemented in
17600 accordance with its use in the @sc{gnu} @command{gfortran} compiler. Here, the
17601 kind parameter for a given @var{type} specifies its size in memory --- a
17602 Fortran @code{Integer*4} or @code{Integer(kind=4)} would be an integer type
17603 occupying 4 bytes of memory. An exception to this rule is the @code{Complex}
17604 type for which the kind of the type does not specify its entire size, but
17605 the size of each of the two @code{Real}'s it is composed of. A
17606 @code{Complex*4} would thus consist of two @code{Real*4}s and occupy 8 bytes
17607 of memory.
17608
17609 For every type there is also a default kind associated with it, e.g.@
17610 @code{Integer} in @value{GDBN} will internally be an @code{Integer*4} (see the
17611 table below for default types). The default types are the same as in @sc{gnu}
17612 compilers but note, that the @sc{gnu} default types can actually be changed by
17613 compiler flags such as @option{-fdefault-integer-8} and
17614 @option{-fdefault-real-8}.
17615
17616 Not every kind parameter is valid for every type and in @value{GDBN} the
17617 following type kinds are available.
17618
17619 @table @code
17620 @item Integer
17621 @code{Integer*1}, @code{Integer*2}, @code{Integer*4}, @code{Integer*8}, and
17622 @code{Integer} = @code{Integer*4}.
17623
17624 @item Logical
17625 @code{Logical*1}, @code{Logical*2}, @code{Logical*4}, @code{Logical*8}, and
17626 @code{Logical} = @code{Logical*4}.
17627
17628 @item Real
17629 @code{Real*4}, @code{Real*8}, @code{Real*16}, and @code{Real} = @code{Real*4}.
17630
17631 @item Complex
17632 @code{Complex*4}, @code{Complex*8}, @code{Complex*16}, and @code{Complex} =
17633 @code{Complex*4}.
17634
17635 @end table
17636
17637 @node Fortran Operators
17638 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
17639
17640 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
17641
17642 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
17643 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
17644 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
17645
17646 @table @code
17647 @item **
17648 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
17649 of the second one.
17650
17651 @item :
17652 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
17653 represent a section of array.
17654
17655 @item %
17656 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
17657 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
17658 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
17659 union type.
17660 @item ::
17661 The scope operator. Normally used to access variables in modules or
17662 to set breakpoints on subroutines nested in modules or in other
17663 subroutines (internal subroutines).
17664 @end table
17665
17666 @node Fortran Intrinsics
17667 @subsubsection Fortran Intrinsics
17668
17669 @cindex Fortran Intrinsics
17670
17671 Fortran provides a large set of intrinsic procedures. @value{GDBN} implements
17672 an incomplete subset of those procedures and their overloads. Some of these
17673 procedures take an optional @code{KIND} parameter, see @ref{Fortran Types}.
17674
17675 @table @code
17676 @item ABS(@var{a})
17677 Computes the absolute value of its argument @var{a}. Currently not supported
17678 for @code{Complex} arguments.
17679
17680 @item ALLOCATE(@var{array})
17681 Returns whether @var{array} is allocated or not.
17682
17683 @item ASSOCIATED(@var{pointer} [, @var{target}])
17684 Returns the association status of the pointer @var{pointer} or, if @var{target}
17685 is present, whether @var{pointer} is associated with the target @var{target}.
17686
17687 @item CEILING(@var{a} [, @var{kind}])
17688 Computes the least integer greater than or equal to @var{a}. The optional
17689 parameter @var{kind} specifies the kind of the return type
17690 @code{Integer(@var{kind})}.
17691
17692 @item CMPLX(@var{x} [, @var{y} [, @var{kind}]])
17693 Returns a complex number where @var{x} is converted to the real component. If
17694 @var{y} is present it is converted to the imaginary component. If @var{y} is
17695 not present then the imaginary component is set to @code{0.0} except if @var{x}
17696 itself is of @code{Complex} type. The optional parameter @var{kind} specifies
17697 the kind of the return type @code{Complex(@var{kind})}.
17698
17699 @item FLOOR(@var{a} [, @var{kind}])
17700 Computes the greatest integer less than or equal to @var{a}. The optional
17701 parameter @var{kind} specifies the kind of the return type
17702 @code{Integer(@var{kind})}.
17703
17704 @item KIND(@var{a})
17705 Returns the kind value of the argument @var{a}, see @ref{Fortran Types}.
17706
17707 @item LBOUND(@var{array} [, @var{dim} [, @var{kind}]])
17708 Returns the lower bounds of an @var{array}, or a single lower bound along the
17709 @var{dim} dimension if present. The optional parameter @var{kind} specifies
17710 the kind of the return type @code{Integer(@var{kind})}.
17711
17712 @item LOC(@var{x})
17713 Returns the address of @var{x} as an @code{Integer}.
17714
17715 @item MOD(@var{a}, @var{p})
17716 Computes the remainder of the division of @var{a} by @var{p}.
17717
17718 @item MODULO(@var{a}, @var{p})
17719 Computes the @var{a} modulo @var{p}.
17720
17721 @item RANK(@var{a})
17722 Returns the rank of a scalar or array (scalars have rank @code{0}).
17723
17724 @item SHAPE(@var{a})
17725 Returns the shape of a scalar or array (scalars have shape @samp{()}).
17726
17727 @item SIZE(@var{array}[, @var{dim} [, @var{kind}]])
17728 Returns the extent of @var{array} along a specified dimension @var{dim}, or the
17729 total number of elements in @var{array} if @var{dim} is absent. The optional
17730 parameter @var{kind} specifies the kind of the return type
17731 @code{Integer(@var{kind})}.
17732
17733 @item UBOUND(@var{array} [, @var{dim} [, @var{kind}]])
17734 Returns the upper bounds of an @var{array}, or a single upper bound along the
17735 @var{dim} dimension if present. The optional parameter @var{kind} specifies
17736 the kind of the return type @code{Integer(@var{kind})}.
17737
17738 @end table
17739
17740 @node Special Fortran Commands
17741 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
17742
17743 @cindex Special Fortran commands
17744
17745 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
17746 such as displaying common blocks.
17747
17748 @table @code
17749 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
17750 @kindex info common
17751 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
17752 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
17753 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
17754 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
17755 printed.
17756 @cindex arrays slices (Fortran)
17757 @kindex set fortran repack-array-slices
17758 @kindex show fortran repack-array-slices
17759 @item set fortran repack-array-slices [on|off]
17760 @item show fortran repack-array-slices
17761 When taking a slice from an array, a Fortran compiler can choose to
17762 either produce an array descriptor that describes the slice in place,
17763 or it may repack the slice, copying the elements of the slice into a
17764 new region of memory.
17765
17766 When this setting is on, then @value{GDBN} will also repack array
17767 slices in some situations. When this setting is off, then
17768 @value{GDBN} will create array descriptors for slices that reference
17769 the original data in place.
17770
17771 @value{GDBN} will never repack an array slice if the data for the
17772 slice is contiguous within the original array.
17773
17774 @value{GDBN} will always repack string slices if the data for the
17775 slice is non-contiguous within the original string as @value{GDBN}
17776 does not support printing non-contiguous strings.
17777
17778 The default for this setting is @code{off}.
17779 @end table
17780
17781 @node Pascal
17782 @subsection Pascal
17783
17784 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
17785 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
17786 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
17787 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
17788 syntax.
17789
17790 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
17791 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
17792 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
17793
17794 @node Rust
17795 @subsection Rust
17796
17797 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
17798 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
17799 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
17800 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
17801
17802 @itemize @bullet
17803 @item
17804 Linespecs (@pxref{Location Specifications}) are never relative to the
17805 current crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace
17806 of crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
17807
17808 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
17809 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
17810 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
17811 @samp{B}.
17812
17813 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
17814 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
17815
17816 @item
17817 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
17818 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
17819 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
17820 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
17821 @samp{K::x::y}.
17822
17823 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
17824 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
17825 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
17826 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
17827 scope.
17828
17829 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
17830 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
17831
17832 @item
17833 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
17834 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
17835
17836 @item
17837 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
17838
17839 @item
17840 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
17841 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
17842 never be destroyed.
17843
17844 @item
17845 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
17846 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
17847 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
17848
17849 @item
17850 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
17851 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
17852 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
17853 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
17854 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
17855 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
17856 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
17857 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
17858
17859 @item
17860 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
17861 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
17862 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
17863 @itemize @bullet
17864
17865 @item
17866 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
17867
17868 @item
17869 Operator overloading is not implemented.
17870
17871 @item
17872 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
17873 type names.
17874
17875 @item
17876 The type @code{Self} is not available.
17877
17878 @item
17879 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
17880 available in the crate.
17881 @end itemize
17882 @end itemize
17883
17884 @node Modula-2
17885 @subsection Modula-2
17886
17887 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
17888
17889 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
17890 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
17891 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
17892 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
17893 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
17894 table.
17895
17896 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
17897 @menu
17898 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
17899 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
17900 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
17901 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
17902 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
17903 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
17904 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
17905 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
17906 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
17907 @end menu
17908
17909 @node M2 Operators
17910 @subsubsection Operators
17911 @cindex Modula-2 operators
17912
17913 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
17914 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
17915 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
17916 following definitions hold:
17917
17918 @itemize @bullet
17919
17920 @item
17921 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
17922 their subranges.
17923
17924 @item
17925 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
17926
17927 @item
17928 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
17929
17930 @item
17931 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
17932 @var{type}}.
17933
17934 @item
17935 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
17936
17937 @item
17938 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
17939
17940 @item
17941 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
17942 @end itemize
17943
17944 @noindent
17945 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
17946 increasing precedence:
17947
17948 @table @code
17949 @item ,
17950 Function argument or array index separator.
17951
17952 @item :=
17953 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
17954 @var{value}.
17955
17956 @item <@r{, }>
17957 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
17958 types.
17959
17960 @item <=@r{, }>=
17961 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
17962 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
17963 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
17964
17965 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
17966 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
17967 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
17968 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
17969 comment character.
17970
17971 @item IN
17972 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
17973 Same precedence as @code{<}.
17974
17975 @item OR
17976 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
17977
17978 @item AND@r{, }&
17979 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
17980
17981 @item @@
17982 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
17983
17984 @item +@r{, }-
17985 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
17986 and difference on set types.
17987
17988 @item *
17989 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
17990 on set types.
17991
17992 @item /
17993 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
17994 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
17995
17996 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
17997 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
17998 precedence as @code{*}.
17999
18000 @item -
18001 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
18002
18003 @item ^
18004 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
18005
18006 @item NOT
18007 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
18008 @code{^}.
18009
18010 @item .
18011 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
18012 precedence as @code{^}.
18013
18014 @item []
18015 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
18016
18017 @item ()
18018 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
18019 as @code{^}.
18020
18021 @item ::@r{, }.
18022 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
18023 @end table
18024
18025 @quotation
18026 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
18027 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
18028 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
18029 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
18030 @end quotation
18031
18032
18033 @node Built-In Func/Proc
18034 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
18035 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
18036
18037 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
18038 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
18039
18040 @table @var
18041
18042 @item a
18043 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
18044
18045 @item c
18046 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
18047
18048 @item i
18049 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
18050
18051 @item m
18052 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
18053 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
18054 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
18055
18056 @item n
18057 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
18058
18059 @item r
18060 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
18061
18062 @item t
18063 represents a type.
18064
18065 @item v
18066 represents a variable.
18067
18068 @item x
18069 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
18070 explanation of the function for details.
18071 @end table
18072
18073 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
18074
18075 @table @code
18076 @item ABS(@var{n})
18077 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
18078
18079 @item CAP(@var{c})
18080 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
18081 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
18082
18083 @item CHR(@var{i})
18084 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
18085
18086 @item DEC(@var{v})
18087 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
18088
18089 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
18090 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
18091 new value.
18092
18093 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
18094 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
18095 set.
18096
18097 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
18098 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
18099
18100 @item HIGH(@var{a})
18101 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
18102
18103 @item INC(@var{v})
18104 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
18105
18106 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
18107 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
18108 new value.
18109
18110 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
18111 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
18112 there. Returns the new set.
18113
18114 @item MAX(@var{t})
18115 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
18116
18117 @item MIN(@var{t})
18118 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
18119
18120 @item ODD(@var{i})
18121 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
18122
18123 @item ORD(@var{x})
18124 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
18125 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
18126 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
18127 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
18128
18129 @item SIZE(@var{x})
18130 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
18131 variable or a type.
18132
18133 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
18134 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
18135
18136 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
18137 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
18138 variable or a type.
18139
18140 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
18141 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
18142 @end table
18143
18144 @quotation
18145 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
18146 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
18147 an error.
18148 @end quotation
18149
18150 @cindex Modula-2 constants
18151 @node M2 Constants
18152 @subsubsection Constants
18153
18154 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
18155 ways:
18156
18157 @itemize @bullet
18158
18159 @item
18160 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
18161 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
18162 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
18163 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
18164
18165 @item
18166 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
18167 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
18168 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
18169 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
18170 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
18171 digits.
18172
18173 @item
18174 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
18175 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
18176 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
18177 followed by a @samp{C}.
18178
18179 @item
18180 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
18181 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
18182 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
18183 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
18184 sequences.
18185
18186 @item
18187 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
18188
18189 @item
18190 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
18191 @code{FALSE}.
18192
18193 @item
18194 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
18195
18196 @item
18197 Set constants are not yet supported.
18198 @end itemize
18199
18200 @node M2 Types
18201 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
18202 @cindex Modula-2 types
18203
18204 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
18205 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
18206 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
18207 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
18208 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
18209 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
18210
18211 The first example contains the following section of code:
18212
18213 @smallexample
18214 VAR
18215 s: SET OF CHAR ;
18216 r: [20..40] ;
18217 @end smallexample
18218
18219 @noindent
18220 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
18221 @code{r} and @code{s}.
18222
18223 @smallexample
18224 (@value{GDBP}) print s
18225 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
18226 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
18227 SET OF CHAR
18228 (@value{GDBP}) print r
18229 21
18230 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
18231 [20..40]
18232 @end smallexample
18233
18234 @noindent
18235 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
18236
18237 @smallexample
18238 VAR
18239 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
18240 @end smallexample
18241
18242 @noindent
18243 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
18244
18245 @smallexample
18246 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
18247 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
18248 @end smallexample
18249
18250 @noindent
18251 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
18252 expressions using the debugger.
18253
18254 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
18255 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
18256
18257 @smallexample
18258 VAR
18259 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
18260 @end smallexample
18261
18262 @smallexample
18263 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
18264 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
18265 @end smallexample
18266
18267 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
18268 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
18269 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
18270 above.
18271
18272 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
18273
18274 @smallexample
18275 TYPE
18276 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
18277 t = [blue..yellow] ;
18278 VAR
18279 s: t ;
18280 BEGIN
18281 s := blue ;
18282 @end smallexample
18283
18284 @noindent
18285 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
18286 and value of a variable.
18287
18288 @smallexample
18289 (@value{GDBP}) print s
18290 $1 = blue
18291 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
18292 type = [blue..yellow]
18293 @end smallexample
18294
18295 @noindent
18296 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
18297 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
18298 their @code{C} counterparts.
18299
18300 @smallexample
18301 VAR
18302 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
18303 BEGIN
18304 s[1] := 1 ;
18305 @end smallexample
18306
18307 @smallexample
18308 (@value{GDBP}) print s
18309 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
18310 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
18311 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
18312 @end smallexample
18313
18314 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
18315 pointer types as shown in this example:
18316
18317 @smallexample
18318 VAR
18319 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
18320 BEGIN
18321 NEW(s) ;
18322 s^[1] := 1 ;
18323 @end smallexample
18324
18325 @noindent
18326 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
18327
18328 @smallexample
18329 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
18330 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
18331 @end smallexample
18332
18333 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
18334 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
18335 types:
18336
18337 @smallexample
18338 TYPE
18339 foo = RECORD
18340 f1: CARDINAL ;
18341 f2: CHAR ;
18342 f3: myarray ;
18343 END ;
18344
18345 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
18346 myrange = [-2..2] ;
18347 VAR
18348 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
18349 @end smallexample
18350
18351 @noindent
18352 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
18353 below.
18354
18355 @smallexample
18356 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
18357 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
18358 f1 : CARDINAL;
18359 f2 : CHAR;
18360 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
18361 END
18362 @end smallexample
18363
18364 @node M2 Defaults
18365 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
18366 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
18367
18368 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
18369 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
18370 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
18371 selected the working language.
18372
18373 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
18374 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
18375 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
18376 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
18377
18378 @node Deviations
18379 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
18380 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
18381
18382 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
18383 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
18384
18385 @itemize @bullet
18386 @item
18387 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
18388 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
18389 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
18390 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
18391 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
18392 returned a pointer.)
18393
18394 @item
18395 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
18396 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
18397 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
18398 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
18399
18400 @item
18401 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
18402 argument.
18403
18404 @item
18405 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
18406 @end itemize
18407
18408 @node M2 Checks
18409 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
18410 @cindex Modula-2 checks
18411
18412 @quotation
18413 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
18414 range checking.
18415 @end quotation
18416 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
18417
18418 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
18419
18420 @itemize @bullet
18421 @item
18422 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
18423 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
18424
18425 @item
18426 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
18427 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
18428 @end itemize
18429
18430 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
18431 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
18432
18433 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
18434 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
18435
18436 @node M2 Scope
18437 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
18438 @cindex scope
18439 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
18440 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
18441 @ifinfo
18442 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
18443 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
18444 @end ifinfo
18445 @ifnotinfo
18446 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
18447 @end ifnotinfo
18448
18449 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
18450 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
18451 similar syntax:
18452
18453 @smallexample
18454
18455 @var{module} . @var{id}
18456 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
18457 @end smallexample
18458
18459 @noindent
18460 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
18461 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
18462 identifier within your program, except another module.
18463
18464 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
18465 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
18466 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
18467 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
18468
18469 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
18470 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
18471 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
18472 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
18473 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
18474 @var{module}.
18475
18476 @node GDB/M2
18477 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
18478
18479 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
18480 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
18481 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
18482 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
18483 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
18484 analogue in Modula-2.
18485
18486 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
18487 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
18488 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
18489 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
18490 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
18491 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
18492
18493 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
18494 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
18495 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
18496
18497 @node Ada
18498 @subsection Ada
18499 @cindex Ada
18500
18501 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
18502 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
18503 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
18504 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
18505 to be difficult.
18506
18507
18508 @cindex expressions in Ada
18509 @menu
18510 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
18511 and semantics supported by Ada mode
18512 in @value{GDBN}.
18513 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
18514 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
18515 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
18516 subprograms.
18517 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
18518 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
18519 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
18520 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
18521 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
18522 Profile
18523 * Ada Source Character Set:: Character set of Ada source files.
18524 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
18525 @end menu
18526
18527 @node Ada Mode Intro
18528 @subsubsection Introduction
18529 @cindex Ada mode, general
18530
18531 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
18532 syntax, with some extensions.
18533 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
18534
18535 @itemize @bullet
18536 @item
18537 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
18538 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
18539 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
18540 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
18541
18542 @item
18543 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
18544 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
18545
18546 @item
18547 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
18548 @end itemize
18549
18550 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
18551 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
18552 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
18553 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
18554 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
18555
18556 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
18557 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
18558 was translated from an Ada source file.
18559
18560 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
18561 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
18562 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
18563 middle (to allow based literals).
18564
18565 @node Omissions from Ada
18566 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
18567 @cindex Ada, omissions from
18568
18569 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
18570
18571 @itemize @bullet
18572 @item
18573 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
18574
18575 @itemize @minus
18576 @item
18577 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
18578 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
18579
18580 @item
18581 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
18582
18583 @item
18584 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
18585
18586 @item
18587 @t{'Tag}.
18588
18589 @item
18590 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
18591 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
18592
18593 @item
18594 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
18595 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
18596
18597 @item
18598 @t{'Address}.
18599 @end itemize
18600
18601 @item
18602 The names in @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available.
18603
18604 @item
18605 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
18606 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
18607 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
18608 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
18609 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
18610 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
18611 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
18612 indeterminate values.
18613
18614 @item
18615 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
18616 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
18617 are not implemented.
18618
18619 @item
18620 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
18621 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
18622 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
18623 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
18624 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
18625
18626 @smallexample
18627 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
18628 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
18629 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
18630 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
18631 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
18632 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
18633 @end smallexample
18634
18635 Changing a
18636 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
18637 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
18638 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
18639 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
18640 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
18641 declared to have a type such as:
18642
18643 @smallexample
18644 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
18645 Id : Integer;
18646 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
18647 end record;
18648 @end smallexample
18649
18650 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
18651 assignments:
18652
18653 @smallexample
18654 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
18655 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
18656 @end smallexample
18657
18658 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
18659 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
18660 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
18661 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
18662 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
18663 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
18664 redundant component associations, although which component values are
18665 assigned in such cases is not defined.
18666
18667 @item
18668 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
18669
18670 @item
18671 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
18672 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
18673 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
18674 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
18675 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
18676 the proper resolution.
18677
18678 @item
18679 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
18680
18681 @item
18682 Entry calls are not implemented.
18683
18684 @item
18685 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
18686 formats are not supported.
18687
18688 @item
18689 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
18690
18691 @item
18692 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
18693 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
18694 context.
18695 Should your program
18696 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
18697 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
18698
18699 @item
18700 Based real literals are not implemented.
18701 @end itemize
18702
18703 @node Additions to Ada
18704 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
18705 @cindex Ada, deviations from
18706
18707 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
18708 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
18709
18710 @itemize @bullet
18711 @item
18712 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
18713 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
18714 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
18715 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
18716 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
18717 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
18718 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
18719 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
18720
18721 @item
18722 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
18723 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
18724 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
18725
18726 @item
18727 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
18728 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
18729
18730 @item
18731 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
18732 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
18733 @end itemize
18734
18735 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
18736 additions specific to Ada:
18737
18738 @itemize @bullet
18739 @item
18740 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
18741 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
18742
18743 @smallexample
18744 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
18745 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
18746 @end smallexample
18747
18748 @item
18749 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
18750 the value of its right-hand operand.
18751 This allows, for example,
18752 complex conditional breaks:
18753
18754 @smallexample
18755 (@value{GDBP}) break f
18756 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
18757 @end smallexample
18758
18759 @item
18760 An extension to based literals can be used to specify the exact byte
18761 contents of a floating-point literal. After the base, you can use
18762 from zero to two @samp{l} characters, followed by an @samp{f}. The
18763 number of @samp{l} characters controls the width of the resulting real
18764 constant: zero means @code{Float} is used, one means
18765 @code{Long_Float}, and two means @code{Long_Long_Float}.
18766
18767 @smallexample
18768 (@value{GDBP}) print 16f#41b80000#
18769 $1 = 23.0
18770 @end smallexample
18771
18772 @item
18773 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
18774 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
18775 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
18776 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
18777 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
18778 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
18779 in strings. For example,
18780 @smallexample
18781 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
18782 @end smallexample
18783 @noindent
18784 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
18785 after each period.
18786
18787 @item
18788 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
18789 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
18790 to write
18791
18792 @smallexample
18793 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
18794 @end smallexample
18795
18796 @item
18797 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
18798 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
18799 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
18800 of 3 might print as
18801
18802 @smallexample
18803 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
18804 @end smallexample
18805
18806 @noindent
18807 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
18808 clause.
18809
18810 @item
18811 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
18812 multi-character subsequence of
18813 their names (an exact match gets preference).
18814 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
18815 in place of @t{a'length}.
18816
18817 @item
18818 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
18819 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
18820 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
18821 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
18822 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
18823 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
18824 For example,
18825 @smallexample
18826 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
18827 @end smallexample
18828
18829 @item
18830 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
18831 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
18832 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
18833 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
18834 object.
18835
18836 @end itemize
18837
18838 @node Overloading support for Ada
18839 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
18840 @cindex overloading, Ada
18841
18842 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
18843 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
18844 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
18845 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
18846 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
18847 functions to procedures elsewhere.
18848
18849 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
18850 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
18851 use, for instance:
18852
18853 @smallexample
18854 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
18855 Multiple matches for f
18856 [0] cancel
18857 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
18858 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
18859 >
18860 @end smallexample
18861
18862 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
18863 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
18864 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
18865
18866 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
18867 case:
18868
18869 @table @code
18870
18871 @kindex set ada print-signatures
18872 @item set ada print-signatures
18873 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
18874 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
18875 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
18876
18877 @kindex show ada print-signatures
18878 @item show ada print-signatures
18879 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
18880 overloads selection menu.
18881 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
18882
18883 @end table
18884
18885 @node Stopping Before Main Program
18886 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
18887
18888 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
18889 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
18890 before reaching the main procedure.
18891 As defined in the Ada Reference
18892 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
18893 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
18894 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
18895 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
18896
18897 @node Ada Exceptions
18898 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
18899
18900 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
18901
18902 @table @code
18903 @kindex info exceptions
18904 @item info exceptions
18905 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
18906 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
18907 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
18908 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
18909 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
18910 @end table
18911
18912 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
18913 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
18914 argument.
18915
18916 @smallexample
18917 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
18918 All defined Ada exceptions:
18919 constraint_error: 0x613da0
18920 program_error: 0x613d20
18921 storage_error: 0x613ce0
18922 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
18923 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
18924 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
18925 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
18926 constraint_error: 0x613da0
18927 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
18928 @end smallexample
18929
18930 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
18931 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
18932
18933 @node Ada Tasks
18934 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
18935 @cindex Ada, tasking
18936
18937 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
18938 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
18939
18940 @table @code
18941 @kindex info tasks
18942 @item info tasks
18943 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
18944
18945
18946 @smallexample
18947 @iftex
18948 @leftskip=0.5cm
18949 @end iftex
18950 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
18951 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
18952 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
18953 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
18954 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
18955 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
18956
18957 @end smallexample
18958
18959 @noindent
18960 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
18961 task currently being inspected.
18962
18963 @table @asis
18964 @item ID
18965 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
18966
18967 @item TID
18968 The Ada task ID.
18969
18970 @item P-ID
18971 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
18972
18973 @item Pri
18974 The base priority of the task.
18975
18976 @item State
18977 Current state of the task.
18978
18979 @table @code
18980 @item Unactivated
18981 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
18982 executing.
18983
18984 @item Runnable
18985 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
18986 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
18987
18988 @item Terminated
18989 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
18990 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
18991 terminated themselves.
18992
18993 @item Child Activation Wait
18994 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
18995
18996 @item Accept or Select Term
18997 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
18998
18999 @item Waiting on entry call
19000 The task is waiting on an entry call.
19001
19002 @item Async Select Wait
19003 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
19004 select statement.
19005
19006 @item Delay Sleep
19007 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
19008 alternative open.
19009
19010 @item Child Termination Wait
19011 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
19012 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
19013 waiting on a terminate Phase.
19014
19015 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
19016 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
19017 finish terminating.
19018
19019 @item Asynchronous Hold
19020 The task has been held by @code{Ada.Asynchronous_Task_Control.Hold_Task}.
19021
19022 @item Activating
19023 The task has been created and is being made runnable.
19024
19025 @item Selective Wait
19026 The task is waiting in a selective wait statement.
19027
19028 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
19029 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
19030
19031 @item Waiting on RV with @var{taskno}
19032 The task is waiting for a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
19033 @end table
19034
19035 @item Name
19036 Name of the task in the program.
19037
19038 @end table
19039
19040 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
19041 @item info task @var{taskno}
19042 This command shows detailed informations on the specified task, as in
19043 the following example:
19044 @smallexample
19045 @iftex
19046 @leftskip=0.5cm
19047 @end iftex
19048 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
19049 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
19050 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
19051 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
19052 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
19053 Ada Task: 0x807c468
19054 Name: "task_1"
19055 Thread: 0
19056 LWP: 0x1fac
19057 Parent: 1 ("main_task")
19058 Base Priority: 15
19059 State: Runnable
19060 @end smallexample
19061
19062 @item task
19063 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
19064 @cindex current Ada task ID
19065 This command prints the ID and name of the current task.
19066
19067 @smallexample
19068 @iftex
19069 @leftskip=0.5cm
19070 @end iftex
19071 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
19072 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
19073 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
19074 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable some_task
19075 (@value{GDBP}) task
19076 [Current task is 2 "some_task"]
19077 @end smallexample
19078
19079 @item task @var{taskno}
19080 @cindex Ada task switching
19081 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
19082 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
19083 from the current task to the given task.
19084
19085 @smallexample
19086 @iftex
19087 @leftskip=0.5cm
19088 @end iftex
19089 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
19090 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
19091 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
19092 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable some_task
19093 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
19094 [Switching to task 1 "main_task"]
19095 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
19096 (@value{GDBP}) bt
19097 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
19098 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
19099 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
19100 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
19101 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
19102 @end smallexample
19103
19104 @item task apply [@var{task-id-list} | all] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
19105 The @code{task apply} command is the Ada tasking analogue of
19106 @code{thread apply} (@pxref{Threads}). It allows you to apply the
19107 named @var{command} to one or more tasks. Specify the tasks that you
19108 want affected using a list of task IDs, or specify @code{all} to apply
19109 to all tasks.
19110
19111 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to
19112 handle errors raised when applying @var{command} to a task.
19113 @var{flag} must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter
19114 in @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
19115 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
19116
19117 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some task information before the
19118 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
19119 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{task apply}. The
19120 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
19121
19122 @table @code
19123 @item -c
19124 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
19125 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
19126 @code{task apply} then continues.
19127 @item -s
19128 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
19129 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
19130 That is, the execution continues, but the task information and errors
19131 are not printed.
19132 @item -q
19133 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the task
19134 information.
19135 @end table
19136
19137 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
19138
19139 @item break @var{locspec} task @var{taskno}
19140 @itemx break @var{locspec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
19141 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
19142 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
19143 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
19144 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
19145 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). @xref{Location Specifications}, for
19146 the various forms of @var{locspec}.
19147
19148 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
19149 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
19150 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
19151 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
19152 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
19153
19154 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
19155 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
19156 program.
19157
19158 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
19159 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
19160 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
19161
19162 For example,
19163
19164 @smallexample
19165 @iftex
19166 @leftskip=0.5cm
19167 @end iftex
19168 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
19169 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
19170 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
19171 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
19172 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
19173 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
19174 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
19175 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
19176 (@value{GDBP}) cont
19177 Continuing.
19178 task # 1 running
19179 task # 2 running
19180
19181 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
19182 15 flush;
19183 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
19184 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
19185 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
19186 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
19187 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
19188 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
19189 @end smallexample
19190 @end table
19191
19192 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
19193 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
19194 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
19195
19196 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
19197 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
19198 the platform being used.
19199 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
19200 switching is not supported.
19201
19202 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
19203 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
19204 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
19205 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
19206 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
19207 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
19208
19209 @node Ravenscar Profile
19210 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
19211 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
19212
19213 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
19214 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
19215 requirements.
19216
19217 @table @code
19218 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
19219 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
19220 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
19221 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
19222 Profile. This is the default.
19223
19224 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
19225 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
19226 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
19227 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
19228 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
19229 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
19230 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
19231
19232 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
19233 @item show ravenscar task-switching
19234 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
19235 using the Ravenscar Profile.
19236
19237 @end table
19238
19239 @cindex Ravenscar thread
19240 When Ravenscar task-switching is enabled, Ravenscar tasks are
19241 announced by @value{GDBN} as if they were threads:
19242
19243 @smallexample
19244 (gdb) continue
19245 [New Ravenscar Thread 0x2b8f0]
19246 @end smallexample
19247
19248 Both Ravenscar tasks and the underlying CPU threads will show up in
19249 the output of @code{info threads}:
19250
19251 @smallexample
19252 (gdb) info threads
19253 Id Target Id Frame
19254 1 Thread 1 (CPU#0 [running]) simple () at simple.adb:10
19255 2 Thread 2 (CPU#1 [running]) 0x0000000000003d34 in __gnat_initialize_cpu_devices ()
19256 3 Thread 3 (CPU#2 [running]) 0x0000000000003d28 in __gnat_initialize_cpu_devices ()
19257 4 Thread 4 (CPU#3 [halted ]) 0x000000000000c6ec in system.task_primitives.operations.idle ()
19258 * 5 Ravenscar Thread 0x2b8f0 simple () at simple.adb:10
19259 6 Ravenscar Thread 0x2f150 0x000000000000c6ec in system.task_primitives.operations.idle ()
19260 @end smallexample
19261
19262 One known limitation of the Ravenscar support in @value{GDBN} is that
19263 it isn't currently possible to single-step through the runtime
19264 initialization sequence. If you need to debug this code, you should
19265 use @code{set ravenscar task-switching off}.
19266
19267 @node Ada Source Character Set
19268 @subsubsection Ada Source Character Set
19269 @cindex Ada, source character set
19270
19271 The GNAT compiler supports a number of character sets for source
19272 files. @xref{Character Set Control, , Character Set Control,
19273 gnat_ugn}. @value{GDBN} includes support for this as well.
19274
19275 @table @code
19276 @item set ada source-charset @var{charset}
19277 @kindex set ada source-charset
19278 Set the source character set for Ada. The character set must be
19279 supported by GNAT. Because this setting affects the decoding of
19280 symbols coming from the debug information in your program, the setting
19281 should be set as early as possible. The default is @code{ISO-8859-1},
19282 because that is also GNAT's default.
19283
19284 @item show ada source-charset
19285 @kindex show ada source-charset
19286 Show the current source character set for Ada.
19287 @end table
19288
19289 @node Ada Glitches
19290 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
19291 @cindex Ada, problems
19292
19293 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
19294 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
19295 @value{GDBN},
19296 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
19297 and the GNU Ada compiler.
19298
19299 @itemize @bullet
19300 @item
19301 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
19302 storage are invisible to the debugger.
19303
19304 @item
19305 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
19306 argument lists are treated as positional).
19307
19308 @item
19309 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
19310
19311 @item
19312 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
19313 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
19314 the host machine.
19315
19316 @item
19317 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
19318 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
19319 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
19320 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
19321 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
19322 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
19323 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
19324 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
19325 you can usually resolve the confusion
19326 by qualifying the problematic names with package
19327 @code{Standard} explicitly.
19328 @end itemize
19329
19330 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
19331 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
19332 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
19333 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
19334 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
19335 enabled.
19336
19337 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
19338 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
19339 @table @code
19340
19341 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
19342 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
19343 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
19344 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
19345 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
19346 This is the default.
19347
19348 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
19349 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
19350 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
19351 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
19352 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
19353 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
19354 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
19355
19356 @end table
19357
19358 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
19359 @cindex GNAT encoding
19360 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
19361 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
19362 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
19363 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
19364 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
19365 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
19366
19367 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
19368 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
19369 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
19370 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
19371 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
19372 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
19373 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
19374 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
19375
19376 @table @code
19377
19378 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
19379 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
19380 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
19381 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
19382
19383 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
19384 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
19385 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
19386
19387 @end table
19388
19389 @node Unsupported Languages
19390 @section Unsupported Languages
19391
19392 @cindex unsupported languages
19393 @cindex minimal language
19394 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
19395 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
19396 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
19397 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
19398 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
19399 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
19400
19401 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
19402 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
19403 language.
19404
19405 @node Symbols
19406 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
19407
19408 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
19409 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
19410 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
19411 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
19412 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
19413 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
19414 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19415
19416 @cindex symbol names
19417 @cindex names of symbols
19418 @cindex quoting names
19419 @anchor{quoting names}
19420 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
19421 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
19422 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
19423 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
19424 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
19425 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
19426 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
19427 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
19428
19429 @smallexample
19430 p 'foo.c'::x
19431 @end smallexample
19432
19433 @noindent
19434 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
19435
19436 @table @code
19437 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
19438 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
19439 @kindex set case-sensitive
19440 @item set case-sensitive on
19441 @itemx set case-sensitive off
19442 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
19443 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
19444 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
19445 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
19446 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
19447 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
19448 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
19449 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
19450 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
19451 case-insensitive matches.
19452
19453 @kindex show case-sensitive
19454 @item show case-sensitive
19455 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
19456 lookups.
19457
19458 @kindex set print type methods
19459 @item set print type methods
19460 @itemx set print type methods on
19461 @itemx set print type methods off
19462 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
19463 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
19464 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
19465 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
19466 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
19467 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
19468
19469 @kindex show print type methods
19470 @item show print type methods
19471 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
19472 classes.
19473
19474 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
19475 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
19476 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
19477 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
19478 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
19479 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
19480 types defined in classes.
19481
19482 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
19483 @item show print type nested-type-limit
19484 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
19485 printing classes.
19486
19487 @kindex set print type typedefs
19488 @item set print type typedefs
19489 @itemx set print type typedefs on
19490 @itemx set print type typedefs off
19491
19492 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
19493 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
19494 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
19495 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
19496 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
19497 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
19498 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
19499 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
19500 types.
19501
19502 @kindex show print type typedefs
19503 @item show print type typedefs
19504 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
19505 printing classes.
19506
19507 @kindex set print type hex
19508 @item set print type hex
19509 @itemx set print type hex on
19510 @itemx set print type hex off
19511
19512 When @value{GDBN} prints sizes and offsets of struct members, it can use
19513 either the decimal or hexadecimal notation. You can select one or the
19514 other either by passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or by using
19515 the @command{set print type hex} command.
19516
19517 @kindex show print type hex
19518 @item show print type hex
19519 This command shows whether the sizes and offsets of struct members are
19520 printed in decimal or hexadecimal notation.
19521
19522 @kindex info address
19523 @cindex address of a symbol
19524 @item info address @var{symbol}
19525 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
19526 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
19527 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
19528 is always stored.
19529
19530 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
19531 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
19532 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
19533
19534 @kindex info symbol
19535 @cindex symbol from address
19536 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
19537 @item info symbol @var{addr}
19538 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
19539 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
19540 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
19541
19542 @smallexample
19543 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
19544 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
19545 @end smallexample
19546
19547 @noindent
19548 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
19549 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
19550
19551 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
19552 library containing the symbol is also printed:
19553
19554 @smallexample
19555 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
19556 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
19557 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
19558 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
19559 @end smallexample
19560
19561 @kindex demangle
19562 @cindex demangle
19563 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
19564 Demangle @var{name}.
19565 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
19566 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
19567
19568 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
19569 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
19570
19571 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
19572 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
19573
19574 @kindex whatis
19575 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
19576 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
19577 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
19578 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
19579
19580 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
19581 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
19582 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
19583
19584 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
19585 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
19586 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
19587 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
19588 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
19589 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
19590 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
19591 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
19592 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
19593
19594 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
19595 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
19596 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
19597 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
19598 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
19599 unroll it.
19600
19601 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
19602 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
19603 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
19604
19605 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
19606 Available flags are:
19607
19608 @table @code
19609 @item r
19610 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
19611 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
19612 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
19613
19614 @item m
19615 Do not print methods defined in the class.
19616
19617 @item M
19618 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
19619 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
19620
19621 @item t
19622 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
19623 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
19624 names are substituted when printing other types.
19625
19626 @item T
19627 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
19628 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
19629
19630 @item o
19631 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
19632 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
19633
19634 @item x
19635 Use hexadecimal notation when printing offsets and sizes of fields in a
19636 struct.
19637
19638 @item d
19639 Use decimal notation when printing offsets and sizes of fields in a
19640 struct.
19641
19642 For example, given the following declarations:
19643
19644 @smallexample
19645 struct tuv
19646 @{
19647 int a1;
19648 char *a2;
19649 int a3;
19650 @};
19651
19652 struct xyz
19653 @{
19654 int f1;
19655 char f2;
19656 void *f3;
19657 struct tuv f4;
19658 @};
19659
19660 union qwe
19661 @{
19662 struct tuv fff1;
19663 struct xyz fff2;
19664 @};
19665
19666 struct tyu
19667 @{
19668 int a1 : 1;
19669 int a2 : 3;
19670 int a3 : 23;
19671 char a4 : 2;
19672 int64_t a5;
19673 int a6 : 5;
19674 int64_t a7 : 3;
19675 @};
19676 @end smallexample
19677
19678 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
19679
19680 @smallexample
19681 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
19682 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
19683 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
19684 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
19685 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
19686 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
19687
19688 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
19689 @}
19690 @end smallexample
19691
19692 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
19693 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
19694 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
19695 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
19696 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
19697 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
19698 its fields.
19699
19700 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
19701
19702 @smallexample
19703 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
19704 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
19705 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
19706 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
19707 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
19708 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
19709 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
19710
19711 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
19712 @} fff1;
19713 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
19714 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
19715 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
19716 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
19717 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
19718 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
19719 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
19720 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
19721 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
19722 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
19723
19724 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
19725 @} f4;
19726
19727 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
19728 @} fff2;
19729
19730 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
19731 @}
19732 @end smallexample
19733
19734 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
19735 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
19736 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
19737 of these structures' fields.
19738
19739 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
19740 bitfields:
19741
19742 @smallexample
19743 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
19744 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
19745 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
19746 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
19747 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
19748 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
19749 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
19750 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
19751 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
19752 /* 16: 0 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
19753 /* 16: 5 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
19754 /* XXX 7-byte padding */
19755
19756 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
19757 @}
19758 @end smallexample
19759
19760 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include the
19761 first bit of the bitfield.
19762 @end table
19763
19764 @kindex ptype
19765 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
19766 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
19767 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
19768 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
19769
19770 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
19771 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
19772 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
19773 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
19774 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
19775 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
19776 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
19777 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
19778
19779 For example, for this variable declaration:
19780
19781 @smallexample
19782 typedef double real_t;
19783 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
19784 typedef struct complex complex_t;
19785 complex_t var;
19786 real_t *real_pointer_var;
19787 @end smallexample
19788
19789 @noindent
19790 the two commands give this output:
19791
19792 @smallexample
19793 @group
19794 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
19795 type = complex_t
19796 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
19797 type = struct complex @{
19798 real_t real;
19799 double imag;
19800 @}
19801 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
19802 type = struct complex
19803 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
19804 type = struct complex
19805 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
19806 type = struct complex @{
19807 real_t real;
19808 double imag;
19809 @}
19810 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
19811 type = real_t *
19812 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
19813 type = double *
19814 @end group
19815 @end smallexample
19816
19817 @noindent
19818 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
19819 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
19820
19821 @cindex incomplete type
19822 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
19823 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
19824 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
19825 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
19826 given these declarations:
19827
19828 @smallexample
19829 struct foo;
19830 struct foo *fooptr;
19831 @end smallexample
19832
19833 @noindent
19834 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
19835
19836 @smallexample
19837 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
19838 $1 = <incomplete type>
19839 @end smallexample
19840
19841 @noindent
19842 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
19843 completely specified.
19844
19845 @cindex unknown type
19846 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
19847 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
19848 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
19849 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
19850 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
19851 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
19852 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
19853 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
19854
19855 @smallexample
19856 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
19857 type = <data variable, no debug info>
19858 @end smallexample
19859
19860 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
19861 of such variables.
19862
19863 @kindex info types
19864 @item info types [-q] [@var{regexp}]
19865 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
19866 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
19867 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
19868 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
19869 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
19870 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
19871 name is @code{value}.
19872
19873 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
19874 to print the type description according to the
19875 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
19876 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
19877 language of the type, other values mean to use
19878 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
19879
19880 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
19881 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
19882 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
19883
19884 The output from @samp{into types} is proceeded with a header line
19885 describing what types are being listed. The optional flag @samp{-q},
19886 which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables printing this header
19887 information.
19888
19889 @kindex info type-printers
19890 @item info type-printers
19891 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
19892 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
19893 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
19894 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
19895 type printers.
19896
19897 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
19898
19899 @kindex enable type-printer
19900 @kindex disable type-printer
19901 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
19902 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
19903 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
19904
19905 @kindex info scope
19906 @cindex local variables
19907 @item info scope @var{locspec}
19908 List all the variables local to the lexical scope of the code location
19909 that results from resolving @var{locspec}. @xref{Location
19910 Specifications}, for details about supported forms of @var{locspec}.
19911 For example:
19912
19913 @smallexample
19914 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
19915 Scope for command_line_handler:
19916 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
19917 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
19918 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
19919 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
19920 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
19921 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
19922 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
19923 @end smallexample
19924
19925 @noindent
19926 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
19927 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
19928 collect}.
19929
19930 @kindex info source
19931 @item info source
19932 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
19933 the function containing the current point of execution:
19934 @itemize @bullet
19935 @item
19936 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
19937 @item
19938 the directory it was compiled in,
19939 @item
19940 its length, in lines,
19941 @item
19942 which programming language it is written in,
19943 @item
19944 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
19945 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
19946 @item
19947 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
19948 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
19949 @item
19950 whether the debugging information includes information about
19951 preprocessor macros.
19952 @end itemize
19953
19954
19955 @kindex info sources
19956 @item info sources @r{[}-dirname | -basename@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
19957
19958
19959 With no options @samp{info sources} prints the names of all source
19960 files in your program for which there is debugging information. The
19961 source files are presented based on a list of object files
19962 (executables and libraries) currently loaded into @value{GDBN}. For
19963 each object file all of the associated source files are listed.
19964
19965 Each source file will only be printed once for each object file, but a
19966 single source file can be repeated in the output if it is part of
19967 multiple object files.
19968
19969 If the optional @var{regexp} is provided, then only source files that
19970 match the regular expression will be printed. The matching is
19971 case-sensitive, except on operating systems that have case-insensitive
19972 filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows). @samp{--} can be used before
19973 @var{regexp} to prevent @value{GDBN} interpreting @var{regexp} as a
19974 command option (e.g. if @var{regexp} starts with @samp{-}).
19975
19976 By default, the @var{regexp} is used to match anywhere in the
19977 filename. If @code{-dirname}, only files having a dirname matching
19978 @var{regexp} are shown. If @code{-basename}, only files having a
19979 basename matching @var{regexp} are shown.
19980
19981 It is possible that an object file may be printed in the list with no
19982 associated source files. This can happen when either no source files
19983 match @var{regexp}, or, the object file was compiled without debug
19984 information and so @value{GDBN} is unable to find any source file
19985 names.
19986
19987 @kindex info functions
19988 @item info functions [-q] [-n]
19989 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
19990 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
19991 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
19992 number.
19993
19994 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
19995 to print the function name and type according to the
19996 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
19997 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
19998 language of the function, other values mean to use
19999 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
20000
20001 The @samp{-n} flag excludes @dfn{non-debugging symbols} from the
20002 results. A non-debugging symbol is a symbol that comes from the
20003 executable's symbol table, not from the debug information (for
20004 example, DWARF) associated with the executable.
20005
20006 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
20007 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
20008 have been printed.
20009
20010 @item info functions [-q] [-n] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
20011 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
20012 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
20013
20014 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
20015 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
20016 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
20017 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
20018 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
20019 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
20020 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
20021
20022 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
20023 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
20024 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
20025 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
20026 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
20027 of special characters or quotes.
20028 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
20029 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
20030 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
20031 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
20032 int.
20033
20034 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
20035 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
20036 @var{type_regexp}.
20037
20038
20039 @kindex info variables
20040 @item info variables [-q] [-n]
20041 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
20042 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
20043 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
20044 their respective source line numbers.
20045
20046 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
20047 to print the variable name and type according to the
20048 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
20049 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
20050 language of the variable, other values mean to use
20051 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
20052
20053 The @samp{-n} flag excludes non-debugging symbols from the results.
20054
20055 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
20056 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
20057 have been printed.
20058
20059 @item info variables [-q] [-n] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
20060 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
20061 with the provided regexp(s).
20062
20063 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
20064 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
20065
20066 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
20067 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
20068 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
20069 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
20070 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
20071 of special characters or quotes.
20072
20073 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
20074 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
20075 @var{type_regexp}.
20076
20077 @kindex info modules
20078 @cindex modules
20079 @item info modules @r{[}-q@r{]} @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
20080 List all Fortran modules in the program, or all modules matching the
20081 optional regular expression @var{regexp}.
20082
20083 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
20084 printing header information and messages explaining why no modules
20085 have been printed.
20086
20087 @kindex info module
20088 @cindex Fortran modules, information about
20089 @cindex functions and variables by Fortran module
20090 @cindex module functions and variables
20091 @item info module functions @r{[}-q@r{]} @r{[}-m @var{module-regexp}@r{]} @r{[}-t @var{type-regexp}@r{]} @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
20092 @itemx info module variables @r{[}-q@r{]} @r{[}-m @var{module-regexp}@r{]} @r{[}-t @var{type-regexp}@r{]} @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
20093 List all functions or variables within all Fortran modules. The set
20094 of functions or variables listed can be limited by providing some or
20095 all of the optional regular expressions. If @var{module-regexp} is
20096 provided, then only Fortran modules matching @var{module-regexp} will
20097 be searched. Only functions or variables whose type matches the
20098 optional regular expression @var{type-regexp} will be listed. And
20099 only functions or variables whose name matches the optional regular
20100 expression @var{regexp} will be listed.
20101
20102 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
20103 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
20104 or variables have been printed.
20105
20106 @kindex info classes
20107 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
20108 @item info classes
20109 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
20110 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
20111 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
20112 expression.
20113
20114 @kindex info selectors
20115 @item info selectors
20116 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
20117 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
20118 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
20119 expression.
20120
20121 @ignore
20122 This was never implemented.
20123 @kindex info methods
20124 @item info methods
20125 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
20126 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
20127 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
20128 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
20129 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
20130 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
20131 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
20132 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
20133 @end ignore
20134
20135 @cindex opaque data types
20136 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
20137 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
20138 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
20139 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
20140 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
20141 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
20142 another source file. The default is on.
20143
20144 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
20145 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
20146
20147 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
20148 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
20149 is printed as follows:
20150 @smallexample
20151 @{<no data fields>@}
20152 @end smallexample
20153
20154 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
20155 @item show opaque-type-resolution
20156 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
20157
20158 @kindex set print symbol-loading
20159 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
20160 @item set print symbol-loading
20161 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
20162 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
20163 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
20164 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
20165 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
20166 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
20167 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
20168 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
20169 can be annoying.
20170 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
20171 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
20172 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
20173 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
20174
20175 @kindex show print symbol-loading
20176 @item show print symbol-loading
20177 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
20178 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
20179
20180 @kindex maint print symbols
20181 @cindex symbol dump
20182 @kindex maint print psymbols
20183 @cindex partial symbol dump
20184 @kindex maint print msymbols
20185 @cindex minimal symbol dump
20186 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
20187 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
20188 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
20189 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
20190 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
20191 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
20192 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
20193 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
20194 that objfile.
20195 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
20196 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
20197 @code{main}.
20198 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
20199 source file.
20200
20201 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
20202 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
20203 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
20204 tables.
20205 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
20206 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
20207 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
20208 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
20209 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
20210 ``ELF symbols''.
20211
20212 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
20213 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
20214
20215 @kindex maint info symtabs
20216 @kindex maint info psymtabs
20217 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
20218 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
20219 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
20220 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
20221 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
20222 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
20223
20224 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
20225 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
20226 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
20227 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
20228 structure in more detail. For example:
20229
20230 @smallexample
20231 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
20232 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
20233 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
20234 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
20235 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
20236 readin no
20237 fullname (null)
20238 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
20239 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
20240 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
20241 dependencies (none)
20242 @}
20243 @}
20244 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
20245 (@value{GDBP})
20246 @end smallexample
20247 @noindent
20248 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
20249 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
20250 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
20251 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
20252 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
20253
20254 @smallexample
20255 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
20256 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
20257 line 1574.
20258 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
20259 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
20260 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
20261 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
20262 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
20263 dirname (null)
20264 fullname (null)
20265 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
20266 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
20267 debugformat DWARF 2
20268 @}
20269 @}
20270 (@value{GDBP})
20271 @end smallexample
20272
20273 @kindex maint info line-table
20274 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
20275 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
20276 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
20277
20278 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
20279 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
20280 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
20281 For example:
20282
20283 @smallexample
20284 (@value{GDBP}) maint info line-table
20285 objfile: /home/gnu/build/a.out ((struct objfile *) 0x6120000e0d40)
20286 compunit_symtab: simple.cpp ((struct compunit_symtab *) 0x6210000ff450)
20287 symtab: /home/gnu/src/simple.cpp ((struct symtab *) 0x6210000ff4d0)
20288 linetable: ((struct linetable *) 0x62100012b760):
20289 INDEX LINE ADDRESS IS-STMT PROLOGUE-END
20290 0 3 0x0000000000401110 Y
20291 1 4 0x0000000000401114 Y Y
20292 2 9 0x0000000000401120 Y
20293 3 10 0x0000000000401124 Y Y
20294 4 10 0x0000000000401129
20295 5 15 0x0000000000401130 Y
20296 6 16 0x0000000000401134 Y Y
20297 7 16 0x0000000000401139
20298 8 21 0x0000000000401140 Y
20299 9 22 0x000000000040114f Y Y
20300 10 22 0x0000000000401154
20301 11 END 0x000000000040115a Y
20302 @end smallexample
20303 @noindent
20304 The @samp{IS-STMT} column indicates if the address is a recommended breakpoint
20305 location to represent a line or a statement. The @samp{PROLOGUE-END} column
20306 indicates that a given address is an adequate place to set a breakpoint at the
20307 first instruction following a function prologue.
20308
20309 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
20310 @cindex symbol cache size
20311 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
20312 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
20313 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
20314 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
20315 with different sizes.
20316
20317 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
20318 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
20319 Show the size of the symbol cache.
20320
20321 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
20322 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
20323 @item maint print symbol-cache
20324 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
20325 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
20326
20327 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
20328 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
20329 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
20330 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
20331 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
20332
20333 @kindex maint flush symbol-cache
20334 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
20335 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
20336 @item maint flush symbol-cache
20337 @itemx maint flush-symbol-cache
20338 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed. This
20339 command is useful when debugging the symbol cache. It is also useful
20340 when collecting performance data. The command @code{maint
20341 flush-symbol-cache} is deprecated in favor of @code{maint flush
20342 symbol-cache}..
20343
20344 @kindex maint set ignore-prologue-end-flag
20345 @cindex prologue-end
20346 @item maint set ignore-prologue-end-flag [on|off]
20347 Enable or disable the use of the @samp{PROLOGUE-END} flag from the line-table.
20348 When @samp{off} (the default), @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{PROLOGUE-END} flag
20349 to place breakpoints past the end of a function prologue. When @samp{on},
20350 @value{GDBN} ignores the flag and relies on prologue analyzers to skip function
20351 prologues.
20352
20353 @kindex maint show ignore-prologue-end-flag
20354 @item maint show ignore-prologue-end-flag
20355 Show whether @value{GDBN} will ignore the @samp{PROLOGUE-END} flag.
20356
20357 @end table
20358
20359 @node Altering
20360 @chapter Altering Execution
20361
20362 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
20363 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
20364 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
20365 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
20366 program.
20367
20368 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
20369 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
20370 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
20371
20372 @menu
20373 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
20374 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
20375 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
20376 * Returning:: Returning from a function
20377 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
20378 * Patching:: Patching your program
20379 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
20380 @end menu
20381
20382 @node Assignment
20383 @section Assignment to Variables
20384
20385 @cindex assignment
20386 @cindex setting variables
20387 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
20388 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
20389
20390 @smallexample
20391 print x=4
20392 @end smallexample
20393
20394 @noindent
20395 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
20396 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
20397 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
20398 information on operators in supported languages.
20399
20400 @kindex set variable
20401 @cindex variables, setting
20402 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
20403 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
20404 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
20405 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
20406 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
20407
20408 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
20409 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
20410 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
20411 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
20412 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
20413 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
20414 command @code{set width}:
20415
20416 @smallexample
20417 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
20418 type = double
20419 (@value{GDBP}) p width
20420 $4 = 13
20421 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
20422 Invalid syntax in expression.
20423 @end smallexample
20424
20425 @noindent
20426 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
20427 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
20428
20429 @smallexample
20430 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
20431 @end smallexample
20432
20433 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
20434 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
20435 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
20436 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
20437 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
20438 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
20439
20440 @smallexample
20441 @group
20442 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
20443 type = double
20444 (@value{GDBP}) p g
20445 $1 = 1
20446 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
20447 (@value{GDBP}) p g
20448 $2 = 1
20449 (@value{GDBP}) r
20450 The program being debugged has been started already.
20451 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
20452 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
20453 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
20454 Invalid bfd target.
20455 (@value{GDBP}) show g
20456 The current BFD target is "=4".
20457 @end group
20458 @end smallexample
20459
20460 @noindent
20461 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
20462 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
20463 @code{g}, use
20464
20465 @smallexample
20466 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
20467 @end smallexample
20468
20469 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
20470 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
20471 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
20472 same length or shorter.
20473 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
20474 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
20475
20476 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
20477 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
20478 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
20479 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
20480 and representation in memory), and
20481
20482 @smallexample
20483 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
20484 @end smallexample
20485
20486 @noindent
20487 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
20488
20489 @node Jumping
20490 @section Continuing at a Different Address
20491
20492 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
20493 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
20494 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
20495
20496 @table @code
20497 @kindex jump
20498 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
20499 @item jump @var{locspec}
20500 @itemx j @var{locspec}
20501 Resume execution at the address of the code location that results from
20502 resolving @var{locspec}.
20503 @xref{Location Specifications}, for a description of the different
20504 forms of @var{locspec}. If @var{locspec} resolves to more than one
20505 address, the command aborts before jumping.
20506 Execution stops again immediately if there is a breakpoint there. It
20507 is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction
20508 with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
20509
20510 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
20511 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
20512 register other than the program counter. If @var{locspec} resolves to
20513 an address in a different function from the one currently executing, the
20514 results may be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns
20515 of arguments or of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump}
20516 command requests confirmation if the jump address is not in the
20517 function currently executing. However, even bizarre results are
20518 predictable if you are well acquainted with the machine-language code
20519 of your program.
20520 @end table
20521
20522 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
20523 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
20524 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
20525 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
20526 example,
20527
20528 @smallexample
20529 set $pc = 0x485
20530 @end smallexample
20531
20532 @noindent
20533 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
20534 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
20535 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
20536
20537 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
20538 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
20539 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
20540 detail.
20541
20542 @c @group
20543 @node Signaling
20544 @section Giving your Program a Signal
20545 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
20546
20547 @table @code
20548 @kindex signal
20549 @item signal @var{signal}
20550 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
20551 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
20552 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
20553 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
20554
20555 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
20556 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
20557 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
20558 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
20559 signal.
20560
20561 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
20562 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
20563 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
20564 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
20565 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
20566 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
20567 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
20568 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
20569
20570 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
20571 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
20572 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
20573 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
20574 passes the signal directly to your program.
20575
20576 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
20577 after executing the command.
20578
20579 @kindex queue-signal
20580 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
20581 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
20582 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
20583 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
20584 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
20585 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
20586 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
20587 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
20588 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
20589
20590 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
20591 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
20592 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
20593 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
20594 @code{continue} command.
20595
20596 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
20597 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
20598 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
20599 (@pxref{Signals}).
20600 @end table
20601 @c @end group
20602
20603 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
20604 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
20605
20606 @node Returning
20607 @section Returning from a Function
20608
20609 @table @code
20610 @cindex returning from a function
20611 @kindex return
20612 @item return
20613 @itemx return @var{expression}
20614 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
20615 command. If you give an
20616 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
20617 value.
20618 @end table
20619
20620 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
20621 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
20622 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
20623 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
20624
20625 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
20626 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
20627 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
20628 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
20629 of functions.
20630
20631 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
20632 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
20633 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
20634 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
20635 selected stack frame returns naturally.
20636
20637 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
20638 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
20639 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
20640 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
20641 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
20642 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
20643 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
20644 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
20645 assignment into the right register(s).
20646
20647 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
20648 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
20649 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
20650 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
20651 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
20652 into a @code{long long int}:
20653
20654 @smallexample
20655 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
20656 29 return 31;
20657 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
20658 Make func return now? (y or n) y
20659 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
20660 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
20661 (@value{GDBP})
20662 @end smallexample
20663
20664 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
20665 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
20666 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
20667 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
20668 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
20669 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
20670 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
20671 an appropriate cast explicitly:
20672
20673 @smallexample
20674 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
20675 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
20676 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
20677 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
20678 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
20679 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
20680 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
20681 (@value{GDBP})
20682 @end smallexample
20683
20684 @node Calling
20685 @section Calling Program Functions
20686
20687 @table @code
20688 @cindex calling functions
20689 @cindex inferior functions, calling
20690 @item print @var{expr}
20691 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
20692 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
20693 debugged.
20694
20695 @kindex call
20696 @item call @var{expr}
20697 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
20698 returned values.
20699
20700 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
20701 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
20702 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
20703 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
20704 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
20705 value history.
20706 @end table
20707
20708 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
20709 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
20710 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
20711 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
20712
20713 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
20714 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
20715 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
20716 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
20717 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
20718 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
20719 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
20720 in that case is controlled by the
20721 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
20722
20723 @table @code
20724 @item set unwindonsignal
20725 @kindex set unwindonsignal
20726 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
20727 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
20728 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
20729 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
20730 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
20731 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
20732 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
20733 received.
20734
20735 @item show unwindonsignal
20736 @kindex show unwindonsignal
20737 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
20738 @value{GDBN}.
20739
20740 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
20741 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
20742 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
20743 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
20744 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
20745 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
20746 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
20747 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
20748 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
20749 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
20750
20751 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
20752 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
20753 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
20754 @value{GDBN}.
20755
20756 @item set may-call-functions
20757 @kindex set may-call-functions
20758 @cindex disabling calling functions in the program
20759 @cindex calling functions in the program, disabling
20760 Set permission to call functions in the program.
20761 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to call functions in
20762 the program, such as with expressions in the @code{print} command. It
20763 defaults to @code{on}.
20764
20765 To call a function in the program, @value{GDBN} has to temporarily
20766 modify the state of the inferior. This has potentially undesired side
20767 effects. Also, having @value{GDBN} call nested functions is likely to
20768 be erroneous and may even crash the program being debugged. You can
20769 avoid such hazards by forbidding @value{GDBN} from calling functions
20770 in the program being debugged. If calling functions in the program
20771 is forbidden, GDB will throw an error when a command (such as printing
20772 an expression) starts a function call in the program.
20773
20774 @item show may-call-functions
20775 @kindex show may-call-functions
20776 Show permission to call functions in the program.
20777
20778 @end table
20779
20780 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
20781
20782 @cindex no debug info functions
20783 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
20784 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
20785 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
20786 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
20787 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
20788 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
20789
20790 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
20791 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
20792 declared return type. For example:
20793
20794 @smallexample
20795 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
20796 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
20797 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
20798 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
20799 @end smallexample
20800
20801 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
20802 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
20803 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
20804 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
20805
20806 @smallexample
20807 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
20808 @end smallexample
20809
20810 @noindent
20811 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
20812
20813 @smallexample
20814 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
20815 @end smallexample
20816
20817 @noindent
20818 these calls are equivalent:
20819
20820 @smallexample
20821 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
20822 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
20823 @end smallexample
20824
20825 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
20826 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
20827 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
20828 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
20829 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
20830 float parameters, and no debug info:
20831
20832 @smallexample
20833 float
20834 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
20835 float v1, v2;
20836 @{
20837 return v1 * v2;
20838 @}
20839 @end smallexample
20840
20841 @noindent
20842 you call it like this:
20843
20844 @smallexample
20845 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
20846 @end smallexample
20847
20848 @node Patching
20849 @section Patching Programs
20850
20851 @cindex patching binaries
20852 @cindex writing into executables
20853 @cindex writing into corefiles
20854
20855 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
20856 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
20857 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
20858 patching your program's binary.
20859
20860 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
20861 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
20862 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
20863 repairs.
20864
20865 @table @code
20866 @kindex set write
20867 @item set write on
20868 @itemx set write off
20869 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
20870 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
20871 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
20872
20873 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
20874 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
20875 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
20876
20877 @item show write
20878 @kindex show write
20879 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
20880 as well as reading.
20881 @end table
20882
20883 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
20884 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
20885 @cindex injecting code
20886 @cindex writing into executables
20887 @cindex compiling code
20888
20889 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
20890 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
20891 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
20892 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
20893
20894 @table @code
20895 @kindex compile code
20896 @item compile code @var{source-code}
20897 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
20898 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
20899 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
20900 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
20901 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
20902 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
20903 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
20904 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
20905 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
20906 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
20907 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
20908
20909 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
20910 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
20911 E.g.:
20912
20913 @smallexample
20914 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
20915 @end smallexample
20916
20917 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
20918 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
20919 from actual source code. E.g.:
20920
20921 @smallexample
20922 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
20923 @end smallexample
20924
20925 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
20926 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
20927 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
20928 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
20929 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
20930 editor.
20931
20932 @smallexample
20933 compile code
20934 >printf ("hello\n");
20935 >printf ("world\n");
20936 >end
20937 @end smallexample
20938
20939 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
20940 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
20941 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
20942 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
20943 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
20944 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
20945 inferior symbols otherwise.
20946
20947 @kindex compile file
20948 @item compile file @var{filename}
20949 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
20950 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
20951
20952 @smallexample
20953 compile file /home/user/example.c
20954 @end smallexample
20955 @end table
20956
20957 @table @code
20958 @item compile print [[@var{options}] --] @var{expr}
20959 @itemx compile print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f} @var{expr}
20960 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
20961 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
20962 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
20963 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
20964 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
20965 Formats}. The @code{compile print} command accepts the same options
20966 as the @code{print} command; see @ref{print options}.
20967
20968 @item compile print [[@var{options}] --]
20969 @itemx compile print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f}
20970 @cindex reprint the last value
20971 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
20972 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
20973 command without any text following the command. This will start the
20974 multiple-line editor.
20975 @end table
20976
20977 @noindent
20978 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
20979
20980 @table @code
20981 @anchor{set debug compile}
20982 @item set debug compile
20983 @cindex compile command debugging info
20984 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
20985 injecting the code. The default is off.
20986
20987 @item show debug compile
20988 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
20989 compiling and injecting the code.
20990
20991 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
20992 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
20993 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
20994 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
20995 The default is off.
20996
20997 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
20998 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
20999 C@t{++} type conversion.
21000 @end table
21001
21002 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
21003
21004 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
21005 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
21006 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
21007 injecting process.
21008
21009 @noindent
21010 The options used, in increasing precedence:
21011
21012 @table @asis
21013 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
21014 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
21015 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
21016 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
21017
21018 @item compilation options recorded in the target
21019 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
21020 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
21021 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
21022 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
21023 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
21024 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
21025 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
21026
21027 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
21028 @end table
21029
21030 @noindent
21031 You can override compilation options using the following command:
21032
21033 @table @code
21034 @item set compile-args
21035 @cindex compile command options override
21036 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
21037 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
21038 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
21039 compilation.
21040
21041 @item show compile-args
21042 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
21043 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
21044 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
21045 @end table
21046
21047 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
21048
21049 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
21050 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
21051 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
21052
21053 @table @asis
21054 @item C code examples and caveats
21055 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
21056 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
21057 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
21058 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
21059 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
21060
21061 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
21062 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
21063 much like any other normal debugging session.
21064
21065 @smallexample
21066 void function1 (void)
21067 @{
21068 int i = 42;
21069 printf ("function 1\n");
21070 @}
21071
21072 void function2 (void)
21073 @{
21074 int j = 12;
21075 function1 ();
21076 @}
21077
21078 int main(void)
21079 @{
21080 int k = 6;
21081 int *p;
21082 function2 ();
21083 return 0;
21084 @}
21085 @end smallexample
21086
21087 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
21088 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
21089 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
21090
21091 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
21092 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
21093 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
21094 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
21095 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
21096
21097 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
21098 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
21099 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
21100 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
21101 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
21102 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
21103 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
21104 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
21105 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
21106 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
21107
21108 @smallexample
21109 compile code k = 3;
21110 @end smallexample
21111
21112 @noindent
21113 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
21114 something else in the example program changes it, or another
21115 @code{compile} command changes it.
21116
21117 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
21118 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
21119 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
21120 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
21121 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
21122
21123 @smallexample
21124 compile code j = 3;
21125 @end smallexample
21126
21127 @noindent
21128 will result in a compilation error message.
21129
21130 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
21131 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
21132 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
21133
21134 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
21135 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
21136 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
21137 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
21138
21139 @smallexample
21140 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
21141 @end smallexample
21142
21143 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
21144 command has completed:
21145
21146 @smallexample
21147 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
21148 @end smallexample
21149
21150 @noindent
21151 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
21152 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
21153 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
21154 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
21155 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
21156
21157 @smallexample
21158 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
21159 @end smallexample
21160
21161 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
21162 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
21163 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
21164 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
21165 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
21166 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
21167 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
21168 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
21169
21170 @smallexample
21171 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
21172 @end smallexample
21173
21174 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
21175 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
21176 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
21177 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
21178 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
21179 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
21180 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
21181
21182 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
21183 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
21184 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
21185 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
21186 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
21187 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
21188
21189 @smallexample
21190 (@value{GDBP}) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
21191 (@value{GDBP}) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
21192 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
21193 Compilation failed.
21194 (@value{GDBP}) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
21195 42
21196 @end smallexample
21197
21198 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
21199 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
21200 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
21201 will print to the console.
21202 @end table
21203
21204 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
21205
21206 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
21207 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
21208 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @env{PATH} on
21209 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
21210 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
21211 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @env{PATH} is
21212 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
21213 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
21214
21215
21216 Specifically @env{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
21217 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
21218 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
21219 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
21220 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
21221 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
21222 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
21223
21224 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
21225 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
21226 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
21227 variable @env{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @env{PATH} or @code{set
21228 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
21229 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
21230 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
21231
21232 @table @code
21233 @item set compile-gcc
21234 @cindex compile command driver filename override
21235 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
21236 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
21237 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
21238 default.
21239
21240 @item show compile-gcc
21241 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
21242 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
21243 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
21244 @end table
21245
21246 @node GDB Files
21247 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
21248
21249 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
21250 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
21251 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
21252 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
21253
21254 @menu
21255 * Files:: Commands to specify files
21256 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
21257 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
21258 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
21259 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
21260 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
21261 * Data Files:: GDB data files
21262 @end menu
21263
21264 @node Files
21265 @section Commands to Specify Files
21266
21267 @cindex symbol table
21268 @cindex core dump file
21269
21270 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
21271 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
21272 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
21273 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
21274
21275 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
21276 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
21277 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
21278 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
21279 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
21280 new files are useful.
21281
21282 @table @code
21283 @cindex executable file
21284 @kindex file
21285 @item file @var{filename}
21286 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
21287 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
21288 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
21289 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
21290 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @env{PATH} as a list of
21291 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
21292 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
21293 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
21294
21295 @cindex unlinked object files
21296 @cindex patching object files
21297 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
21298 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
21299 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
21300 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
21301 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
21302 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
21303 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
21304 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
21305
21306 @item file
21307 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
21308 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
21309
21310 @kindex exec-file
21311 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
21312 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
21313 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @env{PATH}
21314 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
21315 discard information on the executable file.
21316
21317 @kindex symbol-file
21318 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
21319 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @env{PATH} is
21320 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
21321 table and program to run from the same file.
21322
21323 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
21324 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
21325 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
21326 enabled.
21327
21328 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
21329 program's symbol table.
21330
21331 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
21332 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
21333 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
21334 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
21335 @value{GDBN}.
21336
21337 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
21338 executing it once.
21339
21340 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
21341 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
21342 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
21343 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
21344 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
21345 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
21346 optimized code.
21347
21348 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
21349 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
21350 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
21351 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
21352 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
21353
21354 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
21355 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
21356 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
21357 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
21358 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
21359 Warnings and Messages}.)
21360
21361 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
21362 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
21363 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
21364 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
21365 in stabs format.
21366
21367 @kindex readnow
21368 @cindex reading symbols immediately
21369 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
21370 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
21371 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
21372 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
21373 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
21374 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
21375 entire symbol table available.
21376
21377 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
21378 @cindex never read symbols
21379 @cindex symbols, never read
21380 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
21381 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
21382 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
21383 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
21384 @xref{--readnever}.
21385
21386 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
21387 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
21388 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
21389 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
21390 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
21391 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
21392 @c files.
21393
21394 @kindex core-file
21395 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
21396 @itemx core
21397 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
21398 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
21399 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
21400 executable file itself for other parts.
21401
21402 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
21403 to be used.
21404
21405 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
21406 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
21407 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
21408 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
21409 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
21410
21411 @kindex add-symbol-file
21412 @cindex dynamic linking
21413 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
21414 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
21415 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
21416 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
21417 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
21418 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
21419 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
21420 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
21421 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
21422 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
21423 can be given as an expression.
21424
21425 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
21426 address of each section, except those for which the address was
21427 specified explicitly.
21428
21429 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
21430 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
21431 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
21432 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
21433
21434 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
21435
21436 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
21437 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
21438 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
21439 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
21440 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
21441 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
21442 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
21443 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
21444 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
21445
21446 @itemize @bullet
21447 @item
21448 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
21449 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
21450 @item
21451 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
21452 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
21453 @item
21454 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
21455 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
21456 @end itemize
21457
21458 @noindent
21459 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
21460 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
21461 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
21462 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
21463 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
21464 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
21465 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
21466 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
21467 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
21468 way.
21469
21470 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
21471
21472 @kindex remove-symbol-file
21473 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
21474 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
21475 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
21476 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
21477 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
21478
21479 @smallexample
21480 (@value{GDBP}) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
21481 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
21482 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
21483 (y or n) y
21484 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...
21485 (@value{GDBP}) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
21486 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
21487 (@value{GDBP})
21488 @end smallexample
21489
21490
21491 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
21492
21493 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
21494 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
21495 @cindex load symbols from memory
21496 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
21497 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
21498 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
21499 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
21500 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
21501 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
21502 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
21503 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
21504 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
21505
21506 @kindex section
21507 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
21508 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
21509 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
21510 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
21511 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
21512 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
21513 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
21514 their addresses.
21515
21516 @kindex info files
21517 @kindex info target
21518 @item info files
21519 @itemx info target
21520 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
21521 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
21522 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
21523 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
21524 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
21525 current ones.
21526
21527 @kindex maint info sections
21528 @item maint info sections @r{[}-all-objects@r{]} @r{[}@var{filter-list}@r{]}
21529 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
21530 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
21531 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
21532 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files.
21533
21534 When @samp{-all-objects} is passed then sections from all loaded object
21535 files, including shared libraries, are printed.
21536
21537 The optional @var{filter-list} is a space separated list of filter
21538 keywords. Sections that match any one of the filter criteria will be
21539 printed. There are two types of filter:
21540
21541 @table @code
21542 @item @var{section-name}
21543 Display information about any section named @var{section-name}.
21544 @item @var{section-flag}
21545 Display information for any section with @var{section-flag}. The
21546 section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
21547 @table @code
21548 @item ALLOC
21549 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
21550 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
21551 @item LOAD
21552 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
21553 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
21554 @item RELOC
21555 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
21556 @item READONLY
21557 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
21558 @item CODE
21559 Section contains executable code only.
21560 @item DATA
21561 Section contains data only (no executable code).
21562 @item ROM
21563 Section will reside in ROM.
21564 @item CONSTRUCTOR
21565 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
21566 @item HAS_CONTENTS
21567 Section is not empty.
21568 @item NEVER_LOAD
21569 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
21570 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
21571 A notification to the linker that the section contains
21572 COFF shared library information.
21573 @item IS_COMMON
21574 Section contains common symbols.
21575 @end table
21576 @end table
21577
21578 @kindex maint info target-sections
21579 @item maint info target-sections
21580 This command prints @value{GDBN}'s internal section table. For each
21581 target @value{GDBN} maintains a table containing the allocatable
21582 sections from all currently mapped objects, along with information
21583 about where the section is mapped.
21584
21585 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
21586 @cindex read-only sections
21587 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
21588 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
21589 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
21590 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
21591 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
21592 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
21593 enhancement to debugging performance.
21594
21595 The default is off.
21596
21597 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
21598 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
21599 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
21600 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
21601
21602 @item show trust-readonly-sections
21603 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
21604 @end table
21605
21606 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
21607 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
21608 name and remembers it that way.
21609
21610 @cindex shared libraries
21611 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
21612 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
21613 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
21614 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
21615
21616 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
21617 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
21618
21619 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
21620 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
21621 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
21622 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
21623 debugging a core file).
21624
21625 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
21626 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
21627 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
21628
21629 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
21630 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
21631 particularly large or there are many of them.
21632
21633 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
21634 commands:
21635
21636 @table @code
21637 @kindex set auto-solib-add
21638 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
21639 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
21640 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
21641 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
21642 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
21643 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
21644 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
21645
21646 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
21647 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
21648 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
21649 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
21650 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
21651 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
21652 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
21653 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
21654 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
21655
21656 @kindex show auto-solib-add
21657 @item show auto-solib-add
21658 Display the current autoloading mode.
21659 @end table
21660
21661 @cindex load shared library
21662 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
21663 command:
21664
21665 @table @code
21666 @kindex info sharedlibrary
21667 @kindex info share
21668 @item info share @var{regex}
21669 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
21670 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
21671 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
21672 all shared libraries that are loaded.
21673
21674 @kindex info dll
21675 @item info dll @var{regex}
21676 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
21677
21678 @kindex sharedlibrary
21679 @kindex share
21680 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
21681 @itemx share @var{regex}
21682 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
21683 Unix regular expression.
21684 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
21685 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
21686 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
21687 loaded.
21688
21689 @item nosharedlibrary
21690 @kindex nosharedlibrary
21691 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
21692 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
21693 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
21694 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
21695 discarded.
21696 @end table
21697
21698 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
21699 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
21700 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
21701 Catchpoints}).
21702
21703 @value{GDBN} also supports the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
21704 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
21705 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
21706 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
21707
21708 @table @code
21709 @item set stop-on-solib-events
21710 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
21711 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
21712 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
21713 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
21714 shared library.
21715
21716 @item show stop-on-solib-events
21717 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
21718 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
21719 library events happen.
21720 @end table
21721
21722 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
21723 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
21724 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
21725 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
21726 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
21727 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
21728 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
21729 not.
21730
21731 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
21732 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
21733 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
21734 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
21735 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
21736
21737 @table @code
21738 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
21739 @cindex system root, alternate
21740 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
21741 @kindex set sysroot
21742 @item set sysroot @var{path}
21743 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
21744 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
21745 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
21746 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
21747 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
21748 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
21749 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
21750 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
21751 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
21752 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
21753 @var{path}.
21754
21755 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
21756 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
21757 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
21758 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
21759 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
21760 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
21761 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
21762 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
21763 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
21764 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
21765 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
21766 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
21767 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
21768 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
21769
21770 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows,
21771 @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
21772 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
21773 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
21774 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
21775
21776 @smallexample
21777 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
21778 @end smallexample
21779
21780 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
21781 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
21782 system:
21783
21784 @smallexample
21785 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
21786 @end smallexample
21787
21788 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
21789 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
21790 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
21791 colons:
21792
21793 @smallexample
21794 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
21795 @end smallexample
21796
21797 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
21798 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
21799 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
21800 @samp{z}):
21801
21802 @smallexample
21803 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
21804 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
21805 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
21806 @end smallexample
21807
21808 @noindent
21809 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
21810 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
21811 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
21812
21813 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
21814 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
21815
21816 @smallexample
21817 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
21818 @end smallexample
21819
21820 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
21821 if you don't want or need to.
21822
21823 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
21824 sysroot}.
21825
21826 @cindex default system root
21827 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
21828 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
21829 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
21830 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
21831 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
21832 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
21833 location.
21834
21835 @kindex show sysroot
21836 @item show sysroot
21837 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
21838
21839 @kindex set solib-search-path
21840 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
21841 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21842 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
21843 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
21844 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
21845 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
21846 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
21847 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
21848 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
21849 of shared library symbols.
21850
21851 @kindex show solib-search-path
21852 @item show solib-search-path
21853 Display the current shared library search path.
21854
21855 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
21856 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
21857 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
21858 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
21859 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
21860
21861 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
21862 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
21863 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
21864 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
21865 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
21866 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
21867 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
21868 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
21869 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
21870 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
21871 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
21872 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
21873 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
21874 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
21875 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
21876 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
21877 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
21878 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
21879 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
21880 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
21881 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
21882 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
21883
21884 @table @code
21885 @item unix
21886 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
21887 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
21888 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
21889 the forward slash.
21890
21891 @item dos-based
21892 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
21893 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
21894 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
21895 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
21896 considered directory separators.
21897
21898 @item auto
21899 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
21900 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
21901 This is the default.
21902 @end table
21903 @end table
21904
21905 @cindex file name canonicalization
21906 @cindex base name differences
21907 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
21908 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
21909 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
21910 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
21911 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
21912 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
21913 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
21914 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
21915 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
21916 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
21917 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
21918 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
21919 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
21920 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
21921 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
21922
21923 @table @code
21924 @item set basenames-may-differ
21925 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
21926 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
21927
21928 @item show basenames-may-differ
21929 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
21930 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
21931 @end table
21932
21933 @node File Caching
21934 @section File Caching
21935 @cindex caching of opened files
21936 @cindex caching of bfd objects
21937
21938 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
21939 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
21940 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
21941 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
21942
21943 @table @code
21944 @kindex maint info bfds
21945 @item maint info bfds
21946 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
21947 @value{GDBN}.
21948
21949 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
21950 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
21951 @kindex bfd caching
21952 @item maint set bfd-sharing
21953 @item maint show bfd-sharing
21954 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
21955 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
21956 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
21957 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
21958 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
21959 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
21960 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
21961
21962 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
21963 @kindex bfd caching
21964 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
21965 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
21966
21967 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
21968 @kindex bfd caching
21969 @item show debug bfd-cache
21970 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
21971 @end table
21972
21973 @node Separate Debug Files
21974 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
21975 @cindex separate debugging information files
21976 @cindex debugging information in separate files
21977 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
21978 @cindex debugging information directory, global
21979 @cindex global debugging information directories
21980 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
21981 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
21982
21983 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
21984 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
21985 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
21986 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
21987 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
21988 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
21989 install only when they need to debug a problem.
21990
21991 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
21992 file:
21993
21994 @itemize @bullet
21995 @item
21996 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
21997 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
21998 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
21999 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
22000 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
22001 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
22002 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
22003 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
22004
22005 @item
22006 @anchor{build ID}
22007 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
22008 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
22009 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
22010 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
22011 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
22012 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
22013 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
22014 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
22015 below.
22016 @end itemize
22017
22018 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
22019 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
22020
22021 @itemize @bullet
22022 @item
22023 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
22024 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
22025 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the
22026 global debug directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to
22027 the leading directories of the executable's absolute file name. (On
22028 MS-Windows/MS-DOS, the drive letter of the executable's leading
22029 directories is converted to a one-letter subdirectory, i.e.@:
22030 @file{d:/usr/bin/} is converted to @file{/d/usr/bin/}, because Windows
22031 filesystems disallow colons in file names.)
22032
22033 @item
22034 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
22035 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
22036 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
22037 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
22038 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
22039 hex characters, not 10.) @value{GDBN} can automatically query
22040 @code{debuginfod} servers using build IDs in order to download separate debug
22041 files that cannot be found locally. For more information see @ref{Debuginfod}.
22042 @end itemize
22043
22044 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
22045 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
22046 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
22047 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
22048 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
22049 debug information files, in the indicated order:
22050
22051 @itemize @minus
22052 @item
22053 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
22054 @item
22055 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
22056 @item
22057 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
22058 @item
22059 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
22060 @end itemize
22061
22062 If the debug file still has not been found and @code{debuginfod}
22063 (@pxref{Debuginfod}) is enabled, @value{GDBN} will attempt to download the
22064 file from @code{debuginfod} servers.
22065
22066 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
22067 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
22068 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
22069 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
22070 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
22071
22072 @table @code
22073
22074 @kindex set debug-file-directory
22075 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
22076 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
22077 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
22078 concatenating them by a path separator.
22079
22080 @kindex show debug-file-directory
22081 @item show debug-file-directory
22082 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
22083 information files.
22084
22085 @end table
22086
22087 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
22088 @cindex debug link sections
22089 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
22090 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
22091
22092 @itemize
22093 @item
22094 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
22095 a zero byte,
22096 @item
22097 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
22098 boundary within the section, and
22099 @item
22100 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
22101 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
22102 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
22103 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
22104 @end itemize
22105
22106 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
22107 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
22108 described above.
22109
22110 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
22111 @cindex build ID sections
22112 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
22113 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
22114 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
22115 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
22116 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
22117 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
22118 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
22119 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
22120 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
22121
22122 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
22123 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
22124 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
22125 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
22126 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
22127 in an ordinary executable.
22128
22129 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
22130 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
22131 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
22132 following commands:
22133
22134 @smallexample
22135 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
22136 @kbd{strip -g foo}
22137 @end smallexample
22138
22139 @noindent
22140 These commands remove the debugging
22141 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
22142 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
22143 two files:
22144
22145 @itemize @bullet
22146 @item
22147 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
22148 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
22149
22150 @smallexample
22151 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
22152 @end smallexample
22153
22154 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
22155 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
22156 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
22157 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
22158
22159 @item
22160 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
22161 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
22162 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
22163 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
22164 @end itemize
22165
22166 @noindent
22167
22168 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
22169 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
22170 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
22171
22172 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
22173 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
22174 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
22175 @c different ways!
22176 @ifhtml
22177 @display
22178 @html
22179 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
22180 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
22181 @end html
22182 @end display
22183 @end ifhtml
22184 @ifnothtml
22185 @display
22186 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
22187 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
22188 @end display
22189 @end ifnothtml
22190
22191 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
22192 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
22193 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
22194 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
22195 CRC.
22196
22197 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
22198 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
22199 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
22200 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
22201 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
22202
22203 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
22204 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
22205 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
22206 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
22207 @code{0xffffffff}.
22208
22209 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
22210 @smallexample
22211 unsigned long
22212 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
22213 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
22214 @{
22215 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
22216 @{
22217 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
22218 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
22219 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
22220 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
22221 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
22222 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
22223 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
22224 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
22225 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
22226 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
22227 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
22228 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
22229 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
22230 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
22231 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
22232 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
22233 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
22234 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
22235 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
22236 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
22237 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
22238 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
22239 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
22240 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
22241 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
22242 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
22243 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
22244 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
22245 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
22246 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
22247 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
22248 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
22249 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
22250 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
22251 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
22252 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
22253 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
22254 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
22255 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
22256 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
22257 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
22258 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
22259 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
22260 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
22261 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
22262 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
22263 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
22264 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
22265 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
22266 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
22267 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
22268 0x2d02ef8d
22269 @};
22270 unsigned char *end;
22271
22272 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
22273 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
22274 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
22275 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
22276 @}
22277 @end smallexample
22278
22279 @noindent
22280 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
22281
22282 @node MiniDebugInfo
22283 @section Debugging information in a special section
22284 @cindex separate debug sections
22285 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
22286
22287 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
22288 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
22289 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
22290 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
22291
22292 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
22293 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
22294 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
22295 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
22296 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
22297 debugging information might be included in the section.
22298
22299 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
22300 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
22301 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
22302
22303 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
22304 standard utilities:
22305
22306 @smallexample
22307 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
22308 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
22309 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
22310 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
22311
22312 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
22313 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
22314 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
22315 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
22316 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
22317 | sort > funcsyms
22318
22319 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
22320 # table.
22321 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
22322
22323 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
22324 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
22325
22326 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
22327 # removing some unnecessary sections.
22328 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
22329 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
22330
22331 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
22332 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
22333
22334 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
22335 # original binary.
22336 xz mini_debuginfo
22337 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
22338 @end smallexample
22339
22340 @node Index Files
22341 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
22342 @cindex index files
22343 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
22344
22345 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
22346 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
22347 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
22348 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
22349 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
22350 startup.
22351
22352 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
22353 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
22354 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
22355
22356 @smallexample
22357 $ gdb-add-index symfile
22358 @end smallexample
22359
22360 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
22361
22362 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
22363 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
22364
22365 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
22366 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
22367 using @command{objcopy}.
22368
22369 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
22370
22371 @table @code
22372 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
22373 @kindex save gdb-index
22374 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
22375 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
22376 default creates it produces a single file
22377 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
22378 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
22379 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
22380 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
22381 given @var{directory}.
22382 @end table
22383
22384 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
22385 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
22386
22387 @smallexample
22388 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
22389 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
22390 @end smallexample
22391
22392 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
22393
22394 @smallexample
22395 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
22396 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
22397 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
22398 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
22399 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
22400 @end smallexample
22401
22402 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
22403 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
22404 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
22405 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
22406 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
22407 The default is @code{off}.
22408 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
22409 @xref{Index Section Format}.
22410
22411 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
22412 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
22413
22414 @smallexample
22415 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
22416 @end smallexample
22417
22418 Instead you must do, for example,
22419
22420 @smallexample
22421 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
22422 @end smallexample
22423
22424 Indices only work when using DWARF debugging information, not stabs.
22425
22426 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
22427
22428 @cindex automatic symbol index cache
22429 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
22430 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
22431 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache enabled on}.
22432 The following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
22433
22434 @table @code
22435
22436 @kindex set index-cache
22437 @item set index-cache enabled on
22438 @itemx set index-cache enabled off
22439 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
22440
22441 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
22442 @kindex show index-cache
22443 @itemx show index-cache directory
22444 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
22445
22446 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
22447 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
22448 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
22449 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
22450 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
22451 differ according to local convention.
22452
22453 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
22454 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
22455
22456 @item show index-cache stats
22457 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
22458
22459 @end table
22460
22461 @node Symbol Errors
22462 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
22463
22464 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
22465 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
22466 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
22467 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
22468 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
22469 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
22470 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
22471 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
22472 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
22473 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
22474 Messages}).
22475
22476 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
22477
22478 @table @code
22479 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
22480
22481 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
22482 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
22483 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
22484 in its outer scope blocks.
22485
22486 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
22487 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
22488 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
22489 function.
22490
22491 @item block at @var{address} out of order
22492
22493 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
22494 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
22495 do so.
22496
22497 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
22498 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
22499 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
22500 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
22501 Messages}.)
22502
22503 @item bad block start address patched
22504
22505 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
22506 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
22507 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
22508
22509 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
22510 starting on the previous source line.
22511
22512 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
22513
22514 @cindex foo
22515 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
22516 larger than the size of the string table.
22517
22518 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
22519 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
22520 with this name.
22521
22522 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
22523
22524 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
22525 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
22526 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
22527
22528 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
22529 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
22530 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
22531 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
22532 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
22533 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
22534
22535 @item stub type has NULL name
22536
22537 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
22538
22539 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
22540 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
22541 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
22542 it.
22543
22544 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
22545
22546 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
22547
22548 @end table
22549
22550 @node Data Files
22551 @section GDB Data Files
22552
22553 @cindex prefix for data files
22554 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
22555 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
22556
22557 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
22558 is currently using.
22559
22560 @table @code
22561 @kindex set data-directory
22562 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
22563 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
22564 to @var{directory}.
22565
22566 @kindex show data-directory
22567 @item show data-directory
22568 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
22569 @end table
22570
22571 @cindex default data directory
22572 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
22573 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
22574 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
22575 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
22576 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
22577 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
22578 location.
22579
22580 The data directory may also be specified with the
22581 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
22582 @xref{Mode Options}.
22583
22584 @node Targets
22585 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
22586
22587 @cindex debugging target
22588 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
22589
22590 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
22591 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
22592 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
22593 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
22594 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
22595 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
22596 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
22597 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
22598
22599 @cindex target architecture
22600 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
22601 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
22602 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
22603 command.
22604
22605 @table @code
22606 @kindex set architecture
22607 @kindex show architecture
22608 @item set architecture @var{arch}
22609 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
22610 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
22611 supported architectures.
22612
22613 @item show architecture
22614 Show the current target architecture.
22615
22616 @item set processor
22617 @itemx processor
22618 @kindex set processor
22619 @kindex show processor
22620 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
22621 and @code{show architecture}.
22622 @end table
22623
22624 @menu
22625 * Active Targets:: Active targets
22626 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
22627 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
22628 @end menu
22629
22630 @node Active Targets
22631 @section Active Targets
22632
22633 @cindex stacking targets
22634 @cindex active targets
22635 @cindex multiple targets
22636
22637 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
22638 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
22639 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
22640 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
22641 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
22642 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
22643 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
22644 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
22645 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
22646
22647 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
22648 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
22649 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
22650 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
22651
22652 @node Target Commands
22653 @section Commands for Managing Targets
22654
22655 @table @code
22656 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
22657 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
22658 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
22659 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
22660 protocol of the target machine.
22661
22662 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
22663 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
22664 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
22665
22666 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
22667 after executing the command.
22668
22669 @kindex help target
22670 @item help target
22671 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
22672 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
22673 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
22674
22675 @item help target @var{name}
22676 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
22677 select it.
22678
22679 @kindex set gnutarget
22680 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
22681 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
22682 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
22683 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
22684 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
22685 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
22686
22687 @quotation
22688 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
22689 you must know the actual BFD name.
22690 @end quotation
22691
22692 @noindent
22693 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
22694
22695 @kindex show gnutarget
22696 @item show gnutarget
22697 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
22698 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
22699 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
22700 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
22701 @end table
22702
22703 @cindex common targets
22704 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
22705 configuration):
22706
22707 @table @code
22708 @kindex target
22709 @item target exec @var{program}
22710 @cindex executable file target
22711 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
22712 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
22713
22714 @item target core @var{filename}
22715 @cindex core dump file target
22716 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
22717 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
22718
22719 @item target remote @var{medium}
22720 @cindex remote target
22721 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
22722 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
22723 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
22724
22725 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
22726 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
22727
22728 @smallexample
22729 target remote /dev/ttya
22730 @end smallexample
22731
22732 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
22733 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
22734 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
22735 clobbered by the download.
22736
22737 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22738 @cindex built-in simulator target
22739 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
22740 In general,
22741 @smallexample
22742 target sim
22743 load
22744 run
22745 @end smallexample
22746 @noindent
22747 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
22748 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
22749 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
22750 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
22751 Processors}.
22752
22753 @item target native
22754 @cindex native target
22755 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
22756 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
22757 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
22758 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
22759
22760 @end table
22761
22762 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
22763 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
22764
22765 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
22766 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
22767 various aspects of this process.
22768
22769 @table @code
22770
22771 @item set hash
22772 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
22773 @cindex hash mark while downloading
22774 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
22775 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
22776 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
22777 monitor.
22778
22779 @item show hash
22780 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
22781 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
22782
22783 @item set debug monitor
22784 @kindex set debug monitor
22785 @cindex display remote monitor communications
22786 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
22787 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
22788
22789 @item show debug monitor
22790 @kindex show debug monitor
22791 Show the current status of displaying communications between
22792 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
22793 @end table
22794
22795 @table @code
22796
22797 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
22798 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
22799 @anchor{load}
22800 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
22801 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
22802 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
22803 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
22804 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
22805 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
22806
22807 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
22808 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
22809 target is @dots{}}''
22810
22811 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
22812 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
22813 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
22814 specifies a fixed address.
22815 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
22816
22817 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
22818 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
22819 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
22820
22821 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
22822 load programs into flash memory.
22823
22824 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
22825 @end table
22826
22827 @table @code
22828
22829 @kindex flash-erase
22830 @item flash-erase
22831 @anchor{flash-erase}
22832
22833 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
22834
22835 @end table
22836
22837 @node Byte Order
22838 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
22839
22840 @cindex choosing target byte order
22841 @cindex target byte order
22842
22843 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
22844 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
22845 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
22846 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
22847 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
22848 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
22849
22850 @table @code
22851 @kindex set endian
22852 @item set endian big
22853 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
22854
22855 @item set endian little
22856 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
22857
22858 @item set endian auto
22859 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
22860 executable.
22861
22862 @item show endian
22863 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
22864
22865 @end table
22866
22867 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
22868 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
22869 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
22870 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
22871 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
22872 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
22873 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
22874 and @code{big} otherwise.
22875
22876 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
22877 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
22878 target system.
22879
22880
22881 @node Remote Debugging
22882 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
22883 @cindex remote debugging
22884
22885 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
22886 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
22887 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
22888 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
22889 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
22890
22891 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
22892 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
22893 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
22894 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
22895 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
22896 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
22897
22898 Other remote targets may be available in your
22899 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
22900
22901 @menu
22902 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
22903 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
22904 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
22905 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
22906 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
22907 @end menu
22908
22909 @node Connecting
22910 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
22911 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
22912 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
22913 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
22914 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
22915 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
22916 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
22917
22918 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
22919 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
22920 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
22921 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
22922
22923 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
22924
22925 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
22926 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
22927 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
22928 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
22929
22930 @table @asis
22931
22932 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
22933 @item Result of detach or program exit
22934 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
22935 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
22936 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
22937
22938 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
22939 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
22940 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
22941 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
22942
22943 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
22944 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
22945 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
22946 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
22947
22948 @item Specifying the program to debug
22949 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
22950 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
22951 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
22952 target.
22953
22954 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
22955 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
22956 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
22957
22958 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
22959 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
22960 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
22961 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
22962
22963 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
22964 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
22965 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
22966 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
22967 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
22968 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
22969 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
22970 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
22971 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
22972
22973 @item The @code{run} command
22974 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
22975 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
22976 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
22977 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
22978 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
22979
22980 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
22981 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
22982 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
22983 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
22984 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
22985
22986 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
22987 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
22988 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
22989 @code{target remote} mode.
22990
22991 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
22992 @item Attaching
22993 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
22994 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
22995 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
22996
22997 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
22998 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
22999 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
23000 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
23001 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
23002
23003 Some remote targets allow @value{GDBN} to determine the executable file running
23004 in the process the debugger is attaching to. In such a case, @value{GDBN}
23005 uses the value of @code{exec-file-mismatch} to handle a possible mismatch
23006 between the executable file name running in the process and the name of the
23007 current exec-file loaded by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set exec-file-mismatch}).
23008
23009 @end table
23010
23011 @anchor{Host and target files}
23012 @subsection Host and Target Files
23013 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
23014 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
23015
23016 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
23017 information for your program running on the target. This requires
23018 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
23019 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
23020 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
23021
23022 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
23023 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
23024 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
23025 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
23026 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
23027
23028 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
23029 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
23030 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
23031 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
23032 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
23033 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
23034 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
23035 target libraries.
23036
23037 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
23038 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
23039 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
23040 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
23041 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
23042 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
23043 programs.
23044
23045 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
23046 @cindex remote connection commands
23047 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
23048 local Unix domain socket, or
23049 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
23050 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
23051 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
23052 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
23053 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
23054 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
23055
23056 @table @code
23057
23058 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
23059 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
23060 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
23061 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
23062 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
23063
23064 @smallexample
23065 target remote /dev/ttyb
23066 @end smallexample
23067
23068 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
23069 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
23070 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
23071 @code{target} command.
23072
23073 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
23074 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
23075 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
23076 @cindex Unix domain socket
23077 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
23078 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
23079
23080 @smallexample
23081 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
23082 @end smallexample
23083
23084 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
23085 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
23086 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
23087 of connection.
23088 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
23089 Unix domain sockets.
23090
23091 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
23092 @itemx target remote @code{[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
23093 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23094 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
23095 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23096 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23097 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
23098 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
23099 @itemx target extended-remote @code{[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
23100 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23101 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
23102 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23103 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23104 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
23105 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
23106 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
23107 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
23108 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
23109 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
23110 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
23111 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
23112 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
23113
23114 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
23115 @code{manyfarms}:
23116
23117 @smallexample
23118 target remote manyfarms:2828
23119 @end smallexample
23120
23121 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
23122 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
23123 square bracket syntax:
23124
23125 @smallexample
23126 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
23127 @end smallexample
23128
23129 @noindent
23130 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
23131
23132 @smallexample
23133 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
23134 @end smallexample
23135
23136 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
23137 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
23138 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
23139 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
23140 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
23141 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
23142
23143 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
23144 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
23145 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
23146 port 1234 on your local machine:
23147
23148 @smallexample
23149 target remote :1234
23150 @end smallexample
23151 @noindent
23152
23153 Note that the colon is still required here.
23154
23155 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23156 @itemx target remote @code{udp:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
23157 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23158 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
23159 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23160 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23161 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
23162 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23163 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
23164 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:[@var{host}]:@var{port}}
23165 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
23166 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
23167 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
23168
23169 @smallexample
23170 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
23171 @end smallexample
23172
23173 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
23174 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
23175 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
23176 cause havoc with your debugging session.
23177
23178 @item target remote | @var{command}
23179 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
23180 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
23181 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
23182 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
23183 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
23184 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
23185 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
23186 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
23187 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
23188
23189 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
23190 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
23191 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
23192
23193 @end table
23194
23195 @cindex interrupting remote programs
23196 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
23197 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
23198 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
23199 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
23200 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
23201 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
23202
23203 @smallexample
23204 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
23205 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
23206 @end smallexample
23207
23208 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
23209 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
23210 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
23211 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
23212
23213 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
23214 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
23215
23216 @table @code
23217 @kindex detach (remote)
23218 @item detach
23219 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
23220 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
23221 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
23222 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
23223 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
23224 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
23225 still connected to the target.
23226
23227 @kindex disconnect
23228 @item disconnect
23229 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
23230 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
23231 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
23232 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
23233 another target.
23234
23235 @cindex send command to remote monitor
23236 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
23237 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
23238 @kindex monitor
23239 @item monitor @var{cmd}
23240 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
23241 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
23242 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
23243 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
23244 and implement.
23245 @end table
23246
23247 @node File Transfer
23248 @section Sending files to a remote system
23249 @cindex remote target, file transfer
23250 @cindex file transfer
23251 @cindex sending files to remote systems
23252
23253 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
23254 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
23255 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
23256 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
23257 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
23258 the only way to upload or download files.
23259
23260 Not all remote targets support these commands.
23261
23262 @table @code
23263 @kindex remote put
23264 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
23265 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
23266 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
23267
23268 @kindex remote get
23269 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
23270 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
23271 on the host system.
23272
23273 @kindex remote delete
23274 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
23275 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
23276
23277 @end table
23278
23279 @node Server
23280 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
23281
23282 @kindex gdbserver
23283 @cindex remote connection without stubs
23284 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
23285 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
23286 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
23287 linking in the usual debugging stub.
23288
23289 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
23290 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
23291 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
23292 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
23293 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
23294 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
23295 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
23296 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
23297 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
23298 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
23299 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
23300 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
23301 choice for debugging.
23302
23303 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
23304 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
23305 protocol.
23306
23307 @quotation
23308 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
23309 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
23310 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
23311 target system with the same privileges as the user running
23312 @code{gdbserver}.
23313 @end quotation
23314
23315 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
23316 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
23317 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
23318 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
23319
23320 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
23321 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
23322 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
23323 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
23324 system does all the symbol handling.
23325
23326 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
23327 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
23328 syntax is:
23329
23330 @smallexample
23331 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
23332 @end smallexample
23333
23334 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
23335 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
23336 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
23337 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
23338 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
23339 @file{/dev/com1}:
23340
23341 @smallexample
23342 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
23343 @end smallexample
23344
23345 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
23346 with it.
23347
23348 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
23349
23350 @smallexample
23351 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
23352 @end smallexample
23353
23354 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
23355 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
23356 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
23357 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
23358 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
23359 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
23360 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
23361 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
23362 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
23363 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
23364 @code{target remote} command.
23365
23366 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
23367 with ssh:
23368
23369 @smallexample
23370 (@value{GDBP}) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
23371 @end smallexample
23372
23373 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
23374 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
23375 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
23376 You could elide it if you want to.
23377
23378 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
23379 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
23380 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
23381 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
23382
23383 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
23384 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
23385 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
23386 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
23387
23388 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
23389 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
23390
23391 @smallexample
23392 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
23393 @end smallexample
23394
23395 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
23396 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
23397
23398 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
23399 @value{GDBN} attach command
23400 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
23401
23402 @pindex pidof
23403 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
23404 @code{pidof} utility:
23405
23406 @smallexample
23407 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
23408 @end smallexample
23409
23410 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
23411 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
23412 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
23413
23414 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
23415
23416 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
23417 port.
23418
23419 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
23420 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
23421 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
23422 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
23423 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
23424 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
23425 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
23426 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
23427
23428 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
23429 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
23430 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
23431
23432 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
23433 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
23434 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
23435 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
23436 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
23437 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
23438 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
23439 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
23440 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
23441 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
23442 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
23443 instance closes its port after the first connection.
23444
23445 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
23446 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
23447
23448 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
23449 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
23450 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
23451 program. For more information,
23452 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
23453
23454 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
23455 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
23456 status information about the debugging process.
23457 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
23458 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
23459 remote protocol debug output.
23460 @cindex @option{--debug-file}, @code{gdbserver} option
23461 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, send all debug output to a single file
23462 The @option{--debug-file=@var{filename}} option tells @code{gdbserver} to
23463 write any debug output to the given @var{filename}. These options are intended
23464 for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
23465
23466 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
23467 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
23468 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
23469 Possible options are:
23470
23471 @table @code
23472 @item none
23473 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
23474 @item all
23475 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
23476 @item timestamps
23477 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
23478 @end table
23479
23480 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
23481 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
23482
23483 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
23484 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
23485 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
23486 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
23487 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
23488
23489 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
23490 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
23491 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
23492 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
23493
23494 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
23495 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
23496 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
23497 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
23498
23499 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
23500 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
23501 environment:
23502
23503 @smallexample
23504 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
23505 @end smallexample
23506
23507 @cindex @option{--selftest}
23508 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
23509
23510 @smallexample
23511 $ gdbserver --selftest
23512 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
23513 @end smallexample
23514
23515 These tests are disabled in release.
23516 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
23517
23518 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
23519 @itemize
23520
23521 @item
23522 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
23523
23524 @item
23525 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
23526 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
23527 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
23528 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
23529 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
23530 @code{--with-sysroot}).
23531
23532 @item
23533 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
23534 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
23535 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
23536 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
23537 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
23538 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
23539 program is already on the target.
23540
23541 @end itemize
23542
23543 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
23544 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
23545 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
23546
23547 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
23548 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
23549 Here are the available commands.
23550
23551 @table @code
23552 @item monitor help
23553 List the available monitor commands.
23554
23555 @item monitor set debug 0
23556 @itemx monitor set debug 1
23557 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
23558
23559 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
23560 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
23561 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
23562 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
23563
23564 @item monitor set debug-file filename
23565 @itemx monitor set debug-file
23566 Send any debug output to the given file, or to stderr.
23567
23568 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
23569 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
23570 Possible options are:
23571
23572 @table @code
23573 @item none
23574 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
23575 @item all
23576 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
23577 @item timestamps
23578 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
23579 @end table
23580
23581 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
23582 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
23583
23584 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
23585 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
23586 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
23587 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
23588 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
23589 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
23590
23591 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
23592 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
23593
23594 @item monitor exit
23595 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
23596 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
23597 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
23598 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
23599 of a multi-process mode debug session.
23600
23601 @end table
23602
23603 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
23604 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
23605
23606 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
23607 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
23608
23609 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
23610 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
23611 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
23612 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
23613 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
23614 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
23615 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
23616 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
23617 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
23618 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
23619 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
23620 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
23621
23622 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
23623
23624 @table @code
23625 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
23626
23627 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
23628 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
23629 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
23630
23631 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
23632
23633 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
23634 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
23635 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
23636 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
23637 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
23638 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
23639
23640 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
23641
23642 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
23643 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
23644 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
23645 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
23646 command for that. For example:
23647
23648 @smallexample
23649 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
23650 @end smallexample
23651
23652 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
23653 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
23654 @end table
23655
23656 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
23657 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
23658 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
23659 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
23660 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
23661 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
23662 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
23663 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
23664 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
23665 @code{gdbserver} like so:
23666
23667 @smallexample
23668 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
23669 @end smallexample
23670
23671 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
23672
23673 @smallexample
23674 $ gdb myprogram
23675 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
23676 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
23677 (@value{GDBP}) b main
23678 (@value{GDBP}) continue
23679 @end smallexample
23680
23681 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
23682 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
23683 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
23684 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
23685 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
23686 tracing.
23687
23688 @node Remote Configuration
23689 @section Remote Configuration
23690
23691 @kindex set remote
23692 @kindex show remote
23693 This section documents the configuration options available when
23694 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
23695 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
23696 system-call-allowed}.
23697
23698 @table @code
23699 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
23700 @cindex address size for remote targets
23701 @cindex bits in remote address
23702 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
23703 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
23704 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
23705 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
23706
23707 @item show remoteaddresssize
23708 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
23709
23710 @item set serial baud @var{n}
23711 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
23712 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
23713 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
23714 remote targets.
23715
23716 @item show serial baud
23717 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
23718
23719 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
23720 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
23721 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
23722
23723 @item show serial parity
23724 Show the current parity of the serial port.
23725
23726 @item set remotebreak
23727 @cindex interrupt remote programs
23728 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
23729 @anchor{set remotebreak}
23730 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
23731 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
23732 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
23733 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
23734 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
23735
23736 @item show remotebreak
23737 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
23738 interrupt the remote program.
23739
23740 @item set remoteflow on
23741 @itemx set remoteflow off
23742 @kindex set remoteflow
23743 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
23744 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
23745
23746 @item show remoteflow
23747 @kindex show remoteflow
23748 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
23749
23750 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
23751 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
23752 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
23753 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
23754 @code{ascii}.
23755
23756 @item show remotelogbase
23757 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
23758 protocol.
23759
23760 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
23761 @cindex record serial communications on file
23762 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
23763 default is not to record at all.
23764
23765 @item show remotelogfile
23766 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
23767 serial communications.
23768
23769 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
23770 @cindex timeout for serial communications
23771 @cindex remote timeout
23772 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
23773 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
23774
23775 @item show remotetimeout
23776 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
23777 responses.
23778
23779 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
23780 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
23781 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
23782 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
23783 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
23784 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
23785 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
23786 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
23787 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
23788 watchpoints or breakpoints.
23789
23790 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
23791 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
23792 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
23793 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
23794
23795 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
23796 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
23797 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
23798 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
23799 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
23800 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
23801 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
23802 length.
23803
23804 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
23805 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
23806 a remote hardware watchpoint.
23807
23808 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
23809 @itemx show remote exec-file
23810 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
23811 @cindex executable file, for remote target
23812 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
23813 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
23814 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
23815 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
23816
23817 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
23818 @cindex interrupt remote programs
23819 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
23820 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
23821 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
23822 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
23823 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
23824 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
23825 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
23826 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
23827
23828 @item show remote interrupt-sequence
23829 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
23830 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
23831 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
23832 also known as Magic SysRq g.
23833
23834 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
23835 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
23836 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
23837 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
23838 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
23839 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
23840
23841 @item show remote interrupt-on-connect
23842 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
23843 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
23844
23845 @kindex set tcp
23846 @kindex show tcp
23847 @item set tcp auto-retry on
23848 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
23849 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
23850 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
23851 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
23852 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
23853 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
23854 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
23855 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
23856
23857 @item set tcp auto-retry off
23858 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
23859
23860 @item show tcp auto-retry
23861 Show the current auto-retry setting.
23862
23863 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
23864 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
23865 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
23866 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
23867 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
23868 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
23869 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
23870 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
23871 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
23872 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
23873 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
23874
23875 @item show tcp connect-timeout
23876 Show the current connection timeout setting.
23877 @end table
23878
23879 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
23880 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
23881 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
23882 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
23883 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
23884 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
23885 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
23886 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
23887 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
23888
23889 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
23890 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
23891 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
23892 @value{GDBN} developers.
23893
23894 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
23895 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. If you configure a packet, the
23896 configuration will apply for all future remote targets if no target is selected.
23897 In case there is a target selected, only the configuration of the current target
23898 is changed. All other existing remote targets' features are not affected.
23899 The command to print the current configuration of a packet is
23900 @code{show remote @var{name}-packet}. It displays the current remote target's
23901 configuration. If no remote target is selected, the default configuration for
23902 future connections is shown. The available settings are:
23903
23904 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
23905 @item Command Name
23906 @tab Remote Packet
23907 @tab Related Features
23908
23909 @item @code{fetch-register}
23910 @tab @code{p}
23911 @tab @code{info registers}
23912
23913 @item @code{set-register}
23914 @tab @code{P}
23915 @tab @code{set}
23916
23917 @item @code{binary-download}
23918 @tab @code{X}
23919 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
23920
23921 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
23922 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
23923 @tab @code{info auxv}
23924
23925 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
23926 @tab @code{qSymbol}
23927 @tab Detecting multiple threads
23928
23929 @item @code{attach}
23930 @tab @code{vAttach}
23931 @tab @code{attach}
23932
23933 @item @code{verbose-resume}
23934 @tab @code{vCont}
23935 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
23936
23937 @item @code{run}
23938 @tab @code{vRun}
23939 @tab @code{run}
23940
23941 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
23942 @tab @code{Z0}
23943 @tab @code{break}
23944
23945 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
23946 @tab @code{Z1}
23947 @tab @code{hbreak}
23948
23949 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
23950 @tab @code{Z2}
23951 @tab @code{watch}
23952
23953 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
23954 @tab @code{Z3}
23955 @tab @code{rwatch}
23956
23957 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
23958 @tab @code{Z4}
23959 @tab @code{awatch}
23960
23961 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
23962 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
23963 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
23964
23965 @item @code{target-features}
23966 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
23967 @tab @code{set architecture}
23968
23969 @item @code{library-info}
23970 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
23971 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
23972
23973 @item @code{memory-map}
23974 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23975 @tab @code{info mem}
23976
23977 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
23978 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
23979 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
23980
23981 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
23982 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
23983 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
23984
23985 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
23986 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
23987 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
23988
23989 @item @code{threads}
23990 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
23991 @tab @code{info threads}
23992
23993 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
23994 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
23995 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
23996
23997 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
23998 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
23999 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
24000
24001 @item @code{search-memory}
24002 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
24003 @tab @code{find}
24004
24005 @item @code{supported-packets}
24006 @tab @code{qSupported}
24007 @tab Remote communications parameters
24008
24009 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
24010 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
24011 @tab @code{catch syscall}
24012
24013 @item @code{pass-signals}
24014 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
24015 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
24016
24017 @item @code{program-signals}
24018 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
24019 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
24020
24021 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
24022 @tab @code{vFile:close}
24023 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
24024
24025 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
24026 @tab @code{vFile:open}
24027 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
24028
24029 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
24030 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
24031 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
24032
24033 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
24034 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
24035 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
24036
24037 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
24038 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
24039 @tab @code{remote delete}
24040
24041 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
24042 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
24043 @tab Host I/O
24044
24045 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
24046 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
24047 @tab Host I/O
24048
24049 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
24050 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
24051 @tab Host I/O
24052
24053 @item @code{noack-packet}
24054 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
24055 @tab Packet acknowledgment
24056
24057 @item @code{osdata}
24058 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
24059 @tab @code{info os}
24060
24061 @item @code{query-attached}
24062 @tab @code{qAttached}
24063 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
24064
24065 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
24066 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
24067 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
24068
24069 @item @code{trace-status}
24070 @tab @code{qTStatus}
24071 @tab @code{tstatus}
24072
24073 @item @code{traceframe-info}
24074 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
24075 @tab Traceframe info
24076
24077 @item @code{install-in-trace}
24078 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
24079 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
24080
24081 @item @code{disable-randomization}
24082 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
24083 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
24084
24085 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
24086 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
24087 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
24088
24089 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
24090 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
24091 @tab @code{set environment}
24092
24093 @item @code{environment-unset}
24094 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
24095 @tab @code{unset environment}
24096
24097 @item @code{environment-reset}
24098 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
24099 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
24100
24101 @item @code{set-working-dir}
24102 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
24103 @tab @code{set cwd}
24104
24105 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
24106 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
24107 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
24108
24109 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
24110 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
24111 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
24112
24113 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
24114 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
24115 @tab @code{break}
24116
24117 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
24118 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
24119 @tab @code{hbreak}
24120
24121 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
24122 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
24123 @tab @code{fork}
24124
24125 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
24126 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
24127 @tab @code{vfork}
24128
24129 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
24130 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
24131 @tab @code{exec}
24132
24133 @item @code{thread-events}
24134 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
24135 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
24136
24137 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
24138 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
24139 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
24140
24141 @end multitable
24142
24143 @cindex packet size, remote, configuring
24144 The number of bytes per memory-read or memory-write packet for a remote target
24145 can be configured using the commands
24146 @w{@code{set remote memory-read-packet-size}} and
24147 @w{@code{set remote memory-write-packet-size}}. If set to @samp{0} (zero) the
24148 default packet size will be used. The actual limit is further reduced depending
24149 on the target. Specify @samp{fixed} to disable the target-dependent restriction
24150 and @samp{limit} to enable it. Similar to the enabling and disabling of remote
24151 packets, the command applies to the currently selected target (if available).
24152 If no remote target is selected, it applies to all future remote connections.
24153 The configuration of the selected target can be displayed using the commands
24154 @w{@code{show remote memory-read-packet-size}} and
24155 @w{@code{show remote memory-write-packet-size}}. If no remote target is
24156 selected, the default configuration for future connections is shown.
24157
24158 @node Remote Stub
24159 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
24160
24161 @cindex debugging stub, example
24162 @cindex remote stub, example
24163 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
24164 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
24165 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
24166 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
24167 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
24168 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
24169 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
24170 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
24171
24172 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
24173 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
24174 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
24175 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
24176 program, you need:
24177
24178 @enumerate
24179 @item
24180 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
24181 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
24182 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
24183
24184 @item
24185 A C subroutine library to support your program's
24186 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
24187
24188 @item
24189 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
24190 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
24191 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
24192 documentation.
24193 @end enumerate
24194
24195 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
24196 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
24197 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
24198
24199 @table @emph
24200 @item On the host,
24201 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
24202 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
24203 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24204
24205 @item On the target,
24206 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
24207 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
24208 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
24209
24210 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
24211 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
24212 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
24213 @end table
24214
24215 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
24216 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
24217 @sc{sparc} boards.
24218
24219 @cindex remote serial stub list
24220 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
24221
24222 @table @code
24223
24224 @item i386-stub.c
24225 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
24226 @cindex Intel
24227 @cindex i386
24228 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
24229
24230 @item m68k-stub.c
24231 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
24232 @cindex Motorola 680x0
24233 @cindex m680x0
24234 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
24235
24236 @item sh-stub.c
24237 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
24238 @cindex Renesas
24239 @cindex SH
24240 For Renesas SH architectures.
24241
24242 @item sparc-stub.c
24243 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
24244 @cindex Sparc
24245 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
24246
24247 @item sparcl-stub.c
24248 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
24249 @cindex Fujitsu
24250 @cindex SparcLite
24251 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
24252
24253 @end table
24254
24255 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
24256 recently added stubs.
24257
24258 @menu
24259 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
24260 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
24261 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
24262 @end menu
24263
24264 @node Stub Contents
24265 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
24266
24267 @cindex remote serial stub
24268 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
24269 subroutines:
24270
24271 @table @code
24272 @item set_debug_traps
24273 @findex set_debug_traps
24274 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
24275 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
24276 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
24277 program's startup code.
24278
24279 @item handle_exception
24280 @findex handle_exception
24281 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
24282 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
24283 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
24284 run when a trap is triggered.
24285
24286 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
24287 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
24288 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
24289 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
24290 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
24291 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
24292 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
24293 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
24294 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
24295 machine.
24296
24297 @item breakpoint
24298 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
24299 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
24300 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
24301 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
24302 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
24303 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
24304 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
24305 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
24306 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
24307 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
24308 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
24309
24310 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
24311 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
24312 start of your debugging session.
24313 @end table
24314
24315 @node Bootstrapping
24316 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
24317
24318 @cindex remote stub, support routines
24319 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
24320 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
24321 debugging target machine.
24322
24323 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
24324 serial port.
24325
24326 @table @code
24327 @item int getDebugChar()
24328 @findex getDebugChar
24329 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
24330 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
24331 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
24332
24333 @item void putDebugChar(int)
24334 @findex putDebugChar
24335 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
24336 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
24337 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
24338 @end table
24339
24340 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
24341 @cindex interrupting remote targets
24342 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
24343 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
24344 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
24345 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
24346 remote system to stop.
24347
24348 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
24349 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
24350 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
24351 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
24352
24353 Other routines you need to supply are:
24354
24355 @table @code
24356 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
24357 @findex exceptionHandler
24358 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
24359 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
24360 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
24361 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
24362 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
24363 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
24364 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
24365 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
24366 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
24367 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
24368 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
24369 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
24370 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
24371
24372 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
24373 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
24374 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
24375 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
24376 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
24377
24378 @item void flush_i_cache()
24379 @findex flush_i_cache
24380 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
24381 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
24382 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
24383
24384 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
24385 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
24386 @end table
24387
24388 @noindent
24389 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
24390
24391 @table @code
24392 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
24393 @findex memset
24394 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
24395 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
24396 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
24397 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
24398 @end table
24399
24400 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
24401 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
24402 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
24403 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
24404
24405
24406 @node Debug Session
24407 @subsection Putting it All Together
24408
24409 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
24410 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
24411 steps.
24412
24413 @enumerate
24414 @item
24415 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
24416 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
24417 @display
24418 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
24419 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
24420 @end display
24421
24422 @item
24423 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
24424 procedure is called:
24425
24426 @smallexample
24427 set_debug_traps();
24428 breakpoint();
24429 @end smallexample
24430
24431 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
24432 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
24433 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
24434 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
24435 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
24436 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
24437 progress.
24438
24439 @item
24440 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
24441 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
24442
24443 @smallexample
24444 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
24445 @end smallexample
24446
24447 @noindent
24448 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
24449 function in your program, that function is called when
24450 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
24451 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
24452 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
24453
24454 @item
24455 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
24456 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
24457
24458 @item
24459 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
24460 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
24461
24462 @item
24463 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
24464 @c document that. FIXME.
24465 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
24466 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
24467
24468 @item
24469 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
24470 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
24471
24472 @end enumerate
24473
24474 @node Configurations
24475 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
24476
24477 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
24478 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
24479 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
24480
24481 There are three major categories of configurations: native
24482 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
24483 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
24484 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
24485 are quite different from each other.
24486
24487 @menu
24488 * Native::
24489 * Embedded OS::
24490 * Embedded Processors::
24491 * Architectures::
24492 @end menu
24493
24494 @node Native
24495 @section Native
24496
24497 This section describes details specific to particular native
24498 configurations.
24499
24500 @menu
24501 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
24502 * Process Information:: Process information
24503 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
24504 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
24505 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
24506 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
24507 * FreeBSD:: Features specific to FreeBSD
24508 @end menu
24509
24510 @node BSD libkvm Interface
24511 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
24512
24513 @cindex libkvm
24514 @cindex kernel memory image
24515 @cindex kernel crash dump
24516
24517 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
24518 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
24519 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
24520 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
24521 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
24522 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
24523 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
24524 @code{kvm} target:
24525
24526 @smallexample
24527 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
24528 @end smallexample
24529
24530 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
24531 argument:
24532
24533 @smallexample
24534 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
24535 @end smallexample
24536
24537 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
24538 available:
24539
24540 @table @code
24541 @kindex kvm
24542 @item kvm pcb
24543 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
24544
24545 @item kvm proc
24546 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
24547 modern FreeBSD systems.
24548 @end table
24549
24550 @node Process Information
24551 @subsection Process Information
24552 @cindex /proc
24553 @cindex examine process image
24554 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
24555
24556 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
24557 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
24558 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
24559 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
24560 to report information about the process running your program, or about
24561 any process running on your system.
24562
24563 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
24564 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
24565 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
24566 systems.
24567
24568 On FreeBSD and NetBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query
24569 process information.
24570
24571 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
24572 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
24573 information available from a live process. Process information is
24574 currently available from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
24575 systems.
24576
24577 @table @code
24578 @kindex info proc
24579 @cindex process ID
24580 @item info proc
24581 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
24582 Summarize available information about a process. If a
24583 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
24584 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
24585 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
24586 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
24587 executable file's absolute file name.
24588
24589 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
24590 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
24591 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
24592 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
24593 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
24594 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
24595
24596 @item info proc cmdline
24597 @cindex info proc cmdline
24598 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
24599 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
24600
24601 @item info proc cwd
24602 @cindex info proc cwd
24603 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
24604 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
24605
24606 @item info proc exe
24607 @cindex info proc exe
24608 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
24609 on @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
24610
24611 @item info proc files
24612 @cindex info proc files
24613 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
24614 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
24615 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
24616 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
24617 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
24618 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
24619 FreeBSD.
24620
24621 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
24622 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
24623
24624 @smallexample
24625 (@value{GDBP}) info proc files 22136
24626 process 22136
24627 Open files:
24628
24629 FD Type Offset Flags Name
24630 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
24631 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
24632 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
24633 root dir - r-------- /
24634 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
24635 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
24636 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
24637 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
24638 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
24639 @end smallexample
24640
24641 @item info proc mappings
24642 @cindex memory address space mappings
24643 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
24644 Solaris, FreeBSD and NetBSD systems, each memory range includes information
24645 on whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
24646 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD systems, each memory range
24647 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
24648
24649 @item info proc stat
24650 @itemx info proc status
24651 @cindex process detailed status information
24652 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
24653 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
24654 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
24655 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
24656 on @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD and NetBSD.
24657
24658 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
24659 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
24660
24661 For FreeBSD and NetBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for
24662 @code{info proc status}.
24663
24664 @item info proc all
24665 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
24666 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
24667
24668 @ignore
24669 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
24670 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
24671 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
24672 @kindex info proc times
24673 @item info proc times
24674 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
24675 its children.
24676
24677 @kindex info proc id
24678 @item info proc id
24679 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
24680 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
24681 @end ignore
24682
24683 @item set procfs-trace
24684 @kindex set procfs-trace
24685 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
24686 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
24687
24688 @item show procfs-trace
24689 @kindex show procfs-trace
24690 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
24691
24692 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
24693 @kindex set procfs-file
24694 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
24695 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
24696 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
24697 standard output.
24698
24699 @item show procfs-file
24700 @kindex show procfs-file
24701 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
24702
24703 @item proc-trace-entry
24704 @itemx proc-trace-exit
24705 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
24706 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
24707 @kindex proc-trace-entry
24708 @kindex proc-trace-exit
24709 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
24710 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
24711 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
24712 from the @code{syscall} interface.
24713
24714 @item info pidlist
24715 @kindex info pidlist
24716 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
24717 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
24718 processes and all the threads within each process.
24719
24720 @item info meminfo
24721 @kindex info meminfo
24722 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
24723 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
24724 @end table
24725
24726 @node DJGPP Native
24727 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
24728 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
24729 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
24730 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
24731
24732 @cindex DPMI
24733 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
24734 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
24735 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
24736 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
24737
24738 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
24739 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
24740 subsection describes those commands.
24741
24742 @table @code
24743 @kindex info dos
24744 @item info dos
24745 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
24746 information about the target system and important OS structures.
24747
24748 @kindex sysinfo
24749 @cindex MS-DOS system info
24750 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
24751 @item info dos sysinfo
24752 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
24753 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
24754 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
24755
24756 @cindex GDT
24757 @cindex LDT
24758 @cindex IDT
24759 @cindex segment descriptor tables
24760 @cindex descriptor tables display
24761 @item info dos gdt
24762 @itemx info dos ldt
24763 @itemx info dos idt
24764 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
24765 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
24766 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
24767 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
24768 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
24769 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
24770 rights.
24771
24772 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
24773 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
24774 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
24775 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
24776 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
24777
24778 @cindex garbled pointers
24779 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
24780 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
24781 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
24782 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
24783 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
24784 debugged program's data segment:
24785
24786 @smallexample
24787 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
24788 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
24789 @end smallexample
24790
24791 @noindent
24792 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
24793 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
24794
24795 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
24796 @item info dos pde
24797 @itemx info dos pte
24798 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
24799 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
24800 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
24801 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
24802 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
24803 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
24804 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
24805 that is currently in use.
24806
24807 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
24808 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
24809 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
24810 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
24811 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
24812 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
24813 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
24814
24815 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
24816 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
24817 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
24818 controller.
24819
24820 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
24821
24822 @cindex physical address from linear address
24823 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
24824 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
24825 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
24826 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
24827 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
24828 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
24829 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
24830
24831 @smallexample
24832 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
24833 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
24834 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
24835 @end smallexample
24836
24837 @noindent
24838 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
24839 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
24840 attributes of that page.
24841
24842 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
24843 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
24844 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
24845 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
24846 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
24847 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
24848
24849 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
24850 transfer buffer:
24851
24852 @smallexample
24853 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
24854 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
24855 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
24856 @end smallexample
24857
24858 @noindent
24859 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
24860 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
24861 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
24862 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
24863 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
24864
24865 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
24866 @end table
24867
24868 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
24869 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
24870 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
24871 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
24872
24873 @table @code
24874 @kindex set com1base
24875 @kindex set com1irq
24876 @kindex set com2base
24877 @kindex set com2irq
24878 @kindex set com3base
24879 @kindex set com3irq
24880 @kindex set com4base
24881 @kindex set com4irq
24882 @item set com1base @var{addr}
24883 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
24884 port.
24885
24886 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
24887 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
24888 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
24889
24890 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
24891 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
24892 other 3 COM ports.
24893
24894 @kindex show com1base
24895 @kindex show com1irq
24896 @kindex show com2base
24897 @kindex show com2irq
24898 @kindex show com3base
24899 @kindex show com3irq
24900 @kindex show com4base
24901 @kindex show com4irq
24902 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
24903 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
24904 lines used by the COM ports.
24905
24906 @item info serial
24907 @kindex info serial
24908 @cindex DOS serial port status
24909 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
24910 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
24911 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
24912 counts of various errors encountered so far.
24913 @end table
24914
24915
24916 @node Cygwin Native
24917 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
24918 @cindex MS Windows debugging
24919 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
24920 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
24921
24922 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
24923 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
24924
24925 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
24926 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
24927 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
24928 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
24929 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
24930 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
24931 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
24932 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
24933
24934 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
24935 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
24936 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
24937
24938 @table @code
24939 @kindex info w32
24940 @item info w32
24941 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
24942 information about the target system and important OS structures.
24943
24944 @item info w32 selector
24945 This command displays information returned by
24946 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
24947 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
24948 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
24949 Without argument, this command displays information
24950 about the six segment registers.
24951
24952 @item info w32 thread-information-block
24953 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
24954 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
24955 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
24956
24957 @kindex signal-event
24958 @item signal-event @var{id}
24959 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
24960 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
24961
24962 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
24963 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
24964 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
24965 (for x86_64 versions):
24966
24967 @itemize @minus
24968 @item
24969 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
24970 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
24971 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
24972
24973 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
24974 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
24975 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
24976 to attach.
24977
24978 @item
24979 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
24980 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
24981 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
24982 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
24983 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
24984 @end itemize
24985
24986 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
24987 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
24988 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
24989 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
24990 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
24991 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
24992 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
24993 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
24994 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
24995 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
24996 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
24997
24998 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
24999 @item show cygwin-exceptions
25000 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
25001 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
25002
25003 @kindex set new-console
25004 @item set new-console @var{mode}
25005 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
25006 be started in a new console on next start.
25007 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
25008 be started in the same console as the debugger.
25009
25010 @kindex show new-console
25011 @item show new-console
25012 Displays whether a new console is used
25013 when the debuggee is started.
25014
25015 @kindex set new-group
25016 @item set new-group @var{mode}
25017 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
25018 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
25019 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
25020 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
25021
25022 @kindex show new-group
25023 @item show new-group
25024 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
25025
25026 @kindex set debugevents
25027 @item set debugevents
25028 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
25029 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
25030 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
25031 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
25032 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
25033
25034 @kindex set debugexec
25035 @item set debugexec
25036 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
25037 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
25038
25039 @kindex set debugexceptions
25040 @item set debugexceptions
25041 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
25042 debuggee seen by the debugger.
25043
25044 @kindex set debugmemory
25045 @item set debugmemory
25046 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
25047 and writes by the debugger.
25048
25049 @kindex set shell
25050 @item set shell
25051 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
25052 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
25053
25054 @kindex show shell
25055 @item show shell
25056 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
25057
25058 @end table
25059
25060 @menu
25061 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
25062 @end menu
25063
25064 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
25065 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
25066 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
25067 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
25068
25069 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
25070 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
25071 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
25072 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
25073 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
25074 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
25075 ``minimal symbols''.
25076
25077 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
25078 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
25079 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
25080 program run once to completion.
25081
25082 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
25083
25084 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
25085 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
25086 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
25087 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
25088 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
25089 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
25090 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
25091 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
25092 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
25093
25094 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
25095 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
25096 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
25097 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
25098 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
25099 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
25100
25101 @smallexample
25102 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
25103 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
25104
25105 Non-debugging symbols:
25106 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
25107 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
25108 @end smallexample
25109
25110 @smallexample
25111 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
25112 All functions matching regular expression "!":
25113
25114 Non-debugging symbols:
25115 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
25116 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
25117 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
25118 [etc...]
25119 @end smallexample
25120
25121 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
25122
25123 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
25124 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
25125 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
25126 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
25127 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
25128 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
25129 a function within a DLL without a running program.
25130
25131 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
25132 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
25133 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
25134 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
25135 problem:
25136
25137 @smallexample
25138 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
25139 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
25140 @end smallexample
25141
25142 @smallexample
25143 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
25144 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
25145 @end smallexample
25146
25147 And two possible solutions:
25148
25149 @smallexample
25150 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
25151 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
25152 @end smallexample
25153
25154 @smallexample
25155 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
25156 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
25157 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
25158 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
25159 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
25160 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
25161 @end smallexample
25162
25163 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
25164 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
25165 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
25166 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
25167 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
25168
25169 @smallexample
25170 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
25171 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
25172 @end smallexample
25173
25174 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
25175 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
25176 safe.
25177
25178 @node Hurd Native
25179 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
25180 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
25181
25182 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
25183 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
25184
25185 @table @code
25186 @item set signals
25187 @itemx set sigs
25188 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
25189 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
25190 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
25191 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
25192 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
25193 @code{signals}.
25194
25195 @item show signals
25196 @itemx show sigs
25197 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
25198 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
25199 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
25200
25201 @item set signal-thread
25202 @itemx set sigthread
25203 @kindex set signal-thread
25204 @kindex set sigthread
25205 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
25206 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
25207 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
25208 signal-thread}.
25209
25210 @item show signal-thread
25211 @itemx show sigthread
25212 @kindex show signal-thread
25213 @kindex show sigthread
25214 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
25215 delivered a signal.
25216
25217 @item set stopped
25218 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
25219 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
25220 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
25221 continued by delivering a signal to it.
25222
25223 @item show stopped
25224 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
25225 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
25226 stopped.
25227
25228 @item set exceptions
25229 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
25230 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
25231 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
25232 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
25233 trapping on.
25234
25235 @item show exceptions
25236 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
25237 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
25238
25239 @item set task pause
25240 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
25241 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
25242 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
25243 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
25244 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
25245 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
25246 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
25247 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
25248 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
25249
25250 @item show task pause
25251 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
25252 Show the current state of task suspension.
25253
25254 @item set task detach-suspend-count
25255 @cindex task suspend count
25256 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25257 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
25258 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
25259
25260 @item show task detach-suspend-count
25261 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
25262
25263 @item set task exception-port
25264 @itemx set task excp
25265 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25266 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
25267 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
25268 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
25269
25270 @item set noninvasive
25271 @cindex noninvasive task options
25272 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
25273 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
25274 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
25275 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
25276
25277 @item info send-rights
25278 @itemx info receive-rights
25279 @itemx info port-rights
25280 @itemx info port-sets
25281 @itemx info dead-names
25282 @itemx info ports
25283 @itemx info psets
25284 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25285 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25286 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25287 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25288 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25289 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
25290 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
25291 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
25292 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
25293
25294 @item set thread pause
25295 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
25296 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25297 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
25298 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
25299 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
25300 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
25301 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
25302 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
25303 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
25304 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
25305 only the current thread.
25306
25307 @item show thread pause
25308 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
25309 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
25310
25311 @item set thread run
25312 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
25313
25314 @item show thread run
25315 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
25316
25317 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
25318 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25319 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25320 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
25321 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
25322 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
25323 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
25324
25325 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
25326 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
25327 detaching.
25328
25329 @item set thread exception-port
25330 @itemx set thread excp
25331 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
25332 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
25333 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
25334
25335 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
25336 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
25337 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
25338 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
25339
25340 @item set thread default
25341 @itemx show thread default
25342 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
25343 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
25344 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
25345 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
25346 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
25347 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
25348 the non-default commands.
25349 @end table
25350
25351 @node Darwin
25352 @subsection Darwin
25353 @cindex Darwin
25354
25355 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
25356
25357 @table @code
25358 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
25359 @kindex set debug darwin
25360 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
25361 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
25362
25363 @item show debug darwin
25364 @kindex show debug darwin
25365 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
25366
25367 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
25368 @kindex set debug mach-o
25369 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
25370 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
25371 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
25372 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
25373 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
25374 usage.
25375
25376 @item show debug mach-o
25377 @kindex show debug mach-o
25378 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
25379
25380 @item set mach-exceptions on
25381 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
25382 @kindex set mach-exceptions
25383 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
25384 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
25385 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
25386 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
25387
25388 @item show mach-exceptions
25389 @kindex show mach-exceptions
25390 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
25391 @end table
25392
25393 @node FreeBSD
25394 @subsection FreeBSD
25395 @cindex FreeBSD
25396
25397 When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this
25398 is implemented by leaving a compatibility system call using the old
25399 ABI at the existing number and allocating a new system call number for
25400 the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a system call
25401 is caught by name (@pxref{catch syscall}), compatibility system calls
25402 are also caught.
25403
25404 For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the @code{kevent}
25405 system call and catching the @code{kevent} system call by name catches
25406 both variants:
25407
25408 @smallexample
25409 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall kevent
25410 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'freebsd11_kevent' [363] 'kevent' [560])
25411 (@value{GDBP})
25412 @end smallexample
25413
25414
25415 @node Embedded OS
25416 @section Embedded Operating Systems
25417
25418 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
25419 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
25420 architectures.
25421
25422 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
25423 various real-time operating systems.
25424
25425 @node Embedded Processors
25426 @section Embedded Processors
25427
25428 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
25429 configurations.
25430
25431 @cindex send command to simulator
25432 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
25433 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
25434
25435 @table @code
25436 @item sim @var{command}
25437 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
25438 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
25439 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
25440 acceptable commands.
25441 @end table
25442
25443
25444 @menu
25445 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
25446 * ARM:: ARM
25447 * BPF:: eBPF
25448 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
25449 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
25450 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
25451 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
25452 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
25453 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
25454 * CRIS:: CRIS
25455 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
25456 @end menu
25457
25458 @node ARC
25459 @subsection Synopsys ARC
25460 @cindex Synopsys ARC
25461 @cindex ARC specific commands
25462 @cindex ARC600
25463 @cindex ARC700
25464 @cindex ARC EM
25465 @cindex ARC HS
25466
25467 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
25468
25469 @table @code
25470 @item set debug arc
25471 @kindex set debug arc
25472 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
25473 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
25474
25475 @item show debug arc
25476 @kindex show debug arc
25477 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
25478
25479 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
25480 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
25481 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
25482
25483 @end table
25484
25485 @node ARM
25486 @subsection ARM
25487
25488 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
25489
25490 @table @code
25491 @item set arm disassembler
25492 @kindex set arm
25493 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
25494 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
25495
25496 @item show arm disassembler
25497 @kindex show arm
25498 Show the current disassembly style.
25499
25500 @item set arm apcs32
25501 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
25502 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
25503
25504 @item show arm apcs32
25505 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
25506
25507 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
25508 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
25509 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
25510
25511 @table @code
25512 @item auto
25513 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
25514 @item softfpa
25515 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
25516 processors.
25517 @item fpa
25518 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
25519 @item softvfp
25520 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
25521 @item vfp
25522 VFP co-processor.
25523 @end table
25524
25525 @item show arm fpu
25526 Show the current type of the FPU.
25527
25528 @item set arm abi
25529 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
25530
25531 @item show arm abi
25532 Show the currently used ABI.
25533
25534 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
25535 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
25536 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
25537 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
25538 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
25539 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
25540 register).
25541
25542 @item show arm fallback-mode
25543 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
25544
25545 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
25546 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
25547 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
25548 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
25549 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
25550
25551 @item show arm force-mode
25552 Show the current forced instruction mode.
25553
25554 @item set arm unwind-secure-frames
25555 This command enables unwinding from Non-secure to Secure mode on
25556 Cortex-M with Security extension.
25557 This can trigger security exceptions when unwinding the exception
25558 stack.
25559 It is enabled by default.
25560
25561 @item show arm unwind-secure-frames
25562 Show whether unwinding from Non-secure to Secure mode is enabled.
25563
25564 @item set debug arm
25565 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
25566 target support subsystem.
25567
25568 @item show debug arm
25569 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
25570 @end table
25571
25572 @table @code
25573 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
25574 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
25575
25576 @table @code
25577 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
25578 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
25579 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
25580 The default value is @code{all}.
25581
25582 @table @code
25583 @item none
25584 @item demon
25585 @item angel
25586 @item redboot
25587 @item all
25588 @end table
25589 @end table
25590 @end table
25591
25592 @node BPF
25593 @subsection BPF
25594
25595 @table @code
25596 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
25597 The @value{GDBN} BPF simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
25598
25599 @table @code
25600 @item --skb-data-offset=@var{offset}
25601 Tell the simulator the offset, measured in bytes, of the
25602 @code{skb_data} field in the kernel @code{struct sk_buff} structure.
25603 This offset is used by some BPF specific-purpose load/store
25604 instructions. Defaults to 0.
25605 @end table
25606 @end table
25607
25608 @node M68K
25609 @subsection M68k
25610
25611 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
25612
25613 @node MicroBlaze
25614 @subsection MicroBlaze
25615 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
25616 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
25617
25618 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
25619 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
25620 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
25621 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
25622 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
25623 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
25624 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
25625 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
25626 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
25627 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
25628 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
25629
25630 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
25631
25632 @table @code
25633 @item target remote :1234
25634 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
25635 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
25636
25637 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
25638 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
25639 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
25640
25641 @item load
25642 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
25643
25644 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
25645 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
25646
25647 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
25648 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
25649 @end table
25650
25651 @node MIPS Embedded
25652 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
25653
25654 @noindent
25655 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
25656
25657 @table @code
25658 @item set mipsfpu double
25659 @itemx set mipsfpu single
25660 @itemx set mipsfpu none
25661 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
25662 @itemx show mipsfpu
25663 @kindex set mipsfpu
25664 @kindex show mipsfpu
25665 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
25666 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
25667 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
25668 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
25669 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
25670 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
25671 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
25672 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
25673 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
25674 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
25675 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
25676 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
25677 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
25678
25679 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
25680 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
25681 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
25682
25683 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
25684 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
25685 @end table
25686
25687 @node OpenRISC 1000
25688 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
25689 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
25690
25691 @noindent
25692 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
25693 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
25694 FPGA's.
25695
25696 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
25697 a target:
25698
25699 @table @code
25700
25701 @kindex target sim
25702 @item target sim
25703
25704 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
25705 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
25706 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
25707 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
25708
25709 Example: @code{target sim}
25710
25711 @item set debug or1k
25712 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
25713 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
25714
25715 @item show debug or1k
25716 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
25717 @end table
25718
25719 @node PowerPC Embedded
25720 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
25721
25722 @cindex DVC register
25723 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
25724 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
25725
25726 @smallexample
25727 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{address|variable} \
25728 if @var{address|variable} == @var{constant expression}
25729 @end smallexample
25730
25731 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
25732 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
25733 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
25734 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
25735 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
25736 or newer.
25737
25738 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
25739 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
25740 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
25741 watching variables of scalar types.
25742
25743 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
25744 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
25745
25746 @smallexample
25747 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
25748 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
25749 @end smallexample
25750
25751 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
25752 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
25753
25754 @cindex ranged breakpoint
25755 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
25756 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
25757 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
25758 the range it was set at. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
25759 use the @code{break-range} command.
25760
25761 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
25762
25763 @table @code
25764 @kindex break-range
25765 @item break-range @var{start-locspec}, @var{end-locspec}
25766 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by @var{start-locspec} and
25767 @var{end-locspec}, which are location specs. @xref{Location
25768 Specifications}, for a list of all the possible forms of location
25769 specs. @value{GDBN} resolves both @var{start-locspec} and
25770 @var{end-locspec}, and uses the addresses of the resolved code
25771 locations as start and end addresses of the range to break at. The
25772 breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes an
25773 instruction at any address between the start and end addresses,
25774 inclusive. If either @var{start-locspec} or @var{end-locspec} resolve
25775 to multiple code locations in the program, then the command aborts
25776 with an error without creating a breakpoint.
25777
25778 @kindex set powerpc
25779 @item set powerpc soft-float
25780 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
25781 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
25782 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
25783 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
25784
25785 @item set powerpc vector-abi
25786 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
25787 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
25788 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
25789 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
25790 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
25791 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
25792 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
25793
25794 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
25795 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
25796 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
25797 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
25798 address of its first byte.
25799
25800 @end table
25801
25802 @node AVR
25803 @subsection Atmel AVR
25804 @cindex AVR
25805
25806 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
25807 following AVR-specific commands:
25808
25809 @table @code
25810 @item info io_registers
25811 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
25812 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
25813 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
25814 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
25815 @end table
25816
25817 @node CRIS
25818 @subsection CRIS
25819 @cindex CRIS
25820
25821 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
25822 following CRIS-specific commands:
25823
25824 @table @code
25825 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
25826 @cindex CRIS version
25827 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
25828 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
25829 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
25830
25831 @item show cris-version
25832 Show the current CRIS version.
25833
25834 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
25835 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
25836 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
25837 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
25838 @code{R59}.
25839
25840 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
25841 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
25842
25843 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
25844 @cindex CRIS mode
25845 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
25846 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
25847 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
25848
25849 @item show cris-mode
25850 Show the current CRIS mode.
25851 @end table
25852
25853 @node Super-H
25854 @subsection Renesas Super-H
25855 @cindex Super-H
25856
25857 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
25858 commands:
25859
25860 @table @code
25861 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
25862 @kindex set sh calling-convention
25863 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
25864 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
25865 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
25866 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
25867 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
25868 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
25869 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
25870 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
25871 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
25872 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
25873
25874 @item show sh calling-convention
25875 @kindex show sh calling-convention
25876 Show the current calling convention setting.
25877
25878 @end table
25879
25880
25881 @node Architectures
25882 @section Architectures
25883
25884 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
25885 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
25886
25887 @menu
25888 * AArch64::
25889 * i386::
25890 * Alpha::
25891 * MIPS::
25892 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
25893 * PowerPC::
25894 * Nios II::
25895 * Sparc64::
25896 * S12Z::
25897 * AMD GPU:: @acronym{AMD GPU} architectures
25898 @end menu
25899
25900 @node AArch64
25901 @subsection AArch64
25902 @cindex AArch64 support
25903
25904 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
25905 following special commands:
25906
25907 @table @code
25908 @item set debug aarch64
25909 @kindex set debug aarch64
25910 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
25911 messages are to be displayed.
25912
25913 @item show debug aarch64
25914 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
25915
25916 @end table
25917
25918 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
25919 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
25920
25921 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
25922 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
25923 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
25924 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
25925 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
25926 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
25927
25928 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
25929 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
25930 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
25931 target process.
25932
25933 @subsubsection AArch64 Pointer Authentication.
25934 @cindex AArch64 Pointer Authentication.
25935 @anchor{AArch64 PAC}
25936
25937 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, and the program is
25938 using the v8.3-A feature Pointer Authentication (PAC), then whenever the link
25939 register @code{$lr} is pointing to an PAC function its value will be masked.
25940 When GDB prints a backtrace, any addresses that required unmasking will be
25941 postfixed with the marker [PAC]. When using the MI, this is printed as part
25942 of the @code{addr_flags} field.
25943
25944 @subsubsection AArch64 Memory Tagging Extension.
25945 @cindex AArch64 Memory Tagging Extension.
25946
25947 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, the program is
25948 using the v8.5-A feature Memory Tagging Extension (MTE) and there is support
25949 in the kernel for MTE, @value{GDBN} will make memory tagging functionality
25950 available for inspection and editing of logical and allocation tags.
25951 @xref{Memory Tagging}.
25952
25953 To aid debugging, @value{GDBN} will output additional information when SIGSEGV
25954 signals are generated as a result of memory tag failures.
25955
25956 If the tag violation is synchronous, the following will be shown:
25957
25958 @smallexample
25959 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
25960 Memory tag violation while accessing address 0x0500fffff7ff8000
25961 Allocation tag 0x1
25962 Logical tag 0x5.
25963 @end smallexample
25964
25965 If the tag violation is asynchronous, the fault address is not available.
25966 In this case @value{GDBN} will show the following:
25967
25968 @smallexample
25969 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
25970 Memory tag violation
25971 Fault address unavailable.
25972 @end smallexample
25973
25974 A special register, @code{tag_ctl}, is made available through the
25975 @code{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.mte} feature. This register exposes some
25976 options that can be controlled at runtime and emulates the @code{prctl}
25977 option @code{PR_SET_TAGGED_ADDR_CTRL}. For further information, see the
25978 documentation in the Linux kernel.
25979
25980 @value{GDBN} supports dumping memory tag data to core files through the
25981 @command{gcore} command and reading memory tag data from core files generated
25982 by the @command{gcore} command or the Linux kernel.
25983
25984 When a process uses memory-mapped pages protected by memory tags (for
25985 example, AArch64 MTE), this additional information will be recorded in
25986 the core file in the event of a crash or if @value{GDBN} generates a core file
25987 from the current process state.
25988
25989 The memory tag data will be used so developers can display the memory
25990 tags from a particular memory region (using the @samp{m} modifier to the
25991 @command{x} command, using the @command{print} command or using the various
25992 @command{memory-tag} subcommands.
25993
25994 In the case of a crash, @value{GDBN} will attempt to retrieve the memory tag
25995 information automatically from the core file, and will show one of the above
25996 messages depending on whether the synchronous or asynchronous mode is selected.
25997 @xref{Memory Tagging}. @xref{Memory}.
25998
25999 @node i386
26000 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
26001
26002 @table @code
26003 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
26004 @kindex set struct-convention
26005 @cindex struct return convention
26006 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
26007 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
26008 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
26009 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
26010 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
26011 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
26012 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
26013 be returned in a register.
26014
26015 @item show struct-convention
26016 @kindex show struct-convention
26017 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
26018 from functions.
26019 @end table
26020
26021
26022 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
26023 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
26024
26025 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
26026 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
26027 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
26028 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
26029 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
26030 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
26031 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
26032
26033 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
26034 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
26035 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
26036 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
26037 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
26038 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
26039
26040 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
26041 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
26042 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
26043
26044 @smallexample
26045 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
26046 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
26047 @end smallexample
26048
26049 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
26050 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
26051 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
26052 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
26053 the pointer.
26054
26055 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
26056 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
26057 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
26058 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
26059 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
26060
26061 @table @code
26062 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
26063 @kindex show mpx bound
26064 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
26065
26066 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
26067 @kindex set mpx bound
26068 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
26069 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
26070 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
26071 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
26072 @end table
26073
26074 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
26075 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
26076 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
26077 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
26078
26079 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
26080 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
26081 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
26082 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
26083 function.
26084
26085 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
26086 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
26087 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
26088 continuing the execution. For example:
26089
26090 @smallexample
26091 $ break *upper
26092 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
26093 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
26094 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
26095 $ print $bnd0
26096 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
26097 @end smallexample
26098
26099 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
26100 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
26101 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
26102
26103 @node Alpha
26104 @subsection Alpha
26105
26106 See the following section.
26107
26108 @node MIPS
26109 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
26110
26111 @cindex stack on Alpha
26112 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
26113 @cindex Alpha stack
26114 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
26115 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
26116 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
26117 find the beginning of a function.
26118
26119 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
26120 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
26121 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
26122 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
26123 commands:
26124
26125 @table @code
26126 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
26127 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
26128 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
26129 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
26130 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
26131 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
26132 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
26133 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
26134
26135 @item show heuristic-fence-post
26136 Display the current limit.
26137 @end table
26138
26139 @noindent
26140 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
26141 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
26142
26143 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
26144 programs:
26145
26146 @table @code
26147 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
26148 @kindex set mips abi
26149 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
26150 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
26151 values of @var{arg} are:
26152
26153 @table @samp
26154 @item auto
26155 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
26156 default).
26157 @item o32
26158 @item o64
26159 @item n32
26160 @item n64
26161 @item eabi32
26162 @item eabi64
26163 @end table
26164
26165 @item show mips abi
26166 @kindex show mips abi
26167 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
26168
26169 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
26170 @kindex set mips compression
26171 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
26172 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
26173 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
26174 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
26175 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
26176 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
26177 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
26178 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
26179 provided by the executable.
26180
26181 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
26182 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
26183 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
26184 identified as such.
26185
26186 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
26187 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
26188 implicitly from an executable.
26189
26190 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
26191 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
26192 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
26193 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
26194 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
26195
26196 @item show mips compression
26197 @kindex show mips compression
26198 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
26199 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
26200
26201 @item set mipsfpu
26202 @itemx show mipsfpu
26203 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
26204
26205 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
26206 @kindex set mips mask-address
26207 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
26208 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
26209 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
26210 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
26211 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
26212
26213 @item show mips mask-address
26214 @kindex show mips mask-address
26215 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
26216 not.
26217
26218 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
26219 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
26220 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
26221 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
26222 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
26223 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
26224
26225 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
26226 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
26227 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
26228
26229 @item set debug mips
26230 @kindex set debug mips
26231 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
26232 target code in @value{GDBN}.
26233
26234 @item show debug mips
26235 @kindex show debug mips
26236 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
26237 @end table
26238
26239
26240 @node HPPA
26241 @subsection HPPA
26242 @cindex HPPA support
26243
26244 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
26245 following special commands:
26246
26247 @table @code
26248 @item set debug hppa
26249 @kindex set debug hppa
26250 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
26251 messages are to be displayed.
26252
26253 @item show debug hppa
26254 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
26255
26256 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
26257 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
26258 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
26259 given @var{address}.
26260
26261 @end table
26262
26263
26264 @node PowerPC
26265 @subsection PowerPC
26266 @cindex PowerPC architecture
26267
26268 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
26269 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
26270 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
26271 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
26272 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
26273
26274 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
26275 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
26276 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
26277
26278 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
26279 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
26280
26281 @node Nios II
26282 @subsection Nios II
26283 @cindex Nios II architecture
26284
26285 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
26286 it provides the following special commands:
26287
26288 @table @code
26289
26290 @item set debug nios2
26291 @kindex set debug nios2
26292 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
26293 target code in @value{GDBN}.
26294
26295 @item show debug nios2
26296 @kindex show debug nios2
26297 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
26298 @end table
26299
26300 @node Sparc64
26301 @subsection Sparc64
26302 @cindex Sparc64 support
26303 @cindex Application Data Integrity
26304 @subsubsection ADI Support
26305
26306 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
26307 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
26308 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
26309 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
26310 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
26311 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
26312 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
26313 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
26314 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
26315 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
26316 signal.
26317
26318 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
26319 ADI-enabled.
26320
26321 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
26322 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
26323
26324
26325 @table @code
26326 @kindex adi examine
26327 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
26328
26329 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
26330 cacheline.
26331
26332 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
26333 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
26334 block size, to display.
26335
26336 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
26337 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
26338
26339 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
26340
26341 @smallexample
26342 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
26343 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
26344 @end smallexample
26345
26346 @kindex adi assign
26347 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
26348
26349 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
26350 to an address.
26351
26352 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
26353 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
26354 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
26355
26356 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
26357 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
26358
26359 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
26360
26361 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
26362 variable "shmaddr":
26363
26364 @smallexample
26365 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
26366 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
26367 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
26368 @end smallexample
26369
26370 @end table
26371
26372 @node S12Z
26373 @subsection S12Z
26374 @cindex S12Z support
26375
26376 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
26377 it provides the following special command:
26378
26379 @table @code
26380 @item maint info bdccsr
26381 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
26382 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
26383 BDCCSR register.
26384 @end table
26385
26386 @node AMD GPU
26387 @subsection @acronym{AMD GPU}
26388 @cindex @acronym{AMD GPU} support
26389
26390 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs offloaded to @acronym{AMD GPU} devices
26391 using the @url{https://docs.amd.com/, @acronym{AMD ROCm}} platform.
26392 @value{GDBN} presents host threads alongside GPU wavefronts, allowing debugging
26393 both the host and device parts of the program simultaneously.
26394
26395 @subsubsection @acronym{AMD GPU} Architectures
26396
26397 The list of @acronym{AMD GPU} architectures supported by @value{GDBN} depends
26398 on the version of the AMD Debugger API library used. See its
26399 @uref{https://docs.amd.com/bundle/ROCDebugger_User_and_API, documentation} for
26400 more details.
26401
26402 @subsubsection @acronym{AMD GPU} Device Driver and @acronym{AMD ROCm} Runtime
26403
26404 @value{GDBN} requires a compatible @acronym{AMD GPU} device driver to
26405 be installed. A warning message is displayed if either the device
26406 driver version or the version of the debug support it implements is
26407 unsupported. @value{GDBN} will continue to function except no
26408 @acronym{AMD GPU} debugging will be possible.
26409
26410 @value{GDBN} requires each agent to have compatible firmware installed
26411 by the device driver. A warning message is displayed if unsupported
26412 firmware is detected. @value{GDBN} will continue to function except
26413 no @acronym{AMD GPU} debugging will be possible on the agent.
26414
26415 @value{GDBN} requires a compatible @acronym{AMD ROCm} runtime to be
26416 loaded in order to detect @acronym{AMD GPU} code objects and
26417 wavefronts. A warning message is displayed if an unsupported
26418 @acronym{AMD ROCm} runtime is detected, or there is an error or
26419 restriction that prevents debugging. @value{GDBN} will continue to
26420 function except no @acronym{AMD GPU} debugging will be possible.
26421
26422 @subsubsection @acronym{AMD GPU} Wavefronts
26423 @cindex wavefronts
26424
26425 An @acronym{AMD GPU} wavefront is represented in @value{GDBN} as a
26426 thread.
26427
26428 Note that some @acronym{AMD GPU} architectures may have restrictions
26429 on providing information about @acronym{AMD GPU} wavefronts created
26430 when @value{GDBN} is not attached (@pxref{AMD GPU Attaching
26431 Restrictions, , @acronym{AMD GPU} Attaching Restrictions}).
26432
26433 When scheduler-locking is in effect (@pxref{set scheduler-locking}),
26434 new wavefronts created by the resumed thread (either CPU thread or GPU
26435 wavefront) are held in the halt state.
26436
26437 @subsubsection @acronym{AMD GPU} Code Objects
26438
26439 The @samp{info sharedlibrary} command will show the @acronym{AMD GPU}
26440 code objects as file or memory URIs, together with the host's shared
26441 libraries. For example:
26442
26443 @smallexample
26444 (@value{GDBP}) info sharedlibrary
26445 From To Syms Read Shared Object Library
26446 0x1111 0x2222 Yes (*) /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
26447 ...
26448 0x3333 0x4444 Yes (*) /opt/rocm-4.5.0/.../libamd_comgr.so
26449 0x5555 0x6666 Yes (*) /lib/x86_64-linux-gnu/libtinfo.so.5
26450 0x7777 0x8888 Yes file:///tmp/a.out#offset=6477&size=10832
26451 0x9999 0xaaaa Yes (*) memory://95557/mem#offset=0x1234&size=100
26452 (*): Shared library is missing debugging information.
26453 (@value{GDBP})
26454 @end smallexample
26455
26456 For a @samp{file} URI, the path portion is the file on disk containing
26457 the code object. The @var{offset} parameter is a 0-based offset in
26458 this file, to the start of the code object. If omitted, it defaults to
26459 0. The @var{size} parameter is the size of the code object in bytes.
26460 If omitted, it defaults to the size of the file.
26461
26462 For a @samp{memory} URI, the path portion is the process id of the
26463 process owning the memory containing the code object. The @var{offset}
26464 parameter is the memory address where the code object is found, and
26465 the @var{size} parameter is its size in bytes.
26466
26467 @acronym{AMD GPU} code objects are loaded into each @acronym{AMD GPU}
26468 device separately. The @samp{info sharedlibrary} command may
26469 therefore show the same code object loaded multiple times. As a
26470 consequence, setting a breakpoint in @acronym{AMD GPU} code will
26471 result in multiple breakpoint locations if there are multiple
26472 @acronym{AMD GPU} devices.
26473
26474 @subsubsection @acronym{AMD GPU} Entity Target Identifiers and Convenience Variables
26475
26476 The @acronym{AMD GPU} entities have the following target identifier formats:
26477
26478 @table @asis
26479
26480 @item Thread Target ID
26481 The @acronym{AMD GPU} thread target identifier (@var{systag}) string has the
26482 following format:
26483
26484 @smallexample
26485 AMDGPU Wave @var{agent-id}:@var{queue-id}:@var{dispatch-id}:@var{wave-id} (@var{work-group-x},@var{work-group-y},@var{work-group-z})/@var{work-group-thread-index}
26486 @end smallexample
26487
26488 @end table
26489
26490 @anchor{AMD GPU Signals}
26491 @subsubsection @acronym{AMD GPU} Signals
26492
26493 For @acronym{AMD GPU} wavefronts, @value{GDBN} maps target conditions to stop
26494 signals in the following way:
26495
26496 @table @code
26497
26498 @item SIGILL
26499 Execution of an illegal instruction.
26500
26501 @item SIGTRAP
26502 Execution of a @code{S_TRAP} instruction other than:
26503
26504 @itemize @bullet{}
26505
26506 @item
26507 @code{S_TRAP 1} which is used by @value{GDBN} to insert breakpoints.
26508
26509 @item
26510 @code{S_TRAP 2} which raises @code{SIGABRT}.
26511
26512 @end itemize
26513
26514 @item SIGABRT
26515 Execution of a @code{S_TRAP 2} instruction.
26516
26517 @item SIGFPE
26518 Execution of a floating point or integer instruction detects a
26519 condition that is enabled to raise a signal. The conditions include:
26520
26521 @itemize @bullet{}
26522
26523 @item
26524 Floating point operation is invalid.
26525
26526 @item
26527 Floating point operation had subnormal input that was rounded to zero.
26528
26529 @item
26530 Floating point operation performed a division by zero.
26531
26532 @item
26533 Floating point operation produced an overflow result. The result was
26534 rounded to infinity.
26535
26536 @item
26537 Floating point operation produced an underflow result. A subnormal
26538 result was rounded to zero.
26539
26540 @item
26541 Floating point operation produced an inexact result.
26542
26543 @item
26544 Integer operation performed a division by zero.
26545
26546 @end itemize
26547
26548 By default, these conditions are not enabled to raise signals. The
26549 @samp{set $mode} command can be used to change the @acronym{AMD GPU}
26550 wavefront's register that has bits controlling which conditions are
26551 enabled to raise signals. The @samp{print $trapsts} command can be
26552 used to inspect which conditions have been detected even if they are
26553 not enabled to raise a signal.
26554
26555 @item SIGBUS
26556 Execution of an instruction that accessed global memory using an
26557 address that is outside the virtual address range.
26558
26559 @item SIGSEGV
26560 Execution of an instruction that accessed a global memory page that is
26561 either not mapped or accessed with incompatible permissions.
26562
26563 @end table
26564
26565 If a single instruction raises more than one signal, they will be
26566 reported one at a time each time the wavefront is continued.
26567
26568 @subsubsection @acronym{AMD GPU} Logging
26569
26570 The @samp{set debug amd-dbgapi} command can be used
26571 to enable diagnostic messages in the @samp{amd-dbgapi} target. The
26572 @samp{show debug amd-dbgapi} command displays the current setting.
26573 @xref{set debug amd-dbgapi}.
26574
26575 The @samp{set debug amd-dbgapi-lib log-level @var{level}} command can be used
26576 to enable diagnostic messages from the @samp{amd-dbgapi} library (which
26577 @value{GDBN} uses under the hood). The @samp{show debug amd-dbgapi-lib
26578 log-level} command displays the current @samp{amd-dbgapi} library log level.
26579 @xref{set debug amd-dbgapi-lib}.
26580
26581 @subsubsection @acronym{AMD GPU} Restrictions
26582
26583 @enumerate
26584
26585 @item
26586 When in non-stop mode, wavefronts may not hit breakpoints inserted
26587 while not stopped, nor see memory updates made while not stopped,
26588 until the wavefront is next stopped. Memory updated by non-stopped
26589 wavefronts may not be visible until the wavefront is next stopped.
26590
26591 @item The HIP runtime performs deferred code object loading by default.
26592 @acronym{AMD GPU} code objects are not loaded until the first kernel is
26593 launched. Before then, all breakpoints have to be set as pending breakpoints.
26594
26595 If source line positions are used that only correspond to source lines in
26596 unloaded code objects, then @value{GDBN} may not set pending breakpoints, and
26597 instead set breakpoints on the next following source line that maps to host
26598 code. This can result in unexpected breakpoint hits being reported. When the
26599 code object containing the source lines is loaded, the incorrect breakpoints
26600 will be removed and replaced by the correct ones. This problem can be avoided
26601 by only setting breakpoints in unloaded code objects using symbol or function
26602 names.
26603
26604 Setting the @code{HIP_ENABLE_DEFERRED_LOADING} environment variable to @code{0}
26605 can be used to disable deferred code object loading by the HIP runtime. This
26606 ensures all code objects will be loaded when the inferior reaches the beginning
26607 of the @code{main} function.
26608
26609 @item
26610 If no CPU thread is running, then @samp{Ctrl-C} is not able to stop
26611 @acronym{AMD GPU} threads. This can happen for example if you enable
26612 @code{scheduler-locking} after the whole program stopped, and then resume an
26613 @acronym{AMD GPU} thread. The only way to unblock the situation is to kill the
26614 @value{GDBN} process.
26615
26616 @anchor{AMD GPU Attaching Restrictions}
26617 @item
26618
26619 By default, for some architectures, the @acronym{AMD GPU} device driver causes
26620 all @acronym{AMD GPU} wavefronts created when @value{GDBN} is not attached to
26621 be unable to report the dispatch associated with the wavefront, or the
26622 wavefront's work-group position. The @samp{info threads} command will display
26623 this missing information with a @samp{?}.
26624
26625 This does not affect wavefronts created while @value{GDBN} is attached which
26626 are always capable of reporting this information.
26627
26628 If the @env{HSA_ENABLE_DEBUG} environment variable is set to @samp{1} when the
26629 @acronym{AMD ROCm} runtime is initialized, then this information will be
26630 available for all architectures even for wavefronts created when @value{GDBN}
26631 was not attached.
26632
26633 @end enumerate
26634
26635 @node Controlling GDB
26636 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
26637
26638 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
26639 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
26640 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
26641 described here.
26642
26643 @menu
26644 * Prompt:: Prompt
26645 * Editing:: Command editing
26646 * Command History:: Command history
26647 * Screen Size:: Screen size
26648 * Output Styling:: Output styling
26649 * Numbers:: Numbers
26650 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
26651 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
26652 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
26653 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
26654 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
26655 @end menu
26656
26657 @node Prompt
26658 @section Prompt
26659
26660 @cindex prompt
26661
26662 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
26663 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
26664 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
26665 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
26666 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
26667 which one you are talking to.
26668
26669 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
26670 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
26671 or a prompt that does not.
26672
26673 @table @code
26674 @kindex set prompt
26675 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
26676 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
26677
26678 @kindex show prompt
26679 @item show prompt
26680 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
26681 @end table
26682
26683 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
26684 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
26685 are:
26686
26687 @table @code
26688 @kindex set extended-prompt
26689 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
26690 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
26691 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
26692 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
26693 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
26694 is displayed.
26695
26696 For example:
26697
26698 @smallexample
26699 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (@value{GDBP})
26700 @end smallexample
26701
26702 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
26703 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
26704
26705 @kindex show extended-prompt
26706 @item show extended-prompt
26707 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
26708 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
26709 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
26710 @end table
26711
26712 @node Editing
26713 @section Command Editing
26714 @cindex readline
26715 @cindex command line editing
26716
26717 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
26718 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
26719 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
26720 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
26721 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
26722 debugging sessions.
26723
26724 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
26725 command @code{set}.
26726
26727 @table @code
26728 @kindex set editing
26729 @cindex editing
26730 @item set editing
26731 @itemx set editing on
26732 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
26733
26734 @item set editing off
26735 Disable command line editing.
26736
26737 @kindex show editing
26738 @item show editing
26739 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
26740 @end table
26741
26742 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26743 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
26744 @end ifset
26745 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26746 @xref{Command Line Editing},
26747 @end ifclear
26748 for more details about the Readline
26749 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
26750 encouraged to read that chapter.
26751
26752 @cindex Readline application name
26753 @value{GDBN} sets the Readline application name to @samp{gdb}. This
26754 is useful for conditions in @file{.inputrc}.
26755
26756 @cindex operate-and-get-next
26757 @value{GDBN} defines a bindable Readline command,
26758 @code{operate-and-get-next}. This is bound to @kbd{C-o} by default.
26759 This command accepts the current line for execution and fetches the
26760 next line relative to the current line from the history for editing.
26761 Any argument is ignored.
26762
26763 @node Command History
26764 @section Command History
26765 @cindex command history
26766
26767 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
26768 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
26769 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
26770 history facility.
26771
26772 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
26773 package, to provide the history facility.
26774 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26775 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
26776 @end ifset
26777 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26778 @xref{Using History Interactively},
26779 @end ifclear
26780 for the detailed description of the History library.
26781
26782 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
26783 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
26784 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
26785 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
26786 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
26787 pressed on a line by itself.
26788
26789 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
26790 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
26791 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
26792 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
26793
26794 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
26795 history.
26796
26797 @table @code
26798 @cindex history substitution
26799 @cindex history file
26800 @kindex set history filename
26801 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
26802 @item set history filename @r{[}@var{fname}@r{]}
26803 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
26804 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
26805 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
26806 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
26807 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
26808 to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
26809 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
26810 is not set.
26811
26812 The @env{GDBHISTFILE} environment variable is read after processing
26813 any @value{GDBN} initialization files (@pxref{Startup}) and after
26814 processing any commands passed using command line options (for
26815 example, @code{-ex}).
26816
26817 If the @var{fname} argument is not given, or if the @env{GDBHISTFILE}
26818 is the empty string then @value{GDBN} will neither try to load an
26819 existing history file, nor will it try to save the history on exit.
26820
26821 @cindex save command history
26822 @kindex set history save
26823 @item set history save
26824 @itemx set history save on
26825 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
26826 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is
26827 disabled. The command history will be recorded when @value{GDBN}
26828 exits. If @code{set history filename} is set to the empty string then
26829 history saving is disabled, even when @code{set history save} is
26830 @code{on}.
26831
26832 @item set history save off
26833 Don't record the command history into the file specified by @code{set
26834 history filename} when @value{GDBN} exits.
26835
26836 @cindex history size
26837 @kindex set history size
26838 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
26839 @item set history size @var{size}
26840 @itemx set history size unlimited
26841 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
26842 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
26843 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
26844 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
26845 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
26846 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
26847
26848 The @env{GDBHISTSIZE} environment variable is read after processing
26849 any @value{GDBN} initialization files (@pxref{Startup}) and after
26850 processing any commands passed using command line options (for
26851 example, @code{-ex}).
26852
26853 @cindex remove duplicate history
26854 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
26855 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
26856 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
26857 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
26858 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
26859 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
26860 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
26861 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
26862 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
26863
26864 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
26865 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
26866
26867 @end table
26868
26869 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
26870 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26871 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
26872 @end ifset
26873 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26874 @xref{Event Designators},
26875 @end ifclear
26876 for more details.
26877
26878 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
26879 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
26880 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
26881 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
26882 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
26883 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
26884 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
26885 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
26886
26887 The commands to control history expansion are:
26888
26889 @table @code
26890 @item set history expansion on
26891 @itemx set history expansion
26892 @kindex set history expansion
26893 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
26894
26895 @item set history expansion off
26896 Disable history expansion.
26897
26898 @c @group
26899 @kindex show history
26900 @item show history
26901 @itemx show history filename
26902 @itemx show history save
26903 @itemx show history size
26904 @itemx show history expansion
26905 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
26906 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
26907 @c @end group
26908 @end table
26909
26910 @table @code
26911 @kindex show commands
26912 @cindex show last commands
26913 @cindex display command history
26914 @item show commands
26915 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
26916
26917 @item show commands @var{n}
26918 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
26919
26920 @item show commands +
26921 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
26922 @end table
26923
26924 @node Screen Size
26925 @section Screen Size
26926 @cindex size of screen
26927 @cindex screen size
26928 @cindex pagination
26929 @cindex page size
26930 @cindex pauses in output
26931
26932 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
26933 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
26934 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
26935 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
26936 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
26937 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
26938 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
26939 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
26940 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
26941 following line.
26942
26943 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
26944 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
26945 together with the value of the @env{TERM} environment variable and the
26946 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
26947 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
26948 width} commands:
26949
26950 @table @code
26951 @kindex set height
26952 @kindex set width
26953 @kindex show width
26954 @kindex show height
26955 @item set height @var{lpp}
26956 @itemx set height unlimited
26957 @itemx show height
26958 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
26959 @itemx set width unlimited
26960 @itemx show width
26961 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
26962 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
26963 commands display the current settings.
26964
26965 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
26966 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
26967 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
26968 buffer.
26969
26970 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
26971 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
26972
26973 @item set pagination on
26974 @itemx set pagination off
26975 @kindex set pagination
26976 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
26977 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
26978 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
26979 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
26980
26981 @item show pagination
26982 @kindex show pagination
26983 Show the current pagination mode.
26984 @end table
26985
26986 @node Output Styling
26987 @section Output Styling
26988 @cindex styling
26989 @cindex colors
26990
26991 @kindex set style
26992 @kindex show style
26993 @value{GDBN} can style its output on a capable terminal. This is
26994 enabled by default on most systems, but disabled by default when in
26995 batch mode (@pxref{Mode Options}). Various style settings are available;
26996 and styles can also be disabled entirely.
26997
26998 @table @code
26999 @item set style enabled @samp{on|off}
27000 Enable or disable all styling. The default is host-dependent, with
27001 most hosts defaulting to @samp{on}.
27002
27003 @item show style enabled
27004 Show the current state of styling.
27005
27006 @item set style sources @samp{on|off}
27007 Enable or disable source code styling. This affects whether source
27008 code, such as the output of the @code{list} command, is styled. The
27009 default is @samp{on}. Note that source styling only works if styling
27010 in general is enabled, and if a source highlighting library is
27011 available to @value{GDBN}.
27012
27013 There are two ways that highlighting can be done. First, if
27014 @value{GDBN} was linked with the GNU Source Highlight library, then it
27015 is used. Otherwise, if @value{GDBN} was configured with Python
27016 scripting support, and if the Python Pygments package is available,
27017 then it will be used.
27018
27019 @item show style sources
27020 Show the current state of source code styling.
27021
27022 @item set style tui-current-position @samp{on|off}
27023 Enable or disable styling of the source and assembly code highlighted
27024 by the TUI's current position indicator. The default is @samp{off}.
27025 @xref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}.
27026
27027 @item show style tui-current-position
27028 Show whether the source and assembly code highlighted by the TUI's
27029 current position indicator is styled.
27030
27031 @anchor{style_disassembler_enabled}
27032 @item set style disassembler enabled @samp{on|off}
27033 Enable or disable disassembler styling. This affects whether
27034 disassembler output, such as the output of the @code{disassemble}
27035 command, is styled. Disassembler styling only works if styling in
27036 general is enabled (with @code{set style enabled on}), and if a source
27037 highlighting library is available to @value{GDBN}.
27038
27039 The two source highlighting libraries that @value{GDBN} could use to
27040 style disassembler output are; @value{GDBN}'s builtin disassembler, or
27041 the Python Pygments package.
27042
27043 @value{GDBN}'s first choice will be to use the builtin disassembler
27044 for styling, this usually provides better results, being able to style
27045 different types of instruction operands differently. However, the
27046 builtin disassembler is not able to style all architectures.
27047
27048 For architectures that the builtin disassembler is unable to style,
27049 @value{GDBN} will fall back to use the Python Pygments package where
27050 possible. In order to use the Python Pygments package, @value{GDBN}
27051 must be built with Python support, and the Pygments package must be
27052 installed.
27053
27054 If neither of these options are available then @value{GDBN} will
27055 produce unstyled disassembler output, even when this setting is
27056 @samp{on}.
27057
27058 To discover if the current architecture supports styling using the
27059 builtin disassembler library see @ref{maint_libopcodes_styling,,@kbd{maint
27060 show libopcodes-styling enabled}}.
27061
27062 @item show style disassembler enabled
27063 Show the current state of disassembler styling.
27064
27065 @end table
27066
27067 Subcommands of @code{set style} control specific forms of styling.
27068 These subcommands all follow the same pattern: each style-able object
27069 can be styled with a foreground color, a background color, and an
27070 intensity.
27071
27072 For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the
27073 @code{set style filename} group of commands:
27074
27075 @table @code
27076 @item set style filename background @var{color}
27077 Set the background to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
27078 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
27079 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
27080 and@samp{white}.
27081
27082 @item set style filename foreground @var{color}
27083 Set the foreground to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
27084 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
27085 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
27086 and@samp{white}.
27087
27088 @item set style filename intensity @var{value}
27089 Set the intensity to @var{value}. Valid intensities are @samp{normal}
27090 (the default), @samp{bold}, and @samp{dim}.
27091 @end table
27092
27093 The @code{show style} command and its subcommands are styling
27094 a style name in their output using its own style.
27095 So, use @command{show style} to see the complete list of styles,
27096 their characteristics and the visual aspect of each style.
27097
27098 The style-able objects are:
27099 @table @code
27100 @item filename
27101 Control the styling of file names and URLs. By default, this style's
27102 foreground color is green.
27103
27104 @item function
27105 Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the
27106 @code{set style function} family of commands. By default, this
27107 style's foreground color is yellow.
27108
27109 This style is also used for symbol names in styled disassembler output
27110 if @value{GDBN} is using its builtin disassembler library for styling
27111 (@pxref{style_disassembler_enabled,,@kbd{set style disassembler
27112 enabled}}).
27113
27114 @item variable
27115 Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the
27116 @code{set style variable} family of commands. By default, this style's
27117 foreground color is cyan.
27118
27119 @item address
27120 Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the
27121 @code{set style address} family of commands. By default, this style's
27122 foreground color is blue.
27123
27124 This style is also used for addresses in styled disassembler output
27125 if @value{GDBN} is using its builtin disassembler library for styling
27126 (@pxref{style_disassembler_enabled,,@kbd{set style disassembler
27127 enabled}}).
27128
27129 @item version
27130 Control the styling of @value{GDBN}'s version number text. By
27131 default, this style's foreground color is magenta and it has bold
27132 intensity. The version number is displayed in two places, the output
27133 of @command{show version}, and when @value{GDBN} starts up.
27134
27135 In order to control how @value{GDBN} styles the version number at
27136 startup, add the @code{set style version} family of commands to the
27137 early initialization command file (@pxref{Initialization
27138 Files}).
27139
27140 @item title
27141 Control the styling of titles. These are managed with the
27142 @code{set style title} family of commands. By default, this style's
27143 intensity is bold. Commands are using the title style to improve
27144 the readability of large output. For example, the commands
27145 @command{apropos} and @command{help} are using the title style
27146 for the command names.
27147
27148 @item highlight
27149 Control the styling of highlightings. These are managed with the
27150 @code{set style highlight} family of commands. By default, this style's
27151 foreground color is red. Commands are using the highlight style to draw
27152 the user attention to some specific parts of their output. For example,
27153 the command @command{apropos -v REGEXP} uses the highlight style to
27154 mark the documentation parts matching @var{regexp}.
27155
27156 @item metadata
27157 Control the styling of data annotations added by @value{GDBN} to data
27158 it displays. By default, this style's intensity is dim. Metadata
27159 annotations include the @samp{repeats @var{n} times} annotation for
27160 suppressed display of repeated array elements (@pxref{Print Settings}),
27161 @samp{<unavailable>} and @w{@samp{<error @var{descr}>}} annotations
27162 for errors and @samp{<optimized-out>} annotations for optimized-out
27163 values in displaying stack frame information in backtraces
27164 (@pxref{Backtrace}), etc.
27165
27166 @item tui-border
27167 Control the styling of the TUI border. Note that, unlike other
27168 styling options, only the color of the border can be controlled via
27169 @code{set style}. This was done for compatibility reasons, as TUI
27170 controls to set the border's intensity predated the addition of
27171 general styling to @value{GDBN}. @xref{TUI Configuration}.
27172
27173 @item tui-active-border
27174 Control the styling of the active TUI border; that is, the TUI window
27175 that has the focus.
27176
27177 @item disassembler comment
27178 Control the styling of comments in the disassembler output. These are
27179 managed with the @code{set style disassembler comment} family of
27180 commands. This style is only used when @value{GDBN} is styling using
27181 its builtin disassembler library
27182 (@pxref{style_disassembler_enabled,,@kbd{set style disassembler
27183 enabled}}). By default, this style's intensity is dim, and its
27184 foreground color is white.
27185
27186 @item disassembler immediate
27187 Control the styling of numeric operands in the disassembler output.
27188 These are managed with the @code{set style disassembler immediate}
27189 family of commands. This style is not used for instruction operands
27190 that represent addresses, in that case the @samp{disassembler address}
27191 style is used. This style is only used when @value{GDBN} is styling
27192 using its builtin disassembler library. By default, this style's
27193 foreground color is blue.
27194
27195 @item disassembler address
27196 Control the styling of address operands in the disassembler output.
27197 This is an alias for the @samp{address} style.
27198
27199 @item disassembler symbol
27200 Control the styling of symbol names in the disassembler output. This
27201 is an alias for the @samp{function} style.
27202
27203 @item disassembler mnemonic
27204 Control the styling of instruction mnemonics in the disassembler
27205 output. These are managed with the @code{set style disassembler
27206 mnemonic} family of commands. This style is also used for assembler
27207 directives, e.g.@: @code{.byte}, @code{.word}, etc. This style is
27208 only used when @value{GDBN} is styling using its builtin disassembler
27209 library. By default, this style's foreground color is green.
27210
27211 @item disassembler register
27212 Control the styling of register operands in the disassembler output.
27213 These are managed with the @code{set style disassembler register}
27214 family of commands. This style is only used when @value{GDBN} is
27215 styling using its builtin disassembler library. By default, this style's
27216 foreground color is red.
27217
27218 @end table
27219
27220 @node Numbers
27221 @section Numbers
27222 @cindex number representation
27223 @cindex entering numbers
27224
27225 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
27226 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
27227 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
27228 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
27229 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
27230 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
27231 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
27232 both input and output with the commands described below.
27233
27234 @table @code
27235 @kindex set input-radix
27236 @item set input-radix @var{base}
27237 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
27238 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
27239 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
27240 example, any of
27241
27242 @smallexample
27243 set input-radix 012
27244 set input-radix 10.
27245 set input-radix 0xa
27246 @end smallexample
27247
27248 @noindent
27249 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
27250 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
27251 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
27252 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
27253 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
27254 change the radix.
27255
27256 @kindex set output-radix
27257 @item set output-radix @var{base}
27258 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
27259 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
27260 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
27261
27262 @kindex show input-radix
27263 @item show input-radix
27264 Display the current default base for numeric input.
27265
27266 @kindex show output-radix
27267 @item show output-radix
27268 Display the current default base for numeric display.
27269
27270 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
27271 @itemx show radix
27272 @kindex set radix
27273 @kindex show radix
27274 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
27275 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
27276 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
27277 default value of 10.
27278
27279 @end table
27280
27281 @node ABI
27282 @section Configuring the Current ABI
27283
27284 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
27285 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
27286 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
27287 current ABI.
27288
27289 @cindex OS ABI
27290 @kindex set osabi
27291 @kindex show osabi
27292 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
27293
27294 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
27295 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
27296 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
27297 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
27298 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
27299 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
27300 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
27301 platform provides.
27302
27303 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
27304 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
27305 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
27306 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
27307
27308 @table @code
27309 @item show osabi
27310 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
27311
27312 @item set osabi
27313 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
27314
27315 @item set osabi @var{abi}
27316 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
27317 @end table
27318
27319 @cindex float promotion
27320
27321 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
27322 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
27323 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
27324 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
27325 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
27326 @code{double} and then passed.
27327
27328 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
27329 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
27330 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
27331
27332 @table @code
27333 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
27334 @item set coerce-float-to-double
27335 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
27336 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
27337 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
27338
27339 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
27340 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
27341 functions.
27342
27343 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
27344 @item show coerce-float-to-double
27345 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
27346 @end table
27347
27348 @kindex set cp-abi
27349 @kindex show cp-abi
27350 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
27351 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
27352 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
27353 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
27354 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
27355 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
27356 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
27357 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
27358 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
27359 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
27360 ``auto''.
27361
27362 @table @code
27363 @item show cp-abi
27364 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
27365
27366 @item set cp-abi
27367 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
27368
27369 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
27370 @itemx set cp-abi auto
27371 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
27372 @end table
27373
27374 @node Auto-loading
27375 @section Automatically loading associated files
27376 @cindex auto-loading
27377
27378 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
27379 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
27380 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
27381 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
27382 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
27383 sources).
27384
27385 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
27386 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
27387 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
27388
27389 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
27390 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
27391 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27392
27393 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
27394 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
27395
27396 @table @code
27397 @anchor{set auto-load off}
27398 @kindex set auto-load off
27399 @item set auto-load off
27400 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
27401 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
27402 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
27403 @smallexample
27404 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
27405 @end smallexample
27406
27407 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
27408 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
27409 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
27410 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
27411 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
27412 @code{set auto-load no}.
27413
27414 @anchor{show auto-load}
27415 @kindex show auto-load
27416 @item show auto-load
27417 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
27418 or disabled.
27419
27420 @smallexample
27421 (@value{GDBP}) show auto-load
27422 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
27423 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
27424 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
27425 is on.
27426 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
27427 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
27428 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
27429 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
27430 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
27431 @end smallexample
27432
27433 @anchor{info auto-load}
27434 @kindex info auto-load
27435 @item info auto-load
27436 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
27437 not.
27438
27439 @smallexample
27440 (@value{GDBP}) info auto-load
27441 gdb-scripts:
27442 Loaded Script
27443 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
27444 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
27445 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
27446 loaded.
27447 python-scripts:
27448 Loaded Script
27449 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
27450 @end smallexample
27451 @end table
27452
27453 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
27454
27455 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
27456 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
27457 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
27458 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
27459 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
27460 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
27461 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
27462 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
27463 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
27464 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
27465 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
27466 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
27467 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
27468 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
27469 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
27470 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
27471 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
27472 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
27473 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
27474 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
27475 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
27476 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
27477 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
27478 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
27479 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
27480 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
27481 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
27482 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
27483 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
27484 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
27485 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
27486 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
27487 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
27488 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
27489 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
27490 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
27491 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
27492 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
27493 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
27494 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
27495 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
27496 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
27497 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
27498 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
27499 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
27500 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
27501 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
27502 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
27503 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
27504 @end multitable
27505
27506 @menu
27507 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
27508 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
27509
27510 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
27511 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
27512 @end menu
27513
27514 @node Init File in the Current Directory
27515 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
27516 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
27517
27518 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
27519 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
27520 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
27521
27522 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
27523 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27524
27525 @table @code
27526 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
27527 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
27528 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
27529 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
27530 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
27531
27532 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
27533 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
27534 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
27535 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
27536 current directory is enabled or disabled.
27537
27538 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
27539 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
27540 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
27541 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
27542 current directory have been auto-loaded.
27543 @end table
27544
27545 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
27546 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
27547 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
27548
27549 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
27550
27551 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
27552 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
27553
27554 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
27555 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
27556 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
27557 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
27558 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
27559 library.
27560
27561 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
27562 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27563
27564 @table @code
27565 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
27566 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
27567 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
27568 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
27569
27570 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
27571 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
27572 @item show auto-load libthread-db
27573 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
27574 enabled or disabled.
27575
27576 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
27577 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
27578 @item info auto-load libthread-db
27579 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
27580 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
27581 @end table
27582
27583 @node Auto-loading safe path
27584 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
27585 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
27586
27587 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
27588 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
27589 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
27590 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
27591 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
27592
27593 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
27594 get loaded:
27595
27596 @smallexample
27597 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
27598 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...
27599 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
27600 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
27601 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
27602 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
27603 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
27604 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
27605 @end smallexample
27606
27607 @noindent
27608 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
27609 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
27610
27611 @smallexample
27612 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
27613 @end smallexample
27614
27615 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
27616
27617 @table @code
27618 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
27619 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
27620 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
27621 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
27622 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
27623 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
27624 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
27625 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
27626 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
27627 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
27628
27629 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
27630 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
27631 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
27632
27633 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
27634 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
27635 @item show auto-load safe-path
27636 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
27637 scripts.
27638
27639 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
27640 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
27641 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
27642 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
27643 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
27644 by the host platform path separator in use.
27645 @end table
27646
27647 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
27648 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
27649 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
27650 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
27651 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
27652
27653 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
27654 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
27655 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
27656 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
27657 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
27658 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
27659 init file in the current directory
27660 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
27661
27662 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
27663 example, you could use one of the following ways:
27664
27665 @table @asis
27666 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
27667 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
27668 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
27669 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
27670
27671 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
27672 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
27673 @value{GDBN} session.
27674
27675 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
27676 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
27677 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
27678 from trusted sources.
27679
27680 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
27681 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
27682 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
27683 trusted sources.
27684 @end table
27685
27686 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
27687 also suppresses any such warning messages:
27688
27689 @table @asis
27690 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
27691 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
27692
27693 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
27694 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
27695 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
27696 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
27697 @end table
27698
27699 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
27700 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
27701 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
27702 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
27703 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
27704 recommended to be entered.
27705
27706 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
27707 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
27708 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
27709
27710 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
27711 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
27712 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
27713 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
27714 be printed.
27715
27716 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
27717 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
27718 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
27719
27720 @smallexample
27721 (@value{GDBP}) set debug auto-load on
27722 (@value{GDBP}) file ~/src/t/true
27723 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
27724 for objfile "/tmp/true".
27725 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
27726 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
27727 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
27728 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
27729 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
27730 @end smallexample
27731
27732 @table @code
27733 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
27734 @kindex set debug auto-load
27735 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
27736 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
27737
27738 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
27739 @kindex show debug auto-load
27740 @item show debug auto-load
27741 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
27742 on or off.
27743 @end table
27744
27745 @node Messages/Warnings
27746 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
27747
27748 @cindex verbose operation
27749 @cindex optional warnings
27750 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
27751 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
27752 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
27753 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
27754
27755 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
27756 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
27757 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27758
27759 @table @code
27760 @kindex set verbose
27761 @item set verbose on
27762 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
27763
27764 @item set verbose off
27765 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
27766
27767 @kindex show verbose
27768 @item show verbose
27769 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
27770 @end table
27771
27772 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
27773 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
27774 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
27775 Symbol Files}).
27776
27777 @table @code
27778
27779 @kindex set complaints
27780 @item set complaints @var{limit}
27781 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
27782 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
27783 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
27784 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
27785
27786 @kindex show complaints
27787 @item show complaints
27788 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
27789
27790 @end table
27791
27792 @anchor{confirmation requests}
27793 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
27794 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
27795 you try to run a program which is already running:
27796
27797 @smallexample
27798 (@value{GDBP}) run
27799 The program being debugged has been started already.
27800 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
27801 @end smallexample
27802
27803 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
27804 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
27805
27806 @table @code
27807
27808 @kindex set confirm
27809 @cindex flinching
27810 @cindex confirmation
27811 @cindex stupid questions
27812 @item set confirm off
27813 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
27814 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
27815 automatically disables confirmation requests.
27816
27817 @item set confirm on
27818 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
27819
27820 @kindex show confirm
27821 @item show confirm
27822 Displays state of confirmation requests.
27823
27824 @end table
27825
27826 @cindex command tracing
27827 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
27828 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
27829 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
27830 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
27831
27832 @table @code
27833 @kindex set trace-commands
27834 @cindex command scripts, debugging
27835 @item set trace-commands on
27836 Enable command tracing.
27837 @item set trace-commands off
27838 Disable command tracing.
27839 @item show trace-commands
27840 Display the current state of command tracing.
27841 @end table
27842
27843 @node Debugging Output
27844 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
27845 @cindex optional debugging messages
27846
27847 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
27848 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
27849 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
27850 section documents those commands.
27851
27852 @table @code
27853 @kindex set exec-done-display
27854 @item set exec-done-display
27855 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
27856 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
27857 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
27858 @kindex show exec-done-display
27859 @item show exec-done-display
27860 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
27861 notification.
27862
27863 @kindex set debug
27864 @cindex ARM AArch64
27865 @item set debug aarch64
27866 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
27867 The default is off.
27868 @kindex show debug
27869 @item show debug aarch64
27870 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
27871 ARM AArch64.
27872
27873 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
27874 @cindex architecture debugging info
27875 @item set debug arch
27876 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
27877 @item show debug arch
27878 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
27879
27880 @item set debug aix-thread
27881 @cindex AIX threads
27882 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
27883 module.
27884 @item show debug aix-thread
27885 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
27886
27887 @cindex AMD GPU debugging info
27888 @anchor{set debug amd-dbgapi-lib}
27889 @item set debug amd-dbgapi-lib
27890 @itemx show debug amd-dbgapi-lib
27891
27892 The @code{set debug amd-dbgapi-lib log-level @var{level}} command can be used
27893 to enable diagnostic messages from the @samp{amd-dbgapi} library, where
27894 @var{level} can be:
27895
27896 @table @code
27897
27898 @item off
27899 no logging is enabled
27900
27901 @item error
27902 fatal errors are reported
27903
27904 @item warning
27905 fatal errors and warnings are reported
27906
27907 @item info
27908 fatal errors, warnings, and info messages are reported
27909
27910 @item verbose
27911 all messages are reported
27912
27913 @end table
27914
27915 The @code{show debug amd-dbgapi-lib log-level} command displays the current
27916 @acronym{amd-dbgapi} library log level.
27917
27918 @anchor{set debug amd-dbgapi}
27919 @item set debug amd-dbgapi
27920 @itemx show debug amd-dbgapi
27921
27922 The @samp{set debug amd-dbgapi} command can be used
27923 to enable diagnostic messages in the @samp{amd-dbgapi} target. The
27924 @samp{show debug amd-dbgapi} command displays the current setting.
27925 @xref{set debug amd-dbgapi}.
27926
27927 @item set debug check-physname
27928 @cindex physname
27929 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
27930 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
27931 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
27932 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
27933 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
27934 both ways and display any discrepancies.
27935 @item show debug check-physname
27936 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
27937
27938 @item set debug coff-pe-read
27939 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
27940 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
27941 exported symbols. The default is off.
27942 @item show debug coff-pe-read
27943 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
27944 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
27945
27946 @item set debug dwarf-die
27947 @cindex DWARF DIEs
27948 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
27949 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
27950 A value of zero turns off the display.
27951 @item show debug dwarf-die
27952 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
27953
27954 @item set debug dwarf-line
27955 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
27956 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
27957 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
27958 A value of 1 provides basic information.
27959 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
27960 @item show debug dwarf-line
27961 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
27962
27963 @item set debug dwarf-read
27964 @cindex DWARF Reading
27965 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
27966 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
27967 A value of 1 provides basic information.
27968 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
27969 @item show debug dwarf-read
27970 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
27971
27972 @item set debug displaced
27973 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
27974 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
27975 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
27976 @item show debug displaced
27977 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
27978 related to displaced stepping.
27979
27980 @item set debug event
27981 @cindex event debugging info
27982 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
27983 default is off.
27984 @item show debug event
27985 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
27986 info.
27987
27988 @item set debug event-loop
27989 @cindex event-loop debugging
27990 Controls output of debugging info about the event loop. The possible
27991 values are @samp{off}, @samp{all} (shows all debugging info) and
27992 @samp{all-except-ui} (shows all debugging info except those about
27993 UI-related events).
27994 @item show debug event-loop
27995 Shows the current state of displaying debugging info about the event
27996 loop.
27997
27998 @item set debug expression
27999 @cindex expression debugging info
28000 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
28001 expression parsing. The default is off.
28002 @item show debug expression
28003 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
28004 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
28005
28006 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
28007 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
28008 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
28009 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
28010 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
28011
28012 @item set debug fbsd-nat
28013 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
28014 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
28015 @item show debug fbsd-nat
28016 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
28017
28018 @item set debug fortran-array-slicing
28019 @cindex fortran array slicing debugging info
28020 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} Fortran array slicing
28021 debugging info. The default is off.
28022
28023 @item show debug fortran-array-slicing
28024 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} Fortran array
28025 slicing debugging info.
28026
28027 @item set debug frame
28028 @cindex frame debugging info
28029 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
28030 default is off.
28031 @item show debug frame
28032 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
28033 info.
28034
28035 @item set debug gnu-nat
28036 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
28037 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
28038 @item show debug gnu-nat
28039 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
28040
28041 @item set debug infrun
28042 @cindex inferior debugging info
28043 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
28044 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
28045 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
28046 @item show debug infrun
28047 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
28048
28049 @item set debug infcall
28050 @cindex inferior function call debugging info
28051 Turns on or off display of debugging info related to inferior function
28052 calls made by @value{GDBN}.
28053 @item show debug infcall
28054 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior function call debugging.
28055
28056 @item set debug jit
28057 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
28058 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
28059 @item show debug jit
28060 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
28061
28062 @item set debug linux-nat @r{[}on@r{|}off@r{]}
28063 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux native target debug messages
28064 @cindex Linux native targets
28065 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux native target debug support.
28066 @item show debug linux-nat
28067 Show the current state of Linux native target debugging messages.
28068
28069 @item set debug linux-namespaces
28070 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
28071 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
28072 @item show debug linux-namespaces
28073 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
28074
28075 @item set debug mach-o
28076 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
28077 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
28078 processing. The default is off.
28079 @item show debug mach-o
28080 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
28081 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
28082
28083 @item set debug notification
28084 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
28085 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
28086 The default is off.
28087 @item show debug notification
28088 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
28089
28090 @item set debug observer
28091 @cindex observer debugging info
28092 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
28093 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
28094 @item show debug observer
28095 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
28096
28097 @item set debug overload
28098 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
28099 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
28100 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
28101 is off.
28102 @item show debug overload
28103 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
28104 debugging info.
28105
28106 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
28107 @cindex debug expression parser
28108 @item set debug parser
28109 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
28110 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
28111 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
28112 details. The default is off.
28113 @item show debug parser
28114 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
28115
28116 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
28117 @cindex serial connections, debugging
28118 @cindex debug remote protocol
28119 @cindex remote protocol debugging
28120 @cindex display remote packets
28121 @item set debug remote
28122 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
28123 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
28124 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
28125 @item show debug remote
28126 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
28127
28128 @item set debug remote-packet-max-chars
28129 Sets the maximum number of characters to display for each remote packet when
28130 @code{set debug remote} is on. This is useful to prevent @value{GDBN} from
28131 displaying lengthy remote packets and polluting the console.
28132
28133 The default value is @code{512}, which means @value{GDBN} will truncate each
28134 remote packet after 512 bytes.
28135
28136 Setting this option to @code{unlimited} will disable truncation and will output
28137 the full length of the remote packets.
28138 @item show debug remote-packet-max-chars
28139 Displays the number of bytes to output for remote packet debugging.
28140
28141 @item set debug separate-debug-file
28142 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
28143 @item show debug separate-debug-file
28144 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
28145
28146 @item set debug serial
28147 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
28148 default is off.
28149 @item show debug serial
28150 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
28151 info.
28152
28153 @item set debug solib
28154 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to shared libraries.
28155 The default is off.
28156 @item show debug solib
28157 Show the current state of solib debugging messages.
28158
28159 @item set debug symbol-lookup
28160 @cindex symbol lookup
28161 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
28162 The default is 0 (off).
28163 A value of 1 provides basic information.
28164 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
28165 @item show debug symbol-lookup
28166 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
28167
28168 @item set debug symfile
28169 @cindex symbol file functions
28170 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
28171 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
28172 @item show debug symfile
28173 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
28174
28175 @item set debug symtab-create
28176 @cindex symbol table creation
28177 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
28178 The default is 0 (off).
28179 A value of 1 provides basic information.
28180 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
28181 @item show debug symtab-create
28182 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
28183
28184 @item set debug target
28185 @cindex target debugging info
28186 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
28187 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
28188 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
28189 value of large memory transfers.
28190 @item show debug target
28191 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
28192 info.
28193
28194 @item set debug timestamp
28195 @cindex timestamping debugging info
28196 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
28197 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
28198 message.
28199 @item show debug timestamp
28200 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
28201 debugging info.
28202
28203 @item set debug varobj
28204 @cindex variable object debugging info
28205 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
28206 info. The default is off.
28207 @item show debug varobj
28208 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
28209 debugging info.
28210
28211 @item set debug xml
28212 @cindex XML parser debugging
28213 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
28214 @item show debug xml
28215 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
28216 @end table
28217
28218 @node Other Misc Settings
28219 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
28220 @cindex miscellaneous settings
28221
28222 @table @code
28223 @kindex set interactive-mode
28224 @item set interactive-mode
28225 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
28226 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
28227 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
28228 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
28229 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
28230 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
28231 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
28232 is, non-interactively otherwise.
28233
28234 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
28235 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
28236 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
28237 inside a cygwin window.
28238
28239 @kindex show interactive-mode
28240 @item show interactive-mode
28241 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
28242 @end table
28243
28244 @table @code
28245 @kindex set suppress-cli-notifications
28246 @item set suppress-cli-notifications
28247 If @code{on}, command-line-interface (CLI) notifications that are
28248 printed by @value{GDBN} are suppressed. If @code{off}, the
28249 notifications are printed as usual. The default value is @code{off}.
28250 CLI notifications occur when you change the selected context or when
28251 the program being debugged stops, as detailed below.
28252
28253 @table @emph
28254 @item User-selected context changes:
28255 When you change the selected context (i.e.@: the current inferior,
28256 thread and/or the frame), @value{GDBN} prints information about the
28257 new context. For example, the default behavior is below:
28258
28259 @smallexample
28260 (gdb) inferior 1
28261 [Switching to inferior 1 [process 634] (/tmp/test)]
28262 [Switching to thread 1 (process 634)]
28263 #0 main () at test.c:3
28264 3 return 0;
28265 (gdb)
28266 @end smallexample
28267
28268 When the notifications are suppressed, the new context is not printed:
28269
28270 @smallexample
28271 (gdb) set suppress-cli-notifications on
28272 (gdb) inferior 1
28273 (gdb)
28274 @end smallexample
28275
28276 @item The program being debugged stops:
28277 When the program you are debugging stops (e.g.@: because of hitting a
28278 breakpoint, completing source-stepping, an interrupt, etc.),
28279 @value{GDBN} prints information about the stop event. For example,
28280 below is a breakpoint hit:
28281
28282 @smallexample
28283 (gdb) break test.c:3
28284 Breakpoint 2 at 0x555555555155: file test.c, line 3.
28285 (gdb) continue
28286 Continuing.
28287
28288 Breakpoint 2, main () at test.c:3
28289 3 return 0;
28290 (gdb)
28291 @end smallexample
28292
28293 When the notifications are suppressed, the output becomes:
28294
28295 @smallexample
28296 (gdb) break test.c:3
28297 Breakpoint 2 at 0x555555555155: file test.c, line 3.
28298 (gdb) set suppress-cli-notifications on
28299 (gdb) continue
28300 Continuing.
28301 (gdb)
28302 @end smallexample
28303
28304 Suppressing CLI notifications may be useful in scripts to obtain a
28305 reduced output from a list of commands.
28306 @end table
28307
28308 @kindex show suppress-cli-notifications
28309 @item show suppress-cli-notifications
28310 Displays whether printing CLI notifications is suppressed or not.
28311 @end table
28312
28313 @node Extending GDB
28314 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
28315 @cindex extending GDB
28316
28317 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
28318 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
28319 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
28320 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
28321 being debugged.
28322
28323 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
28324 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
28325 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
28326 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
28327 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
28328 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
28329
28330 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
28331 setting:
28332
28333 @table @code
28334 @kindex set script-extension
28335 @kindex show script-extension
28336 @item set script-extension off
28337 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
28338
28339 @item set script-extension soft
28340 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
28341 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
28342 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
28343 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
28344
28345 @item set script-extension strict
28346 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
28347 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
28348 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
28349
28350 @item show script-extension
28351 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
28352
28353 @end table
28354
28355 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR
28356 This setting is not used for files in the system-wide gdbinit directory.
28357 Files in that directory must have an extension matching their language,
28358 or have a @file{.gdb} extension to be interpreted as regular @value{GDBN}
28359 commands. @xref{Startup}.
28360 @end ifset
28361
28362 @menu
28363 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
28364 * Aliases:: Command Aliases
28365 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
28366 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
28367 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
28368 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
28369 @end menu
28370
28371 @node Sequences
28372 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
28373
28374 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
28375 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
28376 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
28377 files.
28378
28379 @menu
28380 * Define:: How to define your own commands
28381 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
28382 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
28383 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
28384 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
28385 @end menu
28386
28387 @node Define
28388 @subsection User-defined Commands
28389
28390 @cindex user-defined command
28391 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
28392 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
28393 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
28394 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
28395 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
28396 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
28397
28398 @smallexample
28399 define adder
28400 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
28401 end
28402 @end smallexample
28403
28404 @noindent
28405 To execute the command use:
28406
28407 @smallexample
28408 adder 1 2 3
28409 @end smallexample
28410
28411 @noindent
28412 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
28413 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
28414 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
28415 functions calls.
28416
28417 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
28418 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
28419 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
28420 been passed.
28421
28422 @smallexample
28423 define adder
28424 if $argc == 2
28425 print $arg0 + $arg1
28426 end
28427 if $argc == 3
28428 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
28429 end
28430 end
28431 @end smallexample
28432
28433 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
28434 to process a variable number of arguments:
28435
28436 @smallexample
28437 define adder
28438 set $i = 0
28439 set $sum = 0
28440 while $i < $argc
28441 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
28442 set $i = $i + 1
28443 end
28444 print $sum
28445 end
28446 @end smallexample
28447
28448 @table @code
28449
28450 @kindex define
28451 @item define @var{commandname}
28452 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
28453 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
28454 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
28455 numbers, dashes, dots, and underscores. It may also start with any
28456 predefined or user-defined prefix command.
28457 For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
28458 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
28459
28460 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
28461 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
28462 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
28463
28464 @kindex document
28465 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
28466 @item document @var{commandname}
28467 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
28468 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
28469 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
28470 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
28471 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
28472 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
28473
28474 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
28475 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
28476 does not change the documentation.
28477
28478 It is also possible to document user-defined aliases. The alias documentation
28479 will then be used by the @code{help} and @code{apropos} commands
28480 instead of the documentation of the aliased command.
28481 Documenting a user-defined alias is particularly useful when defining
28482 an alias as a set of nested @code{with} commands
28483 (@pxref{Command aliases default args}).
28484
28485 @kindex define-prefix
28486 @item define-prefix @var{commandname}
28487 Define or mark the command @var{commandname} as a user-defined prefix
28488 command. Once marked, @var{commandname} can be used as prefix command
28489 by the @code{define} command.
28490 Note that @code{define-prefix} can be used with a not yet defined
28491 @var{commandname}. In such a case, @var{commandname} is defined as
28492 an empty user-defined command.
28493 In case you redefine a command that was marked as a user-defined
28494 prefix command, the subcommands of the redefined command are kept
28495 (and @value{GDBN} indicates so to the user).
28496
28497 Example:
28498 @example
28499 (@value{GDBP}) define-prefix abc
28500 (@value{GDBP}) define-prefix abc def
28501 (@value{GDBP}) define abc def
28502 Type commands for definition of "abc def".
28503 End with a line saying just "end".
28504 >echo command initial def\n
28505 >end
28506 (@value{GDBP}) define abc def ghi
28507 Type commands for definition of "abc def ghi".
28508 End with a line saying just "end".
28509 >echo command ghi\n
28510 >end
28511 (@value{GDBP}) define abc def
28512 Keeping subcommands of prefix command "def".
28513 Redefine command "def"? (y or n) y
28514 Type commands for definition of "abc def".
28515 End with a line saying just "end".
28516 >echo command def\n
28517 >end
28518 (@value{GDBP}) abc def ghi
28519 command ghi
28520 (@value{GDBP}) abc def
28521 command def
28522 (@value{GDBP})
28523 @end example
28524
28525 @kindex dont-repeat
28526 @cindex don't repeat command
28527 @item dont-repeat
28528 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
28529 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
28530 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
28531
28532 @kindex help user-defined
28533 @item help user-defined
28534 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
28535 COMMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
28536 included (if any).
28537
28538 @kindex show user
28539 @item show user
28540 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
28541 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
28542 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
28543 definitions for all user-defined commands.
28544 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
28545
28546 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
28547 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
28548 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
28549 @item show max-user-call-depth
28550 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
28551 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
28552 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
28553 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
28554 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
28555 @end table
28556
28557 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
28558 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
28559
28560 When user-defined commands are executed, the
28561 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
28562 stops execution of the user-defined command.
28563
28564 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
28565 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
28566 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
28567 messages when used in a user-defined command.
28568
28569 @node Hooks
28570 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
28571 @cindex command hooks
28572 @cindex hooks, for commands
28573 @cindex hooks, pre-command
28574
28575 @kindex hook
28576 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
28577 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
28578 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
28579 before that command.
28580
28581 @cindex hooks, post-command
28582 @kindex hookpost
28583 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
28584 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
28585 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
28586 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
28587 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
28588
28589 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
28590 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
28591
28592 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
28593 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
28594
28595 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
28596 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
28597 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
28598 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
28599 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
28600
28601 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
28602 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
28603 you could define:
28604
28605 @smallexample
28606 define hook-stop
28607 handle SIGALRM nopass
28608 end
28609
28610 define hook-run
28611 handle SIGALRM pass
28612 end
28613
28614 define hook-continue
28615 handle SIGALRM pass
28616 end
28617 @end smallexample
28618
28619 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
28620 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
28621 you could define:
28622
28623 @smallexample
28624 define hook-echo
28625 echo <<<---
28626 end
28627
28628 define hookpost-echo
28629 echo --->>>\n
28630 end
28631
28632 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
28633 <<<---Hello World--->>>
28634 (@value{GDBP})
28635
28636 @end smallexample
28637
28638 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
28639 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
28640 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
28641 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
28642 @c or not?
28643 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
28644 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
28645 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
28646
28647 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
28648 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
28649 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
28650
28651 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
28652 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
28653
28654 @node Command Files
28655 @subsection Command Files
28656
28657 @cindex command files
28658 @cindex scripting commands
28659 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
28660 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
28661 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
28662 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
28663 terminal.
28664
28665 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
28666 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
28667 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
28668 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
28669 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
28670
28671 @table @code
28672 @kindex source
28673 @cindex execute commands from a file
28674 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
28675 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
28676 @end table
28677
28678 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
28679 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
28680 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
28681 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
28682 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
28683
28684 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
28685 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
28686 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
28687 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
28688 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
28689 is not relevant to scripts.
28690
28691 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
28692 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
28693 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
28694 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
28695 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
28696 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
28697 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
28698 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
28699 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
28700 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
28701 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
28702 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
28703 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
28704 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
28705
28706 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
28707 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
28708 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
28709
28710 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
28711 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
28712 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
28713 when called from command files.
28714
28715 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
28716 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
28717 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
28718 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
28719 the next command.
28720
28721 @smallexample
28722 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
28723 @end smallexample
28724
28725 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
28726 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
28727 would be directed to @file{log}.
28728
28729 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
28730 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
28731 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
28732 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
28733 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
28734 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
28735 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
28736 conditionally, etc.
28737
28738 @table @code
28739 @kindex if
28740 @kindex else
28741 @item if
28742 @itemx else
28743 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
28744 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
28745 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
28746 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
28747 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
28748 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
28749 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
28750
28751 @kindex while
28752 @item while
28753 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
28754 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
28755 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
28756 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
28757 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
28758 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
28759
28760 @kindex loop_break
28761 @item loop_break
28762 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
28763 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
28764 line.
28765
28766 @kindex loop_continue
28767 @item loop_continue
28768 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
28769 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
28770 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
28771 the controlling expression.
28772
28773 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
28774 @item end
28775 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
28776 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
28777 @end table
28778
28779
28780 @node Output
28781 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
28782
28783 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
28784 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
28785 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
28786 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
28787 want.
28788
28789 @table @code
28790 @kindex echo
28791 @item echo @var{text}
28792 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
28793 @c because it is not in ANSI.
28794 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
28795 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
28796 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
28797 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
28798 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
28799 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
28800 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
28801 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
28802 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
28803
28804 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
28805 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
28806
28807 @smallexample
28808 echo This is some text\n\
28809 which is continued\n\
28810 onto several lines.\n
28811 @end smallexample
28812
28813 produces the same output as
28814
28815 @smallexample
28816 echo This is some text\n
28817 echo which is continued\n
28818 echo onto several lines.\n
28819 @end smallexample
28820
28821 @kindex output
28822 @item output @var{expression}
28823 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
28824 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
28825 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
28826 on expressions.
28827
28828 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
28829 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
28830 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
28831 Formats}, for more information.
28832
28833 @kindex printf
28834 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
28835 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
28836 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
28837 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
28838 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
28839 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
28840 executing the code below:
28841
28842 @smallexample
28843 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
28844 @end smallexample
28845
28846 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
28847 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
28848 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
28849 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
28850 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
28851 printed.
28852
28853 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
28854
28855 @smallexample
28856 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
28857 @end smallexample
28858
28859 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
28860 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
28861 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
28862
28863 @itemize @bullet
28864 @item
28865 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
28866
28867 @item
28868 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
28869 width.
28870
28871 @item
28872 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
28873 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
28874
28875 @item
28876 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
28877 supported.
28878
28879 @item
28880 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
28881
28882 @item
28883 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
28884 @end itemize
28885
28886 @noindent
28887 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
28888 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
28889 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
28890 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
28891
28892 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
28893 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
28894 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
28895 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
28896 supported.
28897
28898 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
28899 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
28900 together with a floating point specifier.
28901 letters:
28902
28903 @itemize @bullet
28904 @item
28905 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
28906
28907 @item
28908 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
28909
28910 @item
28911 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
28912 @end itemize
28913
28914 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
28915 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
28916 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
28917
28918 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
28919 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
28920
28921 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
28922 @smallexample
28923 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
28924 @end smallexample
28925
28926 @anchor{eval}
28927 @kindex eval
28928 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
28929 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
28930 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
28931
28932 @end table
28933
28934 @node Auto-loading sequences
28935 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
28936 @cindex native script auto-loading
28937
28938 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
28939 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
28940 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
28941 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
28942
28943 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
28944 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
28945
28946 @table @code
28947 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
28948 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
28949 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
28950 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
28951
28952 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
28953 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
28954 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
28955 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
28956 disabled.
28957
28958 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
28959 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
28960 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
28961 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
28962 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
28963 auto-loaded.
28964 @end table
28965
28966 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
28967 matching names are printed.
28968
28969 @node Aliases
28970 @section Command Aliases
28971 @cindex aliases for commands
28972
28973 Aliases allow you to define alternate spellings for existing commands.
28974 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python
28975 (@pxref{Python}) has a long name, it is handy to have an abbreviated
28976 version of it that involves less typing.
28977
28978 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
28979 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
28980 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
28981
28982 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
28983 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
28984 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
28985
28986 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
28987
28988 @table @code
28989
28990 @kindex alias
28991 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{alias} = @var{command} [@var{default-args}]
28992
28993 @end table
28994
28995 @var{alias} specifies the name of the new alias. Each word of
28996 @var{alias} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and underscores.
28997
28998 @var{command} specifies the name of an existing command
28999 that is being aliased.
29000
29001 @var{command} can also be the name of an existing alias. In this
29002 case, @var{command} cannot be an alias that has default arguments.
29003
29004 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
29005 of the command. Abbreviations are not used in command completion.
29006
29007 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
29008 and is useful when @var{alias} begins with a dash.
29009
29010 You can specify @var{default-args} for your alias. These
29011 @var{default-args} will be automatically added before the alias
29012 arguments typed explicitly on the command line.
29013
29014 For example, the below defines an alias @code{btfullall} that shows all local
29015 variables and all frame arguments:
29016 @smallexample
29017 (@value{GDBP}) alias btfullall = backtrace -full -frame-arguments all
29018 @end smallexample
29019
29020 For more information about @var{default-args}, see @ref{Command
29021 aliases default args, ,Default Arguments}.
29022
29023 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation of a
29024 command so that there is less to type. Suppose you were tired of
29025 typing @samp{disas}, the current shortest unambiguous abbreviation of
29026 the @samp{disassemble} command and you wanted an even shorter version
29027 named @samp{di}. The following will accomplish this.
29028
29029 @smallexample
29030 (@value{GDBP}) alias -a di = disas
29031 @end smallexample
29032
29033 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands. With a
29034 user-defined command, you also need to write documentation for it with
29035 the @samp{document} command. An alias automatically picks up the
29036 documentation of the existing command.
29037
29038 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
29039 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
29040 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
29041 of a command.
29042
29043 @smallexample
29044 (@value{GDBP}) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
29045 (@value{GDBP}) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
29046 (@value{GDBP}) set p elms 200
29047 (@value{GDBP}) show p elms
29048 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
29049 @end smallexample
29050
29051 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
29052 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
29053 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
29054
29055 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{command} and
29056 @var{alias}, just as they are normally.
29057
29058 @smallexample
29059 (@value{GDBP}) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
29060 @end smallexample
29061
29062 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
29063 alias for a more complex command.
29064 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
29065
29066 @smallexample
29067 (@value{GDBP}) alias spe = set print elements
29068 (@value{GDBP}) spe 20
29069 @end smallexample
29070
29071 @menu
29072 * Command aliases default args:: Default arguments for aliases
29073 @end menu
29074
29075 @node Command aliases default args
29076 @subsection Default Arguments
29077 @cindex aliases for commands, default arguments
29078
29079 You can tell @value{GDBN} to always prepend some default arguments to
29080 the list of arguments provided explicitly by the user when using a
29081 user-defined alias.
29082
29083 If you repeatedly use the same arguments or options for a command, you
29084 can define an alias for this command and tell @value{GDBN} to
29085 automatically prepend these arguments or options to the list of
29086 arguments you type explicitly when using the alias@footnote{@value{GDBN}
29087 could easily accept default arguments for pre-defined commands and aliases,
29088 but it was deemed this would be confusing, and so is not allowed.}.
29089
29090 For example, if you often use the command @code{thread apply all}
29091 specifying to work on the threads in ascending order and to continue in case it
29092 encounters an error, you can tell @value{GDBN} to automatically preprend
29093 the @code{-ascending} and @code{-c} options by using:
29094
29095 @smallexample
29096 (@value{GDBP}) alias thread apply asc-all = thread apply all -ascending -c
29097 @end smallexample
29098
29099 Once you have defined this alias with its default args, any time you type
29100 the @code{thread apply asc-all} followed by @code{some arguments},
29101 @value{GDBN} will execute @code{thread apply all -ascending -c some arguments}.
29102
29103 To have even less to type, you can also define a one word alias:
29104 @smallexample
29105 (@value{GDBP}) alias t_a_c = thread apply all -ascending -c
29106 @end smallexample
29107
29108 As usual, unambiguous abbreviations can be used for @var{alias}
29109 and @var{default-args}.
29110
29111 The different aliases of a command do not share their default args.
29112 For example, you define a new alias @code{bt_ALL} showing all possible
29113 information and another alias @code{bt_SMALL} showing very limited information
29114 using:
29115 @smallexample
29116 (@value{GDBP}) alias bt_ALL = backtrace -entry-values both -frame-arg all \
29117 -past-main -past-entry -full
29118 (@value{GDBP}) alias bt_SMALL = backtrace -entry-values no -frame-arg none \
29119 -past-main off -past-entry off
29120 @end smallexample
29121
29122 (For more on using the @code{alias} command, see @ref{Aliases}.)
29123
29124 Default args are not limited to the arguments and options of @var{command},
29125 but can specify nested commands if @var{command} accepts such a nested command
29126 as argument.
29127 For example, the below defines @code{faalocalsoftype} that lists the
29128 frames having locals of a certain type, together with the matching
29129 local vars:
29130 @smallexample
29131 (@value{GDBP}) alias faalocalsoftype = frame apply all info locals -q -t
29132 (@value{GDBP}) faalocalsoftype int
29133 #1 0x55554f5e in sleeper_or_burner (v=0xdf50) at sleepers.c:86
29134 i = 0
29135 ret = 21845
29136 @end smallexample
29137
29138 This is also very useful to define an alias for a set of nested @code{with}
29139 commands to have a particular combination of temporary settings. For example,
29140 the below defines the alias @code{pp10} that pretty prints an expression
29141 argument, with a maximum of 10 elements if the expression is a string or
29142 an array:
29143 @smallexample
29144 (@value{GDBP}) alias pp10 = with print pretty -- with print elements 10 -- print
29145 @end smallexample
29146 This defines the alias @code{pp10} as being a sequence of 3 commands.
29147 The first part @code{with print pretty --} temporarily activates the setting
29148 @code{set print pretty}, then launches the command that follows the separator
29149 @code{--}.
29150 The command following the first part is also a @code{with} command that
29151 temporarily changes the setting @code{set print elements} to 10, then
29152 launches the command that follows the second separator @code{--}.
29153 The third part @code{print} is the command the @code{pp10} alias will launch,
29154 using the temporary values of the settings and the arguments explicitly given
29155 by the user.
29156 For more information about the @code{with} command usage,
29157 see @ref{Command Settings}.
29158
29159 By default, asking the help for an alias shows the documentation of
29160 the aliased command. When the alias is a set of nested commands, @code{help}
29161 of an alias shows the documentation of the first command. This help
29162 is not particularly useful for an alias such as @code{pp10}.
29163 For such an alias, it is useful to give a specific documentation
29164 using the @code{document} command (@pxref{Define, document}).
29165
29166
29167 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
29168 @include python.texi
29169
29170 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
29171 @include guile.texi
29172
29173 @node Auto-loading extensions
29174 @section Auto-loading extensions
29175 @cindex auto-loading extensions
29176
29177 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading
29178 extensions when a new object file is read (for example, due to the
29179 @code{file} command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared
29180 library): @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (@pxref{objfile-gdbdotext
29181 file,,The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file}) and the
29182 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section of modern file formats like ELF
29183 (@pxref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section,,The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
29184 section}). For a discussion of the differences between these two
29185 approaches see @ref{Which flavor to choose?}.
29186
29187 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
29188 debugging commands and features.
29189
29190 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
29191 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
29192 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
29193 for more information.
29194 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
29195 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
29196
29197 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
29198 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
29199
29200 @menu
29201 * objfile-gdbdotext file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
29202 * dotdebug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
29203 * Which flavor to choose?:: Choosing between these approaches
29204 @end menu
29205
29206 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
29207 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
29208 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
29209 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
29210 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
29211
29212 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
29213 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
29214 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
29215 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
29216
29217 @table @code
29218 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
29219 GDB's own command language
29220 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
29221 Python
29222 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
29223 Guile
29224 @end table
29225
29226 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
29227 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
29228 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
29229 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
29230 script in the specified extension language.
29231
29232 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
29233 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
29234 (On MS-Windows/MS-DOS, the drive letter of the executable's leading
29235 directories is converted to a one-letter subdirectory, i.e.@:
29236 @file{d:/usr/bin/} is converted to @file{/d/usr/bin/}, because Windows
29237 filesystems disallow colons in file names.)
29238
29239 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
29240 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
29241
29242 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
29243 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
29244 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
29245 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
29246 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
29247 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
29248
29249 @table @code
29250 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
29251 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
29252 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
29253 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
29254 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
29255 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
29256
29257 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
29258 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
29259
29260 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
29261 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
29262 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
29263 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
29264
29265 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
29266 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
29267 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
29268 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
29269 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
29270 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
29271 platform.
29272
29273 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
29274 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
29275 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
29276
29277 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
29278 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
29279 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
29280 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
29281
29282 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
29283 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
29284 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
29285 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
29286 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
29287 @end table
29288
29289 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
29290 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
29291 @var{objfile} is opened.
29292 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
29293 is evaluated more than once.
29294
29295 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
29296 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
29297 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
29298
29299 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
29300 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
29301 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
29302 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
29303 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
29304 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
29305 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
29306
29307 The following entries are supported:
29308
29309 @table @code
29310 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
29311 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
29312 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
29313 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
29314 @end table
29315
29316 @subsubsection Script File Entries
29317
29318 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
29319 in the current directory and then along the source search path
29320 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
29321 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
29322 directory is not relevant to scripts.
29323
29324 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
29325 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
29326
29327 @example
29328 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
29329 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
29330 asm("\
29331 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
29332 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
29333 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
29334 .popsection \n\
29335 ");
29336 @end example
29337
29338 @noindent
29339 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
29340 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
29341
29342 @example
29343 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
29344 @end example
29345
29346 The script name may include directories if desired.
29347
29348 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
29349 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
29350
29351 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
29352 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
29353 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
29354 will remove duplicates.
29355
29356 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
29357
29358 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
29359 itself instead of loading it from a file.
29360 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
29361 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
29362 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
29363 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
29364 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
29365 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
29366 on its name.
29367
29368 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
29369 testsuite.
29370
29371 @example
29372 #include "symcat.h"
29373 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
29374 asm(
29375 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
29376 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
29377 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
29378 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
29379 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
29380 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
29381 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
29382 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
29383 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
29384 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
29385 ".byte 0\n"
29386 ".popsection\n"
29387 );
29388 @end example
29389
29390 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
29391 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
29392 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
29393 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
29394
29395 @node Which flavor to choose?
29396 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
29397
29398 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
29399 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
29400
29401 @noindent
29402 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
29403
29404 @itemize @bullet
29405 @item
29406 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
29407
29408 @item
29409 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
29410
29411 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
29412 in the source search path.
29413 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
29414 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
29415
29416 @item
29417 Doesn't require source code additions.
29418 @end itemize
29419
29420 @noindent
29421 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
29422
29423 @itemize @bullet
29424 @item
29425 Works with static linking.
29426
29427 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
29428 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
29429 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
29430 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
29431 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
29432
29433 @item
29434 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
29435
29436 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
29437 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
29438
29439 @item
29440 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
29441
29442 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
29443 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
29444 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
29445 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
29446 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
29447 top of the source tree to the source search path.
29448 @end itemize
29449
29450 @node Multiple Extension Languages
29451 @section Multiple Extension Languages
29452
29453 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
29454 and generally do not interfere with each other.
29455 There are some things to be aware of, however.
29456
29457 @subsection Python comes first
29458
29459 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
29460 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
29461 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
29462 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
29463 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
29464 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
29465 pretty-printed form of a value).
29466 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
29467 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
29468 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
29469
29470 @node Interpreters
29471 @chapter Command Interpreters
29472 @cindex command interpreters
29473
29474 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
29475 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
29476 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
29477
29478 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
29479 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
29480 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
29481 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
29482
29483 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
29484 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
29485 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
29486 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
29487
29488 @table @code
29489 @item console
29490 @cindex console interpreter
29491 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
29492 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
29493 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
29494
29495 @item dap
29496 @cindex DAP
29497 @cindex Debugger Adapter Protocol
29498 When @value{GDBN} has been built with Python support, it also supports
29499 the Debugger Adapter Protocol. This protocol can be used by a
29500 debugger GUI or an IDE to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This
29501 protocol is documented at
29502 @url{https://microsoft.github.io/debug-adapter-protocol/}.
29503
29504 @item mi
29505 @cindex mi interpreter
29506 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi3}). Used primarily
29507 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
29508 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
29509 Interface}.
29510
29511 @item mi3
29512 @cindex mi3 interpreter
29513 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 9.1.
29514
29515 @item mi2
29516 @cindex mi2 interpreter
29517 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 6.0.
29518
29519 @end table
29520
29521 @cindex invoke another interpreter
29522
29523 @kindex interpreter-exec
29524 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
29525 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
29526 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
29527
29528 @smallexample
29529 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
29530 @end smallexample
29531
29532 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
29533 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
29534
29535 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
29536 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
29537 permanently.
29538
29539 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
29540
29541 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
29542 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
29543 device (usually a tty).
29544
29545 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
29546 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
29547 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
29548 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
29549 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
29550 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
29551 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
29552 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
29553 the separate MI interpreter.
29554
29555 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
29556 @code{new-ui} command:
29557
29558 @kindex new-ui
29559 @cindex new user interface
29560 @smallexample
29561 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
29562 @end smallexample
29563
29564 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
29565 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
29566 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
29567 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
29568 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
29569 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
29570
29571 @smallexample
29572 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
29573 @end smallexample
29574
29575 @noindent
29576 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
29577
29578 @node TUI
29579 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
29580 @cindex TUI
29581 @cindex Text User Interface
29582
29583 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
29584 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
29585 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
29586 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
29587 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
29588 is available.
29589
29590 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
29591 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
29592 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
29593 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
29594 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
29595 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
29596
29597 @menu
29598 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
29599 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
29600 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
29601 * TUI Mouse Support:: TUI mouse support
29602 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
29603 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
29604 @end menu
29605
29606 @node TUI Overview
29607 @section TUI Overview
29608
29609 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
29610
29611 @table @emph
29612 @item command
29613 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
29614 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
29615 managed using readline.
29616
29617 @item source
29618 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
29619 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
29620
29621 @item assembly
29622 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
29623
29624 @item register
29625 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
29626 when their values change.
29627 @end table
29628
29629 The source and assembly windows show the current program position by
29630 highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
29631 By default, source and assembly code styling is disabled for the
29632 highlighted text, but you can enable it with the @code{set style
29633 tui-current-position on} command. @xref{Output Styling}.
29634
29635 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
29636 indicates the breakpoint type:
29637
29638 @table @code
29639 @item B
29640 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
29641
29642 @item b
29643 Breakpoint which was never hit.
29644
29645 @item H
29646 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
29647
29648 @item h
29649 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
29650 @end table
29651
29652 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
29653
29654 @table @code
29655 @item +
29656 Breakpoint is enabled.
29657
29658 @item -
29659 Breakpoint is disabled.
29660 @end table
29661
29662 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
29663 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
29664 changes.
29665
29666 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
29667 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
29668 layouts:
29669
29670 @itemize @bullet
29671 @item
29672 source only,
29673
29674 @item
29675 assembly only,
29676
29677 @item
29678 source and assembly,
29679
29680 @item
29681 source and registers, or
29682
29683 @item
29684 assembly and registers.
29685 @end itemize
29686
29687 These are the standard layouts, but other layouts can be defined.
29688
29689 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
29690
29691 @table @emph
29692 @item target
29693 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
29694 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
29695
29696 @item process
29697 Gives the current process or thread number.
29698 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
29699
29700 @item function
29701 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
29702 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
29703 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
29704 the string @code{??} is displayed.
29705
29706 @item line
29707 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
29708 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
29709
29710 @item pc
29711 Indicates the current program counter address.
29712 @end table
29713
29714 @node TUI Keys
29715 @section TUI Key Bindings
29716 @cindex TUI key bindings
29717
29718 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
29719 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
29720 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
29721 @end ifset
29722 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
29723 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
29724 @end ifclear
29725 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
29726 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
29727
29728 @table @kbd
29729 @kindex C-x C-a
29730 @item C-x C-a
29731 @kindex C-x a
29732 @itemx C-x a
29733 @kindex C-x A
29734 @itemx C-x A
29735 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
29736 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
29737 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
29738 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
29739 The screen is then refreshed.
29740
29741 This key binding uses the bindable Readline function
29742 @code{tui-switch-mode}.
29743
29744 @kindex C-x 1
29745 @item C-x 1
29746 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
29747 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
29748 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
29749
29750 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
29751
29752 This key binding uses the bindable Readline function
29753 @code{tui-delete-other-windows}.
29754
29755 @kindex C-x 2
29756 @item C-x 2
29757 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
29758 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
29759 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
29760 previous layout and the new one.
29761
29762 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
29763
29764 This key binding uses the bindable Readline function
29765 @code{tui-change-windows}.
29766
29767 @kindex C-x o
29768 @item C-x o
29769 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
29770 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
29771 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
29772
29773 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
29774
29775 This key binding uses the bindable Readline function
29776 @code{tui-other-window}.
29777
29778 @kindex C-x s
29779 @item C-x s
29780 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
29781 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
29782
29783 This key binding uses the bindable Readline function
29784 @code{next-keymap}.
29785 @end table
29786
29787 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
29788
29789 @table @asis
29790 @kindex PgUp
29791 @item @key{PgUp}
29792 Scroll the active window one page up.
29793
29794 @kindex PgDn
29795 @item @key{PgDn}
29796 Scroll the active window one page down.
29797
29798 @kindex Up
29799 @item @key{Up}
29800 Scroll the active window one line up.
29801
29802 @kindex Down
29803 @item @key{Down}
29804 Scroll the active window one line down.
29805
29806 @kindex Left
29807 @item @key{Left}
29808 Scroll the active window one column left.
29809
29810 @kindex Right
29811 @item @key{Right}
29812 Scroll the active window one column right.
29813
29814 @kindex C-L
29815 @item @kbd{C-L}
29816 Refresh the screen.
29817 @end table
29818
29819 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
29820 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
29821 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
29822 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
29823 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
29824
29825 @node TUI Single Key Mode
29826 @section TUI Single Key Mode
29827 @cindex TUI single key mode
29828
29829 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
29830 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
29831 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
29832
29833 @table @kbd
29834 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29835 @item c
29836 continue
29837
29838 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29839 @item d
29840 down
29841
29842 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29843 @item f
29844 finish
29845
29846 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29847 @item n
29848 next
29849
29850 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29851 @item o
29852 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
29853
29854 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29855 @item q
29856 exit the SingleKey mode.
29857
29858 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29859 @item r
29860 run
29861
29862 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29863 @item s
29864 step
29865
29866 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29867 @item i
29868 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
29869
29870 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29871 @item u
29872 up
29873
29874 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29875 @item v
29876 info locals
29877
29878 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
29879 @item w
29880 where
29881 @end table
29882
29883 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
29884 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
29885 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
29886 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
29887 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
29888 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
29889
29890 @cindex SingleKey keymap name
29891 If @value{GDBN} was built with Readline 8.0 or later, the TUI
29892 SingleKey keymap will be named @samp{SingleKey}. This can be used in
29893 @file{.inputrc} to add additional bindings to this keymap.
29894
29895 @node TUI Mouse Support
29896 @section TUI Mouse Support
29897 @cindex TUI mouse support
29898
29899 If the curses library supports the mouse, the TUI supports mouse
29900 actions.
29901
29902 The mouse wheel scrolls the appropriate window under the mouse cursor.
29903
29904 The TUI itself does not directly support copying/pasting with the
29905 mouse. However, on Unix terminals, you can typically press and hold
29906 the @key{SHIFT} key on your keyboard to temporarily bypass
29907 @value{GDBN}'s TUI and access the terminal's native mouse copy/paste
29908 functionality (commonly, click-drag-release or double-click to select
29909 text, middle-click to paste). This copy/paste works with the
29910 terminal's selection buffer, as opposed to the TUI's buffer.
29911
29912 @node TUI Commands
29913 @section TUI-specific Commands
29914 @cindex TUI commands
29915
29916 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
29917 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
29918 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
29919 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
29920
29921 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
29922 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
29923 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
29924 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
29925 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
29926
29927 @table @code
29928 @item tui enable
29929 @kindex tui enable
29930 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
29931 TUI mode has previously been used in the current debugging session,
29932 otherwise a default layout is used.
29933
29934 @item tui disable
29935 @kindex tui disable
29936 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
29937
29938 @anchor{info_win_command}
29939 @item info win
29940 @kindex info win
29941 List the names and sizes of all currently displayed windows.
29942
29943 @item tui new-layout @var{name} @var{window} @var{weight} @r{[}@var{window} @var{weight}@dots{}@r{]}
29944 @kindex tui new-layout
29945 Create a new TUI layout. The new layout will be named @var{name}, and
29946 can be accessed using the @code{layout} command (see below).
29947
29948 Each @var{window} parameter is either the name of a window to display,
29949 or a window description. The windows will be displayed from top to
29950 bottom in the order listed.
29951
29952 The names of the windows are the same as the ones given to the
29953 @code{focus} command (see below); additional, the @code{status}
29954 window can be specified. Note that, because it is of fixed height,
29955 the weight assigned to the status window is of no importance. It is
29956 conventional to use @samp{0} here.
29957
29958 A window description looks a bit like an invocation of @code{tui
29959 new-layout}, and is of the form
29960 @{@r{[}@code{-horizontal}@r{]}@var{window} @var{weight} @r{[}@var{window} @var{weight}@dots{}@r{]}@}.
29961
29962 This specifies a sub-layout. If @code{-horizontal} is given, the
29963 windows in this description will be arranged side-by-side, rather than
29964 top-to-bottom.
29965
29966 Each @var{weight} is an integer. It is the weight of this window
29967 relative to all the other windows in the layout. These numbers are
29968 used to calculate how much of the screen is given to each window.
29969
29970 For example:
29971
29972 @example
29973 (gdb) tui new-layout example src 1 regs 1 status 0 cmd 1
29974 @end example
29975
29976 Here, the new layout is called @samp{example}. It shows the source
29977 and register windows, followed by the status window, and then finally
29978 the command window. The non-status windows all have the same weight,
29979 so the terminal will be split into three roughly equal sections.
29980
29981 Here is a more complex example, showing a horizontal layout:
29982
29983 @example
29984 (gdb) tui new-layout example @{-horizontal src 1 asm 1@} 2 status 0 cmd 1
29985 @end example
29986
29987 This will result in side-by-side source and assembly windows; with the
29988 status and command window being beneath these, filling the entire
29989 width of the terminal. Because they have weight 2, the source and
29990 assembly windows will be twice the height of the command window.
29991
29992 @kindex tui layout
29993 @kindex layout
29994 @item tui layout @var{name}
29995 @itemx layout @var{name}
29996 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. The @var{name} parameter
29997 controls which layout is shown. It can be either one of the built-in
29998 layout names, or the name of a layout defined by the user using
29999 @code{tui new-layout}.
30000
30001 The built-in layouts are as follows:
30002
30003 @table @code
30004 @item next
30005 Display the next layout.
30006
30007 @item prev
30008 Display the previous layout.
30009
30010 @item src
30011 Display the source and command windows.
30012
30013 @item asm
30014 Display the assembly and command windows.
30015
30016 @item split
30017 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
30018
30019 @item regs
30020 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
30021 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
30022 register, assembler, and command windows.
30023 @end table
30024
30025 @kindex focus
30026 @item tui focus @var{name}
30027 @itemx focus @var{name}
30028 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
30029 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
30030
30031 @table @code
30032 @item next
30033 Make the next window active for scrolling.
30034
30035 @item prev
30036 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
30037
30038 @item src
30039 Make the source window active for scrolling.
30040
30041 @item asm
30042 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
30043
30044 @item regs
30045 Make the register window active for scrolling.
30046
30047 @item cmd
30048 Make the command window active for scrolling.
30049 @end table
30050
30051 @kindex tui refresh
30052 @kindex refresh
30053 @item tui refresh
30054 @itemx refresh
30055 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
30056
30057 @item tui reg @var{group}
30058 @kindex tui reg
30059 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
30060 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
30061 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
30062 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
30063 following groups are available on most targets:
30064 @table @code
30065 @item next
30066 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
30067 through all of the available register groups.
30068
30069 @item prev
30070 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
30071 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
30072 @var{next}.
30073
30074 @item general
30075 Display the general registers.
30076 @item float
30077 Display the floating point registers.
30078 @item system
30079 Display the system registers.
30080 @item vector
30081 Display the vector registers.
30082 @item all
30083 Display all registers.
30084 @end table
30085
30086 @item update
30087 @kindex update
30088 Update the source window and the current execution point.
30089
30090 @kindex tui window height
30091 @kindex winheight
30092 @item tui window height @var{name} +@var{count}
30093 @itemx tui window height @var{name} -@var{count}
30094 @itemx winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
30095 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
30096 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count} lines.
30097 Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts decrease
30098 it. The @var{name} parameter can be the name of any currently visible
30099 window. The names of the currently visible windows can be discovered
30100 using @kbd{info win} (@pxref{info_win_command,,info win}).
30101
30102 The set of currently visible windows must always fill the terminal,
30103 and so, it is only possible to resize on window if there are other
30104 visible windows that can either give or receive the extra terminal
30105 space.
30106
30107 @kindex tui window width
30108 @kindex winwidth
30109 @item tui window width @var{name} +@var{count}
30110 @itemx tui window width @var{name} -@var{count}
30111 @itemx winwidth @var{name} +@var{count}
30112 @itemx winwidth @var{name} -@var{count}
30113 Change the width of the window @var{name} by @var{count} columns.
30114 Positive counts increase the width, while negative counts decrease it.
30115 The @var{name} parameter can be the name of any currently visible
30116 window. The names of the currently visible windows can be discovered
30117 using @code{info win} (@pxref{info_win_command,,info win}).
30118
30119 The set of currently visible windows must always fill the terminal,
30120 and so, it is only possible to resize on window if there are other
30121 visible windows that can either give or receive the extra terminal
30122 space.
30123 @end table
30124
30125 @node TUI Configuration
30126 @section TUI Configuration Variables
30127 @cindex TUI configuration variables
30128
30129 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
30130
30131 @table @code
30132 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
30133 @kindex set tui border-kind
30134 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
30135 The possible values are the following:
30136 @table @code
30137 @item space
30138 Use a space character to draw the border.
30139
30140 @item ascii
30141 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
30142
30143 @item acs
30144 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
30145 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
30146 @end table
30147
30148 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
30149 @kindex set tui border-mode
30150 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
30151 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
30152 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
30153 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
30154 @table @code
30155 @item normal
30156 Use normal attributes to display the border.
30157
30158 @item standout
30159 Use standout mode.
30160
30161 @item reverse
30162 Use reverse video mode.
30163
30164 @item half
30165 Use half bright mode.
30166
30167 @item half-standout
30168 Use half bright and standout mode.
30169
30170 @item bold
30171 Use extra bright or bold mode.
30172
30173 @item bold-standout
30174 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
30175 @end table
30176
30177 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
30178 @kindex set tui tab-width
30179 @kindex tabset
30180 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
30181 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
30182 assembly windows.
30183
30184 @item set tui compact-source @r{[}on@r{|}off@r{]}
30185 @kindex set tui compact-source
30186 Set whether the TUI source window is displayed in ``compact'' form.
30187 The default display uses more space for line numbers and starts the
30188 source text at the next tab stop; the compact display uses only as
30189 much space as is needed for the line numbers in the current file, and
30190 only a single space to separate the line numbers from the source.
30191
30192 @kindex set debug tui
30193 @item set debug tui @r{[}on|off@r{]}
30194 Turn on or off display of @value{GDBN} internal debug messages relating
30195 to the TUI.
30196
30197 @kindex show debug tui
30198 @item show debug tui
30199 Show the current status of displaying @value{GDBN} internal debug
30200 messages relating to the TUI.
30201
30202 @end table
30203
30204 Note that the colors of the TUI borders can be controlled using the
30205 appropriate @code{set style} commands. @xref{Output Styling}.
30206
30207 @node Emacs
30208 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
30209
30210 @cindex Emacs
30211 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
30212 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
30213 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
30214 @value{GDBN}.
30215
30216 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
30217 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
30218 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
30219 created Emacs buffer.
30220 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
30221
30222 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
30223 things:
30224
30225 @itemize @bullet
30226 @item
30227 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
30228 the GUD buffer.
30229
30230 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
30231 and output done by the program you are debugging.
30232
30233 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
30234 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
30235 in this way.
30236
30237 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
30238 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
30239 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
30240 stop.
30241
30242 @item
30243 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
30244
30245 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
30246 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
30247 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
30248 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
30249 and the source.
30250
30251 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
30252 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
30253 @end itemize
30254
30255 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
30256 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
30257 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
30258 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
30259
30260 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
30261 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
30262 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
30263 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
30264 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
30265 program by searching your environment's @env{PATH} variable, but on
30266 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
30267 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
30268 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
30269
30270 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
30271 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
30272 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
30273 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
30274
30275 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
30276 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
30277 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
30278 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
30279 one you want.
30280
30281 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
30282 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
30283
30284 @table @kbd
30285 @item C-h m
30286 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
30287
30288 @item C-c C-s
30289 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
30290 update the display window to show the current file and location.
30291
30292 @item C-c C-n
30293 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
30294 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
30295 to show the current file and location.
30296
30297 @item C-c C-i
30298 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
30299 display window accordingly.
30300
30301 @item C-c C-f
30302 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
30303 @code{finish} command.
30304
30305 @item C-c C-r
30306 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
30307 command.
30308
30309 @item C-c <
30310 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
30311 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
30312 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
30313
30314 @item C-c >
30315 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
30316 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
30317 @end table
30318
30319 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
30320 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
30321
30322 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
30323 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
30324 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
30325 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
30326 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
30327 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
30328 speedbar displays watch expressions.
30329
30330 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
30331 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
30332 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
30333 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
30334 frame.
30335
30336 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
30337 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
30338 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
30339 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
30340 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
30341 to correspond properly with the code.
30342
30343 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
30344 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
30345 Emacs Manual}).
30346
30347 @node GDB/MI
30348 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
30349
30350 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
30351
30352 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
30353 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
30354 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
30355 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
30356 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
30357 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
30358
30359 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
30360 in the form of a reference manual.
30361
30362 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
30363 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
30364 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
30365
30366 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
30367
30368 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
30369 This chapter uses the following notation:
30370
30371 @itemize @bullet
30372 @item
30373 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
30374
30375 @item
30376 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
30377 it may or may not be given.
30378
30379 @item
30380 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
30381 may repeat zero or more times.
30382
30383 @item
30384 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
30385 may repeat one or more times.
30386
30387 @item
30388 @code{( @var{group} )} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
30389 occurs exactly once.
30390
30391 @item
30392 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
30393 @end itemize
30394
30395 @ignore
30396 @heading Dependencies
30397 @end ignore
30398
30399 @menu
30400 * GDB/MI General Design::
30401 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
30402 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
30403 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
30404 * GDB/MI Output Records::
30405 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
30406 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
30407 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
30408 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30409 * GDB/MI Program Context::
30410 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
30411 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
30412 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
30413 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
30414 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
30415 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
30416 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
30417 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
30418 * GDB/MI File Commands::
30419 @ignore
30420 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
30421 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
30422 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
30423 @end ignore
30424 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
30425 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
30426 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
30427 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
30428 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
30429 @end menu
30430
30431 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30432 @node GDB/MI General Design
30433 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
30434 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
30435
30436 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
30437 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
30438 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
30439 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
30440 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
30441 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
30442 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
30443 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
30444 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
30445 a command and reported as part of that command response.
30446
30447 The important examples of notifications are:
30448 @itemize @bullet
30449
30450 @item
30451 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
30452 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
30453 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
30454 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
30455 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
30456 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
30457 command itself was successfully executed.
30458
30459 @item
30460 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
30461 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
30462 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
30463 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
30464 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
30465 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
30466
30467 @item
30468 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
30469 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
30470 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
30471 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
30472 orthogonal frontend design.
30473
30474 @end itemize
30475
30476 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
30477 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
30478 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
30479 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
30480 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
30481 the user interface.
30482
30483
30484 @menu
30485 * Context management::
30486 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
30487 * Thread groups::
30488 @end menu
30489
30490 @node Context management
30491 @subsection Context management
30492
30493 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
30494
30495 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
30496 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
30497 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
30498 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
30499 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
30500 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
30501 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
30502 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
30503 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
30504
30505 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
30506 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
30507 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
30508 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
30509 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
30510 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
30511 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
30512 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
30513 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
30514 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
30515 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
30516
30517 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
30518 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
30519 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
30520 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
30521 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
30522 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
30523 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
30524 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
30525 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
30526 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
30527
30528 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
30529 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
30530 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
30531 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
30532 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
30533 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
30534 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
30535 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
30536 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
30537 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
30538 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
30539 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
30540 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
30541 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
30542 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
30543 @samp{--frame} options.
30544
30545 @subsubsection Language
30546
30547 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
30548 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
30549 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
30550 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
30551 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
30552 For instance:
30553
30554 @smallexample
30555 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
30556 ^done,value="4"
30557 (gdb)
30558 @end smallexample
30559
30560 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
30561 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
30562 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
30563
30564 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
30565 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
30566
30567 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
30568 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
30569 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
30570 specify a preference for asynchronous execution using the
30571 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
30572 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
30573 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
30574 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
30575 @code{-list-target-features} command.
30576
30577 @table @code
30578 @cindex foreground execution
30579 @cindex background execution
30580 @cindex asynchronous execution
30581 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
30582 @kindex set mi-async
30583 @item -gdb-set mi-async @r{[}on@r{|}off@r{]}
30584 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
30585
30586 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
30587 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
30588 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
30589
30590 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
30591 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
30592 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
30593 MI commands even while the target is running.
30594
30595 @kindex show mi-async
30596 @item -gdb-show mi-async
30597 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
30598 @end table
30599
30600 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
30601 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
30602 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
30603 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
30604 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
30605 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
30606
30607 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
30608 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
30609 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
30610 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
30611 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
30612 are running.
30613
30614 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
30615 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
30616 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
30617 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
30618 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
30619 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
30620 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
30621 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
30622 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
30623 @samp{--thread} option).
30624
30625 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
30626 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
30627 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
30628 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
30629
30630 @node Thread groups
30631 @subsection Thread groups
30632 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
30633 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
30634 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
30635 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
30636 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
30637
30638 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
30639 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
30640 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
30641 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
30642 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
30643 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
30644 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
30645 into processes.
30646
30647 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
30648 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
30649 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
30650 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
30651 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
30652 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
30653 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
30654 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
30655 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
30656 the members of specific thread group.
30657
30658 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
30659 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
30660 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
30661 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
30662 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
30663 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
30664 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
30665 after attaching to that thread group.
30666
30667 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors Connections and
30668 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
30669 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
30670 such thread groups.
30671
30672 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30673 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
30674 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
30675
30676 @menu
30677 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
30678 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
30679 @end menu
30680
30681 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
30682 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
30683
30684 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
30685 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
30686 @table @code
30687 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
30688 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
30689
30690 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
30691 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
30692 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
30693
30694 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
30695 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
30696 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
30697
30698 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
30699 "any sequence of digits"
30700
30701 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
30702 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
30703
30704 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
30705 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
30706
30707 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
30708 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
30709
30710 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
30711 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
30712 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
30713
30714 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
30715 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
30716
30717 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
30718 @code{CR | CR-LF}
30719 @end table
30720
30721 @noindent
30722 Notes:
30723
30724 @itemize @bullet
30725 @item
30726 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
30727 output is described below.
30728
30729 @item
30730 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
30731 finishes.
30732
30733 @item
30734 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
30735 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
30736 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
30737 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
30738 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
30739 @end itemize
30740
30741 Pragmatics:
30742
30743 @itemize @bullet
30744 @item
30745 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
30746
30747 @item
30748 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
30749 @end itemize
30750
30751 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
30752 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
30753
30754 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
30755 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
30756 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
30757 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
30758 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
30759 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
30760
30761 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
30762 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
30763 @var{token}.
30764
30765 @table @code
30766 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
30767 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
30768
30769 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
30770 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
30771
30772 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
30773 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
30774
30775 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
30776 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
30777
30778 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
30779 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
30780
30781 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
30782 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
30783
30784 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
30785 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
30786
30787 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
30788 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
30789
30790 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
30791 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
30792
30793 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
30794 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
30795 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
30796
30797 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
30798 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
30799
30800 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
30801 @code{ @var{string} }
30802
30803 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
30804 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
30805
30806 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
30807 @code{@var{c-string}}
30808
30809 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
30810 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
30811
30812 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
30813 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
30814 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
30815
30816 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
30817 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
30818
30819 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
30820 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
30821
30822 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
30823 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
30824
30825 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
30826 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
30827
30828 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
30829 @code{CR | CR-LF}
30830
30831 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
30832 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
30833 @end table
30834
30835 @noindent
30836 Notes:
30837
30838 @itemize @bullet
30839 @item
30840 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
30841
30842 @item
30843 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
30844 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
30845 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
30846 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
30847 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
30848 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
30849 prior command.
30850
30851 @item
30852 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
30853 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
30854 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
30855 prefixed by @samp{+}.
30856
30857 @item
30858 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
30859 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
30860 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
30861 @samp{*}.
30862
30863 @item
30864 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
30865 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
30866 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
30867 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
30868
30869 @item
30870 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
30871 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
30872 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
30873 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
30874
30875 @item
30876 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
30877 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
30878 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
30879
30880 @item
30881 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
30882 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
30883 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
30884 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
30885
30886 @item
30887 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
30888 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
30889 @var{values}.
30890
30891
30892 @end itemize
30893
30894 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
30895 details about the various output records.
30896
30897 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30898 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
30899 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
30900
30901 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
30902 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
30903
30904 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
30905 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
30906 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
30907 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
30908 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
30909 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
30910
30911 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
30912 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
30913 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
30914
30915 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30916 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
30917 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
30918 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
30919
30920 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
30921 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
30922
30923 Since @sc{gdb/mi} is used by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}, changes
30924 to the MI interface may break existing usage. This section describes how the
30925 protocol changes and how to request previous version of the protocol when it
30926 does.
30927
30928 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
30929 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
30930 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
30931 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
30932
30933 @itemize @bullet
30934 @item
30935 New MI commands may be added.
30936
30937 @item
30938 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
30939
30940 @item
30941 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
30942 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
30943
30944 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
30945 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
30946
30947 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
30948 @c resolve inconsistencies.
30949 @end itemize
30950
30951 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
30952 will be increased by one. The new versions of the MI protocol are not compatible
30953 with the old versions. Old versions of MI remain available, allowing front ends
30954 to keep using them until they are modified to use the latest MI version.
30955
30956 Since @code{--interpreter=mi} always points to the latest MI version, it is
30957 recommended that front ends request a specific version of MI when launching
30958 @value{GDBN} (e.g.@: @code{--interpreter=mi2}) to make sure they get an
30959 interpreter with the MI version they expect.
30960
30961 The following table gives a summary of the released versions of the MI
30962 interface: the version number, the version of GDB in which it first appeared
30963 and the breaking changes compared to the previous version.
30964
30965 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .1 .8
30966 @headitem MI version @tab GDB version @tab Breaking changes
30967
30968 @item
30969 @center 1
30970 @tab
30971 @center 5.1
30972 @tab
30973 None
30974
30975 @item
30976 @center 2
30977 @tab
30978 @center 6.0
30979 @tab
30980
30981 @itemize
30982 @item
30983 The @code{-environment-pwd}, @code{-environment-directory} and
30984 @code{-environment-path} commands now returns values using the MI output
30985 syntax, rather than CLI output syntax.
30986
30987 @item
30988 @code{-var-list-children}'s @code{children} result field is now a list, rather
30989 than a tuple.
30990
30991 @item
30992 @code{-var-update}'s @code{changelist} result field is now a list, rather than
30993 a tuple.
30994 @end itemize
30995
30996 @item
30997 @center 3
30998 @tab
30999 @center 9.1
31000 @tab
31001
31002 @itemize
31003 @item
31004 The output of information about multi-location breakpoints has changed in the
31005 responses to the @code{-break-insert} and @code{-break-info} commands, as well
31006 as in the @code{=breakpoint-created} and @code{=breakpoint-modified} events.
31007 The multiple locations are now placed in a @code{locations} field, whose value
31008 is a list.
31009 @end itemize
31010
31011 @item
31012 @center 4
31013 @tab
31014 @center 13.1
31015 @tab
31016
31017 @itemize
31018 @item
31019 The syntax of the "script" field in breakpoint output has changed in the
31020 responses to the @code{-break-insert} and @code{-break-info} commands, as
31021 well as the @code{=breakpoint-created} and @code{=breakpoint-modified}
31022 events. The previous output was syntactically invalid. The new output is
31023 a list.
31024 @end itemize
31025
31026 @end multitable
31027
31028 If your front end cannot yet migrate to a more recent version of the
31029 MI protocol, you can nevertheless selectively enable specific features
31030 available in those recent MI versions, using the following commands:
31031
31032 @table @code
31033
31034 @item -fix-multi-location-breakpoint-output
31035 Use the output for multi-location breakpoints which was introduced by
31036 MI 3, even when using MI versions below 3. This command has no
31037 effect when using MI version 3 or later.
31038
31039 @item -fix-breakpoint-script-output
31040 Use the output for the breakpoint "script" field which was introduced by
31041 MI 4, even when using MI versions below 4. This command has no effect when
31042 using MI version 4 or later.
31043
31044 @end table
31045
31046 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
31047 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
31048 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
31049 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
31050 @cindex mailing lists
31051
31052 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31053 @node GDB/MI Output Records
31054 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
31055
31056 @menu
31057 * GDB/MI Result Records::
31058 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
31059 * GDB/MI Async Records::
31060 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
31061 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
31062 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
31063 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
31064 @end menu
31065
31066 @node GDB/MI Result Records
31067 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
31068
31069 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
31070 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
31071 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
31072 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
31073
31074 @table @code
31075 @findex ^done
31076 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
31077 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
31078 values.
31079
31080 @item "^running"
31081 @findex ^running
31082 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
31083 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
31084 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
31085 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
31086 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
31087 which threads are resumed.
31088
31089 @item "^connected"
31090 @findex ^connected
31091 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
31092
31093 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
31094 @findex ^error
31095 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
31096 the corresponding error message.
31097
31098 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
31099 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
31100 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
31101
31102 @table @samp
31103 @item "undefined-command"
31104 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
31105 @end table
31106
31107 @item "^exit"
31108 @findex ^exit
31109 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
31110
31111 @end table
31112
31113 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
31114 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
31115
31116 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
31117 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
31118 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
31119 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
31120 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
31121
31122 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
31123 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
31124 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
31125 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
31126 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
31127
31128 @table @code
31129 @item "~" @var{string-output}
31130 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
31131 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
31132
31133 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
31134 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
31135 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
31136 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
31137
31138 @item "&" @var{string-output}
31139 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
31140 internals.
31141 @end table
31142
31143 @node GDB/MI Async Records
31144 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
31145
31146 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
31147 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
31148 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
31149 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
31150 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
31151 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
31152
31153 The following is the list of possible async records:
31154
31155 @table @code
31156
31157 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
31158 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
31159 thread ID of the thread that is now running, and it can be
31160 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
31161 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
31162 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
31163 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
31164 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
31165 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
31166 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
31167 it run freely.
31168
31169 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
31170 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
31171 following values:
31172
31173 @table @code
31174 @item breakpoint-hit
31175 A breakpoint was reached.
31176 @item watchpoint-trigger
31177 A watchpoint was triggered.
31178 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
31179 A read watchpoint was triggered.
31180 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
31181 An access watchpoint was triggered.
31182 @item function-finished
31183 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
31184 @item location-reached
31185 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
31186 @item watchpoint-scope
31187 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
31188 @item end-stepping-range
31189 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
31190 similar CLI command was accomplished.
31191 @item exited-signalled
31192 The inferior exited because of a signal.
31193 @item exited
31194 The inferior exited.
31195 @item exited-normally
31196 The inferior exited normally.
31197 @item signal-received
31198 A signal was received by the inferior.
31199 @item solib-event
31200 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
31201 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
31202 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
31203 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
31204 @item fork
31205 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
31206 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
31207 @item vfork
31208 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
31209 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
31210 @item syscall-entry
31211 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
31212 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
31213 @item syscall-return
31214 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
31215 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
31216 @item exec
31217 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
31218 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
31219 @item no-history
31220 There isn't enough history recorded to continue reverse execution.
31221 @end table
31222
31223 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
31224 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
31225 Depending on whether all-stop
31226 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
31227 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
31228 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
31229 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
31230 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
31231 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
31232 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
31233 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
31234 if such information is not available.
31235
31236 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
31237 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
31238 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
31239 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
31240 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
31241 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
31242 cannot be used in any way.
31243
31244 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
31245 A thread group became associated with a running program,
31246 either because the program was just started or the thread group
31247 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
31248 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
31249 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
31250
31251 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
31252 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
31253 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
31254 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
31255 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
31256 only when the inferior exited with some code.
31257
31258 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
31259 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
31260 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
31261 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
31262 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
31263
31264 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
31265 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
31266 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
31267 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
31268 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
31269 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
31270 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
31271 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
31272 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
31273
31274 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
31275 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
31276
31277 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
31278 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
31279 that thread.
31280
31281 @item =library-loaded,...
31282 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
31283 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
31284 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
31285 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
31286 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
31287 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
31288 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
31289 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
31290 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
31291 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
31292 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
31293 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
31294 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
31295 to this library.
31296
31297 @item =library-unloaded,...
31298 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
31299 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
31300 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31301 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
31302 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
31303 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
31304 thread groups.
31305
31306 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
31307 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
31308 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
31309 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
31310 frame is @var{tpnum}.
31311
31312 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
31313 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
31314 initial value @var{initial}.
31315
31316 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
31317 @itemx =tsv-deleted
31318 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
31319 trace state variables are deleted.
31320
31321 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
31322 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
31323 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
31324 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
31325 value of trace state variable is known.
31326
31327 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
31328 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
31329 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
31330 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
31331 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
31332 user.
31333
31334 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
31335 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
31336 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
31337
31338 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
31339 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
31340
31341 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
31342 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
31343 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
31344 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
31345 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
31346
31347 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
31348 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
31349 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
31350 for existing method and format values.
31351
31352 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
31353 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
31354 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
31355 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
31356 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
31357 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
31358
31359 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
31360 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
31361 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
31362 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
31363 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
31364 executable code.
31365 @end table
31366
31367 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
31368 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
31369
31370 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
31371 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
31372 following fields:
31373
31374 @table @code
31375 @item number
31376 The breakpoint number.
31377
31378 @item type
31379 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
31380 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
31381
31382 @item catch-type
31383 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
31384 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
31385
31386 @item disp
31387 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
31388 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
31389 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
31390
31391 @item enabled
31392 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
31393 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
31394 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
31395
31396 @item addr
31397 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
31398 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
31399 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
31400 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
31401 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
31402
31403 @item addr_flags
31404 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
31405 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
31406 particular CPU.
31407
31408 @item func
31409 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
31410 If not known, this field is not present.
31411
31412 @item filename
31413 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
31414 If not known, this field is not present.
31415
31416 @item fullname
31417 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
31418 known. If not known, this field is not present.
31419
31420 @item line
31421 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
31422 If not known, this field is not present.
31423
31424 @item at
31425 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
31426 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
31427 by a symbol name.
31428
31429 @item pending
31430 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
31431 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
31432
31433 @item evaluated-by
31434 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
31435 @samp{target}.
31436
31437 @item thread
31438 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
31439 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
31440
31441 @item task
31442 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
31443 field will hold the task identifier.
31444
31445 @item cond
31446 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
31447
31448 @item ignore
31449 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
31450
31451 @item enable
31452 The enable count of the breakpoint.
31453
31454 @item traceframe-usage
31455 FIXME.
31456
31457 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
31458 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
31459
31460 @item mask
31461 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
31462
31463 @item pass
31464 A tracepoint's pass count.
31465
31466 @item original-location
31467 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
31468 This field is optional.
31469
31470 @item times
31471 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
31472
31473 @item installed
31474 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
31475 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
31476 is not.
31477
31478 @item what
31479 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
31480
31481 @item locations
31482 This field is present if the breakpoint has multiple locations. It is also
31483 exceptionally present if the breakpoint is enabled and has a single, disabled
31484 location.
31485
31486 The value is a list of locations. The format of a location is described below.
31487
31488 @end table
31489
31490 A location in a multi-location breakpoint is represented as a tuple with the
31491 following fields:
31492
31493 @table @code
31494
31495 @item number
31496 The location number as a dotted pair, like @samp{1.2}. The first digit is the
31497 number of the parent breakpoint. The second digit is the number of the
31498 location within that breakpoint.
31499
31500 @item enabled
31501 There are three possible values, with the following meanings:
31502 @table @code
31503 @item y
31504 The location is enabled.
31505 @item n
31506 The location is disabled by the user.
31507 @item N
31508 The location is disabled because the breakpoint condition is invalid
31509 at this location.
31510 @end table
31511
31512 @item addr
31513 The address of this location as an hexidecimal number.
31514
31515 @item addr_flags
31516 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
31517 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
31518 particular CPU.
31519
31520 @item func
31521 If known, the function in which the location appears.
31522 If not known, this field is not present.
31523
31524 @item file
31525 The name of the source file which contains this location, if known.
31526 If not known, this field is not present.
31527
31528 @item fullname
31529 The full file name of the source file which contains this location, if
31530 known. If not known, this field is not present.
31531
31532 @item line
31533 The line number at which this location appears, if known.
31534 If not known, this field is not present.
31535
31536 @item thread-groups
31537 The thread groups this location is in.
31538
31539 @end table
31540
31541 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
31542 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
31543
31544 @smallexample
31545 -> -break-insert main
31546 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
31547 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31548 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
31549 times="0"@}
31550 <- (gdb)
31551 @end smallexample
31552
31553 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
31554 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
31555
31556 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
31557 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
31558 fields:
31559
31560 @table @code
31561 @item level
31562 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
31563 zero. This field is always present.
31564
31565 @item func
31566 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
31567 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
31568
31569 @item addr
31570 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
31571
31572 @item addr_flags
31573 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
31574 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
31575 particular CPU.
31576
31577 @item file
31578 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
31579 address. This field may be absent.
31580
31581 @item line
31582 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
31583 may be absent.
31584
31585 @item from
31586 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
31587 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
31588
31589 @end table
31590
31591 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
31592 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
31593
31594 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
31595 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
31596 stated otherwise.
31597
31598 @table @code
31599 @item id
31600 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
31601
31602 @item target-id
31603 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
31604
31605 @item details
31606 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
31607 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
31608 frontend. This field is optional.
31609
31610 @item name
31611 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
31612 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
31613 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
31614 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
31615 field is omitted.
31616
31617 @item state
31618 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
31619 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
31620
31621 @item frame
31622 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
31623 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
31624 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
31625
31626 @item core
31627 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
31628 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
31629 @end table
31630
31631 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
31632 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
31633
31634 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
31635 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
31636 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
31637 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
31638 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
31639 the @code{exception-message} field.
31640
31641 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31642 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
31643 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
31644 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
31645
31646 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
31647 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
31648 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
31649 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
31650
31651 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
31652 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
31653
31654 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
31655
31656 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
31657 information of the breakpoint.
31658
31659 @smallexample
31660 -> -break-insert main
31661 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
31662 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31663 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
31664 times="0"@}
31665 <- (gdb)
31666 @end smallexample
31667
31668 @subheading Program Execution
31669
31670 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
31671 reason that execution stopped.
31672
31673 @smallexample
31674 -> -exec-run
31675 <- ^running
31676 <- (gdb)
31677 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31678 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
31679 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
31680 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
31681 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31682 <- (gdb)
31683 -> -exec-continue
31684 <- ^running
31685 <- (gdb)
31686 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
31687 <- (gdb)
31688 @end smallexample
31689
31690 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
31691
31692 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
31693
31694 @smallexample
31695 -> (gdb)
31696 <- -gdb-exit
31697 <- ^exit
31698 @end smallexample
31699
31700 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
31701 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
31702 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
31703 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
31704 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
31705 fails to exit in reasonable time.
31706
31707 @subheading A Bad Command
31708
31709 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
31710
31711 @smallexample
31712 -> -rubbish
31713 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
31714 <- (gdb)
31715 @end smallexample
31716
31717
31718 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31719 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
31720 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
31721
31722 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
31723 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
31724
31725 @subheading Motivation
31726
31727 The motivation for this collection of commands.
31728
31729 @subheading Introduction
31730
31731 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
31732
31733 @subheading Commands
31734
31735 For each command in the block, the following is described:
31736
31737 @subsubheading Synopsis
31738
31739 @smallexample
31740 -command @var{args}@dots{}
31741 @end smallexample
31742
31743 @subsubheading Result
31744
31745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31746
31747 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
31748
31749 @subsubheading Example
31750
31751 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
31752 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
31753
31754
31755 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31756 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
31757 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
31758
31759 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
31760 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
31761 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
31762 breakpoints.
31763
31764 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
31765 @findex -break-after
31766
31767 @subsubheading Synopsis
31768
31769 @smallexample
31770 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
31771 @end smallexample
31772
31773 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
31774 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
31775 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
31776 @samp{-break-list} command below.
31777
31778 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31779
31780 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
31781
31782 @subsubheading Example
31783
31784 @smallexample
31785 (gdb)
31786 -break-insert main
31787 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
31788 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
31789 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
31790 times="0"@}
31791 (gdb)
31792 -break-after 1 3
31793 ~
31794 ^done
31795 (gdb)
31796 -break-list
31797 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
31798 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
31799 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
31800 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
31801 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
31802 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
31803 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
31804 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31805 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
31806 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
31807 (gdb)
31808 @end smallexample
31809
31810 @ignore
31811 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
31812 @findex -break-catch
31813 @end ignore
31814
31815 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
31816 @findex -break-commands
31817
31818 @subsubheading Synopsis
31819
31820 @smallexample
31821 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
31822 @end smallexample
31823
31824 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
31825 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
31826 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
31827 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
31828 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
31829 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
31830
31831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31832
31833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
31834
31835 @subsubheading Example
31836
31837 @smallexample
31838 (gdb)
31839 -break-insert main
31840 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
31841 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
31842 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
31843 times="0"@}
31844 (gdb)
31845 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
31846 ^done
31847 (gdb)
31848 @end smallexample
31849
31850 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
31851 @findex -break-condition
31852
31853 @subsubheading Synopsis
31854
31855 @smallexample
31856 -break-condition [ --force ] @var{number} [ @var{expr} ]
31857 @end smallexample
31858
31859 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
31860 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
31861 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
31862 command below). If the @samp{--force} flag is passed, the condition
31863 is forcibly defined even when it is invalid for all locations of
31864 breakpoint @var{number}. If the @var{expr} argument is omitted,
31865 breakpoint @var{number} becomes unconditional.
31866
31867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31868
31869 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
31870
31871 @subsubheading Example
31872
31873 @smallexample
31874 (gdb)
31875 -break-condition 1 1
31876 ^done
31877 (gdb)
31878 -break-list
31879 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
31880 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
31881 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
31882 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
31883 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
31884 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
31885 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
31886 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31887 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
31888 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
31889 (gdb)
31890 @end smallexample
31891
31892 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
31893 @findex -break-delete
31894
31895 @subsubheading Synopsis
31896
31897 @smallexample
31898 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
31899 @end smallexample
31900
31901 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
31902 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
31903
31904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31905
31906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
31907
31908 @subsubheading Example
31909
31910 @smallexample
31911 (gdb)
31912 -break-delete 1
31913 ^done
31914 (gdb)
31915 -break-list
31916 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
31917 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
31918 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
31919 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
31920 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
31921 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
31922 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
31923 body=[]@}
31924 (gdb)
31925 @end smallexample
31926
31927 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
31928 @findex -break-disable
31929
31930 @subsubheading Synopsis
31931
31932 @smallexample
31933 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
31934 @end smallexample
31935
31936 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
31937 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
31938
31939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31940
31941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
31942
31943 @subsubheading Example
31944
31945 @smallexample
31946 (gdb)
31947 -break-disable 2
31948 ^done
31949 (gdb)
31950 -break-list
31951 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
31952 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
31953 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
31954 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
31955 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
31956 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
31957 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
31958 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
31959 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
31960 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
31961 (gdb)
31962 @end smallexample
31963
31964 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
31965 @findex -break-enable
31966
31967 @subsubheading Synopsis
31968
31969 @smallexample
31970 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
31971 @end smallexample
31972
31973 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
31974
31975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31976
31977 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
31978
31979 @subsubheading Example
31980
31981 @smallexample
31982 (gdb)
31983 -break-enable 2
31984 ^done
31985 (gdb)
31986 -break-list
31987 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
31988 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
31989 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
31990 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
31991 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
31992 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
31993 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
31994 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31995 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
31996 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
31997 (gdb)
31998 @end smallexample
31999
32000 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
32001 @findex -break-info
32002
32003 @subsubheading Synopsis
32004
32005 @smallexample
32006 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
32007 @end smallexample
32008
32009 @c REDUNDANT???
32010 Get information about a single breakpoint.
32011
32012 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
32013 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
32014 table.
32015
32016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32017
32018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
32019
32020 @subsubheading Example
32021 N.A.
32022
32023 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
32024 @findex -break-insert
32025 @anchor{-break-insert}
32026
32027 @subsubheading Synopsis
32028
32029 @smallexample
32030 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ] [ --qualified ]
32031 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ --force-condition ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
32032 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{locspec} ]
32033 @end smallexample
32034
32035 @noindent
32036 If specified, @var{locspec}, can be one of:
32037
32038 @table @var
32039 @item linespec location
32040 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
32041
32042 @item explicit location
32043 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
32044 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
32045 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
32046
32047 @table @samp
32048 @item --source @var{filename}
32049 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
32050 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
32051
32052 @item --function @var{function}
32053 The name of a function or method.
32054
32055 @item --label @var{label}
32056 The name of a label.
32057
32058 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
32059 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
32060 @end table
32061
32062 @item address location
32063 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
32064 @end table
32065
32066 @noindent
32067 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
32068
32069 @table @samp
32070 @item -t
32071 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
32072 @item -h
32073 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
32074 @item -f
32075 If @var{locspec} cannot be resolved (for example if it
32076 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
32077 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
32078 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{locspec}
32079 cannot be parsed.
32080 @item -d
32081 Create a disabled breakpoint.
32082 @item -a
32083 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
32084 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
32085 @item -c @var{condition}
32086 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
32087 @item --force-condition
32088 Forcibly define the breakpoint even if the condition is invalid at
32089 all of the breakpoint locations.
32090 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
32091 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
32092 @item -p @var{thread-id}
32093 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
32094 @var{thread-id}.
32095 @item --qualified
32096 This option makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified as
32097 a complete fully-qualified name.
32098 @end table
32099
32100 @subsubheading Result
32101
32102 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
32103 resulting breakpoint.
32104
32105 Note: this format is open to change.
32106 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
32107
32108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32109
32110 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
32111 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
32112
32113 @subsubheading Example
32114
32115 @smallexample
32116 (gdb)
32117 -break-insert main
32118 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
32119 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
32120 times="0"@}
32121 (gdb)
32122 -break-insert -t foo
32123 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
32124 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
32125 times="0"@}
32126 (gdb)
32127 -break-list
32128 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
32129 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
32130 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
32131 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
32132 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
32133 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
32134 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
32135 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32136 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
32137 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
32138 times="0"@},
32139 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
32140 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
32141 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
32142 times="0"@}]@}
32143 (gdb)
32144 @end smallexample
32145
32146 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
32147 @findex -dprintf-insert
32148
32149 @subsubheading Synopsis
32150
32151 @smallexample
32152 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ --qualified ]
32153 [ -c @var{condition} ] [--force-condition] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
32154 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{locspec} ] [ @var{format} ]
32155 [ @var{argument} ]
32156 @end smallexample
32157
32158 @noindent
32159 If supplied, @var{locspec} and @code{--qualified} may be specified
32160 the same way as for the @code{-break-insert} command.
32161 @xref{-break-insert}.
32162
32163 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
32164
32165 @table @samp
32166 @item -t
32167 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
32168 @item -f
32169 If @var{locspec} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
32170 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
32171 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
32172 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{locspec}
32173 cannot be parsed.
32174 @item -d
32175 Create a disabled breakpoint.
32176 @item -c @var{condition}
32177 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
32178 @item --force-condition
32179 Forcibly define the breakpoint even if the condition is invalid at
32180 all of the breakpoint locations.
32181 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
32182 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
32183 to @var{ignore-count}.
32184 @item -p @var{thread-id}
32185 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
32186 @var{thread-id}.
32187 @end table
32188
32189 @subsubheading Result
32190
32191 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
32192 resulting breakpoint.
32193
32194 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
32195
32196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32197
32198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
32199
32200 @subsubheading Example
32201
32202 @smallexample
32203 (gdb)
32204 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
32205 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32206 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
32207 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
32208 times="0",script=["printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"],
32209 original-location="foo"@}
32210 (gdb)
32211 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
32212 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32213 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
32214 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
32215 times="0",script=["printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"],
32216 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
32217 (gdb)
32218 @end smallexample
32219
32220 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
32221 @findex -break-list
32222
32223 @subsubheading Synopsis
32224
32225 @smallexample
32226 -break-list
32227 @end smallexample
32228
32229 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
32230
32231 @table @samp
32232 @item Number
32233 number of the breakpoint
32234 @item Type
32235 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
32236 @item Disposition
32237 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
32238 or @samp{nokeep}
32239 @item Enabled
32240 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
32241 @item Address
32242 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
32243 @item What
32244 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
32245 name, line number
32246 @item Thread-groups
32247 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
32248 @item Times
32249 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
32250 @end table
32251
32252 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
32253 @code{body} field is an empty list.
32254
32255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32256
32257 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
32258
32259 @subsubheading Example
32260
32261 @smallexample
32262 (gdb)
32263 -break-list
32264 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
32265 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
32266 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
32267 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
32268 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
32269 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
32270 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
32271 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32272 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
32273 times="0"@},
32274 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32275 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
32276 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
32277 (gdb)
32278 @end smallexample
32279
32280 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
32281
32282 @smallexample
32283 (gdb)
32284 -break-list
32285 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
32286 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
32287 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
32288 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
32289 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
32290 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
32291 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
32292 body=[]@}
32293 (gdb)
32294 @end smallexample
32295
32296 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
32297 @findex -break-passcount
32298
32299 @subsubheading Synopsis
32300
32301 @smallexample
32302 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
32303 @end smallexample
32304
32305 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
32306 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
32307 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
32308 command @samp{passcount}.
32309
32310 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
32311 @findex -break-watch
32312
32313 @subsubheading Synopsis
32314
32315 @smallexample
32316 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
32317 @end smallexample
32318
32319 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
32320 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
32321 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
32322 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
32323 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
32324 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
32325 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
32326 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
32327
32328 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
32329 breakpoints inserted.
32330
32331 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32332
32333 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
32334 @samp{rwatch}.
32335
32336 @subsubheading Example
32337
32338 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
32339
32340 @smallexample
32341 (gdb)
32342 -break-watch x
32343 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
32344 (gdb)
32345 -exec-continue
32346 ^running
32347 (gdb)
32348 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
32349 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
32350 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
32351 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
32352 (gdb)
32353 @end smallexample
32354
32355 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
32356 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
32357 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
32358
32359 @smallexample
32360 (gdb)
32361 -break-watch C
32362 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
32363 (gdb)
32364 -exec-continue
32365 ^running
32366 (gdb)
32367 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
32368 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
32369 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
32370 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32371 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
32372 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
32373 (gdb)
32374 -exec-continue
32375 ^running
32376 (gdb)
32377 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
32378 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
32379 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
32380 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32381 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
32382 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
32383 (gdb)
32384 @end smallexample
32385
32386 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
32387 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
32388 deleted.
32389
32390 @smallexample
32391 (gdb)
32392 -break-watch C
32393 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
32394 (gdb)
32395 -break-list
32396 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
32397 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
32398 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
32399 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
32400 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
32401 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
32402 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
32403 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32404 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
32405 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32406 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
32407 times="1"@},
32408 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
32409 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
32410 (gdb)
32411 -exec-continue
32412 ^running
32413 (gdb)
32414 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
32415 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
32416 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
32417 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32418 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
32419 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
32420 (gdb)
32421 -break-list
32422 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
32423 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
32424 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
32425 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
32426 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
32427 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
32428 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
32429 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32430 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
32431 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32432 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
32433 times="1"@},
32434 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
32435 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
32436 (gdb)
32437 -exec-continue
32438 ^running
32439 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
32440 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
32441 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
32442 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32443 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
32444 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
32445 (gdb)
32446 -break-list
32447 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
32448 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
32449 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
32450 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
32451 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
32452 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
32453 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
32454 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32455 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
32456 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32457 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
32458 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
32459 (gdb)
32460 @end smallexample
32461
32462
32463 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32464 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
32465 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
32466
32467 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
32468 catchpoints.
32469
32470 @menu
32471 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
32472 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
32473 * C++ Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
32474 @end menu
32475
32476 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
32477 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
32478
32479 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
32480 @findex -catch-load
32481
32482 @subsubheading Synopsis
32483
32484 @smallexample
32485 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
32486 @end smallexample
32487
32488 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
32489 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
32490 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
32491 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
32492 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
32493
32494
32495 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32496
32497 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
32498
32499 @subsubheading Example
32500
32501 @smallexample
32502 -catch-load -t foo.so
32503 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
32504 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
32505 (gdb)
32506 @end smallexample
32507
32508
32509 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
32510 @findex -catch-unload
32511
32512 @subsubheading Synopsis
32513
32514 @smallexample
32515 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
32516 @end smallexample
32517
32518 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
32519 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
32520 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
32521 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
32522 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
32523
32524 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32525
32526 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
32527
32528 @subsubheading Example
32529
32530 @smallexample
32531 -catch-unload -d bar.so
32532 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
32533 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
32534 (gdb)
32535 @end smallexample
32536
32537 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
32538 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
32539
32540 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
32541 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
32542
32543 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
32544 @findex -catch-assert
32545
32546 @subsubheading Synopsis
32547
32548 @smallexample
32549 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
32550 @end smallexample
32551
32552 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
32553
32554 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
32555
32556 @table @samp
32557 @item -c @var{condition}
32558 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
32559 @item -d
32560 Create a disabled catchpoint.
32561 @item -t
32562 Create a temporary catchpoint.
32563 @end table
32564
32565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32566
32567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
32568
32569 @subsubheading Example
32570
32571 @smallexample
32572 -catch-assert
32573 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
32574 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
32575 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
32576 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
32577 (gdb)
32578 @end smallexample
32579
32580 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
32581 @findex -catch-exception
32582
32583 @subsubheading Synopsis
32584
32585 @smallexample
32586 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
32587 [ -t ] [ -u ]
32588 @end smallexample
32589
32590 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
32591 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
32592 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
32593 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
32594 catchpoints.
32595
32596 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
32597
32598 @table @samp
32599 @item -c @var{condition}
32600 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
32601 @item -d
32602 Create a disabled catchpoint.
32603 @item -e @var{exception-name}
32604 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
32605 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
32606 @item -t
32607 Create a temporary catchpoint.
32608 @item -u
32609 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
32610 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
32611 @end table
32612
32613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32614
32615 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
32616 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
32617
32618 @subsubheading Example
32619
32620 @smallexample
32621 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
32622 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
32623 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
32624 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
32625 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
32626 (gdb)
32627 @end smallexample
32628
32629 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
32630 @findex -catch-handlers
32631
32632 @subsubheading Synopsis
32633
32634 @smallexample
32635 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
32636 [ -t ]
32637 @end smallexample
32638
32639 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
32640 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
32641 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
32642 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
32643 catchpoints.
32644
32645 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
32646
32647 @table @samp
32648 @item -c @var{condition}
32649 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
32650 @item -d
32651 Create a disabled catchpoint.
32652 @item -e @var{exception-name}
32653 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
32654 @item -t
32655 Create a temporary catchpoint.
32656 @end table
32657
32658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32659
32660 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
32661
32662 @subsubheading Example
32663
32664 @smallexample
32665 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
32666 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
32667 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
32668 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
32669 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
32670 (gdb)
32671 @end smallexample
32672
32673 @node C++ Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
32674 @subsection C@t{++} Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
32675
32676 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
32677 that stop the execution when C@t{++} exceptions are being throw, rethrown,
32678 or caught.
32679
32680 @subheading The @code{-catch-throw} Command
32681 @findex -catch-throw
32682
32683 @subsubheading Synopsis
32684
32685 @smallexample
32686 -catch-throw [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
32687 @end smallexample
32688
32689 Stop when the debuggee throws a C@t{++} exception. If @var{regexp} is
32690 given, then only exceptions whose type matches the regular expression
32691 will be caught.
32692
32693 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
32694 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after stopping once for
32695 the event.
32696
32697 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32698
32699 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch throw}
32700 and @samp{tcatch throw} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
32701
32702 @subsubheading Example
32703
32704 @smallexample
32705 -catch-throw -r exception_type
32706 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32707 what="exception throw",catch-type="throw",
32708 thread-groups=["i1"],
32709 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
32710 (gdb)
32711 -exec-run
32712 ^running
32713 (gdb)
32714 ~"\n"
32715 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception thrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
32716 in __cxa_throw () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
32717 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
32718 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_throw",
32719 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
32720 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
32721 (gdb)
32722 @end smallexample
32723
32724 @subheading The @code{-catch-rethrow} Command
32725 @findex -catch-rethrow
32726
32727 @subsubheading Synopsis
32728
32729 @smallexample
32730 -catch-rethrow [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
32731 @end smallexample
32732
32733 Stop when a C@t{++} exception is re-thrown. If @var{regexp} is given,
32734 then only exceptions whose type matches the regular expression will be
32735 caught.
32736
32737 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
32738 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after the first event is
32739 caught.
32740
32741 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32742
32743 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch rethrow}
32744 and @samp{tcatch rethrow} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
32745
32746 @subsubheading Example
32747
32748 @smallexample
32749 -catch-rethrow -r exception_type
32750 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32751 what="exception rethrow",catch-type="rethrow",
32752 thread-groups=["i1"],
32753 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
32754 (gdb)
32755 -exec-run
32756 ^running
32757 (gdb)
32758 ~"\n"
32759 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception rethrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
32760 in __cxa_rethrow () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
32761 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
32762 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_rethrow",
32763 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
32764 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
32765 (gdb)
32766 @end smallexample
32767
32768 @subheading The @code{-catch-catch} Command
32769 @findex -catch-catch
32770
32771 @subsubheading Synopsis
32772
32773 @smallexample
32774 -catch-catch [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
32775 @end smallexample
32776
32777 Stop when the debuggee catches a C@t{++} exception. If @var{regexp}
32778 is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the regular
32779 expression will be caught.
32780
32781 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
32782 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after the first event is
32783 caught.
32784
32785 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32786
32787 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch catch}
32788 and @samp{tcatch catch} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
32789
32790 @subsubheading Example
32791
32792 @smallexample
32793 -catch-catch -r exception_type
32794 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32795 what="exception catch",catch-type="catch",
32796 thread-groups=["i1"],
32797 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
32798 (gdb)
32799 -exec-run
32800 ^running
32801 (gdb)
32802 ~"\n"
32803 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception caught), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
32804 in __cxa_begin_catch () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
32805 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
32806 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_begin_catch",
32807 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
32808 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
32809 (gdb)
32810 @end smallexample
32811
32812 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32813 @node GDB/MI Program Context
32814 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
32815
32816 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
32817 @findex -exec-arguments
32818
32819
32820 @subsubheading Synopsis
32821
32822 @smallexample
32823 -exec-arguments @var{args}
32824 @end smallexample
32825
32826 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
32827 @samp{-exec-run}.
32828
32829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32830
32831 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
32832
32833 @subsubheading Example
32834
32835 @smallexample
32836 (gdb)
32837 -exec-arguments -v word
32838 ^done
32839 (gdb)
32840 @end smallexample
32841
32842
32843 @ignore
32844 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
32845 @findex -exec-show-arguments
32846
32847 @subsubheading Synopsis
32848
32849 @smallexample
32850 -exec-show-arguments
32851 @end smallexample
32852
32853 Print the arguments of the program.
32854
32855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32856
32857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
32858
32859 @subsubheading Example
32860 N.A.
32861 @end ignore
32862
32863
32864 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
32865 @findex -environment-cd
32866
32867 @subsubheading Synopsis
32868
32869 @smallexample
32870 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
32871 @end smallexample
32872
32873 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
32874
32875 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32876
32877 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
32878
32879 @subsubheading Example
32880
32881 @smallexample
32882 (gdb)
32883 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
32884 ^done
32885 (gdb)
32886 @end smallexample
32887
32888
32889 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
32890 @findex -environment-directory
32891
32892 @subsubheading Synopsis
32893
32894 @smallexample
32895 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
32896 @end smallexample
32897
32898 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
32899 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
32900 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
32901 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
32902 occurs as normal.
32903 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
32904 multiple directories in a single command
32905 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
32906 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
32907 If blanks are needed as
32908 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
32909 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
32910 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
32911 character must not be used
32912 in any directory name.
32913 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
32914
32915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32916
32917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
32918
32919 @subsubheading Example
32920
32921 @smallexample
32922 (gdb)
32923 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
32924 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
32925 (gdb)
32926 -environment-directory ""
32927 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
32928 (gdb)
32929 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
32930 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
32931 (gdb)
32932 -environment-directory -r
32933 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
32934 (gdb)
32935 @end smallexample
32936
32937
32938 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
32939 @findex -environment-path
32940
32941 @subsubheading Synopsis
32942
32943 @smallexample
32944 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
32945 @end smallexample
32946
32947 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
32948 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
32949 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
32950 supplied in addition to the
32951 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
32952 occurs as normal.
32953 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
32954 multiple directories in a single command
32955 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
32956 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
32957 If blanks are needed as
32958 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
32959 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
32960 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
32961 character must not be used
32962 in any directory name.
32963 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
32964
32965
32966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32967
32968 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
32969
32970 @subsubheading Example
32971
32972 @smallexample
32973 (gdb)
32974 -environment-path
32975 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
32976 (gdb)
32977 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
32978 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
32979 (gdb)
32980 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
32981 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
32982 (gdb)
32983 @end smallexample
32984
32985
32986 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
32987 @findex -environment-pwd
32988
32989 @subsubheading Synopsis
32990
32991 @smallexample
32992 -environment-pwd
32993 @end smallexample
32994
32995 Show the current working directory.
32996
32997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32998
32999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
33000
33001 @subsubheading Example
33002
33003 @smallexample
33004 (gdb)
33005 -environment-pwd
33006 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
33007 (gdb)
33008 @end smallexample
33009
33010 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33011 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
33012 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
33013
33014
33015 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
33016 @findex -thread-info
33017
33018 @subsubheading Synopsis
33019
33020 @smallexample
33021 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
33022 @end smallexample
33023
33024 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
33025 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
33026 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
33027 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
33028 current thread.
33029
33030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33031
33032 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
33033 about all threads.
33034
33035 @subsubheading Result
33036
33037 The result contains the following attributes:
33038
33039 @table @samp
33040 @item threads
33041 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
33042 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
33043
33044 @item current-thread-id
33045 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
33046 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
33047 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
33048 the command.
33049
33050 @end table
33051
33052 @subsubheading Example
33053
33054 @smallexample
33055 -thread-info
33056 ^done,threads=[
33057 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33058 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
33059 args=[]@},state="running"@},
33060 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33061 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
33062 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33063 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
33064 state="running"@}],
33065 current-thread-id="1"
33066 (gdb)
33067 @end smallexample
33068
33069 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
33070 @findex -thread-list-ids
33071
33072 @subsubheading Synopsis
33073
33074 @smallexample
33075 -thread-list-ids
33076 @end smallexample
33077
33078 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
33079 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
33080 threads.
33081
33082 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
33083 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
33084
33085 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33086
33087 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
33088
33089 @subsubheading Example
33090
33091 @smallexample
33092 (gdb)
33093 -thread-list-ids
33094 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
33095 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
33096 (gdb)
33097 @end smallexample
33098
33099
33100 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
33101 @findex -thread-select
33102
33103 @subsubheading Synopsis
33104
33105 @smallexample
33106 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
33107 @end smallexample
33108
33109 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
33110 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
33111 topmost frame for that thread.
33112
33113 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
33114 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
33115
33116 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33117
33118 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
33119
33120 @subsubheading Example
33121
33122 @smallexample
33123 (gdb)
33124 -exec-next
33125 ^running
33126 (gdb)
33127 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
33128 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
33129 (gdb)
33130 -thread-list-ids
33131 ^done,
33132 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
33133 number-of-threads="3"
33134 (gdb)
33135 -thread-select 3
33136 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
33137 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
33138 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
33139 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33140 (gdb)
33141 @end smallexample
33142
33143 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33144 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
33145 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
33146
33147 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
33148 @findex -ada-task-info
33149
33150 @subsubheading Synopsis
33151
33152 @smallexample
33153 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
33154 @end smallexample
33155
33156 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
33157 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
33158
33159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33160
33161 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
33162 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
33163
33164 @subsubheading Result
33165
33166 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
33167 defined for each Ada task:
33168
33169 @table @samp
33170 @item current
33171 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
33172
33173 @item id
33174 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
33175
33176 @item task-id
33177 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
33178
33179 @item thread-id
33180 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
33181 task.
33182
33183 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
33184 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
33185 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
33186
33187 @item parent-id
33188 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
33189 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
33190
33191 @item priority
33192 The base priority of the task.
33193
33194 @item state
33195 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
33196 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
33197
33198 @item name
33199 The name of the task.
33200
33201 @end table
33202
33203 @subsubheading Example
33204
33205 @smallexample
33206 -ada-task-info
33207 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
33208 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
33209 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
33210 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
33211 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
33212 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
33213 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
33214 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
33215 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
33216 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
33217 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
33218 (gdb)
33219 @end smallexample
33220
33221 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33222 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
33223 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
33224
33225 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
33226 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
33227 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
33228 other cases.
33229
33230 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
33231 @findex -exec-continue
33232
33233 @subsubheading Synopsis
33234
33235 @smallexample
33236 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
33237 @end smallexample
33238
33239 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
33240 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
33241 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
33242 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
33243 @itemize @bullet
33244 @item
33245 breakpoints or watchpoints
33246 @item
33247 signals or exceptions
33248 @item
33249 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
33250 @item
33251 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
33252 @end itemize
33253 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
33254 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
33255 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
33256 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
33257 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
33258 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
33259
33260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33261
33262 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
33263
33264 @subsubheading Example
33265
33266 @smallexample
33267 -exec-continue
33268 ^running
33269 (gdb)
33270 @@Hello world
33271 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
33272 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
33273 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33274 (gdb)
33275 @end smallexample
33276
33277 For a @samp{breakpoint-hit} stopped reason, when the breakpoint
33278 encountered has multiple locations, the field @samp{bkptno} is
33279 followed by the field @samp{locno}.
33280
33281 @smallexample
33282 -exec-continue
33283 ^running
33284 (gdb)
33285 @@Hello world
33286 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",locno="3",frame=@{
33287 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
33288 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33289 (gdb)
33290 @end smallexample
33291
33292 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
33293 @findex -exec-finish
33294
33295 @subsubheading Synopsis
33296
33297 @smallexample
33298 -exec-finish [--reverse]
33299 @end smallexample
33300
33301 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
33302 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
33303 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
33304 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
33305 function was called.
33306
33307 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33308
33309 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
33310
33311 @subsubheading Example
33312
33313 Function returning @code{void}.
33314
33315 @smallexample
33316 -exec-finish
33317 ^running
33318 (gdb)
33319 @@hello from foo
33320 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
33321 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33322 (gdb)
33323 @end smallexample
33324
33325 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
33326 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
33327 value itself.
33328
33329 @smallexample
33330 -exec-finish
33331 ^running
33332 (gdb)
33333 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
33334 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
33335 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
33336 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
33337 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
33338 (gdb)
33339 @end smallexample
33340
33341
33342 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
33343 @findex -exec-interrupt
33344
33345 @subsubheading Synopsis
33346
33347 @smallexample
33348 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
33349 @end smallexample
33350
33351 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
33352 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
33353 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
33354 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
33355 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
33356
33357 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
33358 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
33359 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
33360 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
33361
33362 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
33363 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
33364 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
33365 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
33366
33367 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33368
33369 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
33370
33371 @subsubheading Example
33372
33373 @smallexample
33374 (gdb)
33375 111-exec-continue
33376 111^running
33377
33378 (gdb)
33379 222-exec-interrupt
33380 222^done
33381 (gdb)
33382 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
33383 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
33384 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33385 (gdb)
33386
33387 (gdb)
33388 -exec-interrupt
33389 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
33390 (gdb)
33391 @end smallexample
33392
33393 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
33394 @findex -exec-jump
33395
33396 @subsubheading Synopsis
33397
33398 @smallexample
33399 -exec-jump @var{locspec}
33400 @end smallexample
33401
33402 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the address to
33403 which @var{locspec} resolves. @xref{Location Specifications},
33404 for a description of the different forms of @var{locspec}.
33405
33406 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33407
33408 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
33409
33410 @subsubheading Example
33411
33412 @smallexample
33413 -exec-jump foo.c:10
33414 *running,thread-id="all"
33415 ^running
33416 @end smallexample
33417
33418
33419 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
33420 @findex -exec-next
33421
33422 @subsubheading Synopsis
33423
33424 @smallexample
33425 -exec-next [--reverse]
33426 @end smallexample
33427
33428 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
33429 of the next source line is reached.
33430
33431 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
33432 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
33433 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
33434 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
33435 source line where the function was called.
33436
33437
33438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33439
33440 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
33441
33442 @subsubheading Example
33443
33444 @smallexample
33445 -exec-next
33446 ^running
33447 (gdb)
33448 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
33449 (gdb)
33450 @end smallexample
33451
33452
33453 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
33454 @findex -exec-next-instruction
33455
33456 @subsubheading Synopsis
33457
33458 @smallexample
33459 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
33460 @end smallexample
33461
33462 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
33463 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
33464 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
33465 printed as well.
33466
33467 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
33468 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
33469 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
33470 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
33471 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
33472
33473 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33474
33475 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
33476
33477 @subsubheading Example
33478
33479 @smallexample
33480 (gdb)
33481 -exec-next-instruction
33482 ^running
33483
33484 (gdb)
33485 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
33486 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
33487 (gdb)
33488 @end smallexample
33489
33490
33491 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
33492 @findex -exec-return
33493
33494 @subsubheading Synopsis
33495
33496 @smallexample
33497 -exec-return
33498 @end smallexample
33499
33500 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
33501 Displays the new current frame.
33502
33503 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33504
33505 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
33506
33507 @subsubheading Example
33508
33509 @smallexample
33510 (gdb)
33511 200-break-insert callee4
33512 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
33513 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
33514 (gdb)
33515 000-exec-run
33516 000^running
33517 (gdb)
33518 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
33519 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
33520 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33521 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
33522 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33523 (gdb)
33524 205-break-delete
33525 205^done
33526 (gdb)
33527 111-exec-return
33528 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
33529 args=[@{name="strarg",
33530 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
33531 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33532 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
33533 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33534 (gdb)
33535 @end smallexample
33536
33537
33538 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
33539 @findex -exec-run
33540
33541 @subsubheading Synopsis
33542
33543 @smallexample
33544 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
33545 @end smallexample
33546
33547 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
33548 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
33549 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
33550 the program has exited exceptionally.
33551
33552 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
33553 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
33554 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
33555 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
33556 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
33557
33558 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
33559 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
33560 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
33561 (@pxref{Starting}).
33562
33563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33564
33565 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
33566
33567 @subsubheading Examples
33568
33569 @smallexample
33570 (gdb)
33571 -break-insert main
33572 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
33573 (gdb)
33574 -exec-run
33575 ^running
33576 (gdb)
33577 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
33578 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
33579 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33580 (gdb)
33581 @end smallexample
33582
33583 @noindent
33584 Program exited normally:
33585
33586 @smallexample
33587 (gdb)
33588 -exec-run
33589 ^running
33590 (gdb)
33591 x = 55
33592 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
33593 (gdb)
33594 @end smallexample
33595
33596 @noindent
33597 Program exited exceptionally:
33598
33599 @smallexample
33600 (gdb)
33601 -exec-run
33602 ^running
33603 (gdb)
33604 x = 55
33605 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
33606 (gdb)
33607 @end smallexample
33608
33609 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
33610 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
33611
33612 @smallexample
33613 (gdb)
33614 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
33615 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
33616 @end smallexample
33617
33618
33619 @c @subheading -exec-signal
33620
33621
33622 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
33623 @findex -exec-step
33624
33625 @subsubheading Synopsis
33626
33627 @smallexample
33628 -exec-step [--reverse]
33629 @end smallexample
33630
33631 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
33632 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
33633 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
33634 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
33635 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
33636 previously executed source line.
33637
33638 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33639
33640 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
33641
33642 @subsubheading Example
33643
33644 Stepping into a function:
33645
33646 @smallexample
33647 -exec-step
33648 ^running
33649 (gdb)
33650 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
33651 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
33652 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
33653 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33654 (gdb)
33655 @end smallexample
33656
33657 Regular stepping:
33658
33659 @smallexample
33660 -exec-step
33661 ^running
33662 (gdb)
33663 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
33664 (gdb)
33665 @end smallexample
33666
33667
33668 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
33669 @findex -exec-step-instruction
33670
33671 @subsubheading Synopsis
33672
33673 @smallexample
33674 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
33675 @end smallexample
33676
33677 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
33678 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
33679 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
33680 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
33681 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
33682 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
33683 as well.
33684
33685 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33686
33687 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
33688
33689 @subsubheading Example
33690
33691 @smallexample
33692 (gdb)
33693 -exec-step-instruction
33694 ^running
33695
33696 (gdb)
33697 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
33698 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
33699 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33700 (gdb)
33701 -exec-step-instruction
33702 ^running
33703
33704 (gdb)
33705 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
33706 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
33707 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33708 (gdb)
33709 @end smallexample
33710
33711
33712 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
33713 @findex -exec-until
33714
33715 @subsubheading Synopsis
33716
33717 @smallexample
33718 -exec-until [ @var{locspec} ]
33719 @end smallexample
33720
33721 Executes the inferior until it reaches the address to which
33722 @var{locspec} resolves. If there is no argument, the inferior
33723 executes until it reaches a source line greater than the current one.
33724 The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
33725
33726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33727
33728 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
33729
33730 @subsubheading Example
33731
33732 @smallexample
33733 (gdb)
33734 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
33735 ^running
33736 (gdb)
33737 x = 55
33738 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
33739 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
33740 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33741 (gdb)
33742 @end smallexample
33743
33744 @ignore
33745 @subheading -file-clear
33746 Is this going away????
33747 @end ignore
33748
33749 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33750 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
33751 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
33752
33753 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
33754 @findex -enable-frame-filters
33755
33756 @smallexample
33757 -enable-frame-filters
33758 @end smallexample
33759
33760 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
33761 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
33762 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
33763 request that this functionality be enabled.
33764
33765 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
33766
33767 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
33768 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
33769
33770 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
33771 @findex -stack-info-frame
33772
33773 @subsubheading Synopsis
33774
33775 @smallexample
33776 -stack-info-frame
33777 @end smallexample
33778
33779 Get info on the selected frame.
33780
33781 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33782
33783 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
33784 (without arguments).
33785
33786 @subsubheading Example
33787
33788 @smallexample
33789 (gdb)
33790 -stack-info-frame
33791 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
33792 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33793 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
33794 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33795 (gdb)
33796 @end smallexample
33797
33798 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
33799 @findex -stack-info-depth
33800
33801 @subsubheading Synopsis
33802
33803 @smallexample
33804 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
33805 @end smallexample
33806
33807 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
33808 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
33809
33810 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33811
33812 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33813
33814 @subsubheading Example
33815
33816 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
33817
33818 @smallexample
33819 (gdb)
33820 -stack-info-depth
33821 ^done,depth="12"
33822 (gdb)
33823 -stack-info-depth 4
33824 ^done,depth="4"
33825 (gdb)
33826 -stack-info-depth 12
33827 ^done,depth="12"
33828 (gdb)
33829 -stack-info-depth 11
33830 ^done,depth="11"
33831 (gdb)
33832 -stack-info-depth 13
33833 ^done,depth="12"
33834 (gdb)
33835 @end smallexample
33836
33837 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
33838 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
33839 @findex -stack-list-arguments
33840
33841 @subsubheading Synopsis
33842
33843 @smallexample
33844 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
33845 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
33846 @end smallexample
33847
33848 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
33849 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
33850 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
33851 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
33852 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
33853 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
33854 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
33855 which case only existing frames will be returned.
33856
33857 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
33858 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
33859 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
33860 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
33861 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
33862 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
33863
33864 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
33865 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
33866 are still displayed, however.
33867
33868 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
33869 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
33870
33871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33872
33873 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
33874 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
33875 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
33876
33877 @subsubheading Example
33878
33879 @smallexample
33880 (gdb)
33881 -stack-list-frames
33882 ^done,
33883 stack=[
33884 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
33885 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33886 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
33887 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
33888 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
33889 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33890 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
33891 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
33892 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
33893 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33894 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
33895 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
33896 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
33897 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33898 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
33899 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
33900 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
33901 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33902 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
33903 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
33904 (gdb)
33905 -stack-list-arguments 0
33906 ^done,
33907 stack-args=[
33908 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
33909 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
33910 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
33911 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
33912 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
33913 (gdb)
33914 -stack-list-arguments 1
33915 ^done,
33916 stack-args=[
33917 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
33918 frame=@{level="1",
33919 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
33920 frame=@{level="2",args=[
33921 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
33922 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
33923 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
33924 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
33925 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
33926 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
33927 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
33928 (gdb)
33929 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
33930 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
33931 (gdb)
33932 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
33933 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
33934 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
33935 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
33936 (gdb)
33937 @end smallexample
33938
33939 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
33940
33941
33942 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
33943 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
33944 @findex -stack-list-frames
33945
33946 @subsubheading Synopsis
33947
33948 @smallexample
33949 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
33950 @end smallexample
33951
33952 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
33953 following info:
33954
33955 @table @samp
33956 @item @var{level}
33957 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
33958 @item @var{addr}
33959 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
33960 @item @var{func}
33961 Function name.
33962 @item @var{file}
33963 File name of the source file where the function lives.
33964 @item @var{fullname}
33965 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
33966 @item @var{line}
33967 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
33968 @item @var{from}
33969 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
33970 if the frame's function is not known.
33971 @item @var{arch}
33972 Frame's architecture.
33973 @end table
33974
33975 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
33976 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
33977 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
33978 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
33979 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
33980 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
33981 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
33982 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
33983 Python frame filters will not be executed.
33984
33985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33986
33987 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
33988
33989 @subsubheading Example
33990
33991 Full stack backtrace:
33992
33993 @smallexample
33994 (gdb)
33995 -stack-list-frames
33996 ^done,stack=
33997 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
33998 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
33999 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34000 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34001 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34002 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34003 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34004 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34005 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34006 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34007 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34008 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34009 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34010 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34011 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34012 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34013 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34014 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34015 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34016 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34017 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34018 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34019 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34020 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34021 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34022 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34023 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34024 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34025 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34026 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34027 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34028 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34029 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34030 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
34031 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
34032 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
34033 (gdb)
34034 @end smallexample
34035
34036 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
34037
34038 @smallexample
34039 (gdb)
34040 -stack-list-frames 3 5
34041 ^done,stack=
34042 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34043 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34044 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34045 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34046 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34047 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
34048 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34049 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34050 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
34051 (gdb)
34052 @end smallexample
34053
34054 Show a single frame:
34055
34056 @smallexample
34057 (gdb)
34058 -stack-list-frames 3 3
34059 ^done,stack=
34060 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
34061 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
34062 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
34063 (gdb)
34064 @end smallexample
34065
34066
34067 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
34068 @findex -stack-list-locals
34069 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
34070
34071 @subsubheading Synopsis
34072
34073 @smallexample
34074 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
34075 @end smallexample
34076
34077 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
34078 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
34079 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
34080 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
34081 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
34082 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
34083 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
34084 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
34085 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
34086 Python frame filters will not be executed.
34087
34088 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
34089 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
34090 variables are still displayed, however.
34091
34092 This command is deprecated in favor of the
34093 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
34094
34095 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34096
34097 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
34098
34099 @subsubheading Example
34100
34101 @smallexample
34102 (gdb)
34103 -stack-list-locals 0
34104 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
34105 (gdb)
34106 -stack-list-locals --all-values
34107 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
34108 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
34109 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
34110 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
34111 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
34112 (gdb)
34113 @end smallexample
34114
34115 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
34116 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
34117 @findex -stack-list-variables
34118
34119 @subsubheading Synopsis
34120
34121 @smallexample
34122 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
34123 @end smallexample
34124
34125 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
34126 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
34127 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
34128 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
34129 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
34130 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
34131 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
34132
34133 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
34134 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
34135 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
34136
34137 @subsubheading Example
34138
34139 @smallexample
34140 (gdb)
34141 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
34142 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
34143 (gdb)
34144 @end smallexample
34145
34146
34147 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
34148 @findex -stack-select-frame
34149
34150 @subsubheading Synopsis
34151
34152 @smallexample
34153 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
34154 @end smallexample
34155
34156 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
34157 the stack.
34158
34159 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
34160 option to every command.
34161
34162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34163
34164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
34165 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
34166
34167 @subsubheading Example
34168
34169 @smallexample
34170 (gdb)
34171 -stack-select-frame 2
34172 ^done
34173 (gdb)
34174 @end smallexample
34175
34176 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34177 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
34178 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
34179
34180 @ignore
34181
34182 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
34183
34184 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
34185 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
34186 used by @code{Insight}.
34187
34188 The two main reasons for that are:
34189
34190 @enumerate 1
34191 @item
34192 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
34193
34194 @item
34195 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
34196 now).
34197 @end enumerate
34198
34199 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
34200 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
34201 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
34202 hints about their use.
34203
34204 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
34205 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
34206 least, the following operations:
34207
34208 @itemize @bullet
34209 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
34210 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
34211 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
34212 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
34213 @end itemize
34214
34215 @end ignore
34216
34217 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
34218
34219 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
34220
34221 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
34222 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
34223 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
34224 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
34225 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
34226 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
34227 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
34228 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
34229 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
34230 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
34231 object, or to change display format.
34232
34233 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
34234 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
34235 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
34236 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
34237 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
34238 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
34239 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
34240 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
34241 child will be created.
34242
34243 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
34244 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
34245 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
34246 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
34247 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
34248
34249 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
34250 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
34251 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
34252 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
34253 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
34254 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
34255 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
34256 variables that frontend has created.
34257
34258 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
34259 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
34260 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
34261 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
34262 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
34263 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
34264 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
34265 implicitly updated.
34266
34267 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
34268 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
34269 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
34270 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
34271 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
34272 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
34273 frame. Consider this example:
34274
34275 @smallexample
34276 void do_work(...)
34277 @{
34278 struct work_state state;
34279
34280 if (...)
34281 do_work(...);
34282 @}
34283 @end smallexample
34284
34285 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
34286 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
34287 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
34288 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
34289 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
34290
34291 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
34292 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
34293 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
34294 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
34295 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
34296 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
34297
34298 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
34299 access this functionality:
34300
34301 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
34302 @item @strong{Operation}
34303 @tab @strong{Description}
34304
34305 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
34306 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
34307 @item @code{-var-create}
34308 @tab create a variable object
34309 @item @code{-var-delete}
34310 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
34311 @item @code{-var-set-format}
34312 @tab set the display format of this variable
34313 @item @code{-var-show-format}
34314 @tab show the display format of this variable
34315 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
34316 @tab tells how many children this object has
34317 @item @code{-var-list-children}
34318 @tab return a list of the object's children
34319 @item @code{-var-info-type}
34320 @tab show the type of this variable object
34321 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
34322 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
34323 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
34324 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
34325 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
34326 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
34327 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
34328 @tab get the value of this variable
34329 @item @code{-var-assign}
34330 @tab set the value of this variable
34331 @item @code{-var-update}
34332 @tab update the variable and its children
34333 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
34334 @tab set frozenness attribute
34335 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
34336 @tab set range of children to display on update
34337 @end multitable
34338
34339 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
34340 how it can be used.
34341
34342 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
34343
34344 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
34345 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
34346
34347 @smallexample
34348 -enable-pretty-printing
34349 @end smallexample
34350
34351 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
34352 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
34353 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
34354 request that this functionality be enabled.
34355
34356 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
34357
34358 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
34359 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
34360
34361 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
34362 @findex -var-create
34363
34364 @subsubheading Synopsis
34365
34366 @smallexample
34367 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
34368 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
34369 @end smallexample
34370
34371 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
34372 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
34373 register.
34374
34375 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
34376 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
34377 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
34378 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
34379 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
34380
34381 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
34382 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
34383 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
34384 object must be created.
34385
34386 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
34387 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
34388
34389 @itemize @bullet
34390 @item
34391 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
34392
34393 @item
34394 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
34395
34396 @item
34397 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
34398 @end itemize
34399
34400 @cindex dynamic varobj
34401 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
34402 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
34403 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
34404 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
34405 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
34406 compatibility for existing clients.
34407
34408 @subsubheading Result
34409
34410 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
34411 are:
34412
34413 @table @samp
34414 @item name
34415 The name of the varobj.
34416
34417 @item numchild
34418 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
34419 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
34420 @samp{has_more} attribute.
34421
34422 @item value
34423 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
34424 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
34425 will not be interesting.
34426
34427 @item type
34428 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
34429 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
34430 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
34431 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
34432 @emph{declared} one.
34433
34434 @item thread-id
34435 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
34436 thread's global identifier.
34437
34438 @item has_more
34439 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
34440 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
34441
34442 @item dynamic
34443 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
34444 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
34445 then this attribute will not be present.
34446
34447 @item displayhint
34448 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
34449 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
34450 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
34451 @end table
34452
34453 Typical output will look like this:
34454
34455 @smallexample
34456 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
34457 has_more="@var{has_more}"
34458 @end smallexample
34459
34460
34461 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
34462 @findex -var-delete
34463
34464 @subsubheading Synopsis
34465
34466 @smallexample
34467 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
34468 @end smallexample
34469
34470 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
34471 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
34472
34473 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
34474
34475
34476 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
34477 @findex -var-set-format
34478
34479 @subsubheading Synopsis
34480
34481 @smallexample
34482 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
34483 @end smallexample
34484
34485 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
34486 @var{format-spec}.
34487
34488 @anchor{-var-set-format}
34489 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
34490
34491 @smallexample
34492 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
34493 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
34494 @end smallexample
34495
34496 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
34497 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
34498 for pointers, etc.).
34499
34500 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
34501 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
34502 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
34503 zero-hexadecimal format.
34504
34505 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
34506 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
34507
34508 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
34509 @findex -var-show-format
34510
34511 @subsubheading Synopsis
34512
34513 @smallexample
34514 -var-show-format @var{name}
34515 @end smallexample
34516
34517 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
34518
34519 @smallexample
34520 @var{format} @expansion{}
34521 @var{format-spec}
34522 @end smallexample
34523
34524
34525 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
34526 @findex -var-info-num-children
34527
34528 @subsubheading Synopsis
34529
34530 @smallexample
34531 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
34532 @end smallexample
34533
34534 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
34535
34536 @smallexample
34537 numchild=@var{n}
34538 @end smallexample
34539
34540 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
34541 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
34542 be available.
34543
34544
34545 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
34546 @findex -var-list-children
34547
34548 @subsubheading Synopsis
34549
34550 @smallexample
34551 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
34552 @end smallexample
34553 @anchor{-var-list-children}
34554
34555 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
34556 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
34557 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
34558 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
34559 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
34560 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
34561 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
34562 and unions.
34563
34564 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
34565 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
34566 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
34567 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
34568 reported.
34569
34570 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
34571 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
34572 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
34573 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
34574 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
34575 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
34576 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
34577 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
34578 the visible items.
34579
34580 For each child the following results are returned:
34581
34582 @table @var
34583
34584 @item name
34585 Name of the variable object created for this child.
34586
34587 @item exp
34588 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
34589 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
34590
34591 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
34592 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
34593
34594 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
34595 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
34596 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
34597 type and value are not present.
34598
34599 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
34600 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
34601 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
34602
34603 @item numchild
34604 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
34605 0.
34606
34607 @item type
34608 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
34609 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
34610 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
34611 @emph{declared} one.
34612
34613 @item value
34614 If values were requested, this is the value.
34615
34616 @item thread-id
34617 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
34618 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
34619
34620 @item frozen
34621 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
34622
34623 @item displayhint
34624 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
34625 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
34626 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
34627
34628 @item dynamic
34629 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
34630 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
34631 then this attribute will not be present.
34632
34633 @end table
34634
34635 The result may have its own attributes:
34636
34637 @table @samp
34638 @item displayhint
34639 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
34640 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
34641 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
34642
34643 @item has_more
34644 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
34645 remaining after the end of the selected range.
34646 @end table
34647
34648 @subsubheading Example
34649
34650 @smallexample
34651 (gdb)
34652 -var-list-children n
34653 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
34654 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
34655 (gdb)
34656 -var-list-children --all-values n
34657 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
34658 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
34659 @end smallexample
34660
34661
34662 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
34663 @findex -var-info-type
34664
34665 @subsubheading Synopsis
34666
34667 @smallexample
34668 -var-info-type @var{name}
34669 @end smallexample
34670
34671 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
34672 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
34673 @value{GDBN} CLI:
34674
34675 @smallexample
34676 type=@var{typename}
34677 @end smallexample
34678
34679
34680 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
34681 @findex -var-info-expression
34682
34683 @subsubheading Synopsis
34684
34685 @smallexample
34686 -var-info-expression @var{name}
34687 @end smallexample
34688
34689 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
34690 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
34691 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
34692
34693 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
34694 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
34695
34696 @smallexample
34697 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
34698 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
34699 @end smallexample
34700
34701 @noindent
34702 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
34703 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
34704
34705 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
34706 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
34707 is of limited use.
34708
34709 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
34710 @findex -var-info-path-expression
34711
34712 @subsubheading Synopsis
34713
34714 @smallexample
34715 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
34716 @end smallexample
34717
34718 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
34719 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
34720 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
34721 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
34722 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
34723 watchpoint from a variable object.
34724
34725 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
34726 and will give an error when invoked on one.
34727
34728 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
34729 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
34730 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
34731 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
34732 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
34733 @smallexample
34734 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
34735 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
34736 @end smallexample
34737
34738 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
34739 @findex -var-show-attributes
34740
34741 @subsubheading Synopsis
34742
34743 @smallexample
34744 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
34745 @end smallexample
34746
34747 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
34748
34749 @smallexample
34750 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
34751 @end smallexample
34752
34753 @noindent
34754 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
34755
34756 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
34757 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
34758
34759 @subsubheading Synopsis
34760
34761 @smallexample
34762 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
34763 @end smallexample
34764
34765 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
34766 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
34767 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
34768 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
34769 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
34770 the current display format will be used. The current display format
34771 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
34772
34773 @smallexample
34774 value=@var{value}
34775 @end smallexample
34776
34777 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
34778 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
34779
34780 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
34781 @findex -var-assign
34782
34783 @subsubheading Synopsis
34784
34785 @smallexample
34786 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
34787 @end smallexample
34788
34789 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
34790 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
34791 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
34792 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
34793
34794 @subsubheading Example
34795
34796 @smallexample
34797 (gdb)
34798 -var-assign var1 3
34799 ^done,value="3"
34800 (gdb)
34801 -var-update *
34802 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
34803 (gdb)
34804 @end smallexample
34805
34806 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
34807 @findex -var-update
34808
34809 @subsubheading Synopsis
34810
34811 @smallexample
34812 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
34813 @end smallexample
34814
34815 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
34816 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
34817 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
34818 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
34819 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
34820 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
34821 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
34822 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
34823 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
34824 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
34825 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
34826 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
34827 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
34828
34829 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
34830 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
34831 diagnostic.
34832
34833 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
34834 only the selected range of children will be reported.
34835
34836 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
34837 @samp{changelist}.
34838
34839 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
34840
34841 @table @samp
34842 @item name
34843 The name of the varobj.
34844
34845 @item value
34846 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
34847 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
34848
34849 @item in_scope
34850 @anchor{-var-update}
34851 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
34852
34853 @table @code
34854 @item "true"
34855 The variable object's current value is valid.
34856
34857 @item "false"
34858 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
34859 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
34860 scope.
34861
34862 @item "invalid"
34863 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
34864 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
34865 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
34866 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
34867 objects.
34868 @end table
34869
34870 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
34871 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
34872
34873 @item type_changed
34874 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
34875 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
34876 be @samp{false}.
34877
34878 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
34879 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
34880 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
34881 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
34882 unset.
34883
34884 @item new_type
34885 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
34886 hold the new type.
34887
34888 @item new_num_children
34889 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
34890 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
34891
34892 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
34893 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
34894 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
34895 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
34896 children which may be available.
34897
34898 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
34899 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
34900 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
34901 only happen at the end of the update range).
34902
34903 @item displayhint
34904 The display hint, if any.
34905
34906 @item has_more
34907 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
34908 available outside the varobj's update range.
34909
34910 @item dynamic
34911 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
34912 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
34913 then this attribute will not be present.
34914
34915 @item new_children
34916 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
34917 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
34918 be listed in this attribute.
34919 @end table
34920
34921 @subsubheading Example
34922
34923 @smallexample
34924 (gdb)
34925 -var-assign var1 3
34926 ^done,value="3"
34927 (gdb)
34928 -var-update --all-values var1
34929 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
34930 type_changed="false"@}]
34931 (gdb)
34932 @end smallexample
34933
34934 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
34935 @findex -var-set-frozen
34936 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
34937
34938 @subsubheading Synopsis
34939
34940 @smallexample
34941 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
34942 @end smallexample
34943
34944 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
34945 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
34946 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
34947 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
34948 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
34949 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
34950 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
34951 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
34952 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
34953 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
34954 @code{-var-update} does.
34955
34956 @subsubheading Example
34957
34958 @smallexample
34959 (gdb)
34960 -var-set-frozen V 1
34961 ^done
34962 (gdb)
34963 @end smallexample
34964
34965 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
34966 @findex -var-set-update-range
34967 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
34968
34969 @subsubheading Synopsis
34970
34971 @smallexample
34972 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
34973 @end smallexample
34974
34975 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
34976 @code{-var-update}.
34977
34978 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
34979 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
34980 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
34981 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
34982
34983 @subsubheading Example
34984
34985 @smallexample
34986 (gdb)
34987 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
34988 ^done
34989 @end smallexample
34990
34991 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
34992 @findex -var-set-visualizer
34993 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
34994
34995 @subsubheading Synopsis
34996
34997 @smallexample
34998 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
34999 @end smallexample
35000
35001 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
35002
35003 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
35004 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
35005
35006 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
35007 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
35008 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
35009 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
35010 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
35011 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
35012 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
35013
35014 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
35015 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
35016 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
35017 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
35018
35019 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
35020 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
35021 can be used to check this.
35022
35023 @subsubheading Example
35024
35025 Resetting the visualizer:
35026
35027 @smallexample
35028 (gdb)
35029 -var-set-visualizer V None
35030 ^done
35031 @end smallexample
35032
35033 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
35034
35035 @smallexample
35036 (gdb)
35037 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
35038 ^done
35039 @end smallexample
35040
35041 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
35042 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
35043
35044 @smallexample
35045 (gdb)
35046 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
35047 ^done
35048 @end smallexample
35049
35050 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35051 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
35052 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
35053
35054 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
35055 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
35056 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
35057 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
35058
35059 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
35060 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
35061
35062 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
35063 @c @subheading -data-assign
35064 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
35065 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
35066 @c set variable
35067 @c @subsubheading Example
35068 @c N.A.
35069
35070 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
35071 @findex -data-disassemble
35072
35073 @subsubheading Synopsis
35074
35075 @smallexample
35076 -data-disassemble
35077 ( -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr}
35078 | -a @var{addr}
35079 | -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] )
35080 [ --opcodes @var{opcodes-mode} ]
35081 [ --source ]
35082 [ -- @var{mode} ]
35083 @end smallexample
35084
35085 @noindent
35086 Where:
35087
35088 @table @samp
35089 @item @var{start-addr}
35090 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
35091 @item @var{end-addr}
35092 is the end address
35093 @item @var{addr}
35094 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
35095 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
35096 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
35097 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
35098 @item @var{filename}
35099 is the name of the file to disassemble
35100 @item @var{linenum}
35101 is the line number to disassemble around
35102 @item @var{lines}
35103 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
35104 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
35105 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
35106 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
35107 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
35108 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
35109 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
35110 are displayed.
35111 @item @var{opcodes-mode}
35112 can only be used with @var{mode} 0, and should be one of the following:
35113 @table @samp
35114 @item none
35115 no opcode information will be included in the result.
35116
35117 @item bytes
35118 opcodes will be included in the result, the opcodes will be formatted
35119 as for @kbd{disassemble /b}.
35120
35121 @item display
35122 opcodes will be included in the result, the opcodes will be formatted
35123 as for @kbd{disassemble /r}.
35124 @end table
35125 @item @var{mode}
35126 the use of @var{mode} is deprecated in favour of using the
35127 @code{--opcodes} and @code{--source} options. When no @var{mode} is
35128 given, @var{mode} 0 will be assumed. However, the @var{mode} is still
35129 available for backward compatibility. The @var{mode} should be one of:
35130 @table @samp
35131 @item 0
35132 @emph{disassembly only}, this is the default mode if no mode is
35133 specified.
35134
35135 @item 1
35136 @emph{mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)}, it is not possible
35137 to recreate this mode using @code{--opcodes} and @code{--source}
35138 options.
35139
35140 @item 2
35141 @emph{disassembly with raw opcodes}, this mode is equivalent to using
35142 @var{mode} 0 and passing @code{--opcodes bytes} to the command.
35143
35144 @item 3
35145 @emph{mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)}, it
35146 is not possible to recreate this mode using @code{--opcodes} and
35147 @code{--source} options.
35148
35149 @item 4
35150 @emph{mixed source and disassembly}, this mode is equivalent to using
35151 @var{mode} 0 and passing @code{--source} to the command.
35152
35153 @item 5
35154 @emph{mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes}, this mode is
35155 equivalent to using @var{mode} 0 and passing @code{--opcodes bytes}
35156 and @code{--source} to the command.
35157 @end table
35158 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
35159 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
35160 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
35161 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
35162 @end table
35163
35164 The @code{--source} can only be used with @var{mode} 0. Passing this
35165 option will include the source code in the disassembly result as if
35166 @var{mode} 4 or 5 had been used.
35167
35168 @subsubheading Result
35169
35170 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
35171 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the options used
35172 with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
35173
35174 For modes 0 and 2, and when the @code{--source} option is not used, the
35175 @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the following fields:
35176
35177 @table @code
35178 @item address
35179 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
35180
35181 @item func-name
35182 The name of the function this instruction is within.
35183
35184 @item offset
35185 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
35186
35187 @item inst
35188 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
35189
35190 @item opcodes
35191 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5, or when the
35192 @code{--opcodes} option @samp{bytes} or @samp{display} is used. This
35193 contains the raw opcode bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
35194
35195 When the @samp{--opcodes} option is not passed to
35196 @code{-data-disassemble}, or the @samp{bytes} value is passed to
35197 @samp{--opcodes}, then the bytes are formatted as a series of single
35198 bytes, in hex, in ascending address order, with a single space between
35199 each byte. This format is equivalent to the @samp{/b} option being
35200 used with the @kbd{disassemble} command
35201 (@pxref{disassemble,,@kbd{disassemble}}).
35202
35203 When @samp{--opcodes} is passed the value @samp{display} then the bytes
35204 are formatted in the natural instruction display order. This means
35205 multiple bytes can be grouped together, and the bytes might be
35206 byte-swapped. This format is equivalent to the @samp{/r} option being
35207 used with the @kbd{disassemble} command.
35208 @end table
35209
35210 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5, or when the @code{--source} option is used, the
35211 @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named @samp{src_and_asm_line},
35212 each of which has the following fields:
35213
35214 @table @code
35215 @item line
35216 The line number within @samp{file}.
35217
35218 @item file
35219 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
35220 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
35221 used.
35222
35223 @item fullname
35224 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
35225 using the source file search path
35226 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
35227 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
35228
35229 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
35230 present in the debug information.
35231
35232 @item line_asm_insn
35233 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
35234 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
35235 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
35236 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
35237 @samp{opcodes}.
35238
35239 @end table
35240
35241 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
35242 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
35243 adjust its format.
35244
35245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35246
35247 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
35248
35249 @subsubheading Example
35250
35251 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
35252
35253 @smallexample
35254 (gdb)
35255 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
35256 ^done,
35257 asm_insns=[
35258 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
35259 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
35260 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
35261 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
35262 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
35263 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
35264 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
35265 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
35266 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
35267 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
35268 (gdb)
35269 @end smallexample
35270
35271 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
35272 @code{main}.
35273
35274 @smallexample
35275 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
35276 ^done,asm_insns=[
35277 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
35278 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
35279 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
35280 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
35281 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
35282 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
35283 [@dots{}]
35284 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
35285 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
35286 (gdb)
35287 @end smallexample
35288
35289 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
35290
35291 @smallexample
35292 (gdb)
35293 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
35294 ^done,asm_insns=[
35295 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
35296 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
35297 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
35298 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
35299 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
35300 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
35301 (gdb)
35302 @end smallexample
35303
35304 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
35305
35306 @smallexample
35307 (gdb)
35308 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
35309 ^done,asm_insns=[
35310 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
35311 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
35312 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
35313 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
35314 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
35315 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
35316 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
35317 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
35318 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
35319 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
35320 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
35321 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
35322 (gdb)
35323 @end smallexample
35324
35325
35326 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
35327 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
35328
35329 @subsubheading Synopsis
35330
35331 @smallexample
35332 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
35333 @end smallexample
35334
35335 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
35336 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
35337 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
35338
35339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35340
35341 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
35342 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
35343 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
35344
35345 @subsubheading Example
35346
35347 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
35348 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
35349 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
35350 output.
35351
35352 @smallexample
35353 211-data-evaluate-expression A
35354 211^done,value="1"
35355 (gdb)
35356 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
35357 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
35358 (gdb)
35359 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
35360 411^done,value="4"
35361 (gdb)
35362 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
35363 511^done,value="4"
35364 (gdb)
35365 @end smallexample
35366
35367
35368 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
35369 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
35370
35371 @subsubheading Synopsis
35372
35373 @smallexample
35374 -data-list-changed-registers
35375 @end smallexample
35376
35377 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
35378
35379 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35380
35381 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
35382 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
35383
35384 @subsubheading Example
35385
35386 On a PPC MBX board:
35387
35388 @smallexample
35389 (gdb)
35390 -exec-continue
35391 ^running
35392
35393 (gdb)
35394 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
35395 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
35396 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
35397 (gdb)
35398 -data-list-changed-registers
35399 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
35400 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
35401 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
35402 (gdb)
35403 @end smallexample
35404
35405
35406 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
35407 @findex -data-list-register-names
35408
35409 @subsubheading Synopsis
35410
35411 @smallexample
35412 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
35413 @end smallexample
35414
35415 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
35416 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
35417 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
35418 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
35419 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
35420 include empty register names.
35421
35422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35423
35424 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
35425 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
35426 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
35427
35428 @subsubheading Example
35429
35430 For the PPC MBX board:
35431 @smallexample
35432 (gdb)
35433 -data-list-register-names
35434 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
35435 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
35436 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
35437 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
35438 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
35439 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
35440 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
35441 (gdb)
35442 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
35443 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
35444 (gdb)
35445 @end smallexample
35446
35447 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
35448 @findex -data-list-register-values
35449
35450 @subsubheading Synopsis
35451
35452 @smallexample
35453 -data-list-register-values
35454 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
35455 @end smallexample
35456
35457 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
35458 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
35459 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
35460 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
35461 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
35462 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
35463
35464 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
35465
35466 @table @code
35467 @item x
35468 Hexadecimal
35469 @item o
35470 Octal
35471 @item t
35472 Binary
35473 @item d
35474 Decimal
35475 @item r
35476 Raw
35477 @item N
35478 Natural
35479 @end table
35480
35481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35482
35483 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
35484 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
35485
35486 @subsubheading Example
35487
35488 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
35489 don't appear in the actual output):
35490
35491 @smallexample
35492 (gdb)
35493 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
35494 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
35495 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
35496 (gdb)
35497 -data-list-register-values x
35498 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
35499 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
35500 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
35501 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
35502 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
35503 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
35504 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
35505 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
35506 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
35507 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
35508 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
35509 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
35510 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
35511 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
35512 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
35513 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
35514 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
35515 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
35516 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
35517 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
35518 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
35519 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
35520 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
35521 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
35522 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
35523 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
35524 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
35525 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
35526 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
35527 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
35528 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
35529 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
35530 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
35531 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
35532 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
35533 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
35534 (gdb)
35535 @end smallexample
35536
35537
35538 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
35539 @findex -data-read-memory
35540
35541 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
35542
35543 @subsubheading Synopsis
35544
35545 @smallexample
35546 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
35547 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
35548 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
35549 @end smallexample
35550
35551 @noindent
35552 where:
35553
35554 @table @samp
35555 @item @var{address}
35556 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
35557 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
35558 quoted using the C convention.
35559
35560 @item @var{word-format}
35561 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
35562 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
35563 ,Output Formats}).
35564
35565 @item @var{word-size}
35566 The size of each memory word in bytes.
35567
35568 @item @var{nr-rows}
35569 The number of rows in the output table.
35570
35571 @item @var{nr-cols}
35572 The number of columns in the output table.
35573
35574 @item @var{aschar}
35575 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
35576 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
35577 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
35578 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
35579
35580 @item @var{byte-offset}
35581 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
35582 @end table
35583
35584 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
35585 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
35586 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
35587 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
35588 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
35589 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
35590 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
35591 @samp{addr}.
35592
35593 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
35594 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
35595 @samp{prev-page}.
35596
35597 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35598
35599 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
35600 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
35601
35602 @subsubheading Example
35603
35604 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
35605 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
35606 word. Display each word in hex.
35607
35608 @smallexample
35609 (gdb)
35610 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
35611 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
35612 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
35613 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
35614 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
35615 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
35616 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
35617 (gdb)
35618 @end smallexample
35619
35620 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
35621 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
35622
35623 @smallexample
35624 (gdb)
35625 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
35626 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
35627 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
35628 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
35629 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
35630 (gdb)
35631 @end smallexample
35632
35633 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
35634 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
35635 used as the non-printable character.
35636
35637 @smallexample
35638 (gdb)
35639 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
35640 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
35641 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
35642 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
35643 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
35644 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
35645 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
35646 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
35647 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
35648 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
35649 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
35650 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
35651 (gdb)
35652 @end smallexample
35653
35654 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
35655 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
35656
35657 @subsubheading Synopsis
35658
35659 @smallexample
35660 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
35661 @var{address} @var{count}
35662 @end smallexample
35663
35664 @noindent
35665 where:
35666
35667 @table @samp
35668 @item @var{address}
35669 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
35670 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
35671 quoted using the C convention.
35672
35673 @item @var{count}
35674 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
35675 literal.
35676
35677 @item @var{offset}
35678 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
35679 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
35680 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
35681 arithmetics itself.
35682
35683 @end table
35684
35685 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
35686 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
35687 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
35688 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
35689 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
35690 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
35691
35692 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
35693 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
35694 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
35695 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
35696 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
35697 well for reading across a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
35698 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
35699 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
35700
35701 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
35702 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
35703 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
35704 and has the following fields:
35705
35706 @table @code
35707 @item begin
35708 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
35709
35710 @item end
35711 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
35712
35713 @item offset
35714 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
35715 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
35716
35717 @item contents
35718 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
35719
35720 @end table
35721
35722
35723
35724 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35725
35726 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
35727
35728 @subsubheading Example
35729
35730 @smallexample
35731 (gdb)
35732 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
35733 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
35734 end="0xbffff15e",
35735 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
35736 (gdb)
35737 @end smallexample
35738
35739
35740 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
35741 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
35742
35743 @subsubheading Synopsis
35744
35745 @smallexample
35746 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
35747 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
35748 @end smallexample
35749
35750 @noindent
35751 where:
35752
35753 @table @samp
35754 @item @var{address}
35755 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
35756 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
35757 be quoted using the C convention.
35758
35759 @item @var{contents}
35760 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
35761 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
35762
35763 @item @var{count}
35764 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
35765 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
35766 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
35767 @var{count} memory units.
35768
35769 @end table
35770
35771 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35772
35773 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
35774
35775 @subsubheading Example
35776
35777 @smallexample
35778 (gdb)
35779 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
35780 ^done
35781 (gdb)
35782 @end smallexample
35783
35784 @smallexample
35785 (gdb)
35786 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
35787 ^done
35788 (gdb)
35789 @end smallexample
35790
35791 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35792 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
35793 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
35794
35795 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
35796 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
35797
35798 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
35799 @findex -trace-find
35800
35801 @subsubheading Synopsis
35802
35803 @smallexample
35804 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
35805 @end smallexample
35806
35807 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
35808 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
35809 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
35810
35811 @table @samp
35812
35813 @item none
35814 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
35815
35816 @item frame-number
35817 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
35818 that index.
35819
35820 @item tracepoint-number
35821 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
35822 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
35823
35824 @item pc
35825 An address is required as parameter. Finds
35826 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
35827 address.
35828
35829 @item pc-inside-range
35830 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
35831 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
35832 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
35833
35834 @item pc-outside-range
35835 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
35836 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
35837 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
35838
35839 @item line
35840 Location specification is required as parameter. @xref{Location Specifications}.
35841 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
35842 the specified location.
35843
35844 @end table
35845
35846 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
35847 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
35848
35849 @table @samp
35850 @item found
35851 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
35852 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
35853
35854 @item traceframe
35855 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
35856 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
35857
35858 @item tracepoint
35859 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
35860 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
35861
35862 @item frame
35863 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
35864 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
35865 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
35866
35867 @end table
35868
35869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35870
35871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
35872
35873 @subheading -trace-define-variable
35874 @findex -trace-define-variable
35875
35876 @subsubheading Synopsis
35877
35878 @smallexample
35879 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
35880 @end smallexample
35881
35882 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
35883 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
35884 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
35885 with the @samp{$} character.
35886
35887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35888
35889 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
35890
35891 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
35892 @findex -trace-frame-collected
35893
35894 @subsubheading Synopsis
35895
35896 @smallexample
35897 -trace-frame-collected
35898 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
35899 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
35900 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
35901 [--memory-contents]
35902 @end smallexample
35903
35904 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
35905 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
35906 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
35907 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
35908 See the output description table below for more details.
35909
35910 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
35911 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
35912 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
35913 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
35914 memory range and which is a computed expression.
35915
35916 For instance, if the actions were
35917 @smallexample
35918 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
35919 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
35920 @end smallexample
35921
35922 @noindent
35923 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
35924 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
35925 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
35926 objects would be computed expressions.
35927
35928 An example output would be:
35929
35930 @smallexample
35931 (gdb)
35932 -trace-frame-collected
35933 ^done,
35934 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
35935 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
35936 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
35937 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
35938 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
35939 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
35940 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
35941 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
35942 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
35943 ...
35944 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
35945 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
35946 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
35947 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
35948 (gdb)
35949 @end smallexample
35950
35951 Where:
35952
35953 @table @code
35954 @item explicit-variables
35955 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
35956 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
35957 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
35958 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
35959 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
35960 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
35961 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
35962 arrays, structures and unions.
35963
35964 @item computed-expressions
35965 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
35966 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
35967 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
35968 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
35969
35970 @item registers
35971 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
35972 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
35973 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
35974 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
35975 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
35976
35977 @item tvars
35978 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
35979 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
35980 current value are returned.
35981
35982 @item memory
35983 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
35984 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
35985 collected memory range and has the following fields:
35986
35987 @table @code
35988 @item address
35989 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
35990
35991 @item length
35992 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
35993
35994 @item contents
35995 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
35996 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
35997
35998 @end table
35999
36000 @end table
36001
36002 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36003
36004 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
36005
36006 @subsubheading Example
36007
36008 @subheading -trace-list-variables
36009 @findex -trace-list-variables
36010
36011 @subsubheading Synopsis
36012
36013 @smallexample
36014 -trace-list-variables
36015 @end smallexample
36016
36017 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
36018 table has the following fields:
36019
36020 @table @samp
36021 @item name
36022 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
36023
36024 @item initial
36025 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
36026 field is always present.
36027
36028 @item current
36029 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
36030 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
36031 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
36032 presently running.
36033
36034 @end table
36035
36036 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36037
36038 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
36039
36040 @subsubheading Example
36041
36042 @smallexample
36043 (gdb)
36044 -trace-list-variables
36045 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
36046 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
36047 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
36048 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
36049 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
36050 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
36051 (gdb)
36052 @end smallexample
36053
36054 @subheading -trace-save
36055 @findex -trace-save
36056
36057 @subsubheading Synopsis
36058
36059 @smallexample
36060 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
36061 @end smallexample
36062
36063 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
36064 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
36065 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
36066 to perform the save.
36067
36068 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
36069 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
36070 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
36071
36072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36073
36074 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
36075
36076
36077 @subheading -trace-start
36078 @findex -trace-start
36079
36080 @subsubheading Synopsis
36081
36082 @smallexample
36083 -trace-start
36084 @end smallexample
36085
36086 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
36087 have any fields.
36088
36089 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36090
36091 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
36092
36093 @subheading -trace-status
36094 @findex -trace-status
36095
36096 @subsubheading Synopsis
36097
36098 @smallexample
36099 -trace-status
36100 @end smallexample
36101
36102 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
36103 the following fields:
36104
36105 @table @samp
36106
36107 @item supported
36108 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
36109 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
36110 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
36111 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
36112 started. This field is always present.
36113
36114 @item running
36115 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
36116 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
36117 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
36118
36119 @item stop-reason
36120 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
36121 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
36122 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
36123 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
36124 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
36125 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
36126 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
36127 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
36128 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
36129
36130 @item stopping-tracepoint
36131 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
36132 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
36133 @samp{passcount}.
36134
36135 @item frames
36136 @itemx frames-created
36137 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
36138 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
36139 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
36140 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
36141
36142 @item buffer-size
36143 @itemx buffer-free
36144 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
36145 remaining space. These fields are optional.
36146
36147 @item circular
36148 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
36149 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
36150 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
36151 and may fill up.
36152
36153 @item disconnected
36154 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
36155 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
36156 that the trace run will stop.
36157
36158 @item trace-file
36159 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
36160 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
36161
36162 @end table
36163
36164 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36165
36166 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
36167
36168 @subheading -trace-stop
36169 @findex -trace-stop
36170
36171 @subsubheading Synopsis
36172
36173 @smallexample
36174 -trace-stop
36175 @end smallexample
36176
36177 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
36178 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
36179 @samp{running} fields are not output.
36180
36181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36182
36183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
36184
36185
36186 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
36187 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
36188 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
36189
36190
36191 @ignore
36192 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
36193 @findex -symbol-info-address
36194
36195 @subsubheading Synopsis
36196
36197 @smallexample
36198 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
36199 @end smallexample
36200
36201 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
36202
36203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36204
36205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
36206
36207 @subsubheading Example
36208 N.A.
36209
36210
36211 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
36212 @findex -symbol-info-file
36213
36214 @subsubheading Synopsis
36215
36216 @smallexample
36217 -symbol-info-file
36218 @end smallexample
36219
36220 Show the file for the symbol.
36221
36222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36223
36224 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
36225 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
36226
36227 @subsubheading Example
36228 N.A.
36229 @end ignore
36230
36231 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-functions} Command
36232 @findex -symbol-info-functions
36233 @anchor{-symbol-info-functions}
36234
36235 @subsubheading Synopsis
36236
36237 @smallexample
36238 -symbol-info-functions [--include-nondebug]
36239 [--type @var{type_regexp}]
36240 [--name @var{name_regexp}]
36241 [--max-results @var{limit}]
36242 @end smallexample
36243
36244 @noindent
36245 Return a list containing the names and types for all global functions
36246 taken from the debug information. The functions are grouped by source
36247 file, and shown with the line number on which each function is
36248 defined.
36249
36250 The @code{--include-nondebug} option causes the output to include
36251 code symbols from the symbol table.
36252
36253 The options @code{--type} and @code{--name} allow the symbols returned
36254 to be filtered based on either the name of the function, or the type
36255 signature of the function.
36256
36257 The option @code{--max-results} restricts the command to return no
36258 more than @var{limit} results. If exactly @var{limit} results are
36259 returned then there might be additional results available if a higher
36260 limit is used.
36261
36262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36263
36264 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info functions}.
36265
36266 @subsubheading Example
36267 @smallexample
36268 @group
36269 (gdb)
36270 -symbol-info-functions
36271 ^done,symbols=
36272 @{debug=
36273 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36274 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36275 symbols=[@{line="36", name="f4", type="void (int *)",
36276 description="void f4(int *);"@},
36277 @{line="42", name="main", type="int ()",
36278 description="int main();"@},
36279 @{line="30", name="f1", type="my_int_t (int, int)",
36280 description="static my_int_t f1(int, int);"@}]@},
36281 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36282 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36283 symbols=[@{line="33", name="f2", type="float (another_float_t)",
36284 description="float f2(another_float_t);"@},
36285 @{line="39", name="f3", type="int (another_int_t)",
36286 description="int f3(another_int_t);"@},
36287 @{line="27", name="f1", type="another_float_t (int)",
36288 description="static another_float_t f1(int);"@}]@}]@}
36289 @end group
36290 @group
36291 (gdb)
36292 -symbol-info-functions --name f1
36293 ^done,symbols=
36294 @{debug=
36295 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36296 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36297 symbols=[@{line="30", name="f1", type="my_int_t (int, int)",
36298 description="static my_int_t f1(int, int);"@}]@},
36299 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36300 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36301 symbols=[@{line="27", name="f1", type="another_float_t (int)",
36302 description="static another_float_t f1(int);"@}]@}]@}
36303 @end group
36304 @group
36305 (gdb)
36306 -symbol-info-functions --type void
36307 ^done,symbols=
36308 @{debug=
36309 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36310 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36311 symbols=[@{line="36", name="f4", type="void (int *)",
36312 description="void f4(int *);"@}]@}]@}
36313 @end group
36314 @group
36315 (gdb)
36316 -symbol-info-functions --include-nondebug
36317 ^done,symbols=
36318 @{debug=
36319 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36320 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36321 symbols=[@{line="36", name="f4", type="void (int *)",
36322 description="void f4(int *);"@},
36323 @{line="42", name="main", type="int ()",
36324 description="int main();"@},
36325 @{line="30", name="f1", type="my_int_t (int, int)",
36326 description="static my_int_t f1(int, int);"@}]@},
36327 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36328 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36329 symbols=[@{line="33", name="f2", type="float (another_float_t)",
36330 description="float f2(another_float_t);"@},
36331 @{line="39", name="f3", type="int (another_int_t)",
36332 description="int f3(another_int_t);"@},
36333 @{line="27", name="f1", type="another_float_t (int)",
36334 description="static another_float_t f1(int);"@}]@}],
36335 nondebug=
36336 [@{address="0x0000000000400398",name="_init"@},
36337 @{address="0x00000000004003b0",name="_start"@},
36338 ...
36339 ]@}
36340 @end group
36341 @end smallexample
36342
36343 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-module-functions} Command
36344 @findex -symbol-info-module-functions
36345 @anchor{-symbol-info-module-functions}
36346
36347 @subsubheading Synopsis
36348
36349 @smallexample
36350 -symbol-info-module-functions [--module @var{module_regexp}]
36351 [--name @var{name_regexp}]
36352 [--type @var{type_regexp}]
36353 @end smallexample
36354
36355 @noindent
36356 Return a list containing the names of all known functions within all
36357 know Fortran modules. The functions are grouped by source file and
36358 containing module, and shown with the line number on which each
36359 function is defined.
36360
36361 The option @code{--module} only returns results for modules matching
36362 @var{module_regexp}. The option @code{--name} only returns functions
36363 whose name matches @var{name_regexp}, and @code{--type} only returns
36364 functions whose type matches @var{type_regexp}.
36365
36366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36367
36368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info module functions}.
36369
36370 @subsubheading Example
36371
36372 @smallexample
36373 @group
36374 (gdb)
36375 -symbol-info-module-functions
36376 ^done,symbols=
36377 [@{module="mod1",
36378 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36379 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36380 symbols=[@{line="21",name="mod1::check_all",type="void (void)",
36381 description="void mod1::check_all(void);"@}]@}]@},
36382 @{module="mod2",
36383 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36384 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36385 symbols=[@{line="30",name="mod2::check_var_i",type="void (void)",
36386 description="void mod2::check_var_i(void);"@}]@}]@},
36387 @{module="mod3",
36388 files=[@{filename="/projec/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36389 fullname="/projec/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36390 symbols=[@{line="21",name="mod3::check_all",type="void (void)",
36391 description="void mod3::check_all(void);"@},
36392 @{line="27",name="mod3::check_mod2",type="void (void)",
36393 description="void mod3::check_mod2(void);"@}]@}]@},
36394 @{module="modmany",
36395 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36396 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36397 symbols=[@{line="35",name="modmany::check_some",type="void (void)",
36398 description="void modmany::check_some(void);"@}]@}]@},
36399 @{module="moduse",
36400 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36401 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36402 symbols=[@{line="44",name="moduse::check_all",type="void (void)",
36403 description="void moduse::check_all(void);"@},
36404 @{line="49",name="moduse::check_var_x",type="void (void)",
36405 description="void moduse::check_var_x(void);"@}]@}]@}]
36406 @end group
36407 @end smallexample
36408
36409 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-module-variables} Command
36410 @findex -symbol-info-module-variables
36411 @anchor{-symbol-info-module-variables}
36412
36413 @subsubheading Synopsis
36414
36415 @smallexample
36416 -symbol-info-module-variables [--module @var{module_regexp}]
36417 [--name @var{name_regexp}]
36418 [--type @var{type_regexp}]
36419 @end smallexample
36420
36421 @noindent
36422 Return a list containing the names of all known variables within all
36423 know Fortran modules. The variables are grouped by source file and
36424 containing module, and shown with the line number on which each
36425 variable is defined.
36426
36427 The option @code{--module} only returns results for modules matching
36428 @var{module_regexp}. The option @code{--name} only returns variables
36429 whose name matches @var{name_regexp}, and @code{--type} only returns
36430 variables whose type matches @var{type_regexp}.
36431
36432 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36433
36434 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info module variables}.
36435
36436 @subsubheading Example
36437
36438 @smallexample
36439 @group
36440 (gdb)
36441 -symbol-info-module-variables
36442 ^done,symbols=
36443 [@{module="mod1",
36444 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36445 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36446 symbols=[@{line="18",name="mod1::var_const",type="integer(kind=4)",
36447 description="integer(kind=4) mod1::var_const;"@},
36448 @{line="17",name="mod1::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
36449 description="integer(kind=4) mod1::var_i;"@}]@}]@},
36450 @{module="mod2",
36451 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36452 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36453 symbols=[@{line="28",name="mod2::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
36454 description="integer(kind=4) mod2::var_i;"@}]@}]@},
36455 @{module="mod3",
36456 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36457 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36458 symbols=[@{line="18",name="mod3::mod1",type="integer(kind=4)",
36459 description="integer(kind=4) mod3::mod1;"@},
36460 @{line="17",name="mod3::mod2",type="integer(kind=4)",
36461 description="integer(kind=4) mod3::mod2;"@},
36462 @{line="19",name="mod3::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
36463 description="integer(kind=4) mod3::var_i;"@}]@}]@},
36464 @{module="modmany",
36465 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36466 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36467 symbols=[@{line="33",name="modmany::var_a",type="integer(kind=4)",
36468 description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_a;"@},
36469 @{line="33",name="modmany::var_b",type="integer(kind=4)",
36470 description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_b;"@},
36471 @{line="33",name="modmany::var_c",type="integer(kind=4)",
36472 description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_c;"@},
36473 @{line="33",name="modmany::var_i",type="integer(kind=4)",
36474 description="integer(kind=4) modmany::var_i;"@}]@}]@},
36475 @{module="moduse",
36476 files=[@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36477 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36478 symbols=[@{line="42",name="moduse::var_x",type="integer(kind=4)",
36479 description="integer(kind=4) moduse::var_x;"@},
36480 @{line="42",name="moduse::var_y",type="integer(kind=4)",
36481 description="integer(kind=4) moduse::var_y;"@}]@}]@}]
36482 @end group
36483 @end smallexample
36484
36485 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-modules} Command
36486 @findex -symbol-info-modules
36487 @anchor{-symbol-info-modules}
36488
36489 @subsubheading Synopsis
36490
36491 @smallexample
36492 -symbol-info-modules [--name @var{name_regexp}]
36493 [--max-results @var{limit}]
36494
36495 @end smallexample
36496
36497 @noindent
36498 Return a list containing the names of all known Fortran modules. The
36499 modules are grouped by source file, and shown with the line number on
36500 which each modules is defined.
36501
36502 The option @code{--name} allows the modules returned to be filtered
36503 based the name of the module.
36504
36505 The option @code{--max-results} restricts the command to return no
36506 more than @var{limit} results. If exactly @var{limit} results are
36507 returned then there might be additional results available if a higher
36508 limit is used.
36509
36510 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36511
36512 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info modules}.
36513
36514 @subsubheading Example
36515 @smallexample
36516 @group
36517 (gdb)
36518 -symbol-info-modules
36519 ^done,symbols=
36520 @{debug=
36521 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36522 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36523 symbols=[@{line="16",name="mod1"@},
36524 @{line="22",name="mod2"@}]@},
36525 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36526 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36527 symbols=[@{line="16",name="mod3"@},
36528 @{line="22",name="modmany"@},
36529 @{line="26",name="moduse"@}]@}]@}
36530 @end group
36531 @group
36532 (gdb)
36533 -symbol-info-modules --name mod[123]
36534 ^done,symbols=
36535 @{debug=
36536 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36537 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules-2.f90",
36538 symbols=[@{line="16",name="mod1"@},
36539 @{line="22",name="mod2"@}]@},
36540 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36541 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-fortran-modules.f90",
36542 symbols=[@{line="16",name="mod3"@}]@}]@}
36543 @end group
36544 @end smallexample
36545
36546 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-types} Command
36547 @findex -symbol-info-types
36548 @anchor{-symbol-info-types}
36549
36550 @subsubheading Synopsis
36551
36552 @smallexample
36553 -symbol-info-types [--name @var{name_regexp}]
36554 [--max-results @var{limit}]
36555
36556 @end smallexample
36557
36558 @noindent
36559 Return a list of all defined types. The types are grouped by source
36560 file, and shown with the line number on which each user defined type
36561 is defined. Some base types are not defined in the source code but
36562 are added to the debug information by the compiler, for example
36563 @code{int}, @code{float}, etc.; these types do not have an associated
36564 line number.
36565
36566 The option @code{--name} allows the list of types returned to be
36567 filtered by name.
36568
36569 The option @code{--max-results} restricts the command to return no
36570 more than @var{limit} results. If exactly @var{limit} results are
36571 returned then there might be additional results available if a higher
36572 limit is used.
36573
36574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36575
36576 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info types}.
36577
36578 @subsubheading Example
36579 @smallexample
36580 @group
36581 (gdb)
36582 -symbol-info-types
36583 ^done,symbols=
36584 @{debug=
36585 [@{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36586 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36587 symbols=[@{name="float"@},
36588 @{name="int"@},
36589 @{line="27",name="typedef int my_int_t;"@}]@},
36590 @{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36591 fullname="/project/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36592 symbols=[@{line="24",name="typedef float another_float_t;"@},
36593 @{line="23",name="typedef int another_int_t;"@},
36594 @{name="float"@},
36595 @{name="int"@}]@}]@}
36596 @end group
36597 @group
36598 (gdb)
36599 -symbol-info-types --name _int_
36600 ^done,symbols=
36601 @{debug=
36602 [@{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36603 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36604 symbols=[@{line="27",name="typedef int my_int_t;"@}]@},
36605 @{filename="gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36606 fullname="/project/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36607 symbols=[@{line="23",name="typedef int another_int_t;"@}]@}]@}
36608 @end group
36609 @end smallexample
36610
36611 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-variables} Command
36612 @findex -symbol-info-variables
36613 @anchor{-symbol-info-variables}
36614
36615 @subsubheading Synopsis
36616
36617 @smallexample
36618 -symbol-info-variables [--include-nondebug]
36619 [--type @var{type_regexp}]
36620 [--name @var{name_regexp}]
36621 [--max-results @var{limit}]
36622
36623 @end smallexample
36624
36625 @noindent
36626 Return a list containing the names and types for all global variables
36627 taken from the debug information. The variables are grouped by source
36628 file, and shown with the line number on which each variable is
36629 defined.
36630
36631 The @code{--include-nondebug} option causes the output to include
36632 data symbols from the symbol table.
36633
36634 The options @code{--type} and @code{--name} allow the symbols returned
36635 to be filtered based on either the name of the variable, or the type
36636 of the variable.
36637
36638 The option @code{--max-results} restricts the command to return no
36639 more than @var{limit} results. If exactly @var{limit} results are
36640 returned then there might be additional results available if a higher
36641 limit is used.
36642
36643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36644
36645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info variables}.
36646
36647 @subsubheading Example
36648 @smallexample
36649 @group
36650 (gdb)
36651 -symbol-info-variables
36652 ^done,symbols=
36653 @{debug=
36654 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36655 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36656 symbols=[@{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
36657 description="static float global_f1;"@},
36658 @{line="24",name="global_i1",type="int",
36659 description="static int global_i1;"@}]@},
36660 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36661 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36662 symbols=[@{line="21",name="global_f2",type="int",
36663 description="int global_f2;"@},
36664 @{line="20",name="global_i2",type="int",
36665 description="int global_i2;"@},
36666 @{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
36667 description="static float global_f1;"@},
36668 @{line="18",name="global_i1",type="int",
36669 description="static int global_i1;"@}]@}]@}
36670 @end group
36671 @group
36672 (gdb)
36673 -symbol-info-variables --name f1
36674 ^done,symbols=
36675 @{debug=
36676 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36677 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36678 symbols=[@{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
36679 description="static float global_f1;"@}]@},
36680 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36681 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36682 symbols=[@{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
36683 description="static float global_f1;"@}]@}]@}
36684 @end group
36685 @group
36686 (gdb)
36687 -symbol-info-variables --type float
36688 ^done,symbols=
36689 @{debug=
36690 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36691 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36692 symbols=[@{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
36693 description="static float global_f1;"@}]@},
36694 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36695 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36696 symbols=[@{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
36697 description="static float global_f1;"@}]@}]@}
36698 @end group
36699 @group
36700 (gdb)
36701 -symbol-info-variables --include-nondebug
36702 ^done,symbols=
36703 @{debug=
36704 [@{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36705 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-1.c",
36706 symbols=[@{line="25",name="global_f1",type="float",
36707 description="static float global_f1;"@},
36708 @{line="24",name="global_i1",type="int",
36709 description="static int global_i1;"@}]@},
36710 @{filename="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36711 fullname="/project/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/mi-sym-info-2.c",
36712 symbols=[@{line="21",name="global_f2",type="int",
36713 description="int global_f2;"@},
36714 @{line="20",name="global_i2",type="int",
36715 description="int global_i2;"@},
36716 @{line="19",name="global_f1",type="float",
36717 description="static float global_f1;"@},
36718 @{line="18",name="global_i1",type="int",
36719 description="static int global_i1;"@}]@}],
36720 nondebug=
36721 [@{address="0x00000000004005d0",name="_IO_stdin_used"@},
36722 @{address="0x00000000004005d8",name="__dso_handle"@}
36723 ...
36724 ]@}
36725 @end group
36726 @end smallexample
36727
36728 @ignore
36729 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
36730 @findex -symbol-info-line
36731
36732 @subsubheading Synopsis
36733
36734 @smallexample
36735 -symbol-info-line
36736 @end smallexample
36737
36738 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
36739
36740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36741
36742 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
36743 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
36744
36745 @subsubheading Example
36746 N.A.
36747
36748
36749 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
36750 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
36751
36752 @subsubheading Synopsis
36753
36754 @smallexample
36755 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
36756 @end smallexample
36757
36758 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
36759
36760 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36761
36762 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
36763
36764 @subsubheading Example
36765 N.A.
36766
36767
36768 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
36769 @findex -symbol-list-functions
36770
36771 @subsubheading Synopsis
36772
36773 @smallexample
36774 -symbol-list-functions
36775 @end smallexample
36776
36777 List the functions in the executable.
36778
36779 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36780
36781 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
36782 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
36783
36784 @subsubheading Example
36785 N.A.
36786 @end ignore
36787
36788
36789 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
36790 @findex -symbol-list-lines
36791
36792 @subsubheading Synopsis
36793
36794 @smallexample
36795 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
36796 @end smallexample
36797
36798 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
36799 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
36800 ascending PC order.
36801
36802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36803
36804 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
36805
36806 @subsubheading Example
36807 @smallexample
36808 (gdb)
36809 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
36810 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
36811 (gdb)
36812 @end smallexample
36813
36814
36815 @ignore
36816 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
36817 @findex -symbol-list-types
36818
36819 @subsubheading Synopsis
36820
36821 @smallexample
36822 -symbol-list-types
36823 @end smallexample
36824
36825 List all the type names.
36826
36827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36828
36829 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
36830 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
36831
36832 @subsubheading Example
36833 N.A.
36834
36835
36836 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
36837 @findex -symbol-list-variables
36838
36839 @subsubheading Synopsis
36840
36841 @smallexample
36842 -symbol-list-variables
36843 @end smallexample
36844
36845 List all the global and static variable names.
36846
36847 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36848
36849 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
36850
36851 @subsubheading Example
36852 N.A.
36853
36854
36855 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
36856 @findex -symbol-locate
36857
36858 @subsubheading Synopsis
36859
36860 @smallexample
36861 -symbol-locate
36862 @end smallexample
36863
36864 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36865
36866 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
36867
36868 @subsubheading Example
36869 N.A.
36870
36871
36872 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
36873 @findex -symbol-type
36874
36875 @subsubheading Synopsis
36876
36877 @smallexample
36878 -symbol-type @var{variable}
36879 @end smallexample
36880
36881 Show type of @var{variable}.
36882
36883 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36884
36885 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
36886 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
36887
36888 @subsubheading Example
36889 N.A.
36890 @end ignore
36891
36892
36893 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
36894 @node GDB/MI File Commands
36895 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
36896
36897 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
36898 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
36899
36900 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
36901 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
36902
36903 @subsubheading Synopsis
36904
36905 @smallexample
36906 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
36907 @end smallexample
36908
36909 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
36910 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
36911 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
36912 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
36913 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
36914 notification.
36915
36916 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36917
36918 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
36919
36920 @subsubheading Example
36921
36922 @smallexample
36923 (gdb)
36924 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
36925 ^done
36926 (gdb)
36927 @end smallexample
36928
36929
36930 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
36931 @findex -file-exec-file
36932
36933 @subsubheading Synopsis
36934
36935 @smallexample
36936 -file-exec-file @var{file}
36937 @end smallexample
36938
36939 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
36940 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
36941 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
36942 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
36943 notification.
36944
36945 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36946
36947 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
36948
36949 @subsubheading Example
36950
36951 @smallexample
36952 (gdb)
36953 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
36954 ^done
36955 (gdb)
36956 @end smallexample
36957
36958
36959 @ignore
36960 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
36961 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
36962
36963 @subsubheading Synopsis
36964
36965 @smallexample
36966 -file-list-exec-sections
36967 @end smallexample
36968
36969 List the sections of the current executable file.
36970
36971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36972
36973 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
36974 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
36975 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
36976
36977 @subsubheading Example
36978 N.A.
36979 @end ignore
36980
36981
36982 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
36983 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
36984
36985 @subsubheading Synopsis
36986
36987 @smallexample
36988 -file-list-exec-source-file
36989 @end smallexample
36990
36991 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
36992 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
36993 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
36994 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
36995
36996 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
36997
36998 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
36999
37000 @subsubheading Example
37001
37002 @smallexample
37003 (gdb)
37004 123-file-list-exec-source-file
37005 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
37006 (gdb)
37007 @end smallexample
37008
37009
37010 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
37011 @kindex info sources
37012 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
37013
37014 @subsubheading Synopsis
37015
37016 @smallexample
37017 -file-list-exec-source-files @r{[} @var{--group-by-objfile} @r{]}
37018 @r{[} @var{--dirname} @r{|} @var{--basename} @r{]}
37019 @r{[} -- @r{]}
37020 @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
37021 @end smallexample
37022
37023 This command returns information about the source files @value{GDBN}
37024 knows about, it will output both the filename and fullname (absolute
37025 file name) of a source file, though the fullname can be elided if this
37026 information is not known to @value{GDBN}.
37027
37028 With no arguments this command returns a list of source files. Each
37029 source file is represented by a tuple with the fields; @var{file},
37030 @var{fullname}, and @var{debug-fully-read}. The @var{file} is the
37031 display name for the file, while @var{fullname} is the absolute name
37032 of the file. The @var{fullname} field can be elided if the absolute
37033 name of the source file can't be computed. The field
37034 @var{debug-fully-read} will be a string, either @code{true} or
37035 @code{false}. When @code{true}, this indicates the full debug
37036 information for the compilation unit describing this file has been
37037 read in. When @code{false}, the full debug information has not yet
37038 been read in. While reading in the full debug information it is
37039 possible that @value{GDBN} could become aware of additional source
37040 files.
37041
37042 The optional @var{regexp} can be used to filter the list of source
37043 files returned. The @var{regexp} will be matched against the full
37044 source file name. The matching is case-sensitive, except on operating
37045 systems that have case-insensitive filesystem (e.g.,
37046 MS-Windows). @samp{--} can be used before @var{regexp} to prevent
37047 @value{GDBN} interpreting @var{regexp} as a command option (e.g.@: if
37048 @var{regexp} starts with @samp{-}).
37049
37050 If @code{--dirname} is provided, then @var{regexp} is matched only
37051 against the directory name of each source file. If @code{--basename}
37052 is provided, then @var{regexp} is matched against the basename of each
37053 source file. Only one of @code{--dirname} or @code{--basename} may be
37054 given, and if either is given then @var{regexp} is required.
37055
37056 If @code{--group-by-objfile} is used then the format of the results is
37057 changed. The results will now be a list of tuples, with each tuple
37058 representing an object file (executable or shared library) loaded into
37059 @value{GDBN}. The fields of these tuples are; @var{filename},
37060 @var{debug-info}, and @var{sources}. The @var{filename} is the
37061 absolute name of the object file, @var{debug-info} is a string with
37062 one of the following values:
37063
37064 @table @code
37065 @item none
37066 This object file has no debug information.
37067 @item partially-read
37068 This object file has debug information, but it is not fully read in
37069 yet. When it is read in later, GDB might become aware of additional
37070 source files.
37071 @item fully-read
37072 This object file has debug information, and this information is fully
37073 read into GDB. The list of source files is complete.
37074 @end table
37075
37076 The @var{sources} is a list or tuples, with each tuple describing a
37077 single source file with the same fields as described previously. The
37078 @var{sources} list can be empty for object files that have no debug
37079 information.
37080
37081 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37082
37083 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
37084 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
37085
37086 @subsubheading Example
37087 @smallexample
37088 (@value{GDBP})
37089 -file-list-exec-source-files
37090 ^done,files=[@{file="foo.c",fullname="/home/foo.c",debug-fully-read="true"@},
37091 @{file="/home/bar.c",fullname="/home/bar.c",debug-fully-read="true"@},
37092 @{file="gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c",debug-fully-read="true"@}]
37093 (@value{GDBP})
37094 -file-list-exec-source-files
37095 ^done,files=[@{file="test.c",
37096 fullname="/tmp/info-sources/test.c",
37097 debug-fully-read="true"@},
37098 @{file="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
37099 fullname="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
37100 debug-fully-read="true"@},
37101 @{file="header.h",
37102 fullname="/tmp/info-sources/header.h",
37103 debug-fully-read="true"@},
37104 @{file="helper.c",
37105 fullname="/tmp/info-sources/helper.c",
37106 debug-fully-read="true"@}]
37107 (@value{GDBP})
37108 -file-list-exec-source-files -- \\.c
37109 ^done,files=[@{file="test.c",
37110 fullname="/tmp/info-sources/test.c",
37111 debug-fully-read="true"@},
37112 @{file="helper.c",
37113 fullname="/tmp/info-sources/helper.c",
37114 debug-fully-read="true"@}]
37115 (@value{GDBP})
37116 -file-list-exec-source-files --group-by-objfile
37117 ^done,files=[@{filename="/tmp/info-sources/test.x",
37118 debug-info="fully-read",
37119 sources=[@{file="test.c",
37120 fullname="/tmp/info-sources/test.c",
37121 debug-fully-read="true"@},
37122 @{file="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
37123 fullname="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
37124 debug-fully-read="true"@},
37125 @{file="header.h",
37126 fullname="/tmp/info-sources/header.h",
37127 debug-fully-read="true"@}]@},
37128 @{filename="/lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2",
37129 debug-info="none",
37130 sources=[]@},
37131 @{filename="system-supplied DSO at 0x7ffff7fcf000",
37132 debug-info="none",
37133 sources=[]@},
37134 @{filename="/tmp/info-sources/libhelper.so",
37135 debug-info="fully-read",
37136 sources=[@{file="helper.c",
37137 fullname="/tmp/info-sources/helper.c",
37138 debug-fully-read="true"@},
37139 @{file="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
37140 fullname="/usr/include/stdc-predef.h",
37141 debug-fully-read="true"@},
37142 @{file="header.h",
37143 fullname="/tmp/info-sources/header.h",
37144 debug-fully-read="true"@}]@},
37145 @{filename="/lib64/libc.so.6",
37146 debug-info="none",
37147 sources=[]@}]
37148 @end smallexample
37149
37150 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
37151 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
37152
37153 @subsubheading Synopsis
37154
37155 @smallexample
37156 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
37157 @end smallexample
37158
37159 List the shared libraries in the program.
37160 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
37161 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
37162
37163 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37164
37165 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
37166 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
37167 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
37168 library. Each range has the following fields:
37169
37170 @table @samp
37171 @item from
37172 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
37173 @item to
37174 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
37175 @end table
37176
37177 @subsubheading Example
37178 @smallexample
37179 (gdb)
37180 -file-list-exec-source-files
37181 ^done,shared-libraries=[
37182 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
37183 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
37184 (gdb)
37185 @end smallexample
37186
37187
37188 @ignore
37189 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
37190 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
37191
37192 @subsubheading Synopsis
37193
37194 @smallexample
37195 -file-list-symbol-files
37196 @end smallexample
37197
37198 List symbol files.
37199
37200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37201
37202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
37203
37204 @subsubheading Example
37205 N.A.
37206 @end ignore
37207
37208
37209 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
37210 @findex -file-symbol-file
37211
37212 @subsubheading Synopsis
37213
37214 @smallexample
37215 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
37216 @end smallexample
37217
37218 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
37219 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
37220 produced, except for a completion notification.
37221
37222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37223
37224 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
37225
37226 @subsubheading Example
37227
37228 @smallexample
37229 (gdb)
37230 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
37231 ^done
37232 (gdb)
37233 @end smallexample
37234
37235 @ignore
37236 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
37237 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
37238 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
37239
37240 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
37241
37242 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
37243
37244 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
37245
37246 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
37247
37248 @c @subheading -overlay-map
37249
37250 @c @subheading -overlay-off
37251
37252 @c @subheading -overlay-on
37253
37254 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
37255
37256 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
37257 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
37258 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
37259
37260 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
37261
37262 @c @subheading -signal-handle
37263
37264 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
37265
37266 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
37267 @end ignore
37268
37269
37270 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
37271 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
37272 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
37273
37274
37275 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
37276 @findex -target-attach
37277
37278 @subsubheading Synopsis
37279
37280 @smallexample
37281 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
37282 @end smallexample
37283
37284 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
37285 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
37286 group, the id previously returned by
37287 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
37288
37289 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37290
37291 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
37292
37293 @subsubheading Example
37294 @smallexample
37295 (gdb)
37296 -target-attach 34
37297 =thread-created,id="1"
37298 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
37299 ^done
37300 (gdb)
37301 @end smallexample
37302
37303 @ignore
37304 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
37305 @findex -target-compare-sections
37306
37307 @subsubheading Synopsis
37308
37309 @smallexample
37310 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
37311 @end smallexample
37312
37313 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
37314 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
37315
37316 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37317
37318 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
37319
37320 @subsubheading Example
37321 N.A.
37322 @end ignore
37323
37324
37325 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
37326 @findex -target-detach
37327
37328 @subsubheading Synopsis
37329
37330 @smallexample
37331 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
37332 @end smallexample
37333
37334 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
37335 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
37336 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
37337
37338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37339
37340 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
37341
37342 @subsubheading Example
37343
37344 @smallexample
37345 (gdb)
37346 -target-detach
37347 ^done
37348 (gdb)
37349 @end smallexample
37350
37351
37352 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
37353 @findex -target-disconnect
37354
37355 @subsubheading Synopsis
37356
37357 @smallexample
37358 -target-disconnect
37359 @end smallexample
37360
37361 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
37362 generally not resumed.
37363
37364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37365
37366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
37367
37368 @subsubheading Example
37369
37370 @smallexample
37371 (gdb)
37372 -target-disconnect
37373 ^done
37374 (gdb)
37375 @end smallexample
37376
37377
37378 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
37379 @findex -target-download
37380
37381 @subsubheading Synopsis
37382
37383 @smallexample
37384 -target-download
37385 @end smallexample
37386
37387 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
37388 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
37389
37390 @table @samp
37391 @item section
37392 The name of the section.
37393 @item section-sent
37394 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
37395 @item section-size
37396 The size of the section.
37397 @item total-sent
37398 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
37399 @item total-size
37400 The size of the overall executable to download.
37401 @end table
37402
37403 @noindent
37404 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
37405 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
37406
37407 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
37408 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
37409
37410 @table @samp
37411 @item section
37412 The name of the section.
37413 @item section-size
37414 The size of the section.
37415 @item total-size
37416 The size of the overall executable to download.
37417 @end table
37418
37419 @noindent
37420 At the end, a summary is printed.
37421
37422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37423
37424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
37425
37426 @subsubheading Example
37427
37428 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
37429 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
37430
37431 @smallexample
37432 (gdb)
37433 -target-download
37434 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
37435 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
37436 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
37437 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
37438 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
37439 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
37440 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
37441 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
37442 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
37443 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
37444 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
37445 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
37446 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
37447 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
37448 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
37449 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
37450 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
37451 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
37452 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
37453 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
37454 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
37455 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
37456 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
37457 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
37458 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
37459 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
37460 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
37461 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
37462 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
37463 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
37464 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
37465 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
37466 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
37467 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
37468 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
37469 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
37470 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
37471 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
37472 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
37473 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
37474 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
37475 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
37476 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
37477 write-rate="429"
37478 (gdb)
37479 @end smallexample
37480
37481
37482 @ignore
37483 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
37484 @findex -target-exec-status
37485
37486 @subsubheading Synopsis
37487
37488 @smallexample
37489 -target-exec-status
37490 @end smallexample
37491
37492 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
37493 not, for instance).
37494
37495 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37496
37497 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
37498
37499 @subsubheading Example
37500 N.A.
37501
37502
37503 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
37504 @findex -target-list-available-targets
37505
37506 @subsubheading Synopsis
37507
37508 @smallexample
37509 -target-list-available-targets
37510 @end smallexample
37511
37512 List the possible targets to connect to.
37513
37514 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37515
37516 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
37517
37518 @subsubheading Example
37519 N.A.
37520
37521
37522 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
37523 @findex -target-list-current-targets
37524
37525 @subsubheading Synopsis
37526
37527 @smallexample
37528 -target-list-current-targets
37529 @end smallexample
37530
37531 Describe the current target.
37532
37533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37534
37535 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
37536 other things).
37537
37538 @subsubheading Example
37539 N.A.
37540
37541
37542 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
37543 @findex -target-list-parameters
37544
37545 @subsubheading Synopsis
37546
37547 @smallexample
37548 -target-list-parameters
37549 @end smallexample
37550
37551 @c ????
37552 @end ignore
37553
37554 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37555
37556 No equivalent.
37557
37558 @subsubheading Example
37559 N.A.
37560
37561 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
37562 @findex -target-flash-erase
37563
37564 @subsubheading Synopsis
37565
37566 @smallexample
37567 -target-flash-erase
37568 @end smallexample
37569
37570 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
37571
37572 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
37573
37574 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
37575 addresses and memory region sizes.
37576
37577 @smallexample
37578 (gdb)
37579 -target-flash-erase
37580 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
37581 (gdb)
37582 @end smallexample
37583
37584 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
37585 @findex -target-select
37586
37587 @subsubheading Synopsis
37588
37589 @smallexample
37590 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
37591 @end smallexample
37592
37593 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
37594
37595 @table @samp
37596 @item @var{type}
37597 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
37598 @item @var{parameters}
37599 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
37600 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
37601 @end table
37602
37603 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
37604 which the target program is, in the following form:
37605
37606 @smallexample
37607 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
37608 args=[@var{arg list}]
37609 @end smallexample
37610
37611 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37612
37613 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
37614
37615 @subsubheading Example
37616
37617 @smallexample
37618 (gdb)
37619 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
37620 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
37621 (gdb)
37622 @end smallexample
37623
37624 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
37625 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
37626 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
37627
37628
37629 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
37630 @findex -target-file-put
37631
37632 @subsubheading Synopsis
37633
37634 @smallexample
37635 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
37636 @end smallexample
37637
37638 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
37639 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
37640
37641 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37642
37643 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
37644
37645 @subsubheading Example
37646
37647 @smallexample
37648 (gdb)
37649 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
37650 ^done
37651 (gdb)
37652 @end smallexample
37653
37654
37655 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
37656 @findex -target-file-get
37657
37658 @subsubheading Synopsis
37659
37660 @smallexample
37661 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
37662 @end smallexample
37663
37664 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
37665 on the host system.
37666
37667 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37668
37669 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
37670
37671 @subsubheading Example
37672
37673 @smallexample
37674 (gdb)
37675 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
37676 ^done
37677 (gdb)
37678 @end smallexample
37679
37680
37681 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
37682 @findex -target-file-delete
37683
37684 @subsubheading Synopsis
37685
37686 @smallexample
37687 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
37688 @end smallexample
37689
37690 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
37691
37692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37693
37694 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
37695
37696 @subsubheading Example
37697
37698 @smallexample
37699 (gdb)
37700 -target-file-delete remotefile
37701 ^done
37702 (gdb)
37703 @end smallexample
37704
37705
37706 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
37707 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
37708 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
37709
37710 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
37711 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
37712
37713 @subsubheading Synopsis
37714
37715 @smallexample
37716 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
37717 @end smallexample
37718
37719 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
37720 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
37721 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
37722
37723 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37724
37725 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
37726
37727 @subsubheading Result
37728
37729 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
37730 defined for each exception:
37731
37732 @table @samp
37733 @item name
37734 The name of the exception.
37735
37736 @item address
37737 The address of the exception.
37738
37739 @end table
37740
37741 @subsubheading Example
37742
37743 @smallexample
37744 -info-ada-exceptions aint
37745 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
37746 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
37747 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
37748 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
37749 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
37750 @end smallexample
37751
37752 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
37753
37754 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
37755 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
37756 Catchpoint Commands}.
37757
37758
37759 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
37760 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
37761 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
37762
37763 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
37764 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
37765 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
37766 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
37767
37768 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
37769 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
37770 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
37771
37772 @subsubheading Synopsis
37773
37774 @smallexample
37775 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
37776 @end smallexample
37777
37778 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
37779
37780 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
37781 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
37782 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
37783 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
37784 dash.
37785
37786 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37787
37788 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
37789
37790 @subsubheading Result
37791
37792 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
37793
37794 @table @samp
37795 @item exists
37796 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
37797 @code{"false"} otherwise.
37798
37799 @end table
37800
37801 @subsubheading Example
37802
37803 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
37804
37805 @smallexample
37806 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
37807 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
37808 @end smallexample
37809
37810 @noindent
37811 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
37812 to the debugger:
37813
37814 @smallexample
37815 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
37816 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
37817 @end smallexample
37818
37819 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
37820 @findex -list-features
37821 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
37822
37823 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
37824 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
37825 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
37826 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
37827 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
37828 startup.
37829
37830 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
37831 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
37832 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
37833 is given below.
37834
37835 Example output:
37836
37837 @smallexample
37838 (gdb) -list-features
37839 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
37840 @end smallexample
37841
37842 The current list of features is:
37843
37844 @ftable @samp
37845 @item frozen-varobjs
37846 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
37847 as possible presence of the @code{frozen} field in the output
37848 of @code{-varobj-create}.
37849 @item pending-breakpoints
37850 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
37851 command.
37852 @item python
37853 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
37854 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
37855 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
37856 @item thread-info
37857 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
37858 @item data-read-memory-bytes
37859 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
37860 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
37861 @item breakpoint-notifications
37862 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
37863 CLI will be announced via async records.
37864 @item ada-task-info
37865 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
37866 @item language-option
37867 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
37868 option (@pxref{Context management}).
37869 @item info-gdb-mi-command
37870 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
37871 @item undefined-command-error-code
37872 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
37873 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
37874 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
37875 @item exec-run-start-option
37876 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
37877 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
37878 @item data-disassemble-a-option
37879 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
37880 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
37881 @end ftable
37882
37883 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
37884 @findex -list-target-features
37885
37886 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
37887 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
37888 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
37889 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
37890 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
37891 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
37892 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
37893 Example output:
37894
37895 @smallexample
37896 (gdb) -list-target-features
37897 ^done,result=["async"]
37898 @end smallexample
37899
37900 The current list of features is:
37901
37902 @table @samp
37903 @item async
37904 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
37905 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
37906 while the target is running.
37907
37908 @item reverse
37909 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
37910 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37911
37912 @end table
37913
37914 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
37915 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
37916 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
37917
37918 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
37919
37920 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
37921 @findex -gdb-exit
37922
37923 @subsubheading Synopsis
37924
37925 @smallexample
37926 -gdb-exit
37927 @end smallexample
37928
37929 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
37930
37931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37932
37933 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
37934
37935 @subsubheading Example
37936
37937 @smallexample
37938 (gdb)
37939 -gdb-exit
37940 ^exit
37941 @end smallexample
37942
37943
37944 @ignore
37945 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
37946 @findex -exec-abort
37947
37948 @subsubheading Synopsis
37949
37950 @smallexample
37951 -exec-abort
37952 @end smallexample
37953
37954 Kill the inferior running program.
37955
37956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37957
37958 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
37959
37960 @subsubheading Example
37961 N.A.
37962 @end ignore
37963
37964
37965 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
37966 @findex -gdb-set
37967
37968 @subsubheading Synopsis
37969
37970 @smallexample
37971 -gdb-set
37972 @end smallexample
37973
37974 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
37975 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
37976
37977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
37978
37979 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
37980
37981 @subsubheading Example
37982
37983 @smallexample
37984 (gdb)
37985 -gdb-set $foo=3
37986 ^done
37987 (gdb)
37988 @end smallexample
37989
37990
37991 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
37992 @findex -gdb-show
37993
37994 @subsubheading Synopsis
37995
37996 @smallexample
37997 -gdb-show
37998 @end smallexample
37999
38000 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
38001
38002 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
38003
38004 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
38005
38006 @subsubheading Example
38007
38008 @smallexample
38009 (gdb)
38010 -gdb-show annotate
38011 ^done,value="0"
38012 (gdb)
38013 @end smallexample
38014
38015 @c @subheading -gdb-source
38016
38017
38018 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
38019 @findex -gdb-version
38020
38021 @subsubheading Synopsis
38022
38023 @smallexample
38024 -gdb-version
38025 @end smallexample
38026
38027 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
38028
38029 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
38030
38031 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
38032 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
38033
38034 @subsubheading Example
38035
38036 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
38037 @c box in TeX.
38038 @smallexample
38039 (gdb)
38040 -gdb-version
38041 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
38042 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
38043 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
38044 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
38045 ~ certain conditions.
38046 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
38047 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
38048 ~ details.
38049 ~This GDB was configured as
38050 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
38051 ^done
38052 (gdb)
38053 @end smallexample
38054
38055 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
38056 @findex -list-thread-groups
38057
38058 @subheading Synopsis
38059
38060 @smallexample
38061 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
38062 @end smallexample
38063
38064 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
38065 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
38066 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
38067 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
38068 top-level thread groups.
38069
38070 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
38071 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
38072 available on the target.
38073
38074 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
38075 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
38076 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
38077 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
38078 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
38079 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
38080 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
38081 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
38082
38083 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
38084 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
38085 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
38086 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
38087 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
38088 @samp{threads} field.
38089
38090 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
38091 the following caveats:
38092
38093 @itemize @bullet
38094 @item
38095 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
38096 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
38097 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
38098
38099 @item
38100 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
38101 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
38102 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
38103 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
38104 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
38105 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
38106
38107 @end itemize
38108
38109 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
38110 have the following fields:
38111
38112 @table @code
38113 @item id
38114 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
38115 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
38116 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
38117
38118 @item type
38119 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
38120 valid type.
38121
38122 @item pid
38123 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
38124 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
38125
38126 @item exit-code
38127 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
38128 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
38129 only if the process is not running.
38130
38131 @item num_children
38132 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
38133 absent for an available thread group.
38134
38135 @item threads
38136 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
38137 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
38138 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
38139
38140 @item cores
38141 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
38142 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
38143 such information is not available.
38144
38145 @item executable
38146 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
38147 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
38148 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
38149
38150 @end table
38151
38152 @subheading Example
38153
38154 @smallexample
38155 (@value{GDBP})
38156 -list-thread-groups
38157 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
38158 -list-thread-groups 17
38159 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
38160 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
38161 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
38162 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
38163 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
38164 -list-thread-groups --available
38165 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
38166 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
38167 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
38168 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
38169 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
38170 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
38171 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
38172 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
38173 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
38174 @end smallexample
38175
38176 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
38177 @findex -info-os
38178
38179 @subsubheading Synopsis
38180
38181 @smallexample
38182 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
38183 @end smallexample
38184
38185 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
38186 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
38187 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
38188 of data of that type.
38189
38190 The types of information available depend on the target operating
38191 system.
38192
38193 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
38194
38195 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
38196
38197 @subsubheading Example
38198
38199 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
38200 like this:
38201
38202 @smallexample
38203 (@value{GDBP})
38204 -info-os
38205 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
38206 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
38207 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
38208 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
38209 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
38210 col2="CPUs"@},
38211 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
38212 col2="File descriptors"@},
38213 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
38214 col2="Kernel modules"@},
38215 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
38216 col2="Message queues"@},
38217 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
38218 col2="Processes"@},
38219 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
38220 col2="Process groups"@},
38221 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
38222 col2="Semaphores"@},
38223 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
38224 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
38225 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
38226 col2="Sockets"@},
38227 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
38228 col2="Threads"@}]
38229 (@value{GDBP})
38230 -info-os processes
38231 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
38232 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
38233 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
38234 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
38235 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
38236 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
38237 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
38238 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
38239 ...
38240 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
38241 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
38242 (@value{GDBP})
38243 @end smallexample
38244
38245 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
38246 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
38247 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
38248 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
38249 @code{info os} omits it.)
38250
38251 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
38252 @findex -add-inferior
38253
38254 @subheading Synopsis
38255
38256 @smallexample
38257 -add-inferior [ --no-connection ]
38258 @end smallexample
38259
38260 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors Connections and Programs}). The created
38261 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
38262 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
38263 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}).
38264
38265 By default, the new inferior begins connected to the same target
38266 connection as the current inferior. For example, if the current
38267 inferior was connected to @code{gdbserver} with @code{target remote},
38268 then the new inferior will be connected to the same @code{gdbserver}
38269 instance. The @samp{--no-connection} option starts the new inferior
38270 with no connection yet. You can then for example use the
38271 @code{-target-select remote} command to connect to some other
38272 @code{gdbserver} instance, use @code{-exec-run} to spawn a local
38273 program, etc.
38274
38275 The command response always has a field, @var{inferior}, whose value
38276 is the identifier of the thread group corresponding to the new
38277 inferior.
38278
38279 An additional section field, @var{connection}, is optional. This
38280 field will only exist if the new inferior has a target connection. If
38281 this field exists, then its value will be a tuple containing the
38282 following fields:
38283
38284 @table @samp
38285 @item number
38286 The number of the connection used for the new inferior.
38287
38288 @item name
38289 The name of the connection type used for the new inferior.
38290 @end table
38291
38292 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
38293
38294 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{add-inferior}
38295 (@pxref{add_inferior_cli,,@samp{add-inferior}}).
38296
38297 @subheading Example
38298
38299 @smallexample
38300 (@value{GDBP})
38301 -add-inferior
38302 ^done,inferior="i3"
38303 @end smallexample
38304
38305 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
38306 @findex -interpreter-exec
38307
38308 @subheading Synopsis
38309
38310 @smallexample
38311 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
38312 @end smallexample
38313 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
38314
38315 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
38316
38317 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
38318
38319 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
38320
38321 @subheading Example
38322
38323 @smallexample
38324 (gdb)
38325 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
38326 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
38327 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
38328 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
38329 ^done
38330 (gdb)
38331 @end smallexample
38332
38333 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
38334 @findex -inferior-tty-set
38335
38336 @subheading Synopsis
38337
38338 @smallexample
38339 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
38340 @end smallexample
38341
38342 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
38343
38344 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
38345
38346 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
38347
38348 @subheading Example
38349
38350 @smallexample
38351 (gdb)
38352 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
38353 ^done
38354 (gdb)
38355 @end smallexample
38356
38357 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
38358 @findex -inferior-tty-show
38359
38360 @subheading Synopsis
38361
38362 @smallexample
38363 -inferior-tty-show
38364 @end smallexample
38365
38366 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
38367
38368 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
38369
38370 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
38371
38372 @subheading Example
38373
38374 @smallexample
38375 (gdb)
38376 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
38377 ^done
38378 (gdb)
38379 -inferior-tty-show
38380 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
38381 (gdb)
38382 @end smallexample
38383
38384 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
38385 @findex -enable-timings
38386
38387 @subheading Synopsis
38388
38389 @smallexample
38390 -enable-timings [yes | no]
38391 @end smallexample
38392
38393 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
38394 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
38395 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
38396 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
38397
38398 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
38399
38400 No equivalent.
38401
38402 @subheading Example
38403
38404 @smallexample
38405 (gdb)
38406 -enable-timings
38407 ^done
38408 (gdb)
38409 -break-insert main
38410 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
38411 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
38412 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
38413 times="0"@},
38414 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
38415 (gdb)
38416 -enable-timings no
38417 ^done
38418 (gdb)
38419 -exec-run
38420 ^running
38421 (gdb)
38422 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
38423 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
38424 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
38425 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
38426 (gdb)
38427 @end smallexample
38428
38429 @subheading The @code{-complete} Command
38430 @findex -complete
38431
38432 @subheading Synopsis
38433
38434 @smallexample
38435 -complete @var{command}
38436 @end smallexample
38437
38438 Show a list of completions for partially typed CLI @var{command}.
38439
38440 This command is intended for @sc{gdb/mi} frontends that cannot use two separate
38441 CLI and MI channels --- for example: because of lack of PTYs like on Windows or
38442 because @value{GDBN} is used remotely via a SSH connection.
38443
38444 @subheading Result
38445
38446 The result consists of two or three fields:
38447
38448 @table @samp
38449 @item completion
38450 This field contains the completed @var{command}. If @var{command}
38451 has no known completions, this field is omitted.
38452
38453 @item matches
38454 This field contains a (possibly empty) array of matches. It is always present.
38455
38456 @item max_completions_reached
38457 This field contains @code{1} if number of known completions is above
38458 @code{max-completions} limit (@pxref{Completion}), otherwise it contains
38459 @code{0}. It is always present.
38460
38461 @end table
38462
38463 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
38464
38465 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{complete}.
38466
38467 @subheading Example
38468
38469 @smallexample
38470 (gdb)
38471 -complete br
38472 ^done,completion="break",
38473 matches=["break","break-range"],
38474 max_completions_reached="0"
38475 (gdb)
38476 -complete "b ma"
38477 ^done,completion="b ma",
38478 matches=["b madvise","b main"],max_completions_reached="0"
38479 (gdb)
38480 -complete "b push_b"
38481 ^done,completion="b push_back(",
38482 matches=[
38483 "b A::push_back(void*)",
38484 "b std::string::push_back(char)",
38485 "b std::vector<int, std::allocator<int> >::push_back(int&&)"],
38486 max_completions_reached="0"
38487 (gdb)
38488 -complete "nonexist"
38489 ^done,matches=[],max_completions_reached="0"
38490 (gdb)
38491
38492 @end smallexample
38493
38494 @node Annotations
38495 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
38496
38497 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
38498 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
38499 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
38500 relatively high level.
38501
38502 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
38503 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
38504
38505 @ignore
38506 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
38507 @end ignore
38508
38509 @menu
38510 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
38511 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
38512 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
38513 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
38514 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
38515 * Annotations for Running::
38516 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
38517 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
38518 @end menu
38519
38520 @node Annotations Overview
38521 @section What is an Annotation?
38522 @cindex annotations
38523
38524 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
38525 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
38526 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
38527 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
38528 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
38529 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
38530 cannot contain newline characters.
38531
38532 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
38533 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
38534 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
38535 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
38536 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
38537 means those three characters as output.
38538
38539 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
38540 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
38541 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
38542 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
38543 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
38544 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
38545 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
38546 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
38547 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
38548
38549 @table @code
38550 @kindex set annotate
38551 @item set annotate @var{level}
38552 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
38553 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
38554
38555 @item show annotate
38556 @kindex show annotate
38557 Show the current annotation level.
38558 @end table
38559
38560 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
38561
38562 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
38563
38564 @smallexample
38565 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
38566 GNU gdb 6.0
38567 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
38568 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
38569 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
38570 under certain conditions.
38571 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
38572 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
38573 for details.
38574 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
38575
38576 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
38577 (@value{GDBP})
38578 ^Z^Zprompt
38579 @kbd{quit}
38580
38581 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
38582 $
38583 @end smallexample
38584
38585 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
38586 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
38587 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
38588 output from @value{GDBN}.
38589
38590 @node Server Prefix
38591 @section The Server Prefix
38592 @cindex server prefix
38593
38594 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
38595 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
38596 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
38597 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
38598 a transparent manner.
38599
38600 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
38601 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
38602 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
38603 @code{print} command.
38604
38605 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
38606 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
38607
38608 @node Prompting
38609 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
38610
38611 @cindex annotations for prompts
38612 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
38613 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
38614 over, etc.
38615
38616 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
38617 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
38618 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
38619 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
38620 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
38621 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
38622 features the following annotations:
38623
38624 @smallexample
38625 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
38626 ^Z^Zprompt
38627 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
38628 @end smallexample
38629
38630 The input types are
38631
38632 @table @code
38633 @findex pre-prompt annotation
38634 @findex prompt annotation
38635 @findex post-prompt annotation
38636 @item prompt
38637 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
38638
38639 @findex pre-commands annotation
38640 @findex commands annotation
38641 @findex post-commands annotation
38642 @item commands
38643 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
38644 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
38645
38646 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
38647 @findex overload-choice annotation
38648 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
38649 @item overload-choice
38650 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
38651
38652 @findex pre-query annotation
38653 @findex query annotation
38654 @findex post-query annotation
38655 @item query
38656 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
38657
38658 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
38659 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
38660 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
38661 @item prompt-for-continue
38662 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
38663 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
38664 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
38665 presence of annotations.
38666 @end table
38667
38668 @node Errors
38669 @section Errors
38670 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
38671
38672 @findex quit annotation
38673 @smallexample
38674 ^Z^Zquit
38675 @end smallexample
38676
38677 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
38678
38679 @findex error annotation
38680 @smallexample
38681 ^Z^Zerror
38682 @end smallexample
38683
38684 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
38685
38686 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
38687 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
38688 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
38689 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
38690 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
38691 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
38692 to the top level.
38693
38694 @findex error-begin annotation
38695 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
38696
38697 @smallexample
38698 ^Z^Zerror-begin
38699 @end smallexample
38700
38701 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
38702 message.
38703
38704 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
38705 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
38706 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
38707
38708 @node Invalidation
38709 @section Invalidation Notices
38710
38711 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
38712 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
38713 changed.
38714
38715 @table @code
38716 @findex frames-invalid annotation
38717 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
38718
38719 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
38720 have changed.
38721
38722 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
38723 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
38724
38725 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
38726 deleted a breakpoint.
38727 @end table
38728
38729 @node Annotations for Running
38730 @section Running the Program
38731 @cindex annotations for running programs
38732
38733 @findex starting annotation
38734 @findex stopping annotation
38735 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
38736 @code{step} or @code{continue},
38737
38738 @smallexample
38739 ^Z^Zstarting
38740 @end smallexample
38741
38742 is output. When the program stops,
38743
38744 @smallexample
38745 ^Z^Zstopped
38746 @end smallexample
38747
38748 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
38749 annotations describe how the program stopped.
38750
38751 @table @code
38752 @findex exited annotation
38753 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
38754 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
38755 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
38756
38757 @findex signalled annotation
38758 @findex signal-name annotation
38759 @findex signal-name-end annotation
38760 @findex signal-string annotation
38761 @findex signal-string-end annotation
38762 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
38763 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
38764 annotation continues:
38765
38766 @smallexample
38767 @var{intro-text}
38768 ^Z^Zsignal-name
38769 @var{name}
38770 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
38771 @var{middle-text}
38772 ^Z^Zsignal-string
38773 @var{string}
38774 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
38775 @var{end-text}
38776 @end smallexample
38777
38778 @noindent
38779 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
38780 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
38781 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
38782 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
38783 user's benefit and have no particular format.
38784
38785 @findex signal annotation
38786 @item ^Z^Zsignal
38787 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
38788 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
38789 terminated with it.
38790
38791 @findex breakpoint annotation
38792 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
38793 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
38794
38795 @findex watchpoint annotation
38796 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
38797 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
38798 @end table
38799
38800 @node Source Annotations
38801 @section Displaying Source
38802 @cindex annotations for source display
38803
38804 @findex source annotation
38805 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
38806
38807 @smallexample
38808 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
38809 @end smallexample
38810
38811 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
38812 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
38813 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
38814 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
38815 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
38816 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
38817 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
38818 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
38819 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
38820 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
38821 depend on the language).
38822
38823 @node JIT Interface
38824 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
38825 @cindex just-in-time compilation
38826 @cindex JIT compilation interface
38827
38828 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
38829 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
38830 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
38831 performance while maintaining platform independence.
38832
38833 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
38834 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
38835 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
38836 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
38837 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
38838 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
38839
38840 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
38841 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
38842 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
38843 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
38844 LLVM JIT.
38845
38846 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
38847 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
38848 variable and calling a function at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
38849 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
38850 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
38851 out about additional code.
38852
38853 @menu
38854 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
38855 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
38856 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
38857 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
38858 @end menu
38859
38860 @node Declarations
38861 @section JIT Declarations
38862
38863 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
38864 implement the interface:
38865
38866 @smallexample
38867 typedef enum
38868 @{
38869 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
38870 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
38871 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
38872 @} jit_actions_t;
38873
38874 struct jit_code_entry
38875 @{
38876 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
38877 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
38878 const char *symfile_addr;
38879 uint64_t symfile_size;
38880 @};
38881
38882 struct jit_descriptor
38883 @{
38884 uint32_t version;
38885 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
38886 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
38887 uint32_t action_flag;
38888 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
38889 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
38890 @};
38891
38892 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
38893 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
38894
38895 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
38896 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
38897 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
38898 @end smallexample
38899
38900 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
38901 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
38902 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
38903
38904 @node Registering Code
38905 @section Registering Code
38906
38907 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
38908
38909 @itemize @bullet
38910 @item
38911 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
38912 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
38913
38914 @item
38915 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
38916 file.
38917
38918 @item
38919 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
38920
38921 @item
38922 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
38923
38924 @item
38925 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
38926 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
38927 @end itemize
38928
38929 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
38930 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
38931 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
38932 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
38933
38934 @node Unregistering Code
38935 @section Unregistering Code
38936
38937 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
38938
38939 @itemize @bullet
38940 @item
38941 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
38942
38943 @item
38944 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
38945
38946 @item
38947 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
38948 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
38949 @end itemize
38950
38951 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
38952 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
38953
38954 @node Custom Debug Info
38955 @section Custom Debug Info
38956 @cindex custom JIT debug info
38957 @cindex JIT debug info reader
38958
38959 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
38960 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
38961 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
38962 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
38963 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
38964 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
38965 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
38966 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
38967 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
38968
38969 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
38970 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
38971 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
38972 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
38973 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
38974 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
38975 compiler.
38976
38977 @menu
38978 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
38979 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
38980 @end menu
38981
38982 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
38983 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
38984 @kindex jit-reader-load
38985 @kindex jit-reader-unload
38986
38987 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
38988 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
38989
38990 @table @code
38991 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
38992 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
38993 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
38994 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
38995 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
38996 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
38997 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
38998
38999 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
39000 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
39001 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
39002 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
39003 @code{jit-reader-load}.
39004
39005 @item jit-reader-unload
39006 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
39007
39008 @end table
39009
39010 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
39011 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
39012 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
39013
39014 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
39015 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
39016
39017 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
39018 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
39019 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
39020 the system include directory.
39021
39022 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
39023 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
39024 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
39025
39026 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
39027 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
39028
39029 @findex gdb_init_reader
39030 @smallexample
39031 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
39032 @end smallexample
39033
39034 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
39035
39036 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
39037 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
39038 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
39039 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
39040 (@code{get_frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
39041 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
39042
39043 @smallexample
39044 struct gdb_reader_funcs
39045 @{
39046 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
39047 int reader_version;
39048
39049 /* For use by the reader. */
39050 void *priv_data;
39051
39052 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
39053 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
39054 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
39055 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
39056 @};
39057 @end smallexample
39058
39059 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
39060 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
39061
39062 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
39063 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
39064 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
39065 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
39066 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
39067 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
39068 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
39069 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
39070 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
39071 target's address space.
39072
39073 @node In-Process Agent
39074 @chapter In-Process Agent
39075 @cindex debugging agent
39076 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
39077 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
39078 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
39079 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
39080 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
39081 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
39082 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
39083 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
39084 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
39085 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
39086 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
39087 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
39088 behavior without interrupting it.
39089
39090 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
39091 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
39092 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
39093 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
39094 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
39095 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
39096 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
39097 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
39098 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
39099
39100 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
39101 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
39102 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
39103 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
39104
39105 @anchor{Control Agent}
39106 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
39107 debugging with the following commands:
39108
39109 @table @code
39110 @kindex set agent on
39111 @item set agent on
39112 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
39113 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
39114 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
39115 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
39116 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
39117 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
39118
39119 @kindex set agent off
39120 @item set agent off
39121 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
39122 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
39123
39124 @kindex show agent
39125 @item show agent
39126 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
39127 the in-process agent.
39128 @end table
39129
39130 @menu
39131 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
39132 @end menu
39133
39134 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
39135 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
39136 @cindex in-process agent protocol
39137
39138 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
39139 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
39140 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
39141 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
39142 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
39143 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
39144 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
39145 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
39146 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
39147
39148 @menu
39149 * IPA Protocol Objects::
39150 * IPA Protocol Commands::
39151 @end menu
39152
39153 @node IPA Protocol Objects
39154 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
39155 @cindex ipa protocol objects
39156
39157 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
39158 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
39159
39160 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
39161 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
39162 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
39163 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
39164
39165 @enumerate
39166 @item
39167 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
39168 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
39169 @item
39170 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
39171 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
39172 the other one.
39173 @end enumerate
39174
39175 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
39176
39177 @enumerate
39178 @item
39179 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
39180 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
39181 @anchor{agent expression object}
39182 @item
39183 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
39184 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
39185 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
39186 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
39187 @item
39188 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39189 @anchor{tracepoint object}
39190
39191 @end enumerate
39192
39193 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
39194 object:
39195
39196 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
39197 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
39198 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
39199 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
39200 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
39201 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
39202 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
39203 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
39204 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
39205 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
39206 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
39207 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
39208 memory address for collecting.
39209 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
39210 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
39211 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
39212 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
39213 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
39214 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
39215 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
39216 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
39217 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
39218 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
39219 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
39220 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
39221 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
39222 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
39223 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
39224 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
39225 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
39226 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
39227 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
39228 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
39229 @ref{agent expression object}
39230 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
39231 @ref{agent expression object}
39232 @item actions @tab variable
39233 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
39234 @end multitable
39235
39236 @node IPA Protocol Commands
39237 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
39238 @cindex ipa protocol commands
39239
39240 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
39241 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
39242
39243 @table @samp
39244
39245 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
39246 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
39247 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
39248 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
39249 in IPA finally.
39250
39251 Replies:
39252 @table @samp
39253 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
39254 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
39255 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
39256 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
39257 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
39258 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
39259 @item E @var{NN}
39260 for an error
39261
39262 @end table
39263
39264 @item close
39265 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
39266 is about to kill inferiors.
39267
39268 @item qTfSTM
39269 @xref{qTfSTM}.
39270 @item qTsSTM
39271 @xref{qTsSTM}.
39272 @item qTSTMat
39273 @xref{qTSTMat}.
39274 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
39275 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
39276
39277 Replies:
39278 @table @samp
39279 @item E @var{NN}
39280 for an error
39281 @end table
39282 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
39283 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
39284 @end table
39285
39286 @node GDB Bugs
39287 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
39288 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
39289 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
39290
39291 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
39292
39293 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
39294 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
39295 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
39296 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
39297
39298 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
39299 information that enables us to fix the bug.
39300
39301 @menu
39302 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
39303 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
39304 @end menu
39305
39306 @node Bug Criteria
39307 @section Have You Found a Bug?
39308 @cindex bug criteria
39309
39310 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
39311
39312 @itemize @bullet
39313 @cindex fatal signal
39314 @cindex debugger crash
39315 @cindex crash of debugger
39316 @item
39317 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
39318 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
39319
39320 @cindex error on valid input
39321 @item
39322 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
39323 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
39324 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
39325
39326 @cindex invalid input
39327 @item
39328 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
39329 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
39330 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
39331 for traditional practice''.
39332
39333 @item
39334 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
39335 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
39336 @end itemize
39337
39338 @node Bug Reporting
39339 @section How to Report Bugs
39340 @cindex bug reports
39341 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
39342
39343 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
39344 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
39345 contact that organization first.
39346
39347 You can find contact information for many support companies and
39348 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
39349 distribution.
39350 @c should add a web page ref...
39351
39352 @ifset BUGURL
39353 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
39354 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
39355 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
39356 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
39357 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
39358 be used.
39359
39360 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
39361 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
39362 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
39363 @samp{bug-gdb}.
39364
39365 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
39366 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
39367 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
39368 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
39369 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
39370 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
39371 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
39372 bug reports to the mailing list.
39373 @end ifset
39374 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
39375 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
39376 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
39377 @end ifclear
39378 @end ifset
39379
39380 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
39381 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
39382 fact or leave it out, state it!
39383
39384 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
39385 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
39386 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
39387 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
39388 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
39389 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
39390 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
39391 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
39392 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
39393
39394 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
39395 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
39396 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
39397 self-contained.
39398
39399 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
39400 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
39401 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
39402 bugs properly.
39403
39404 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
39405
39406 @itemize @bullet
39407 @item
39408 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
39409 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
39410 version}.
39411
39412 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
39413 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
39414
39415 @item
39416 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
39417 version number.
39418
39419 @item
39420 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
39421 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
39422 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
39423 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
39424
39425 @item
39426 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
39427 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
39428
39429 @item
39430 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
39431 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
39432 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
39433 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
39434 those compilers.
39435
39436 @item
39437 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
39438 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
39439 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
39440 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
39441
39442 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
39443 and then we might not encounter the bug.
39444
39445 @item
39446 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
39447 reproduce the bug.
39448
39449 @item
39450 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
39451 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
39452
39453 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
39454 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
39455 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
39456 a chance to make a mistake.
39457
39458 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
39459 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
39460 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
39461 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
39462 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
39463 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
39464 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
39465 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
39466
39467 @pindex script
39468 @cindex recording a session script
39469 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
39470 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
39471 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
39472 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
39473
39474 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
39475 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
39476
39477 @item
39478 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
39479 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
39480 it by context, not by line number.
39481
39482 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
39483 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
39484
39485 @end itemize
39486
39487 Here are some things that are not necessary:
39488
39489 @itemize @bullet
39490 @item
39491 A description of the envelope of the bug.
39492
39493 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
39494 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
39495 changes will not affect it.
39496
39497 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
39498 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
39499 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
39500 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
39501
39502 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
39503 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
39504 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
39505 less time, and so on.
39506
39507 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
39508 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
39509
39510 @item
39511 A patch for the bug.
39512
39513 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
39514 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
39515 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
39516 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
39517
39518 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
39519 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
39520 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
39521 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
39522
39523 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
39524 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
39525 help us to understand.
39526
39527 @item
39528 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
39529
39530 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
39531 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
39532 @end itemize
39533
39534 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
39535 @c and consists of the two following files:
39536 @c rluser.texi
39537 @c hsuser.texi
39538 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
39539 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
39540 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
39541 @include rluser.texi
39542 @include hsuser.texi
39543 @end ifclear
39544
39545 @node In Memoriam
39546 @appendix In Memoriam
39547
39548 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
39549 contributors:
39550
39551 @table @code
39552 @item Fred Fish
39553 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
39554 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
39555 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
39556
39557 @item Michael Snyder
39558 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
39559 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
39560 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
39561 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
39562 @end table
39563
39564 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
39565 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
39566
39567 @node Formatting Documentation
39568 @appendix Formatting Documentation
39569
39570 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
39571 @cindex reference card
39572 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
39573 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
39574 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
39575 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
39576 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
39577 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
39578
39579 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
39580 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
39581
39582 @smallexample
39583 make refcard.dvi
39584 @end smallexample
39585
39586 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
39587 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
39588 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
39589 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
39590 your @sc{dvi} output program.
39591
39592 @cindex documentation
39593
39594 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
39595 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
39596 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
39597 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
39598 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
39599 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
39600
39601 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
39602 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
39603 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
39604 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
39605 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
39606 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
39607 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
39608 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
39609
39610 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
39611 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
39612 @code{makeinfo}.
39613
39614 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
39615 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
39616 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
39617
39618 @smallexample
39619 cd gdb
39620 make gdb.info
39621 @end smallexample
39622
39623 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
39624 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
39625 Texinfo definitions file.
39626
39627 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
39628 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
39629 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
39630 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
39631 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
39632 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
39633 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
39634
39635 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
39636 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
39637 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
39638 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
39639 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
39640 directory.
39641
39642 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
39643 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
39644 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
39645 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
39646
39647 @smallexample
39648 make gdb.dvi
39649 @end smallexample
39650
39651 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
39652
39653 @node Installing GDB
39654 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
39655 @cindex installation
39656
39657 @menu
39658 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
39659 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
39660 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
39661 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
39662 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
39663 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
39664 @end menu
39665
39666 @node Requirements
39667 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
39668 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
39669
39670 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
39671 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
39672
39673 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
39674 @table @asis
39675 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
39676 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
39677 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
39678
39679 @item GNU make
39680 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
39681 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
39682
39683 @item GMP (The GNU Multiple Precision Arithmetic Library)
39684 @value{GDBN} now uses GMP to perform some of its arithmetics.
39685 This library may be included with your operating system distribution;
39686 if it is not, you can get the latest version from
39687 @url{https://gmplib.org/}. If GMP is installed at an unusual path,
39688 you can use the @option{--with-gmp} option or options
39689 @option{--with-gmp-include} and @option{--with-gmp-lib} to specify
39690 its location.
39691
39692 @end table
39693
39694 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
39695 @table @asis
39696 @item Expat
39697 @anchor{Expat}
39698 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
39699 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
39700 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
39701 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
39702 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
39703 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
39704
39705 Expat is used for:
39706
39707 @itemize @bullet
39708 @item
39709 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
39710 @item
39711 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
39712 @item
39713 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
39714 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
39715 @item
39716 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
39717 @item
39718 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
39719 @item
39720 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
39721 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
39722 @end itemize
39723
39724 @item Guile
39725 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
39726 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
39727 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
39728 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
39729 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
39730 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
39731
39732 @item iconv
39733 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
39734 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
39735 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
39736 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
39737
39738 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
39739 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
39740 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
39741 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
39742 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
39743
39744 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
39745 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
39746 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
39747 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
39748 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
39749
39750 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
39751 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
39752 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
39753 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
39754 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
39755 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
39756 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
39757 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
39758 code to @samp{libiconv}.
39759
39760 @item lzma
39761 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
39762 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
39763 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
39764 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
39765 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
39766 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
39767 @option{--with-liblzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
39768
39769 @item MPFR
39770 @anchor{MPFR}
39771 @value{GDBN} now uses the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
39772 library. This library may be included with your operating system
39773 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
39774 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
39775 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
39776 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-mpfr} option or options
39777 @option{--with-mpfr-include} and @option{--with-mpfr-lib} to specify
39778 its location.
39779
39780 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
39781 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
39782 formats than the host.
39783
39784 @item Python
39785 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
39786 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
39787 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
39788 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
39789 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
39790 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
39791 installation of Python.
39792
39793 @item zlib
39794 @cindex compressed debug sections
39795 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
39796 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
39797 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
39798 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
39799 information in such binaries.
39800
39801 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
39802 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
39803 @url{http://zlib.net}.
39804 @end table
39805
39806 @node Running Configure
39807 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
39808 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
39809 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
39810 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
39811 build the @code{gdb} program.
39812 @iftex
39813 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
39814 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
39815 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
39816 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
39817 @end iftex
39818
39819 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
39820 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
39821 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
39822
39823 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
39824 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
39825
39826 @table @code
39827 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
39828 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
39829
39830 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
39831 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
39832
39833 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
39834 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
39835
39836 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
39837 @sc{gnu} include files
39838
39839 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
39840 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
39841
39842 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
39843 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
39844
39845 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
39846 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
39847 @end table
39848
39849 There may be other subdirectories as well.
39850
39851 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
39852 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
39853 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
39854
39855 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
39856 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
39857 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
39858 argument.
39859
39860 For example:
39861
39862 @smallexample
39863 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
39864 ./configure
39865 make
39866 @end smallexample
39867
39868 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
39869 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
39870 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
39871 directories.
39872
39873 @need 750
39874 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
39875 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
39876 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
39877
39878 @smallexample
39879 sh configure
39880 @end smallexample
39881
39882 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
39883 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
39884 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
39885 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
39886 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
39887 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
39888 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
39889 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
39890 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
39891
39892 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
39893 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
39894 install it with @code{make install}.
39895
39896 @node Separate Objdir
39897 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
39898
39899 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
39900 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
39901 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
39902 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
39903 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
39904 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
39905 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
39906 program specified there.
39907
39908 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
39909 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
39910 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
39911 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
39912 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
39913 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
39914
39915 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
39916 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
39917
39918 @smallexample
39919 @group
39920 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
39921 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
39922 cd ../gdb-sun4
39923 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
39924 make
39925 @end group
39926 @end smallexample
39927
39928 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
39929 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
39930 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
39931 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
39932 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
39933 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
39934
39935 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
39936 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
39937 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
39938 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
39939 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
39940
39941 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
39942 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
39943 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
39944 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
39945 You specify a cross-debugging target by
39946 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
39947
39948 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
39949 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
39950 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
39951
39952 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
39953 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
39954 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
39955 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
39956 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
39957
39958 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
39959 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
39960 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
39961 with each other.
39962
39963 @node Config Names
39964 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
39965
39966 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
39967 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
39968 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
39969 of information in the following pattern:
39970
39971 @smallexample
39972 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
39973 @end smallexample
39974
39975 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
39976 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
39977 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
39978
39979 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
39980 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
39981 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
39982 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
39983 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
39984 abbreviations---for example:
39985
39986 @smallexample
39987 % sh config.sub i386-linux
39988 i386-pc-linux-gnu
39989 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
39990 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
39991 % sh config.sub hp9k700
39992 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
39993 % sh config.sub sun4
39994 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
39995 % sh config.sub sun3
39996 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
39997 % sh config.sub i986v
39998 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
39999 @end smallexample
40000
40001 @noindent
40002 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
40003 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
40004
40005 @node Configure Options
40006 @section @file{configure} Options
40007
40008 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
40009 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
40010 also has several other options not listed here. @xref{Running
40011 configure Scripts,,,autoconf}, for a full
40012 explanation of @file{configure}.
40013
40014 @smallexample
40015 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
40016 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
40017 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
40018 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
40019 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
40020 @end smallexample
40021
40022 @noindent
40023 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
40024 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
40025 @samp{--}.
40026
40027 @table @code
40028 @item --help
40029 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
40030
40031 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
40032 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
40033 @file{@var{dir}}.
40034
40035 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
40036 Configure the source to install programs under directory
40037 @file{@var{dir}}.
40038
40039 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
40040 @need 2000
40041 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
40042 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
40043 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
40044 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
40045 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
40046 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
40047 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
40048 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
40049 @var{dirname}.
40050
40051 @item --target=@var{target}
40052 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
40053 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
40054 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
40055
40056 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
40057 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
40058 @end table
40059
40060 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
40061 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
40062 options not described here.
40063
40064 @table @code
40065 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
40066 @itemx --enable-targets=all
40067 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
40068 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
40069 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
40070
40071 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
40072 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
40073 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
40074 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadir} (which can be set using
40075 @code{--datadir}).
40076
40077 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
40078 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
40079 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
40080 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
40081 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
40082 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
40083 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
40084 after it is built.
40085
40086 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
40087 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
40088
40089 @item --disable-gdbmi
40090 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
40091 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
40092
40093 @item --enable-tui
40094 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
40095 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
40096 supported).
40097
40098 @item --with-curses
40099 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
40100 terminal operations.
40101
40102 @item --with-debuginfod
40103 Build @value{GDBN} with @file{libdebuginfod}, the @code{debuginfod} client
40104 library. Used to automatically fetch ELF, DWARF and source files from
40105 @code{debuginfod} servers using build IDs associated with any missing
40106 files. Enabled by default if @file{libdebuginfod} is installed and found
40107 at configure time. For more information regarding @code{debuginfod} see
40108 @ref{Debuginfod}.
40109
40110 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
40111 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
40112 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
40113 details.
40114
40115 @item --with-system-readline
40116 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
40117 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}. Readline 7 or newer is
40118 required; this is enforced by the build system.
40119
40120 @item --with-system-zlib
40121 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
40122 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
40123
40124 @item --with-expat
40125 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
40126 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
40127 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
40128 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
40129 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
40130 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
40131 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
40132 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
40133
40134 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
40135
40136 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
40137 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
40138 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
40139 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
40140 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
40141
40142 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
40143 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
40144
40145 @item --with-lzma
40146 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
40147 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
40148 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
40149 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
40150 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
40151 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
40152
40153 @item --with-mpfr
40154 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
40155 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
40156 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
40157 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
40158 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
40159 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
40160 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
40161 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
40162 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
40163
40164 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
40165 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
40166 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
40167 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
40168 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
40169 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
40170 of Python supported by GDB is 2.6. The optional argument @var{python}
40171 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
40172 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
40173 Python is installed.
40174
40175 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
40176 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
40177 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
40178 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
40179 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
40180 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
40181 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
40182 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
40183 compile and link against Guile.
40184
40185 @item --without-included-regex
40186 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
40187 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
40188 the GNU C library.
40189
40190 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
40191 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
40192 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
40193 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
40194 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
40195 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
40196 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
40197 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
40198
40199 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
40200 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
40201 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
40202 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
40203 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
40204 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
40205
40206 @item --with-system-gdbinit-dir=@var{directory}
40207 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load init files from a
40208 system-wide directory. @var{directory} should be an absolute directory
40209 name. If @var{directory} is in a directory under the configured
40210 prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to another location after being
40211 built, the location of the system-wide init directory will be
40212 adjusted accordingly.
40213
40214 @item --enable-build-warnings
40215 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
40216 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
40217 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
40218 compiler you are using.
40219
40220 @item --enable-werror
40221 Treat compiler warnings as errors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
40222 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
40223 outputs any warning messages.
40224
40225 @item --enable-ubsan
40226 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
40227 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
40228 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
40229 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
40230 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
40231 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
40232 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
40233 @end table
40234
40235 @node System-wide configuration
40236 @section System-wide configuration and settings
40237 @cindex system-wide init file
40238
40239 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file and a
40240 system-wide init file directory; this file and files in that directory
40241 (if they have a recognized file extension) will be read and executed at
40242 startup (@pxref{Startup, , What @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
40243
40244 Here are the corresponding configure options:
40245
40246 @table @code
40247 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
40248 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
40249 @var{file}.
40250 @item --with-system-gdbinit-dir=@var{directory}
40251 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file directory
40252 is @var{directory}.
40253 @end table
40254
40255 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
40256 they may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
40257
40258 @itemize @bullet
40259 @item
40260 If the default location of this init file/directory contains @file{$prefix},
40261 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
40262 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
40263 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
40264 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
40265 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
40266
40267 @item
40268 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
40269 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
40270 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
40271 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
40272 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
40273 @end itemize
40274
40275 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
40276 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
40277 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
40278 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
40279 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
40280 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
40281 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
40282 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
40283 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
40284 reread.
40285
40286 This applies similarly to the system-wide directory specified in
40287 @option{--with-system-gdbinit-dir}.
40288
40289 Any supported scripting language can be used for these init files, as long
40290 as the file extension matches the scripting language. To be interpreted
40291 as regular @value{GDBN} commands, the files needs to have a @file{.gdb}
40292 extension.
40293
40294 @menu
40295 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
40296 @end menu
40297
40298 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
40299 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
40300 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
40301
40302 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
40303 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
40304 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
40305 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
40306 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
40307 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
40308
40309 The following scripts are currently available:
40310 @itemize @bullet
40311
40312 @item @file{elinos.py}
40313 @pindex elinos.py
40314 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
40315 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
40316 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
40317 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
40318 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
40319 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
40320
40321 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
40322 @pindex wrs-linux.py
40323 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
40324 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
40325 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
40326 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
40327
40328 @end itemize
40329
40330 @node Maintenance Commands
40331 @appendix Maintenance Commands
40332 @cindex maintenance commands
40333 @cindex internal commands
40334
40335 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
40336 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
40337 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
40338 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
40339 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
40340
40341 @table @code
40342 @kindex maint agent
40343 @kindex maint agent-eval
40344 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{linespec}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
40345 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{linespec}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
40346 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
40347 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
40348 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
40349 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
40350 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
40351 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
40352 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
40353 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
40354 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
40355 addition and return the sum.
40356 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for all the
40357 addresses to which @var{linespec} resolves (@pxref{Linespec
40358 Locations}).
40359 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
40360
40361 @kindex maint agent-printf
40362 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
40363 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
40364 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
40365 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
40366 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
40367
40368 @kindex maint info breakpoints
40369 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
40370 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
40371 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
40372 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
40373 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
40374 is shown:
40375
40376 @table @code
40377 @item breakpoint
40378 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
40379
40380 @item watchpoint
40381 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
40382
40383 @item longjmp
40384 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
40385 @code{longjmp} calls.
40386
40387 @item longjmp resume
40388 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
40389
40390 @item until
40391 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
40392
40393 @item finish
40394 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
40395
40396 @item shlib events
40397 Shared library events.
40398
40399 @end table
40400
40401 @kindex maint info btrace
40402 @item maint info btrace
40403 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
40404
40405 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
40406 @item maint btrace packet-history
40407 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
40408 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
40409 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
40410 recording format.
40411
40412 @table @code
40413 @item bts
40414 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
40415 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
40416
40417 @table @asis
40418 @item Block number
40419 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
40420 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
40421 @item Highest @samp{PC}
40422 @end table
40423
40424 @item pt
40425 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
40426 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
40427 information is printed:
40428
40429 @table @asis
40430 @item Packet number
40431 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
40432 @item Trace offset
40433 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
40434 @item Packet opcode and payload
40435 @end table
40436 @end table
40437
40438 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
40439 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
40440 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
40441 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
40442 needed.
40443
40444 @kindex maint btrace clear
40445 @item maint btrace clear
40446 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
40447 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
40448
40449 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
40450 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
40451 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
40452 buffer.
40453
40454 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
40455 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
40456 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
40457 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
40458 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
40459 packet history.
40460
40461 @kindex maint info jit
40462 @item maint info jit
40463 Print information about JIT code objects loaded in the current inferior.
40464
40465 @anchor{maint info python-disassemblers}
40466 @kindex maint info python-disassemblers
40467 @item maint info python-disassemblers
40468 This command is defined within the @code{gdb.disassembler} Python
40469 module (@pxref{Disassembly In Python}), and will only be present after
40470 that module has been imported. To force the module to be imported do
40471 the following:
40472
40473 @smallexample
40474 (@value{GDBP}) python import gdb.disassembler
40475 @end smallexample
40476
40477 This command lists all the architectures for which a disassembler is
40478 currently registered, and the name of the disassembler. If a
40479 disassembler is registered for all architectures, then this is listed
40480 last against the @samp{GLOBAL} architecture.
40481
40482 If one of the disassemblers would be selected for the architecture of
40483 the current inferior, then this disassembler will be marked.
40484
40485 The following example shows a situation in which two disassemblers are
40486 registered, initially the @samp{i386} disassembler matches the current
40487 architecture, then the architecture is changed, now the @samp{GLOBAL}
40488 disassembler matches.
40489
40490 @smallexample
40491 @group
40492 (@value{GDBP}) show architecture
40493 The target architecture is set to "auto" (currently "i386").
40494 (@value{GDBP}) maint info python-disassemblers
40495 Architecture Disassember Name
40496 i386 Disassembler_1 (Matches current architecture)
40497 GLOBAL Disassembler_2
40498 @end group
40499 @group
40500 (@value{GDBP}) set architecture arm
40501 The target architecture is set to "arm".
40502 (@value{GDBP}) maint info python-disassemblers
40503 quit
40504 Architecture Disassember Name
40505 i386 Disassembler_1
40506 GLOBAL Disassembler_2 (Matches current architecture)
40507 @end group
40508 @end smallexample
40509
40510 @kindex set displaced-stepping
40511 @kindex show displaced-stepping
40512 @cindex displaced stepping support
40513 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
40514 @item set displaced-stepping
40515 @itemx show displaced-stepping
40516 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
40517 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
40518 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
40519 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
40520 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
40521
40522 @table @code
40523 @item set displaced-stepping on
40524 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
40525 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
40526
40527 @item set displaced-stepping off
40528 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
40529 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
40530
40531 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
40532 @item set displaced-stepping auto
40533 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
40534 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
40535 architecture supports displaced stepping.
40536 @end table
40537
40538 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
40539 @item maint check-psymtabs
40540 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
40541 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
40542
40543 @kindex maint check-symtabs
40544 @item maint check-symtabs
40545 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
40546
40547 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
40548 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
40549 Expand symbol tables.
40550 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
40551 names matching @var{regexp}.
40552
40553 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
40554 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
40555 @cindex demangler crashes
40556 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
40557 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
40558 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
40559 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
40560 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
40561 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
40562 option to terminate the current session.
40563
40564 @kindex maint cplus first_component
40565 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
40566 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
40567
40568 @kindex maint cplus namespace
40569 @item maint cplus namespace
40570 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
40571
40572 @kindex maint deprecate
40573 @kindex maint undeprecate
40574 @cindex deprecated commands
40575 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
40576 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
40577 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
40578 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
40579 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
40580 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
40581 the replacement as part of the warning.
40582
40583 @kindex maint dump-me
40584 @item maint dump-me
40585 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
40586 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
40587 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
40588 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
40589
40590 @kindex maint internal-error
40591 @kindex maint internal-warning
40592 @kindex maint demangler-warning
40593 @cindex demangler crashes
40594 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
40595 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
40596 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
40597
40598 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
40599 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
40600 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
40601 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
40602 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
40603 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
40604 @value{GDBN} session.
40605
40606 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
40607 used as the text of the error or warning message.
40608
40609 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
40610
40611 @smallexample
40612 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
40613 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
40614 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
40615 debugging may prove unreliable.
40616 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
40617 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
40618 (@value{GDBP})
40619 @end smallexample
40620
40621 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
40622 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
40623 @cindex demangler crashes
40624
40625 @kindex maint set internal-error
40626 @kindex maint show internal-error
40627 @kindex maint set internal-warning
40628 @kindex maint show internal-warning
40629 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
40630 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
40631 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
40632 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
40633 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
40634 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
40635 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
40636 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
40637 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
40638 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
40639 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
40640 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
40641 described in the table below.
40642
40643 @table @samp
40644 @item quit
40645 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
40646 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
40647
40648 @item corefile
40649 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
40650 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
40651 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
40652 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
40653 disabled.
40654 @end table
40655
40656 @kindex maint set internal-error
40657 @kindex maint show internal-error
40658 @kindex maint set internal-warning
40659 @kindex maint show internal-warning
40660 @item maint set internal-error backtrace @r{[}on|off@r{]}
40661 @itemx maint show internal-error backtrace
40662 @itemx maint set internal-warning backtrace @r{[}on|off@r{]}
40663 @itemx maint show internal-warning backtrace
40664 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it is
40665 possible to have a backtrace of @value{GDBN} printed to the standard
40666 error stream. This is @samp{on} by default for @code{internal-error}
40667 and @samp{off} by default for @code{internal-warning}.
40668
40669 @anchor{maint packet}
40670 @kindex maint packet
40671 @item maint packet @var{text}
40672 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
40673 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
40674 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
40675 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
40676 checksum.
40677
40678 Any non-printable characters in the reply are printed as escaped hex,
40679 e.g. @samp{\x00}, @samp{\x01}, etc.
40680
40681 @kindex maint print architecture
40682 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
40683 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
40684 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
40685
40686 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
40687 @item maint print c-tdesc @r{[}-single-feature@r{]} @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
40688 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
40689 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
40690 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
40691 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
40692 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
40693 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
40694 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
40695 modify XML target descriptions.
40696
40697 When the optional flag @samp{-single-feature} is provided then the
40698 target description being processed (either the default, or from
40699 @var{file}) must only contain a single feature. The source file
40700 produced is different in this case.
40701
40702 @kindex maint print xml-tdesc
40703 @item maint print xml-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
40704 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as an XML
40705 file. By default print the target description for the current target,
40706 but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, then that file is
40707 read in by GDB and then used to produce the description. The
40708 @var{file} should be an XML document, of the form described in
40709 @ref{Target Description Format}.
40710
40711 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
40712 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
40713 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
40714 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
40715
40716 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
40717 @kindex maint check libthread-db
40718 @item maint check libthread-db
40719 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
40720 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
40721 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
40722 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
40723 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
40724 on some platforms when debugging core files.
40725
40726 @kindex maint print core-file-backed-mappings
40727 @cindex memory address space mappings
40728 @item maint print core-file-backed-mappings
40729 Print the file-backed mappings which were loaded from a core file note.
40730 This output represents state internal to @value{GDBN} and should be
40731 similar to the mappings displayed by the @code{info proc mappings}
40732 command.
40733
40734 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
40735 @item maint print dummy-frames
40736 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
40737
40738 @smallexample
40739 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
40740 @dots{}
40741 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
40742 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
40743 58 return (a + b);
40744 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
40745 @dots{}
40746 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
40747 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
40748 (@value{GDBP})
40749 @end smallexample
40750
40751 Takes an optional file parameter.
40752
40753 @kindex maint print frame-id
40754 @item maint print frame-id
40755 @itemx maint print frame-id @var{level}
40756 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal frame-id for the frame at relative
40757 @var{level}, or for the currently selected frame when @var{level} is
40758 not given.
40759
40760 If used, @var{level} should be an integer, as displayed in the
40761 @command{backtrace} output.
40762
40763 @smallexample
40764 (@value{GDBP}) maint print frame-id
40765 frame-id for frame #0: @{stack=0x7fffffffac70,code=0x0000000000401106,!special@}
40766 (@value{GDBP}) maint print frame-id 2
40767 frame-id for frame #2: @{stack=0x7fffffffac90,code=0x000000000040111c,!special@}
40768 @end smallexample
40769
40770 @kindex maint print registers
40771 @kindex maint print raw-registers
40772 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
40773 @kindex maint print register-groups
40774 @kindex maint print remote-registers
40775 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
40776 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
40777 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
40778 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
40779 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
40780 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
40781
40782 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
40783 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
40784 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
40785 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
40786 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
40787 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
40788 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
40789 and offsets in the `G' packets.
40790
40791 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
40792 write the information.
40793
40794 @kindex maint print reggroups
40795 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
40796 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
40797 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
40798 information.
40799
40800 The register groups info looks like this:
40801
40802 @smallexample
40803 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
40804 Group Type
40805 general user
40806 float user
40807 all user
40808 vector user
40809 system user
40810 save internal
40811 restore internal
40812 @end smallexample
40813
40814 @kindex maint flush register-cache
40815 @kindex flushregs
40816 @cindex register cache, flushing
40817 @item maint flush register-cache
40818 @itemx flushregs
40819 Flush the contents of the register cache and as a consequence the
40820 frame cache. This command is useful when debugging issues related to
40821 register fetching, or frame unwinding. The command @code{flushregs}
40822 is deprecated in favor of @code{maint flush register-cache}.
40823
40824 @kindex maint flush source-cache
40825 @cindex source code, caching
40826 @item maint flush source-cache
40827 Flush @value{GDBN}'s cache of source code file contents. After
40828 @value{GDBN} reads a source file, and optionally applies styling
40829 (@pxref{Output Styling}), the file contents are cached. This command
40830 clears that cache. The next time @value{GDBN} wants to show lines
40831 from a source file, the content will be re-read.
40832
40833 This command is useful when debugging issues related to source code
40834 styling. After flushing the cache any source code displayed by
40835 @value{GDBN} will be re-read and re-styled.
40836
40837 @kindex maint print objfiles
40838 @cindex info for known object files
40839 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
40840 Print a dump of all known object files.
40841 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
40842 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
40843 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
40844
40845 @kindex maint print user-registers
40846 @cindex user registers
40847 @item maint print user-registers
40848 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
40849 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
40850 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
40851 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
40852 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
40853 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
40854 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
40855
40856 @kindex maint print section-scripts
40857 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
40858 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
40859 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
40860 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
40861 matching @var{regexp}.
40862 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
40863 and the full path if known.
40864 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
40865
40866 @kindex maint print statistics
40867 @cindex bcache statistics
40868 @item maint print statistics
40869 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
40870 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
40871 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
40872 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
40873 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
40874 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
40875 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
40876 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
40877 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
40878 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
40879 lengths.
40880
40881 @kindex maint print target-stack
40882 @cindex target stack description
40883 @item maint print target-stack
40884 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
40885 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
40886 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
40887 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
40888 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
40889 address.
40890
40891 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
40892 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
40893
40894 @kindex maint print type
40895 @cindex type chain of a data type
40896 @item maint print type @var{expr}
40897 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
40898 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
40899 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
40900 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
40901 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
40902
40903 @kindex maint print record-instruction
40904 @item maint print record-instruction
40905 @itemx maint print record-instruction @var{N}
40906 print how GDB recorded a given instruction. If @var{n} is not positive
40907 number, it prints the values stored by the inferior before the @var{n}-th previous
40908 instruction was exectued. If @var{n} is positive, print the values after the @var{n}-th
40909 following instruction is executed. If @var{n} is not given, 0 is assumed.
40910
40911 @kindex maint selftest
40912 @cindex self tests
40913 @item maint selftest @r{[}-verbose@r{]} @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
40914 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
40915 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
40916 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
40917 name will be ran. If @code{-verbose} is passed, the self tests can be
40918 more verbose.
40919
40920 @kindex maint set selftest verbose
40921 @kindex maint show selftest verbose
40922 @cindex self tests
40923 @item maint set selftest verbose
40924 @item maint show selftest verbose
40925 Control whether self tests are run verbosely or not.
40926
40927 @kindex maint info selftests
40928 @cindex self tests
40929 @item maint info selftests
40930 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
40931
40932 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
40933 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
40934 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
40935 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
40936 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
40937 information.
40938
40939 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
40940 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
40941 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
40942 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
40943 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
40944 always see the disassembly form.
40945
40946 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
40947
40948 @smallexample
40949 (@value{GDBP}) info addr argc
40950 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
40951 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
40952 @end smallexample
40953
40954 For more information on these expressions, see
40955 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
40956
40957 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
40958 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
40959 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
40960 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
40961 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
40962
40963 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
40964 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
40965 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
40966 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
40967 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
40968 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
40969 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
40970 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
40971 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
40972
40973 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
40974 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
40975 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
40976 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
40977 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
40978
40979 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
40980 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
40981 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
40982 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
40983 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
40984 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
40985
40986 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
40987 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
40988 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
40989
40990 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
40991 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
40992 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
40993 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
40994
40995 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
40996 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
40997
40998 @kindex maint info frame-unwinders
40999 @item maint info frame-unwinders
41000 List the frame unwinders currently in effect, starting with the highest priority.
41001
41002 @kindex maint set worker-threads
41003 @kindex maint show worker-threads
41004 @item maint set worker-threads
41005 @item maint show worker-threads
41006 Control the number of worker threads that may be used by @value{GDBN}.
41007 On capable hosts, @value{GDBN} may use multiple threads to speed up
41008 certain CPU-intensive operations, such as demangling symbol names.
41009 While the number of threads used by @value{GDBN} may vary, this
41010 command can be used to set an upper bound on this number. The default
41011 is @code{unlimited}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a reasonable
41012 number. Note that this only controls worker threads started by
41013 @value{GDBN} itself; libraries used by @value{GDBN} may start threads
41014 of their own.
41015
41016 @kindex maint set profile
41017 @kindex maint show profile
41018 @cindex profiling GDB
41019 @item maint set profile
41020 @itemx maint show profile
41021 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
41022
41023 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
41024 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
41025 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
41026 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
41027 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
41028 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
41029 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
41030
41031 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
41032 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
41033
41034 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
41035 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
41036 @cindex hardware debug registers
41037 @item maint set show-debug-regs
41038 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
41039 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
41040 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
41041 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
41042 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
41043 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
41044
41045 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
41046 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
41047 @item maint set show-all-tib
41048 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
41049 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
41050 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
41051 command.
41052
41053 @kindex maint set target-async
41054 @kindex maint show target-async
41055 @item maint set target-async
41056 @itemx maint show target-async
41057 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
41058 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
41059 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
41060 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
41061
41062 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
41063 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
41064 @item maint set target-non-stop
41065 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
41066
41067 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
41068 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
41069 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
41070 if supported by the target.
41071
41072 @table @code
41073 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
41074 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
41075 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
41076
41077 @item maint set target-non-stop on
41078 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
41079 does not indicate support.
41080
41081 @item maint set target-non-stop off
41082 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
41083 target supports it.
41084 @end table
41085
41086 @kindex maint set tui-resize-message
41087 @kindex maint show tui-resize-message
41088 @item maint set tui-resize-message
41089 @item maint show tui-resize-message
41090 Control whether @value{GDBN} displays a message each time the terminal
41091 is resized when in TUI mode. The default is @code{off}, which means
41092 that @value{GDBN} is silent during resizes. When @code{on},
41093 @value{GDBN} will display a message after a resize is completed; the
41094 message will include a number indicating how many times the terminal
41095 has been resized. This setting is intended for use by the test suite,
41096 where it would otherwise be difficult to determine when a resize and
41097 refresh has been completed.
41098
41099 @kindex maint set per-command
41100 @kindex maint show per-command
41101 @item maint set per-command
41102 @itemx maint show per-command
41103 @cindex resources used by commands
41104
41105 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
41106 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
41107
41108 @table @code
41109 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
41110 @itemx maint show per-command space
41111 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
41112 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
41113 took, following the command's own output.
41114 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
41115 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
41116
41117 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
41118 @itemx maint show per-command time
41119 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
41120 for each command.
41121 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
41122 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
41123 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
41124 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
41125 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
41126 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
41127 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
41128 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
41129 spent by the program been debugged.
41130 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
41131 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
41132
41133 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
41134 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
41135 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
41136 for each command.
41137 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
41138
41139 @enumerate a
41140 @item
41141 number of symbol tables
41142 @item
41143 number of primary symbol tables
41144 @item
41145 number of blocks in the blockvector
41146 @end enumerate
41147 @end table
41148
41149 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
41150 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
41151 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
41152 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
41153 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
41154 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
41155 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
41156 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
41157 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
41158 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
41159
41160 @kindex maint set gnu-source-highlight enabled
41161 @kindex maint show gnu-source-highlight enabled
41162 @item maint set gnu-source-highlight enabled @r{[}on|off@r{]}
41163 @itemx maint show gnu-source-highlight enabled
41164 Control whether @value{GDBN} should use the GNU Source Highlight
41165 library for applying styling to source code (@pxref{Output Styling}).
41166 This will be @samp{on} by default if the GNU Source Highlight library
41167 is available. If the GNU Source Highlight library is not available,
41168 then this will be @samp{off} by default, and attempting to change this
41169 value to @samp{on} will give an error.
41170
41171 If the GNU Source Highlight library is not being used, then
41172 @value{GDBN} will use the Python Pygments package for source code
41173 styling, if it is available.
41174
41175 This option is useful for debugging @value{GDBN}'s use of the Pygments
41176 library when @value{GDBN} is linked against the GNU Source Highlight
41177 library.
41178
41179 @anchor{maint_libopcodes_styling}
41180 @kindex maint set libopcodes-styling enabled
41181 @kindex maint show libopcodes-styling enabled
41182 @item maint set libopcodes-styling enabled @r{[}on|off@r{]}
41183 @itemx maint show libopcodes-styling enabled
41184 Control whether @value{GDBN} should use its builtin disassembler
41185 (@file{libopcodes}) to style disassembler output (@pxref{Output
41186 Styling}). The builtin disassembler does not support styling for all
41187 architectures.
41188
41189 When this option is @samp{off} the builtin disassembler will not be
41190 used for styling, @value{GDBN} will fall back to using the Python
41191 Pygments package if possible.
41192
41193 Trying to set this option @samp{on} for an architecture that the
41194 builtin disassembler is unable to style will give an error, otherwise,
41195 the builtin disassembler will be used to style disassembler output.
41196
41197 This option is @samp{on} by default for supported architectures.
41198
41199 This option is useful for debugging @value{GDBN}'s use of the Pygments
41200 library when @value{GDBN} is built for an architecture that supports
41201 styling with the builtin disassembler
41202 @kindex maint space
41203 @cindex memory used by commands
41204 @item maint space @var{value}
41205 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
41206 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
41207
41208 @kindex maint time
41209 @cindex time of command execution
41210 @item maint time @var{value}
41211 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
41212 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
41213
41214 @kindex maint translate-address
41215 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
41216 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
41217 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
41218 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
41219 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
41220 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
41221 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
41222
41223 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
41224 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
41225 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
41226
41227 @kindex maint test-options
41228 @item maint test-options require-delimiter
41229 @itemx maint test-options unknown-is-error
41230 @itemx maint test-options unknown-is-operand
41231 These commands are used by the testsuite to validate the command
41232 options framework. The @code{require-delimiter} variant requires a
41233 double-dash delimiter to indicate end of options. The
41234 @code{unknown-is-error} and @code{unknown-is-operand} do not. The
41235 @code{unknown-is-error} variant throws an error on unknown option,
41236 while @code{unknown-is-operand} treats unknown options as the start of
41237 the command's operands. When run, the commands output the result of
41238 the processed options. When completed, the commands store the
41239 internal result of completion in a variable exposed by the @code{maint
41240 show test-options-completion-result} command.
41241
41242 @kindex maint show test-options-completion-result
41243 @item maint show test-options-completion-result
41244 Shows the result of completing the @code{maint test-options}
41245 subcommands. This is used by the testsuite to validate completion
41246 support in the command options framework.
41247
41248 @kindex maint set test-settings
41249 @kindex maint show test-settings
41250 @item maint set test-settings @var{kind}
41251 @itemx maint show test-settings @var{kind}
41252 These are representative commands for each @var{kind} of setting type
41253 @value{GDBN} supports. They are used by the testsuite for exercising
41254 the settings infrastructure.
41255
41256 @kindex maint set backtrace-on-fatal-signal
41257 @kindex maint show backtrace-on-fatal-signal
41258 @item maint set backtrace-on-fatal-signal [on|off]
41259 @itemx maint show backtrace-on-fatal-signal
41260 When this setting is @code{on}, if @value{GDBN} itself terminates with
41261 a fatal signal (e.g.@: SIGSEGV), then a limited backtrace will be
41262 printed to the standard error stream. This backtrace can be used to
41263 help diagnose crashes within @value{GDBN} in situations where a user
41264 is unable to share a corefile with the @value{GDBN} developers.
41265
41266 If the functionality to provide this backtrace is not available for
41267 the platform on which GDB is running then this feature will be
41268 @code{off} by default, and attempting to turn this feature on will
41269 give an error.
41270
41271 For platforms that do support creating the backtrace this feature is
41272 @code{on} by default.
41273
41274 @kindex maint with
41275 @item maint with @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
41276 Like the @code{with} command, but works with @code{maintenance set}
41277 variables. This is used by the testsuite to exercise the @code{with}
41278 command's infrastructure.
41279
41280 @kindex maint ignore-probes
41281 @item maint ignore-probes [@var{-v}|@var{-verbose}] [@var{provider} [@var{name} [@var{objfile}]]]
41282 @itemx maint ignore-probes @var{-reset}
41283 Set or reset the ignore-probes filter. The @var{provider}, @var{name}
41284 and @var{objfile} arguments are as in @code{enable probes} and
41285 @code{disable probes} (@pxref{enable probes}). Only supported for
41286 SystemTap probes.
41287
41288 Here's an example of using @code{maint ignore-probes}:
41289 @smallexample
41290 (gdb) maint ignore-probes -verbose libc ^longjmp$
41291 ignore-probes filter has been set to:
41292 PROVIDER: 'libc'
41293 PROBE_NAME: '^longjmp$'
41294 OBJNAME: ''
41295 (gdb) start
41296 <... more output ...>
41297 Ignoring SystemTap probe libc longjmp in /lib64/libc.so.6.^M
41298 Ignoring SystemTap probe libc longjmp in /lib64/libc.so.6.^M
41299 Ignoring SystemTap probe libc longjmp in /lib64/libc.so.6.^M
41300 @end smallexample
41301 @end table
41302
41303 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
41304 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
41305
41306 @table @code
41307 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
41308 @kindex set watchdog
41309 @cindex watchdog timer
41310 @cindex timeout for commands
41311 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
41312 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
41313 reports and error and the command is aborted.
41314
41315 @item show watchdog
41316 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
41317 @end table
41318
41319 @node Remote Protocol
41320 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
41321
41322 @menu
41323 * Overview::
41324 * Packets::
41325 * Stop Reply Packets::
41326 * General Query Packets::
41327 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
41328 * Tracepoint Packets::
41329 * Host I/O Packets::
41330 * Interrupts::
41331 * Notification Packets::
41332 * Remote Non-Stop::
41333 * Packet Acknowledgment::
41334 * Examples::
41335 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
41336 * Library List Format::
41337 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
41338 * Memory Map Format::
41339 * Thread List Format::
41340 * Traceframe Info Format::
41341 * Branch Trace Format::
41342 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
41343 @end menu
41344
41345 @node Overview
41346 @section Overview
41347
41348 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
41349 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
41350 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
41351 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
41352
41353 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
41354 transmitted and received data, respectively.
41355
41356 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
41357 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
41358 @cindex remote serial protocol
41359 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
41360 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
41361 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
41362 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
41363 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
41364
41365 @smallexample
41366 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
41367 @end smallexample
41368 @noindent
41369
41370 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
41371 @noindent
41372 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
41373 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
41374 eight bit unsigned checksum).
41375
41376 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
41377 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
41378
41379 @smallexample
41380 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
41381 @end smallexample
41382
41383 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
41384 @noindent
41385 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
41386 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
41387 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
41388
41389 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
41390 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
41391 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
41392 retransmission):
41393
41394 @smallexample
41395 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
41396 <- @code{+}
41397 @end smallexample
41398 @noindent
41399
41400 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
41401 once a connection is established.
41402 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
41403
41404 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
41405 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
41406 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
41407 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
41408 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
41409 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
41410 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
41411
41412 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
41413 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
41414 exceptions).
41415
41416 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
41417 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
41418 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
41419 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
41420
41421 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
41422 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
41423 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
41424
41425 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
41426 @anchor{Binary Data}
41427 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
41428 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
41429 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
41430 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
41431 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
41432 binary data.
41433
41434 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
41435 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
41436 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
41437 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
41438 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
41439 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
41440 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
41441 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
41442 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
41443 (described next).
41444
41445 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
41446 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
41447 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
41448 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
41449 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
41450 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
41451 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
41452 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
41453 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
41454 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
41455 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
41456 3}} more times.
41457
41458 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
41459 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
41460 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
41461 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
41462 @samp{0*"00}.
41463
41464 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
41465 error number. That number is not well defined.
41466
41467 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
41468 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
41469 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
41470 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
41471 on that response.
41472
41473 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{?} command to
41474 tell @value{GDBN} the reason for halting, @samp{g} and @samp{G}
41475 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
41476 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
41477 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue) command, and if
41478 the target architecture supports hardware-assisted single-stepping,
41479 the @samp{s} (step) command. Stubs that support multi-threading
41480 targets should support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands
41481 are optional.
41482
41483 @node Packets
41484 @section Packets
41485
41486 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
41487 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
41488 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
41489 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
41490
41491 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
41492 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
41493 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
41494 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
41495 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
41496 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
41497 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
41498 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
41499 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
41500 @var{baz}.
41501
41502 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
41503 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
41504 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
41505 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
41506 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
41507 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
41508 pick any thread.
41509
41510 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
41511 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
41512 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
41513 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
41514 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
41515 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
41516 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
41517 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
41518 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
41519 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
41520 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
41521 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
41522 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
41523
41524 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
41525 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
41526 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
41527 more information.
41528
41529 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
41530 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
41531
41532 Here are the packet descriptions.
41533
41534 @table @samp
41535
41536 @item !
41537 @cindex @samp{!} packet
41538 @anchor{extended mode}
41539 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
41540 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
41541 debugged.
41542
41543 Reply:
41544 @table @samp
41545 @item OK
41546 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
41547 @end table
41548
41549 @item ?
41550 @cindex @samp{?} packet
41551 @anchor{? packet}
41552 This is sent when connection is first established to query the reason
41553 the target halted. The reply is the same as for step and continue.
41554 This packet has a special interpretation when the target is in
41555 non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
41556
41557 Reply:
41558 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
41559
41560 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
41561 @cindex @samp{A} packet
41562 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
41563 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
41564 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
41565
41566 Reply:
41567 @table @samp
41568 @item OK
41569 The arguments were set.
41570 @item E @var{NN}
41571 An error occurred.
41572 @end table
41573
41574 @item b @var{baud}
41575 @cindex @samp{b} packet
41576 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
41577 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
41578
41579 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
41580 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
41581 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
41582
41583 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
41584 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
41585 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
41586 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
41587 of view, nothing actually happened.}
41588
41589 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
41590 @cindex @samp{B} packet
41591 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
41592 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
41593
41594 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
41595 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
41596
41597 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
41598 @anchor{bc}
41599 @item bc
41600 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
41601 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
41602
41603 Reply:
41604 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
41605
41606 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
41607 @anchor{bs}
41608 @item bs
41609 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
41610 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
41611
41612 Reply:
41613 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
41614
41615 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
41616 @cindex @samp{c} packet
41617 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
41618 is omitted, resume at current address.
41619
41620 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
41621 packet}.
41622
41623 Reply:
41624 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
41625
41626 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
41627 @cindex @samp{C} packet
41628 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
41629 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
41630
41631 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
41632 packet}.
41633
41634 Reply:
41635 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
41636
41637 @item d
41638 @cindex @samp{d} packet
41639 Toggle debug flag.
41640
41641 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
41642 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
41643
41644 @item D
41645 @itemx D;@var{pid}
41646 @cindex @samp{D} packet
41647 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
41648 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
41649 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
41650
41651 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
41652 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
41653 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
41654 big-endian hex string.
41655
41656 Reply:
41657 @table @samp
41658 @item OK
41659 for success
41660 @item E @var{NN}
41661 for an error
41662 @end table
41663
41664 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
41665 @cindex @samp{F} packet
41666 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
41667 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
41668 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
41669
41670 @item g
41671 @anchor{read registers packet}
41672 @cindex @samp{g} packet
41673 Read general registers.
41674
41675 Reply:
41676 @table @samp
41677 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
41678 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
41679 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
41680 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
41681 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
41682 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
41683
41684 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
41685 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
41686 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
41687 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
41688 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
41689 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
41690 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
41691 have been collected, and both have zero value:
41692
41693 @smallexample
41694 -> @code{g}
41695 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
41696 @end smallexample
41697
41698 @item E @var{NN}
41699 for an error.
41700 @end table
41701
41702 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
41703 @cindex @samp{G} packet
41704 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
41705 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
41706
41707 Reply:
41708 @table @samp
41709 @item OK
41710 for success
41711 @item E @var{NN}
41712 for an error
41713 @end table
41714
41715 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
41716 @cindex @samp{H} packet
41717 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
41718 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
41719 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
41720 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
41721 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
41722 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
41723 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
41724
41725 Reply:
41726 @table @samp
41727 @item OK
41728 for success
41729 @item E @var{NN}
41730 for an error
41731 @end table
41732
41733 @c FIXME: JTC:
41734 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
41735 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
41736 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
41737 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
41738 @c described. For example:
41739 @c
41740 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
41741 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
41742 @c otherwise returns current registers.
41743 @c
41744 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
41745 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
41746 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
41747
41748 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
41749 @anchor{cycle step packet}
41750 @cindex @samp{i} packet
41751 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
41752 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
41753 step starting at that address.
41754
41755 @item I
41756 @cindex @samp{I} packet
41757 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
41758 step packet}.
41759
41760 @item k
41761 @cindex @samp{k} packet
41762 Kill request.
41763
41764 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
41765
41766 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
41767 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
41768
41769 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
41770
41771 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
41772 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
41773 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
41774
41775 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
41776 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
41777 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
41778
41779 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
41780 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
41781 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
41782 (@pxref{? packet}).
41783
41784 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
41785 @cindex @samp{m} packet
41786 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
41787 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
41788 any particular boundary.
41789
41790 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
41791 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
41792 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
41793 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
41794 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
41795 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
41796 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
41797 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
41798
41799 Reply:
41800 @table @samp
41801 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
41802 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
41803 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
41804 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
41805 @item E @var{NN}
41806 @var{NN} is errno
41807 @end table
41808
41809 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
41810 @cindex @samp{M} packet
41811 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
41812 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
41813 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
41814
41815 Reply:
41816 @table @samp
41817 @item OK
41818 for success
41819 @item E @var{NN}
41820 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
41821 written).
41822 @end table
41823
41824 @item p @var{n}
41825 @cindex @samp{p} packet
41826 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
41827 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
41828 register value is encoded.
41829
41830 Reply:
41831 @table @samp
41832 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
41833 the register's value
41834 @item E @var{NN}
41835 for an error
41836 @item @w{}
41837 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
41838 @end table
41839
41840 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
41841 @anchor{write register packet}
41842 @cindex @samp{P} packet
41843 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
41844 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
41845 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
41846
41847 Reply:
41848 @table @samp
41849 @item OK
41850 for success
41851 @item E @var{NN}
41852 for an error
41853 @end table
41854
41855 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
41856 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
41857 @cindex @samp{q} packet
41858 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
41859 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
41860 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
41861
41862 @item r
41863 @cindex @samp{r} packet
41864 Reset the entire system.
41865
41866 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
41867
41868 @item R @var{XX}
41869 @cindex @samp{R} packet
41870 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
41871 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
41872
41873 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
41874
41875 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
41876 @cindex @samp{s} packet
41877 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
41878 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
41879
41880 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
41881 packet}.
41882
41883 Reply:
41884 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
41885
41886 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
41887 @anchor{step with signal packet}
41888 @cindex @samp{S} packet
41889 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
41890 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
41891
41892 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
41893 packet}.
41894
41895 Reply:
41896 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
41897
41898 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
41899 @cindex @samp{t} packet
41900 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
41901 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
41902 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
41903
41904 @item T @var{thread-id}
41905 @cindex @samp{T} packet
41906 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
41907
41908 Reply:
41909 @table @samp
41910 @item OK
41911 thread is still alive
41912 @item E @var{NN}
41913 thread is dead
41914 @end table
41915
41916 @item v
41917 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
41918 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
41919
41920 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
41921 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
41922 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
41923 The process ID is a
41924 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
41925 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
41926 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
41927
41928 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
41929 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
41930 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
41931 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
41932 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
41933 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
41934 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
41935 @c stopping or restarting threads.
41936
41937 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
41938
41939 Reply:
41940 @table @samp
41941 @item E @var{nn}
41942 for an error
41943 @item @r{Any stop packet}
41944 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
41945 @item OK
41946 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
41947 @end table
41948
41949 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
41950 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
41951 @anchor{vCont packet}
41952 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
41953
41954 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
41955 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
41956 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
41957 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
41958 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
41959 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
41960 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
41961 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
41962 error.
41963
41964 Currently supported actions are:
41965
41966 @table @samp
41967 @item c
41968 Continue.
41969 @item C @var{sig}
41970 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
41971 @item s
41972 Step.
41973 @item S @var{sig}
41974 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
41975 @item t
41976 Stop.
41977 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
41978 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
41979 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
41980 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
41981 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
41982 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
41983
41984 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
41985 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
41986 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
41987 jumps to @var{start}).
41988
41989 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
41990 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
41991 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
41992
41993 @end table
41994
41995 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
41996 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
41997 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
41998
41999 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
42000 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
42001 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
42002 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
42003 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
42004 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
42005 as an implementation detail.
42006
42007 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
42008 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
42009 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
42010 stopped.
42011
42012 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
42013 @value{GDBN} acknowledges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
42014 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
42015
42016 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
42017 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
42018
42019 Reply:
42020 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
42021
42022 @item vCont?
42023 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
42024 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
42025
42026 Reply:
42027 @table @samp
42028 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
42029 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
42030 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
42031 @item @w{}
42032 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
42033 @end table
42034
42035 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
42036 @item vCtrlC
42037 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
42038 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
42039 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
42040 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
42041 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
42042 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
42043 variant.
42044
42045 Reply:
42046 @table @samp
42047 @item E @var{nn}
42048 for an error
42049 @item OK
42050 for success
42051 @end table
42052
42053 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
42054 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
42055 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
42056 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
42057
42058 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
42059 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
42060 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
42061 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
42062 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
42063 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
42064 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
42065 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
42066 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
42067 packet is received.
42068
42069 Reply:
42070 @table @samp
42071 @item OK
42072 for success
42073 @item E @var{NN}
42074 for an error
42075 @end table
42076
42077 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
42078 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
42079 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
42080 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
42081 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
42082 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
42083 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
42084 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
42085 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
42086 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
42087 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
42088 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
42089
42090
42091 Reply:
42092 @table @samp
42093 @item OK
42094 for success
42095 @item E.memtype
42096 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
42097 @item E @var{NN}
42098 for an error
42099 @end table
42100
42101 @item vFlashDone
42102 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
42103 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
42104 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
42105 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
42106 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
42107 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
42108 request is completed.
42109
42110 @item vKill;@var{pid}
42111 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
42112 @anchor{vKill packet}
42113 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
42114 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
42115 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
42116 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
42117
42118 Reply:
42119 @table @samp
42120 @item E @var{nn}
42121 for an error
42122 @item OK
42123 for success
42124 @end table
42125
42126 @item vMustReplyEmpty
42127 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
42128 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
42129 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
42130 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
42131
42132 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
42133 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
42134 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
42135 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
42136 packets then it is possible that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
42137 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
42138
42139 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
42140 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
42141 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
42142 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
42143 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
42144 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
42145 state.
42146
42147 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
42148
42149 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
42150
42151 Reply:
42152 @table @samp
42153 @item E @var{nn}
42154 for an error
42155 @item @r{Any stop packet}
42156 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
42157 @end table
42158
42159 @item vStopped
42160 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
42161 @xref{Notification Packets}.
42162
42163 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
42164 @anchor{X packet}
42165 @cindex @samp{X} packet
42166 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
42167 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
42168 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
42169 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
42170
42171 Reply:
42172 @table @samp
42173 @item OK
42174 for success
42175 @item E @var{NN}
42176 for an error
42177 @end table
42178
42179 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
42180 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
42181 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
42182 @cindex @samp{z} packet
42183 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
42184 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
42185 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
42186
42187 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
42188 separately.
42189
42190 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
42191 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
42192 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
42193 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
42194 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
42195 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
42196
42197 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
42198 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
42199 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
42200 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
42201 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
42202 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
42203
42204 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
42205 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
42206 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
42207 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
42208 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
42209 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
42210 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
42211 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
42212 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
42213 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
42214 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
42215 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
42216 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
42217
42218 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
42219 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
42220
42221 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
42222 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
42223
42224 @table @samp
42225
42226 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
42227 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
42228 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
42229
42230 @end table
42231
42232 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
42233 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
42234 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
42235 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
42236 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
42237 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
42238 separators. Each expression has the following form:
42239
42240 @table @samp
42241
42242 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
42243 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
42244 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
42245
42246 @end table
42247
42248 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
42249 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
42250 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
42251 target, is not defined.}
42252
42253 Reply:
42254 @table @samp
42255 @item OK
42256 success
42257 @item @w{}
42258 not supported
42259 @item E @var{NN}
42260 for an error
42261 @end table
42262
42263 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
42264 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
42265 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
42266 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
42267 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
42268 address @var{addr}.
42269
42270 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
42271 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
42272 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
42273 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
42274
42275 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
42276 movement.}
42277
42278 Reply:
42279 @table @samp
42280 @item OK
42281 success
42282 @item @w{}
42283 not supported
42284 @item E @var{NN}
42285 for an error
42286 @end table
42287
42288 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
42289 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
42290 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
42291 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
42292 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
42293 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
42294
42295 Reply:
42296 @table @samp
42297 @item OK
42298 success
42299 @item @w{}
42300 not supported
42301 @item E @var{NN}
42302 for an error
42303 @end table
42304
42305 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
42306 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
42307 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
42308 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
42309 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
42310 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
42311
42312 Reply:
42313 @table @samp
42314 @item OK
42315 success
42316 @item @w{}
42317 not supported
42318 @item E @var{NN}
42319 for an error
42320 @end table
42321
42322 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
42323 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
42324 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
42325 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
42326 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
42327 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
42328
42329 Reply:
42330 @table @samp
42331 @item OK
42332 success
42333 @item @w{}
42334 not supported
42335 @item E @var{NN}
42336 for an error
42337 @end table
42338
42339 @end table
42340
42341 @node Stop Reply Packets
42342 @section Stop Reply Packets
42343 @cindex stop reply packets
42344
42345 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
42346 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
42347 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
42348 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
42349 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
42350 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
42351 @value{GDBN} source code.
42352
42353 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
42354 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
42355 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
42356
42357 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
42358 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
42359 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
42360 components.
42361
42362 @table @samp
42363
42364 @item S @var{AA}
42365 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
42366 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
42367 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
42368
42369 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
42370 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
42371 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
42372 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
42373 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
42374 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
42375 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
42376 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
42377
42378 @itemize @bullet
42379 @item
42380 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
42381 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
42382 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
42383 two-digit hex number.
42384
42385 @item
42386 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread ID of
42387 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
42388
42389 @item
42390 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
42391 the core on which the stop event was detected.
42392
42393 @item
42394 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
42395 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
42396 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
42397 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
42398
42399 @item
42400 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
42401 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
42402 future.
42403 @end itemize
42404
42405 The currently defined stop reasons are:
42406
42407 @table @samp
42408 @item watch
42409 @itemx rwatch
42410 @itemx awatch
42411 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
42412 hex.
42413
42414 @item syscall_entry
42415 @itemx syscall_return
42416 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
42417 syscall number, in hex.
42418
42419 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
42420 @item library
42421 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
42422 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
42423 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
42424
42425 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
42426 @item replaylog
42427 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
42428 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
42429 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
42430 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
42431 for more information.
42432
42433 @item swbreak
42434 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
42435 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
42436 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
42437 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
42438 part must be left empty.
42439
42440 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
42441 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
42442 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
42443 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
42444 address.
42445
42446 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
42447 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
42448 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
42449 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
42450 indicating support.
42451
42452 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
42453
42454 @item hwbreak
42455 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
42456 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
42457
42458 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
42459 apply.
42460
42461 @cindex fork events, remote reply
42462 @item fork
42463 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r} is the
42464 thread ID of the new child process, as specified in @ref{thread-id
42465 syntax}. This packet is only applicable to targets that support fork
42466 events.
42467
42468 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
42469 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
42470 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
42471 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
42472 indicating support.
42473
42474 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
42475 @item vfork
42476 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r} is the
42477 thread ID of the new child process, as specified in @ref{thread-id
42478 syntax}. This packet is only applicable to targets that support vfork
42479 events.
42480
42481 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
42482 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
42483 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
42484 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
42485 indicating support.
42486
42487 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
42488 @item vforkdone
42489 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
42490 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
42491 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
42492 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
42493 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
42494
42495 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
42496 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
42497 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
42498 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
42499 indicating support.
42500
42501 @cindex exec events, remote reply
42502 @item exec
42503 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
42504 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
42505 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
42506
42507 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
42508 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
42509 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
42510 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
42511 indicating support.
42512
42513 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
42514 @anchor{thread create event}
42515 @item create
42516 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
42517 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
42518 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
42519 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
42520 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
42521 @var{r} part is ignored.
42522
42523 @end table
42524
42525 @item W @var{AA}
42526 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
42527 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
42528 applicable to certain targets.
42529
42530 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
42531 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
42532 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
42533 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
42534 hex strings.
42535
42536 @item X @var{AA}
42537 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
42538 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
42539
42540 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
42541 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
42542 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
42543 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
42544 hex strings.
42545
42546 @anchor{thread exit event}
42547 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
42548 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
42549
42550 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
42551 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
42552 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
42553 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
42554
42555 @item N
42556 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
42557 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
42558 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
42559 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
42560 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
42561 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
42562 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
42563 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
42564 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
42565 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
42566 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
42567 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
42568 support.
42569
42570 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
42571 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
42572 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
42573 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
42574 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
42575
42576 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
42577 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
42578 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
42579 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
42580 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
42581 system calls.
42582
42583 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
42584 this very system call.
42585
42586 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
42587 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
42588 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
42589 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
42590 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
42591 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
42592
42593 @end table
42594
42595 @node General Query Packets
42596 @section General Query Packets
42597 @cindex remote query requests
42598
42599 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
42600 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
42601 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
42602 sending information to and from the stub.
42603
42604 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
42605 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
42606 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
42607 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
42608 conventions:
42609
42610 @itemize @bullet
42611 @item
42612 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
42613 @item
42614 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
42615 letter.
42616 @item
42617 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
42618 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
42619 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
42620 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
42621 @end itemize
42622
42623 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
42624 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
42625 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
42626 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
42627 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
42628 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
42629 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
42630 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
42631 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
42632 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
42633 packet.}.
42634
42635 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
42636 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
42637 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
42638 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
42639 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
42640
42641 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
42642
42643 @table @samp
42644
42645 @item QAgent:1
42646 @itemx QAgent:0
42647 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
42648 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
42649
42650 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
42651 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
42652 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
42653 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
42654 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
42655 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
42656 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
42657 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
42658 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
42659 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
42660 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
42661
42662 @item qC
42663 @cindex current thread, remote request
42664 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
42665 Return the current thread ID.
42666
42667 Reply:
42668 @table @samp
42669 @item QC @var{thread-id}
42670 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
42671 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
42672 @item @r{(anything else)}
42673 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
42674 @end table
42675
42676 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
42677 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
42678 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
42679 @anchor{qCRC packet}
42680 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
42681 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
42682 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
42683 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
42684
42685 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
42686 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
42687 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
42688 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
42689 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
42690 detect trailing zeros.
42691
42692 Reply:
42693 @table @samp
42694 @item E @var{NN}
42695 An error (such as memory fault)
42696 @item C @var{crc32}
42697 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
42698 @end table
42699
42700 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
42701 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
42702 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
42703 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
42704 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
42705 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
42706 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
42707 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
42708 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
42709 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
42710 randomization.
42711
42712 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
42713
42714 Reply:
42715 @table @samp
42716 @item OK
42717 The request succeeded.
42718
42719 @item E @var{nn}
42720 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
42721
42722 @item @w{}
42723 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
42724 by the stub.
42725 @end table
42726
42727 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42728 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
42729 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
42730 address space randomization.
42731
42732 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
42733 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
42734 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
42735 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
42736 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
42737 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
42738 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
42739 inferior using a shell or not.
42740
42741 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
42742 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
42743 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
42744 values are considered an error.
42745
42746 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
42747 mode}).
42748
42749 Reply:
42750 @table @samp
42751 @item OK
42752 The request succeeded.
42753
42754 @item E @var{nn}
42755 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
42756 @end table
42757
42758 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42759 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
42760 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
42761 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
42762
42763 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
42764 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
42765
42766 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
42767 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
42768 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
42769 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
42770 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
42771 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
42772 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
42773 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
42774 environment}).
42775
42776 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
42777 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
42778 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
42779 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
42780 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
42781 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
42782 not be present.
42783
42784 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
42785 mode}).
42786
42787 Reply:
42788 @table @samp
42789 @item OK
42790 The request succeeded.
42791 @end table
42792
42793 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42794 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
42795 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
42796 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
42797 inferior.
42798
42799 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
42800 @pxref{set environment}.
42801
42802 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
42803 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
42804 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
42805 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
42806 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
42807 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
42808 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
42809 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
42810
42811 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
42812 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
42813
42814 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
42815 mode}).
42816
42817 Reply:
42818 @table @samp
42819 @item OK
42820 The request succeeded.
42821 @end table
42822
42823 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42824 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
42825 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
42826 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
42827 inferior.
42828
42829 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
42830 @pxref{unset environment}.
42831
42832 @item QEnvironmentReset
42833 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
42834 @cindex reset environment, remote request
42835 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
42836 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
42837 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
42838 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
42839 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
42840 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
42841 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
42842 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
42843 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
42844
42845 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
42846 mode}).
42847
42848 Reply:
42849 @table @samp
42850 @item OK
42851 The request succeeded.
42852 @end table
42853
42854 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
42855 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
42856 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
42857 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
42858 inferior.
42859
42860 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
42861 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
42862 @cindex set working directory, remote request
42863 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
42864 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
42865 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
42866
42867 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
42868 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
42869 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
42870 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
42871 directory to its original, empty value.
42872
42873 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
42874 mode}).
42875
42876 Reply:
42877 @table @samp
42878 @item OK
42879 The request succeeded.
42880 @end table
42881
42882 @item qfThreadInfo
42883 @itemx qsThreadInfo
42884 @cindex list active threads, remote request
42885 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
42886 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
42887 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
42888 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
42889 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
42890 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
42891 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
42892 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
42893
42894 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
42895
42896 Reply:
42897 @table @samp
42898 @item m @var{thread-id}
42899 A single thread ID
42900 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
42901 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
42902 @item l
42903 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
42904 @end table
42905
42906 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
42907 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
42908 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
42909 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
42910 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
42911 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
42912 fields.
42913
42914 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
42915 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
42916 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
42917 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
42918 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
42919
42920 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
42921 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
42922 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
42923 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
42924 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
42925
42926 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
42927 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
42928
42929 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
42930 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
42931 information associated with the variable.)
42932
42933 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
42934 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
42935 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
42936 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
42937 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
42938 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
42939
42940 Reply:
42941 @table @samp
42942 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
42943 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
42944 local storage requested.
42945
42946 @item E @var{nn}
42947 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
42948
42949 @item @w{}
42950 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
42951 @end table
42952
42953 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
42954 @cindex get thread information block address
42955 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
42956 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
42957
42958 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
42959
42960 Reply:
42961 @table @samp
42962 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
42963 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
42964 thread information block.
42965
42966 @item E @var{nn}
42967 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
42968 address could not be retrieved.
42969
42970 @item @w{}
42971 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
42972 @end table
42973
42974 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
42975 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
42976 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
42977 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
42978 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
42979 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
42980 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
42981
42982 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
42983
42984 Reply:
42985 @table @samp
42986 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
42987 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
42988 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
42989 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
42990 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
42991 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
42992 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
42993 @end table
42994
42995 @item qMemTags:@var{start address},@var{length}:@var{type}
42996 @anchor{qMemTags}
42997 @cindex fetch memory tags
42998 @cindex @samp{qMemTags} packet
42999 Fetch memory tags of type @var{type} from the address range
43000 @w{@r{[}@var{start address}, @var{start address} + @var{length}@r{)}}. The
43001 target is responsible for calculating how many tags will be returned, as this
43002 is architecture-specific.
43003
43004 @var{start address} is the starting address of the memory range.
43005
43006 @var{length} is the length, in bytes, of the memory range.
43007
43008 @var{type} is the type of tag the request wants to fetch. The type is a signed
43009 integer.
43010
43011 Reply:
43012 @table @samp
43013 @item @var{mxx}@dots{}
43014 Hex encoded sequence of uninterpreted bytes, @var{xx}@dots{}, representing the
43015 tags found in the requested memory range.
43016
43017 @item E @var{nn}
43018 An error occured. This means that fetching of memory tags failed for some
43019 reason.
43020
43021 @item @w{}
43022 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qMemTags} is not supported by the stub,
43023 although this should not happen given @value{GDBN} will only send this packet
43024 if the stub has advertised support for memory tagging via @samp{qSupported}.
43025 @end table
43026
43027 @item QMemTags:@var{start address},@var{length}:@var{type}:@var{tag bytes}
43028 @anchor{QMemTags}
43029 @cindex store memory tags
43030 @cindex @samp{QMemTags} packet
43031 Store memory tags of type @var{type} to the address range
43032 @w{@r{[}@var{start address}, @var{start address} + @var{length}@r{)}}. The
43033 target is responsible for interpreting the type, the tag bytes and modifying
43034 the memory tag granules accordingly, given this is architecture-specific.
43035
43036 The interpretation of how many tags (@var{nt}) should be written to how many
43037 memory tag granules (@var{ng}) is also architecture-specific. The behavior is
43038 implementation-specific, but the following is suggested.
43039
43040 If the number of memory tags, @var{nt}, is greater than or equal to the
43041 number of memory tag granules, @var{ng}, only @var{ng} tags will be
43042 stored.
43043
43044 If @var{nt} is less than @var{ng}, the behavior is that of a fill operation,
43045 and the tag bytes will be used as a pattern that will get repeated until
43046 @var{ng} tags are stored.
43047
43048 @var{start address} is the starting address of the memory range. The address
43049 does not have any restriction on alignment or size.
43050
43051 @var{length} is the length, in bytes, of the memory range.
43052
43053 @var{type} is the type of tag the request wants to fetch. The type is a signed
43054 integer.
43055
43056 @var{tag bytes} is a sequence of hex encoded uninterpreted bytes which will be
43057 interpreted by the target. Each pair of hex digits is interpreted as a
43058 single byte.
43059
43060 Reply:
43061 @table @samp
43062 @item OK
43063 The request was successful and the memory tag granules were modified
43064 accordingly.
43065
43066 @item E @var{nn}
43067 An error occured. This means that modifying the memory tag granules failed
43068 for some reason.
43069
43070 @item @w{}
43071 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QMemTags} is not supported by the stub,
43072 although this should not happen given @value{GDBN} will only send this packet
43073 if the stub has advertised support for memory tagging via @samp{qSupported}.
43074 @end table
43075
43076 @item qOffsets
43077 @cindex section offsets, remote request
43078 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
43079 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
43080 image.
43081
43082 Reply:
43083 @table @samp
43084 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
43085 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
43086 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
43087 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
43088 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
43089 segments by the supplied offsets.
43090
43091 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
43092 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
43093 to the @code{Bss} section.}
43094
43095 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
43096 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
43097 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
43098 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
43099 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
43100 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
43101 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
43102 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
43103 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
43104 @end table
43105
43106 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
43107 @cindex thread information, remote request
43108 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
43109 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
43110 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
43111 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
43112
43113 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
43114 (see below).
43115
43116 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
43117
43118 @item QNonStop:1
43119 @itemx QNonStop:0
43120 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
43121 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
43122 @anchor{QNonStop}
43123 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
43124 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
43125
43126 Reply:
43127 @table @samp
43128 @item OK
43129 The request succeeded.
43130
43131 @item E @var{nn}
43132 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
43133
43134 @item @w{}
43135 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
43136 the stub.
43137 @end table
43138
43139 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
43140 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
43141 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
43142 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
43143
43144 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
43145 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
43146 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
43147 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
43148 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
43149 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
43150 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
43151
43152 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
43153 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
43154 is listed, every system call should be reported.
43155
43156 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
43157 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
43158 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
43159 report the requested syscalls.
43160
43161 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
43162 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
43163
43164 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
43165 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
43166 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
43167 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
43168
43169 Reply:
43170 @table @samp
43171 @item OK
43172 The request succeeded.
43173
43174 @item E @var{nn}
43175 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
43176
43177 @item @w{}
43178 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
43179 the stub.
43180 @end table
43181
43182 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
43183 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
43184 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
43185 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
43186
43187 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
43188 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
43189 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
43190 @anchor{QPassSignals}
43191 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
43192 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
43193 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
43194 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
43195 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
43196 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
43197 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
43198 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
43199 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
43200
43201 Reply:
43202 @table @samp
43203 @item OK
43204 The request succeeded.
43205
43206 @item E @var{nn}
43207 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
43208
43209 @item @w{}
43210 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
43211 the stub.
43212 @end table
43213
43214 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
43215 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
43216 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
43217 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
43218
43219 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
43220 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
43221 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
43222 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
43223 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
43224 Others should be silently discarded.
43225
43226 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
43227 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
43228 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
43229 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
43230 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
43231 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
43232 signals.
43233
43234 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
43235 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
43236
43237 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
43238 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
43239 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
43240 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
43241 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
43242
43243 Reply:
43244 @table @samp
43245 @item OK
43246 The request succeeded.
43247
43248 @item E @var{nn}
43249 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
43250
43251 @item @w{}
43252 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
43253 by the stub.
43254 @end table
43255
43256 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
43257 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
43258 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
43259 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
43260
43261 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
43262 @item QThreadEvents:1
43263 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
43264 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
43265 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
43266
43267 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
43268 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
43269 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
43270 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
43271 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
43272 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
43273 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
43274 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
43275 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
43276 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
43277
43278 Reply:
43279 @table @samp
43280 @item OK
43281 The request succeeded.
43282
43283 @item E @var{nn}
43284 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
43285
43286 @item @w{}
43287 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
43288 the stub.
43289 @end table
43290
43291 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
43292 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
43293
43294 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
43295 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
43296 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
43297 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
43298 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
43299 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
43300 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
43301 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
43302 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
43303
43304 Reply:
43305 @table @samp
43306 @item OK
43307 A command response with no output.
43308 @item @var{OUTPUT}
43309 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
43310 @item E @var{NN}
43311 Indicate a badly formed request. The error number @var{NN} is given as
43312 hex digits.
43313 @item @w{}
43314 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
43315 @end table
43316
43317 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
43318 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
43319 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
43320 packets.)
43321
43322 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
43323 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
43324 @ifnotinfo
43325 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
43326 @end ifnotinfo
43327 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
43328 @anchor{qSearch memory}
43329 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
43330 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
43331 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
43332
43333 Reply:
43334 @table @samp
43335 @item 0
43336 The pattern was not found.
43337 @item 1,address
43338 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
43339 @item E @var{NN}
43340 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
43341 @item @w{}
43342 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
43343 @end table
43344
43345 @item QStartNoAckMode
43346 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
43347 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
43348 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
43349 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
43350
43351 Reply:
43352 @table @samp
43353 @item OK
43354 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
43355 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this response,
43356 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
43357 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
43358 @item @w{}
43359 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
43360 @end table
43361
43362 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
43363 @cindex supported packets, remote query
43364 @cindex features of the remote protocol
43365 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
43366 @anchor{qSupported}
43367 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
43368 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
43369 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
43370 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
43371 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
43372 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
43373 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
43374 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
43375 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
43376 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
43377 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
43378 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
43379 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
43380 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
43381
43382 Reply:
43383 @table @samp
43384 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
43385 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
43386 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
43387 possible forms).
43388 @item @w{}
43389 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
43390 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
43391 @end table
43392
43393 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
43394 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
43395 are:
43396
43397 @table @samp
43398 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
43399 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
43400 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
43401 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
43402 @item @var{name}+
43403 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
43404 need an associated value.
43405 @item @var{name}-
43406 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
43407 @item @var{name}?
43408 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
43409 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
43410 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
43411 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
43412 @end table
43413
43414 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
43415 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
43416 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
43417 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
43418 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
43419
43420 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
43421 are defined:
43422
43423 @table @samp
43424 @item multiprocess
43425 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
43426 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
43427 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
43428 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
43429 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
43430
43431 @item xmlRegisters
43432 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
43433 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
43434 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
43435 description.
43436
43437 @item qRelocInsn
43438 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
43439 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
43440 instruction reply packet}).
43441
43442 @item swbreak
43443 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
43444 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
43445
43446 @item hwbreak
43447 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
43448 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
43449
43450 @item fork-events
43451 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
43452 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
43453 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
43454 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
43455
43456 @item vfork-events
43457 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
43458 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
43459 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
43460 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
43461
43462 @item exec-events
43463 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
43464 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
43465 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
43466 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
43467
43468 @item vContSupported
43469 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
43470 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
43471 @end table
43472
43473 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
43474 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
43475 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
43476 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
43477 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
43478 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
43479 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
43480 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
43481 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
43482 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
43483 all the features it supports.
43484
43485 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
43486 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
43487
43488 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
43489 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
43490 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
43491 form response.
43492
43493 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
43494 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
43495 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
43496 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
43497
43498 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
43499 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
43500 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
43501 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
43502 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
43503
43504 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
43505
43506 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
43507 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
43508 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
43509 @item Feature Name
43510 @tab Value Required
43511 @tab Default
43512 @tab Probe Allowed
43513
43514 @item @samp{PacketSize}
43515 @tab Yes
43516 @tab @samp{-}
43517 @tab No
43518
43519 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
43520 @tab No
43521 @tab @samp{-}
43522 @tab Yes
43523
43524 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
43525 @tab No
43526 @tab @samp{-}
43527 @tab Yes
43528
43529 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
43530 @tab No
43531 @tab @samp{-}
43532 @tab Yes
43533
43534 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
43535 @tab No
43536 @tab @samp{-}
43537 @tab Yes
43538
43539 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
43540 @tab No
43541 @tab @samp{-}
43542 @tab Yes
43543
43544 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
43545 @tab No
43546 @tab @samp{-}
43547 @tab Yes
43548
43549 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
43550 @tab No
43551 @tab @samp{-}
43552 @tab Yes
43553
43554 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
43555 @tab No
43556 @tab @samp{-}
43557 @tab No
43558
43559 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
43560 @tab No
43561 @tab @samp{-}
43562 @tab Yes
43563
43564 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
43565 @tab No
43566 @tab @samp{-}
43567 @tab Yes
43568
43569 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
43570 @tab No
43571 @tab @samp{-}
43572 @tab Yes
43573
43574 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
43575 @tab No
43576 @tab @samp{-}
43577 @tab Yes
43578
43579 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
43580 @tab No
43581 @tab @samp{-}
43582 @tab Yes
43583
43584 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
43585 @tab No
43586 @tab @samp{-}
43587 @tab Yes
43588
43589 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
43590 @tab No
43591 @tab @samp{-}
43592 @tab Yes
43593
43594 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
43595 @tab No
43596 @tab @samp{-}
43597 @tab Yes
43598
43599 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
43600 @tab Yes
43601 @tab @samp{-}
43602 @tab Yes
43603
43604 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
43605 @tab Yes
43606 @tab @samp{-}
43607 @tab Yes
43608
43609 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
43610 @tab Yes
43611 @tab @samp{-}
43612 @tab Yes
43613
43614 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
43615 @tab Yes
43616 @tab @samp{-}
43617 @tab Yes
43618
43619 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
43620 @tab Yes
43621 @tab @samp{-}
43622 @tab Yes
43623
43624 @item @samp{QNonStop}
43625 @tab No
43626 @tab @samp{-}
43627 @tab Yes
43628
43629 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
43630 @tab No
43631 @tab @samp{-}
43632 @tab Yes
43633
43634 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
43635 @tab No
43636 @tab @samp{-}
43637 @tab Yes
43638
43639 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
43640 @tab No
43641 @tab @samp{-}
43642 @tab Yes
43643
43644 @item @samp{multiprocess}
43645 @tab No
43646 @tab @samp{-}
43647 @tab No
43648
43649 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
43650 @tab No
43651 @tab @samp{-}
43652 @tab No
43653
43654 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
43655 @tab No
43656 @tab @samp{-}
43657 @tab No
43658
43659 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
43660 @tab No
43661 @tab @samp{-}
43662 @tab No
43663
43664 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
43665 @tab No
43666 @tab @samp{-}
43667 @tab No
43668
43669 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
43670 @tab No
43671 @tab @samp{-}
43672 @tab No
43673
43674 @item @samp{QAgent}
43675 @tab No
43676 @tab @samp{-}
43677 @tab No
43678
43679 @item @samp{QAllow}
43680 @tab No
43681 @tab @samp{-}
43682 @tab No
43683
43684 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
43685 @tab No
43686 @tab @samp{-}
43687 @tab No
43688
43689 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
43690 @tab No
43691 @tab @samp{-}
43692 @tab No
43693
43694 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
43695 @tab No
43696 @tab @samp{-}
43697 @tab No
43698
43699 @item @samp{tracenz}
43700 @tab No
43701 @tab @samp{-}
43702 @tab No
43703
43704 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
43705 @tab No
43706 @tab @samp{-}
43707 @tab No
43708
43709 @item @samp{swbreak}
43710 @tab No
43711 @tab @samp{-}
43712 @tab No
43713
43714 @item @samp{hwbreak}
43715 @tab No
43716 @tab @samp{-}
43717 @tab No
43718
43719 @item @samp{fork-events}
43720 @tab No
43721 @tab @samp{-}
43722 @tab No
43723
43724 @item @samp{vfork-events}
43725 @tab No
43726 @tab @samp{-}
43727 @tab No
43728
43729 @item @samp{exec-events}
43730 @tab No
43731 @tab @samp{-}
43732 @tab No
43733
43734 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
43735 @tab No
43736 @tab @samp{-}
43737 @tab No
43738
43739 @item @samp{no-resumed}
43740 @tab No
43741 @tab @samp{-}
43742 @tab No
43743
43744 @item @samp{memory-tagging}
43745 @tab No
43746 @tab @samp{-}
43747 @tab No
43748
43749 @end multitable
43750
43751 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
43752
43753 @table @samp
43754 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
43755 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
43756 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
43757 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
43758 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
43759 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
43760 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
43761 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
43762 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
43763 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
43764
43765 @item qXfer:auxv:read
43766 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
43767 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
43768
43769 @item qXfer:btrace:read
43770 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
43771 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
43772
43773 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
43774 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
43775 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
43776
43777 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
43778 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
43779 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
43780
43781 @item qXfer:features:read
43782 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
43783 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
43784
43785 @item qXfer:libraries:read
43786 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
43787 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
43788
43789 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
43790 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
43791 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
43792
43793 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
43794 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
43795 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
43796 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
43797
43798 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
43799 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
43800 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
43801
43802 @item qXfer:sdata:read
43803 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
43804 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
43805
43806 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
43807 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
43808 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
43809
43810 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
43811 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
43812 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
43813
43814 @item qXfer:threads:read
43815 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
43816 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
43817
43818 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
43819 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
43820 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
43821
43822 @item qXfer:uib:read
43823 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
43824 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
43825
43826 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
43827 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
43828 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
43829
43830 @item QNonStop
43831 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
43832 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
43833
43834 @item QCatchSyscalls
43835 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
43836 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
43837
43838 @item QPassSignals
43839 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
43840 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
43841
43842 @item QStartNoAckMode
43843 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
43844 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
43845
43846 @item multiprocess
43847 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
43848 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
43849 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
43850 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
43851 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
43852 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
43853 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
43854 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
43855 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
43856 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
43857 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
43858
43859 @item qXfer:osdata:read
43860 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
43861 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
43862
43863 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
43864 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
43865 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
43866 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
43867
43868 @item ConditionalTracepoints
43869 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
43870 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
43871
43872 @item ReverseContinue
43873 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
43874 (@pxref{bc}).
43875
43876 @item ReverseStep
43877 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
43878 (@pxref{bs}).
43879
43880 @item TracepointSource
43881 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
43882 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
43883
43884 @item QAgent
43885 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
43886
43887 @item QAllow
43888 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
43889
43890 @item QDisableRandomization
43891 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
43892
43893 @item StaticTracepoint
43894 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
43895 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
43896
43897 @item InstallInTrace
43898 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
43899 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
43900
43901 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
43902 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
43903 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
43904 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
43905
43906 @item QTBuffer:size
43907 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
43908 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
43909
43910 @item tracenz
43911 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
43912 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
43913 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
43914
43915 @item BreakpointCommands
43916 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
43917 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
43918 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
43919
43920 @item Qbtrace:off
43921 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
43922
43923 @item Qbtrace:bts
43924 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
43925
43926 @item Qbtrace:pt
43927 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
43928
43929 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
43930 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
43931
43932 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
43933 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
43934
43935 @item swbreak
43936 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
43937 breakpoints.
43938
43939 @item hwbreak
43940 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
43941 breakpoints.
43942
43943 @item fork-events
43944 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
43945
43946 @item vfork-events
43947 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
43948 and vforkdone events.
43949
43950 @item exec-events
43951 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
43952
43953 @item vContSupported
43954 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
43955 @samp{vCont?} packet.
43956
43957 @item QThreadEvents
43958 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
43959
43960 @item no-resumed
43961 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
43962
43963
43964 @item memory-tagging
43965 The remote stub supports and implements the required memory tagging
43966 functionality and understands the @samp{qMemTags} (@pxref{qMemTags}) and
43967 @samp{QMemTags} (@pxref{QMemTags}) packets.
43968
43969 For AArch64 GNU/Linux systems, this feature also requires access to the
43970 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} file so memory mapping page flags can be inspected.
43971 This is done via the @samp{vFile} requests.
43972
43973 @end table
43974
43975 @item qSymbol::
43976 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
43977 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
43978 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
43979 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
43980
43981 Reply:
43982 @table @samp
43983 @item OK
43984 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
43985 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
43986 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
43987 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
43988 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
43989 below.
43990 @end table
43991
43992 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
43993 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
43994
43995 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
43996 target has previously requested.
43997
43998 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
43999 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
44000 will be empty.
44001
44002 Reply:
44003 @table @samp
44004 @item OK
44005 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
44006 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
44007 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
44008 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
44009 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
44010 @end table
44011
44012 @item qTBuffer
44013 @itemx QTBuffer
44014 @itemx QTDisconnected
44015 @itemx QTDP
44016 @itemx QTDPsrc
44017 @itemx QTDV
44018 @itemx qTfP
44019 @itemx qTfV
44020 @itemx QTFrame
44021 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
44022
44023 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
44024
44025 @anchor{qThreadExtraInfo}
44026 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
44027 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
44028 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
44029 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
44030 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
44031 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
44032 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
44033 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
44034 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
44035 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
44036 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
44037
44038 Reply:
44039 @table @samp
44040 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
44041 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
44042 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
44043 the thread's attributes.
44044 @end table
44045
44046 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
44047 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
44048 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
44049 packets.)
44050
44051 @item QTNotes
44052 @itemx qTP
44053 @itemx QTSave
44054 @itemx qTsP
44055 @itemx qTsV
44056 @itemx QTStart
44057 @itemx QTStop
44058 @itemx QTEnable
44059 @itemx QTDisable
44060 @itemx QTinit
44061 @itemx QTro
44062 @itemx qTStatus
44063 @itemx qTV
44064 @itemx qTfSTM
44065 @itemx qTsSTM
44066 @itemx qTSTMat
44067 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
44068
44069 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
44070 @cindex read special object, remote request
44071 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
44072 @anchor{qXfer read}
44073 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
44074 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
44075 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
44076 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
44077 additional details about what data to access.
44078
44079 Reply:
44080 @table @samp
44081 @item m @var{data}
44082 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
44083 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
44084 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
44085 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
44086 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
44087 request.
44088
44089 @item l @var{data}
44090 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
44091 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
44092 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
44093
44094 @item l
44095 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
44096 There is no more data to be read.
44097
44098 @item E00
44099 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
44100
44101 @item E @var{nn}
44102 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
44103 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
44104
44105 @item @w{}
44106 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
44107 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
44108 @end table
44109
44110 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
44111 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
44112 formats, listed above.
44113
44114 @table @samp
44115 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
44116 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
44117 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
44118 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
44119
44120 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44121 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44122
44123 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
44124 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
44125
44126 Return a description of the current branch trace.
44127 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
44128 packet may have one of the following values:
44129
44130 @table @code
44131 @item all
44132 Returns all available branch trace.
44133
44134 @item new
44135 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
44136 the last read request.
44137
44138 @item delta
44139 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
44140 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
44141 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
44142 used to stitch traces together.
44143
44144 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
44145 @end table
44146
44147 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
44148 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44149
44150 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
44151 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
44152
44153 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
44154 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
44155
44156 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
44157 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44158
44159 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
44160 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
44161 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
44162 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
44163 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
44164 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
44165 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
44166
44167 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44168 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44169
44170 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
44171 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
44172 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
44173 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
44174 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
44175
44176 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44177 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44178
44179 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
44180 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
44181 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
44182 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
44183 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
44184
44185 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
44186 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
44187 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
44188
44189 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44190 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44191
44192 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
44193 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
44194 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
44195 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
44196 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
44197 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
44198 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
44199 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
44200
44201 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
44202 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
44203
44204 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44205 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44206
44207 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
44208 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
44209 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
44210 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
44211
44212 @table @code
44213 @item start=@var{address}
44214 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
44215 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
44216 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
44217 chosen as the starting point.
44218
44219 @item prev=@var{address}
44220 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
44221 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
44222 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
44223 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
44224 exists prior to the starting point.
44225
44226 @item lmid=@var{lmid}
44227 A hexadecimal number specifying a namespace identifier. This is
44228 currently only used together with @samp{start} to provide the
44229 namespace identifier back to @value{GDBN} in the response.
44230 @value{GDBN} will only provide values that were previously reported to
44231 it. If unset, the response will include @samp{lmid="0x0"}.
44232 @end table
44233
44234 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
44235 ignored.
44236
44237 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
44238 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
44239 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
44240 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
44241 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
44242
44243 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44244 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44245
44246 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
44247 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
44248
44249 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
44250 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
44251 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
44252 Action Lists}.
44253
44254 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44255 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
44256 (@pxref{qSupported}).
44257
44258 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
44259 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
44260 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
44261 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
44262 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
44263
44264 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44265 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
44266 (@pxref{qSupported}).
44267
44268 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
44269 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
44270 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
44271 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
44272 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
44273
44274 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44275 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44276
44277 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
44278 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
44279
44280 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
44281 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
44282 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
44283
44284 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44285 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44286
44287 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
44288 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
44289
44290 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
44291 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
44292
44293 This packet is not probed by default.
44294
44295 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
44296 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
44297 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
44298 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
44299 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
44300
44301 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44302 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
44303
44304 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
44305 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
44306 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
44307 @xref{Operating System Information}.
44308
44309 @end table
44310
44311 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
44312 @cindex write data into object, remote request
44313 @anchor{qXfer write}
44314 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
44315 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
44316 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
44317 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
44318 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
44319 to access.
44320
44321 Reply:
44322 @table @samp
44323 @item @var{nn}
44324 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
44325 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
44326
44327 @item E00
44328 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
44329
44330 @item E @var{nn}
44331 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
44332 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
44333
44334 @item @w{}
44335 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
44336 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
44337 @end table
44338
44339 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
44340 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
44341 formats, listed above.
44342
44343 @table @samp
44344 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
44345 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
44346 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
44347 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
44348 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
44349
44350 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
44351 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
44352 (@pxref{qSupported}).
44353 @end table
44354
44355 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
44356 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
44357 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
44358 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
44359 must respond with an empty packet.
44360
44361 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
44362 @cindex query attached, remote request
44363 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
44364 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
44365 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
44366 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
44367 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
44368 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
44369 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
44370
44371 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
44372 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
44373 the @code{quit} command.
44374
44375 Reply:
44376 @table @samp
44377 @item 1
44378 The remote server attached to an existing process.
44379 @item 0
44380 The remote server created a new process.
44381 @item E @var{NN}
44382 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
44383 @end table
44384
44385 @item Qbtrace:bts
44386 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
44387
44388 Reply:
44389 @table @samp
44390 @item OK
44391 Branch tracing has been enabled.
44392 @item E.errtext
44393 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
44394 @end table
44395
44396 @item Qbtrace:pt
44397 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
44398
44399 Reply:
44400 @table @samp
44401 @item OK
44402 Branch tracing has been enabled.
44403 @item E.errtext
44404 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
44405 @end table
44406
44407 @item Qbtrace:off
44408 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
44409
44410 Reply:
44411 @table @samp
44412 @item OK
44413 Branch tracing has been disabled.
44414 @item E.errtext
44415 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
44416 @end table
44417
44418 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
44419 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
44420 btrace recording method in bts format.
44421
44422 Reply:
44423 @table @samp
44424 @item OK
44425 The ring buffer size has been set.
44426 @item E.errtext
44427 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
44428 @end table
44429
44430 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
44431 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
44432 btrace recording method in pt format.
44433
44434 Reply:
44435 @table @samp
44436 @item OK
44437 The ring buffer size has been set.
44438 @item E.errtext
44439 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
44440 @end table
44441
44442 @end table
44443
44444 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
44445 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
44446
44447 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
44448 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
44449 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
44450
44451 @menu
44452 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
44453 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
44454 @end menu
44455
44456 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
44457 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
44458
44459 @menu
44460 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
44461 * ARM Memory Tag Types::
44462 @end menu
44463
44464 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
44465 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
44466 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
44467
44468 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
44469
44470 @table @r
44471
44472 @item 2
44473 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
44474
44475 @item 3
44476 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
44477
44478 @item 4
44479 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
44480
44481 @end table
44482
44483 @node ARM Memory Tag Types
44484 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Memory Tag Types
44485 @cindex memory tag types, @acronym{ARM}
44486
44487 These memory tag types are defined for the @samp{qMemTag} and @samp{QMemTag}
44488 packets.
44489
44490 @table @r
44491
44492 @item 0
44493 MTE logical tag
44494
44495 @item 1
44496 MTE allocation tag
44497
44498 @end table
44499
44500 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
44501 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
44502
44503 @menu
44504 * MIPS Register packet Format::
44505 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
44506 @end menu
44507
44508 @node MIPS Register packet Format
44509 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
44510 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
44511
44512 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
44513 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
44514 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
44515 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
44516 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
44517 most-significant -- least-significant.
44518
44519 @table @r
44520
44521 @item MIPS32
44522 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
44523 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
44524 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
44525
44526 @item MIPS64
44527 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
44528 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
44529 as @code{MIPS32}.
44530
44531 @end table
44532
44533 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
44534 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
44535 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
44536
44537 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
44538
44539 @table @r
44540
44541 @item 2
44542 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
44543
44544 @item 3
44545 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
44546
44547 @item 4
44548 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
44549
44550 @item 5
44551 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
44552
44553 @end table
44554
44555 @node Tracepoint Packets
44556 @section Tracepoint Packets
44557 @cindex tracepoint packets
44558 @cindex packets, tracepoint
44559
44560 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
44561 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
44562
44563 @table @samp
44564
44565 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
44566 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
44567 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
44568 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
44569 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
44570 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
44571 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
44572 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
44573 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
44574 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
44575 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
44576 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
44577 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
44578 actions.
44579
44580 Replies:
44581 @table @samp
44582 @item OK
44583 The packet was understood and carried out.
44584 @item qRelocInsn
44585 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
44586 @item @w{}
44587 The packet was not recognized.
44588 @end table
44589
44590 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
44591 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
44592 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
44593 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
44594 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
44595 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
44596 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
44597
44598 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
44599 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
44600 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
44601 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
44602 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
44603 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
44604 tracepoint actions.
44605
44606 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
44607 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
44608 following forms:
44609
44610 @table @samp
44611
44612 @item R @var{mask}
44613 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
44614 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
44615 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
44616 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
44617 not fit in a 32-bit word.
44618
44619 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
44620 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
44621 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
44622 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
44623 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
44624 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
44625 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
44626
44627 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
44628 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
44629 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
44630 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
44631 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
44632 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
44633 packet).
44634
44635 @end table
44636
44637 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
44638 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
44639 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
44640 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
44641 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
44642 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
44643 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
44644 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
44645
44646 Replies:
44647 @table @samp
44648 @item OK
44649 The packet was understood and carried out.
44650 @item qRelocInsn
44651 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
44652 @item @w{}
44653 The packet was not recognized.
44654 @end table
44655
44656 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
44657 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
44658 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
44659 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
44660 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
44661 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
44662 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
44663 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
44664
44665 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
44666 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
44667 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
44668 fit in a single packet.
44669 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
44670 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
44671
44672 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
44673 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
44674 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
44675 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
44676
44677 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
44678 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
44679 query packets.
44680
44681 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
44682 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
44683 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
44684 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
44685 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
44686 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
44687 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
44688 be found.
44689
44690 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
44691 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
44692 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
44693 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
44694 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
44695 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
44696 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
44697 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
44698 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
44699 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
44700 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
44701 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
44702 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
44703 variable.
44704
44705 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
44706 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
44707 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
44708 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
44709 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
44710
44711 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
44712 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
44713 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
44714 one of the following forms:
44715
44716 @table @samp
44717 @item F @var{f}
44718 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
44719 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
44720 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
44721
44722 @item T @var{t}
44723 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
44724 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
44725
44726 @end table
44727
44728 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
44729 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
44730 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
44731 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
44732
44733 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
44734 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
44735 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
44736 is a hexadecimal number.
44737
44738 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
44739 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
44740 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
44741 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
44742 numbers.
44743
44744 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
44745 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
44746 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
44747
44748 @item qTMinFTPILen
44749 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
44750 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
44751 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
44752 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
44753 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
44754 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
44755 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
44756 arrange for that.
44757
44758 Replies:
44759
44760 @table @samp
44761 @item 0
44762 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
44763 @item @var{length}
44764 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
44765 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
44766 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
44767 regardless of size.
44768 @item E
44769 An error has occurred.
44770 @item @w{}
44771 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
44772 @end table
44773
44774 @item QTStart
44775 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
44776 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
44777 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
44778 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
44779 instruction reply packet}).
44780
44781 @item QTStop
44782 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
44783 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
44784
44785 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
44786 @anchor{QTEnable}
44787 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
44788 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
44789 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
44790 of data from it will resume.
44791
44792 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
44793 @anchor{QTDisable}
44794 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
44795 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
44796 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
44797 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
44798
44799 @item QTinit
44800 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
44801 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
44802
44803 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
44804 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
44805 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
44806 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
44807 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
44808
44809 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
44810 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
44811 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
44812 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
44813
44814 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
44815 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
44816 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
44817 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
44818 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
44819 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
44820
44821 @item qTStatus
44822 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
44823 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
44824
44825 The reply has the form:
44826
44827 @table @samp
44828
44829 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
44830 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
44831 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
44832 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
44833
44834 @end table
44835
44836 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
44837 explanations as one of the optional fields:
44838
44839 @table @samp
44840
44841 @item tnotrun:0
44842 No trace has been run yet.
44843
44844 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
44845 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
44846 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
44847 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
44848 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
44849
44850 @item tfull:0
44851 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
44852
44853 @item tdisconnected:0
44854 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
44855
44856 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
44857 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
44858
44859 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
44860 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
44861 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
44862 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
44863 is hex encoded.
44864
44865 @item tunknown:0
44866 The trace stopped for some other reason.
44867
44868 @end table
44869
44870 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
44871 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
44872 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
44873 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
44874 trace.
44875
44876 @table @samp
44877
44878 @item tframes:@var{n}
44879 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
44880
44881 @item tcreated:@var{n}
44882 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
44883 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
44884
44885 @item tsize:@var{n}
44886 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
44887
44888 @item tfree:@var{n}
44889 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
44890
44891 @item circular:@var{n}
44892 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
44893 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
44894 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
44895 and may fill up.
44896
44897 @item disconn:@var{n}
44898 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
44899 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
44900 that the trace run will stop.
44901
44902 @end table
44903
44904 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
44905 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
44906 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
44907 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
44908 address @var{addr}.
44909
44910 Replies:
44911 @table @samp
44912 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
44913 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
44914 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
44915 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
44916 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
44917
44918 @end table
44919
44920 @item qTV:@var{var}
44921 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
44922 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
44923 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
44924
44925 Replies:
44926 @table @samp
44927 @item V@var{value}
44928 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
44929 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
44930 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
44931 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
44932 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
44933 program is running.
44934
44935 @item U
44936 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
44937 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
44938 was not collected.
44939 @end table
44940
44941 @item qTfP
44942 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
44943 @itemx qTsP
44944 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
44945 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
44946 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
44947 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
44948 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
44949 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
44950
44951 @item qTfV
44952 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
44953 @itemx qTsV
44954 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
44955 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
44956 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
44957 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
44958 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
44959 trace state variables.
44960
44961 @item qTfSTM
44962 @itemx qTsSTM
44963 @anchor{qTfSTM}
44964 @anchor{qTsSTM}
44965 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
44966 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
44967 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
44968 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
44969 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
44970 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
44971
44972 Reply:
44973 @table @samp
44974 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
44975 A single marker
44976 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
44977 a comma-separated list of markers
44978 @item l
44979 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
44980 @item E @var{nn}
44981 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
44982 @item @w{}
44983 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
44984 stub.
44985 @end table
44986
44987 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
44988 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
44989
44990 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
44991 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
44992 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
44993 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
44994 @dfn{last}).
44995
44996 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
44997 @anchor{qTSTMat}
44998 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
44999 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
45000 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
45001 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
45002 tracepoint markers.
45003
45004 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
45005 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
45006 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
45007 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
45008 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
45009 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
45010
45011 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
45012 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
45013 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
45014 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
45015 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
45016 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
45017 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
45018 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
45019 available.
45020
45021 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
45022 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
45023 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
45024
45025 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
45026 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
45027 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
45028 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
45029 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
45030 use whatever size it prefers.
45031
45032 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
45033 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
45034 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
45035 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
45036 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
45037
45038 @end table
45039
45040 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
45041 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
45042 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
45043 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
45044 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
45045 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
45046 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
45047 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
45048 it had executed in the original location.
45049
45050 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
45051 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
45052 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
45053 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
45054 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
45055 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
45056 format of the request is:
45057
45058 @table @samp
45059 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
45060
45061 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
45062 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
45063 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
45064 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
45065 memory starting at @var{to}.
45066 @end table
45067
45068 Replies:
45069 @table @samp
45070 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
45071 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
45072 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
45073 @item E @var{NN}
45074 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
45075 relocating the instruction.
45076 @end table
45077
45078 @node Host I/O Packets
45079 @section Host I/O Packets
45080 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
45081 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
45082
45083 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
45084 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
45085 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
45086 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
45087 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
45088 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
45089 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
45090 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
45091 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
45092 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
45093
45094 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
45095 its arguments. They have this format:
45096
45097 @table @samp
45098
45099 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
45100 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
45101 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
45102 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
45103 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
45104 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
45105 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
45106 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
45107 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
45108
45109 @end table
45110
45111 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
45112
45113 @table @samp
45114
45115 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
45116 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
45117 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
45118 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
45119 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
45120 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
45121 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
45122 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
45123 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
45124 @var{attachment}.
45125
45126 @item @w{}
45127 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
45128
45129 @end table
45130
45131 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
45132
45133 @table @samp
45134 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
45135 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
45136 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
45137 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
45138 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
45139 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
45140 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
45141
45142 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
45143 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
45144 -1 if an error occurs.
45145
45146 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
45147 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
45148 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
45149 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
45150 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
45151 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
45152 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
45153 @var{count} was zero.
45154
45155 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
45156 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
45157 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
45158 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
45159 some characters were escaped.
45160
45161 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
45162 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
45163 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
45164 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
45165 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
45166 packet is used. @samp{vFile:pwrite} returns the number of bytes written,
45167 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
45168 error occurred.
45169
45170 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
45171 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
45172 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
45173 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
45174 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
45175 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
45176
45177 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
45178 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
45179 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
45180
45181 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
45182 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
45183 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
45184
45185 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
45186 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
45187 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
45188 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
45189 some characters were escaped.
45190
45191 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
45192 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
45193 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
45194 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
45195 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
45196 inferior(s).
45197
45198 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
45199 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
45200 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
45201 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
45202 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
45203 operation.
45204
45205 @end table
45206
45207 @node Interrupts
45208 @section Interrupts
45209 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
45210 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
45211
45212 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
45213 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
45214 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
45215 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
45216
45217 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
45218 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
45219 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
45220 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
45221 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
45222
45223 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
45224 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
45225 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
45226 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
45227 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
45228 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
45229 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
45230 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
45231
45232 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
45233 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
45234 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
45235
45236 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
45237 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
45238 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
45239 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
45240 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
45241 @code{0x03}.
45242
45243 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
45244 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
45245 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
45246 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
45247 currently-executing threads and processes.
45248 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
45249 running program, it should send one of the stop
45250 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
45251 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
45252 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
45253 Interrupts received while the
45254 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
45255 it is resumed next time.
45256
45257 @node Notification Packets
45258 @section Notification Packets
45259 @cindex notification packets
45260 @cindex packets, notification
45261
45262 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
45263 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
45264 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
45265 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
45266 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
45267 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
45268 is not a problem.
45269
45270 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
45271 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
45272 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
45273 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
45274 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
45275 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
45276 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
45277
45278 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
45279 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
45280
45281 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
45282 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
45283 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
45284 not they understand it.
45285
45286 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
45287 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
45288 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
45289 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
45290 recipients.
45291
45292 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
45293 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
45294 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
45295 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
45296 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
45297
45298 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
45299 @table @samp
45300 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
45301 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
45302 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
45303 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
45304 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
45305 @item @var{ack}
45306 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
45307 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
45308 @end table
45309
45310 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
45311 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
45312
45313 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
45314 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
45315 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
45316 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
45317 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
45318 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
45319 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
45320 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
45321 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
45322 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
45323
45324 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
45325 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
45326 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
45327 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
45328 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
45329 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
45330
45331 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
45332 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
45333 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
45334 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
45335 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
45336
45337 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
45338 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
45339 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
45340 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
45341 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
45342 normally.
45343
45344 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
45345 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
45346 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
45347 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
45348 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
45349 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
45350 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
45351 the process shall be repeated.
45352
45353 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
45354 following example:
45355 @smallexample
45356 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
45357 @code{...}
45358 -> @code{vStopped}
45359 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
45360 -> @code{vStopped}
45361 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
45362 -> @code{vStopped}
45363 <- @code{OK}
45364 @end smallexample
45365
45366 The following notifications are defined:
45367 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
45368
45369 @item Notification
45370 @tab Ack
45371 @tab Event
45372 @tab Description
45373
45374 @item Stop
45375 @tab vStopped
45376 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
45377 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
45378 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
45379 @value{GDBN}.
45380 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
45381
45382 @end multitable
45383
45384 @node Remote Non-Stop
45385 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
45386
45387 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
45388 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
45389 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
45390 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
45391
45392 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
45393 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
45394 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
45395 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
45396 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
45397 probe the target state after a mode change.
45398
45399 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
45400 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
45401 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
45402 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
45403 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
45404 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
45405 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
45406 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
45407 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
45408 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
45409 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
45410
45411 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
45412 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
45413 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
45414 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
45415 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
45416 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
45417 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
45418 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
45419 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
45420 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
45421 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
45422 @samp{OK}.
45423
45424 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
45425 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
45426 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
45427 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
45428 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
45429 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
45430 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
45431 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
45432 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
45433 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
45434 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
45435 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
45436 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
45437
45438 @node Packet Acknowledgment
45439 @section Packet Acknowledgment
45440
45441 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
45442 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
45443 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
45444 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
45445 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
45446 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
45447 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
45448
45449 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
45450 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
45451 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
45452 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
45453 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
45454
45455 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
45456 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
45457 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
45458 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
45459
45460 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
45461 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
45462 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
45463 @pxref{qSupported}.
45464 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
45465 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
45466 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
45467 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
45468 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
45469 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
45470 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
45471
45472 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
45473 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
45474 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
45475 connection.
45476 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
45477 new connection is established,
45478 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
45479 for the current connection, once disabled.
45480
45481 @node Examples
45482 @section Examples
45483
45484 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
45485 does not get any direct output:
45486
45487 @smallexample
45488 -> @code{R00}
45489 <- @code{+}
45490 @emph{target restarts}
45491 -> @code{?}
45492 <- @code{+}
45493 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
45494 -> @code{+}
45495 @end smallexample
45496
45497 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
45498
45499 @smallexample
45500 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
45501 <- @code{+}
45502 -> @code{s}
45503 <- @code{+}
45504 @emph{time passes}
45505 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
45506 -> @code{+}
45507 -> @code{g}
45508 <- @code{+}
45509 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
45510 -> @code{+}
45511 @end smallexample
45512
45513 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
45514 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
45515 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
45516
45517 @menu
45518 * File-I/O Overview::
45519 * Protocol Basics::
45520 * The F Request Packet::
45521 * The F Reply Packet::
45522 * The Ctrl-C Message::
45523 * Console I/O::
45524 * List of Supported Calls::
45525 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
45526 * Constants::
45527 * File-I/O Examples::
45528 @end menu
45529
45530 @node File-I/O Overview
45531 @subsection File-I/O Overview
45532 @cindex file-i/o overview
45533
45534 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
45535 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
45536 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
45537 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
45538 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
45539 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
45540
45541 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
45542 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
45543 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
45544 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
45545 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
45546
45547 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
45548 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
45549 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
45550 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
45551 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
45552 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
45553 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
45554
45555 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
45556 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
45557 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
45558 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
45559 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
45560
45561 @smallexample
45562 (@value{GDBP}) continue
45563 <- target requests 'system call X'
45564 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
45565 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
45566 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
45567 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
45568 @end smallexample
45569
45570 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
45571 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
45572 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
45573 system are not supported by this protocol.
45574
45575 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
45576
45577 @node Protocol Basics
45578 @subsection Protocol Basics
45579 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
45580
45581 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
45582 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
45583 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
45584 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
45585 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
45586 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
45587 to call the appropriate host system call:
45588
45589 @itemize @bullet
45590 @item
45591 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
45592
45593 @item
45594 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
45595 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
45596 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
45597 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
45598
45599 @end itemize
45600
45601 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
45602
45603 @itemize @bullet
45604 @item
45605 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
45606 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
45607 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
45608 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
45609 packet.
45610
45611 @item
45612 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
45613 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
45614
45615 @item
45616 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
45617
45618 @item
45619 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
45620
45621 @item
45622 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
45623 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
45624 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
45625 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
45626 packet.
45627
45628 @end itemize
45629
45630 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
45631 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
45632
45633 @itemize @bullet
45634 @item
45635 Return value.
45636
45637 @item
45638 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
45639
45640 @item
45641 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
45642
45643 @end itemize
45644
45645 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
45646 the latest continue or step action.
45647
45648 @node The F Request Packet
45649 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
45650 @cindex file-i/o request packet
45651 @cindex @code{F} request packet
45652
45653 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
45654
45655 @table @samp
45656 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
45657
45658 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
45659 This is just the name of the function.
45660
45661 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
45662 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
45663 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
45664 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
45665 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
45666 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
45667 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
45668
45669 @end table
45670
45671
45672
45673 @node The F Reply Packet
45674 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
45675 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
45676 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
45677
45678 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
45679
45680 @table @samp
45681
45682 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
45683
45684 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
45685
45686 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
45687 representation.
45688 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
45689
45690 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
45691 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
45692 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
45693
45694 @smallexample
45695 F0,0,C
45696 @end smallexample
45697
45698 @noindent
45699 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
45700
45701 @smallexample
45702 F-1,4,C
45703 @end smallexample
45704
45705 @noindent
45706 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
45707
45708 @end table
45709
45710
45711 @node The Ctrl-C Message
45712 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
45713 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
45714
45715 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
45716 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
45717 the target should behave as if it had
45718 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
45719 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
45720 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
45721 packet.
45722
45723 It's important for the target to know in which
45724 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
45725
45726 @itemize @bullet
45727 @item
45728 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
45729
45730 @item
45731 The system call on the host has been finished.
45732
45733 @end itemize
45734
45735 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
45736 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
45737 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
45738 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
45739 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
45740 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
45741
45742 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
45743 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
45744 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
45745 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
45746 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
45747 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
45748 or the full action has been completed.
45749
45750 @node Console I/O
45751 @subsection Console I/O
45752 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
45753
45754 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
45755 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
45756 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
45757 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
45758 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
45759 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
45760 conditions is met:
45761
45762 @itemize @bullet
45763 @item
45764 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
45765 @code{read}
45766 system call is treated as finished.
45767
45768 @item
45769 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
45770 newline.
45771
45772 @item
45773 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
45774 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
45775
45776 @end itemize
45777
45778 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
45779 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
45780 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
45781 is stopped at the user's request.
45782
45783
45784 @node List of Supported Calls
45785 @subsection List of Supported Calls
45786 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
45787
45788 @menu
45789 * open::
45790 * close::
45791 * read::
45792 * write::
45793 * lseek::
45794 * rename::
45795 * unlink::
45796 * stat/fstat::
45797 * gettimeofday::
45798 * isatty::
45799 * system::
45800 @end menu
45801
45802 @node open
45803 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
45804 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
45805
45806 @table @asis
45807 @item Synopsis:
45808 @smallexample
45809 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
45810 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
45811 @end smallexample
45812
45813 @item Request:
45814 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
45815
45816 @noindent
45817 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
45818
45819 @table @code
45820 @item O_CREAT
45821 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
45822 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
45823 are concerned.
45824
45825 @item O_EXCL
45826 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
45827 an error and open() fails.
45828
45829 @item O_TRUNC
45830 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
45831 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
45832 truncated to zero length.
45833
45834 @item O_APPEND
45835 The file is opened in append mode.
45836
45837 @item O_RDONLY
45838 The file is opened for reading only.
45839
45840 @item O_WRONLY
45841 The file is opened for writing only.
45842
45843 @item O_RDWR
45844 The file is opened for reading and writing.
45845 @end table
45846
45847 @noindent
45848 Other bits are silently ignored.
45849
45850
45851 @noindent
45852 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
45853
45854 @table @code
45855 @item S_IRUSR
45856 User has read permission.
45857
45858 @item S_IWUSR
45859 User has write permission.
45860
45861 @item S_IRGRP
45862 Group has read permission.
45863
45864 @item S_IWGRP
45865 Group has write permission.
45866
45867 @item S_IROTH
45868 Others have read permission.
45869
45870 @item S_IWOTH
45871 Others have write permission.
45872 @end table
45873
45874 @noindent
45875 Other bits are silently ignored.
45876
45877
45878 @item Return value:
45879 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
45880 occurred.
45881
45882 @item Errors:
45883
45884 @table @code
45885 @item EEXIST
45886 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
45887
45888 @item EISDIR
45889 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
45890
45891 @item EACCES
45892 The requested access is not allowed.
45893
45894 @item ENAMETOOLONG
45895 @var{pathname} was too long.
45896
45897 @item ENOENT
45898 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
45899
45900 @item ENODEV
45901 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
45902
45903 @item EROFS
45904 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
45905 write access was requested.
45906
45907 @item EFAULT
45908 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
45909
45910 @item ENOSPC
45911 No space on device to create the file.
45912
45913 @item EMFILE
45914 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
45915
45916 @item ENFILE
45917 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
45918 has been reached.
45919
45920 @item EINTR
45921 The call was interrupted by the user.
45922 @end table
45923
45924 @end table
45925
45926 @node close
45927 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
45928 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
45929
45930 @table @asis
45931 @item Synopsis:
45932 @smallexample
45933 int close(int fd);
45934 @end smallexample
45935
45936 @item Request:
45937 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
45938
45939 @item Return value:
45940 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
45941
45942 @item Errors:
45943
45944 @table @code
45945 @item EBADF
45946 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
45947
45948 @item EINTR
45949 The call was interrupted by the user.
45950 @end table
45951
45952 @end table
45953
45954 @node read
45955 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
45956 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
45957
45958 @table @asis
45959 @item Synopsis:
45960 @smallexample
45961 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
45962 @end smallexample
45963
45964 @item Request:
45965 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
45966
45967 @item Return value:
45968 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
45969 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
45970 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
45971
45972 @item Errors:
45973
45974 @table @code
45975 @item EBADF
45976 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
45977 reading.
45978
45979 @item EFAULT
45980 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
45981
45982 @item EINTR
45983 The call was interrupted by the user.
45984 @end table
45985
45986 @end table
45987
45988 @node write
45989 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
45990 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
45991
45992 @table @asis
45993 @item Synopsis:
45994 @smallexample
45995 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
45996 @end smallexample
45997
45998 @item Request:
45999 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
46000
46001 @item Return value:
46002 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
46003 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
46004 is returned.
46005
46006 @item Errors:
46007
46008 @table @code
46009 @item EBADF
46010 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
46011 writing.
46012
46013 @item EFAULT
46014 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
46015
46016 @item EFBIG
46017 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
46018 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
46019
46020 @item ENOSPC
46021 No space on device to write the data.
46022
46023 @item EINTR
46024 The call was interrupted by the user.
46025 @end table
46026
46027 @end table
46028
46029 @node lseek
46030 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
46031 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
46032
46033 @table @asis
46034 @item Synopsis:
46035 @smallexample
46036 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
46037 @end smallexample
46038
46039 @item Request:
46040 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
46041
46042 @var{flag} is one of:
46043
46044 @table @code
46045 @item SEEK_SET
46046 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
46047
46048 @item SEEK_CUR
46049 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
46050 bytes.
46051
46052 @item SEEK_END
46053 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
46054 bytes.
46055 @end table
46056
46057 @item Return value:
46058 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
46059 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
46060 value of -1 is returned.
46061
46062 @item Errors:
46063
46064 @table @code
46065 @item EBADF
46066 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
46067
46068 @item ESPIPE
46069 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
46070
46071 @item EINVAL
46072 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
46073
46074 @item EINTR
46075 The call was interrupted by the user.
46076 @end table
46077
46078 @end table
46079
46080 @node rename
46081 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
46082 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
46083
46084 @table @asis
46085 @item Synopsis:
46086 @smallexample
46087 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
46088 @end smallexample
46089
46090 @item Request:
46091 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
46092
46093 @item Return value:
46094 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
46095
46096 @item Errors:
46097
46098 @table @code
46099 @item EISDIR
46100 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
46101 directory.
46102
46103 @item EEXIST
46104 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
46105
46106 @item EBUSY
46107 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
46108 process.
46109
46110 @item EINVAL
46111 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
46112 of itself.
46113
46114 @item ENOTDIR
46115 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
46116 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
46117 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
46118
46119 @item EFAULT
46120 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
46121
46122 @item EACCES
46123 No access to the file or the path of the file.
46124
46125 @item ENAMETOOLONG
46126
46127 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
46128
46129 @item ENOENT
46130 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
46131
46132 @item EROFS
46133 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
46134
46135 @item ENOSPC
46136 The device containing the file has no room for the new
46137 directory entry.
46138
46139 @item EINTR
46140 The call was interrupted by the user.
46141 @end table
46142
46143 @end table
46144
46145 @node unlink
46146 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
46147 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
46148
46149 @table @asis
46150 @item Synopsis:
46151 @smallexample
46152 int unlink(const char *pathname);
46153 @end smallexample
46154
46155 @item Request:
46156 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
46157
46158 @item Return value:
46159 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
46160
46161 @item Errors:
46162
46163 @table @code
46164 @item EACCES
46165 No access to the file or the path of the file.
46166
46167 @item EPERM
46168 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
46169
46170 @item EBUSY
46171 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
46172 being used by another process.
46173
46174 @item EFAULT
46175 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
46176
46177 @item ENAMETOOLONG
46178 @var{pathname} was too long.
46179
46180 @item ENOENT
46181 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
46182
46183 @item ENOTDIR
46184 A component of the path is not a directory.
46185
46186 @item EROFS
46187 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
46188
46189 @item EINTR
46190 The call was interrupted by the user.
46191 @end table
46192
46193 @end table
46194
46195 @node stat/fstat
46196 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
46197 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
46198 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
46199
46200 @table @asis
46201 @item Synopsis:
46202 @smallexample
46203 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
46204 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
46205 @end smallexample
46206
46207 @item Request:
46208 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
46209 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
46210
46211 @item Return value:
46212 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
46213
46214 @item Errors:
46215
46216 @table @code
46217 @item EBADF
46218 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
46219
46220 @item ENOENT
46221 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
46222 path is an empty string.
46223
46224 @item ENOTDIR
46225 A component of the path is not a directory.
46226
46227 @item EFAULT
46228 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
46229
46230 @item EACCES
46231 No access to the file or the path of the file.
46232
46233 @item ENAMETOOLONG
46234 @var{pathname} was too long.
46235
46236 @item EINTR
46237 The call was interrupted by the user.
46238 @end table
46239
46240 @end table
46241
46242 @node gettimeofday
46243 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
46244 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
46245
46246 @table @asis
46247 @item Synopsis:
46248 @smallexample
46249 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
46250 @end smallexample
46251
46252 @item Request:
46253 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
46254
46255 @item Return value:
46256 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
46257
46258 @item Errors:
46259
46260 @table @code
46261 @item EINVAL
46262 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
46263
46264 @item EFAULT
46265 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
46266 @end table
46267
46268 @end table
46269
46270 @node isatty
46271 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
46272 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
46273
46274 @table @asis
46275 @item Synopsis:
46276 @smallexample
46277 int isatty(int fd);
46278 @end smallexample
46279
46280 @item Request:
46281 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
46282
46283 @item Return value:
46284 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
46285
46286 @item Errors:
46287
46288 @table @code
46289 @item EINTR
46290 The call was interrupted by the user.
46291 @end table
46292
46293 @end table
46294
46295 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
46296 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
46297 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
46298 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
46299 needed.
46300
46301
46302 @node system
46303 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
46304 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
46305
46306 @table @asis
46307 @item Synopsis:
46308 @smallexample
46309 int system(const char *command);
46310 @end smallexample
46311
46312 @item Request:
46313 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
46314
46315 @item Return value:
46316 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
46317 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
46318 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
46319 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
46320 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
46321 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
46322 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
46323
46324 @item Errors:
46325
46326 @table @code
46327 @item EINTR
46328 The call was interrupted by the user.
46329 @end table
46330
46331 @end table
46332
46333 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
46334 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
46335 the host is simplified before it's returned
46336 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
46337 is discarded, and the return value consists
46338 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
46339
46340 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
46341 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
46342 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
46343
46344 @table @code
46345 @item set remote system-call-allowed
46346 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
46347 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
46348 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
46349
46350 @item show remote system-call-allowed
46351 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
46352 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
46353 protocol.
46354 @end table
46355
46356 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
46357 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
46358 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
46359
46360 @menu
46361 * Integral Datatypes::
46362 * Pointer Values::
46363 * Memory Transfer::
46364 * struct stat::
46365 * struct timeval::
46366 @end menu
46367
46368 @node Integral Datatypes
46369 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
46370 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
46371
46372 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
46373 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
46374 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
46375
46376 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
46377 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
46378
46379 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
46380
46381 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
46382 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
46383
46384 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
46385
46386 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
46387 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
46388 byte order.
46389
46390 @node Pointer Values
46391 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
46392 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
46393
46394 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
46395 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
46396 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
46397 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
46398
46399 @smallexample
46400 @code{1aaf/12}
46401 @end smallexample
46402
46403 @noindent
46404 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
46405 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
46406 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
46407 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
46408
46409 @smallexample
46410 @code{123456/d}
46411 @end smallexample
46412
46413 @node Memory Transfer
46414 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
46415 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
46416
46417 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
46418 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
46419 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
46420 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
46421 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
46422 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
46423 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
46424
46425
46426 @node struct stat
46427 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
46428 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
46429
46430 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
46431 is defined as follows:
46432
46433 @smallexample
46434 struct stat @{
46435 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
46436 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
46437 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
46438 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
46439 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
46440 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
46441 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
46442 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
46443 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
46444 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
46445 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
46446 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
46447 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
46448 @};
46449 @end smallexample
46450
46451 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
46452 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
46453 structure is of size 64 bytes.
46454
46455 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
46456 range of values.
46457
46458 @table @code
46459
46460 @item st_dev
46461 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
46462
46463 @item st_ino
46464 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
46465
46466 @item st_mode
46467 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
46468 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
46469
46470 @item st_uid
46471 @itemx st_gid
46472 @itemx st_rdev
46473 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
46474
46475 @item st_atime
46476 @itemx st_mtime
46477 @itemx st_ctime
46478 These values have a host and file system dependent
46479 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
46480 support exact timing values.
46481 @end table
46482
46483 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
46484 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
46485 continuing.
46486
46487 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
46488 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
46489 get truncated on the target.
46490
46491 @node struct timeval
46492 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
46493 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
46494
46495 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
46496 is defined as follows:
46497
46498 @smallexample
46499 struct timeval @{
46500 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
46501 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
46502 @};
46503 @end smallexample
46504
46505 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
46506 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
46507 structure is of size 8 bytes.
46508
46509 @node Constants
46510 @subsection Constants
46511 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
46512
46513 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
46514 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
46515 values before and after the call as needed.
46516
46517 @menu
46518 * Open Flags::
46519 * mode_t Values::
46520 * Errno Values::
46521 * Lseek Flags::
46522 * Limits::
46523 @end menu
46524
46525 @node Open Flags
46526 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
46527 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
46528
46529 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
46530
46531 @smallexample
46532 O_RDONLY 0x0
46533 O_WRONLY 0x1
46534 O_RDWR 0x2
46535 O_APPEND 0x8
46536 O_CREAT 0x200
46537 O_TRUNC 0x400
46538 O_EXCL 0x800
46539 @end smallexample
46540
46541 @node mode_t Values
46542 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
46543 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
46544
46545 All values are given in octal representation.
46546
46547 @smallexample
46548 S_IFREG 0100000
46549 S_IFDIR 040000
46550 S_IRUSR 0400
46551 S_IWUSR 0200
46552 S_IXUSR 0100
46553 S_IRGRP 040
46554 S_IWGRP 020
46555 S_IXGRP 010
46556 S_IROTH 04
46557 S_IWOTH 02
46558 S_IXOTH 01
46559 @end smallexample
46560
46561 @node Errno Values
46562 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
46563 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
46564
46565 All values are given in decimal representation.
46566
46567 @smallexample
46568 EPERM 1
46569 ENOENT 2
46570 EINTR 4
46571 EBADF 9
46572 EACCES 13
46573 EFAULT 14
46574 EBUSY 16
46575 EEXIST 17
46576 ENODEV 19
46577 ENOTDIR 20
46578 EISDIR 21
46579 EINVAL 22
46580 ENFILE 23
46581 EMFILE 24
46582 EFBIG 27
46583 ENOSPC 28
46584 ESPIPE 29
46585 EROFS 30
46586 ENAMETOOLONG 91
46587 EUNKNOWN 9999
46588 @end smallexample
46589
46590 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
46591 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
46592
46593 @node Lseek Flags
46594 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
46595 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
46596
46597 @smallexample
46598 SEEK_SET 0
46599 SEEK_CUR 1
46600 SEEK_END 2
46601 @end smallexample
46602
46603 @node Limits
46604 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
46605 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
46606
46607 All values are given in decimal representation.
46608
46609 @smallexample
46610 INT_MIN -2147483648
46611 INT_MAX 2147483647
46612 UINT_MAX 4294967295
46613 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
46614 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
46615 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
46616 @end smallexample
46617
46618 @node File-I/O Examples
46619 @subsection File-I/O Examples
46620 @cindex file-i/o examples
46621
46622 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
46623 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
46624
46625 @smallexample
46626 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
46627 @emph{request memory read from target}
46628 -> @code{m1234,6}
46629 <- XXXXXX
46630 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
46631 -> @code{F6}
46632 @end smallexample
46633
46634 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
46635 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
46636
46637 @smallexample
46638 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
46639 @emph{request memory write to target}
46640 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
46641 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
46642 -> @code{F6}
46643 @end smallexample
46644
46645 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
46646 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
46647
46648 @smallexample
46649 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
46650 -> @code{F-1,9}
46651 @end smallexample
46652
46653 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
46654 host is called:
46655
46656 @smallexample
46657 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
46658 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
46659 <- @code{T02}
46660 @end smallexample
46661
46662 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
46663 host is called:
46664
46665 @smallexample
46666 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
46667 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
46668 <- @code{T02}
46669 @end smallexample
46670
46671 @node Library List Format
46672 @section Library List Format
46673 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
46674
46675 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
46676 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
46677 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
46678 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
46679 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
46680 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
46681 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
46682 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
46683 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
46684 are loaded.
46685
46686 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
46687 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
46688 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
46689 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
46690
46691 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
46692 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
46693 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
46694 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
46695 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
46696 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
46697
46698 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
46699 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
46700
46701 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
46702 offset, looks like this:
46703
46704 @smallexample
46705 <library-list>
46706 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
46707 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
46708 </library>
46709 </library-list>
46710 @end smallexample
46711
46712 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
46713 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
46714
46715 @smallexample
46716 <library-list>
46717 <library name="sharedlib.o">
46718 <section address="0x10000000"/>
46719 <section address="0x20000000"/>
46720 <section address="0x30000000"/>
46721 </library>
46722 </library-list>
46723 @end smallexample
46724
46725 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
46726
46727 @smallexample
46728 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
46729 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
46730 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
46731 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
46732 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
46733 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
46734 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
46735 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
46736 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
46737 @end smallexample
46738
46739 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
46740 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
46741 section for each library.
46742
46743 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
46744 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
46745 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
46746
46747 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
46748 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
46749 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
46750 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
46751
46752 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
46753 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
46754 target, the following parameters are reported:
46755
46756 @itemize @minus
46757 @item
46758 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
46759 @code{struct link_map}.
46760 @item
46761 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
46762 (Thread Local Storage) access.
46763 @item
46764 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
46765 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
46766 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
46767 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
46768 @item
46769 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
46770 @item
46771 @code{lmid}, which is an identifier for a linker namespace, such as
46772 the memory address of the @code{r_debug} object that contains this
46773 namespace's load map or the namespace identifier returned by
46774 @code{dlinfo (3)}.
46775 @end itemize
46776
46777 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
46778 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
46779 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
46780
46781 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
46782 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
46783
46784 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
46785 looks like this:
46786
46787 @smallexample
46788 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
46789 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
46790 l_ld="0xe4eefc" lmid="0xfffe0"/>
46791 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
46792 l_ld="0x152350" lmid="0xfffe0"/>
46793 </library-list-svr>
46794 @end smallexample
46795
46796 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
46797
46798 @smallexample
46799 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
46800 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
46801 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
46802 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
46803 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
46804 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
46805 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
46806 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
46807 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
46808 <!ATTLIST library lmid CDATA #IMPLIED>
46809 @end smallexample
46810
46811 @node Memory Map Format
46812 @section Memory Map Format
46813 @cindex memory map format
46814
46815 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
46816 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
46817 memory map.
46818
46819 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
46820 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
46821 lists memory regions.
46822
46823 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
46824 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
46825
46826 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
46827
46828 @smallexample
46829 <?xml version="1.0"?>
46830 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
46831 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
46832 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
46833 <memory-map>
46834 region...
46835 </memory-map>
46836 @end smallexample
46837
46838 Each region can be either:
46839
46840 @itemize
46841
46842 @item
46843 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
46844 bytes from there:
46845
46846 @smallexample
46847 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
46848 @end smallexample
46849
46850
46851 @item
46852 A region of read-only memory:
46853
46854 @smallexample
46855 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
46856 @end smallexample
46857
46858
46859 @item
46860 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
46861 bytes in length:
46862
46863 @smallexample
46864 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
46865 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
46866 </memory>
46867 @end smallexample
46868
46869 @end itemize
46870
46871 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
46872 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
46873 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
46874
46875 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
46876
46877 @smallexample
46878 <!-- ................................................... -->
46879 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
46880 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
46881 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
46882 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
46883 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
46884 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
46885 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
46886 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
46887 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
46888 and its type, or device. -->
46889 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
46890 start CDATA #REQUIRED
46891 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
46892 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
46893 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
46894 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
46895 @end smallexample
46896
46897 @node Thread List Format
46898 @section Thread List Format
46899 @cindex thread list format
46900
46901 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
46902 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
46903 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
46904 the following structure:
46905
46906 @smallexample
46907 <?xml version="1.0"?>
46908 <threads>
46909 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
46910 ... description ...
46911 </thread>
46912 </threads>
46913 @end smallexample
46914
46915 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
46916 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
46917 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
46918 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
46919 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
46920 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
46921 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
46922 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
46923
46924
46925 @node Traceframe Info Format
46926 @section Traceframe Info Format
46927 @cindex traceframe info format
46928
46929 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
46930 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
46931 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
46932 collected in a traceframe.
46933
46934 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
46935 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
46936
46937 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
46938 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
46939
46940 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
46941
46942 @smallexample
46943 <?xml version="1.0"?>
46944 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
46945 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
46946 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
46947 <traceframe-info>
46948 block...
46949 </traceframe-info>
46950 @end smallexample
46951
46952 Each traceframe block can be either:
46953
46954 @itemize
46955
46956 @item
46957 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
46958 @var{length} bytes from there:
46959
46960 @smallexample
46961 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
46962 @end smallexample
46963
46964 @item
46965 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
46966 collected:
46967
46968 @smallexample
46969 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
46970 @end smallexample
46971
46972 @end itemize
46973
46974 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
46975
46976 @smallexample
46977 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
46978 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
46979
46980 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
46981 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
46982 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
46983 <!ELEMENT tvar>
46984 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
46985 @end smallexample
46986
46987 @node Branch Trace Format
46988 @section Branch Trace Format
46989 @cindex branch trace format
46990
46991 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
46992 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
46993 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
46994 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
46995
46996 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
46997 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
46998
46999 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
47000 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
47001
47002 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
47003
47004 @smallexample
47005 <?xml version="1.0"?>
47006 <!DOCTYPE btrace
47007 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
47008 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
47009 <btrace>
47010 block...
47011 </btrace>
47012 @end smallexample
47013
47014 @itemize
47015
47016 @item
47017 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
47018 and ending at @var{end}:
47019
47020 @smallexample
47021 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
47022 @end smallexample
47023
47024 @end itemize
47025
47026 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
47027
47028 @smallexample
47029 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
47030 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
47031
47032 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
47033 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
47034 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
47035
47036 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
47037
47038 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
47039
47040 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
47041 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
47042 family CDATA #REQUIRED
47043 model CDATA #REQUIRED
47044 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
47045
47046 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
47047 @end smallexample
47048
47049 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
47050 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
47051 @cindex branch trace configuration format
47052
47053 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
47054 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
47055 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
47056
47057 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
47058 settings for that format. The following information is described:
47059
47060 @table @code
47061 @item bts
47062 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
47063 @table @code
47064 @item size
47065 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
47066 @end table
47067 @item pt
47068 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
47069 PT}) format.
47070 @table @code
47071 @item size
47072 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
47073 @end table
47074 @end table
47075
47076 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
47077 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
47078
47079 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
47080
47081 @smallexample
47082 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
47083 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
47084
47085 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
47086 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
47087
47088 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
47089 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
47090 @end smallexample
47091
47092 @include agentexpr.texi
47093
47094 @node Target Descriptions
47095 @appendix Target Descriptions
47096 @cindex target descriptions
47097
47098 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
47099 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
47100 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
47101 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
47102 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
47103 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
47104 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
47105
47106 @itemize @bullet
47107 @item
47108 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
47109 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
47110 @item
47111 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
47112 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
47113 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
47114 @item
47115 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
47116 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
47117 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
47118 @end itemize
47119
47120 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
47121 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
47122 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
47123 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
47124 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
47125
47126 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
47127 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
47128
47129 @menu
47130 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
47131 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
47132 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
47133 descriptions.
47134 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
47135 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
47136 @end menu
47137
47138 @node Retrieving Descriptions
47139 @section Retrieving Descriptions
47140
47141 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
47142 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
47143 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
47144 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
47145 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
47146 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
47147 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
47148 Format}.
47149
47150 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
47151 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
47152 specify a file are:
47153
47154 @table @code
47155 @cindex set tdesc filename
47156 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
47157 Read the target description from @var{path}.
47158
47159 @cindex unset tdesc filename
47160 @item unset tdesc filename
47161 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
47162 will use the description supplied by the current target.
47163
47164 @cindex show tdesc filename
47165 @item show tdesc filename
47166 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
47167 @end table
47168
47169
47170 @node Target Description Format
47171 @section Target Description Format
47172 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
47173
47174 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
47175 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
47176 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
47177 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
47178 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
47179 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
47180 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
47181
47182 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
47183 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
47184 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
47185 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
47186 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
47187
47188 Here is a simple target description:
47189
47190 @smallexample
47191 <target version="1.0">
47192 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
47193 </target>
47194 @end smallexample
47195
47196 @noindent
47197 This minimal description only says that the target uses
47198 the x86-64 architecture.
47199
47200 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
47201 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
47202 are explained further below.
47203
47204 @smallexample
47205 <?xml version="1.0"?>
47206 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
47207 <target version="1.0">
47208 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
47209 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
47210 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
47211 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
47212 </target>
47213 @end smallexample
47214
47215 @noindent
47216 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
47217 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
47218 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
47219 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
47220 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
47221 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
47222 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
47223 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
47224 the version mismatch.
47225
47226 @subsection Inclusion
47227 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
47228 @cindex XInclude
47229 @ifnotinfo
47230 @cindex <xi:include>
47231 @end ifnotinfo
47232
47233 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
47234 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
47235 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
47236 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
47237 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
47238
47239 @smallexample
47240 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
47241 @end smallexample
47242
47243 @noindent
47244 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
47245 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
47246 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
47247 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
47248 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
47249 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
47250 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
47251 original description.
47252
47253 @subsection Architecture
47254 @cindex <architecture>
47255
47256 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
47257
47258 @smallexample
47259 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
47260 @end smallexample
47261
47262 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
47263 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
47264
47265 @subsection OS ABI
47266 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
47267
47268 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
47269 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
47270
47271 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
47272
47273 @smallexample
47274 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
47275 @end smallexample
47276
47277 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
47278 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
47279
47280 @subsection Compatible Architecture
47281 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
47282
47283 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
47284 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
47285
47286 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
47287
47288 @smallexample
47289 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
47290 @end smallexample
47291
47292 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
47293 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
47294
47295 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
47296 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
47297 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
47298 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
47299 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
47300 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
47301 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
47302
47303 @smallexample
47304 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
47305 <compatible>spu</compatible>
47306 @end smallexample
47307
47308 @subsection Features
47309 @cindex <feature>
47310
47311 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
47312 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
47313 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
47314 has this form:
47315
47316 @smallexample
47317 <feature name="@var{name}">
47318 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
47319 @var{reg}@dots{}
47320 </feature>
47321 @end smallexample
47322
47323 @noindent
47324 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
47325 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
47326 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
47327 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
47328
47329 @subsection Types
47330
47331 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
47332 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
47333 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
47334 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
47335 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
47336 and enum types.
47337
47338 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
47339 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
47340 Types must be defined before they are used.
47341
47342 @cindex <vector>
47343 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
47344 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
47345 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
47346 @var{count}:
47347
47348 @smallexample
47349 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
47350 @end smallexample
47351
47352 @cindex <union>
47353 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
47354 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
47355 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
47356 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
47357
47358 @smallexample
47359 <union id="@var{id}">
47360 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
47361 @dots{}
47362 </union>
47363 @end smallexample
47364
47365 @cindex <struct>
47366 @cindex <flags>
47367 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
47368 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
47369 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
47370 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
47371 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
47372 specified.
47373
47374 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
47375
47376 @smallexample
47377 <struct id="@var{id}">
47378 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
47379 @dots{}
47380 </struct>
47381 @end smallexample
47382
47383 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
47384 No implicit padding is added.
47385
47386 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
47387
47388 @smallexample
47389 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
47390 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
47391 @dots{}
47392 </struct>
47393 @end smallexample
47394
47395 @smallexample
47396 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
47397 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
47398 @dots{}
47399 </flags>
47400 @end smallexample
47401
47402 The @var{name} value is required.
47403 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
47404 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
47405 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
47406
47407 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
47408 is optional.
47409 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
47410 and zero represents the least significant bit.
47411
47412 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
47413 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
47414
47415 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
47416
47417 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
47418 defining them with @samp{struct}:
47419
47420 @itemize @bullet
47421 @item
47422 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
47423 @item
47424 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
47425 @end itemize
47426
47427 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
47428 defining them with @samp{flags}:
47429
47430 @itemize @bullet
47431 @item
47432 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
47433
47434 @smallexample
47435 (@value{GDBP}) print $my_struct_reg.field3
47436 $1 = 42
47437 @end smallexample
47438
47439 @end itemize
47440
47441 @subsection Registers
47442 @cindex <reg>
47443
47444 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
47445
47446 @smallexample
47447 <reg name="@var{name}"
47448 bitsize="@var{size}"
47449 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
47450 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
47451 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
47452 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
47453 @end smallexample
47454
47455 @noindent
47456 The components are as follows:
47457
47458 @table @var
47459
47460 @item name
47461 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
47462
47463 @item bitsize
47464 The register's size, in bits.
47465
47466 @item regnum
47467 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
47468 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
47469 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
47470 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
47471 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
47472 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
47473 in order of increasing register number.
47474
47475 @item save-restore
47476 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
47477 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
47478 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
47479 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
47480 ABI.
47481
47482 @item type
47483 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
47484 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
47485 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
47486 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
47487 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
47488 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
47489
47490 @item group
47491 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
47492 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
47493 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
47494 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
47495 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
47496 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
47497 @code{info registers}.
47498
47499 @end table
47500
47501 @node Predefined Target Types
47502 @section Predefined Target Types
47503 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
47504
47505 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
47506 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
47507 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
47508 types. The currently supported types are:
47509
47510 @table @code
47511
47512 @item bool
47513 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
47514
47515 @item int8
47516 @itemx int16
47517 @itemx int24
47518 @itemx int32
47519 @itemx int64
47520 @itemx int128
47521 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
47522
47523 @item uint8
47524 @itemx uint16
47525 @itemx uint24
47526 @itemx uint32
47527 @itemx uint64
47528 @itemx uint128
47529 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
47530
47531 @item code_ptr
47532 @itemx data_ptr
47533 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
47534 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
47535 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
47536 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
47537 may be marked as data pointers.
47538
47539 @item ieee_half
47540 Half precision IEEE floating point.
47541
47542 @item ieee_single
47543 Single precision IEEE floating point.
47544
47545 @item ieee_double
47546 Double precision IEEE floating point.
47547
47548 @item bfloat16
47549 The 16-bit @dfn{brain floating point} format used e.g.@: by x86 and ARM.
47550
47551 @item arm_fpa_ext
47552 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
47553
47554 @item i387_ext
47555 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
47556
47557 @item i386_eflags
47558 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
47559
47560 @item i386_mxcsr
47561 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
47562
47563 @end table
47564
47565 @node Enum Target Types
47566 @section Enum Target Types
47567 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
47568
47569 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
47570 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
47571
47572 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
47573
47574 @smallexample
47575 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
47576 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
47577 @dots{}
47578 </enum>
47579 @end smallexample
47580
47581 Enums must be defined before they are used.
47582
47583 @smallexample
47584 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
47585 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
47586 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
47587 </enum>
47588 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
47589 <field name="X" start="0"/>
47590 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
47591 </flags>
47592 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
47593 @end smallexample
47594
47595 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
47596 would be printed as:
47597
47598 @smallexample
47599 (@value{GDBP}) info register flags
47600 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
47601 @end smallexample
47602
47603 @node Standard Target Features
47604 @section Standard Target Features
47605 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
47606
47607 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
47608 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
47609 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
47610 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
47611 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
47612 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
47613 can recognize them.
47614
47615 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
47616 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
47617 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
47618 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
47619 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
47620 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
47621 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
47622 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
47623
47624 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
47625 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
47626 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
47627
47628 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
47629 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
47630 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
47631 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
47632
47633 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
47634 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
47635 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
47636
47637 @menu
47638 * AArch64 Features::
47639 * ARC Features::
47640 * ARM Features::
47641 * i386 Features::
47642 * LoongArch Features::
47643 * MicroBlaze Features::
47644 * MIPS Features::
47645 * M68K Features::
47646 * NDS32 Features::
47647 * Nios II Features::
47648 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
47649 * PowerPC Features::
47650 * RISC-V Features::
47651 * RX Features::
47652 * S/390 and System z Features::
47653 * Sparc Features::
47654 * TIC6x Features::
47655 @end menu
47656
47657
47658 @node AArch64 Features
47659 @subsection AArch64 Features
47660 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
47661
47662 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
47663 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
47664 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
47665
47666 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
47667 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
47668 and @samp{fpcr}.
47669
47670 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
47671 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
47672 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
47673
47674 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.pauth} feature is optional. If present,
47675 it should contain registers @samp{pauth_dmask} and @samp{pauth_cmask}.
47676
47677 @node ARC Features
47678 @subsection ARC Features
47679 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
47680
47681 ARC processors are so configurable that even core registers and their numbers
47682 are not predetermined completely. Moreover, @emph{flags} and @emph{PC}
47683 registers, which are important to @value{GDBN}, are not ``core'' registers in
47684 ARC. Therefore, there are two features that their presence is mandatory:
47685 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core} and @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux}.
47686
47687 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core} feature is required for all targets. It must
47688 contain registers:
47689
47690 @itemize @minus
47691 @item
47692 @samp{r0} through @samp{r25} for normal register file targets.
47693 @item
47694 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, and @samp{r10} through @samp{r15} for reduced
47695 register file targets.
47696 @item
47697 @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}@footnote{Not necessary for ARCv1.},
47698 @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count}, @samp{pcl}.
47699 @end itemize
47700
47701 In case of an ARCompact target (ARCv1 ISA), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core}
47702 feature may contain registers @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2}. While in case
47703 of ARC EM and ARC HS targets (ARCv2 ISA), register @samp{ilink} may be present.
47704 The difference between ARCv1 and ARCv2 is the naming of registers @emph{29th}
47705 and @emph{30th}. They are called @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} for ARCv1 and
47706 are optional. For ARCv2, they are called @samp{ilink} and @samp{r30} and only
47707 @samp{ilink} is optional. The optionality of @samp{ilink*} registers is
47708 because of their inaccessibility during user space debugging sessions.
47709
47710 Extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59} are optional and their
47711 existence depends on the configuration. When debugging GNU/Linux applications,
47712 i.e.@: user space debugging, these core registers are not available.
47713
47714 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux} feature is required for all ARC targets. Here
47715 is the list of registers pertinent to this feature:
47716
47717 @itemize @minus
47718 @item
47719 mandatory: @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
47720 @item
47721 optional: @samp{lp_start}, @samp{lp_end}, and @samp{bta}.
47722 @end itemize
47723
47724 @node ARM Features
47725 @subsection ARM Features
47726 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
47727
47728 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
47729 ARM targets.
47730 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
47731 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
47732
47733 For M-profile targets (e.g.@: Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
47734 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
47735 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
47736 and @samp{xpsr}.
47737
47738 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
47739 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
47740
47741 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile-mve} feature is optional. If present, it
47742 must contain register @samp{vpr}.
47743
47744 If the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile-mve} feature is available, @value{GDBN}
47745 will synthesize the @samp{p0} pseudo register from @samp{vpr} contents.
47746
47747 If the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is available alongside the
47748 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile-mve} feature, @value{GDBN} will
47749 synthesize the @samp{q} pseudo registers from @samp{d} register
47750 contents.
47751
47752 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
47753 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
47754 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
47755 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
47756
47757 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
47758 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
47759 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
47760 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
47761 halves of the double-precision registers.
47762
47763 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
47764 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
47765 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
47766 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
47767 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
47768 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
47769
47770 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile-pacbti} feature is optional, and
47771 acknowledges support for the ARMv8.1-m PACBTI extensions. @value{GDBN}
47772 will track return address signing states and will decorate backtraces using
47773 the [PAC] marker, similar to AArch64's PAC extension.
47774 @xref{AArch64 PAC}.
47775
47776 @node i386 Features
47777 @subsection i386 Features
47778 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
47779
47780 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
47781 targets. It should describe the following registers:
47782
47783 @itemize @minus
47784 @item
47785 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
47786 @item
47787 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
47788 @item
47789 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
47790 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
47791 @item
47792 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
47793 @item
47794 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
47795 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
47796 @end itemize
47797
47798 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
47799
47800 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
47801 describe registers:
47802
47803 @itemize @minus
47804 @item
47805 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
47806 @item
47807 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
47808 @item
47809 @samp{mxcsr}
47810 @end itemize
47811
47812 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
47813 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
47814 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
47815
47816 @itemize @minus
47817 @item
47818 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
47819 @item
47820 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
47821 @end itemize
47822
47823 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
47824 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
47825
47826 @itemize @minus
47827 @item
47828 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
47829 @item
47830 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
47831 @end itemize
47832
47833 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
47834 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
47835
47836 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
47837 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
47838
47839 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
47840 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
47841 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
47842
47843 @itemize @minus
47844 @item
47845 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
47846 @end itemize
47847
47848 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
47849
47850 @itemize @minus
47851 @item
47852 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
47853 @end itemize
47854
47855 It should
47856 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
47857
47858 @itemize @minus
47859 @item
47860 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
47861 @item
47862 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
47863 @end itemize
47864
47865 It should
47866 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
47867
47868 @itemize @minus
47869 @item
47870 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
47871 @end itemize
47872
47873 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
47874 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
47875 valid for i386 and amd64.
47876
47877 @node LoongArch Features
47878 @subsection LoongArch Features
47879 @cindex target descriptions, LoongArch Features
47880
47881 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.loongarch.base} feature is required for LoongArch
47882 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
47883 @samp{pc}, and @samp{badv}. Either the architectural names (@samp{r0},
47884 @samp{r1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra}, etc).
47885
47886 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.loongarch.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
47887 it should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcc},
47888 and @samp{fcsr}.
47889
47890 @node MicroBlaze Features
47891 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
47892 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
47893
47894 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
47895 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
47896 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
47897 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
47898 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
47899
47900 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
47901 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
47902
47903 @node MIPS Features
47904 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
47905 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
47906
47907 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
47908 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
47909 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
47910 on the target.
47911
47912 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
47913 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
47914 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
47915
47916 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
47917 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
47918 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
47919 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
47920
47921 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
47922 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
47923 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
47924 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
47925
47926 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
47927 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
47928 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
47929
47930 @node M68K Features
47931 @subsection M68K Features
47932 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
47933
47934 @table @code
47935 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
47936 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
47937 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
47938 One of those features must be always present.
47939 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
47940 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
47941 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
47942 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
47943
47944 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
47945 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
47946 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
47947 @samp{fpiaddr}.
47948
47949 Note that, despite the fact that this feature's name says
47950 @samp{coldfire}, it is used to describe any floating point registers.
47951 The size of the registers must match the main m68k flavor; so, for
47952 example, if the primary feature is reported as @samp{coldfire}, then
47953 64-bit floating point registers are required.
47954 @end table
47955
47956 @node NDS32 Features
47957 @subsection NDS32 Features
47958 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
47959
47960 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
47961 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
47962 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
47963 and @samp{pc}.
47964
47965 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
47966 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
47967 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
47968 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
47969
47970 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
47971 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
47972 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
47973 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
47974 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
47975 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
47976 support to it could be totally removed some day.
47977
47978 @node Nios II Features
47979 @subsection Nios II Features
47980 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
47981
47982 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
47983 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
47984 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
47985 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
47986 @samp{mpuacc}).
47987
47988 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
47989 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
47990 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
47991
47992 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
47993 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
47994 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
47995
47996 @node PowerPC Features
47997 @subsection PowerPC Features
47998 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
47999
48000 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
48001 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
48002 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
48003 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
48004
48005 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
48006 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
48007
48008 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
48009 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, and
48010 @samp{vrsave}. @value{GDBN} will define pseudo-registers @samp{v0}
48011 through @samp{v31} as aliases for the corresponding @samp{vrX}
48012 registers.
48013
48014 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
48015 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
48016 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
48017 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
48018 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
48019 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
48020 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
48021 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
48022
48023 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
48024 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
48025 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
48026 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
48027 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
48028 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
48029 user.
48030
48031 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
48032 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
48033
48034 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
48035 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
48036
48037 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
48038 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
48039
48040 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
48041 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
48042 64-bit wide.
48043
48044 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
48045 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
48046 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
48047 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
48048
48049 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
48050 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
48051 64-bit wide.
48052
48053 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
48054 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
48055 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
48056 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
48057 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
48058 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
48059 wide.
48060
48061 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
48062 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
48063 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
48064 @samp{cfpscr}.
48065
48066 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
48067 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
48068 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
48069 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
48070 wide.
48071
48072 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
48073 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
48074 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
48075 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
48076 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
48077 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
48078 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
48079 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
48080 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
48081
48082 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
48083 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
48084
48085 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
48086 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
48087
48088 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
48089 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
48090
48091
48092 @node RISC-V Features
48093 @subsection RISC-V Features
48094 @cindex target descriptions, RISC-V Features
48095
48096 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.cpu} feature is required for RISC-V
48097 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{x0} through
48098 @samp{x31}, and @samp{pc}. Either the architectural names (@samp{x0},
48099 @samp{x1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra},
48100 etc).
48101
48102 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.fpu} feature is optional. If present, it
48103 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fflags},
48104 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr}. As with the cpu feature, either the
48105 architectural register names, or the ABI names can be used.
48106
48107 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.virtual} feature is optional. If present,
48108 it should contain registers that are not backed by real registers on
48109 the target, but are instead virtual, where the register value is
48110 derived from other target state. In many ways these are like
48111 @value{GDBN}s pseudo-registers, except implemented by the target.
48112 Currently the only register expected in this set is the one byte
48113 @samp{priv} register that contains the target's privilege level in the
48114 least significant two bits.
48115
48116 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.csr} feature is optional. If present, it
48117 should contain all of the target's standard CSRs. Standard CSRs are
48118 those defined in the RISC-V specification documents. There is some
48119 overlap between this feature and the fpu feature; the @samp{fflags},
48120 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr} registers could be in either feature. The
48121 expectation is that these registers will be in the fpu feature if the
48122 target has floating point hardware, but can be moved into the csr
48123 feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no
48124 other floating point hardware.
48125
48126 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector} feature is optional. If present,
48127 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, all of which
48128 must be the same size. These requirements are based on the v0.10
48129 draft vector extension, as the vector extension is not yet final. In
48130 the event that the register set of the vector extension changes for
48131 the final specification, the requirements given here could change for
48132 future releases of @value{GDBN}.
48133
48134 @node RX Features
48135 @subsection RX Features
48136 @cindex target descriptions, RX Features
48137
48138 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.rx.core} feature is required for RX
48139 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{r0} through
48140 @samp{r15}, @samp{usp}, @samp{isp}, @samp{psw}, @samp{pc}, @samp{intb},
48141 @samp{bpsw}, @samp{bpc}, @samp{fintv}, @samp{fpsw}, and @samp{acc}.
48142
48143 @node S/390 and System z Features
48144 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
48145 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
48146 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
48147
48148 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
48149 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
48150 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
48151 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
48152 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
48153 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
48154 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
48155 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
48156 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
48157
48158 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
48159 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
48160 @samp{fpc}.
48161
48162 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
48163 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
48164
48165 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
48166 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
48167 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
48168 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
48169 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
48170 32-bit wide.
48171
48172 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
48173 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
48174 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
48175
48176 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
48177 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
48178 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
48179 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
48180 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
48181 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
48182 @samp{v31}.
48183
48184 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
48185 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
48186 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
48187
48188 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
48189 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
48190 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
48191
48192 @node Sparc Features
48193 @subsection Sparc Features
48194 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
48195 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
48196 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
48197 targets. It should describe the following registers:
48198
48199 @itemize @minus
48200 @item
48201 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
48202 @item
48203 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
48204 @item
48205 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
48206 @item
48207 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
48208 @end itemize
48209
48210 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
48211
48212 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
48213 targets. It should describe the following registers:
48214
48215 @itemize @minus
48216 @item
48217 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
48218 @item
48219 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
48220 @end itemize
48221
48222 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
48223 targets. It should describe the following registers:
48224
48225 @itemize @minus
48226 @item
48227 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
48228 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
48229 @item
48230 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
48231 for sparc64
48232 @end itemize
48233
48234 @node TIC6x Features
48235 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
48236 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
48237 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
48238 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
48239 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
48240 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
48241
48242 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
48243 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
48244 through @samp{B31}.
48245
48246 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
48247 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
48248
48249 @node Operating System Information
48250 @appendix Operating System Information
48251 @cindex operating system information
48252
48253 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
48254 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
48255 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
48256 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
48257 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
48258 on a different aspect of target.
48259
48260 Operating system information is retrieved from the target via the
48261 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
48262 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
48263 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
48264
48265 @menu
48266 * Process list::
48267 @end menu
48268
48269 @node Process list
48270 @appendixsection Process list
48271 @cindex operating system information, process list
48272
48273 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
48274 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
48275 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
48276 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
48277
48278 An example document is:
48279
48280 @smallexample
48281 <?xml version="1.0"?>
48282 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
48283 <osdata type="processes">
48284 <item>
48285 <column name="pid">1</column>
48286 <column name="user">root</column>
48287 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
48288 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
48289 </item>
48290 </osdata>
48291 @end smallexample
48292
48293 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
48294 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
48295 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
48296 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
48297 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
48298 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
48299 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
48300
48301 @node Trace File Format
48302 @appendix Trace File Format
48303 @cindex trace file format
48304
48305 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
48306 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
48307
48308 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
48309 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
48310 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
48311 in the future.
48312
48313 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
48314 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
48315 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
48316 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
48317 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
48318 of this section.
48319
48320 @table @code
48321 @item R @var{size}
48322 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
48323 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
48324 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
48325 a single trace file.
48326
48327 @item status @var{status}
48328 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
48329 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
48330 file.
48331
48332 @item tp @var{payload}
48333 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
48334 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
48335 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
48336 reply packets.
48337
48338 @item tsv @var{payload}
48339 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
48340 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
48341 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
48342 reply packets.
48343
48344 @item tdesc @var{payload}
48345 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
48346 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
48347 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
48348 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
48349 file. Includes are not allowed.
48350
48351 @end table
48352
48353 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
48354 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
48355 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
48356 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
48357 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
48358 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
48359 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
48360 endianness.
48361
48362 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
48363
48364 @table @code
48365 @item R @var{bytes}
48366 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
48367 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
48368 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
48369
48370 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
48371 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
48372 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
48373 @var{length} bytes.
48374
48375 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
48376 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
48377 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
48378
48379 @end table
48380
48381 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
48382 of blocks.
48383
48384 @node Index Section Format
48385 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
48386 @cindex .gdb_index section format
48387 @cindex index section format
48388
48389 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
48390 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
48391 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
48392 description.
48393
48394 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
48395 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
48396 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
48397 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
48398 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
48399 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
48400
48401 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
48402
48403 @enumerate
48404 @item
48405 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
48406 unless otherwise noted:
48407
48408 @enumerate
48409 @item
48410 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
48411 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
48412 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
48413 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
48414 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
48415 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
48416 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
48417
48418 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
48419 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
48420 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
48421 currently not flagged as deprecated.
48422
48423 @item
48424 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
48425
48426 @item
48427 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
48428 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
48429 to the next offset.
48430
48431 @item
48432 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
48433
48434 @item
48435 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
48436
48437 @item
48438 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
48439 @end enumerate
48440
48441 @item
48442 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
48443 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
48444 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
48445 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
48446 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
48447 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
48448 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
48449 CU indices.
48450
48451 @item
48452 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
48453 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
48454 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
48455 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
48456
48457 @item
48458 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
48459 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
48460
48461 @enumerate
48462 @item
48463 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
48464
48465 @item
48466 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
48467 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
48468
48469 @item
48470 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
48471 @end enumerate
48472
48473 @item
48474 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
48475 the hash table is always a power of 2.
48476
48477 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
48478 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
48479 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
48480 constant pool.
48481
48482 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
48483 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
48484 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
48485
48486 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
48487 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
48488 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
48489 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
48490 index version:
48491
48492 @table @asis
48493 @item Version 4
48494 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
48495
48496 @item Versions 5 to 7
48497 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
48498 @end table
48499
48500 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
48501
48502 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
48503 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
48504 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
48505 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
48506 collision.
48507
48508 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
48509 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
48510 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
48511 the code.
48512
48513 @item
48514 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
48515 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
48516 strings.
48517
48518 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
48519 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
48520 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
48521 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
48522 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
48523 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
48524
48525 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
48526 @end enumerate
48527
48528 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
48529 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
48530 CU index+attributes value for each use.
48531
48532 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
48533 (bit 0 = LSB):
48534
48535 @table @asis
48536
48537 @item Bits 0-23
48538 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
48539 @item Bits 24-27
48540 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
48541 @item Bits 28-30
48542 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
48543
48544 @table @asis
48545 @item 0
48546 This value is reserved and should not be used.
48547 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
48548 with previous versions of the index.
48549 @item 1
48550 The symbol is a type.
48551 @item 2
48552 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
48553 @item 3
48554 The symbol is a function.
48555 @item 4
48556 Any other kind of symbol.
48557 @item 5,6,7
48558 These values are reserved.
48559 @end table
48560
48561 @item Bit 31
48562 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
48563
48564 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
48565 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
48566 @value{GDBN} sources.
48567
48568 @end table
48569
48570 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
48571 global/static attributes in the index.
48572
48573 @smallexample
48574 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
48575 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
48576 switch (die->tag)
48577 @{
48578 case DW_TAG_typedef:
48579 case DW_TAG_base_type:
48580 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
48581 kind = TYPE;
48582 is_static = 1;
48583 break;
48584 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
48585 kind = VARIABLE;
48586 is_static = language != CPLUS;
48587 break;
48588 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
48589 kind = FUNCTION;
48590 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
48591 break;
48592 case DW_TAG_constant:
48593 kind = VARIABLE;
48594 is_static = ! is_external;
48595 break;
48596 case DW_TAG_variable:
48597 kind = VARIABLE;
48598 is_static = ! is_external;
48599 break;
48600 case DW_TAG_namespace:
48601 kind = TYPE;
48602 is_static = 0;
48603 break;
48604 case DW_TAG_class_type:
48605 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
48606 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
48607 case DW_TAG_union_type:
48608 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
48609 kind = TYPE;
48610 is_static = language != CPLUS;
48611 break;
48612 default:
48613 assert (0);
48614 @}
48615 @end smallexample
48616
48617 @node Debuginfod
48618 @appendix Download debugging resources with Debuginfod
48619 @cindex debuginfod
48620
48621 @code{debuginfod} is an HTTP server for distributing ELF, DWARF and source
48622 files.
48623
48624 With the @code{debuginfod} client library, @file{libdebuginfod}, @value{GDBN}
48625 can query servers using the build IDs associated with missing debug info,
48626 executables and source files in order to download them on demand.
48627
48628 For instructions on building @value{GDBN} with @file{libdebuginfod},
48629 @pxref{Configure Options,,--with-debuginfod}. @code{debuginfod} is packaged
48630 with @code{elfutils}, starting with version 0.178. See
48631 @uref{https://sourceware.org/elfutils/Debuginfod.html} for more information
48632 regarding @code{debuginfod}.
48633
48634 @menu
48635 * Debuginfod Settings:: Configuring debuginfod with @value{GDBN}
48636 @end menu
48637
48638 @node Debuginfod Settings
48639 @section Debuginfod Settings
48640
48641 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands for configuring @code{debuginfod}.
48642
48643 @table @code
48644 @kindex set debuginfod enabled
48645 @anchor{set debuginfod enabled}
48646 @item set debuginfod enabled
48647 @itemx set debuginfod enabled on
48648 @cindex enable debuginfod
48649 @value{GDBN} will attempt to query @code{debuginfod} servers when missing debug
48650 info or source files.
48651
48652 @item set debuginfod enabled off
48653 @value{GDBN} will not attempt to query @code{debuginfod} servers when missing
48654 debug info or source files. By default, @code{debuginfod enabled} is set to
48655 @code{off} for non-interactive sessions.
48656
48657 @item set debuginfod enabled ask
48658 @value{GDBN} will prompt the user to enable or disable @code{debuginfod} before
48659 attempting to perform the next query. By default, @code{debuginfod enabled}
48660 is set to @code{ask} for interactive sessions.
48661
48662 @kindex show debuginfod enabled
48663 @item show debuginfod enabled
48664 Display whether @code{debuginfod enabled} is set to @code{on}, @code{off} or
48665 @code{ask}.
48666
48667 @kindex set debuginfod urls
48668 @cindex configure debuginfod URLs
48669 @item set debuginfod urls
48670 @itemx set debuginfod urls @var{urls}
48671 Set the space-separated list of URLs that @code{debuginfod} will attempt to
48672 query. Only @code{http://}, @code{https://} and @code{file://} protocols
48673 should be used. The default value of @code{debuginfod urls} is copied from
48674 the @var{DEBUGINFOD_URLS} environment variable.
48675
48676 @kindex show debuginfod urls
48677 @item show debuginfod urls
48678 Display the list of URLs that @code{debuginfod} will attempt to query.
48679
48680 @kindex set debuginfod verbose
48681 @cindex debuginfod verbosity
48682 @item set debuginfod verbose
48683 @itemx set debuginfod verbose @var{n}
48684 Enable or disable @code{debuginfod}-related output. Use a non-zero value
48685 to enable and @code{0} to disable. @code{debuginfod} output is shown by
48686 default.
48687
48688 @kindex show debuginfod verbose
48689 @item show debuginfod verbose
48690 Show the current verbosity setting.
48691
48692 @end table
48693
48694 @node Man Pages
48695 @appendix Manual pages
48696 @cindex Man pages
48697
48698 @menu
48699 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
48700 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
48701 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
48702 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
48703 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
48704 @end menu
48705
48706 @node gdb man
48707 @heading gdb man
48708
48709 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
48710
48711 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
48712 gdb [OPTIONS] [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
48713 @c man end
48714
48715 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
48716 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
48717 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
48718 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
48719
48720 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
48721 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
48722
48723 @itemize @bullet
48724 @item
48725 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
48726
48727 @item
48728 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
48729
48730 @item
48731 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
48732
48733 @item
48734 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
48735 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
48736 @end itemize
48737
48738 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
48739 Modula-2.
48740
48741 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
48742 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
48743 command @code{quit} or @code{exit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
48744 by using the command @code{help}.
48745
48746 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
48747 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
48748 executable program as the argument:
48749
48750 @smallexample
48751 gdb program
48752 @end smallexample
48753
48754 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
48755
48756 @smallexample
48757 gdb program core
48758 @end smallexample
48759
48760 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option
48761 @code{-p}, if you want to debug a running process:
48762
48763 @smallexample
48764 gdb program 1234
48765 gdb -p 1234
48766 @end smallexample
48767
48768 @noindent
48769 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234}. With option @option{-p} you
48770 can omit the @var{program} filename.
48771
48772 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
48773
48774 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
48775 @table @env
48776 @item break [@var{file}:][@var{function}|@var{line}]
48777 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} or @var{line} (in @var{file}).
48778
48779 @item run [@var{arglist}]
48780 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
48781
48782 @item bt
48783 Backtrace: display the program stack.
48784
48785 @item print @var{expr}
48786 Display the value of an expression.
48787
48788 @item c
48789 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g.@: at a breakpoint).
48790
48791 @item next
48792 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
48793 function calls in the line.
48794
48795 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
48796 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
48797
48798 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
48799 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
48800
48801 @item step
48802 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
48803 function calls in the line.
48804
48805 @item help [@var{name}]
48806 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
48807 about using @value{GDBN}.
48808
48809 @item quit
48810 @itemx exit
48811 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
48812 @end table
48813
48814 @ifset man
48815 For full details on @value{GDBN},
48816 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
48817 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
48818 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
48819 @end ifset
48820 @c man end
48821
48822 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
48823 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
48824 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
48825 encountered with no
48826 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{--se} option, and the second,
48827 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
48828 Many options have
48829 both long and abbreviated forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
48830 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
48831 present to be unambiguous.
48832
48833 The abbreviated forms are shown here with @samp{-} and long forms are shown
48834 with @samp{--} to reflect how they are shown in @option{--help}. However,
48835 @value{GDBN} recognizes all of the following conventions for most options:
48836
48837 @table @code
48838 @item --option=@var{value}
48839 @item --option @var{value}
48840 @item -option=@var{value}
48841 @item -option @var{value}
48842 @item --o=@var{value}
48843 @item --o @var{value}
48844 @item -o=@var{value}
48845 @item -o @var{value}
48846 @end table
48847
48848 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
48849 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
48850 option is used.
48851
48852 @table @env
48853 @item --help
48854 @itemx -h
48855 List all options, with brief explanations.
48856
48857 @item --symbols=@var{file}
48858 @itemx -s @var{file}
48859 Read symbol table from @var{file}.
48860
48861 @item --write
48862 Enable writing into executable and core files.
48863
48864 @item --exec=@var{file}
48865 @itemx -e @var{file}
48866 Use @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
48867 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
48868 dump.
48869
48870 @item --se=@var{file}
48871 Read symbol table from @var{file} and use it as the executable
48872 file.
48873
48874 @item --core=@var{file}
48875 @itemx -c @var{file}
48876 Use @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
48877
48878 @item --command=@var{file}
48879 @itemx -x @var{file}
48880 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from @var{file}.
48881
48882 @item --eval-command=@var{command}
48883 @item -ex @var{command}
48884 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
48885
48886 @item --init-eval-command=@var{command}
48887 @item -iex
48888 Execute @value{GDBN} @var{command} before loading the inferior.
48889
48890 @item --directory=@var{directory}
48891 @itemx -d @var{directory}
48892 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
48893
48894 @item --nh
48895 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.config/gdb/gdbinit},
48896 @file{~/.gdbinit}, @file{~/.config/gdb/gdbearlyinit}, or
48897 @file{~/.gdbearlyinit}
48898
48899 @item --nx
48900 @itemx -n
48901 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} or
48902 @file{.gdbearlyinit} initialization files.
48903
48904 @item --quiet
48905 @item --silent
48906 @itemx -q
48907 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
48908 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
48909
48910 @item --batch
48911 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
48912 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
48913 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
48914 commands in the command files.
48915
48916 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
48917 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
48918 more useful, the message
48919
48920 @smallexample
48921 Program exited normally.
48922 @end smallexample
48923
48924 @noindent
48925 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
48926 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
48927
48928 @item --batch-silent
48929 Run in batch mode, just like @option{--batch}, but totally silent. All @value{GDBN}
48930 output is supressed (stderr is unaffected). This is much quieter than
48931 @option{--silent} and would be useless for an interactive session.
48932
48933 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
48934 messages, for example.
48935
48936 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to writing
48937 directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
48938
48939 @item --args @var{prog} [@var{arglist}]
48940 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following this
48941 option are passed as arguments to the inferior. As an example, take
48942 the following command:
48943
48944 @smallexample
48945 gdb ./a.out -q
48946 @end smallexample
48947
48948 @noindent
48949 It would start @value{GDBN} with @option{-q}, not printing the introductory message. On
48950 the other hand, using:
48951
48952 @smallexample
48953 gdb --args ./a.out -q
48954 @end smallexample
48955
48956 @noindent
48957 starts @value{GDBN} with the introductory message, and passes the option to the inferior.
48958
48959 @item --pid=@var{pid}
48960 Attach @value{GDBN} to an already running program, with the PID @var{pid}.
48961
48962 @item --tui
48963 Open the terminal user interface.
48964
48965 @item --readnow
48966 Read all symbols from the given symfile on the first access.
48967
48968 @item --readnever
48969 Do not read symbol files.
48970
48971 @item --return-child-result
48972 @value{GDBN}'s exit code will be the same as the child's exit code.
48973
48974 @item --configuration
48975 Print details about GDB configuration and then exit.
48976
48977 @item --version
48978 Print version information and then exit.
48979
48980 @item --cd=@var{directory}
48981 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
48982 instead of the current directory.
48983
48984 @item --data-directory=@var{directory}
48985 @item -D
48986 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory. The data
48987 directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its auxiliary files.
48988
48989 @item --fullname
48990 @itemx -f
48991 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
48992 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
48993 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
48994 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
48995 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
48996 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
48997 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
48998 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
48999
49000 @item -b @var{baudrate}
49001 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
49002 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
49003
49004 @item -l @var{timeout}
49005 Set timeout, in seconds, for remote debugging.
49006
49007 @item --tty=@var{device}
49008 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
49009 @end table
49010 @c man end
49011
49012 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
49013 @ifset man
49014 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
49015 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
49016 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
49017
49018 @smallexample
49019 info gdb
49020 @end smallexample
49021
49022 @noindent
49023 should give you access to the complete manual.
49024
49025 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
49026 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
49027 @end ifset
49028 @c man end
49029
49030 @node gdbserver man
49031 @heading gdbserver man
49032
49033 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
49034 @format
49035 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
49036 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
49037
49038 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
49039
49040 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
49041 @c man end
49042 @end format
49043
49044 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
49045 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
49046 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
49047
49048 @ifclear man
49049 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
49050 @end ifclear
49051 @ifset man
49052 Usage (server (target) side):
49053 @end ifset
49054
49055 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
49056 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
49057 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
49058 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
49059
49060 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
49061 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
49062 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
49063
49064 @smallexample
49065 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
49066 @end smallexample
49067
49068 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
49069
49070 @smallexample
49071 @ifset man
49072 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
49073 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
49074 @end ifset
49075 @ifclear man
49076 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
49077 @end ifclear
49078 @end smallexample
49079
49080 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
49081 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
49082 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
49083
49084 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
49085
49086 @smallexample
49087 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
49088 @end smallexample
49089
49090 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
49091 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
49092 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
49093 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
49094 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
49095 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
49096 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
49097 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
49098 print an error message and exit.
49099
49100 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
49101 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
49102
49103 @smallexample
49104 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
49105 @end smallexample
49106
49107 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
49108 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
49109
49110 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
49111 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
49112 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
49113 the program you want to debug.
49114
49115 @smallexample
49116 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
49117 @end smallexample
49118
49119 @ifclear man
49120 @subheading Usage (host side)
49121 @end ifclear
49122 @ifset man
49123 Usage (host side):
49124 @end ifset
49125
49126 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
49127 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
49128 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
49129 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
49130 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
49131 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
49132 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
49133 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
49134 descriptor. For example:
49135
49136 @smallexample
49137 @ifset man
49138 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
49139 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
49140 @end ifset
49141 @ifclear man
49142 (@value{GDBP}) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
49143 @end ifclear
49144 @end smallexample
49145
49146 @noindent
49147 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
49148
49149 @smallexample
49150 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
49151 @end smallexample
49152
49153 @noindent
49154 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
49155 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
49156 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
49157 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
49158 `Connection refused'.
49159
49160 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
49161 described in
49162 @ifset man
49163 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors Connections and Programs}
49164 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors Connections and Programs'}.
49165 @end ifset
49166 @ifclear man
49167 @ref{Inferiors Connections and Programs}.
49168 @end ifclear
49169 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
49170
49171 @smallexample
49172 (@value{GDBP}) target extended-remote the-target:2345
49173 @end smallexample
49174
49175 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
49176 case.
49177 @c man end
49178
49179 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
49180 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
49181
49182 @itemize @bullet
49183
49184 @item
49185 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
49186
49187 @smallexample
49188 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
49189 @end smallexample
49190
49191 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
49192 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
49193 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
49194 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
49195 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
49196 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
49197 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
49198
49199 @item
49200 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
49201 program:
49202
49203 @smallexample
49204 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
49205 @end smallexample
49206
49207 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
49208 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
49209 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
49210 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
49211
49212 @item
49213 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
49214
49215 @smallexample
49216 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
49217 @end smallexample
49218
49219 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
49220 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
49221 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
49222 debug several processes in the same session.
49223 @end itemize
49224
49225 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
49226
49227 @table @env
49228
49229 @item --help
49230 List all options, with brief explanations.
49231
49232 @item --version
49233 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
49234
49235 @item --attach
49236 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
49237
49238 @smallexample
49239 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
49240 @end smallexample
49241
49242 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
49243 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
49244
49245 @item --multi
49246 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
49247 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
49248 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
49249 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
49250
49251 @smallexample
49252 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
49253 @end smallexample
49254
49255 @item --debug
49256 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
49257 process.
49258 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
49259 the developers.
49260
49261 @item --remote-debug
49262 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
49263 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
49264 the developers.
49265
49266 @item --debug-file=@var{filename}
49267 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to send any debug output to the given @var{filename}.
49268 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
49269 the developers.
49270
49271 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
49272 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
49273 of debugging output.
49274 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
49275
49276 @item --wrapper
49277 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
49278 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
49279 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
49280 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
49281
49282 @item --once
49283 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
49284 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
49285 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
49286 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
49287
49288 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
49289
49290 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
49291 @c QDisableRandomization.
49292
49293 @end table
49294 @c man end
49295
49296 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
49297 @ifset man
49298 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
49299 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
49300 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
49301
49302 @smallexample
49303 info gdb
49304 @end smallexample
49305
49306 should give you access to the complete manual.
49307
49308 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
49309 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
49310 @end ifset
49311 @c man end
49312
49313 @node gcore man
49314 @heading gcore
49315
49316 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
49317
49318 @format
49319 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
49320 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
49321 @c man end
49322 @end format
49323
49324 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
49325 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
49326 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
49327 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
49328 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
49329 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
49330 its job the program remains running without any change.
49331 @c man end
49332
49333 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
49334 @table @env
49335 @item -a
49336 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
49337 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
49338 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
49339 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
49340 dump-excluded-mappings}).
49341
49342 @item -o @var{prefix}
49343 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
49344 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
49345 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
49346 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
49347 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
49348 @end table
49349 @c man end
49350
49351 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
49352 @ifset man
49353 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
49354 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
49355 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
49356
49357 @smallexample
49358 info gdb
49359 @end smallexample
49360
49361 @noindent
49362 should give you access to the complete manual.
49363
49364 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
49365 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
49366 @end ifset
49367 @c man end
49368
49369 @node gdbinit man
49370 @heading gdbinit
49371
49372 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
49373
49374 @format
49375 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
49376 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
49377 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
49378 @end ifset
49379
49380 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR
49381 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR}/*
49382 @end ifset
49383
49384 ~/.config/gdb/gdbinit
49385
49386 ~/.gdbinit
49387
49388 ./.gdbinit
49389 @c man end
49390 @end format
49391
49392 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
49393 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
49394 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
49395 described in
49396 @ifset man
49397 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
49398 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
49399 @end ifset
49400 @ifclear man
49401 @ref{Sequences}.
49402 @end ifclear
49403
49404 Please read more in
49405 @ifset man
49406 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
49407 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
49408 @end ifset
49409 @ifclear man
49410 @ref{Startup}.
49411 @end ifclear
49412
49413 @table @env
49414 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
49415 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
49416 @end ifset
49417 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
49418 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
49419 @end ifclear
49420 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
49421 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
49422 See more in
49423 @ifset man
49424 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
49425 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
49426 @end ifset
49427 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR
49428 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR}
49429 @end ifset
49430 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT_DIR
49431 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit-dir} during compilation)
49432 @end ifclear
49433 System-wide initialization directory. All files in this directory are
49434 executed on startup unless user specified @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or
49435 @code{-n}, as long as they have a recognized file extension.
49436 See more in
49437 @ifset man
49438 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
49439 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
49440 @end ifset
49441 @ifclear man
49442 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
49443 @end ifclear
49444
49445 @item @file{~/.config/gdb/gdbinit} or @file{~/.gdbinit}
49446 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
49447 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
49448
49449 @item @file{.gdbinit}
49450 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
49451 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
49452 See more in
49453 @ifset man
49454 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
49455 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
49456 @end ifset
49457 @ifclear man
49458 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
49459 @end ifclear
49460 @end table
49461 @c man end
49462
49463 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
49464 @ifset man
49465 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
49466
49467 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
49468 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
49469 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
49470
49471 @smallexample
49472 info gdb
49473 @end smallexample
49474
49475 should give you access to the complete manual.
49476
49477 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
49478 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
49479 @end ifset
49480 @c man end
49481
49482 @node gdb-add-index man
49483 @heading gdb-add-index
49484 @pindex gdb-add-index
49485 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
49486
49487 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
49488
49489 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
49490 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
49491 @c man end
49492
49493 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
49494 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
49495 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
49496 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
49497 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
49498 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
49499
49500 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
49501 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
49502 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
49503 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
49504 named @code{.debug_*}).
49505
49506 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
49507 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
49508 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
49509 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
49510
49511 See more in
49512 @ifset man
49513 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
49514 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
49515 @end ifset
49516 @ifclear man
49517 @ref{Index Files}.
49518 @end ifclear
49519 @c man end
49520
49521 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
49522 @ifset man
49523 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
49524 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
49525 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
49526
49527 @smallexample
49528 info gdb
49529 @end smallexample
49530
49531 should give you access to the complete manual.
49532
49533 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
49534 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
49535 @end ifset
49536 @c man end
49537
49538 @include gpl.texi
49539
49540 @node GNU Free Documentation License
49541 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
49542 @include fdl.texi
49543
49544 @node Concept Index
49545 @unnumbered Concept Index
49546
49547 @printindex cp
49548
49549 @node Command and Variable Index
49550 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
49551
49552 @printindex fn
49553
49554 @tex
49555 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
49556 % meantime:
49557 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
49558 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
49559 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
49560 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
49561 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
49562 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
49563 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
49564 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
49565 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
49566 \page\colophon
49567 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
49568 @end tex
49569
49570 @bye